% This document takes a *long* time to compile from scratch. See % notes below. % % arara: lualatex if missing("glstex") % arara: bib2gls: { group: on, packages: [ mfirstuc-english ] } if missing("glstex") % arara: lualatex: { shell: yes } % arara: bib2gls: { group: on, packages: [ mfirstuc-english ] } % arara: lualatex % arara: lualatex if found("log", "Rerun to get") % % This manual creates example documents on the fly in the % directory created by the following line: \directlua{os.execute("mkdir -p glossaries-extra-manual-examples")} % If the above doesn't work, you'll have to create the directory % manually. % If the shell escape is enabled the example documents will be % automatically built with arara. If you already have the example .tex and % .pdf files in the above directory, the shell escape isn't % required. You'll need to run pdfcrop on the example pdf files if % you don't have the *-crop.pdf files. If you only have the .tex % files in the examples directory, then you need to run arara on % each .tex file (which will call pdfcrop where applicable). % % This document requires glossaries-extra v1.49, bib2gls v3.0 % and nlctuserguide.sty. Some of the example documents require % glossaries v4.50 and mfirstuc v2.08. If they haven't already % been uploaded to CTAN, they will be shortly. \documentclass[titlepage=false,oneside, fontsize=12pt,captions=tableheading]{scrbook} %\usepackage[autooneside=false]{scrlayer-scrpage} \usepackage{relsize} \usepackage{mfirstuc-english} \usepackage[ deephierarchy, numberedsection, abbreviations, %debug=showwrgloss,novref, %showtargets=annoteleft ]{nlctuserguide} \hypersetup{pdfauthor={Nicola Talbot}, pdftitle={glossaries-extra manual}, bookmarksdepth=5} \renewcommand*{\thispackagename}{glossaries-extra} \renewcommand{\cmdnotefmt}[1]{} \renewcommand*{\summarynotefmt}[1]{{\small(#1)}} \appto\terminaldesc{. See also \qt{\dickimawhref{latex/buildglossaries}{Incorporating makeglossaries or makeglossaries-lite or bib2gls into the document build}}} \newfontfamily\noto{Noto Serif} \newcommand{\textnoto}[1]{{\noto #1}} \providecommand{\eth}{\char"00F0} \providecommand{\Eth}{\char"00D0} \providecommand{\thorn}{\char"00FE} \providecommand{\Thorn}{\char"00DE} \providecommand{\wynn}{\char"01BF} \providecommand{\Wynn}{\char"01F7} \newcommand{\insularg}{\textnoto{\char"1D79}} \newcommand{\InsularG}{\textnoto{\char"A77D}} \providecommand{\longs}{\char"017F} \providecommand{\Schwa}{\char"018F} \providecommand{\schwa}{\char"0259} \newcommand{\attr}{\idxc{categoryattribute}{attribute}} \newcommand{\attrs}{\idxc{categoryattribute}{attributes}} \newcommand{\location}{\idxc{entrylocation}{location}} \newcommand{\locations}{\idxc{entrylocation}{locations}} \newcommand{\encap}[2][]{{\let\csfmt\csfmtcolourfont\gls[#1]{#2}}} \newcommand{\indexed}{\idxc{indexing}{indexed}} \newcommand{\recorded}{\idxc{indexing}{recorded}} \newcommand{\record}{\idxc{indexing}{record}} \newcommand{\records}{\idxc{indexing}{records}} \newcommand{\atentry}[1]{\texorpdfstring{\code{@#1}}{@#1}} \newcommand{\thecounter}[1]{\glslink{thecounter}{\csfmt{the\-#1}}} \newcommand{\theHcounter}[1]{\glslink{theHcounter}{\csfmt{the\-H\-#1}}} \newcommand{\thecountername}{\glslink{thecounter}{\csfmt{the\-\meta{counter-name}}}} \newcommand{\theHcountername}{\glslink{theHcounter}{\csfmt{the\-\meta{counter-name}}}} \newcommand{\recordcounterfield}[1]{% \glslink{opt.glosfield.recordcount.counter}{\csoptfmt{record\-count\dfullstop#1}}} \newcommand{\recordcounterlocationfield}[2]{% \glslink{opt.glosfield.recordcount.counter.location}{\csoptfmt{record\-count\dfullstop#1\dfullstop#2}}} \MFUhyphentrue \setabbreviationstyle[termacronym]{short-sm-desc} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.printgloss.}{\printglossopt} \newcommand{\printglossoptval}[2]{\optval{printgloss.#1}{#2}} \newcommand{\printglossoptvalm}[2]{\optval{printgloss.#1}{\marg{#2}}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.printunsrttab.}{\glstableopt} \newcommand{\glstableoptval}[2]{\optval{printunsrttab.#1}{#2}} \newcommand{\glstableoptvalm}[2]{\optval{printunsrttab.#1}{\marg{#2}}} \glsxtrnewgls{optval.printunsrttab.block-style.}{\glstableblockstyle} \newcommand{\glstableblockstyledef}[1]{\optionvaldef{printunsrttab.block-style}{#1}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.glsopt.}{\glsopt} \newcommand{\glsoptval}[2]{\optval{glsopt.#1}{#2}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.mglsopt.}{\mglsopt} \newcommand{\mglsoptval}[2]{\optval{mglsopt.#1}{#2}} \newcommand{\mglsoptvalm}[2]{\optvalm{mglsopt.#1}{#2}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.gloskey.}{\gloskey} \newcommand{\gloskeyval}[2]{\optval{gloskey.#1}{\marg{#2}}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.glosfield.}{\glosfield} \newcommand{\glosfielddisp}[3][]{\glsdisp[#1]{opt.glosfield.#2}{\csoptfmt{#3}}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.cat.}{\cat} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.catattr.}{\catattr} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.resource.}{\resourceopt} \newcommand{\resourceoptval}[2]{\optval{resource.#1}{#2}} \newcommand{\resourceoptvalm}[2]{\optval{resource.#1}{\marg{#2}}} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.glostyle.}{\glostyle} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.abbrstyle.}{\abbrstyle} \glsxtrnewgls{opt.acrstyle.}{\acrstyle} \newcommand*{\abbrstyledef}[1]{\optiondef{abbrstyle.#1}} \defsemanticcmd[style1]{\fieldfmt}{\texttt}{} \defsemanticcmd[style2]{\entryfmt}{\texttt}{} \newcommand*{\atentryfmt}[1]{\entryfmt{@#1}} \defsemanticcmd{\acrstylefmt}{\textsf}{} \defsemanticcmd[style3]{\abbrstylefmt}{\textsf}{} \defsemanticcmd{\glostylefmt}{\textsf}{} \defsemanticcmd[style4]{\catattrfmt}{\textsf}{} \newcommand*{\catfmt}{\csoptfmt} \newcommand{\hierarchical}{\glslink{hierarchicallevel}{hierarchical}} \renewcommand{\nlctuserguidecustomentryaliases}{% glossarystyle=index, abbreviationstyle=index, acronymstyle=index, } \appto{\nlctexampledisablecmds}{% \letcs{\opt}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\cat}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\catattr}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\resourceopt}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\abbrstyle}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\glostyle}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\glsopt}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\mglsopt}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\gloskey}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\glosfield}{@firstofone}% \letcs{\printglossopt}{@firstofone}% \let\resourceoptval\keyeqvalue \let\resourceoptvalm\keyeqvaluem \let\optval\keyeqvalue \let\opteqvalref\keyeqvalue \let\gloskeyval\keyeqvaluem \let\glsoptval\keyeqvaluem \let\mglsoptval\keyeqvaluem \let\printglossoptval\keyeqvalue \let\printglossoptvalm\keyeqvaluem } \newcommand{\genabbrvstyleexamplecode}[6]{% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\allowbreak\marg{\abbrstyle{#2}} #6\gls{newabbreviation}#4\marg{ex}\marg{#3}\marg{long form} \cbeg{document} First: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert]. Next: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert]. Full: \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{ex}[-insert]. First plural: \gls{glspl}\oarg{prereset}\marg{ex}[-insert].\newline \gls{printunsrtglossaries}\newline \cend{document} } \newcommand{\genabbrvstyleexampleresult}[6]{% \createexample*[fontsize={20},title={The \optfmt{#2} abbreviation style}, description={Example document demonstrating the #2 abbreviation style}, label={ex:abbrvstyle#2},#1] {% #5\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% #6\gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{#2}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}#4\marg{ex}\marg{#3}\marg{long form} } {% First: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert]. Next: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert].^^J% Full: \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{ex}[-insert]. First plural: \gls{glspl}\oarg{prereset}\marg{ex}[-insert].^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } } \newcommand{\genabbrvstyleexampleside}[6]{% \begin{coderesult} \genabbrvstyleexamplecode{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}% \tcblower \genabbrvstyleexampleresult{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}% \end{coderesult}% } \newcommand{\genabbrvstyleexamplestack}[6]{% \begin{codebox} \genabbrvstyleexamplecode{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}% \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \genabbrvstyleexampleresult{fontsize={11},#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}% \end{resultbox}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleucfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}{}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleucdescfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelcfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}{}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelcdescfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplesmfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}{}% {^^J\cmd{usepackage}\marg{relsize}}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplesmdescfn}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexampleside{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {^^J\cmd{usepackage}\marg{relsize}}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleuc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}{}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}{}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplesm}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}{}% {^^J\cmd{usepackage}\marg{relsize}}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleucdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplesmdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {^^J\cmd{usepackage}\marg{relsize}}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelcuser}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{extra info}}}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleucuser}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{extra info}}}% {}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexamplelcuserdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{shrt fm}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description},\newline \gloskeyval{user1}{extra info}}}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleucuserdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description},\newline \gloskeyval{user1}{extra info}}}{}{}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleuchyp}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {}% {}{\gls{glssetcategoryattributes}\marg{\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{\catattr{markwords},\catattr{markshortwords}}\marg{true}\newline}% } \newcommand*{\abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc}[2][]{% \genabbrvstyleexamplestack{#1}{#2}{SHRT FM}% {\oarg{\gloskeyval{description}{sample description}}\newline}% {}% {% \gls{glssetcategoryattributes}\marg{\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{\catattr{markwords},\catattr{markshortwords}}\marg{true}\newline }% } \newcommand{\summaryentryglossarystyle}[1]{% {% \renewcommand*{\glostylefmt}[1]{\texttt{##1}}% \genericsummaryentryoption{#1}% }% } \newcommand{\summaryentryabbreviationstyle}[1]{% {% \renewcommand*{\abbrstylefmt}[1]{\texttt{##1}}% \genericsummaryentryoption{#1}% }% } \renewcommand{\nlctuserguideletterrules}{% \glsxtrGeneralLatinAtoGrules \stringaccsupp \gcmdmetameta{gls\-xtr}{category}{}{field}{acc\-supp} {% \note{user defined} \desc{expands to the accessibility support command for the given \idx{internalfieldlabel} and category, which is used by \gls{glsfieldaccsupp}} } % \glsfieldaccsupp \gcmd{gls\-field\-acc\-supp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{replacement}\margm{content}\margm{field}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if \sty{glossaries-extra} has been loaded, this command will first check for the existence of the command \gls{glsxtrcategoryfieldaccsupp}. If that command doesn't exist or if \sty{glossaries-extra} hasn't been loaded, it then checks for the existence of \csmetafmt{gls}{field}{accsupp} (for example, \gls{glsshortaccsupp}). Failing that it will use \gls{glsaccsupp}. Whichever command is found first, \code{\meta{cs}\margm{replacement}\margm{content}} is performed.} } % \glsaccsupp \gcmd{gls\-acc\-supp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{replacement}\margm{content}} \desc{applies \meta{replacement} as the ActualText for \meta{content} using \gls{glsaccessibility}} } % \glsshortaccsupp \gcmd{gls\-short\-acc\-supp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{replacement}\margm{content}} \desc{applies \meta{replacement} as the expansion (E) attribute for \meta{content} using \gls{glsaccessibility}} } % \glsaccessibility \gcmd{gls\-ac\-ces\-si\-bil\-ity} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{PDF element}\margm{value}\margm{content}} \desc{applies \meta{value} as the accessibility attribute \meta{PDF element} for the given \meta{content}. This internally uses the accessibility support provided by \sty{accsupp}} } % % ABBREVIATION STYLES \gidxpl{abbrvstyle}% {% \common \field{text}{abbreviation style}% \desc{abbreviations defined using \gls{newabbreviation} will follow the style associated with the entry's category. If there is no style associated with the entry's category, the style for the \cat{abbreviation} category is used (the default is \abbrstyle{long-short}). Note that \sty{glossaries-extra} redefines \gls{newacronym} to use \gls{newabbreviation} with \code{\gloskey{category}\dequals\cat{acronym}} so any entry defined with \gls{newacronym} will use the abbreviation style for the \cat{acronym} category (the default is \abbrstyle{short-nolong})} } % long-short \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that shows the long form followed by the short form on \idx{firstuse}. If the \meta{insert} argument is used with the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands, it will be placed after the long form on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse}, only the short form is shown (followed by \meta{insert}, if provided). This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false} (which means that the \idx{glslike} commands won't use the \gloskey{first}\slash\gloskey{firstplural} or \gloskey{text}\slash\gloskey{plural} values)} } % long-short-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{long-short} but the \gloskey{description} must be supplied in \meta{options}} } % short-long \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen long}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that shows the short form followed by the long form on \idx{firstuse}. If the \meta{insert} argument is used with the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands, it will be placed after the short form on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse}, only the short form is shown (followed by \meta{insert}, if provided). This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false} (which means that the \idx{glslike} commands won't use the \gloskey{first}\slash\gloskey{firstplural} or \gloskey{text}\slash\gloskey{plural} values)} } % short-long-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-long} but the \gloskey{description} must be supplied in \meta{options}} } % short-nolong \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen nolong}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that only shows the short form on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. The long form won't be showed unless you use a command like \gls{glsxtrlong}. The full form will only be shown with commands like \gls{glsxtrfull}. This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true}} } % short \gabbrstyalias{short}{short-nolong} % short-nolong-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but the \gloskey{description} must be supplied in \meta{options}} } % short-desc \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen desc}{short-nolong-desc} % short-nolong-noreg \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but it will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % short-nolong-desc-noreg \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen desc\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but it will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % short-sc-nolong \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen nolong}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen sc}{short-sc-nolong} % short-sc-nolong-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-desc \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen desc}{short-sc-nolong-desc} % nolong-short \gabbrsty{nolong\dhyphen short}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but the \idx{inlinefullform} shows the long form followed by the short form in parentheses} } % nolong-short-noreg \gabbrsty{nolong\dhyphen short\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but it will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % nolong-short-sc \gabbrsty{nolong\dhyphen short\dhyphen sc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-noshort \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that only shows the long form on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. The short form won't be showed unless you use a command like \gls{glsxtrshort}. The full form will only be shown with commands like \gls{glsxtrfull}. This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true}} } % long \gabbrstyalias{long}{long-noshort} % long-noshort-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that only shows the long form on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. The short form won't be showed unless you use a command like \gls{glsxtrshort}. The \gloskey{description} key must be supplied. The full form will only be shown with commands like \gls{glsxtrfull}. This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true}} } % long-desc \gabbrstyalias{long-desc}{long-noshort-desc} % long-noshort-desc-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen desc\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but it will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % long-noshort-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but it will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % long-noshort-sc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen sc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-noshort-sc-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen sc\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-short-sc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen sc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-short-sc-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-long \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen long}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-long-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-short-sm \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen sm}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % long-short-sm-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % long-short-em \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-short-em-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-em-short-em \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen short\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-em-short-em-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen short\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-sm-long \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen long}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-long-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-nolong \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen nolong}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen sm}{short-sm-nolong} % short-sm-nolong-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-desc \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen desc}{short-sm-nolong-desc} % nolong-short-sm \gabbrsty{nolong\dhyphen short\dhyphen sm}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % long-noshort-sm \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen sm}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % long-noshort-sm-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen sm\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-em-long \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen long}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-long-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-long-em \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen long\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-long-em-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen long\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-nolong \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen nolong}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen em}{short-em-nolong} % short-em-nolong-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen nolong\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-desc \gabbrstyalias{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}{short-em-nolong-desc} % nolong-short-em \gabbrsty{nolong\dhyphen short\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-noshort-em \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-noshort-em-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-em-noshort-em \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-em-noshort-em-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but formats both the long and short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-em-noshort-em-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em} but sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % long-em-noshort-em-desc-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen em\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen em\dhyphen desc\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em-desc} but sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}} } % short-footnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen footnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that shows the short form with the long form as a footnote on \idx{firstuse}. If the \meta{insert} argument is used with the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands, it will be placed after the short form, before the footnote marker, on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse}, only the short form is shown (followed by \meta{insert}, if provided). The \idx{inlinefullform} shows the short form followed by the long form in parentheses. This style sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false} (which means that the \idx{glslike} commands won't use the \gloskey{first}\slash\gloskey{firstplural} or \gloskey{text}\slash\gloskey{plural} values). This style also sets the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute to \code{true} to avoid nesting the footnote marker link. If you want hyperlinks on \idx{firstuse}, use the \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} style instead} } % footnote \gabbrstyalias{footnote}{short-footnote} % short-footnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen footnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but the \gloskey{description} must be supplied in \meta{options}} } % footnote-desc \gabbrstyalias{footnote\dhyphen desc}{short-footnote-desc} % short-postfootnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen postfootnote}% {% \desc{similar to \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but the footnote is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % postfootnote \gabbrstyalias{postfootnote}{short-postfootnote} % short-postfootnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen postfootnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{as \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but the \gloskey{description} must be supplied in \meta{options}} } % postfootnote-desc \gabbrstyalias{postfootnote\dhyphen desc}{short-postfootnote-desc} % short-sc-footnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen footnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-footnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen footnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-postfootnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen postfootnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sc-postfootnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen postfootnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % short-sm-footnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen footnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-footnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen footnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-postfootnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen postfootnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-sm-postfootnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen sm\dhyphen postfootnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but formats the short form in a smaller font (\gls{textsmaller}). The \sty{relsize} package is must be loaded} } % short-em-footnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen footnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-footnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen footnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-postfootnote \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen postfootnote}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % short-em-postfootnote-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen em\dhyphen postfootnote\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but formats the short form in an emphasized font (\gls{emph})} } % long-short-user \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen user}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but includes the value of the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield} (if set) in the parenthetical content} } % long-postshort-user \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen user}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} but the parenthetical content is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % long-short-user-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen user\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} but the description must be supplied} } % long-postshort-user-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen user\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user} but the description must be supplied} } % long-postshort-sc-user \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen sc\dhyphen user}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user} but formats the short form in a small caps font (\gls{textsc}). The short form should therefore be in lowercase} } % long-postshort-sc-user-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen sc\dhyphen user\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user} but the description must be supplied} } % short-postlong-user \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen postlong\dhyphen user}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but includes the value of the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield} (if set) in the parenthetical content, which is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % short-postlong-user-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen postlong\dhyphen user\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-postlong-user} but the description must be supplied} } % short-long-user \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen long\dhyphen user}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but includes the value of the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield} (if set) in the parenthetical content} } % short-long-user-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen long\dhyphen user\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long-user} but the description must be supplied} } % long-hyphen-short-hyphen \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen short\dhyphen hyphen}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-short} but checks if the inserted material starts with a hyphen (use with \catattr{markwords} or \catattr{markshortwords} attributes)} } % long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen hyphen}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} but places the insert and parenthetical material in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen short\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} but the description must be supplied} } % long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen postshort\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc} but places the insert and parenthetical material in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen desc\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but checks if the inserted material starts with a hyphen (use with \catattr{markwords} attribute)} } % long-hyphen-noshort-noreg \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen noshort\dhyphen noreg}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} but doesn't show the short form on \idx{firstuse}} } % short-hyphen-long-hyphen \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen long\dhyphen hyphen}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-long} but checks if the inserted material starts with a hyphen (use with \catattr{markwords} or \catattr{markshortwords} attributes)} } % short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen long\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} but the description must be supplied} } % short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen postlong\dhyphen hyphen}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} but the insert and parenthetical material are placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen-desc \gabbrsty{short\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen postlong\dhyphen hyphen\dhyphen desc}% {% \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc} but the insert and parenthetical material are placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % long-only-short-only \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen only\dhyphen short\dhyphen only} { \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} that only shows the long form on \idx{firstuse} and only shows the short form on \idx{subsequentuse}} } % long-only-short-only-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen only\dhyphen short\dhyphen only\dhyphen desc} { \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only} but the description must be supplied} } % long-only-short-sc-only \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen only\dhyphen short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen only} { \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only} but uses \idx{smallcaps} for the short form} } % long-only-short-sc-only-desc \gabbrsty{long\dhyphen only\dhyphen short\dhyphen sc\dhyphen only\dhyphen desc} { \desc{an \idx{abbrvstyle} like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-sc-only} but the description must be supplied} } % long-sc \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen sc}{long-noshort-sc} % long-desc-sc \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sc}{long-noshort-sc-desc} % footnote-sc \gdepabbrsty{footnote\dhyphen sc}{short-sc-footnote} % postfootnote-sc \gdepabbrsty{postfootnote\dhyphen sc}{short-sc-postfootnote} % long-sm \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen sm}{long-noshort-sm} % long-desc-sm \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sm}{long-noshort-sm-desc} % footnote-sm \gdepabbrsty{footnote\dhyphen sm}{short-sm-footnote} % postfootnote-sm \gdepabbrsty{postfootnote\dhyphen sm}{short-sm-postfootnote} % long-em \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen em}{long-noshort-em} % long-desc-em \gdepabbrsty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen em}{long-noshort-em-desc} % footnote-em \gdepabbrsty{footnote\dhyphen em}{short-em-footnote} % postfootnote-em \gdepabbrsty{postfootnote\dhyphen em}{short-em-postfootnote} % base acronym styles \gidx{acronymstyle}{\name{acronym (base) style}% \field{text}{acronym style} } \gacrsty{long\dhyphen short}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sc\dhyphen short}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sm\dhyphen short}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sp\dhyphen short}{} \gacrsty{short\dhyphen long}{} \gacrsty{sc\dhyphen short\dhyphen long}{} \gacrsty{sm\dhyphen short\dhyphen long}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen short\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sc\dhyphen short\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sm\dhyphen short\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{long\dhyphen sp\dhyphen short\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{short\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{sc\dhyphen short\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{sm\dhyphen short\dhyphen long\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{dua}{} \gacrsty{dua\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{footnote}{} \gacrsty{footnote\dhyphen sc}{} \gacrsty{footnote\dhyphen sm}{} \gacrsty{footnote\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{footnote\dhyphen sc\dhyphen desc}{} \gacrsty{footnote\dhyphen sm\dhyphen desc}{} % GLOSSARY STYLES: % \setglossarystyle \gcmd{set\-glossary\-style}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+}% \syntax{\margm{style-name}} \desc{set the current \idx{glossarystyle} to \meta{style-name}. Redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} to include \gls{glsxtrpreglossarystyle}} } % \glsxtrpreglossarystyle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-pre\-glossary\-style} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+}% \desc{hook performed by \gls{setglossarystyle} to initialise default definitions of style commands} } \gidxpl{glossarystyle}% {% \common \field{text}{glossary style}% \desc{the default style may be set with \gls{setglossarystyle} or use: \begin{compactcodebox} \csfmt{usepackage}[\optval{stylemods}{\meta{name}},\optval{style}{\meta{style-name}}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{compactcodebox} where the style is provided by package \styfmt{glossary-\meta{name}}. The default style can be overridden for individual \idxpl{glossary} with the \printglossopt{style} option. For a summary of all available styles, see \gallerypage{glossaries-styles}{Gallery: Predefined Styles}} } % glossary style: inline \gglosty{inline}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline}}% \desc{a compact style with all entries listed in the same paragraph and no \idxpl{group}, locations or symbols} } % glossary style: list \gglosty{list}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}}% \desc{this style uses the \env{description} environment and places the entry name in the optional argument of \gls{item}. Symbols and sub-entry names are not shown} } % glossary style: listgroup \gglosty{list\-group}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}}% \desc{as \glostyle{list} but has headers at the start of each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: listhypergroup \gglosty{list\-hyper\-group}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}}% \desc{as \glostyle{listgroup} but has a row at the start with hyperlinks to each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: altlist \gglosty{alt\-list}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}}% \desc{as \glostyle{list} but starts the description on a new line} } % glossary style: listdotted \gglosty{list\-dotted}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}}% \desc{a \glostyle{list}-like style that has a dotted leader between the name and description. The \idx{locationlist} isn't shown} } % glossary style: long \gglosty{long}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-long}}% \desc{this style uses the \env{longtable} environment (provided by the \sty{longtable} package). Symbols and sub-entry names are not shown} } % glossary style: longheader \gglosty{longheader}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-long}}% \desc{this style uses the \env{longtable} environment (provided by the \sty{longtable} package) with a header row. Symbols and sub-entry names are not shown} } % glossary style: long-name-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the name and the description} } % glossary style: long-desc-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the description and the name} } % glossary style: long-name-desc-loc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen desc\dhyphen loc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the name, description and \idx{locationlist}} } % glossary style: long-loc-desc-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen loc\dhyphen desc\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the \idx{locationlist}, description and name} } % glossary style: long-name-desc-sym \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sym}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the name, description and symbol} } % glossary style: long-name-desc-sym-loc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sym\dhyphen loc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the name, description, symbol and \idx{locationlist}} } % glossary style: long-name-sym-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen sym\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the name, symbol and description} } % glossary style: long-name-sym-desc-loc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen sym\dhyphen desc\dhyphen loc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the name, symbol, description and \idx{locationlist}} } % glossary style: long-sym-desc-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen sym\dhyphen desc\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the symbol, description and name} } % glossary style: long-loc-sym-desc-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen loc\dhyphen sym\dhyphen desc\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the \idx{locationlist}, symbol, description and name} } % glossary style: long-desc-sym-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sym\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the description, symbol and name} } % glossary style: long-loc-desc-sym-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen loc\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sym\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the \idx{locationlist}, description, symbol and name} } % glossary style: long-sym-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen sym\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the symbol and the description} } % glossary style: long-desc-sym \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen sym}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the description and the symbol} } % glossary style: abbr-short-long \gglosty{abbr\dhyphen short\dhyphen long}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the short form and the long form} } % glossary style: abbr-long-short \gglosty{abbr\dhyphen long\dhyphen short}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the long form and the short form} } % glossary style: long-name-custom1 \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom1}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the name and the custom 1 field} } % glossary style: long-name-custom2 \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom2}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the name, custom 1 field and custom 2 field} } % glossary style: long-name-custom3 \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom3}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the name, custom 1 field, custom 2 field and custom 3 field} } % glossary style: long-name-custom1-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom1\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the name, the custom 1 field and the description} } % glossary style: long-name-custom2-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom2\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the name, the custom 1 field, the custom 2 field and the description} } % glossary style: long-name-custom3-desc \gglosty{long\dhyphen name\dhyphen custom3\dhyphen desc}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with five columns: the name, the custom 1 field, the custom 2 field, the custom 3 field and the description} } % glossary style: long-custom1-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen custom1\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with two columns: the custom 1 field and the name} } % glossary style: long-custom2-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen custom2\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the custom 1 field, custom 2 field, and the name} } % glossary style: long-custom3-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen custom3\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the custom 1 field, custom 2 field, custom 3 field, and the name} } % glossary style: long-desc-custom1-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen custom1\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with three columns: the description, the custom 1 field and the name} } % glossary style: long-desc-custom2-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen custom2\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with four columns: the description, the custom 1 field, the custom 2 field and the name} } % glossary style: long-desc-custom3-name \gglosty{long\dhyphen desc\dhyphen custom3\dhyphen name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} in a table for (either \env{longtable} or \env{tabular}) with five columns: the description, the custom 1 field, the custom 2 field, the custom 3 field and the name} } % glossary style: long-booktabs \gglosty{long\dhyphen booktabs} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longbooktabs} v4.21+}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} using \env{longtable} and horizontal rules from the \sty{booktabs} package} } % glossary style: longragged \gglosty{longragged} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-longragged}}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} using \env{longtable} with ragged right paragraph formatting for the description column} } % glossary style: super \gglosty{super} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-super}}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} using \env{supertabular}} } % glossary style: superragged \gglosty{superragged} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-superragged}}% \desc{this style displays the \idx{glossary} using \env{supertabular} with ragged right paragraph formatting for the description column} } % glossary style: topic \gglosty{topic} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic}}% \desc{this style is designed for hierarchical glossaries where the top-level entry represents a topic} } % glossary style: topicmcols \gglosty{topicmcols} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic}}% \desc{similar to \glostyle{topic} but the sub-entries are placed in a \env{multicols} environment} } % glossary style: table \gglosty{table} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table}}% \desc{this style is specific to \gls{printunsrttable}} } % glossary style: bookindex \gglosty{bookindex}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex}}% \desc{this style is designed for indexes. Symbols and descriptions are not shown. Since descriptions aren't shown, there's no \gls{postdeschook}} } % glossary style: index \gglosty{index}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{a hierarchical style that supports up to level~2, similar to normal indexes, but symbols and descriptions are shown} } % glossary style: tree \gglosty{tree}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{a hierarchical style that supports unlimited levels (although a deep hierarchy may not fit the available line width) with that shows symbols and descriptions} } % glossary style: treegroup \gglosty{tree\-group}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{as \glostyle{tree} but has headers at the start of each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: treehypergroup \gglosty{tree\-hyper\-group}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{as \glostyle{treegroup} but has a row at the start with hyperlinks to each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: indexgroup \gglosty{index\-group}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{as \glostyle{index} but has headers at the start of each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: alttree \gglosty{alt\-tree}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{like \glostyle{tree} but the width of the widest name must be supplied (using a command like \gls{glssetwidest})} } % glossary style: alttreegroup \gglosty{alt\-tree\-group}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{as \glostyle{alttree} but has headers at the start of each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: treenoname \gglosty{tree\-no\-name}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}}% \desc{like \glostyle{tree} but the child entries don't have their name shown} } % glossary style: mcolindex \gglosty{mcol\-index}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-mcols}}% \desc{as \glostyle{index} but puts the content inside a \env{multicols} environment} } % glossary style: mcolindexgroup \gglosty{mcol\-index\-group}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-mcols}}% \desc{as \glostyle{mcolindex} but has headers at the start of each \idx{group}} } % glossary style: mcoltree \gglosty{mcol\-tree}% { \providedby{\sty{glossary-mcols}}% \desc{as \glostyle{tree} but puts the content inside a \env{multicols} environment} } % PACKAGE OPTIONS % package option prefix \gstyopt{prefix} {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{loads \sty{glossaries-prefix}} } % package option accsupp \gstyopt{accsupp} {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{loads \sty{glossaries-accsupp}} } % package option style \gstyopt{style}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \syntax{\meta{style-name}} \desc{sets the default \idx{glossarystyle} to \meta{style-name}}% } % package option nostyles \gstyopt{nostyles}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{don't load the default set of predefined styles. Note that if \sty{glossaries} is loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}, then this option should be passed directly to \sty{glossaries} not \sty{glossaries-extra} otherwise it will be too late to implement}% } % package option nolist \gstyopt{nolist}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{don't load \sty{glossary-list}, which is normally loaded automatically. Note that if \sty{glossaries} is loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}, then this option should be passed directly to \sty{glossaries} not \sty{glossaries-extra} otherwise it will be too late to implement}% } % package option nolong \gstyopt{nolong}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{don't load \sty{glossary-long}, which is normally loaded automatically. Note that if \sty{glossaries} is loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}, then this option should be passed directly to \sty{glossaries} not \sty{glossaries-extra} otherwise it will be too late to implement}% } % package option nosuper \gstyopt{nosuper}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{don't load \sty{glossary-super}, which is normally loaded automatically. Note that if \sty{glossaries} is loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}, then this option should be passed directly to \sty{glossaries} not \sty{glossaries-extra} otherwise it will be too late to implement}% } % package option notree \gstyopt{notree}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{don't load \sty{glossary-tree}, which is normally loaded automatically. Note that if \sty{glossaries} is loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}, then this option should be passed directly to \sty{glossaries} not \sty{glossaries-extra} otherwise it will be too late to implement}% } % package option stylemods \gstyopt{stylemods} {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \syntax{\meta{value}} \defval{default} \desc{loads \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} with the given options. If \opteqvalref{stylemods}{default} then no options are passed to \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods}} } % package option stylemods values % stylemods=default \goptval{stylemods}{default}{\desc{load \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} with no options (patches any predefined styles that have been loaded)}% } % stylemods=all \goptval{stylemods}{all}% {% \desc{load \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} with all predefined styles}% } % stylemods= \goptmetaval{stylemods}{list}% {% \desc{load \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} with all the listed styles}% } \gstyopt{all}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra-stylemods}% \desc{load all predefined styles}% } \gstyopt{name}% {% \name{{}\meta{name}}% \inpackage{glossaries-extra-stylemods}% \desc{load package \styfmt{glossary-\meta{name}}}% } % package option section \gstyopt{section} { \inpackage{glossaries}% \syntax{\meta{value}} \defval{section} \desc{indicates which section heading command to use for the \idx{glossary}. The value may be one of the standard sectioning command's control sequence name (without the leading backslash), such as \code{chapter} or \code{section}} } % package option sort \gstyopt{sort}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{standard} \desc{indicates how the \gloskey{sort} key should automatically be assigned if not explicitly provided (for \gls{makeglossaries} and \gls{makenoidxglossaries} only)} } \goptval{sort}{none}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.30+} \desc{don't process the \gloskey{sort} key. Use this option if no \idx{indexing} is required for a slightly faster build}% } \goptval{sort}{clear}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \desc{sets the \gloskey{sort} key to an empty value. Use this option if no \idx{indexing} is required for a slightly faster build}% }% \goptval{sort}{standard}% {% \desc{use the value of the \gloskey{name} key as the default for the \gloskey{sort} key and implement the \gls{glsprestandardsort} hook}% } \goptval{sort}{def}% {% \desc{use the (zero-padded) order of definition as the default for the \gloskey{sort} key}% } \goptval{sort}{use}% {% \desc{use the (zero-padded) order of use as the default for the \gloskey{sort} key}% } % package option sanitizesort \gstyopt{sanitize\-sort}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initvalvaries \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether the default sort value should be sanitized (only applicable with \opteqvalref{sort}{standard})} } % package option debug (base) \glsbibwriteentry{packageoption}{opt.base.debug}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.24+}% \field{name}{{}\styoptfmt{debug}}% \initval{false}% \syntax{\meta{value}} \inpackage{glossaries} \note{modified by \sty{glossaries-extra}['s] \opt{debug} option} \desc{adds markers to the document for debugging purposes} } % package option debug \gstyopt{debug}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \defval{true}% \initval{false}% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{provides debugging information. Some options are also available with just the base \sty{glossaries} package} } % package option debug values \goptval{debug}{true}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.24+}% \desc{writes \code{wrglossary(\meta{type})(\meta{\idx{indexing} info})} to the \ext+{log} file if there is an attempt to index an entry before the associated \idx{indexing} file has been opened (\app{makeindex} and \app{xindy} only). With \sty{glossaries-extra}, this setting will also display the label of any undefined entries that are referenced in the document} } \goptval{debug}{false}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.24+}% \desc{disable debugging actions} } \goptval{debug}{showtargets}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.24+}% \desc{implements \optval{debug}{true} and also shows target markers in the document}% \field{seealso}{opt.showtargets} } \goptval{debug}{showaccsupp}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.45+}% \desc{implements \optval{debug}{true} and also shows accessibility information in the document} } \goptval{debug}{showwrgloss}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+}% \desc{implements \optval{debug}{true} and also shows a marker in the document whenever the entry is \indexed\ and (if used with \opt{indexcounter}) will mark where the \ctr{wrglossary} counter is incremented} } \goptval{debug}{all}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+}% \desc{implements all debugging options} } % package option showtargets \gstyopt{show\-targets}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+}% \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{implements \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets}} } \goptval{showtargets}{left}% {% \desc{a marker is placed to the left of the link/target and a marginal note is used in outer mode} } \goptval{showtargets}{right}% {% \desc{a marker is placed to the right of the link/target and a marginal note is used in outer mode} } \goptval{showtargets}{innerleft}% {% \desc{a marker and annotation are placed to the left of the link/target in all modes} } \goptval{showtargets}{innerright}% {% \desc{a marker and annotation are placed to the left of the link/target in all modes} } \goptval{showtargets}{annoteleft}% {% \desc{markers are placed on either side of the link/target with the annotation on the left in all modes} } \goptval{showtargets}{annoteright}% {% \desc{markers are placed on either side of the link/target with the annotation on the right in all modes} } % package option undefaction \gstyopt{undef\-action}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{error} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{indicates whether to trigger an error or warning if an unknown entry label is referenced} } \goptval{undefaction}{error}% {% \desc{trigger an error if an unknown entry label is referenced} } \goptval{undefaction}{warn}% {% \desc{trigger a warning if an unknown entry label is referenced} } % package option makeindex \gstyopt{makeindex} { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates that the \idx{indexing} should be performed by \app+{makeindex} (default)} } % package option xindy \gstyopt{xindy} { \syntax{\margm{options}} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates that the \idx{indexing} should be performed by \app+{xindy}} } % package option hyperfirst \gstyopt{hyper\-first}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates whether or not to use hyperlinks on \idx{firstuse} (if hyperlinks are supported)} } % package option indexonlyfirst \gstyopt{index\-only\-first}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates whether or not to only \idxc{indexing}{index} the \idx{firstuse}} } % package option indexcrossrefs \gstyopt{index\-cross\-refs}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initvalvaries \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{indicates whether or not to enable automatic \idx{indexing} of cross-referenced entries} } \goptval{indexcrossrefs}{true}% {% \desc{enables automatic \idx{indexing} of cross-referenced entries} } \goptval{indexcrossrefs}{false}% {% \desc{disables automatic \idx{indexing} of cross-referenced entries} } % package option autoseeindex \gstyopt{auto\-see\-index}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{indicates whether or not to enable automatic \idx{indexing} of \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} fields} } \goptval{autoseeindex}{true}% {% \desc{enables automatic \idx{indexing} of \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} fields} } \goptval{autoseeindex}{false}% {% \desc{disables automatic \idx{indexing} of \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} fields} } % package option seenoindex \gstyopt{see\-no\-index}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{error} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates what to do if the \gloskey{see} key is used before the associated \idx{indexing} files have been opened by \gls{makeglossaries}} } \goptval{seenoindex}{error}% {% \desc{triggers an error if the \gloskey{see} key is used before \gls{makeglossaries}} } \goptval{seenoindex}{warn}% {% \desc{triggers a warning if the \gloskey{see} key is used before \gls{makeglossaries}} } \goptval{seenoindex}{ignore}% {% \desc{does nothing if the \gloskey{see} key is used before \gls{makeglossaries}} } % package option record \gstyopt{record}% {% \common \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{off} \defval{only} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{indicates whether or not \app{bib2gls} is being used (in which case entry \idx{indexing} is performed by adding \app{bib2gls} \records\ in the \ext{aux} file)} } % package option record=off \goptval{record}{off}% {% \desc{entry \idx{indexing} is performed as per the base \sty{glossaries} package, using either \gls{makeglossaries} or \gls{makenoidxglossaries}} } % package option record=only \goptval{record}{only}% {% \desc{entry \idx{indexing} is performed by adding \app{bib2gls} \records\ in the \ext{aux} file. Glossaries should be displayed with the \idx{unsrtfam}} } % package option record=nameref \goptval{record}{name\-ref}% {% \desc{entry \idx{indexing} is performed by adding \app{bib2gls} nameref \records\ in the \ext{aux} file. Glossaries should be displayed with the \idx{unsrtfam}} } % package option record=hybrid \goptval{record}{hybrid}% {% \desc{performs a mixture of \app{bib2gls} \records\ in the \ext{aux} file (to select entries from a \ext{bib} file) and \app+{makeindex}\slash\app+{xindy} \idx{indexing} in their associated files. The actual sorting and collation is performed by the \idx{indexingapp}, so \resourceoptval{sort}{none} and \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false} should be used in \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} (because it's redundant to make \app{bib2gls} sort and collate as well). This setting should be used with \gls{makeglossaries} before \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} and \idxpl{glossary} should be displayed with \gls{printglossary} (or \gls{printglossaries}). There's little point in using this setting unless you have a custom \app{xindy} module that you can't convert to an equivalent set of \app{bib2gls} options} } % package option record=alsoindex \goptval{record}{also\-index}% {% \deprecated \field{alias}{optval.record.hybrid} } % package option bibglsaux \gstyopt{bib\-gls\-aux}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \app{bib2gls} v3.0+} \initvalempty \syntax{\meta{basename}} \desc{if set, an additional \ext+{aux} file called \metafilefmt{}{basename}{.aux} will be created in which to store the \app{bib2gls} records. This file will be skipped by \LaTeX\ when the main \ext{aux} file is input but will be read by \app{bib2gls}} } % package option numberedsection \gstyopt{numbered\-section} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \defval{nolabel} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{indicates whether or not \idx{glossary} section headers will be numbered and also if they should automatically be labelled} } % package option savenumberlist \gstyopt{save\-number\-list} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{if true, patches the \idx{locationlist} encapsulator to save the \idx{locationlist}. With \app{bib2gls}, use the \resourceopt{save-locations} resource option} } % package option equations \gstyopt{equations} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{automatically switch the \idx{locationcounter} to \ctr{equation} when inside a numbered equation environment} } % package option floats \gstyopt{floats} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{automatically switch the \idx{locationcounter} to the corresponding counter when inside a floating environment} } % package option indexcounter \gstyopt{index\-counter} { \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{defines the index counter \ctr{wrglossary} and implements \optval{counter}{wrglossary}} } % counter wrglossary \gctr{wr\-glossary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \desc{a counter that is incremented every time an entry is \indexed} } % package option counter \gstyopt{counter}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \syntax{\meta{counter-name}} \initval{page} \desc{sets the default \idx{locationcounter}}% } % package option nonumberlist \gstyopt{no\-number\-list}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{set no \glspl{locationlist} as the default for all \idxpl{glossary}. May be overridden for individual \idxpl{glossary} with \printglossoptval{nonumberlist}{true}} } % package option entrycounter \gstyopt{entry\-counter}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{enables the entry counter for top-level entries} } % package option subentrycounter \gstyopt{sub\-entry\-counter}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{enables the entry counter for level~1 entries} } % package option writeglslabels \gstyopt{write\-gls\-labels}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{creates a file called \csfmt{jobname}\filefmt{.}\ext+{glslabels} that contains all defined entry labels (for the benefit of autocompletion tools)} } % package option writeglslabelnames \gstyopt{write\-gls\-label\-names}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{creates a file called \csfmt{jobname}\filefmt{.}\ext+{glslabels} that contains all defined entry labels and names (for the benefit of autocompletion tools)} } % package option nomain \gstyopt{nomain}% {% \inpackage{glossaries}% \desc{prevents the definition of the \code{main} \idx{glossary}. You will need to define another \idx{glossary} to use instead. For example, with the \opt{acronyms} package option}% } % package option acronymlists \gstyopt{acronym\-lists}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\margm{label-list}} \banned \desc{identifies the \idxpl{glossary} that contain acronyms (defined with the base \sty{glossaries} packages acronym mechanism)} } % package option shortcuts \gstyopt{shortcuts}% { \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \syntax{\margm{value}} \initval{none} \desc{defines various shortcut commands (boolean only with just the base \sty{glossaries} package)} } % package option shortcuts=none \goptval{shortcuts}{none}% {% \desc{don't define any shortcut commands} } % package option shortcuts=all \goptval{shortcuts}{all}% {% \desc{implements \optval{shortcuts}{ac}, \optval{shortcuts}{abbreviations}, \optval{shortcuts}{other}} } % package option shortcuts=acother \goptval{shortcuts}{acother}% {% \desc{implements \optval{shortcuts}{ac} and \optval{shortcuts}{other}} } % package option shortcuts=abother \goptval{shortcuts}{abother}% {% \desc{implements \optval{shortcuts}{abbreviations} and \optval{shortcuts}{other}} } % package option shortcuts=true \goptval{shortcuts}{true}% {% \field{alias}{optval.shortcuts.all} } % package option shortcuts=false \goptval{shortcuts}{false}% {% \field{alias}{optval.shortcuts.all} } % package option shortcuts=ac \goptval{shortcuts}{ac}% {% \desc{implements the acronym shortcuts that are compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % package option shortcuts=abbreviations \goptval{shortcuts}{abbreviations}% {% \desc{implements the abbreviation shortcuts} } % package option shortcuts=abbr \goptval{shortcuts}{abbr}% {% \field{alias}{optval.shortcuts.abbreviations} } % package option shortcuts=other \goptval{shortcuts}{other}% {% \desc{implements the shortcuts \gls{newentry}, \gls{newsym} and \gls{newnum}} } % package option shortcuts=acronyms \goptval{shortcuts}{acronyms}% {% \desc{implements the acronym shortcuts. Don't use this option unless you have reverted \gls{newacronym} back to the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism} } % package option shortcuts=acro \goptval{shortcuts}{acro}% {% \field{alias}{optval.shortcuts.acronyms} } % package option acronyms \gstyopt{acronyms}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{acronym}, redefines \gls{acronymtype} to \code{acronym}, and provides \gls{printacronyms}} } % package option acronym \gstyopt{acronym}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{if true, provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{acronym} and title given by \gls{acronymname}, redefines \gls{acronymtype} to \code{acronym}, and provides \gls{printacronyms}} } % package option abbreviations \gstyopt{abbreviations}% { \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \desc{provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{abbreviations} and title given by \gls{abbreviationsname}, redefines \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} to \code{abbreviations}, redefines \gls{acronymtype} to \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} (unless the \opt{acronym} or \opt{acronyms} option has been used), and provides \gls{printabbreviations}} } % package option symbols \gstyopt{symbols}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{symbols} and the title \gls{glssymbolsgroupname}, and provides \gls{printsymbols}. With \sty{glossaries-extra}, this additionally defines \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol}} } % package option numbers \gstyopt{numbers}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{numbers} and the title \gls{glsnumbersgroupname}, and provides \gls{printnumbers}. With \sty{glossaries-extra}, this additionally defines \gls{glsxtrnewnumber}} } % package option index \gstyopt{index}% { \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{provides a new \idx{glossary} with the label \code{index} and the title \gls{indexname}, and provides \gls{printindex} and \gls{newterm}} } % package option nomissingglstext \gstyopt{no\-missing\-gls\-text}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to display warning text if the external \idx{glossary} file hasn't been generated due to an incomplete build} } % package option nopostdot \gstyopt{nopostdot}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{if true, suppresses the automatic insertion of a \idx{fullstop} after each entry's description in the \idx{glossary} (for styles that support this). The default is \optval{nopostdot}{true} for \sty{glossaries-extra} and \optval{nopostdot}{false} for just \sty{glossaries}} \field{seealso}{opt.postdot,opt.postpunc} } % package option postdot \gstyopt{postdot}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+}% \desc{a shortcut for \optval{nopostdot}{false}} \field{seealso}{opt.nopostdot,opt.postpunc} } % package option postpunc \gstyopt{postpunc}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+}% \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{an alternative to \opt{postdot}, this can be used to insert a different punctuation character after the description} } % package option postpunc values \goptval{postpunc}{dot}% {% \desc{equivalent to \opt{postdot} or \optval{nopostdot}{false}} } \goptval{postpunc}{comma}% {% \desc{inserts a comma after the description} } \goptval{postpunc}{none}% {% \desc{switches off automatic post-description punctuation insertion} } \goptval{postpunc}{other}% {% \name{{}\meta{punctuation}} \desc{inserts \meta{punctuation} after the description} } % package option nowarn \gstyopt{no\-warn}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{suppresses warnings} } % package option noredefwarn \gstyopt{noredefwarn}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{suppresses a warning if \env{theglossary} or \gls{printglossary} have already been defined (which indicates that the document class or another package also provides a mechanism for creating a \idx{glossary} that could potentially conflict with \sty{glossaries}). This option is automatically implemented with \sty{glossaries-extra}} } % package option translate \gstyopt{translate}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{babel} \desc{indicates how multilingual support should be provided, if applicable} } % package option translate values \goptval{translate}{babel}% {% \desc{uses \sty{babel}['s] language hooks to implement multilingual support (default for \sty{glossaries-extra} if \sty{babel} has been detected)} } \goptval{translate}{true}% {% \desc{uses \sty{translator}['s] language hooks to implement multilingual support (default for \sty{glossaries} if a language package has been detected)} } \goptval{translate}{false}% {% \desc{don't implement multilingual support (default if no language package has been detected)} } % package option notranslate \gstyopt{notranslate}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \desc{equivalent to \optval{translate}{false}} } % package option nogroupskip \gstyopt{nogroupskip}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{if true, suppress the gap between letter \idxpl{group} in the \idxpl{glossary} by default} } % package option toc \gstyopt{toc}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{if true, each \idx{glossary} will be automatically added to the table of contents. The default is \optval{toc}{false} with \sty{glossaries} and \optval{toc}{true} with \sty{glossaries-extra}} } % package option docdef \gstyopt{docdef}% {% \inpackage{glossaries-extra} \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not \gls{newglossaryentry} is permitted in the \env{document} environment} } \goptval{docdef}{false}% {% \desc{don't allow \gls{newglossaryentry} in the \env{document} environment} } \goptval{docdef}{true}% {% \desc{allow \gls{newglossaryentry} in the \env{document} environment if the base \sty{glossaries} package would allow it} } \goptval{docdef}{restricted}% {% \desc{allow \gls{newglossaryentry} in the \env{document} environment, but only before any \idxpl{glossary}} } \goptval{docdef}{atom}% {% \desc{as \optfmt{restricted} but creates the \ext{glsdefs} file for atom's autocomplete support} } % package option automake \gstyopt{auto\-make}% {% \inpackage{glossaries} \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to attempt to use \TeX's shell escape to run an \idx{indexingapp}} } % package option mfirstuc \gstyopt{mfirstuc} { \inpackage{glossaries} \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \initval{unexpanded} \desc{implements the \optfmt{expanded} and \optfmt{unexpanded} options provided by \sty{mfirstuc}} } % COMMANDS % COMMANDS: OPTIONS % \setupglossaries \gcmd{set\-up\-glos\-saries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{change allowed options that are defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package. Note that some options can only be passed as package options. To change options defined or modified by the \sty{glossaries-extra} package, use \gls{glossariesextrasetup}} } % \glossariesextrasetup \gcmd{glos\-saries\-extra\-setup}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{change allowed options that are defined or modified by the \sty{glossaries-extra} package. Note that some options can only be passed as package options} } % \glsindexingsetting \gcmd{gls\-index\-ing\-setting} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+ \& \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{indicates what \idx{indexing} option has been chosen} } % \glsxtrsetbibglsaux \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-bib\-gls\-aux} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \app{bib2gls} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{basename}} \desc{as the \opt{bibglsaux} option} } % COMMANDS: DEBUGGING % \glsshowtargetinner \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-inner}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \desc{formats the target name for inner and maths mode when \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets} is enabled} } % \glsshowtargetouter \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-outer}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \desc{formats the target name for outer mode when \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets} is enabled. This places a marker (\gls{glsshowtargetsymbol}) in the text and \meta{target-name} in the margin} } % \glsshowtarget \gcmd{gls\-show\-target}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.32+} \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \desc{formats the target name when \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets} is enabled using either \gls{glsshowtargetinner} or \gls{glsshowtargetouter}, depending on the current mode} } % \glsshowtargetfont \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-font}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.45+} \desc{font declaration used by debugging annotations} } % \glsshowtargetfonttext \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-font\-text}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{text-block command that checks for math mode and switches to the font given by the \gls{glsshowtargetfont} declaration} } % \glsshowtargetsymbol \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-symbol}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.45+} \desc{marker (\glsshowtargetsymbol) used in debugging annotations} } % \glsxtrwrglossmark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-wr\-gloss\-mark}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{marker (\glsxtrwrglossmark) used to mark write operations with \opteqvalref{debug}{showwrgloss}} } % \glsxtrwrglosscountermark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-wr\-gloss\-counter\-mark}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{number}} \desc{used to mark where the \ctr{wrglossary} counter is incrememented with \opteqvalref{debug}{showwrgloss}} } % \glsxtrshowtargetouter \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-show\-target\-outer}% {% \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{used in outer mode for debugging, this defaults to \gls{glsshowtargetouter} but is changed by the \opt{showtargets} options} } % \glsxtrshowtargetinner \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-show\-target\-inner}% {% \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{used in inner mode for debugging, this defaults to \gls{glsshowtargetinner} but is changed by the \opt{showtargets} options} } % \glsshowtargetinnersymleft \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-inner\-sym\-left}% {% \syntax{\marg{name}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{shows the left inner annotation followed by the left marker symbol \gls{glsxtrshowtargetsymbolleft}} } % \glsshowtargetinnersymright \gcmd{gls\-show\-target\-inner\-sym\-right}% {% \syntax{\marg{name}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{shows the right marker symbol \gls{glsxtrshowtargetsymbolright} followed by the right inner annotation} } % \glsxtrshowtargetsymbolleft \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-show\-target\-symbol\-left}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{the left marker debugging symbol~(\glsxtrshowtargetsymbolleft)} } % \glsxtrshowtargetsymbolright \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-show\-target\-symbol\-right}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{the right marker debugging symbol~(\glsxtrshowtargetsymbolright)} } % COMMANDS: INDEXING INITIALISATION % \glsprestandardsort \gcmd{gls\-pre\-standard\-sort} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.13a+} \syntax{\margm{sort cs}\margm{type}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook used with \opteqvalref{sort}{standard} to adjust the default sort value (with \gls{makeglossaries} or \gls{makenoidxglossaries} only)} } % \makeglossaries \gcmd{make\-glossaries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{types}} \desc{opens the associated \idx{glossary} files that need to be processed by \app+{makeindex} or \app+{xindy}. The optional argument is only available with \sty{glossaries-extra} and is used for a hybrid approach. All \idxpl{glossary} (or each \idx{glossary} identified in \meta{types}) should be displayed with \gls{printglossary}. If the optional argument is present, any \idxpl{glossary} not identified in \meta{types} should be displayed with \gls{printnoidxglossary}} } % \makenoidxglossaries \gcmd{make\-noidx\-glossaries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.04+} \desc{sets up all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} so that they can be displayed with \gls{printnoidxglossary}} } % COMMANDS: GLOSSARIES % \glsdefaulttype \gcmd{gls\-default\-type}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{main}% \desc{expands to the label of the default \idx{glossary}, which is normally \code{main} but if \opt{nomain} is used, it will be the label of the first \idx{glossary} to be defined} }% % \acronymtype \gcmd{acronym\-type}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initvalcs{glsdefaulttype}% \desc{expands to the label of the default acronym \idx{glossary}. The \opt{acronym} or \opt{acronyms} package option will redefine this to \code{acronym}. The \opt{abbreviations} package option will redefine this to \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} if \opt{acronyms}\slash\opt{acronym} isn't used} }% % \glsxtrabbrvtype \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-abbrv\-type}% {% \initvalcs{glsdefaulttype}% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \desc{expands to the label of the default abbreviation \idx{glossary}. The \opt{abbreviations} package option will redefine this to \code{abbreviations}} }% % \newglossary \gcmd{new\-glos\-sary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{log-ext}\margm{glossary-label}\margm{in-ext}\margm{out-ext}\margm{title}\oargm{counter}} \desc{defines a \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{glossary-label} (which can be referenced by the \gloskey{type} key when defining an entry). The \meta{title} will be used when displaying the \idx{glossary} (using commands like \gls{printglossary}), but this title can be overridden by the \printglossopt{title} option. The optional \meta{counter} indicates which \idxc{locationcounter}{counter} should be used by default for the \location\ when \idx{indexing} any entries that have been assigned to this \idx{glossary}. (This can be overridden by the \glsopt{counter} option.) The other arguments are file extensions for use with \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}. These arguments aren't relevant for other \idx{indexing} options (in which case, you may prefer to use \gls{newglossary*})} } % \newglossary* \gcmd{new\-glos\-sary*}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}\margm{title}\oargm{counter}} \desc{a shortcut that supplies file extensions based on the \idx{glossary} label:\begin{compactcodebox}% \gls{newglossary}\oarg{\meta{glossary-label}-glg}\margm{glossary-label}\marg{\meta{glossary-label}-gls}\margm{\meta{glossary-label}-glo}\margm{title}\oargm{counter}% \end{compactcodebox}\glsxtrnopostpunc } } % \newignoredglossary \gcmd{new\-ignored\-glos\-sary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}} \desc{defines a \idx{glossary} that should be ignored by iterative commands, such as \gls{printglossaries}. This \idx{glossary} has no associated \idx{indexing} files and has hyperlinks disabled. You can use an \idx{ignoredglossary} for common terms or abbreviations that don't need to be included in any listing (but you may want these terms defined as entries to allow automated formatting with the \idx{glslike} commands). An \idx{ignoredglossary} can't be displayed with \gls{printglossary} but may be displayed with the \idx{unsrtfam}, such as \gls{printunsrtglossary}} } % \newignoredglossary* \gcmd{new\-ignored\-glos\-sary*}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.11+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}} \desc{this is like the unstarred \gls{newignoredglossary} but doesn't disable hyperlinks. You will need to ensure that the hypertargets are defined. For example, with \gls{printunsrtglossary} or through \idxpl{standaloneentry}} } % \provideignoredglossary \gcmds{provide\-ignored\-glos\-sary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}} \desc{as \gls{newignoredglossary} but does nothing if the \idx{glossary} has already been defined} } % \ifglossaryexists \gcmds{if\-glos\-sary\-exists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{glossary-type}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{if the \idx{glossary} given by \meta{glossary-type} exists, this does \meta{true}, otherwise it does \meta{false}. The unstarred form treats \idxpl{ignoredglossary} as non-existent. The starred form (v4.46+) will do \meta{true} if \meta{glossary-type} matches an ignored glossary} \field{seealso}{doifglossarynoexistsordo,glsxtrifemptyglossary} } % \doifglossarynoexistsordo \gcmd{do\-if\-glos\-sary\-no\-exists\-or\-do} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.19+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-type}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{if the \idx{glossary} given by \meta{glossary-type} doesn't exist, this does \meta{true}, otherwise it generates an error and does \meta{false}. This uses the starred form of \gls{ifglossaryexists} to test for existence} \field{seealso}{ifglossaryexists,glsxtrifemptyglossary} } % \glsxtrifemptyglossary \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-empty\-glos\-sary} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.4+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-type}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the glossary identified by \meta{glossary-type} is empty, otherwise does \meta{false}. If the \idx{glossary} doesn't exist, this does \meta{true} and will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}). This command considers \idxpl{ignoredglossary} as existing} \field{seealso}{ifglossaryexists,GlsXtrIfInGlossary} } % \GlsXtrIfInGlossary \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-In\-Glossary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{glossary-type}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} is in the internal list of the \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{glossary-type}, otherwise it does \meta{false}. If the \idx{glossary} doesn't exist, this does \meta{false} and will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}). This command considers \idxpl{ignoredglossary} as existing} \field{seealso}{ifglossaryexists,glsxtrifemptyglossary} } % \glsxtrcopytoglossary \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-copy\-to\-glos\-sary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{glossary-type}} \desc{copies the entry to the internal \idx{glossary} list for the given \idx{glossary}. The starred version performs a global change. The unstarred version can be localised. Only for use with the \idx{unsrtfam}} } % \glsxtrgroupfield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-group\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \initval{group} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used to store the group label (requires \opt{record})} } % \glsautoprefix \gcmd{gls\-auto\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.14+} \desc{expands to the prefix for the label used by \optval{numberedsection}{autolabel} and \optval{numberedsection}{nameref}} } % \glsxtrsetglossarylabel \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-glos\-sary\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.39+} \syntax{\margm{label}} \desc{sets the label to add (using \code{\gls{label}\margm{label}}) after the \idx{glossary} section heading} } % COMMANDS: GLOSSARY STYLES % \ifglsnogroupskip \gcond{if\-gls\-no\-group\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.03+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{conditional set by the \opt{nogroupskip} option} } % \glossentryname \gcmd{gloss\-entry\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \idx{glossary} styles to display the entry's name} } % \Glossentryname \gcmd{Gloss\-entry\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glossentryname} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \glossentrynameother \gcmd{gloss\-entry\-name\-other} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.22+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{behaves like \gls{glossentryname} but uses the given field (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) instead of \gloskey{name}} } % \glossentrysymbol \gcmd{gloss\-entry\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \idx{glossary} styles to display the entry's symbol} } % \Glossentrysymbol \gcmd{Gloss\-entry\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glossentrysymbol} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \glsentrypdfsymbol \gcmd{gls\-entry\-pdf\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used when \gls{glossentrysymbol} occurs in a PDF bookmark} } % \glossentrydesc \gcmd{gloss\-entry\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \idx{glossary} styles to display the entry's description} } % \Glossentrydesc \gcmd{Gloss\-entry\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glossentrydesc} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GlsXtrFormatLocationList \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Format\-Location\-List} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{location list}} \desc{used by \gls{glossaryentrynumbers} to encapsulate the entire \idx{locationlist} in the \idx{glossary}} } % \glossaryentrynumbers \gcmd{glos\-sary\-entry\-numbers} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{location list}} \desc{used within the \idx{glossary} to encapsulate the \idx{locationlist} (redefined by the \opt{nonumberlist} option)} } % \GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-Pre\-Location\-Tag} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{page tag}\margm{pages tag}} \desc{enables the \idx{locationlist} tag} } % \glsnoidxdisplayloc \gcmd{gls\-no\-idx\-display\-loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.04+} \syntax{\margm{prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{format}\margm{location}} \desc{used to display a location in the location list} } % \glsxtrdisplaysingleloc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-display\-single\-loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{format}\margm{location}} \desc{used to display a single location} } % \glsxtrdisplaystartloc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-display\-start\-loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{format}\margm{location}} \desc{used to display a start location from an explicit range} } % \glsxtrdisplayendloc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-display\-end\-loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{format}\margm{location}} \desc{used to display an end location from an explicit range} } % \glsxtrlocrangefmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-loc\-range\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{expands to the range format (set by \gls{glsxtrdisplaystartloc})} } % \glsxtrdisplayendlochook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-display\-end\-loc\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{hook used by \gls{glsxtrdisplayendloc}} } % theglossary environment \genv{the\-glossary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{redefined by \idxpl{glossarystyle} to set up the way the \idx{glossary} is displayed. For example, to start and end the \env{description} environment for the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glsnumberformat \gcmd{gls\-number\-format}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{location(s)}} \desc{the default \idxc{locationencap}{format} for \idxpl{entrylocation}. If hyperlinks are defined, this will use \gls{glshypernumber} otherwise it will simply display its argument, which may be a single \location, or locations delimited by \gls{delimR} or \gls{delimN}} } % \delimR \gcmd{delimR}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{used between the start and end of a \location\ range} } % \delimN \gcmd{delimN}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{used as a separator between \locations} } % \glshypernumber \gcmd{gls\-hyper\-number}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{location(s)}} \desc{this will encapsulate each location with a hyperlink, if supported. This may be used as a \idx{locationencap}. The argument may be a single location or locations delimited by \gls{delimR} or \gls{delimN}. This command should not be used outside of \idxpl{locationlist} as it requires additional information in order to correctly form the hyperlinks} } % \hyperbf \gcmd{hyper\-bf} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{location(s)}} \desc{if hyperlinks are supported this does \code{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\gls{glshypernumber}\margm{location(s)}}} otherwise it just does \code{\cmd{textbf}\margm{location(s)}}} } % \glstarget \gcmd{gls\-target}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.18+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{used by \idxpl{glossarystyle} to create a hypertarget (if enabled) for the entry (identified by \meta{entry-label}). The \meta{text} is usually \gls{glossentryname}\margm{entry-label}, but it can be something else} } % \glsxtrtarget \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-target} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{like \gls{glstarget} but only creates the target if the field given by \gls{glsxtrtarget} field hasn't been set (if hyperlinks are supported). If that field hasn't been set, the target is created and the field is set to the target name} } % \glsxtrtargetfield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-target\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \desc{expands to the field label used by \gls{glsxtrtarget}} } % \setentrycounter \gcmd{set\-entry\-counter} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{prefix}\margm{counter}} \desc{used to set the \idx{locationcounter} and prefix required for \gls{glshypernumber}} } % \glsentryitem \gcmd{gls\-entry\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does nothing if \optval{entrycounter}{false}, otherwise increments and displays the associated counter} } % \glssubentryitem \gcmd{gls\-sub\-entry\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does nothing if \optval{subentrycounter}{false}, otherwise increments and displays the associated counter} } % \glsentrycounterlabel \gcmd{gls\-entry\-counter\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \desc{used by \gls{glsentryitem} to display the entry counter label} } % \theglossaryentry \gcmd{the\-glossary\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \desc{the value of the \ctr{glossaryentry} counter} } % counter glossaryentry \gctr{glossary\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \desc{the counter associated with the \opt{entrycounter} package option} } % \glsnamefont \gcmd{gls\-name\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{glossentryname} to apply a font change to the \gloskey{name}, unless (with \sty{glossaries-extra}) the \catattr{glossnamefont} attribute has been set} } % \glsxtrpostname \gcmdmeta{gls\-xtr\-post\-name}{cat\-e\-gory}{}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+}% \desc{the \gls{postnamehook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}} } % \glsxtrpostnamehook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-name\-hook}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.3+}% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{a hook that's performed within \gls{glossentryname} and \gls{glossentrynameother} after the entry name is displayed. This hook implements auto-indexing (see \sectionref{sec:autoindex}), then the general hook \gls{glsextrapostnamehook} and finally the \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory} hook} } % \glsextrapostnamehook \gcmd{gls\-extra\-post\-name\-hook}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.25+}% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{a general purpose hook that's performed within \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook}} } % \glsdefpostname \gcmd{gls\-def\-post\-name}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+}% \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{definition}} \desc{defines \idx{postnamehook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}. This simply (re)defines \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory} for the given \meta{category} to \meta{definition}} } % \glspostdescription \gcmd{gls\-post\-de\-scrip\-tion}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{a hook that is usually placed after the description in \idxpl{glossarystyle}. Some of the styles provided with the \sty{glossaries} package don't use this hook. The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} redefines those styles to include the hook. The default definition of this command tests for the \opt{nopostdot} option, but the \opt{postpunc} option redefines the command to implement the chosen punctuation} } % \glsxtrpostdescription \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-de\-scrip\-tion} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{an additional hook used within \gls{glspostdescription} that implements the \idx{catpostdeschook}} } % \glsxtrpostdesc \gcmdmeta{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc}{cat\-e\-gory}{}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \desc{the \gls{postdeschook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}} } % \glsdefpostdesc \gcmd{gls\-def\-post\-desc}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{definition}} \desc{defines \idx{postdeschook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}. This simply (re)defines \gls{glsxtrpostdesccategory} for the given \meta{category} to \meta{definition}} } % \glsxtrpostdescgeneral \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-general}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \cat{general} category} } % \glsxtrpostdescsymbol \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-symbol}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{symbols}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{the default \gls{postdeschook} for the \cat{symbol} category} } % \glsxtrpostdescnumber \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-number}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{numbers}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \cat{number} category} } % \glsxtrpostdescindex \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-index}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \cat{index} category} } % \glsxtrpostdescterm \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-term}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \catfmt{term} category (which isn't used by \sty{glossaries-extra})} } % \glsxtrpostdescacronym \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-acronym}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \cat{acronym} category} } % \glsxtrpostdescabbreviation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-desc\-ab\-bre\-vi\-a\-tion}% {% \initvalempty %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{the default post-description hook for the \cat{abbreviation} category} } % \glsxtrrestorepostpunc \gcmd{glsxtrrestorepostpunc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.23+} \desc{used in the \gloskey{description} to counteract the use of \gls{glsxtrnopostpunc}. Does nothing outside of the \idx{glossary}} } % \glsxtrnopostpunc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-no\-post\-punc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.22+} \desc{when placed at the end of the \gloskey{description}, this switches off the post-description punctuation (inserted automatically via options such as \opt{postdot}) but doesn't suppress the \idx{postdeschook}. Does nothing outside of the \idx{glossary}} \field{seealso}{nopostdesc} } % \nopostdesc \gcmd{no\-post\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \desc{when placed at the end of the \gloskey{description}, this switches off the \idx{postdeschook} (including the post-description punctuation). Does nothing outside of the \idx{glossary}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrnopostpunc} } % \glscurrententrylabel \gcmd{gls\-current\-entry\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \desc{assigned at the start of each entry item within the glossary. This command may be used by glossary hooks, such as the \idx{postdeschook}, to reference the current entry} } % COMMANDS: longextra % \glslongextraNameFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to add the hypertarget (if supported) and display a top-level entry's name} } % \glslongextraSubNameFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Name\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to add the hypertarget (if supported) for child-entries. The name isn't shown by default} } % \glslongextraDescFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a top-level entry's description and \idx{postdeschook}} } % \glslongextraSubDescFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Desc\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a child entry's description and \idx{postdeschook}} } % \glslongextraSymbolFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Symbol\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a top-level entry's symbol} } % \glslongextraSubSymbolFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Symbol\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a child entry's symbol} } % \glslongextraSymbolTargetFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Symbol\-Target\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{adds the hypertarget (if supported) and displays the symbol for top-level entries} } % \glslongextraSubSymbolTargetFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Symbol\-Target\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{adds the hypertarget (if supported) and displays the symbol for child entries} } % \glslongextraSymbolOrName \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Symbol\-Or\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{adds the hypertarget (if supported) and displays the symbol if set or the name otherwise for top-level entries} } % \glslongextraSubSymbolOrName \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Symbol\-Or\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{adds the hypertarget (if supported) and displays the symbol if set or the name otherwise for child entries} } % \glslongextraLocationFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a top-level entry's \idx{locationlist}} } % \glslongextraSubLocationFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Location\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used by the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles to display a child entry's \idx{locationlist}} } % \glslongextraHeaderFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Header\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used to format the column headers} } % \ifGlsLongExtraUseTabular \gcond{if\-Gls\-Long\-Extra\-Use\-Tabular} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{conditional that determines whether or not to use \env{tabular} instead of \env{longtable}. If this conditional is changed, it must be changed before the style is set} } % \GlsLongExtraUseTabulartrue \gcmd{Gls\-Long\-Extra\-Use\-Tabular\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets \gls{ifGlsLongExtraUseTabular} to true (if this setting is required, the style must be set after this command)} } % \GlsLongExtraUseTabularfalse \gcmd{Gls\-Long\-Extra\-Use\-Tabular\-false} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets \gls{ifGlsLongExtraUseTabular} to false (if this setting is required, the style must be set after this command)} } % \glslongextraTabularVAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Tabular\-V\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \initval{c} \desc{only for use with the \env{tabular} setting, this should expand to the \env{tabular} environment's vertical alignment specifier} } % \glslongextraNameAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \initval{l} \desc{the horizontal alignment for the name column} } % \glslongextraSymbolAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Symbol\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \initval{c} \desc{the horizontal alignment for the symbol column} } % \glslongextraSymbolNameAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Symbol\-Name\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \initval{l} \desc{the horizontal alignment for the symbol column when it's being used instead of the name} } % \glslongextraDescAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{the horizontal alignment for the description column} } % \glslongextraLocationAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{the horizontal alignment for the \idx{locationlist} column} } % \glslongextraGroupHeading \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Group\-Head\-ing} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{number columns}\margm{group-label}} \desc{formats the top-level \idx{group} heading} } % \glslongextraSubGroupHeading \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Group\-Head\-ing} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{number columns}\margm{prev group level}\margm{group level}\margm{parent-entry-label}\margm{group-label}} \desc{formats the sub-\idx{group} heading, if supported} } % \glslongextraNameDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescLocationHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Location\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-loc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameDescLocationTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Location\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-loc} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescLocationTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Location\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-loc} style} } % \glslongextraDescNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraDescNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationDescNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraLocationDescNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationDescNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymLocationHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Location\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym-loc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymLocationTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Location\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym-loc} style} } % \glslongextraNameDescSymLocationTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Desc\-Sym\-Location\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-desc-sym-loc} style} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescLocationHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Location\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc-loc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescLocationTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Location\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc-loc} style} } % \glslongextraNameSymDescLocationTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Sym\-Desc\-Location\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc-loc} style} } % \glslongextraSymDescNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraSymDescNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraSymDescNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationSymDescNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-sym-desc-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraLocationSymDescNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-loc-sym-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationSymDescNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Sym\-Desc\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-sym-desc-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescSymNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraDescSymNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescSymNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationDescSymNameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-sym-name} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraLocationDescSymNameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-sym-name} style} } % \glslongextraLocationDescSymNameTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Location\-Desc\-Sym\-Name\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-loc-desc-sym-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescSymHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraDescSymTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym} style} } % \glslongextraDescSymTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Sym\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-desc-sym} style} } % \glslongextraSymDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraSymDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc} style} } % \glslongextraSymDescTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Desc\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc} style} } % \glslongextraShortLongTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-Long\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style} } % \glslongextraShortLongTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-Long\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style} } % \glslongextraShortLongHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-Long\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraLongShortTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Long\-Short\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the header for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style} } % \glslongextraLongShortTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Long\-Short\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{displays the footer for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style} } % \glslongextraLongShortHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Long\-Short\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{sets the header and footer for the \glostyle{abbr-short-long} style with \env{longtable}} } % \glslongextraShortNoNameSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-No\-Name\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{sets the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} for the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraShortHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-Head\-er} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \initvalcs{entryname} \desc{the short column header for the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraLongHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Long\-Head\-er} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \initvalcs{descriptionname} \desc{the long column header for the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraShortTargetFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Short\-Target\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the formatting, including the target, for the short form in the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraLongFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Long\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the formatting for the long form in the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraSubShortTargetFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Short\-Target\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the formatting, including the target, for child entry short forms in the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraSubLongFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Long\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the formatting for child entry long forms in the \glostyle{abbr-long-short} and \glostyle{abbr-short-long} styles} } % \glslongextraSetWidest \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Set\-Widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{widest-name}} \desc{identifies \meta{widest-name} as the widest top-level name} } % \glslongextraUpdateWidest \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Update\-Widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{name}} \desc{if \meta{name} is wider than the current widest name, it will be set as the new widest name} } % \glslongextraUpdateWidestChild \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Update\-Widest\-Child} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{glslongextraUpdateWidest} but for child entries. Does nothing by default} } % \glslongextraSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{computes the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name for styles that only show the name and description} } % \glslongextraSymSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{computes the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name for styles that only show the name, symbol and description} } % \glslongextraSymNoNameSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-No\-Name\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.49+} \desc{computes the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name for styles that only show the symbol and description} } % \glslongextraLocSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Loc\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{computes the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name for styles that only show the name, \idx{locationlist} and description} } % \glslongextraSymLocSetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sym\-Loc\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.37+} \desc{computes the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name for styles that show the name, symbol, \idx{locationlist} and description} } % \glslongextraCustomIField \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Field} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{\glosfield{useri}} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldname} of the first custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomIIField \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Field} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{\glosfield{userii}} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldname} of the second custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomIIIField \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Field} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{\glosfield{useriii}} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldname} of the third custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{expands to the header name of the first custom column} } % \glslongextraCustomIIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{expands to the header name of the second custom column} } % \glslongextraCustomIIIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{expands to the header name of the third custom column} } % \glslongextraCustomIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the first custom entry} } % \glslongextraCustomIIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the second custom entry} } % \glslongextraCustomIIIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the third custom entry} } % \glslongextraSubCustomIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Custom\-I\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the first custom sub-entry} } % \glslongextraSubCustomIIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Custom\-II\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the second custom sub-entry} } % \glslongextraSubCustomIIIFmt \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Sub\-Custom\-III\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the format of the third custom sub-entry} } % \glslongextraCustomIAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{l} \desc{expands to the column alignment for the first custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomIIAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{l} \desc{expands to the column alignment for the second custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomIIIAlign \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \initval{l} \desc{expands to the column alignment for the third custom field} } % \glslongextraCustomTabularFooter \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-Tabular\-Footer} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the footer for the custom styles} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-I\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom1} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomITabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-I\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-II\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom2} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIITabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-II\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIIHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-III\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom3} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIITabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-III\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3} style} } % \glslongextraCustomINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-custom1-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-custom1-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-custom2-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-custom2-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIIINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-custom3-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIIINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-custom3-name} style} } % \glslongextraCustomISetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-I\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{used to set the length \gls{glsdescwidth} for \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIISetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-II\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{used to set the length \gls{glsdescwidth} for \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style} } % \glslongextraCustomIIISetDescWidth \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Custom\-III\-Set\-Desc\-Width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{used to set the length \gls{glsdescwidth} for \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-I\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-I\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-II\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-II\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIIDescHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-III\-Desc\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style} } % \glslongextraNameCustomIIIDescTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Name\-Custom\-III\-Desc\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-I\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-desc-custom1-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-I\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom1-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomIINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-II\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-desc-custom2-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomIINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-II\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom2-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomIIINameHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-III\-Name\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \env{longtable} \glostyle{long-desc-custom3-name} style} } % \glslongextraDescCustomIIINameTabularHeader \gcmd{gls\-long\-extra\-Desc\-Custom\-III\-Name\-Tabular\-Header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longextra} v1.50+} \desc{the header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom3-name} style} } % COMMANDS: bookindex % \glsxtrbookindexname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display a top-level entry's name} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display a child entry's name} } % \glsxtrbookindexpregroupskip \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-pre\-group\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{skip}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style insert \meta{skip} after a \idx{group} header} } % \glsxtrbookindexcols \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-cols} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \initval{2} \desc{expands to the number of columns for the \glostyle{bookindex} style} } % \glsxtrbookindexformatsubheader \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-format\-sub\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{previous level}\margm{level}\margm{parent-label}\margm{group-label}\margm{title}} \desc{formats the sub-group header} } % \glsxtrbookindexcolspread \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-col\-spread} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.12+} \desc{if not empty this should expand to the option argument for \env{multicols}} } % \glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-multi\-cols\-env} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.25+} \desc{expands to the name of the \env{multicols} environment to use} } % \glsxtrbookindexprelocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-pre\-lo\-ca\-tion} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display a separator before top-level \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubprelocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-pre\-lo\-ca\-tion} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display a separator before child \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glsxtrbookindexlocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-lo\-ca\-tion} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.39+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display top-level \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glsxtrbookindexsublocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-lo\-ca\-tion} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.39+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to display child \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-parent\-child\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to separate a top-level parent and child entry} } % \glsxtrbookindexparentsubchildsep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-parent\-sub\-child\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to separate a sub-level parent and child entry} } % \glsxtrbookindexbetween \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-between} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry1-label}\margm{entry2-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style between two entries where \meta{entry1-label} is the last top-level entry and \meta{entry2-label} is the next entry, which is a top-level entry} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubbetween \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-between} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry1-label}\margm{entry2-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrbookindexbetween} but for level~1 entries} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubsubbetween \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-sub\-between} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry1-label}\margm{entry2-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrbookindexbetween} but for level~2 entries} } % \glsxtrbookindexatendgroup \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-at\-end\-group} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style at the end of a letter group (where the last top-level entry is given by \meta{entry-label})} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-at\-end\-group} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style at the end of a letter group (where the last level~1 entry is given by \meta{entry-label})} } % \glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-sub\-sub\-at\-end\-group} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style at the end of a letter group (where the last level~2 entry is given by \meta{entry-label})} } % \glsxtrbookindexbookmark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-bookmark} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{group-title}\margm{bookmark-name}} \desc{adds a bookmark with \gls{pdfbookmark}, if supported} } % \glsxtrbookindexformatheader \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-format\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{group-title}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to format a \idx{group} header} } % \glsxtrbookindexmarkentry \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-mark\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to mark an entry in the \ext{aux} file} } % \glsxtrbookindexfirstmarkfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-first\-mark\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to format the first mark} } % \glsxtrbookindexfirstmark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-first\-mark} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to obtain the first mark and, if found, format it with \gls{glsxtrbookindexfirstmarkfmt}} } % \glsxtrbookindexlastmarkfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-last\-mark\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to format the last mark} } % \glsxtrbookindexlastmark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-book\-index\-last\-mark} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-bookindex} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \glostyle{bookindex} style to obtain the last mark and, if found, format it with \gls{glsxtrbookindexlastmarkfmt}} } % COMMANDS: topic % \glstopicGroupHeading \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Group\-Heading} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}} \desc{used to format the top-level group headings, if required} } % \glstopicSubGroupHeading \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Group\-Heading} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{prev group level}\margm{group level}\margm{parent entry}\margm{group-label}} \desc{used to format the sub-group headings, if supported} } % \glstopicItem \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Item} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used to format top-level entries} } % \glstopicSubItem \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Item} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used to format child entries} } % \glstopicSubItemSep \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Item\-Sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{horizontal separator used after child names} } % \glstopicSubItemBox \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Item\-Box} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{text}} \desc{horizontal box used for child name if a widest name has been provided} } % \glstopicSubNameFont \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Name\-Font} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{font command to apply to the child entry name} } % \glstopicSubPreLocSep \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Pre\-Loc\-Sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.41+} \desc{separator before the child \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glstopicSubLoc \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.41+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the child \idxpl{locationlist}} } % \glstopicPreSkip \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Pre\-Skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{vertical space inserted before a top-level entry} } % \glstopicMidSkip \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Mid\-Skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{vertical space inserted before the description for a top-level entry} } % \glstopicPostSkip \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Post\-Skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{vertical space inserted after the description for a top-level entry} } % \glstopicMarker \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Marker} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook inserted before a top-level entry} } % \glstopicTitleFont \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Title\-Font} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{font command to apply to the top-level entry title} } % \glstopicTitle \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Title} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to format the name and (if provided) symbol for the top-level entry title} } % \glstopicDesc \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Desc} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to format the top-level description} } % \glstopicLoc \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used to format the top-level \idx{locationlist}} } % \glstopicParIndent \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Par\-Indent} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{length register used for the top-level paragraph indent} } % \glstopicSubIndent \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Indent} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{length register used for the child indent} } % \glstopicSubItemParIndent \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Sub\-Item\-Par\-Indent} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.46+} \desc{length register used for the child paragraph indent} } % \glstopicInit \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Init} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{initialisation hook} } % \glstopicAssignSubIndent \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Assign\-Sub\-Indent} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{level}} \desc{used to set the indentation for sub-levels} } % \glstopicAssignWidest \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Assign\-Widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \syntax{\margm{level}} \desc{used by \gls{glstopicAssignSubIndent} to calculate the width of the widest name for the given level} } % \glstopicCols \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Cols} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{expands to the number of columns for \glostyle{topicmcols}} } % \glstopicColsEnv \gcmd{gls\-topic\-Cols\-Env} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-topic} v1.40+} \desc{expands to the \env{multicols} environment name to use for \glostyle{topicmcols}} } % COMMANDS: table % \printunsrttable \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-table} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{internally uses \gls{printunsrtglossary} with the \glostyle{table} style} } % \glstablesetstyle \gcmd{gls\-table\-set\-style} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{style-name}} \desc{sets the default block style} } % \glstablenewline \gcmd{gls\-table\-new\-line} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \desc{used to start a new row} } % \glstablecaption \gcmd{gls\-table\-caption} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{lot title}\margm{title}\margm{label code}} \desc{produces the caption for the first page of the table} } % \glstablenextcaption \gcmd{gls\-table\-next\-caption} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{lot title}\margm{title}} \desc{produces the caption for following pages of the table} } % \glstablepostnextcaption \gcmd{gls\-table\-post\-next\-caption} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \initval{\textvisiblespace Cont./} \desc{appended to the caption in \gls{glstablenextcaption}} } % \glstableiffilter \gcmd{gls\-table\-if\-filter} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{internally used by the custom handler in \gls{printunsrttable} to perform additional filtering. This command should do \meta{true} if the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} should be filtered and \meta{false} otherwise} } % \glstableiffilterchild \gcmd{gls\-table\-if\-filter\-child} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{internally used by \gls{glstableChildEntries} to filter child entries. This command should do \meta{true} if the child entry identified by \meta{entry-label} should be filtered and \meta{false} otherwise} } % \glstableblocksubentrysep \gcmd{gls\-table\-block\-sub\-entry\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{separator used by \gls{glstableChildEntries} between child entries} } % \glstableblocksubentry \gcmd{gls\-table\-block\-sub\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the child entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. This command is redefined by block styles} } % glstablesubentries ENVIRONMENT \genv{gls\-table\-sub\-entries} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{encapsulates the child list} } % \glstablesubentryalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-sub\-entry\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \desc{expands to the column alignment used by \env{glstablesubentries}} } % \glstableleftalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-left\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{width}} \desc{expands to \code{l} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{raggedright}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting} } % \glstablerightalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-right\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{width}} \desc{expands to \code{r} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{raggedleft}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting} } % \glstablecenteralign \gcmd{gls\-table\-center\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{width}} \desc{expands to \code{c} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{centering}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting} } % \glstablenamecolalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-name\-col\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the alignment of the name column} } % \glstabledesccolalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-desc\-col\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the alignment of the description column} } % \glstableothercolalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-other\-col\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the alignment of the other column} } % \glstablesymbolcolalign \gcmd{gls\-table\-symbol\-col\-align} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the alignment of the symbol column} } % \glstablenamewidth \gcmd{gls\-table\-name\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{length register used for the width of the name column with \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}. Set by the block style} } % \glstabledescwidth \gcmd{gls\-table\-desc\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{length register used for the width of the description column with \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}. Set by the block style} } % \glstablesymbolwidth \gcmd{gls\-table\-symbol\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{length register used for the width of the symbol column with \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}. Set by the block style} } % \glstableotherwidth \gcmd{gls\-table\-other\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \desc{length register used for the width of the other column with \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}. Set by the block style} } % \glstableblockwidth \gcmd{gls\-table\-block\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{length register used for the width of each block with \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}. Set by the block style} } % \glstablepostpreambleskip \gcmd{gls\-table\-post\-pre\-amble\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \initval{5pt} \desc{length register that specifies the vertical skip after the preamble} } % \glstableprepostambleskip \gcmd{gls\-table\-pre\-post\-amble\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \initval{5pt} \desc{length register that specifies the vertical skip before the postamble} } % \glstableNameFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Name\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the name} } % \glstableSubNameFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Sub\-Name\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the child name} } % \glstableSymbolFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Symbol\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the symbol} } % \glstableSubSymbolFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Sub\-Symbol\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the child symbol} } % \glstableDescFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Desc\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the description} } % \glstableSubDescFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Sub\-Desc\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the child description} } % \glstableotherfield \gcmd{gls\-table\-other\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \initvalempty \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} of the other field} } % \glstableOtherFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Other\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the other field} } % \glstableSubOtherFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Sub\-Other\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formatting applied to the other field} } % \glstableOther \gcmd{gls\-table\-Other} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the other field} } % \glstableSubOther \gcmd{gls\-table\-Sub\-Other} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the sub-entry other field} } % \glstableifhasotherfield \gcmd{gls\-table\-if\-has\-other\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{expands to \meta{true} if the other field is non-void for the given entry otherwise expands to \meta{false}} } % \glstablenameheader \gcmd{gls\-table\-name\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{header for the name column} } % \glstabledescheader \gcmd{gls\-table\-desc\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{header for the description column} } % \glstablesymbolheader \gcmd{gls\-table\-symbol\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{header for the symbol column} } % \glstableotherheader \gcmd{gls\-table\-other\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{header for the other column} } % \glstableHeaderFmt \gcmd{gls\-table\-Header\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{formats the header} } % \glstableChildEntries \gcmd{gls\-table\-Child\-Entries} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{iterates over the \glosfield{childlist} field and formats each child entry in the list for use in the block styles. Does nothing if the list is empty} } % \glstablePreChildren \gcmd{glstablePreChildren} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+} \desc{code performed by \gls{glstableChildEntries} before the child list} } % \printunsrttable OPTIONS \gprintunsrttableopt{blocks}% {% \syntax{\meta{n}} \initval{2} \desc{number of blocks per row} } \gprintunsrttableopt{caption}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{include a caption} } \gprintunsrttableopt{header}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{include header row} } \gprintunsrttableopt{rules}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{include horizontal rules} } \gprintunsrttableopt{blocksep}% {% \syntax{\meta{alignment spec}} \initval{|} \desc{between block table alignment specifier} } \gprintunsrttableopt{par}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \desc{indicates whether or not to use a paragraph column specifier} } \gprintunsrttableopt{block-style}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{name-desc} \desc{indicates the block style} } \gprintunsrttableopt{other}% {% \syntax{\meta{field-label}} \initvalempty \desc{indicates the other field to use} } \gprintunsrttableopt{init}% {% \syntax{\margm{code}} \initvalempty \desc{initialisation code} } % \printunsrttable BLOCK STYLES % name-desc \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen desc}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name \gtableblockstyle{name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name-symbol \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen symbol}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % desc-name \gtableblockstyle{desc\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % symbol-name \gtableblockstyle{symbol\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name-symbol-desc \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen symbol\dhyphen desc}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name-desc-symbol \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen desc\dhyphen symbol}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name-other \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen other}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % symbol-other \gtableblockstyle{symbol\dhyphen other}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % other-name \gtableblockstyle{other\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % other-symbol \gtableblockstyle{other\dhyphen symbol}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.49+}} % name-symbol-other-desc \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen symbol\dhyphen other\dhyphen desc}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % name-other-symbol-desc \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen other\dhyphen symbol\dhyphen desc}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % desc-symbol-other-name \gtableblockstyle{desc\dhyphen symbol\dhyphen other\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % desc-other-symbol-name \gtableblockstyle{desc\dhyphen other\dhyphen symbol\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % name-other-desc \gtableblockstyle{name\dhyphen other\dhyphen desc}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % desc-other-name \gtableblockstyle{desc\dhyphen other\dhyphen name}% {\providedby{\sty{glossary-table} v1.50+}} % COMMANDS: long % \glsdescwidth \gcmd{gls\-desc\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-long} \& \sty{glossary-super}} \desc{a length register used to set the width of the description column for \env{tabular}-like styles} } % \glspagelistwidth \gcmd{gls\-page\-list\-width} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-long} \& \sty{glossary-super}} \desc{a length register used to set the width of the \idx{locationlist} column for \env{tabular}-like styles} } % COMMANDS: longbooktabs style % \glspatchLToutput \gcmd{gls\-patch\-LT\-output} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longbooktabs} v4.21+} \desc{applies a patch to \env{longtable} to check for instances of the group skip occurring at a page break} } % \glspenaltygroupskip \gcmd{gls\-penalty\-group\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-longbooktabs} v4.21+} \desc{the definition of \gls{glsgroupskip} with \optval{nogroupskip}{false} for the \sty{glossary-longbooktabs} styles} } % COMMANDS: tree % \glstreepredesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-pre\-desc} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.26+} \desc{space inserted before top-level descriptions} } % \glstreechildpredesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-child\-pre\-desc} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.26+} \desc{space inserted before child descriptions} } % \glstreenamefmt \gcmd{gls\-tree\-name\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.08+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used to format the name for the \glostyle{tree} and \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreegroupheaderfmt \gcmd{gls\-tree\-group\-header\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.22+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used to format the \idx{group} title for the \glostyle{treegroup} and \glostyle{indexgroup} styles} } % \glstreenavigationfmt \gcmd{gls\-tree\-navigation\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.22+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used to format the navigation element for styles like \glostyle{treehypergroup}} } % \glstreeitem \gcmd{gls\-tree\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.26+} \desc{used to indent the top-level entries for the \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreesubitem \gcmd{gls\-tree\-sub\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.26+} \desc{used to indent the level~1 entries for the \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreesubsubitem \gcmd{gls\-tree\-sub\-sub\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.26+} \desc{used to indent the level~2 entries for the \glostyle{index} styles} } % COMMANDS: list style % \glslistdottedwidth \gcmd{glslistdottedwidth} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-list}} \desc{a length register used by \glostyle{listdotted}} } % \glslistinit \gcmd{gls\-list\-init} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list} v4.48+} \desc{used to disable problematic commands at the start the \glostyle{list} styles to provide better integration with \sty{gettitlestring}} } % \glslistexpandedname \gcmd{gls\-list\-expanded\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-list} v4.48+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glslistinit} to provide better integration with \sty{gettitlestring}} } % COMMANDS: inline style % \glsinlinedescformat \gcmd{gls\-in\-line\-desc\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline} v3.03+} \syntax{\margm{description}\margm{symbol}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the description, symbol and \idx{locationlist} for top-level entries} } % \glsinlinesubdescformat \gcmd{gls\-in\-line\-sub\-desc\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline} v3.03+} \syntax{\margm{description}\margm{symbol}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the description, symbol and \idx{locationlist} for child entries} } % \glspostinline \gcmd{gls\-post\-in\-line} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline} v3.03+} \desc{used at the end of the \env{theglossary} environment} } % \glspostinlinedescformat \gcmd{gls\-post\-in\-line\-desc\-format} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline} v3.03+} \syntax{\margm{description}\margm{symbol}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the top-level entry's description, symbol and \idx{locationlist}} } % \glspostinlinesubdescformat \gcmd{gls\-post\-in\-line\-sub\-desc\-format} {% \providedby{\sty{glossary-inline} v3.03+} \syntax{\margm{description}\margm{symbol}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the child entry's description, symbol and \idx{locationlist}} } % COMMANDS: STYLE MODIFICATIONS % \glsxtrprelocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-pre\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initvalcs{space} \desc{used before the \idx{locationlist} in the predefined styles provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} or modified by \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods}} } % \glslistprelocation \gcmd{gls\-list\-pre\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initvalcs{glsxtrprelocation} \desc{used before the top-level entry \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glslistchildprelocation \gcmd{gls\-list\-child\-pre\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initvalcs{glslistprelocation} \desc{used before the child entry \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glslistchildpostlocation \gcmd{gls\-list\-child\-post\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initval{.} \desc{used after the child entry \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glslistdesc \gcmd{gls\-list\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the description for the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glslistgroupskip \gcmd{gls\-list\-group\-skip} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \desc{used for the group skip in the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glslistitem \gcmd{gls\-list\-item} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the top-level entry item in the \glostyle{list} styles} } % \glsaltlistitem \gcmd{gls\-alt\-list\-item} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the top-level entry item in the \glostyle{altlist} styles} } % \glslistgroupheaderitem \gcmd{gls\-list\-group\-header\-item} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}\margm{header code}} \desc{used to display the \idx{group} headings in the \glostyle{listgroup} styles} } % \glslistgroupafterheader \gcmd{gls\-list\-group\-after\-header} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.47+} \desc{used after \idx{group} headings in the \glostyle{listgroup} styles} } % \glstreedefaultnamefmt \gcmd{gls\-tree\-default\-name\-fmt} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used as the default name format for the \glostyle{tree} and \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreePreHeader \gcmd{gls\-tree\-Pre\-Header} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.41+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}\margm{group-title}} \desc{pre \idx{group} header hook the \glostyle{treegroup} and \glostyle{indexgroup} styles} } % \glstreeSubPreHeader \gcmd{gls\-tree\-Sub\-Pre\-Header} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{previous group level}\margm{level}\margm{parent label}\margm{group label}\margm{group title}} \desc{pre sub-\idx{group} header hook the \glostyle{treegroup} and \glostyle{indexgroup} styles} } % \glstreeprelocation \gcmd{gls\-tree\-pre\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initvalcs{glsxtrprelocation} \desc{used before the top-level entry \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{tree} and \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreechildprelocation \gcmd{gls\-tree\-child\-pre\-location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \initvalcs{glstreeprelocation} \desc{used before the child entry \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{tree} and \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreegroupskip \gcmd{gls\-tree\-group\-skip} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.41+} \desc{group skip for the \glostyle{tree} and \glostyle{index} styles} } % \glstreegroupheaderskip \gcmd{gls\-tree\-group\-header\-skip} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.42+} \desc{after group header skip for the \glostyle{treegroup} and \glostyle{indexgroup} styles} } % \glsindexsubgroupitem \gcmd{gls\-index\-sub\-group\-item} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{previous group level}\margm{level}\margm{parent label}\margm{group label}\margm{group title}} \desc{used to format sub-\idx{group} headers for the \glostyle{indexgroup} styles} } % \glsxtrtreepredesc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-tree\-pre\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.46+} \initvalcs{glstreepredesc} \desc{inserted before the top-level descriptions for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glsxtrtreechildpredesc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-tree\-child\-pre\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.46+} \initvalcs{glstreechildpredesc} \desc{inserted before the child descriptions for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreedesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given top-level entry's description with pre and post hooks for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreechilddesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-child\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given child entry's description with pre and post hooks for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreeDescLoc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-Desc\-Loc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.41+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the top-level description (if set) and \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreeChildDescLoc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-Child\-Desc\-Loc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.41+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the child description (if set) and \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreeNoDescSymbolPreLocation \gcmd{gls\-tree\-No\-Desc\-Symbol\-Pre\-Location} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.42+} \desc{inserted before the \idx{locationlist} when there's no description or symbol for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreesymbol \gcmd{gls\-tree\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the top-level symbol in parentheses, if set, for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreechildsymbol \gcmd{gls\-tree\-child\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the top-level symbol in parentheses, if set, for the \glostyle{tree} styles} } % \glstreesubgroupitem \gcmd{gls\-tree\-sub\-group\-item} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.49+} \syntax{\marg{previous group level}\marg{level}\marg{parent label}\marg{group label}\marg{group title}} \desc{used to display the sub-group header in the \glostyle{treegroup} styles} } % \glstreenonamedesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-no\-name\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given top-level entry's description with pre and post hooks for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles} } % \glstreenonamesymbol \gcmd{gls\-tree\-no\-name\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given top-level entry's symbol in parentheses for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles} } % \glstreenonameDescLoc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-no\-name\-Desc\-Loc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.45+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given top-level entry's description and \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles} } % \glstreenonamechilddesc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-no\-name\-child\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given child entry's description and post hook for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles} } % \glstreenonameChildDescLoc \gcmd{gls\-tree\-no\-name\-Child\-Desc\-Loc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.45+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the given child entry's description and \idx{locationlist} for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles} } % \glsalttreepredesc \gcmd{gls\-alt\-tree\-pre\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.46+} \desc{inserted before the top-level descriptions for the \glostyle{alttree} styles} } % \glsalttreechildpredesc \gcmd{gls\-alt\-tree\-child\-pre\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.46+} \desc{inserted before the child descriptions for the \glostyle{alttree} styles} } % \glssetwidest \gcmd{gls\-set\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree}} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{indicates that \meta{name} is the widest name for the given \idx{hierarchicallevel}} } % \gglssetwidest \gcmd{ggls\-set\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{glssetwidest} but global} } % \eglssetwidest \gcmd{egls\-set\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{glssetwidest} but expands \meta{text}} } % \xglssetwidest \gcmd{xgls\-set\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{eglssetwidest} but global} } % \glsupdatewidest \gcmd{gls\-update\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.23+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{similar to \gls{glssetwidest} but only if \meta{name} is wider than the current widest value for the given \idx{hierarchicallevel}} } % \gglsupdatewidest \gcmd{ggls\-update\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.23+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{glsupdatewidest} but global} } % \eglsupdatewidest \gcmd{egls\-update\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.23+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{glsupdatewidest} but expands \meta{name}} } % \xglsupdatewidest \gcmd{xgls\-update\-widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.23+} \syntax{\oargm{level}\margm{name}} \desc{as \gls{eglsupdatewidest} but global} } % \glsgetwidestname \gcmd{gls\-get\-widest\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \desc{expands to the widest top-level name} } % \glsgetwidestsubname \gcmd{gls\-get\-widest\-sub\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\margm{level}} \desc{expands to the widest name for the given \idx{hierarchicallevel} or to the widest top-level name, if no widest name set for \meta{level}} } % \glsfindwidesttoplevelname \gcmd{gls\-find\-widest\-top\-level\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossary-tree} v4.22+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all top-level entries in the given \idxpl{glossary}. If the optional argument is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed} } % \glsFindWidestTopLevelName \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Top\-Level\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods}}% v1.0+ \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsfindwidesttoplevelname}} } % \glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Top\-Level\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all top-level entries that have been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used} in the given \idxpl{glossary}} } % \glsFindWidestUsedAnyName \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Any\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all entries that have been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used} in the given \idxpl{glossary}} } % \glsFindWidestAnyName \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Any\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all entries in the given \idxpl{glossary}} } % \glsFindWidestUsedLevelTwo \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Level\-Two} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all entries that have been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used} with \idx{hierarchicallevel} less than or equal to 2 in the given \idxpl{glossary}} } % \glsFindWidestLevelTwo \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Level\-Two} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}} \desc{finds and sets the widest name for all entries with \idx{hierarchicallevel} less than or equal to 2 in the given \idxpl{glossary}} } % \glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Any\-Name\-Symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyName} but also also measures the symbol. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register} which should be a length register} } % \glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbol \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Any\-Name\-Symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestAnyName} but also also measures the symbol. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register} which should be a length register} } % \glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Any\-Name\-Symbol\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register1}\margm{register2}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol} but also also measures the \idx{locationlist}. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register1} and the length of the widest location is stored in \meta{register2}, which should both be length registers} } % \glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbolLocation \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Any\-Name\-Symbol\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register1}\margm{register2}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbol} but also also measures the \idx{locationlist}. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register1} and the length of the widest location is stored in \meta{register2}, which should both be length registers} } % \glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameLocation \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Used\-Any\-Name\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyName} but also also measures the \idx{locationlist}. The length of the widest location is stored in \meta{register}, which should be a length register} } % \glsFindWidestAnyNameLocation \gcmd{gls\-Find\-Widest\-Any\-Name\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels}\margm{register}} \desc{like \gls{glsFindWidestAnyName} but also also measures the \idx{locationlist}. The length of the widest location is stored in \meta{register}, which should be a length register} } % \glsxtralttreeSymbolDescLocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-alt\-tree\-Symbol\-Desc\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the symbol, description and location for top-level entries for the \glostyle{alttree}-like styles} } % \glsxtralttreeSubSymbolDescLocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-alt\-tree\-Sub\-Symbol\-Desc\-Location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{location list}} \desc{formats the symbol, description and location for child entries for the \glostyle{alttree}-like styles} } % \glsxtralttreeInit \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-alt\-tree\-Init} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \desc{initialisation code performed by the \glostyle{alttree}-like styles} } % \glsxtrAltTreeIndent \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Alt\-Tree\-Indent} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} v1.05+} \desc{length register for the subsequent paragraph indentation for the \glostyle{alttree}-like styles} } % COMMANDS: DISPLAYING GLOSSARIES % \glossarysection \gcmd{glossary\-section} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{toc-title}\margm{title}} \desc{occurs at the start of a \idx{glossary} (except with \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}). This will typically be defined to use a sectioning command, such as \gls{section} or \gls{chapter}. The default definition follows the \opt{section} and \opt{numberedsection} options} } % \glossarytitle \gcmd{glossary\-title} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{initialised by the \csfmt{print\ldots glossary} set of commands (such as \gls{printglossary}) to the current \idx{glossary}['s] title} } % \glossarytoctitle \gcmd{glossary\-toc\-title} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{initialised by the \csfmt{print\ldots glossary} set of commands (such as \gls{printglossary}) to the current \idx{glossary}['s] table of contents title} } % \glossaryheader \gcmd{glossary\-header} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{inserted after \code{\cbeg{\env{theglossary}}}. This command should be redefined by the \idx{glossarystyle}} } % \glossentry \gcmd{gloss\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08+} \syntax{\margm{entry label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used to format a top-level entry. This command should be redefined by the \idx{glossarystyle}} } % \subglossentry \gcmd{sub\-gloss\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08+} \syntax{\margm{level}\margm{entry label}\margm{location list}} \desc{used to format a child entry. This command should be redefined by the \idx{glossarystyle}} } % \glsresetentrylist \gcmd{gls\-reset\-entry\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{inserted into the \idx{glossary} code to counteract the effect of \gls{glsnonextpages}} } % \glsnonextpages \gcmd{gls\-no\-next\-pages} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \desc{designed for use with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, this may be placed in an entry's description to suppress the entry's \idx{locationlist}} } % \glsnextpages \gcmd{gls\-next\-pages} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \desc{designed for use with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, this may be placed in an entry's description to override \opt{nonumberlist}} } % \glsgroupskip \gcmd{gls\-group\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{inserted before each \idx{group} heading (except the first) in a \idx{glossary} (unless \printglossoptval{groups}{false}). This command is defined by \idxpl{glossarystyle} as appropriate. Most of the predefined styles define this command to check the \opt{nogroupskip} option} } % \glsgroupheading \gcmd{gls\-group\-head\-ing}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{group-label}} \desc{inserted at the start of each \idx{group} in a \idx{glossary} (unless \printglossoptval{groups}{false}) to display the \idx{group}['s] heading, if applicable, using the title associated with \meta{group-label} or, if no title provided, just \meta{group-label}. This command is defined by \idxpl{glossarystyle} as appropriate} } % \glssubgroupheading \gcmd{gls\-sub\-group\-head\-ing}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{previous level}\margm{level}\margm{parent-label}\margm{group-label}} \desc{used to format sub-\idx{group} headings. Only applicable with the \idx{unsrtfam}. This command won't occur in \idxpl{glossary} that use \gls{printglossary} or \gls{printnoidxglossary}} } % \glossarypostamble \gcmd{glossary\-postamble}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{used at the end of the \idx{glossary}} } % \glossarypreamble \gcmd{glossary\-preamble}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{used at the start of the \idx{glossary}. This will be locally redefined to the preamble associated with the current glossary, if one has been set} \field{seealso}{setglossarypreamble} } % \setglossarypreamble \gcmd{set\-glossary\-preamble}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.07+} \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{text}} \desc{globally sets the preamble for the glossary identified by \meta{type} to \meta{text}. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed} } % \apptoglossarypreamble \gcmd{app\-to\-glossary\-preamble}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{text}} \desc{appends (locally) \meta{text} to the preamble for the glossary identified by \meta{type}. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed} } % \pretoglossarypreamble \gcmd{pre\-to\-glossary\-preamble}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{text}} \desc{prepends (locally) \meta{text} to the preamble for the glossary identified by \meta{type}. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed} } % \printglossaries \gcmd{print\-glossaries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{iterates over all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} and does \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\meta{type}}}} for each \idx{glossary}} } % \printnoidxglossaries \gcmd{print\-noidx\-glossaries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.04+} \desc{iterates over all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} and does \code{\gls{printnoidxglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\meta{type}}}} for each \idx{glossary}} } % \printunsrtglossaries \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossaries}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \desc{iterates over all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} and does \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\meta{type}}}} for each \idx{glossary}} } % \printglossary \gcmd{print\-glossary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{displays the \idx{glossary} by inputting a file created by \app+{makeindex} or \app+{xindy}. Must be used with \gls{makeglossaries} and either \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}} }% % \printacronyms \gcmd{print\-acronyms}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires the \opt{acronyms} package option} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{acronymtype}}}}} }% % \printunsrtacronyms \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-acronyms}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.40+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{acronyms},\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{acronymtype}}}}} }% % \printabbreviations \gcmd{print\-ab\-bre\-vi\-a\-tions}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{abbreviations}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{glsxtrabbrvtype}}}}} }% % \printunsrtabbreviations \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-ab\-bre\-vi\-a\-tions}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.40+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{abbreviations},\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{glsxtrabbrvtype}}}}} }% % \printsymbols \gcmd{print\-symbols}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.02+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires the \opt{symbols} package option} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{symbols}}}} }% % \printunsrtsymbols \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-symbols}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.40+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{symbols},\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{symbols}}}} }% % \printnumbers \gcmd{print\-numbers}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.02+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires the \opt{numbers} package option} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{numbers}}}} }% % \printunsrtnumbers \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-numbers}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.40+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{numbers},\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut provided by the \opt{numbers} package option combined with \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} that simply does \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{numbers}}}} }% % \printindex \gcmd{print\-index}% {% \syntax{\oargm{options} v4.02+} \note{requires the \opt{index} package option} \desc{shortcut provided by the \opt{index} package option that simply does \code{\gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{index}}}} }% % \printunsrtindex \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-index}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.40+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{index},\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{shortcut provided by the \opt{index} package option combined with \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} that simply does \code{\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{index}}}} }% % \printnoidxglossary \gcmd{print\-noidx\-glossary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{displays the \idx{glossary} by obtaining the \idx{indexing} information from the \ext+{aux} file and using \TeX\ to sort and collate. Must be used with \gls{makenoidxglossaries} or with the \idxpl{glossary} not identified in the optional argument of \gls{makeglossaries} when using the hybrid method. This method can be very slow and has limitations} }% % \printunsrtglossary \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{displays the \idx{glossary} by iterating over all entries associated with the given \idx{glossary} (in the order in which they were added to the \idx{glossary}). \Idx{group} headers will only be inserted if the \gloskey{group} key has been defined and has been set (typically with the \opt{record} option and \app{bib2gls}). \Idxpl{locationlist} will only be shown if the \gloskey{location} or \glosfield{loclist} fields have been set (typically by \app{bib2gls})} }% % \printunsrtglossary* \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary*}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{init-code}} \desc{does \code{\marg{\meta{init-code}\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oargm{options}}} which localises \meta{init-code}} } % \printunsrtglossaryunit \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-unit} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{counter-name}} \desc{provided for use with \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter} to display a glossary with \gls{printunsrtglossary*} that filters entries that don't have a match for the current \meta{counter-name} value} } % \printunsrtglossaryunitsetup \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-unit\-set\-up} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{counter-name}} \desc{sets up the filtering used by \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}} } % \printunsrtglossaryunitpostskip \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-unit\-post\-skip} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{the vertical space at the end of the \idx{glossary} appended by \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}} } % \printunsrtinnerglossary \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-inner\-glossary}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.44+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{pre-code}\margm{post-code}} \desc{similar to \gls{printunsrtglossary} but doesn't contain the code that starts and ends the \idx{glossary} (such as beginning and ending the \env{theglossary} environment), so this command needs to be either placed inside \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} or in the \gls{printunsrtglossary} entry handler \gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}} }% % \glsxtrnoidxgroups \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-no\-idx\-groups} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{makes the group titling mechanism used with the \idx{unsrtfam} use the same method as for \gls{printnoidxglossary} (\idx{ascii} only). This command can't be used with \gls{makeglossaries} or with \opt{record}} } % \printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-entry\-process\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{glossary} is being constructed} } % \printunsrtglossaryskipentry \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-skip\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{may be used within \gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} to skip the current entry} } % \printunsrtglossarypreentryprocesshook \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-pre\-entry\-process\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{internal cs}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{glossary} is being constructed before the entry line has been added} } % \printunsrtglossarypostentryprocesshook \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-post\-entry\-process\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{internal cs}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{glossary} is being constructed after the entry line has been added} } % \printunsrtglossarygrouphook \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-group\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{internal cs}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{group} header is being constructed} } % \printunsrtglossarypostbegin \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-post\-begin} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{internal cs}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{glossary} is being constructed just after \code{\cbeg{theglossary}} is added} } % \printunsrtglossarypreend \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-pre\-end} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{internal cs}} \desc{hook used within the \idx{unsrtfam} while the \idx{glossary} is being constructed just before \code{\cend{theglossary}} is added} } % \glscurrenttoplevelentry \gcmd{gls\-current\-top\-level\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{may be used within \gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} to reference the most recent top level entry label (allowing for \printglossopt{flatten} and \printglossopt{leveloffset})} } % \glscurrentrootentry \gcmd{gls\-current\-root\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{may be used within \gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} to reference the most recent top level entry label (allowing for \printglossopt{flatten} but not \printglossopt{leveloffset})} } % \currentglossary \gcmd{current\-glossary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \desc{defined by the \csfmt{print\ldots glossary} commands to the current \idx{glossary} label} } % \printunsrtglossarypredoglossary \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-pre\-do\-glossary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{hook performed by the \idx{unsrtfam} just before the \idx{glossary} body is displayed} } % \@glsxtr@doglossary \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-@do\-glossary} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \desc{internal command used within the construction of the \idx{glossary} code by the \idx{unsrtfam}. Should not be used or modified but \gls{printunsrtglossarypredoglossary} can be defined to show the definition of this command for debugging purposes} } % \printunsrtglossaryhandler \gcmd{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-handler} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used within the \idx{unsrtfam} to process the current entry} } % \glsxtrunsrtdo \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-unsrt\-do}% {% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{used by the \idx{unsrtfam}, this displays the \idx{glossary} entry according to the current \idx{glossarystyle} (taking the \idx{hierarchicallevel} into account, which may have been adjusted by \printglossopt{leveloffset} or \printglossopt{flatten})} } % \GlsXtrLocationField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Location\-Field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \initval{location} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used to obtain the formatted \idx{locationlist} for the \idx{unsrtfam}} } % \glsxtriflabelinlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-label\-in\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{label}\margm{label-list}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given label is in the given comma-separated list of labels, otherwise does \meta{false}. The label and list are fully expanded} } % prinunsrtglossarywrap environment \genv{print\-unsrt\-glossary\-wrap}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.44+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{sets up the start and end of the \idx{glossary} (including beginning and ending the \env{theglossary} environment). Use \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary} within the body for each block of entries} }% % print*glossary options \gidx{printglossopt}{\name{print [unsrt|noidx] glossary options}% \field{text}{print glossary option}% \desc{most (but not all) of these options can be used in the optional argument of all the print \idx{glossary} commands: \gls{printglossary}, \gls{printnoidxglossary}, \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. Some may be used in the optional argument of the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment} } % printgloss type \gprintglossopt{type}{% \syntax{\meta{\idx{glossary}-label}} \defval{\gls{glsdefaulttype}}% \desc{identifies the \idx{glossary} to display}} % printgloss sort \gprintglossopt{sort}{% \syntax{\meta{method}} \desc{only available with \gls{printnoidxglossary}, this indicates how the \idx{glossary} should be ordered}} % printgloss title \gprintglossopt{title}{% \syntax{\meta{text}} \desc{sets the glossary title (overriding the default)}} % printgloss toctitle \gprintglossopt{toc\-title}{% \syntax{\meta{text}} \desc{sets the glossary toc title (overriding the default)}} % printgloss target \gprintglossopt{target}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true}% \defval{true}% \desc{if true, each entry in the \idx{glossary} should have a hypertarget created, if supported by the \idx{glossarystyle} and if hyperlinks are enabled} } % printgloss targetnameprefix \gprintglossopt{target\-name\-prefix}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.20+} \syntax{\meta{prefix}} \desc{inserts \meta{prefix} at the start of the hypertarget names}} % printgloss prefix \gprintglossopt{prefix}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\meta{prefix}} \desc{redefines \gls{glolinkprefix} to \meta{prefix}}} % printgloss label \gprintglossopt{label}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.39+} \syntax{\meta{label}} \desc{adds \code{\gls{label}\margm{label}} to the start of the \idx{glossary} (after the title). Not available with \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}} } % printgloss preamble \gprintglossopt{preamble}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\meta{text}} \desc{redefines \gls{glossarypreamble} to \meta{text}} } % printgloss postamble \gprintglossopt{postamble}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\meta{text}} \desc{redefines \gls{glossarypostamble} to \meta{text}} } % printgloss nonumberlist \gprintglossopt{no\-number\-list}{% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{suppress the \gls{locationlist}. Note that \printglossoptval{nonumberlist}{false} will have no effect with the \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false} \idx{resourceopt} as there won't be any \glspl{locationlist} to display} } % printgloss nogroupskip \gprintglossopt{no\-group\-skip}{% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{suppress the gap implemented by some \idxpl{glossarystyle} between \idxpl{group}} } % printgloss numberedsection \gprintglossopt{numbered\-section}{% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false}% \defval{nolabel}% \desc{indicates whether or not \idx{glossary} section headers will be numbered and also if they should automatically be labelled. The \opt{numberedsection} package option will change the default setting to match} } % printgloss style \gprintglossopt{style}{% \syntax{\meta{style-name}} \desc{use the \meta{style-name} \idx{glossarystyle}} } % printgloss leveloffset \gprintglossopt{level\-offset}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.44+} \syntax{\meta{offset}} \initval{0}% \desc{set or increment the \gls{hierarchicallevel} offset. If \meta{offset} starts with \code{++} then the current offset is incremented by the given amount otherwise the current offset is set to \meta{offset}. For example, an entry with a normal \gls{hierarchicallevel} of 1 will be treated as though it has \gls{hierarchicallevel} $1+\meta{offset}$. This option is only available for the \idx{unsrtfam} and the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment}% } % printgloss groups \gprintglossopt{groups}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.44+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{true}% \defval{true}% \desc{enables \idx{group} formation. This option is only available for the \idx{unsrtfam} and the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment. Note that no \idxpl{group} will be formed when invoking \app{bib2gls} with the default \switch{no-group}, regardless of this setting} } % printgloss flatten \gprintglossopt{flatten}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{if true, treats all entries as though they have the same hierarchical level (the value of \printglossopt{leveloffset}). This option is only available for the \idx{unsrtfam} and the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment} } % printgloss nopostdot \gprintglossopt{no\-post\-dot}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{suppress the post-description punctuation} } % printgloss entrycounter \gprintglossopt{entry\-counter}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{if true, enable the entry counter} } % printgloss subentrycounter \gprintglossopt{sub\-entry\-counter}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false}% \defval{true}% \desc{if true, enable the sub-entry counter} } % \ifglsxtrprintglossflatten \gcond{if\-gls\-xtr\-print\-gloss\-flatten} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{conditional set by the \printglossopt{flatten} option} } % \glsxtraddgroup \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-add\-group} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{code}} \desc{used by the \idx{unsrtfam} to perform \meta{code} if the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} should have support for \idxpl{group}} } % \glscurrententrylevel \gcmd{gls\-current\-entry\-level} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.44+} \desc{defined within the \idx{unsrtfam} to the current \idx{hierarchicallevel} (taking \printglossopt{leveloffset} into account)} } % \glsxtrsetgrouptitle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-group\-title} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}\margm{group-title}} \desc{globally assigns the given title \meta{group-title} to the \idx{group} identified by \meta{group-label}} } % \glsxtrlocalsetgrouptitle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-local\-set\-group\-title} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.24+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}\margm{group-title}} \desc{locally assigns the given title \meta{group-title} to the \idx{group} identified by \meta{group-label}} } % \glsxtrgetgrouptitle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-get\-group\-title} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \syntax{\margm{group-label}\margm{cs}} \desc{obtains the title corresponding to the \idx{group} identified by \meta{group-label} and stores the result in the control sequence \meta{cs}} } % \glsxtrdetoklocation \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-de\-tok\-location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{location}} \desc{just expands to \meta{location} by default but may be redefined to help protect awkward characters} } % \glsdisplaynumberlist \gcmd{gls\-display\-number\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{formats the \idx{locationlist} for the given entry. Redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} to obtain the \idx{locationlist} from the \gloskey{location} field} } % \glsentrynumberlist \gcmd{gls\-entry\-number\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the \idx{locationlist} for the given entry. Redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} to obtain the \idx{locationlist} from the \gloskey{location} field} } % COMMANDS: STANDALONE % \glsxtrglossentry \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-gloss\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used for standalone entries to display the name with \gls{glossentryname}, with appropriate hooks} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneGlossaryType \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Glossary\-Type} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{expands to the \idx{glossary} type for standalone entries} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneSubEntryItem \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Sub\-Entry\-Item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display standalone entries that have the \gloskey{parent} field set} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryName \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the standalone entry name and create the associated hypertarget, if supported} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryPdfName \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Pdf\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrglossentry} for the PDF bookmark} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryHeadName \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Head\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrglossentry} for the header and toc} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryOther \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{as \gls{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryName} but where the text is obtained from the given field instead of \gloskey{name}} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryPdfOther \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Pdf\-Other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrglossentryother} for the PDF bookmark} } % \GlsXtrStandaloneEntryHeadOther \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Stand\-alone\-Entry\-Head\-Other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrglossentryother} for the header and toc} } % \glsxtractivatenopost \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-activate\-no\-post} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.22+} \desc{activates \gls{nopostdesc} and \gls{glsxtrnopostpunc}} } % \glsxtrglossentryother \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-gloss\-entry\-other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.22+} \syntax{\margm{header}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrglossentry} but uses the given field instead of \gloskey{name}} } % COMMANDS: DEFINING ENTRIES % \glsnoexpandfields \gcmd{gls\-no\-expand\-fields} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \desc{don't expand field values when defining entries, except for those that explicitly have expansion enabled with \gls{glssetexpandfield}} } % \glsexpandfields \gcmd{gls\-expand\-fields} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \desc{expand field values when defining entries, except for those that explicitly have expansion disabled with \gls{glssetnoexpandfield}} } % \glssetnoexpandfield \gcmd{gls\-set\-no\-expand\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.13a+} \syntax{\margm{field}} \desc{don't expand the value of the field identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} when defining entries (overrides \gls{glsexpandfields})} } % \glssetexpandfield \gcmd{gls\-set\-expand\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.13a+} \syntax{\margm{field}} \desc{expand the value of the field identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} when defining entries (overrides \gls{glsnoexpandfields})} } % \ifglsentryexists \gcmd{if\-gls\-entry\-exists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} exists, otherwise does \meta{false}} \field{seealso}{glsdoifexistsordo,glsdoifexists,glsdoifnoexists} } % \glsdoifexistsordo \gcmd{gls\-do\-if\-exists\-or\-do} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.19+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{similar to \gls{ifglsentryexists}, this does \meta{true} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} exists. If the entry doesn't it exist, this does \meta{false} and generates an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}). The unknown marker \idx{unknowntag} will be placed before the \meta{false} code} \field{seealso}{ifglsentryexists,glsdoifexists,glsdoifnoexists} } % \glsdoifexists \gcmd{gls\-do\-if\-exists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{code}} \desc{does \meta{code} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} exists. If the entry doesn't exist, this will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) and, within the document environment, it will insert the unknown marker \idx{unknowntag}} \field{seealso}{ifglsentryexists,glsdoifexistsordo,glsdoifnoexists} } % \glsdoifexistsorwarn \gcmd{gls\-do\-if\-exists\-or\-warn} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.03+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{code}} \desc{like \gls{glsdoifexists}, but always warns (no error) if the entry doesn't exist, regardless of the \opt{undefaction} setting, and doesn't show the unknown marker} } % \glsdoifnoexists \gcmd{gls\-do\-if\-no\-exists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{code}} \desc{does \meta{code} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} does not exist. If the entry does exist, this will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn})} \field{seealso}{ifglsentryexists,glsdoifexistsordo,glsdoifexists} } % \loadglsentries \gcmd{load\-gls\-entries} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}}% \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{filename}} \desc{locally assigns \gls{glsdefaulttype} to \meta{type} and inputs \meta{filename}. If the optional argument is omitted, the default glossary is assumed. Note that if any entries with \meta{filename} have the \gloskey{type} key set (including implicitly in commands like \gls{newabbreviation}), then this will override the type given in the optional argument} } % \newglossaryentry \gcmd{new\-glossary\-entry}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}}% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{key=value list}} \desc{defines a new \idx{glossary} entry with the given label. The second argument is a comma-separated list of \idxpl{gloskey}} } % \longnewglossaryentry \gcmd{long\-new\-glossary\-entry}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a}% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{key=value list}\margm{description}} \desc{defines a new \idx{glossary} entry with the given label. The second argument is a comma-separated list of \idxpl{gloskey}. The third argument is the description, which may include paragraph breaks} } % \longnewglossaryentry* \gcmd{long\-new\-glossary\-entry*}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{key=value list}\margm{description}} \desc{like the unstarred \gls{longnewglossaryentry} but doesn't add the \gls{glsxtrpostlongdescription} hook} }% % \glsxtrpostlongdescription \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-long\-descrip\-tion}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{hook added to the end of the \gloskey{description} field by the unstarred version of \gls{longnewglossaryentry}} }% % \newterm \gcmd{new\-term}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.02+} \syntax{\oargm{key=value list}\margm{entry-label}} \note{requires \opt{index} package option} \desc{defines a new \idx{glossary} entry with the given label, \gloskey{type} set to \code{index}, the \gloskey{name} set to \meta{entry-label} and the \gloskey{description} set to \gls{nopostdesc}. The optional argument is a comma-separated list of \idxpl{gloskey}, which can be used to override the defaults} } % \glsxtrnewsymbol \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-symbol}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{key=value list}\margm{entry-label}\margm{sym}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{symbols}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{defines a new \idx{glossary} entry with the given label, \gloskey{type} set to \code{symbols}, the \gloskey{category} set to \code{symbol}, the \gloskey{name} set to \meta{sym} and the \gloskey{sort} set to \meta{entry-label}. The optional argument is a comma-separated list of \idxpl{gloskey}, which can be used to override the defaults} } % \glsxtrnewnumber \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-number}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{key=value list}\margm{entry-label}\margm{num}} \note{requires \code{\csfmt{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{numbers}}\marg{glossaries-extra}}} \desc{defines a new \idx{glossary} entry with the given label, \gloskey{type} set to \code{numbers}, the \gloskey{category} set to \code{number}, the \gloskey{name} set to \meta{num} and the \gloskey{sort} set to \meta{entry-label}. The optional argument is a comma-separated list of \idxpl{gloskey}, which can be used to override the defaults} } % \newentry \gcmd{new\-entry}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{options}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{newglossaryentry} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{other} package option} } % \newsym \gcmd{new\-sym}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{key=value list}\margm{entry-label}\margm{sym}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{other} package option (provided the \opt{symbols} option is also used)} } % \newnum \gcmd{new\-num}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{key=value list}\margm{entry-label}\margm{num}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrnewnumber} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{other} package option (provided the \opt{numbers} option is also used)} } % \newabbr \gcmd{new\-abbr}% {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{short}\margm{long}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{newabbreviation} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \glsaddkey \gcmd{gls\-add\-key} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.12a} \syntax{\margm{key}\margm{default value}\margm{no link cs}\margm{no link ucfirst cs}\margm{link cs}\margm{link ucfirst cs}\margm{link allcaps cs}} \desc{defines a new \idx{gloskey} with the given default value and commands that are analogous to \gls{glsentrytext} (\meta{no link cs}), \gls{Glsentrytext} (\meta{no link ucfirst cs}), \gls{glstext} (\meta{link cs}), \gls{Glstext} (\meta{link ucfirst cs}), \gls{GLStext} (\meta{link allcaps cs}). The starred version switches on field expansion for the given key} \field{seealso}{glsaddstoragekey,glsxtrprovidestoragekey} } % \glsaddstoragekey \gcmd{gls\-add\-storage\-key} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16} \syntax{\margm{key}\margm{default value}\margm{no link cs}} \desc{provides a new \idx{gloskey} with a default value and a command for simply accessing the value (without indexing or hyperlinks). The starred version switches on field expansion for the given key} \field{seealso}{glsaddkey,glsxtrprovidestoragekey} } % \glsxtrprovidestoragekey \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-provide\-storage\-key} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{key}\margm{default value}\margm{no link cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsaddstoragekey} but does nothing if the key has already been defined} } % \glsxtrifkeydefined \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-key\-defined} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{key}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given \meta{key} has been defined as a \idx{gloskey}. Does \meta{true} if the key has been defined, otherwise does false} } % \newglossaryentry (glossentry) keys \gidxpl{gloskey}{% \common \field{text}{glossary entry key} \desc{these are options that can be passed to commands that define entries, such as \gls{newglossaryentry} or \gls{newabbreviation}} } % glossentry name \ggloskey{name}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the entry's name, as displayed in the \idx{glossary}. This typically isn't used outside of the \idx{glossary} (the \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} keys are used instead). However, if there is a need to specifically display the entry name, use \gls{glsname} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or \gls{glsentryname}. Glossary styles should use \gls{glossentryname}, which uses \gls{glsentryname} and incorporates the \idxpl{postnamehook} and related \attrs} } % glossentry description \ggloskey{description}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the entry's description, as displayed in the \idx{glossary}. If required in the text, use \gls{glsdesc} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or \gls{glsentrydesc}. Glossary styles should use \gls{glossentrydesc} and \gls{glspostdescription} to incorporate the \idx{postdeschook}} } % glossentry descriptionplural \ggloskey{description\-plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the plural form of the entry's description, if applicable. If omitted, this is set to the same value as the \gloskey{description}, since descriptions tend not to be a singular entity} } % glossentry type \ggloskey{type}% {% \syntax{\meta{\idx{glossary}-label}} \initvalcs{glsdefaulttype}% \desc{assigns the entry to the \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{\idx{glossary}-label}} } % glossentry parent \ggloskey{parent}% {% \syntax{\meta{parent-label}} \desc{the label of the entry's parent (from which the entry's \idx{hierarchicallevel} is obtained)} } % glossentry category \ggloskey{category}% {% \syntax{\meta{category-label}}% \initval{general}% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \desc{the entry's \idx{category} (must be a simple label)} } % glossentry sort \ggloskey{sort}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{\meta{entry name}} \desc{specifies the value to use for sorting (overrides the default). This key is usually required for \app+{xindy} if the \gloskey{name} key only contains commands (for example, the entry is a symbol), but explicitly using this key in other contexts can break certain sort methods. \gallerypage{bib2gls-sorting}{Don't use the \gloskey{sort} field with \app{bib2gls}}} } % glossentry text \ggloskey{text}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the entry's text, as displayed on \idx{subsequentuse} of \idx{glslike} commands. If omitted, this value is assumed to be the same as the \gloskey{name} key} } % glossentry plural \ggloskey{plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the entry's plural form, as displayed on \idx{subsequentuse} of plural \idx{glslike} commands, such as \gls{glspl}. This should be the appropriate plural form of the value provided by the \gloskey{text} key. If omitted, this value is assumed to be the value of the \gloskey{text} key with \gls{glspluralsuffix} appended} } % glossentry symbol \ggloskey{symbol}% {% \initvalcs{relax} \syntax{\margm{symbol}} \desc{the entry's associated symbol (optional), which can be displayed with \gls{glssymbol} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentrysymbol}} } % glossentry symbolplural \ggloskey{symbol\-plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{symbol plural}} \desc{The plural form of the \gloskey{symbol}, if applicable, which can be displayed with \gls{glssymbolplural} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentrysymbolplural}. If omitted, this value is set to the same as the \gloskey{symbol} key (since symbols usually don't have a plural form)} } % glossentry first \ggloskey{first}% {% \syntax{\margm{first}} \desc{the entry's text, as displayed on \idx{firstuse} of \idx{glslike} commands. Note that using an \idx{abbrvstyle} or \glspl{postlinkhook} is a more flexible approach. If omitted, this value is assumed to be the same as the \gloskey{text} key} } % glossentry firstplural \ggloskey{first\-plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the entry's plural form, as displayed on \idx{firstuse} of plural \idx{glslike} commands, such as \gls{glspl}. If this key is omitted, then the value will either be the same as the \gloskey{plural} field, if the \gloskey{first} key wasn't used, or the value will be taken from the \gloskey{first} key with \gls{glspluralsuffix} appended} } % glossentry short \ggloskey{short}% {% \syntax{\margm{short-form}} \desc{a \idx{field} that is set by \gls{newabbreviation} (and \gls{newacronym}) to the entry's short (abbreviated) form. It typically shouldn't be used explicitly with \gls{newglossaryentry} as \gls{newabbreviation} makes other modifications to ensure that when the entry is referenced with the \idx{glslike} commands, it will obey the appropriate \idx{abbrvstyle}. If you are using \app{bib2gls} then this field should be used in the \ext{bib} file when defining abbreviations} } % glossentry shortplural \ggloskey{short\-plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{short-form}} \desc{as \gloskey{short} but the plural form. The default is obtained by appending the abbreviation plural suffix, but this behaviour can be altered by \idxpl{categoryattribute}. See \sectionref{sec:abbreviations} for further details} } % glossentry long \ggloskey{long}% {% \syntax{\margm{long-form}} \desc{a \idx{field} that is set by \gls{newabbreviation} to the entry's long (unabbreviated) form. It typically shouldn't be used explicitly with \gls{newglossaryentry} as \gls{newabbreviation} makes other modifications to ensure that when the entry is referenced with the \idx{glslike} commands, it will obey the appropriate \idx{abbrvstyle}. If you are using \app{bib2gls} then this field should be used in the \ext{bib} file when defining abbreviations} } % glossentry longplural \ggloskey{long\-plural}% {% \syntax{\margm{long-form}} \desc{as \gloskey{long} but the plural form} } % glossentry user1 \ggloskey{user1}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuseri} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuseri}} } % glossentry user2 \ggloskey{user2}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuserii} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuserii}} } % glossentry user3 \ggloskey{user3}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuseriii} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuseriii}} } % glossentry user4 \ggloskey{user4}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuseriv} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuseriv}} } % glossentry user5 \ggloskey{user5}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuserv} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuserv}} } % glossentry user6 \ggloskey{user6}% {% \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{a generic field, which can be displayed with \gls{glsuservi} (if \idx{indexing} and hyperlinks are required) or with \gls{glsentryuservi}} } % glossentry counter \ggloskey{counter}% {% \syntax{\margm{counter-name}} \desc{if set, the value indicates the \idx{locationcounter} to use by default when \idx{indexing} this entry (overrides the counter associated with the \idx{glossary} or the \opt{counter} package option)} } % glossentry see \ggloskey{see}% {% \syntax{\marg{\oargm{tag}\meta{xr-list}}} \desc{with the base \sty{glossaries} package this simply triggers an automatic cross-reference with \gls{glssee}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package additionally saves the value. Use \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{false} to prevent the automatic cross-reference. The \meta{tag} defaults to \gls{seename} and \meta{xr-list} should be a comma-separated list of entries that have already been defined} } % glossentry seealso \ggloskey{see\-also}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{xr-list}} \desc{behaves in a similar manner to \gloskeyval{see}{\oarg{\gls{seealsoname}}\meta{xr-list}}} } % glossentry alias \ggloskey{alias}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{xr-label}} \desc{behaves in a similar manner to \gloskeyval{see}{\oarg{\gls{seealsoname}}\meta{xr-label}} but also sets up aliasing which makes the \idx{linktext} hyperlink to \meta{xr-label} instead} } % glossentry group \ggloskey{group}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{group-label}} \desc{the \idx{group} label that identifies which \idx{group} the entry belongs to. This key is only available with the \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref} options, and is set by \app{bib2gls}, if invoked with \switch{group} or \switch{g}. This is an \idxc{bib2glsinternalfield}{internal key} assigned by \app{bib2gls} as a by-product of sorting. Explicit use without reference to the order of entries can result in fragmented groups. The corresponding title can be set with \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}, although this is more commonly done implicitly within the \ext{glstex} file} } % glossentry location \ggloskey{location}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{location-list}} \desc{the formatted \idx{locationlist} used by the \idx{unsrtfam}. This key is only available with the \opt{record} option and is set by \app{bib2gls} unless \resourceopt{save-locations}{false} is set} } % ACCESSIBILITY KEYS % glossentry access \ggloskey{access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{name} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided and the \catattr{nameshortaccess} attribute is set. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry textaccess \ggloskey{text\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{text} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided and the \catattr{textshortaccess} attribute is set. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry pluralaccess \ggloskey{plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{plural} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided and the \catattr{textshortaccess} attribute is set. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry firstaccess \ggloskey{first\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{first} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided and the \catattr{firstshortaccess} attribute is set. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry firstpluralaccess \ggloskey{first\-plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{firstplural} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided and the \catattr{firstshortaccess} attribute is set. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry shortaccess \ggloskey{short\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{short} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry shortpluralaccess \ggloskey{short\-plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{shortplural} field. This field will be automatically set by \gls{newabbreviation}, if not provided. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr}} } % glossentry longaccess \ggloskey{long\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{long} field} } % glossentry longpluralaccess \ggloskey{long\-plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{longplural} field} } % glossentry descriptionaccess \ggloskey{description\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{description} field} } % glossentry descriptionpluralaccess \ggloskey{description\-plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{descriptionplural} field} } % glossentry symbolaccess \ggloskey{symbol\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{symbol} field} } % glossentry symbolpluralaccess \ggloskey{symbol\-plural\-access}% {% \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{symbolplural} field} } % glossentry user1access \ggloskey{user1\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user1} field} } % glossentry user2access \ggloskey{user2\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user2} field} } % glossentry user3access \ggloskey{user3\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user3} field} } % glossentry user4access \ggloskey{user4\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user4} field} } % glossentry user5access \ggloskey{user5\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user5} field} } % glossentry user6access \ggloskey{user6\-access}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{accessibility text corresponding to the \gloskey{user6} field} } % PREFIX KEYS % glossentry prefix \ggloskey{prefix}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix} v3.14a+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the \idx{subsequentuse} singular prefix} } % glossentry prefixplural \ggloskey{prefix\-plural}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix} v3.14a+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the \idx{subsequentuse} plural prefix} } % glossentry prefixfirst \ggloskey{prefix\-first}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix} v3.14a+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the \idx{firstuse} singular prefix} } % glossentry prefixfirstplural \ggloskey{prefix\-first\-plural}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix} v3.14a+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the \idx{firstuse} plural prefix} } % COMMANDS: FIELDS \gidxpl{glosfield}{% \common \field{text}{glossary entry field} \desc{these are internal fields that don't have a corresponding \idxc{gloskey}{key}} } \gidx{internalfieldname}{\name{internal field name}\field{alias}{idx.glosfield}} % field loclist \gglosfield{loc\-list}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.04+} \syntax{\margm{\sty{etoolbox} list}} \desc{used by \gls{printnoidxglossary} to provide the locations. The value is an \sty{etoolbox} list of individual locations which are obtained from the \ext+{aux} file. This field will also be used by the \idx{unsrtfam} if \gloskey{location} isn't set} } % field indexcounter \gglosfield{index\-counter}% {% \syntax{\margm{target-name}} \desc{used with the \opt{indexcounter} package option and the \resourceopt{save-index-counter} resource option. The value is set to the hyperlink target of the first \ctr{wrglossary} \location\ or the first instance for a specific \idx{locationencap}} } % field childcount \gglosfield{child\-count}% {% \syntax{\margm{number}} \desc{used with the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option to store the entry's child count} } % field childlist \gglosfield{child\-list}% {% \syntax{\margm{entry-label-list}} \desc{used with the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option to store the entry's children as an \sty{etoolbox} internal list} } % field recordcount \gglosfield{record\-count}% {% \syntax{\margm{number}} \desc{used with the \switch{record-count} switch to store the total number of \records\ for the associated entry} } % field record. \gglosfield{record.counter}% {% \name{\csoptfmt{record\dfullstop\meta{counter}}} \syntax{\margm{location}} \desc{used with \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter} to store an \sty{etoolbox} internal list of locations (without encap) corresponding to the given counter} } % field recordcount. \gglosfield{record\-count.counter}% {% \name{\csoptfmt{record\-count\dfullstop\meta{counter}}} \syntax{\margm{number}} \desc{used with the \switch{record-count} switch to store the total number of \records\ with the \idx{locationcounter} \meta{counter} for the associated entry} } % field recordcount.. \gglosfield{record\-count.counter.location}% {% \name{\csoptfmt{record\-count\dfullstop\meta{counter}\dfullstop\meta{location}}} \syntax{\margm{number}} \desc{used with the \switch{record-count-unit} switch to store the total number of \records\ with the \idx{locationcounter} \meta{counter} set to \meta{location} for the associated entry} } % field secondarygroup \gglosfield{sec\-ondary\-group} { \syntax{\margm{group-label}} \desc{used by \app{bib2gls} to store the \idx{group} label obtained from the secondary sort} } % internal field useri \gglosfield{useri} { \desc{corresponds to \gloskey{user1} key} } % internal field userii \gglosfield{userii} { \desc{corresponds to \gloskey{user2} key} } % internal field useriii \gglosfield{useriii} { \desc{corresponds to \gloskey{user3} key} } % \glscategory \gcmd{gls\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the entry's category} } % \glsfieldxdef \gcmd{gls\-field\-xdef} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{as \gls{glsfieldedef} but does a global assignment} } % \glsfieldedef \gcmd{gls\-field\-edef} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{locally assigns the full expansion of \meta{value} to the given \idx{field} (identified by the \idx{internalfieldlabel} \meta{field}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. Produces an error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) if the entry or field doesn't exist. Note that this doesn't update any associated fields} } % \glsfieldgdef \gcmd{gls\-field\-gdef} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{as \gls{glsfielddef} but does a global assignment} } % \glsfielddef \gcmd{gls\-field\-def} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{locally assigns the \meta{value} to the given \idx{field} (identified by the \idx{internalfieldlabel} \meta{field}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. Produces an error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) if the entry or field doesn't exist. Note that this doesn't update any associated fields} } % \glsxtrdeffield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-def\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{like \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but doesn't perform any existence checks} } % \glsxtredeffield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-edef\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrdeffield} but (protected) expands \meta{value}} } % \glsxtrapptocsvfield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-app\-to\-csv\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{element}} \desc{For use with fields that should contain comma-separated lists, this will append a command followed by \meta{element} to the field value. If the field isn't defined, this command will behave like \gls{glsxtrdeffield}. No existence check is performed} } % \glsxtrsetfieldifexists \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-field\-if\-exists} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{code}} \desc{used by commands like \gls{GlsXtrSetField} to check if the entry exists before assigning a value to the field. The \meta{code} part is the assignment code, which is only done if the required condition is met. This can be redefined if the condition needs to be altered} } % \glsxtrfieldlistadd \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-list\-add} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{appends \meta{value} to the given field using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{listcsadd}} } % \glsxtrfieldlistgadd \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-list\-gadd} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{appends \meta{value} to the given field using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{listcsgadd}} } % \glsxtrfieldlisteadd \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-list\-eadd} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{appends \meta{value} to the given field using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{listcseadd}} } % \glsxtrfieldlistxadd \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-list\-xadd} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{value}} \desc{appends \meta{value} to the given field using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{listcsxadd}} } % \glsxtrfieldformatlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-format\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{formats the value of the given field, which should be an \sty{etoolbox} internal list, using the same list handler macro as \sty{datatool}['s] \gls{DTLformatlist}} } % \glsxtrfielddolistloop \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-do\-list\-loop} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}} \desc{iterates over the given field's value using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{dolistcsloop}} } % \glsxtrfieldforlistloop \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-for\-list\-loop} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{handler-cs}} \desc{iterates over the given field's value using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{forlistcsloop}} } % \glsxtrfieldifinlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-if\-in\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{item}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifinlistcs} to determine if \meta{item} is in the list stored in the given field} } % \glsxtrfieldxifinlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-x\-if\-in\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}\margm{item}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{xifinlistcs} to determine if \meta{item} is in the list stored in the given field} } % \GlsXtrSetField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{assigns \meta{value} to the field identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. An error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) occurs if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \gGlsXtrSetField \gcmd{gGls\-Xtr\-Set\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{as \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but globally assigns the value} } % \eGlsXtrSetField \gcmd{eGls\-Xtr\-Set\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{as \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but expands the value} } % \xGlsXtrSetField \gcmd{xGls\-Xtr\-Set\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}} \desc{as \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but expands the value and uses a global assignment} } % \GlsXtrLetField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Let\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{cs}} \desc{like \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but internally uses (\sty{etoolbox}['s]) \gls{cslet} instead of \gls{csdef}} } % \csGlsXtrLetField \gcmd{cs\-Gls\-Xtr\-Let\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{cs-name}} \desc{like \gls{GlsXtrLetField} but internally uses (\sty{etoolbox}['s]) \gls{csletcs} instead of \gls{cslet}} } % \GlsXtrLetFieldToField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Let\-Field\-To\-Field}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry1-label}\margm{field1-label}\margm{entry2-label}\margm{field2-label}} \desc{assigns the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field1-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry1-label} to the value of the \idx{field} identified by \meta{field2-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry2-label}} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldUndef \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Undef} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.23+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{expandable command that tests if the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) is undefined for the entry given by \meta{entry-label}. Internally uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsundef} command. Unlike \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} there is no grouping or starred version} \field{seealso}{ifglsfieldvoid} } % \glsxtrifhasfield \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-if\-has\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.19+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} for the entry given by \meta{entry-label} is defined and is not empty. This is like \gls{ifglshasfield} but doesn't produce a warning if the entry or field doesn't exist. This sets \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} to the field value and does \meta{true} if its defined and not empty, otherwise it does \meta{false}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping to make nesting easier. The starred version doesn't (to make assignments easier)} } % \ifglsfieldeq \gcmd{if\-gls\-field\-eq} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{string}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value of the given field is equal to the given string using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsstring}. Triggers an error if the given field (identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel}) hasn't been defined. Uses \gls{glsdoifexists}} } % \ifglsfielddefeq \gcmd{if\-gls\-field\-def\-eq} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{cs}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value of the given field is equal to the replacement text of the given command \meta{cs} using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \csfmt{ifdefstrequal}. Triggers an error if the given field (identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel}) hasn't been defined. Uses \gls{glsdoifexists}} } % \ifglsfieldcseq \gcmd{if\-gls\-field\-cs\-eq} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{cs-name}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value of the given field is equal to the replacement text of the command given by the control sequence name \meta{cs-name} using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \csfmt{ifcsstrequal}. Triggers an error if the given field (identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel}) hasn't been defined. Uses \gls{glsdoifexists}} } % \glsfieldfetch \gcmd{gls\-field\-fetch} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{cs}} \desc{fetches the value of the given field for the given entry and stores it in the command \meta{cs}. Triggers an error if the given field (identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel}) hasn't been defined. Uses \gls{glsdoifexists}} } % \glsunexpandedfieldvalue \gcmd{gls\-un\-expanded\-field\-value} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.48+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{for use in expandable contexts where the field value is required but the contents should not be expanded. The field should be identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel}. Expands to nothing with no error or warning if the entry or field aren't defined} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Cmp\-Num} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{op}\margm{number}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{compares the (numeric) value of the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} with \meta{number} where \meta{op} is the comparison operator (\code{=}, \code{<} or \code{>}). The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldEqNum \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Eq\-Num} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{number}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{a shortcut that uses \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum} with \meta{op} set to \code{=}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldNonZero \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Non\-Zero} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{a shortcut that uses \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum} to test if the (numeric) value of the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} is non-zero. An empty or undefined field is treated as 0. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't. The value can be referenced within \meta{true} (where it will be 0) or within \meta{false} using \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Eq\-Str} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} set to \meta{value}. This internally uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} and compares \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} to \meta{value} using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifdefstring}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldEqXpStr \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Eq\-Xp\-Str} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{like \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr} but first (protected) expands \meta{value}} } % \GlsXtrIfXpFieldEqXpStr \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Xp\-Field\-Eq\-Xp\-Str} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{like \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr} but first (protected) expands both the field value and the supplied \meta{value}} } % \glsxtrforcsvfield \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-for\-csv\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.24+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{handler cs}} \desc{iterates over the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} and performs \code{\meta{handler cs}\margm{element}} for each element of the list. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the complete list can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \glsxtrendfor \gcmd{glsxtrendfor} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.24+} \desc{when used within \gls{glsxtrforcsvfield} signifies that the loop should break at the end of the current iteration} } % \glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-format\-csv\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{formats the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} using \sty{datatool-base}['s] \gls{DTLformatlist}. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the complete list can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. This adds implicit grouping. There is no starred version} } % \GlsXtrIfFieldValueInCsvList \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Field\-Value\-In\-Csv\-List} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{csv-list}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} is contained in the comma-separated list \meta{csv-list} using \gls{DTLifinlist} (provided by \sty{datatool-base}, which is automatically loaded by the \sty{glossaries} package). One level expansion is performed on \meta{csv-list}. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the field value can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \GlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Value\-In\-Field\-Csv\-List} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given value (\meta{value}) is contained in the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} using \gls{DTLifinlist} (provided by \sty{datatool-base}, which is automatically loaded by the \sty{glossaries} package). No expansion is performed on \meta{value}. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the complete list can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't} } % \xGlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList \gcmds{xGls\-Xtr\-If\-Value\-In\-Field\-Csv\-List} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{as \gls{GlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList} but fully expands \meta{value}} } % \glsxtrusefield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{expands to the value of the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label}) for the entry given by \meta{entry-label}. Expands to \gls{relax} if the entry or field are undefined} } % \Glsxtrusefield \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrusefield} but uses \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSxtrusefield \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrusefield} but converts the field value to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrfieldtitlecase \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-title\-case} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrusefield} but converts the field value to \idx{titlecase}} } % \glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-field\-title\-case\-cs} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{content}} \desc{converts \meta{content} to \idx{titlecase} (expanding the first token once). Uses \gls{glscapitalisewords}, if defined, otherwise uses \gls{capitalisewords}} } % \glscapitalisewords \gcmd{gls\-capitalise\-words} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.48+} \syntax{\margm{content}} \desc{just does \gls{capitalisewords} but may be redefined to use \gls{capitalisefmtwords}, if required} } % \glsentrytitlecase \gcmd{gls\-entry\-title\-case} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.22+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{applies \idx{titlecase} to the value supplied in the given field (which is obtained with \gls{glsfieldfetch})} } % \glsletentryfield \gcmd{gls\-let\-entry\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.07+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}} \desc{fetches the value of the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label}) for the entry given by \meta{entry-label} and stores it in the command \meta{cs}} } % \glsxtrentryparentname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-entry\-parent\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.39+} \syntax{\margm{entry-name}} \desc{expands to the \gloskey{name} field of the given entry's parent or does nothing if the entry doesn't have the \gloskey{parent} field set or isn't defined} } % COMMANDS: FORMATTING HOOKS % \glsexclapplyinnerfmtfield \gcmd{gls\-excl\-apply\-inner\-fmt\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}} \desc{locally adds the field given by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} \meta{internal-field} to the \idx{innerformatting} exclusion list for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. This typically means that the field value already contains the \idx{innerformatting}} } % \glsifapplyinnerfmtfield \gcmd{gls\-if\-apply\-inner\-fmt\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the field given by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} \meta{internal-field} has been added to the \idx{innerformatting} exclusion list for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}} \field{seealso}{glsexclapplyinnerfmtfield} } % \glsxtrattrentrytextfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-attr\-entry\-text\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{applies the command obtained from the control sequence name supplied in the \catattr{innertextformat} attribute for the category assigned to the entry given by \gls{glslabel}. This command isn't used by default as it should rarely be needed an increases complexity} } % \glsxtrgenentrytextfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-gen\-entry\-text\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{redefined by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} hooks to set up the \idx{innerformatting}. Initialised to \gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}} } % \glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-default\-entry\-text\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{default \idx{innerformatting}. Initialised to just do \meta{text}} } % \glsfmtfield \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}} \desc{applies the formatting command \meta{cs} (which takes one argument) to the entry's field value identified by the given \idx{internalfieldlabel}, including \meta{insert} appended. Used by the \idx{innerformatting} commands. Note that \gls{glsfmtfield} should not be robust as it needs to expand if it's inside a case-changing command} } % \Glsfmtfield \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtfield} but uses \gls{makefirstuc} to change the field value to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSfmtfield \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtfield} but changes the field value to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsfmtinsert \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-insert} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{a shortcut that applies \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} to \gls{glsinsert} if \gls{glsinsert} isn't empty} } % \GLSfmtinsert \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-insert} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtinsert} but converts to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrsaveinsert \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-save\-insert} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{implemented at the start of all the \idx{glstextlike} commands (except the \idx{inlinefullform} commands like \gls{glsxtrfull}) to save the \gls{glsinsert} placeholder. By default, this sets \gls{glsinsert} to empty} } % \glsxtrfullsaveinsert \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-full\-save\-insert} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{implemented at the start of all the \idx{inlinefullform} commands like \gls{glsxtrfull} to save the \gls{glsinsert} placeholder. By default, this just does \gls{glsxtrsaveinsert}} } % \glsxtrsetlongfirstuse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-long\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{implemented by the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands to assign \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}} } % \glsxtrsetupfulldefs \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-up\-full\-defs} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{hook used by \gls{glsxtrfull} (and case-changing and plural variations)} } % COMMANDS: REFERENCING ENTRIES % \gls \gcmdspa{gls}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced depends on whether or not this is the \idx{firstuse} and whether or not the \catattr{regular} attribute has been set. The \meta{insert} argument may be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext} or may be inserted at a different point (for example, after the long form on \idx{firstuse} for some abbreviation styles. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Gls \gcmdspa{Gls}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{gls} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLS \gcmdspa{GLS}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{gls} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glspl \gcmdspa{glspl}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{gls} but uses the relevant plural form} } % \Glspl \gcmdspa{Glspl}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glspl} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSpl \gcmdspa{GLSpl}{% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glspl} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsdisp \gcmdspa{gls\-disp}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.19+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} with the given \meta{text} as the \idx{linktext}. This command unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} (use \gls{glslink} instead, if the \idx{firstuseflag} should not be altered). This command is considered a \idx{glslike} command. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsdisp \gcmdspa{Gls\-disp}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{glsdisp} but sets the \idx{linktext} to \code{\gls{glssentencecase}\margm{text}}. This is provided to allow a \idx{sentencecase} mapping in the event that \gls{glsdisp} occurs at the start of content that has automated case-changing} } % \glslink \gcmdspa{gls\-link}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} with the given \meta{text} as the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag} (use \gls{glsdisp} instead, if the \idx{firstuseflag} needs to be unset). This command is considered a \idx{glstextlike} command. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glslink \gcmdspa{Gls\-link}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{glslink} but sets the \idx{linktext} to \code{\gls{glssentencecase}\margm{text}}. This is provided to allow a \idx{sentencecase} mapping in the event that \gls{glslink} occurs at the start of content that has automated case-changing} } % \glstext \gcmdspa{gls\-text}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{text} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{glsxtrshort} for the short form or \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}}, as some abbreviation styles are too complicated to work with \gls{glstext}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glstext \gcmdspa{Gls\-text}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glstext} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{Glsxtrshort} or \code{\gls{Gls}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}} instead} } % \GLStext \gcmdspa{GLS\-text}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glstext} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{GLSxtrshort} or \code{\gls{GLS}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}} instead} } % \glsplural \gcmdspa{gls\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{plural} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{glsxtrshortpl} for the short form or \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}}, as some abbreviation styles are too complicated to work with \gls{glsplural}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsplural \gcmdspa{Gls\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsplural} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{Glsxtrshortpl} or \code{\gls{Glspl}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}} instead} } % \GLSplural \gcmdspa{GLS\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsplural} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{GLSxtrshortpl} or \code{\gls{GLSpl}\oarg{\glsopt{preunset}}} instead} } % \glsfirst \gcmdspa{gls\-first}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{first} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{glsxtrfull} for the full form or \gls{glsxtrlong} for the long form or use \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}}, as some abbreviation styles are too complicated to work with \gls{glsfirst}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsfirst \gcmdspa{Gls\-first}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfirst} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{Glsxtrfull} or \code{\gls{Gls}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}} instead} } % \GLSfirst \gcmdspa{GLS\-first}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfirst} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{GLSxtrfull} or \code{\gls{GLS}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}} instead} } % \glsfirstplural \gcmdspa{gls\-first\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{firstplural} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{glsxtrfullpl} for the full form or \gls{glsxtrlongpl} for the long form or use \code{\gls{glspl}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}}, as some abbreviation styles are too complicated to work with \gls{glsfirstplural}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsfirstplural \gcmdspa{Gls\-first\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfirstplural} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{Glsxtrfullpl} or \code{\gls{Glspl}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}} instead} } % \GLSfirstplural \gcmdspa{GLS\-first\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfirstplural} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}. If you have defined the entry with \gls{newabbreviation} use \gls{GLSxtrfullpl} or \code{\gls{GLSpl}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}} instead} } % \glsxtrshort \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-short}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{short} value, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrshort \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-short}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshort} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrshort \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-short}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshort} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-shortpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{shortplural} value, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-shortpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshortpl} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-shortpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshort} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrlong \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-long}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{long} value, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrlong \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-long}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlong} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrlong \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-long}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlong} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{longplural} value, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlongpl} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlongpl} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrfull \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-full}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{short} and \gloskey{long} values, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. The format produced by this command may not match the format produced by the \idx{firstuse} of \code{\gls{gls}\margm{entry-label}}, depending on the abbreviation style. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrfull \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-full}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfull} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrfull \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-full}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfull} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrfullpl \gcmdspa{gls\-xtr\-fullpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{shortplural} and \gloskey{longplural} values, formatted according to the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the entry's \idx{category}. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. The format produced by this command may not match the format produced by the \idx{firstuse} of \code{\gls{glspl}\margm{entry-label}}, depending on the abbreviation style. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsxtrfullpl \gcmdspa{Gls\-xtr\-fullpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfullpl} but converts the first character of the \idx{linktext} to \idx{uppercase}\glsadd{idx.sentencecase} (for the start of a sentence) using \gls{makefirstuc}} } % \GLSxtrfullpl \gcmdspa{GLS\-xtr\-fullpl}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfullpl} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsname \gcmdspa{gls\-name}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{name} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}. Use \gls{glossentryname} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \Glsname \gcmdspa{Gls\-name}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsname} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}. Use \gls{Glossentryname} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \GLSname \gcmdspa{GLS\-name}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsname} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}. This command is incompatible with some abbreviation styles} } % \glsdesc \gcmdspa{gls\-desc}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{description} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}. Use \gls{glossentrydesc} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \Glsdesc \gcmdspa{Gls\-desc}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsdesc} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}. Use \gls{Glossentrydesc} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \GLSdesc \gcmdspa{GLS\-desc}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsdesc} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsdescplural \gcmdspa{gls\-desc\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsdesc} but for the \gloskey{descriptionplural} field} } % \glssymbol \gcmdspa{gls\-symbol}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{symbol} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}. Use \gls{glossentrysymbol} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \Glssymbol \gcmdspa{Gls\-symbol}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glssymbol} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}. Use \gls{Glossentrysymbol} within custom glossary styles instead of this command} } % \GLSsymbol \gcmdspa{GLS\-symbol}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glssymbol} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glssymbolplural \gcmdspa{gls\-symbol\-plural}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glssymbol} but for the \gloskey{symbolplural} field} } % \glsuseri \gcmdspa{gls\-useri}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user1} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuseri \gcmdspa{Gls\-useri}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseri} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuseri \gcmdspa{GLS\-useri}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseri} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsuserii \gcmdspa{gls\-userii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user2} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuserii \gcmdspa{Gls\-userii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuserii} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuserii \gcmdspa{GLS\-userii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuserii} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsuseriii \gcmdspa{gls\-useriii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user3} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuseriii \gcmdspa{Gls\-useriii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseriii} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuseriii \gcmdspa{GLS\-useriii}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseriii} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsuseriv \gcmdspa{gls\-useriv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user4} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuseriv \gcmdspa{Gls\-useriv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseriv} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuseriv \gcmdspa{GLS\-useriv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuseriv} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsuserv \gcmdspa{gls\-userv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user5} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuserv \gcmdspa{Gls\-userv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuserv} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuserv \gcmdspa{GLS\-userv}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuserv} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsuservi \gcmdspa{gls\-uservi}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. The text produced is obtained from the \gloskey{user6} value. The \meta{insert} argument will be inserted at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This command does not alter or depend on the \idx{firstuseflag}. For the first optional argument, see \idxpl{glsopt}} } % \Glsuservi \gcmdspa{Gls\-uservi}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuservi} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GLSuservi \gcmdspa{GLS\-uservi}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsuservi} but converts the \idx{linktext} to \idx{allcaps}} } % \glshyperlink \gcmd{gls\-hyper\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \syntax{\oargm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{creates a hyperlink to the given entry with the hyperlink text provided in the optional argument. If omitted, the default is \code{\gls{glsentrytext}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \acrshort \gcmdspa{acr\-short}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the short form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \acrshortpl \gcmdspa{acr\-shortpl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the plural short form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \Acrshort \gcmdspa{Acr\-short}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrshort} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Acrshortpl \gcmdspa{Acr\-shortpl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrshort} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \acrlong \gcmdspa{acr\-long}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the long form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \acrlongpl \gcmdspa{acr\-longpl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the plural long form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \Acrlong \gcmdspa{Acr\-long}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrlong} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Acrlongpl \gcmdspa{Acr\-longpl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrlong} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \acrfull \gcmdspa{acr\-full}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the full form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \acrfullpl \gcmdspa{acr\-fullpl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{displays the plural full form of an acronym. Only for use with the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. This command is not compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}} } % \Acrfull \gcmdspa{Acr\-full}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrfull} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Acrfullpl \gcmdspa{Acr\-full\-pl}{% \banned \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{acrfullpl} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \ac \gcmdspa{ac}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cgls} or \gls{gls} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Ac \gcmdspa{Ac}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGls} or \gls{Gls} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \AC \gcmdspa{AC}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGLS} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \acp \gcmdspa{acp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cglspl} or \gls{glspl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Acp \gcmdspa{Acp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGlspl} or \gls{glspl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACP \gcmdspa{ACP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGLSpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \acs \gcmdspa{acs}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrshort} or \gls{acrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Acs \gcmdspa{Acs}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrshort} or \gls{Acrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } \gcmdspa{ACS}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \acsp \gcmdspa{acsp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrshortpl} or \gls{acrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Acsp \gcmdspa{Acsp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrshortpl} or \gls{Acrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACSP \gcmdspa{ACSP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \acl \gcmdspa{acl}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrlong} or \gls{acrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \aclp \gcmdspa{aclp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrlongpl} or \gls{acrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Acl \gcmdspa{Acl}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrlong} or \gls{Acrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACL \gcmdspa{ACL}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \Aclp \gcmdspa{Aclp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrlongpl} or \gls{Acrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACLP \gcmdspa{ACLP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \acf \gcmdspa{acf}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrfull} or \gls{acrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \acfp \gcmdspa{acfp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrfullpl} or \gls{acrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \Acf \gcmdspa{Acf}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrfull} or \gls{Acrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACF \gcmdspa{ACF}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \Acfp \gcmdspa{Acfp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrfullpl} or \gls{Acrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} package option, respectively} } % \ACFP \gcmdspa{ACFP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option} } % \ab \gcmdspa{ab}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cgls} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Ab \gcmdspa{Ab}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGls} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \AB \gcmdspa{AB}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGLS} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \abp \gcmdspa{abp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cglspl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Abp \gcmdspa{Abp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGlspl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \ABP \gcmdspa{ABP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{cGLSpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \as \gcmdspa{as}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \As \gcmdspa{As}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \AS \gcmdspa{AS}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrshort} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \asp \gcmdspa{asp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Asp \gcmdspa{Asp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \ASP \gcmdspa{ASP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrshortpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \al \gcmdspa{al}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Al \gcmdspa{Al}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \AL \gcmdspa{AL}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrlong} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \alp \gcmdspa{alp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Alp \gcmdspa{Alp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \ALP \gcmdspa{ALP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrlongpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \af \gcmdspa{af}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Af \gcmdspa{Af}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \AF \gcmdspa{AF}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrfull} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \afp \gcmdspa{afp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{glsxtrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \Afp \gcmdspa{Afp}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{Glsxtrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \AFP \gcmdspa{AFP}% {% \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{inset}} \desc{a synonym for \gls{GLSxtrfullpl} defined by the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option} } % \glsentrytype \gcmd{gls\-entry\-type} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{type} key. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \glsentryname \gcmd{gls\-entry\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{name} key. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{name} key doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryname \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{name} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryparent \gcmd{gls\-entry\-parent} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the value of the \gloskey{parent} \idx{field}. Expands to nothing if the \gloskey{parent} \idx{field} hasn't been set and expands to \gls{relax} if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \glsentrytext \gcmd{gls\-entry\-text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{text} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{text} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentrytext \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{text} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryplural \gcmd{gls\-entry\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{plural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryplural \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryfirst \gcmd{gls\-entry\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{first} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{first} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryfirst \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{first} \idx{field} with the first letter converted to \idx{uppercase}. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryfirstplural \gcmd{gls\-entry\-first\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryfirstplural \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-first\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentrydesc \gcmd{gls\-entry\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{description} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{description} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentrydesc \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{description} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentrydescplural \gcmd{gls\-entry\-desc\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{descriptionplural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{descriptionplural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \glsentryshort \gcmd{gls\-entry\-short} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{short} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{short} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \glsentryshortpl \gcmd{gls\-entry\-short\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{shortplural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{shortplural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \glsentrylong \gcmd{gls\-entry\-long} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{long} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{long} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \glsentrylongpl \gcmd{gls\-entry\-long\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{longplural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{longplural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryshort \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-short} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the value of the \gloskey{short} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \Glsentrylong \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-long} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the value of the \gloskey{long} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \Glsentryshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-short\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the value of the \gloskey{shortplural} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \Glsentrylong \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-long\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the value of the \gloskey{longplural} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentrysymbol \gcmd{gls\-entry\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{symbol} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{symbol} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentrysymbol \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{symbol} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentrysymbolplural \gcmd{gls\-entry\-symbol\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{symbolplural} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{symbolplural} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \glsentryuseri \gcmd{gls\-entry\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user1} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user1} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuseri \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user1} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryuserii \gcmd{gls\-entry\-user\-ii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user2} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user2} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuserii \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-user\-ii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user2} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryuseriii \gcmd{gls\-entry\-user\-iii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user3} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user3} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuseriii \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-user\-iii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user3} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryuseriv \gcmd{gls\-entry\-user\-iv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user4} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user4} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuseriv \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-user\-iv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user4} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryuserv \gcmd{gls\-entry\-user\-v} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user5} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user5} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuserv \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-user\-v} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user5} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsentryuservi \gcmd{gls\-entry\-user\-vi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{simply expands to the value of the \gloskey{user6} \idx{field}. Does nothing if the entry hasn't been defined. May be used in expandable contexts provided that the \gloskey{user6} \idx{field} doesn't contain any fragile commands} } % \Glsentryuservi \gcmd{Gls\-entry\-user\-vi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v2.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{partially robust command that displays the value of the \gloskey{user6} \idx{field} with \idx{sentencecase} applied. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, this command can expand in PDF bookmarks. Outside of PDF bookmarks it will expand to a robust internal command} } % \glsxtrhiername \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-hier\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the entry's hierarchical name} } % \Glsxtrhiername \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-hier\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the entry's hierarchical name using \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GlsXtrhiername \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-hier\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the entry's hierarchical name where each element name has its first character converted to \idx{uppercase}} } % \GLSxtrhiername \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-hier\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the entry's hierarchical name where the first name is converted to \idx{uppercase}} } % \GLSXTRhiername \gcmd{GLS\-XTR\-hier\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{displays the entry's hierarchical name where each name is converted to \idx{uppercase}} } % \glsxtrhiernamesep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-hier\-name\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \desc{separator used by commands like \gls{glsxtrhiername}} } % \GlsXtrForeignText \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Foreign\-Text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.32+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the field identified by \gls{GlsXtrForeignTextField} then \meta{text} will be encapsulated according to the language tag stored in that field (using \sty{tracklang}['s] interface)} } % \GlsXtrForeignTextField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Foreign\-Text\-Field} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.32+} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used by \gls{GlsXtrForeignText}} } % \glsxtrfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{behaves like \code{\gls{glslink}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\cmd{\meta{csname}}\margm{text}\meta{insert}}} where the control sequence name \meta{csname} is obtained from the field given by \gls{GlsXtrFmtField}. The actual format of the \idx{linktext} is governed by \gls{glsxtrfmtdisplay}} } % \glsxtrfmt* \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fmt*}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.23+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as the unstarred version \gls{glsxtrfmt} but accepts the final \meta{insert} option} } % \Glsxtrfmt \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfmt} but applies a \idx{sentencecase} change to \meta{text}} } % \Glsxtrfmt* \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-fmt*}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrfmt*} but applies a \idx{sentencecase} change to \meta{text}} } % \glsxtrfmtdisplay \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fmt\-display}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.23+} \syntax{\margm{csname}\margm{text}\margm{insert}} \desc{formats the \idx{linktext} used in \gls{glsxtrfmt}} } % \GlsXtrFmtDefaultOptions \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Fmt\-Default\-Options} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \initval{noindex} \desc{expands to the default options for \gls{glsxtrfmt}} } % \GlsXtrFmtField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Fmt\-Field}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \initval{useri} \desc{expands to the name of the \idxc{internalfieldlabel} used by \gls{glsxtrfmt}} } % \glsxtrentryfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-entry\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{does \code{\cmd{\meta{csname}}\margm{text}} where the control sequence name \meta{csname} is obtained from the field given by \gls{GlsXtrFmtField}. If \sty{hyperref} has been loaded and this command will expand to \gls{glsxtrpdfentryfmt}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text} in a PDF bookmark} } % \Glsxtrentryfmt \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-entry\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrentryfmt} but converts \meta{text} to \idx{sentencecase}} } % \glsxtrpdfentryfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-pdf\-entry\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{just does \meta{text}} } % \Glsxtrpdfentryfmt \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-pdf\-entry\-fmt}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{does \code{\gls{MFUsentencecase}\margm{text}}} } % \setupglslink \gcmd{setup\-gls\-link}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{set the default \idxpl{glsopt}} \field{seealso}{setupglsadd} } % \setupglsadd \gcmd{setup\-gls\-add}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{set the default options for \gls{glsadd}} \field{seealso}{setupglslink} } % all \gls... options \gidx{glsopt}{\name{{}\csfmt{gls}-like and {}\csfmt{glstext}-like options}% \common \field{text}{\csfmt{glslink} option}% \desc{most (but not all) of these options can be used in the optional argument of all the \idx{glslike}, \idx{glstextlike} and \gls{glsadd} commands} } % format \gglsopt{format}% {% \common \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{the control sequence name (without the leading backslash) that should be used to \idxc{locationencap}{encapsulate} the \idx{entrylocation}}% }% % counter \gglsopt{counter}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\meta{counter-name}} \desc{the \idx{locationcounter}}% }% % local \gglsopt{local}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.04+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{if true use \gls{glslocalunset} to unset the \idx{firstuseflag}, otherwise use \gls{glsunset} (only applies to \idx{glslike} commands)}% }% % postunset \gglsopt{post\-unset}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{global} \defval{global} \desc{determines whether or not to unset the \idx{firstuseflag} after the \idx{linktext}. The value may be one of: \code{global}, \code{local} or \code{none} (only applies to \idx{glslike} commands)}% }% % prefix \gglsopt{prefix}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\meta{link-prefix}} \desc{the prefix to use for the entry's hyperlink target}% }% % textformat \gglsopt{text\-format}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \syntax{\meta{csname}} \desc{the name of the control sequence to use instead of \gls{glstextformat} to encapsulate the \idx{linktext}}% }% % innertextformat \gglsopt{inner\-text\-format}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\meta{csname}} \initval{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}% \desc{the name of the control sequence to use for the \idx{innerformatting}}% }% % hyperoutside \gglsopt{hyper\-outside}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \initval{true} \defval{true} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{determines whether the hyperlink should be inside or outside of \gls{glstextformat}}% }% % wrgloss \gglsopt{wr\-gloss}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \initval{before} \syntax{\meta{position}} \desc{determines whether to do the \idx{indexing} before or after the \idx{linktext}. Allowed values: \optfmt{before} and \optfmt{after}}% }% % noindex \gglsopt{no\-index}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if \optfmt{true} this option will suppress \idx{indexing}. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you may want to consider using \glsoptval{format}{glsignore} to prevent a \location\ but ensure that the entry is selected}% }% % hyper \gglsopt{hyper}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{determines whether or not the \idx{linktext} should have a hyperlink (provided hyperlinks are supported)}% }% % thevalue \gglsopt{the\-value}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.19+} \syntax{\meta{location}} \desc{set the \location\ to this value instead of obtaining it from the \idx{locationcounter}}% }% % theHvalue \gglsopt{the\-H\-value}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.19+} \syntax{\meta{the-H-value}} \desc{set the hyper \location\ to this value instead of obtaining it from \gls{theHcounter}}% }% % types \gglsopt{types}% { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{glossary list}} \desc{only available with \gls{glsaddall}, the value is the list of glossaries to iterate over} } % prereset \gglsopt{pre\-reset}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \initval{none} \defval{local} \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{determines whether or not to reset the entry before the \idx{linktext}. Allowed values: \optfmt{none} (no reset), \optfmt{local} (localise the reset) and \optfmt{global}}% }% % preunset \gglsopt{pre\-unset}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \initval{none} \defval{local} \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{determines whether or not to unset the entry before the \idx{linktext}. Allowed values: \optfmt{none} (no unset), \optfmt{local} (localise the unset) and \optfmt{global}}% }% % \glolinkprefix \gcmd{glo\-link\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{glo:} \desc{expands to the default prefix for the entry's hypertarget anchor in the glossary} } % \glstextformat \gcmd{gls\-text\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{the default outer text formatting command used by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glsrefentry \gcmd{gls\-ref\-entry} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{references (using \gls{ref}) the entry counter or sub-counter (if \opt{entrycounter} or \opt{subentrycounter} options are set) otherwise just does \gls{gls}\margm{entry-label}} } % \glsxtrpageref \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-page\-ref} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.11+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsrefentry} but uses \gls{pageref} instead of \gls{ref}. As with \gls{glsrefentry}, this will use \gls{gls} instead if the corresponding entry counter is disabled} } % \glsxtrpInit \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-p\-Init} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{cs-name}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook implemented at the start of \gls{glsxtrp} (and case-changing variants) inside the added scoping. By default this disables the \idx{postlinkhook} and ignores its arguments} } % \glsxtrp \gcmd{gls\-xtrp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{field}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use in headings and captions (instead of the \gls{glslike} or \gls{glstextlike} commands). This command is designed to expand to the field value if used in a PDF bookmark and can also expand to a more appropriate command if it ends up in the page header. Note that there's no optional argument. Options should be set beforehand using \gls{glsxtrsetpopts}, which is done automatically in the glossary with \gls{glossxtrsetpopts}} } % \Glsxtrp \gcmd{Gls\-xtrp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{field}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrp} but converts the first letter to uppercase (but not in the PDF bookmark)} } % \GLSxtrp \gcmd{GLS\-xtrp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{field}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrp} but converts to uppercase (but not in the PDF bookmark)} } % \glsps \gcmd{gls\-ps} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{glsxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \glspt \gcmd{gls\-pt} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{glsxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \Glsps \gcmd{Gls\-ps} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{Glsxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \Glspt \gcmd{Gls\-pt} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{Glsxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \GLSps \gcmd{GLS\-ps} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{GLSxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \GLSpt \gcmd{GLS\-pt} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{GLSxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \glsxtrsetpopts \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-p\-opts} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{sets the options that \gls{glsxtrp} (and case-change variants) pass to the relevant \gls{glstextlike} command} } % \glossxtrsetpopts \gcmd{gloss\-xtr\-set\-p\-opts} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \desc{used at the start of each glossary to set the current options for the \gls{glsxtrp} set of commands (with \gls{glsxtrsetpopts})} } % \glsxtridentifyglslike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-identify\-gls\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}\margm{cs}} \desc{used to inform \app{bib2gls} to include the given command when it searches for dependencies} } % \glsxtraddlabelprefix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-add\-label\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}} \desc{appends \meta{label-prefix} to the list of known labels} } % \glsxtrprependlabelprefix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-prepend\-label\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}} \desc{prepends \meta{label-prefix} to the list of known labels} } % \glsxtrclearlabelprefixes \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-clear\-label\-prefixes} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \desc{clears the list of known prefixes} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \glsxtrifinlabelprefixlist \gcmd{glsxtrifinlabelprefixlist} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if \meta{label-prefix} has been identified as a label prefix} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \ifGlsXtrPrefixLabelFallbackLast \gcond{if\-Gls\-Xtr\-Prefix\-Label\-Fallback\-Last} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \initvalcs{iftrue} \desc{conditional that determines whether or not to use the last label prefix as the default} } % \GlsXtrPrefixLabelFallbackLasttrue \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Prefix\-Label\-Fallback\-Last\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{sets the \gls{ifGlsXtrPrefixLabelFallbackLast} conditional to true} } % \GlsXtrPrefixLabelFallbackLastfalse \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Prefix\-Label\-Fallback\-Last\-false} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{sets the \gls{ifGlsXtrPrefixLabelFallbackLast} conditional to false} } % \dgls \gcmdspa{dgls}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{does \code{\gls{gls}\oargm{options}\marg{\meta{prefix}\marg{entry-label}}\oargm{insert}} for the first prefix in the prefix list that matches a defined entry} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGls \gcmdspa{dGls}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{Gls}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGLS \gcmdspa{dGLS}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{GLS}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dglspl \gcmdspa{dgls\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{glspl}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGlspl \gcmdspa{dGls\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{Glspl}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGLSpl \gcmdspa{dGLS\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{GLSpl}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dglslink \gcmdspa{dgls\-link}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{glslink}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGlslink \gcmdspa{dGls\-link}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dglslink} but applies \idx{sentencecase}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dglsdisp \gcmdspa{dgls\-disp}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but uses \gls{glsdisp}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGlsdisp \gcmdspa{dGls\-disp}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dglsdisp} but applies \idx{sentencecase}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dglsfield \gcmdspa{dgls\-field}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dgls} but selects the first matching label that has an entry with the field set} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGlsfield \gcmdspa{dGls\-field}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dglsfield} but applies \idx{sentencecase}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dGLSfield \gcmdspa{dGLS\-field}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field-label}\margm{text}} \desc{as \gls{dglsfield} but \idx{allcaps}} \field{seealso}{glsxtraddlabelprefix,glsxtrprependlabelprefix} } % \dglsfieldcurrentfieldlabel \gcmd{dgls\-field\-current\-field\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{set by the \gls{dglsfield} family of commands to the given \meta{field-label}} } % \dglsfieldfallbackfieldlabel \gcmd{dgls\-field\-fallback\-field\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \initvalopt{gloskey}{text} \desc{expands to the fallback field to use for the \gls{dglsfield} family of commands} } % \dglsfieldactualfieldlabel \gcmd{dgls\-field\-actual\-field\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{set by the \gls{dglsfield} family of commands to the actual field used. This will either be the requested field or the fallback field} } % \newdglsfield \gcmd{new\-d\-gls\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{field}\margm{cs}} \desc{defines the command \meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label} to behave like \code{\gls{dglsfield}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\margm{entry-label}\margm{field}}} } % \newdglsfieldlike \gcmd{new\-d\-gls\-field\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{field}\margm{cs}\margm{Cs}\margm{CS}} \desc{similar to \gls{newdglsfield} but also defines \idx{sentencecase} (\meta{Cs}) and \idx{allcaps} (\meta{CS}) commands with mappings} } % \glsxtrnewgls \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-gls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{cs}} \desc{defines the command \meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label} to behave like \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{entry-label}}}} } % \glsxtrnewglslike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-gls\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{\gls{gls}-like cs}\margm{\gls{glspl}-like cs}\margm{\gls{Gls}-like cs}\margm{\gls{Glspl}-like cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrnewgls} but provides plural and \idx{sentencecase} commands as well} } % \glsxtrnewGLSlike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-GLS\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{\gls{GLS}-like cs}\margm{\gls{GLSpl}-like cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrnewgls} but provides \idx+{allcaps} commands} } % \glsxtrnewrgls \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-rgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrnewgls} but uses \gls{rgls}} } % \glsxtrnewrglslike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-rgls\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{\gls{rgls}-like cs}\margm{\gls{rglspl}-like cs}\margm{\gls{rGls}-like cs}\margm{\gls{rGlspl}-like cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrnewrgls} but provides plural and \idx{sentencecase} commands as well} } % \glsxtrnewrGLSlike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-rGLS\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{\gls{rGLS}-like cs}\margm{\gls{rGLSpl}-like cs}} \desc{like \gls{glsxtrnewrgls} but provides \idx+{allcaps} commands} } % \glsxtrnewglslink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-gls\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{cs}} \desc{defines the command \code{\meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{label}\margm{text}} to behave like \code{\gls{glslink}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{label}}\margm{text}}} } % \glsxtrnewglsdisp \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-new\-gls\-disp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{default-options}\margm{prefix}\margm{cs}} \desc{defines the command \code{\meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{label}\margm{text}} to behave like \code{\gls{glsdisp}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{label}}\margm{text}}} } % \GlsXtrRecordCounter \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Record\-Counter} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{counter-name}} \desc{activates recording for the given counter} \note{preamble only} } % \glsxtr@counterrecord \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-@\-counter\-record} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}\margm{value}} \desc{an \ext{aux} file command used with \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter} to append \meta{value} to the \glosfield{record.counter} field. Also implements \gls{glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook}} } % \glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Add\-Counter\-Record\-Hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}\margm{value}} \desc{user-level hook used by \gls{glsxtr@counterrecord}. If this command is redefined, it must be done so in the preamble before the \ext{aux} file is input} } % \glsxtrsupphypernumber \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-supp\-hyper\-number} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \syntax{\margm{location}} \desc{used to hyperlink to a location in an external document if the \catattr{externallocation} attribute has been set. This will define \gls{glsxtrsupplocationurl} to the location provided by the attribute or to empty if the attribute isn't set} } % \glsxtrsupplocationurl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-supp\-lo\-ca\-tion\-url} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \desc{defined by \gls{glsxtrsupphypernumber} to the external location or empty if not provided} } % COMMANDS: ENTRY COUNTING % \ifglsresetcurrcount \gcond{if\-gls\-re\-set\-curr\-count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{conditional that determines whether or not to reset the entry counter to 0 when the \idx{firstuseflag} is reset} } % \glsresetcurrcounttrue \gcmd{gls\-re\-set\-curr\-count\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{sets \gls{ifglsresetcurrcount} to true} } % \glsresetcurrcountfalse \gcmd{gls\-re\-set\-curr\-count\-false} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{sets \gls{ifglsresetcurrcount} to false} } % \glsenableentrycount \gcmd{gls\-enable\-entry\-count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \desc{enables entry counting} } % \glsenableentryunitcount \gcmd{gls\-enable\-entry\-unit\-count} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \desc{enables entry unit counting} } % \glsentrycurrcount \gcmd{gls\-entry\-curr\-count} { \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \desc{expands to the current entry count running total or 0 if not available (needs to be enabled with \gls{glsenableentrycount} or \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}). With unit entry counting, this expands to the total for the current unit} } % \glsentryprevcount \gcmd{gls\-entry\-prev\-count} { \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \desc{expands to the final entry count total from the previous \LaTeX\ run or if 0 if not available (needs to be enabled with \gls{glsenableentrycount} or \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}). With unit entry counting, this expands to the total for the current unit} } % \glsentryprevtotalcount \gcmd{gls\-entry\-prev\-total\-count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the final entry count total from the previous \LaTeX\ run or if 0 if not available (needs to be enabled with \gls{glsenableentryunitcount})} } % \glsentryprevmaxcount \gcmd{gls\-entry\-prev\-max\-count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the maximum entry unit count total from the previous \LaTeX\ run or if 0 if not available (needs to be enabled with \gls{glsenableentryunitcount})} } % \cgls \gcmdspa{cgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{gls} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cglsformat} } % \cglspl \gcmdspa{cglspl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{glspl} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cglsplformat} } % \cGls \gcmdspa{cGls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{Gls} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cGlsformat} } % \cGlspl \gcmdspa{cGlspl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{Glspl} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cGlsplformat} } % \cglsformat \gcmd{cgls\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cgls} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \cglsplformat \gcmd{cgls\-pl\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cglspl} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \cGlsformat \gcmd{cGls\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cGls} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \cGlsplformat \gcmd{cGls\-pl\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.14+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cGlspl} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \cGLS \gcmdspa{cGLS} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{GLS} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cGLSformat} } % \cGLSpl \gcmdspa{cGLSpl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{GLSpl} but hooks into the entry counting mechanism} \field{seealso}{glsenableentrycount,cGLSplformat} } % \cGLSformat \gcmd{cGLS\-format} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cGLS} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \cGLSplformat \gcmd{cGLS\-pl\-format} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{cGLSpl} if the entry was not used more than the given trigger value on the previous run} } % \glsxtrifcounttrigger \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-count\-trigger} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's total use count at the end of the previous run exceeds the trigger value assigned to the entry's category, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-Entry\-Count\-ing} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{category-list}\margm{trigger-value}} \desc{enables entry counting for the given list of categories with the given trigger value (which must be an integer)} } % \GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-Entry\-Unit\-Count\-ing} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{category-list}\margm{trigger-value}\margm{counter}} \desc{enables unit entry counting for the given list of categories with the given trigger value (which must be an integer) and the associated counter} } % \GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-Start\-Unset\-Buffering} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \desc{enables unset buffering. The starred version doesn't check for duplicates} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering,GlsXtrDiscardUnsetBuffering} } % \GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-Stop\-Unset\-Buffering} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \desc{stops buffering. The starred version performs a global unset} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering,GlsXtrDiscardUnsetBuffering,GlsXtrForUnsetBufferedList} } % \GlsXtrDiscardUnsetBuffering \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Discard\-Unset\-Buffering} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \desc{discards the pending buffer and restores \gls{glsunset}} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering,GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering} } % \GlsXtrForUnsetBufferedList \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-For\-Unset\-Buffered\-List} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{handler-cs}} \desc{iterates over the labels stored in the current buffer} } % \GlsXtrClearUnsetBuffer \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Clear\-Unset\-Buffer} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{locally clears the buffer, but doesn't stop buffering} } % \GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Unset\-Buffer\-Enable\-Repeat\-Local} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{allows repeat entries within the buffering code to be locally unset before the \idx{linktext}} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer} } % \GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Reset\-Local\-Buffer} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{if local unset for repeat entries has been enabled with \gls{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal}, this will locally reset all entries that are in the buffer that hadn't been marked as used before the function was enabled} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal} } % \GlsXtrUnsetBufferDisableRepeatLocal \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Un\-set\-Buffer\-Disable\-Repeat\-Local} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{disables GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal} } % \glsxtrpostlocalunset \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-local\-unset} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook performed by \gls{glslocalunset}. This hook is modified by \gls{glsenableentrycount} and \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}} } % \glsxtrpostunset \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-unset} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook performed by \gls{glsunset}. This hook is modified by \gls{glsenableentrycount} and \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}} } % \glsxtrpostlocalreset \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-local\-reset} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook performed by \gls{glslocalreset}. This hook is modified by \gls{glsenableentrycount} and \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}} } % \glsxtrpostreset \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-reset} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook performed by \gls{glsreset}. This hook is modified by \gls{glsenableentrycount} and \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}} } % \GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-Link\-Count\-ing} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\oargm{parent counter}\margm{categories}} \desc{enables link counting for the given categories} \note{preamble only} } % \glsxtrinclinkcounter \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-inc\-link\-counter} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\margm{counter}} \desc{increments the link counter with \gls{stepcounter}} } % \GlsXtrLinkCounterValue \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Link\-Counter\-Value} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the internal link count register associated with the given register or 0 if it hasn't been defined} } % \GlsXtrTheLinkCounter \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-The\-Link\-Counter} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the value of the link counter associated with the given entry or 0 if it hasn't been defined} } % \GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Link\-Counter\-Def} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{expands to \meta{true} if the link counter associated with the given entry has been defined, otherwise expands to \meta{false}} } % \GlsXtrLinkCounterName \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Link\-Counter\-Name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the name of the link counter associated with the given entry (no check for existence)} } % COMMANDS: MULTI-ENTRY % \multiglossaryentry \gcmd{multi\-glossary\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{main-label}\margm{entry-label-list}} \desc{defines a multi-entry set with the label \meta{multi-label}, consisting of the entries whose labels are listed in \meta{entry-label-list}, where the main entry (which must be present in \meta{entry-label-list}) is identified by \meta{main-label} (or the final element in \meta{entry-label-list}, if \meta{main-label} is omitted)} } % \providemultiglossaryentry \gcmd{provide\-multi\-glossary\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{main-label}\margm{entry-label-list}} \desc{as \gls{multiglossaryentry} but does nothing if a multi-entry set has already been defined with the given label} } % \ifmultiglossaryentryglobal \gcond{if\-multi\-glossary\-entry\-global} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{if true, subsequent multi-entry definitions will be global} } % \multiglossaryentryglobaltrue \gcmd{multi\-glossary\-entry\-global\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{sets \gls{ifmultiglossaryentryglobal} to true} } % \multiglossaryentryglobalfalse \gcmd{multi\-glossary\-entry\-global\-false} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{sets \gls{ifmultiglossaryentryglobal} to false} } % \mglsSetOptions \gcmd{mgls\-Set\-Options} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{new-options}} \desc{locally sets the options associated with the given multi-entry} } % \mglsAddOptions \gcmd{mgls\-Add\-Options} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{new-options}} \desc{locally appends to the options associated with the given multi-entry} } % \GlsXtrMglsOrGls \gcmd{GlsXtrMglsOrGls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{mgls cs}\margm{gls cs}\meta{modifier}\oargm{options}\margm{label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{if \meta{label} matches a defined multi-entry, this will do \meta{mgls cls} otherwise it will do \meta{gls cs}. The \meta{modifier} (\code{*} or \code{+} or the token identified with \gls{GlsXtrSetAltModifier}) may be omitted} } % \multiglossaryentrysetup \gcmd{multi\-glossary\-entry\-set\-up} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{specifies a general set of options to apply to all multi-entries} } % \mglsdefcategoryprefix \gcmd{mgls\-def\-category\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}\margm{definition}} \desc{defines the prefix for the given multi-entry category} } % \mglshascategoryprefix \gcmd{mgls\-has\-category\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given multi-entry category has a prefix set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \mglsusecategoryprefix \gcmd{mgls\-use\-category\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}} \desc{expands to the prefix assigned to the given multi-entry category or does nothing if no prefix assigned} } % \mglsdefcategorysuffix \gcmd{mgls\-def\-category\-suffix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}\margm{definition}} \desc{defines the suffix for the given multi-entry category} } % \mglsprefix \gcmd{mgls\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{code used to typeset the multi-entry prefix} } % \mglshascategorysuffix \gcmd{mgls\-has\-category\-suffix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given multi-entry category has a suffix set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \mglsusecategorysuffix \gcmd{mgls\-use\-category\-suffix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category-label}} \desc{expands to the suffix assigned to the given multi-entry category or does nothing if no suffix assigned} } % \mglssuffix \gcmd{mgls\-suffix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{code used to typeset the multi-entry suffix} } % \glscombinedsep \gcmd{gls\-combined\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{prev label}\margm{next label}} \desc{separator used between elements of a multi-entry set where both elements have been marked as used} } % \glscombinedfirstsep \gcmd{gls\-combined\-first\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{prev label}\margm{next label}} \desc{separator used between elements of a multi-entry set where only the next element have been marked as used} } % \glscombinedsepfirst \gcmd{gls\-combined\-sep\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{prev label}\margm{next label}} \desc{separator used between elements of a multi-entry set where only the previous element have been marked as used} } % \glscombinedfirstsepfirst \gcmd{gls\-combined\-first\-sep\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{prev label}\margm{next label}} \desc{separator used between elements of a multi-entry set where neither the previous nor the next element has been marked as used} } % \glssetcombinedsepabbrvnbsp \gcmd{gls\-set\-combined\-sep\-abbrv\-nbsp} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{defines the multi-entry separators to use a \idx{nbsp} for abbreviations} } % \glssetcombinedsepabbrvnone \gcmd{gls\-set\-combined\-sep\-abbrv\-none} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{defines the multi-entry separators to use no separator for abbreviations} } % \glssetcombinedsepnarrow \gcmd{gls\-set\-combined\-sep\-narrow} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{width}\margm{narrow-sep}} \desc{defines the multi-entry separators to use \meta{narrow-sep} if the width of associated field values is less than \meta{width}} } % \mglselementprehook \gcmd{mgls\-element\-pre\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{hook performed before each (non-skipped) element in a multi-entry set} } % \mglselementposthook \gcmd{mgls\-element\-post\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{hook performed after each (non-skipped) element in a multi-entry set} } % \mglscurrentmultilabel \gcmd{mgls\-current\-multi\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the multi-entry label} } % \mglscurrentmainlabel \gcmd{mgls\-current\-main\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the label of the main element} } % \mglscurrentlist \gcmd{mgls\-current\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the complete comma-separated list of elements} } % \mglscurrentoptions \gcmd{mgls\-current\-options} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the options used when the multi-entry was defined} } % \mglscurrentcategory \gcmd{mgls\-current\-category} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the multi-entry category current in effect} } % \glsxtrcurrentmglscsname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-current\-mgls\-cs\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the control sequence name of the calling command} } % \mglscurrentlabel \gcmd{mgls\-current\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the current element label} } % \mglselementindex \gcmd{mgls\-element\-index} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{a count register used in multi-entry hooks, this is set to the element index} } % \mglscurrentprefix \gcmd{mgls\-current\-prefix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the current prefix} } % \mglscurrentsuffix \gcmd{mgls\-current\-suffix} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{placeholder command for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to the current suffix} } % \mglsisfirstuse \gcmd{mgls\-is\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to \meta{true} if this is the first use otherwise expands to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflast \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry hooks, this expands to \meta{true} if this is the last iteration otherwise expands to \meta{false}} } % \mglslastmultilabel \gcmd{mgls\-last\-multi\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the multi-entry label} } % \mglslastcategory \gcmd{mgls\-last\-category} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the multi-entry category or nothing, if no category assigned} } % \mglswasfirstuse \gcmd{mgls\-was\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if this was the first use of the multi-entry, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglslastelementlabel \gcmd{mgls\-last\-element\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the label of the last non-skipped element} } % \mglsiflastelementskipped \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-element\-skipped} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the last element was skipped, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastelementwasfirstuse \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-element\-was\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the last element was used for the first time, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastelementwasplural \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-element\-was\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the last element had the plural form displayed, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastelementcapscase \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-element\-caps\-case} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{no-change}\margm{firstuc}\margm{all caps}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{no-change} if the last element had no case-change applied, to \meta{firstuc} if the last element had \idx+{sentencecase} applied or to \meta{all caps} if the last element had \idx+{allcaps} applied} } % \mglslastmainlabel \gcmd{mgls\-last\-main\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the label of the main element that was just referenced} } % \mglsiflastmainskipped \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-main\-skipped} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the main element from the multi-entry just referenced was skipped, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastmainwasfirstuse \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-main\-was\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the main element from the multi-entry just referenced was used for the first time, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastmainwasplural \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-main\-was\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{true} if the main element from the multi-entry just referenced had the plural form shown, otherwise to \meta{false}} } % \mglsiflastmaincapscase \gcmd{mgls\-if\-last\-main\-caps\-case} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{no-change}\margm{firstuc}\margm{all caps}} \desc{for use in multi-entry suffix and post-link hooks, this expands to the \meta{no-change} if the main element from the multi-entry just referenced had no case-change applied, to \meta{firstuc} if the last element had \idx+{sentencecase} applied or to \meta{all caps} if the last element had \idx+{allcaps} applied} } % \mglscustompostlinkhook \gcmd{mgls\-custom\-post\-link\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{hook used with the \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{custom} option} } % \mglslastelementpostlinkhook \gcmd{mgls\-last\-element\-post\-link\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{hook used with the \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{last} option} } % \mglslastmainpostlinkhook \gcmd{mgls\-last\-main\-post\-link\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{hook used with the \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main} option} } % \ifmglsused \gcmd{if\-mgls\-used} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given multi-entry has been marked as used, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \mglsunset \gcmd{mgls\-unset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{globally unsets the first use flag for the given multi-entry} } % \mglsreset \gcmd{mgls\-reset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{globally resets the first use flag for the given multi-entry} } % \mglslocalunset \gcmd{mgls\-local\-unset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{locally unsets the first use flag for the given multi-entry} } % \mglslocalreset \gcmd{mgls\-local\-reset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{locally resets the first use flag for the given multi-entry} } % \mglsunsetall \gcmd{mgls\-unset\-all} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{unsets the first use flag for all multi-entries} } % \mglsresetall \gcmd{mgls\-reset\-all} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{resets the first use flag for all multi-entries} } % \mglsSetMain \gcmd{mgls\-Set\-Main} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{new-main-label}} \desc{locally changes the main element for the given multi-entry} } % \mgls \gcmdspa{mgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{references a multi-entry identified by the given \meta{multi-label}} } % \mglspl \gcmdspa{mgls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses the plural form for each element} } % \mglsmainpl \gcmdspa{mgls\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses the plural form for the main element} } % \Mgls \gcmdspa{Mgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Gls} for the first element} } % \MGls \gcmdspa{MGls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Gls} for all elements} } % \Mglspl \gcmdspa{Mglspl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Glspl} for the first element and \gls{glspl} for the remaining elements} } % \Mglsmainpl \gcmdspa{Mglsmainpl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} uses \idx{sentencecase} for the first element and the plural form for the main element} } % \MGlspl \gcmdspa{MGls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Glspl} for each element} } % \MGlsmainpl \gcmdspa{MGls\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Glspl} for the main entry and \gls{Gls} for the others} } % \MGLS \gcmdspa{MGLS} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{GLS} for each element} } % \MGLSpl \gcmdspa{MGLS\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{GLSpl} for each element} } % \MGLSmainpl \gcmdspa{MGLS\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{GLSpl} for the main element and \gls{GLS} for the others} } % \mglsshort \gcmdspa{mgls\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glsxtrshort} for any elements that have the \gloskey{short} field set and \gls{glstext} otherwise} } % \mglslong \gcmdspa{mgls\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glsxtrlong} for any elements that have the \gloskey{long} field set and \gls{glstext} otherwise} } % \mglsfull \gcmdspa{mgls\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glsxtrfull} for any elements that have the \gloskey{short} field set and \gls{glsfirst} otherwise} } % \Mglsshort \gcmdspa{Mgls\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mglsshort} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Mglslong \gcmdspa{Mgls\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mglslong} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Mglsfull \gcmdspa{Mgls\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mglsfull} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \mglsname \gcmdspa{mgls\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glsname}} } % \MGlsname \gcmdspa{MGls\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Glsname}} } % \Mglsname \gcmdspa{Mgls\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{Glsname} for the first entry and \gls{glsname} for the remaining entries} } % \mglssymbol \gcmdspa{mgls\-symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glssymbol} if the \gloskey{symbol} field is set and \gls{gls} otherwise} } % \MGlssymbol \gcmdspa{MGls\-symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glssymbol} if the \gloskey{symbol} field is set and \gls{Gls} otherwise} } % \Mglssymbol \gcmdspa{Mgls\-symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glssymbol} if the \gloskey{symbol} field is set, otherwise it uses \gls{Gls} for the first element and \gls{gls} for the remaining elements} } % \mglsusefield \gcmdspa{mgls\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{glsdisp} if the field identified by \gls{mglsfield} exists with the \idx{linktext} obtained from the field value} } % \Mglsusefield \gcmdspa{Mgls\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mglsusefield} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first element} } % \MGlsusefield \gcmdspa{MGls\-use\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mglsusefield} but \idx{sentencecase} for each element} } % \mglsfield \gcmd{mgls\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \initval{useri} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} required by \gls{mglsusefield}} } % \mpgls \gcmdspa{mpgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{pgls} for the first element} } % \mpglspl \gcmdspa{mpgls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{pglspl} for the first element and \gls{glspl} for the remaining elements} } % \mpglsmainpl \gcmdspa{mpgls\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mgls} but uses \gls{pglspl} for the first element if its the main element otherwise \gls{pgls} and, for the remaining elements, uses \gls{glspl} if the element is the main entry or \gls{gls} otherwise} } % \Mpgls \gcmdspa{Mpgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpgls} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first element} } % \Mpglsmain \gcmdspa{Mpglsmainpl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpglspl} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first element} } % \MPGls \gcmdspa{MPGls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpgls} but \idx{sentencecase} for all elements} } % \MPGlspl \gcmdspa{MPGls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpglspl} but \idx{sentencecase} for all elements} } % \MPGlsmainpl \gcmdspa{MPGls\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpglsmainpl} but \idx{sentencecase} for all elements} } % \MPGLS \gcmdspa{MPGLS} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpgls} but \idx{allcaps} for the all elements} } % \MPGLSpl \gcmdspa{MPGLSpl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpglspl} but \idx{allcaps} for the all elements} } % \MPGLSmainpl \gcmdspa{MPGLS\-main\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{multi-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{mpglsmainpl} but \idx{allcaps} for the all elements} } % \mglsseefirstitem \gcmd{mgls\-see\-first\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{formatting command used by cross-reference lists for the first item if the item is a multi-entry} } % \mglsseeitem \gcmd{mgls\-see\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{formatting command used by cross-reference lists for subsequent items if the item is a multi-entry} } % \glsxtrifmulti \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-multi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if a multi-entry has been defined with the label \meta{multi-label} otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsxtrmultimain \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-main} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{expands to the main label for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label} or nothing if not defined} } % \glsxtrmultilist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{expands to the list of element labels for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label} or nothing if not defined} } % \mglsforelements \gcmd{mgls\-for\-elements} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates over the list of element labels for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label}} } % \mglsforotherelements \gcmd{mgls\-for\-other\-elements} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{as \gls{mglsforelements} but skips the main entry label} } % \glsxtrmultitotalelements \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-total\-elements} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{expands to the total number of elements in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined} } % \glsxtrmultimainindex \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-main\-index} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{expands to the index of the main element in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined} } % \glsxtrmultilastotherindex \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-last\-other\-index} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{expands to the index of the final non-main element in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined} } % \writemultiglossentry \gcmd{write\-multi\-gloss\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{multi-label}\margm{main-label}\margm{list}} \desc{writes multi-entry information to the \ext{aux} file} } % \@glsxtr@multientry \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-@multi\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{multi-label}\margm{main-label}\margm{list}} \desc{information in the \ext{aux} about a multi-label defined in the previous \LaTeX\ run} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustedname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjust\-ed\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{sublist1}\margm{name}\margm{sublist2}\margm{multi-label}} \desc{used by \resourceopt{compound-adjust-name}} } % \Glsxtrmultientryadjustedname \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjust\-ed\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{sublist1}\margm{name}\margm{sublist2}\margm{multi-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \GlsXtrmultientryadjustedname \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjust\-ed\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{sublist1}\margm{name}\margm{sublist2}\margm{multi-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} but \idx{titlecase}} } % \GLSxtrmultientryadjustedname \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjust\-ed\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{sublist1}\margm{name}\margm{sublist2}\margm{multi-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustednamesep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{pre-label}\margm{post-label}} \desc{separator used by \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname}} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustednamepresep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-pre\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{pre-label}\margm{post-label}} \desc{separator used by \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} between the last element of the first sublist and the main element} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustednamepostsep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-post\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{pre-label}\margm{post-label}} \desc{separator used by \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} between the main element and the first element of the second sublist} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the main entry name} } % \Glsxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{Glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the main entry name if the first sublist is empty} } % \GlsXtrmultientryadjustednamefmt \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{GlsXtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the main entry name} } % \GLSxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{GLSxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the main entry name} } % \glsxtrmultientryadjustednameother \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the other (not main) entries} } % \Glsxtrmultientryadjustednameother \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{Glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the other (not main) entries} } % \GlsXtrmultientryadjustednameother \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{GlsXtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the other (not main) entries} } % \GLSxtrmultientryadjustednameother \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-multi\-entry\-adjusted\-name\-other} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{GLSxtrmultientryadjustedname} to encapsulate the other (not main) entries} } % \mglselementreset \gcmd{mgls\-element\-reset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by options such as \mglsopt{resetall} to reset an element's \idx{firstuseflag} (taking the \mglsopt{presetlocal} option into account)} } % \mglselementunset \gcmd{mgls\-element\-unset} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by options such as \mglsopt{unsetall} to unset an element's \idx{firstuseflag} (taking the \mglsopt{presetlocal} option into account)} } % \mglsunsetothers \gcmd{mgls\-unset\-others} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{globally unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} for the other (not main) elements of the given multi-entry} } % \mglslocalunsetothers \gcmd{mgls\-local\-unset\-others} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{multi-label}} \desc{locally unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} for the other (not main) elements of the given multi-entry} } % MULTI-ENTRY OPTIONS: \gidx{mglsopt}{\name{multi-entry set options}} % option: indexmain \gmglsopt{index\-main} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{indicates if the main element should be \indexed, should only be \indexed\ on \idx{firstuse} or should not indexed} } % option: indexothers \gmglsopt{index\-others} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{indicates if the \qt{other} elements should be \indexed, should only be \indexed\ on \idx{firstuse} or should not indexed} } % option: encapmain \gmglsopt{encap\-main} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{glsnumberformat} \desc{the value to pass to the \glsopt{format} option for the main entry} } % option: encapothers \gmglsopt{encap\-others} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{glsnumberformat} \desc{the value to pass to the \glsopt{format} option for the \qt{other} elements} } % option: postlinks \gmglsopt{post\-links} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{none} \desc{indicates which \idxpl{postlinkhook} should be enabled} } % option: mpostlink \gmglsopt{mpost\-link} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not the multi-entry post-link hook should be enabled and, if so, whether it should only be enabled on \idxc{mfirstuse}{first} or \idxc{msubsequentuse}{subsequent} use} } % option: mpostlinkelement \gmglsopt{mpost\-link\-element} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{last} \desc{indicates which \idx{postlinkhook} to use if the multi-entry post-link hook has been enabled} } % option: firstprefix \gmglsopt{first\-prefix} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{the prefix to use on \idx{firstuse} of the multi-entry} } % option: usedprefix \gmglsopt{used\-prefix} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{the prefix to use on \idx{subsequentuse} of the multi-entry} } % option: firstsuffix \gmglsopt{first\-suffix} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{the suffix to use on \idx{mfirstuse} of the multi-entry} } % option: usedsuffix \gmglsopt{used\-suffix} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{the suffix to use on \idx{msubsequentuse} of the multi-entry} } % option: firstskipmain \gmglsopt{first\-skip\-main} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to skip the main entry on \idx{mfirstuse}} } % option: firstskipothers \gmglsopt{first\-skip\-others} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to skip the \qt{other} elements on \idx{mfirstuse}} } % option: usedskipmain \gmglsopt{used\-skip\-main} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to skip the main entry on \idx{msubsequentuse}} } % option: usedskipothers \gmglsopt{used\-skip\-others} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to skip the \qt{other} elements on \idx{msubsequentuse}} } % option: hyper (\multiglossaryentry) \gmglsopt{multi.hyper} { \name{hyper} \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{individual} \desc{indicates which elements should have hyperlinks, if supported. This option is a multi-entry setting, see \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions}} } % option: hyper (\mgls) \gmglsopt{hyper} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to use hyperlinks, if supported, for all elements. This option is for use in the optional argument of \gls{mgls} and can be set implicitly with the default behaviour of the \cmdmod{star} and \cmdmod{plus} modifiers} } % option: textformat \gmglsopt{text\-format} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{@firstofone} \desc{the control sequence name of the command that should encapsulate the entire content} } % option: category \gmglsopt{category} { \syntax{\meta{category-label}} \desc{the category to assign to the multi-entry set} } % option: mglsopts \gmglsopt{mgls\-opts} { \syntax{\meta{option list}} \desc{the default options to pass to commands like \gls{mgls}} } % option: setup \gmglsopt{set\-up} { \syntax{\meta{option list}} \desc{multi-entry options that will override any conflicting options already assigned to the multi-entry} } % option: all \gmglsopt{all} { \syntax{\meta{option list}} \desc{options to pass to the \idx{glslike} command for each element} } % option: main \gmglsopt{main} { \syntax{\meta{option list}} \desc{options to pass to the \idx{glslike} command for the main entry} } % option: others \gmglsopt{others} { \syntax{\meta{option list}} \desc{options to pass to the \idx{glslike} command for the \qt{other} elements} } % option: multiunset \gmglsopt{multi\-un\-set} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{global} \desc{indicates whether or not the \idx{mfirstuseflag} should be unset} } % option: presetlocal \gmglsopt{pre\-set\-local} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not the prereset options should have a local or global effect} } % option: resetall \gmglsopt{reset\-all} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to reset all elements' \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % option: resetmain \gmglsopt{reset\-main} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to reset the main entry's \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % option: resetothers \gmglsopt{reset\-others} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to reset all \qt{other} elements' \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % option: unsetall \gmglsopt{unset\-all} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to unset all elements' \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % option: unsetmain \gmglsopt{unset\-main} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to unset the main entry's \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % option: unsetothers \gmglsopt{unset\-others} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{indicates whether or not to unset all \qt{other} elements' \idx{firstuseflag} before using \gls{gls}} } % COMMANDS: PREFIXES % \pgls \gcmdspa{pgls}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{similar to \gls{gls} but inserts the appropriate prefix, if provided} } % \Pgls \gcmdspa{Pgls}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pgls} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \PGLS \gcmdspa{PGLS}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pgls} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \pglspl \gcmdspa{pgls\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{similar to \gls{glspl} but inserts the appropriate prefix, if provided} } % \Pglspl \gcmdspa{Pgls\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pgls} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \PGLSpl \gcmdspa{PGLS\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pgls} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \glsprefixsep \gcmd{glsprefixsep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-prefix} v4.45+} \initvalempty \desc{separator between the prefix and the term} } % COMMANDS: PREFIXES (glossaries-extra) % \pglsxtrshort \gcmdspa{pgls\-xtr\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshort} but inserts the \gloskey{prefix} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{pgls\-xtr\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrshortpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixplural} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsxtrlong \gcmdspa{pgls\-xtr\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlong} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirst} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{pgls\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrlongpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} field and separator in front if set} } % \Pglsxtrshort \gcmdspa{Pgls\-xtr\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrshort} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Pglsxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{Pgls\-xtr\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrshortpl} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Pglsxtrlong \gcmdspa{Pgls\-xtr\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrlong} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Pglsxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{Pgls\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrlongpl} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \PGLSxtrshort \gcmdspa{PGLS\-xtr\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrshort} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \PGLSxtrshortpl \gcmdspa{PGLS\-xtr\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrshortpl} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \PGLSxtrlong \gcmdspa{PGLS\-xtr\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrlong} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \PGLSxtrlongpl \gcmdspa{PGLS\-xtr\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsxtrlongpl} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \pglsfmtshort \gcmdspa{pgls\-fmt\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtshort} but inserts the \gloskey{prefix} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsfmtshortpl \gcmdspa{pgls\-fmt\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtshortpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixplural} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsfmtlong \gcmdspa{pgls\-fmt\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtlong} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirst} field and separator in front if set} } % \pglsfmtlongpl \gcmdspa{pgls\-fmt\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{glsfmtlongpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} field and separator in front if set} } % \Pglsfmtshort \gcmdspa{Pgls\-fmt\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtshort} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Pglsfmtshortpl \gcmdspa{Pgls\-fmt\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtshortpl} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \PGLSfmtshort \gcmdspa{PGLS\-fmt\-short}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtshort} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \PGLSfmtshortpl \gcmdspa{PGLS\-fmt\-short\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtshortpl} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \Pglsfmtlong \gcmdspa{Pgls\-fmt\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtlong} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Pglsfmtlongpl \gcmdspa{Pgls\-fmt\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtlongpl} but \idx{sentencecase}} } % \PGLSfmtlong \gcmdspa{PGLS\-fmt\-long}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtlong} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \PGLSfmtlongpl \gcmdspa{PGLS\-fmt\-long\-pl}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{as \gls{pglsfmtlongpl} but \idx{allcaps}} } % \Pglsxtrtitleshort \gcmd{Pgls\-xtr\-title\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtshort}} } % \Pglsxtrtitleshortpl \gcmd{Pgls\-xtr\-title\-short\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtshortpl}} } % \Pglsxtrtitlelong \gcmd{Pgls\-xtr\-title\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtlong}} } % \Pglsxtrtitlelongpl \gcmd{Pgls\-xtr\-title\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \note{requires \sty{glossaries-prefix}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtlongpl}} } % COMMANDS: ACCESSIBILITY % \glsentrysymbolaccess \gcmd{gls\-entry\-symbol\-access} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsentrysymbol} but for the \gloskey{symbolaccess} field} } % \glsxtrassignactualsetup \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-assign\-actual\-set\-up} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \desc{used to strip common formatting commands from a field value to supply the text-only accessibility content when initialising the default \gloskey{shortaccess} and \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} values} } % \glsdefaultshortaccess \gcmd{gls\-default\-short\-access} { \note{requires \opt{accsupp}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{long}\margm{short}} \desc{used when \gls{newabbreviation} automatically assigns \gloskey{shortaccess}. This is defined by \sty{glossaries-accsupp} to just do \meta{long} but is redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} to do \code{\meta{long} (\meta{short})}} } % \glsnameaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-name\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glstextaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-text\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{textaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glspluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{pluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsfirstaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-first\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{firstaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsfirstpluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-first\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{firstpluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glssymbolaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-symbol\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{symbolaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glssymbolpluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-symbol\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{symbolpluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsdescriptionaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-description\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{descriptionaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsdescriptionpluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-description\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{descriptionpluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsshortaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-short\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{shortaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsshortpluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-short\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glslongaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-long\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{longaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glslongpluralaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-long\-plural\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp}} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{longpluralaccess} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuseriaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-i\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user1access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuseriiaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-ii\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user2access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuseriiiaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-iii\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user3access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuserivaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-iv\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user4access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuservaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-v\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user5access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsuserviaccessdisplay \gcmd{gls\-user\-vi\-access\-display} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-accsupp} v4.45+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{does \meta{text} with the \gloskey{user6access} replacement text (if set)} } % \glsaccessname \gcmd{gls\-access\-name} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{name} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryname}} } % \Glsaccessname \gcmd{Gls\-access\-name} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessname}} } % \GLSaccessname \gcmd{GLS\-access\-name} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessname}} } % \glsaccesstext \gcmd{gls\-access\-text} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{text} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{textaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrytext}} } % \Glsaccesstext \gcmd{Gls\-access\-text} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccesstext}} } % \GLSaccesstext \gcmd{GLS\-access\-text} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccesstext}} } % \glsaccessplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{plural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{pluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryplural}} } % \Glsaccessplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessplural}} } % \GLSaccessplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessplural}} } % \glsaccessfirst \gcmd{gls\-access\-first} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{first} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{firstaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryfirst}} } % \Glsaccessfirst \gcmd{Gls\-access\-first} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessfirst}} } % \GLSaccessfirst \gcmd{GLS\-access\-first} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessfirst}} } % \glsaccessfirstplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-firstplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{firstplural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{firstpluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryfirstplural}} } % \Glsaccessfirstplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-firstplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessfirstplural}} } % \GLSaccessfirstplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-firstplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessfirstplural}} } % \glsaccesssymbol \gcmd{gls\-access\-symbol} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{symbol} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{symbolaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrysymbol}} } % \Glsaccesssymbol \gcmd{Gls\-access\-symbol} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccesssymbol}} } % \GLSaccesssymbol \gcmd{GLS\-access\-symbol} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccesssymbol}} } % \glsaccesssymbolplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-symbolplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{symbolplural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{symbolpluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrysymbolplural}} } % \Glsaccesssymbolplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-symbolplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccesssymbolplural}} } % \GLSaccesssymbolplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-symbolplural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccesssymbolplural}} } % \glsaccessdesc \gcmd{gls\-access\-desc} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{description} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{descriptionaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrydesc}} } % \Glsaccessdesc \gcmd{Gls\-access\-desc} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessdesc}} } % \GLSaccessdesc \gcmd{GLS\-access\-desc} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessdesc}} } % \glsaccessdescplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-desc\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{descriptionplural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{descriptionpluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrydescplural}} } % \Glsaccessdescplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-desc\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessdescplural}} } % \GLSaccessdescplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-desc\-plural} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessdescplural}} } % \glsaccessshort \gcmd{gls\-access\-short} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{short} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{shortaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryshort}} } % \Glsaccessshort \gcmd{Gls\-access\-short} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessshort}} } % \GLSaccessshort \gcmd{GLS\-access\-short} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessshort}} } % \glsaccessshortpl \gcmd{gls\-access\-shortpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{shortplural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{shortpluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryshortpl}} } % \Glsaccessshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-access\-shortpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessshortpl}} } % \GLSaccessshortpl \gcmd{GLS\-access\-shortpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessshortpl}} } % \glsaccesslong \gcmd{gls\-access\-long} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{long} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{longaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrylong}} } % \Glsaccesslong \gcmd{Gls\-access\-long} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccesslong}} } % \GLSaccesslong \gcmd{GLS\-access\-long} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccesslong}} } % \glsaccesslongpl \gcmd{gls\-access\-longpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{longplural} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{longpluralaccess}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentrylongpl}} } % \Glsaccesslongpl \gcmd{Gls\-access\-longpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccesslongpl}} } % \GLSaccesslongpl \gcmd{GLS\-access\-longpl} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccesslongpl}} } % \glsaccessuseri \gcmd{gls\-access\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user1} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user1access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuseri}} } % \Glsaccessuseri \gcmd{Gls\-access\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuseri}} } % \GLSaccessuseri \gcmd{GLS\-access\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuseri}} } % \glsaccessuserii \gcmd{gls\-access\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user2} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user2access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuserii}} } % \Glsaccessuserii \gcmd{Gls\-access\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuserii}} } % \GLSaccessuserii \gcmd{GLS\-access\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuserii}} } % \glsaccessuseriii \gcmd{gls\-access\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user3} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user3access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuseriii}} } % \Glsaccessuseriii \gcmd{Gls\-access\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuseriii}} } % \GLSaccessuseriii \gcmd{GLS\-access\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuseriii}} } % \glsaccessuseriv \gcmd{gls\-access\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user4} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user4access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuseriv}} } % \Glsaccessuseriv \gcmd{Gls\-access\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuseriv}} } % \GLSaccessuseriv \gcmd{GLS\-access\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuseriv}} } % \glsaccessuserv \gcmd{gls\-access\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user5} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user5access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuserv}} } % \Glsaccessuserv \gcmd{Gls\-access\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuserv}} } % \GLSaccessuserv \gcmd{GLS\-access\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuserv}} } % \glsaccessuservi \gcmd{gls\-access\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if accessibility support was enabled when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded (\opt{accsupp}) this will display the value of the \gloskey{user6} key with the accessibility support enabled for that key (\gloskey{user6access}). If there is no accessibility support, this just uses \gls{glsentryuservi}} } % \Glsaccessuservi \gcmd{Gls\-access\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsaccessuservi}} } % \GLSaccessuservi \gcmd{GLS\-access\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsaccessuservi}} } % \glsaccessfmtname \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessname} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtname \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessname} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtname \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-name} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessname} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmttext \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccesstext} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmttext \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccesstext} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmttext \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-text} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccesstext} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtfirst \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessfirst} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtfirst \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessfirst} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtfirst \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessfirst} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtfirstplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-first\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessfirstplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtfirstplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-first\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessfirstplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtfirstplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-first\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessfirstplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtsymbol \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccesssymbol} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtsymbol \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccesssymbol} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtsymbol \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-symbol} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccesssymbol} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtsymbolplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-symbol\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccesssymbolplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtsymbolplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-symbol\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccesssymbolplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtsymbolplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-symbol\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccesssymbolplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtdesc \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessdesc} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtdesc \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessdesc} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtdesc \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-desc} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessdesc} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtdescplural \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-desc\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessdescplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtdescplural \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-desc\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessdescplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtdescplural \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-desc\-plural} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessdescplural} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtshort \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-short} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessshort} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtshort \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-short} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessshort} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtshort \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-short} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessshort} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtshortpl \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-short\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessshortpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-short\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessshortpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtshortpl \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-short\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessshortpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtlong \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-long} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccesslong} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtlong \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-long} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccesslong} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtlong \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-long} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccesslong} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtlongpl \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-long\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccesslongpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtlongpl \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-long\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccesslongpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtlongpl \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-long\-pl} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccesslongpl} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuseri \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuseri} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuseri \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuseri} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuseri \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-useri} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuseri} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuserii \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuserii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuserii \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuserii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuserii \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-userii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuserii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuseriii \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuseriii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuseriii \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuseriii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuseriii \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-useriii} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuseriii} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuseriv \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuseriv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuseriv \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuseriv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuseriv \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-useriv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuseriv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuserv \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuserv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuserv \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuserv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuserv \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-userv} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuserv} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % \glsaccessfmtuservi \gcmd{gls\-access\-fmt\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsaccessuservi} but formats the displayed text with \gls{glsfmtfield}} } % \Glsaccessfmtuservi \gcmd{Gls\-access\-fmt\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{Glsaccessuservi} but formats the displayed text with \gls{Glsfmtfield}} } % \GLSaccessfmtuservi \gcmd{GLS\-access\-fmt\-uservi} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{insert}\margm{cs}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{similar to \gls{GLSaccessuservi} but formats the displayed text with \gls{GLSfmtfield}} } % COMMANDS: HEADINGS AND CAPTIONS % \glsxtrRevertMarks \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Revert\-Marks} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{restores \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc} to their previous definitions} \field{seealso}{glsxtrRevertTocMarks} } % \glsxtrRevertTocMarks \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Revert\-Toc\-Marks} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \desc{restores \gls{@starttoc} to its previous definition} \field{seealso}{glsxtrRevertMarks} } % \glsxtrifinmark \gcmd{glsxtrifinmark} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if within \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} or \gls{@starttoc} otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \@glsxtrinmark \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-in\-mark} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \desc{redefines \gls{glsxtrifinmark} to do its first argument (\meta{true})} } % \@glsxtrnotinmark \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-not\-in\-mark} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \desc{redefines \gls{glsxtrifinmark} to do its first argument (\meta{true})} } % \@glsxtr@org@markboth \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-@org\-@mark\-both} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{left text}\margm{right text}} \desc{set to the definition of \gls{markboth} when \sty{glossaries-extra} loads} } % \@glsxtr@org@markright \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-@org\-@mark\-right} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{set to the definition of \gls{markright} when \sty{glossaries-extra} loads} } % \@glsxtr@org@@starttoc \gcmd{@gls\-xtr\-@org\-@@start\-toc} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{toc}} \desc{set to the definition of \gls{@starttoc} when \sty{glossaries-extra} loads} } % \glsxtrmarkhook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-mark\-hook} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{hook that's performed at the start of \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc} to redefine commands that need to change when they occur within page headers or contents. This must be counteracted with \gls{glsxtrrestoremarkhook} afterwards} } % \glsxtrrestoremarkhook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-restore\-mark\-hook} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{counteracts \gls{glsxtrmarkhook}} } % \glsxtrtitleorpdforheading \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-or\-pdf\-or\-heading} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{title}\margm{PDF bookmarks}\margm{heading}} \desc{does the applicable argument depending on whether the command occurs within a title\slash caption or PDF bookmark or heading} } % \glsxtrifheaduc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-head\-uc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{if the category associated with the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \catattr{headuc} attribute set to \code{true} this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}} } % \glsxtrifintoc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-in\-toc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{normally just expands to \meta{false} but \gls{@starttoc} is redefined to temporarily set this macro to expand to \meta{true} instead. Will always expand to \meta{false} if \gls{glsxtrRevertTocMarks} or \gls{glsxtrRevertMarks} are used to revert \gls{@starttoc} to its former definition} } % \glsfmtshort \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted short form} } % \Glsfmtshort \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} short form} } % \GLSfmtshort \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} short form} } % \glsfmtshortpl \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-short\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted short plural form} } % \Glsfmtshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-short\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} short plural form} } % \GLSfmtshortpl \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-short\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} short plural form} } % \glsfmtlong \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-long} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted long form} } % \Glsfmtlong \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-long} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} long form} } % \GLSfmtlong \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-long} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} long form} } % \glsfmtlongpl \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-long\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted long plural form} } % \Glsfmtlongpl \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-long\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} long plural form} } % \GLSfmtlongpl \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-long\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.2+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} long plural form} } % \glspdffmtfull \gcmd{gls\-pdf\-fmt\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{glsentrylong}\margm{entry-label} (\gls{glsentryshort}\margm{entry-label})} for use in PDF bookmarks or other text-only contexts} } % \glspdffmtfullpl \gcmd{gls\-pdf\-fmt\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{glsentrylongpl}\margm{entry-label} (\gls{glsentryshortpl}\margm{entry-label})} for use in PDF bookmarks or other text-only contexts} } % \glsfmtfull \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfull}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks, otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{glsxtrtitlefull}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \Glsfmtfull \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfull}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks (no case-change), otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{Glsxtrtitlefull}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \GLSfmtfull \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfull}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks (no case-change), otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{GLSxtrtitlefull}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \glsfmtfullpl \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfullpl}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks, otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{glsxtrtitlefullpl}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \Glsfmtfullpl \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfullpl}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks (no case-change), otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{Glsxtrtitlefullpl}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \GLSfmtfullpl \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{designed for use in section headings or captions, this expands to just \code{\gls{glspdffmtfullpl}\margm{entry-label}} in PDF bookmarks (no case-change), otherwise it expands to \code{\gls{GLSxtrtitlefullpl}\margm{entry-label}}} } % \glsfmtname \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \gloskey{name}} } % \Glsfmtname \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{name}} } % \GLSfmtname \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{name}} } % \glsfmttext \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \gloskey{text}} } % \Glsfmttext \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{text}} } % \GLSfmttext \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-text} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{text}} } % \glsfmtplural \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \gloskey{plural}} } % \Glsfmtplural \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{plural}} } % \GLSfmtplural \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{plural}} } % \glsfmtfirst \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \gloskey{first}} } % \Glsfmtfirst \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{first}} } % \GLSfmtfirst \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{first}} } % \glsfmtfirstpl \gcmd{gls\-fmt\-firstpl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \gloskey{firstplural}} } % \Glsfmtfirstpl \gcmd{Gls\-fmt\-firstpl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{firstplural}} } % \GLSfmtfirstpl \gcmd{GLS\-fmt\-firstpl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{for use within captions or section titles to display the formatted \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{firstplural}} } % COMMANDS: INNER HEAD AND TITLE % \glsxtrtitleopts \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-opts} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the options that commands like \gls{glsfmtshort} should use in the title or caption within the document text} } % \glsxtrheadshort \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshort} when it occurs in a page header} } % \glsxtrtitleshort \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshort}} } % \Glsxtrheadshort \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshort} when it occurs in a page header} } % \Glsxtrtitleshort \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-short} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshort}} } % \GLSxtrheadshort \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshort} when it occurs in a page header} } % \GLSxtrtitleshort \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshort}} } % \glsxtrheadshortpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-short\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \glsxtrtitleshortpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-short\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.03+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshortpl}} } % \Glsxtrheadshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-short\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \Glsxtrtitleshortpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-short\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshortpl}} } % \GLSxtrheadshortpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-short\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \GLSxtrtitleshortpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-short\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshortpl}} } % \glsxtrheadlong \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlong} when it occurs in a page header} } % \glsxtrtitlelong \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlong}} } % \Glsxtrheadlong \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlong} when it occurs in a page header} } % \Glsxtrtitlelong \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlong}} } % \GLSxtrheadlong \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlong} when it occurs in a page header} } % \GLSxtrtitlelong \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlong}} } % \glsxtrheadlongpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \glsxtrtitlelongpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlongpl}} } % \Glsxtrheadlongpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \Glsxtrtitlelongpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlongpl}} } % \GLSxtrheadlongpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a page header} } % \GLSxtrtitlelongpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-long\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{the normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlongpl}} } % \glsxtrheadfull \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's full form in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfull,glsxtrtitlefull} } % \glsxtrtitlefull \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's full form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfull,glsxtrheadfull} } % \glsxtrheadfullpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's full plural form in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfullpl,glsxtrtitlefullpl} } % \glsxtrtitlefullpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's full plural form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfullpl,glsxtrheadfullpl} } % \Glsxtrheadfull \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{sentencecase} full form in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfull,Glsxtrtitlefull} } % \Glsxtrtitlefull \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{sentencecase} full form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfull,Glsxtrheadfull} } % \GLSxtrheadfull \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{allcaps} full form in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfull,GLSxtrtitlefull} } % \GLSxtrtitlefull \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-full} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{allcaps} full form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfull} } % \Glsxtrheadfullpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{sentencecase} full plural form in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfullpl,Glsxtrtitlefullpl} } % \Glsxtrtitlefullpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{sentencecase} full plural form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfullpl,Glsxtrheadfullpl} } % \GLSxtrheadfullpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{allcaps} full plural form in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfullpl,GLSxtrtitlefullpl} } % \GLSxtrtitlefullpl \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-full\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \idx{allcaps} full plural form in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfullpl} } % \glsxtrheadname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's name in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtname,glsxtrtitlename} } % \glsxtrtitlename \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's name in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtname,glsxtrheadname} } % \Glsxtrheadname \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's name in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtname,Glsxtrtitlename} } % \Glsxtrtitlename \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's name in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtname,Glsxtrheadname} } % \GLSxtrheadname \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{name} \idx{field} in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtname,GLSxtrtitlename} } % \GLSxtrtitlename \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's name in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtname,GLSxtrheadname} } % \glsxtrheadtext \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmttext,glsxtrtitletext} } % \glsxtrtitletext \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmttext,glsxtrheadtext} } % \Glsxtrheadtext \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmttext,Glsxtrtitletext} } % \Glsxtrtitletext \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-text} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmttext,Glsxtrheadtext} } % \GLSxtrheadtext \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-text} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmttext,GLSxtrtitletext} } % \GLSxtrtitletext \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-text} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{text} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmttext,GLSxtrheadtext} } % \glsxtrheadplural \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtplural,glsxtrtitleplural} } % \glsxtrtitleplural \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtplural,glsxtrheadplural} } % \Glsxtrheadplural \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtplural,Glsxtrtitleplural} } % \Glsxtrtitleplural \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-plural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtplural,Glsxtrheadplural} } % \GLSxtrheadplural \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtplural,GLSxtrtitleplural} } % \GLSxtrtitleplural \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{plural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtplural,GLSxtrheadplural} } % \glsxtrheadfirst \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfirst,glsxtrtitlefirst} } % \glsxtrtitlefirst \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfirst,glsxtrheadfirst} } % \Glsxtrheadfirst \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfirst,Glsxtrtitlefirst} } % \Glsxtrtitlefirst \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-first} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfirst,Glsxtrheadfirst} } % \GLSxtrheadfirst \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfirst,GLSxtrtitlefirst} } % \GLSxtrtitlefirst \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{first} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfirst,GLSxtrheadfirst} } % \glsxtrheadfirstplural \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-head\-firstplural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfirstpl,glsxtrtitlefirstplural} } % \glsxtrtitlefirstplural \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-title\-firstplural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{glsfmtfirstpl,glsxtrheadfirstplural} } % \Glsxtrheadfirstplural \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-head\-firstplural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the page header (converts to \idx{allcaps} if \catattr{headuc} attribute is \code{true})} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfirstpl,Glsxtrtitlefirstplural} } % \Glsxtrtitlefirstplural \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-title\-firstplural} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{sentencecase} entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{Glsfmtfirstpl,Glsxtrheadfirstplural} } % \GLSxtrheadfirstplural \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-head\-first\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the page header} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfirstpl,GLSxtrtitlefirstplural} } % \GLSxtrtitlefirstplural \gcmd{GLS\-xtr\-title\-firstplural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to display the \idx{allcaps} entry's \gloskey{firstplural} \idx{field} in the section title and table of contents} \field{seealso}{GLSfmtfirstpl,GLSxtrheadfirstplural} } % COMMANDS: FORMATTING % \glsxtrassignfieldfont \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-assign\-field\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by the \idx{glstextlike} commands to initialise the formatting commands required for the given entry} } % \glssetabbrvfmt \gcmd{gls\-set\-abbrv\-fmt} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}} \desc{implements the \meta{display definitions} code for the abbreviation style associated with the given category} } % \GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleSetup \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Use\-Abbr\-Style\-Set\-up} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{style-name}} \desc{implements the \meta{setup} code for the given abbreviation style} } % \GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleFmts \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Use\-Abbr\-Style\-Fmts} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{style-name}} \desc{implements the \meta{display definitions} code for the given abbreviation style} } % \glsuseabbrvfont \gcmd{gls\-use\-abbrv\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{style-name}\margm{text}} \desc{formats \meta{text} according to the short format for the given abbreviation style} } % \glsuselongfont \gcmd{gls\-use\-long\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{style-name}\margm{text}} \desc{formats \meta{text} according to the long format for the given abbreviation style} } % \glsxtrgenabbrvfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-gen\-abbrv\-fmt} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{the display format used by \gls{glsentryfmt} for entries that have the \gloskey{short} field set and have the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{false}} } % \glsgenentryfmt \gcmd{gls\-gen\-entry\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \desc{the display format used by \gls{glsentryfmt} for regular entries} } % \glsentryfmt \gcmd{gls\-entry\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \desc{the default display format used by the \idx{glslike} commands. This checks if the \gloskey{short} field has been set for the current entry and, if set, initialises the abbreviation formatting commands (with \gls{glssetabbrvfmt}). This command will do \gls{glsgenentryfmt} (encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrregularfont}) if the entry is considered a regular entry (\gls{glsifregular}) or if the entry doesn't have the \gloskey{short} field set. Otherwise it will do \gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt} encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}} } % \glsxtrregularfont \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-regular\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{glsentryfmt} to encapsulate regular entries. Also used by \gls{glsxtrassignfieldfont} for regular entries} } % \glsxtrabbreviationfont \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-ab\-bre\-vi\-a\-tion\-font} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{used by \gls{glsentryfmt} to encapsulate non-regular entries the have the \gloskey{short} field set} } % \defglsentryfmt \gcmd{def\-gls\-entry\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{display}} \desc{overrides the default display format (\gls{glsentryfmt}) for the given glossary. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed. This will make the \idx{glslike} commands do \meta{display} for any entries that have the \gloskey{type} field set to the given \meta{type}. If you want to support any abbreviation styles, you need to include \gls{glssetabbrvfmt} in \meta{display}. Non-regular abbreviation styles are designed to work with \gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt}} } % \glslabel \gcmd{gls\-label} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{the current entry label, initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This command may be used within associated hooks, entry display styles (\gls{defglsentryfmt}), and the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % \glsinsert \gcmd{gls\-insert} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{the final \meta{insert} argument passed to the \idx{glslike} commands (but not to the \idx{glstextlike} commands, where the \meta{insert} is added to \gls{glscustomtext}). This command may be used within associated hooks, entry display styles (\gls{defglsentryfmt}), and the \idx{postlinkhook}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrsaveinsert,glsxtrfullsaveinsert} } % \glscustomtext \gcmd{gls\-custom\-text} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{the custom text provided by \gls{glsdisp} or the \idx{linktext} for the \idx{glstextlike} commands. This command may be used within associated hooks, entry display styles (\gls{defglsentryfmt}), and the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % \glsifplural \gcmd{gls\-if\-plural} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, this expands to \meta{true} if the calling command accesses a plural field (such as \gls{glspl} or \gls{glsplural}) otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. This command may be used within associated hooks, entry display styles (\gls{defglsentryfmt}), and the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % \glscapscase \gcmd{gls\-caps\-case} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{no change}\margm{sentence}\margm{all caps}} \desc{initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, this expands to \meta{no change} if the calling command doesn't apply a case-change (such as \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext}), to \meta{sentence} if the calling command converts to \idx+{sentencecase} (such as \gls{Gls} or \gls{Glstext}), or to \meta{all caps} if the calling command converts to \idx+{allcaps} (such as \gls{GLS} or \gls{GLStext}). This command may be used within associated hooks, entry display styles (\gls{defglsentryfmt}), and the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % \glsxtrifallcaps \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-all\-caps} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{all caps}\margm{not all caps}} \desc{shortcut for \code{\gls{glscapscase}\margm{not all caps}\margm{not all caps}\margm{all caps}}} } % \glsxtrifwasfirstuse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-was\-first\-use} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, this expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was considered the \idx{firstuse}, otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. This command may be used within the \idx{postlinkhook} (where it's too late to test the \idx{firstuseflag} with \gls{ifglsused})} } % \glsxtrifwasglslike \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-was\-gls\-like} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, this expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command, otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. This command may be used within the \idx{postlinkhook}} } % \glsxtrifwasglslikeandfirstuse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-was\-gls\-like\-and\-first\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{a shortcut that nests \gls{glsxtrifwasglslike} and \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}. This does \meta{true} if the calling command was both a \idx{glslike} command and was considered the \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsxtrifwassubsequentuse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-was\-subsequent\-use} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{a shortcut that nests \gls{glsxtrifwasglslike} and \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}. This does \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command but was not considered the \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsxtrifwassubsequentorshort \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-was\-subsequent\-or\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command and was the \idx{subsequentuse} or if \gls{glsxtrcurrentfield} was set to \code{short}} } % \glsxtrcurrentfield \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-current\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{placeholder command for use in \idxpl{postlinkhook}. This expands to empty if the calling command was one of the \idx{glslike} commands or it was one of the \idx{inlinefullform} commands, otherwise it will expand to the name of the key associated with the \emph{singular} form of the command} } % \glsxtrassignlinktextfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-assign\-link\-text\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{initialised by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, this contains the definitions of \gls{glslabel}, \gls{glstextformat}, \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}} } % COMMANDS: CATEGORIES % \glsifcategory \gcmd{gls\-if\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{category}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{category} set to \meta{category} (uses \gls{ifglsfieldeq} for the test)} } % \glsifregularcategory \gcmd{gls\-if\-regular\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given category has the \catattr{regular} attribute explicitly set to \code{true}, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsifnotregularcategory \gcmd{gls\-if\-not\-regular\-category} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given category has the \catattr{regular} attribute explicitly set to \code{false}, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsifregular \gcmd{gls\-if\-regular} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the category for the given entry has the \catattr{regular} attribute explicitly set to \code{true}, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsifnotregular \gcmd{gls\-if\-not\-regular} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the category for the given entry has the \catattr{regular} attribute explicitly set to \code{false}, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsforeachincategory \gcmd{gls\-for\-each\-in\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary-types}\margm{category}\margm{glossary-cs}\margm{label-cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates over all entry in the given list of \idxpl{glossary} (or all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary}, if the optional argument is omitted) and performs \meta{body} for those entries that have the \gloskey{category} set to \meta{category}. Within \meta{body}, the current entry can be referenced with \meta{label-cs} and the \idx{glossary} can be referenced with \meta{glossary-cs}} } % \glsforeachwithattribute \gcmd{gls\-for\-each\-with\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary-types}\margm{attribute-label}\margm{attribute-value}\margm{glossary-cs}\margm{label-cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates over all entry in the given list of \idxpl{glossary} (or all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary}, if the optional argument is omitted) and performs \meta{body} for those entries that have the attribute given by \meta{attribute-label} set to \meta{attribute-value}. Within \meta{body}, the current entry can be referenced with \meta{label-cs} and the \idx{glossary} can be referenced with \meta{glossary-cs}} } % \glssetcategoryattribute \gcmd{gls\-set\-category\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}\margm{value}} \desc{locally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for the given category} } % \glssetcategoriesattribute \gcmd{gls\-set\-categories\-attribute} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category list}\margm{attribute}\margm{value}} \desc{globally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for all the categories in the comma-separated list \meta{category list}} } % \glssetcategoriesattributes \gcmd{gls\-set\-categories\-attributes} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{category list}\margm{attribute list}\margm{value}} \desc{globally sets each attribute in the comma separated \meta{attribute list} to \meta{value} for each category in the comma-separated list \meta{category list}} } % \glssetcategoryattributes \gcmd{gls\-set\-category\-attributes} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute list}\margm{value}} \desc{globally sets each attribute in the comma separated \meta{attribute list} to \meta{value} for the given \meta{category}} } % \glssetregularcategory \gcmd{gls\-set\-regular\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}} \desc{locally sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the given category} } % \glsgetcategoryattribute \gcmd{gls\-get\-category\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}} \desc{expands to the value of the given attribute for the given category. Expands to nothing if the attribute hasn't been set} } % \glsunsetcategoryattribute \gcmd{gls\-unset\-category\-attribute}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}} \desc{locally unsets the given attribute for the given category} } % \glshascategoryattribute \gcmd{gls\-has\-category\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given attribute has been set for the given category (using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsvoid})} } % \glssetattribute \gcmd{gls\-set\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}\margm{value}} \desc{locally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}} } % \glsgetattribute \gcmd{gls\-get\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}} \desc{expands to the value of the given attribute for the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. Expands to nothing if the attribute hasn't been set} } % \glsxtrsetcategory \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-category} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-labels}\margm{category-label}} \desc{globally sets the \gloskey{category} field to the fully expanded \meta{category-label} for each entry listed in \meta{entry-labels}} } % \glsxtrsetcategoryforall \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-category\-for\-all} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-labels}\margm{category-label}} \desc{globally sets the \gloskey{category} field to the fully expanded \meta{category-label} for each entry belonging to the \idxpl{glossary} listed in \meta{glossary-labels}} } % \glshasattribute \gcmd{gls\-has\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given attribute has been set for the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} (using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsvoid}). Does \meta{false} if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \glsifcategoryattribute \gcmd{gls\-if\-category\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given category has the given attribute set to \meta{value}. Does \meta{true} if the attribute is \meta{value} and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category} } % \glsifattribute \gcmd{gls\-if\-attribute} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}\margm{value}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} has the given attribute set to \meta{value}. Does \meta{true} if the attribute is \meta{value} and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category or if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \glsifcategoryattributetrue \gcmd{gls\-if\-category\-attribute\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the given category has the given attribute set to \code{true}. Does \meta{true} if the attribute is \code{true} and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category} } % \glsifattributetrue \gcmd{gls\-if\-attribute\-true} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the category associated with the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the given attribute set to \code{true}. Does \meta{true} if the attribute is \code{true} and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category or if the entry hasn't been defined} } % \glsifcategoryattributehasitem \gcmd{gls\-if\-category\-attribute\-has\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{attribute}\margm{item}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the category has the attribute (whose value is a comma-separated list) contains the given item and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category. The item and list are expanded and passed to \sty{datatool}['s] \gls{DTLifinlist} to perform the test} } % \glsxtrchecknohyperfirst \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-check\-no\-hyper\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.07+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{sets \glsoptval{hyper}{false} if the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute is set} } % COMMANDS: INDEXING % \glsignore \gcmd{gls\-ignore} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.12+} \syntax{\margm{text}} \desc{does nothing. When used as a \idx{locationencap}, this signifies to \app{bib2gls} that the entry is required but the \location\ shouldn't be added to the \idx{locationlist}. With other \idx{indexing} methods, this simply creates an invisible \location} } % \glsxtrdowrglossaryhook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-do\-wr\-glossary\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook used whenever an entry is \indexed. Does nothing by default} } % \glsadd \gcmd{gls\-add} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{indexes the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}} } % \glsaddall \gcmd{gls\-add\-all} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \desc{iterates over all \idxpl{glossary} (or all those listed in the \glsopt{types} option) and \idxc{indexing}{indexes} each entry in the \idx{glossary}. The optional argument \meta{options} are passed to \gls{glsadd}. This command can't be used with \app{bib2gls}. Use the \resourceoptval{selection}{all} \idx{resourceopt} instead} } % \glsaddallunused \gcmd{gls\-add\-all\-unused} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\oargm{glossary types}} \desc{iterates over all \idxpl{glossary} listed in \meta{glossary types} and \idxc{indexing}{indexes} each entry (with \glsoptval{format}{glsignore}) that hasn't been used. This command can't be used with \app{bib2gls}. Use the \resourceoptval{selection}{all} \idx{resourceopt} instead} } % \glsaddallunindexed \gcmd{gls\-add\-all\-un\-indexed} {% \syntax{\oargm{glossary types}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{iterates over all \idxpl{glossary} listed in \meta{glossary types} and \idxc{indexing}{indexes} each entry (with \glsoptval{format}{glsignore}) that hasn't already been indexed. This command can't be used with \app{bib2gls}. Use the \resourceoptval{selection}{all} \idx{resourceopt} instead} } % \glsaddeach \gcmd{gls\-add\-each} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry label list}} \desc{does \code{\gls{glsadd}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}} for each label in the supplied comma-separated list} } % \glsstartrange \gcmd{gls\-start\-range} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry label list}} \desc{essentially does \code{\gls{glsaddeach}\oarg{\meta{options},\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}\meta{encap}}}\margm{entry label list}} where \meta{encap} can either be provided by the \glsopt{format} key in \meta{options} or will default to the format given in \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultRangeFormat}} } % \glsendrange \gcmd{gls\-end\-range} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry label list}} \desc{as \gls{glsstartrange} but with the end range marker \sym{endrange}} } % \GlsXtrAutoAddOnFormat \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Auto\-Add\-On\-Format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\oargm{entry-label}\margm{format list}\margm{gls\-add options}} \desc{identifies formats that should trigger an automatic \gls{glsadd} by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glsxtrdoautoindexname \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-do\-auto\-index\-name} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.3+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{attribute}} \desc{used to automatically index (using \gls{glsxtrautoindex}) the entry's name, if the given attribute is set for the entry's category} } % \glsxtrautoindex \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-auto\-index} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \initvalcs{index} \desc{the indexing command used by by the auto-indexing feature} } % \glsxtrautoindexesc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-auto\-index\-esc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.36+} \desc{escapes the sort value used by the auto-indexing feature} } % \glsxtrautoindexentry \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-auto\-index\-entry} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the \qt{actual} part for the auto-indexing feature} } % \glsxtrautoindexassignsort \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-auto\-index\-assign\-sort} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used to assign the sort value for the auto-indexing feature} } % \GlsXtrEnableIndexFormatOverride \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-Index\-Format\-Override} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \desc{allows the \glsopt{format} key to override the attribute value} \note{preamble only} } % \GlsXtrSetActualChar \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Actual\-Char} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{character}} \desc{sets the \qt{actual character} for the auto-indexing feature} \note{preamble only} } % \GlsXtrSetEncapChar \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Encap\-Char} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{character}} \desc{sets the \qt{encap character} for the auto-indexing feature} \note{preamble only} } % \GlsXtrSetLevelChar \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Level\-Char} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{character}} \desc{sets the \qt{level character} for the auto-indexing feature} \note{preamble only} } % \GlsXtrSetEscChar \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Esc\-Char} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{character}} \desc{sets the \qt{escape character} for the auto-indexing feature} \note{preamble only} } % \glssee \gcmd{gls\-see} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \syntax{\oargm{tag}\margm{entry-label}\margm{xr-list}} \desc{indexes the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} as a general cross-reference to the entries identified in the comma-separated list \meta{xr-list}. The optional argument is the textual tag that's inserted before the cross-reference list and defaults to \gls{seename}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrindexseealso} } % \glsseeformat \gcmd{gls\-see\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \syntax{\oargm{tag}\margm{xr-list}\margm{location}} \desc{used to format the \gloskey{see} cross-reference in the \idx{locationlist}. This requires a \location\ argument for \app{makeindex} even though it isn't required. The default definition is \code{\csfmt{emph}\margm{tag} \gls{glsseelist}\margm{xr-list}}} } % \glsseelist \gcmd{gls\-see\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \syntax{\margm{csv-list}} \desc{iterates over a comma-separated list of entry labels \meta{csv-list} and formats them. Each label in the list is encapsulated with \gls{glsseeitem} (or \gls{mglsseeitem}, the label corresponds to a multi-entry). The separators are \gls{glsseelastsep} (between the penultimate and last items) and \gls{glsseesep} (between all the other items). With \sty{glossaries-extra}, the first label is encapsulated with \gls{glsseefirstitem} (or \gls{mglsseefirstitem}) and the final separator for a list consisting of at least three items is given by \gls{glsseelastoxfordsep}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrseelist} } % \glsseeitem \gcmd{gls\-see\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelist} to format each entry} \field{seealso}{glsseefirstitem} } % \glsseeitemformat \gcmd{gls\-see\-item\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsseeitem} to produce the hyperlink text} } % \glsseefirstitem \gcmd{gls\-see\-first\-item} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelist} to format the first entry} \field{seealso}{glsseeitem} } % \glsseesep \gcmd{gls\-see\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \initval{{,\textvisiblespace}} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelist} as a separator between each entry except the last pair} \field{seealso}{glsseelastsep,glsseelastoxfordsep} } % \glsseelastsep \gcmd{gls\-see\-last\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v1.17+} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelist} as a separator between penultimate and final entry in the list} \field{seealso}{glsseelastsep,glsseelastoxfordsep} } % \glsseelastoxfordsep \gcmd{gls\-see\-last\-oxford\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.47+} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelist} as a separator between penultimate and final entry in the list if there are at least three entries in the list} \field{seealso}{glsseelastsep,glsseelastoxfordsep} } % \andname \gcmd{and\-name} { \initvalcs{amp} \desc{used by \gls{glsseelastsep} (provided by \sty{glossaries} if not already defined)} } % \glsxtrseelist \gcmd{glsxtrseelist} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{csv-list}} \desc{fully expands \meta{csv-list} and passes it to \gls{glsseelist}} } % \glsxtrtaggedlist \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-tagged\-list} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{singular tag}\margm{plural tag}\margm{label prefix}\margm{csv-list}} \desc{similar to \gls{glsseelist}, this will start the list with \meta{singular tag} if the list only contains one element and \meta{plural tag} if the list contains more than one element. Each element is prefixed with \meta{label prefix}. The tag is separated from the start of the list with \gls{glsxtrtaggedlistsep}. The actual list separators as as for \gls{glsseelist}. The \meta{csv-list} is expanded before being iterated over. Does nothing if \meta{csv-list} is empty} } % \glsxtrtaggedlistsep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-tagged\-list\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \initvalcs{space} \desc{separator used by \gls{glsxtrtaggedlist} between the tag and the list} } % \glsxtrusesee \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-see} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.06+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{see} field set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseeformat}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrusealias,glsxtruseseealso,glsxtrseelists} } % \glsxtrusealias \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-alias} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{alias} field set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseeformat}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrusesee,glsxtruseseealso,glsxtrseelists} } % \glsxtruseseealso \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-see\-also} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{seealso} field set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrusesee,glsxtrusealias,glsxtrseelists} } % \glsxtrseelists \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-see\-lists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} or \gloskey{alias} fields set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseeformat} (for \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{alias}) or \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat} (for \gloskey{seealso}). If any of these fields are set, the list is encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrseelistsencap}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrseelistsencap,glsxtrseelistsdelim} } % \glsxtrseelistsencap \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-see\-lists\-encap} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{content}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrseelists} to encapsulate the lists} } % \glsxtrseelistsdelim \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-see\-lists\-delim} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrseelists} to as separator between sub-lists} } % \glsxtruseseeformat \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-see\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.06+} \syntax{\margm{tag}\margm{xr-list}} \desc{format used by \gls{glsxtrusesee}. This internally uses \gls{glsseeformat}} } % \glsxtruseseealsoformat \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-use\-see\-also\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{csv-list}} \desc{formats the comma-separated list of entry labels as a \qt{see also} cross-reference} } % \glsxtrindexseealso \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-index\-see\-also} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{xr-list}} \desc{indexes the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} as a \qt{see also} cross-reference to the entries identified in the comma-separated list \meta{xr-list}. The cross-reference list is prefixed with \gls{seealsoname}} \field{seealso}{glssee} } % \glsxtrsetaliasnoindex \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-alias\-no\-index} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{hook used to switch off indexing for aliases} } % \glsxtrindexaliased \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-index\-aliased} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{index the current entry's alias. May only be used within the definition of \gls{glsxtrsetaliasnoindex}} } % \glsxtralias \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-alias} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the value of the \gloskey{alias} field for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. If the field isn't set, this will expand to nothing. If the entry isn't defined, this will expand to \gls{relax}} } % \glsxtraliashook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-alias\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook implemented when the \gloskey{alias} key is provided when an entry is defined} } % \glsxtrseealsolabels \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-see\-also\-labels} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the value of the \gloskey{seealso} field for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. If the field isn't set, this will expand to nothing. If the entry isn't defined, this will expand to \gls{relax}} } % \glsxtraddallcrossrefs \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-add\-all\-cross\-refs} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{iterates over all defined entries and indexes any cross-references (identified by the \gloskey{see} or \gloskey{seealso} keys) that haven't been used} \field{seealso}{opt.indexcrossrefs} } % \glsxtraddunusedxrefs \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-add\-un\-used\-xrefs} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{indexes any cross-references (identified by the \gloskey{see} or \gloskey{seealso} keys) that haven't been used} } % \glsxtrunusedformat \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-un\-used\-format} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{location}} \desc{the \idxc{locationencap}{format} used by \gls{glsxtraddallcrossrefs}} } % \glsxtrdowrglossaryhook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-wr\-glossary\-hook} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{hook implemented everytime an entry is indexed} } % \GlsXtrSetAltModifier \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Alt\-Modifier} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{token}\margm{options}} \desc{sets \meta{token} as a modifier for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands that will automatically implement the given options} } % \GlsXtrSetStarModifier \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Star\-Modifier} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{overrides the options that should be implemented by the star (\code{*}) modifier for \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \GlsXtrSetPlusModifier \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Plus\-Modifier} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{overrides the options that should be implemented by the plus (\code{+}) modifier for \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glslinkwrcontent \gcmd{gls\-link\-wr\-content} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{code}} \desc{encapsulates the \idx{linktext} and \idx{indexing}. Just does \meta{code} by default} } % \glsencapwrcontent \gcmd{gls\-encap\-wr\-content} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+ \& \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{code}} \desc{encapsulates the \idx{indexing} code (within \gls{glslinkwrcontent})} } % \glsentryindexcount \gcmd{gls\-entry\-index\-count} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the number of times the given entry has been indexed. This will expand to 0 if the entry hasn't been indexed or hasn't been defined} } % \glsifindexed \gcmd{gls\-if\-indexed} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value obtained from \gls{glsentryindexcount} is greater than 0} } % \glswriteentry \gcmd{gls\-write\-entry} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{code}} \desc{performs the indexing code unless indexing should be suppressed} } % \glsxtrifindexing \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-indexing} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests whether or not the \glsopt{noindex} has been set. Does \meta{false} if \glsoptval{noindex}{true} otherwise does \meta{true}} } % \ifglsindexonlyfirst \gcond{if\-gls\-index\-only\-first} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \initvalcs{iffalse} \desc{a conditional that corresponds to the \opt{indexonlyfirst} option} } % \ifglsxtrinitwrglossbefore \gcond{if\-gls\-xtr\-init\-wr\-gloss\-before} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \initvalcs{iftrue} \desc{a conditional that indicates whether or not \glsoptval{wrgloss}{before} is set} } % \glsxtrinitwrglossbeforetrue \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-init\-wr\-gloss\-before\-true} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \desc{corresponds to \glsoptval{wrgloss}{before}} } % \glsxtrinitwrglossbeforefalse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-init\-wr\-gloss\-before\-false} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \desc{corresponds to \glsoptval{wrgloss}{after}} } % \GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Default\-Number\-Format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.19+} \syntax{\margm{encap}} \desc{sets the default \glsopt{format} to \meta{encap} (without the leading backslash)} } % \GlsXtrSetDefaultRangeFormat \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Default\-Range\-Format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.50+} \syntax{\margm{encap}} \desc{sets the default \glsopt{format} to \meta{encap} (without the leading backslash) for \gls{glsstartrange} and \gls{glsendrange}} } % \GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Default\-Gls\-Opts} {% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{locally set the default options for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \GlsXtrAppToDefaultGlsOpts \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-App\-To\-Default\-Gls\-Opts} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{locally append \meta{options} to the default options for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \GlsXtrPreToDefaultGlsOpts \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Pre\-To\-Default\-Gls\-Opts} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{options}} \desc{locally prepend \meta{options} to the default options for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glslinkpresetkeys \gcmd{gls\-link\-pre\-set\-keys} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.26+} \desc{hook implemented before setting the options passed to the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glslinkpostsetkeys \gcmd{gls\-link\-post\-set\-keys} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \desc{hook implemented after setting the options passed to the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % \glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook \gcmd{gls\-link\-check\-first\-hyper\-hook} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \desc{hook used at the end of the code in the \idx{glslike} commands that tests if the hyperlink should be switched off on \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsaddpresetkeys \gcmd{gls\-add\-pre\-set\-keys} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \desc{hook implemented before setting the options passed to \gls{glsadd}} } % \glsaddpostsetkeys \gcmd{gls\-add\-post\-set\-keys} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \desc{hook implemented after setting the options passed to \gls{glsadd}} } % \glsxtrinitwrgloss \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-init\-wr\-gloss} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \desc{hook that initialises the \glsopt{wrgloss} setting} } % \glsxtrinithyperoutside \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-init\-hyper\-out\-side} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{hook that initialises the \glsopt{hyperoutside} setting} } % \glsinitreunsets \gcmd{gls\-init\-re\-un\-sets} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{hook that initialises the \glsopt{prereset}, \glsopt{preunset} and \glsopt{postunset} settings} } % COMMANDS: CONDITIONALS % \glsunset \gcmd{gls\-unset} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{globally unsets the entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. That is, this marks the entry as \qt{used}} \field{seealso}{glslocalunset,glsreset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glslocalunset \gcmd{gls\-local\-unset} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{locally unsets the entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. That is, this marks the entry as \qt{used}} \field{seealso}{glsunset,glslocalreset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glslocalunseteach \gcmd{gls\-local\-unset\-each} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-labels}} \desc{locally unsets each listed entry's \idx{firstuseflag}} \field{seealso}{glsunset,glslocalreset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glsreset \gcmd{gls\-reset} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{globally resets the entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. That is, this marks the entry as \qt{not used}} \field{seealso}{glslocalreset,glsunset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glslocalreset \gcmd{gls\-local\-reset} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{locally resets the entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. That is, this marks the entry as \qt{not used}} \field{seealso}{glsreset,glslocalunset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glslocalreseteach \gcmd{gls\-local\-reset\-each} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{entry-labels}} \desc{locally resets each listed entry's \idx{firstuseflag}} \field{seealso}{glsreset,glslocalreset,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glsunsetall \gcmd{gls\-unset\-all} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{types}} \desc{globally unsets all entries associated with the listed glossaries or all glossaries if \meta{types} is omitted} \field{seealso}{glsunset,glsresetall,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glsresetall \gcmd{gls\-reset\-all} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{types}} \desc{globally resets all entries associated with the listed glossaries or all glossaries if \meta{types} is omitted} \field{seealso}{glsreset,glsunsetall,ifglsused,GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} } % \glslocalunsetall \gcmd{gls\-local\-un\-set\-all} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels list}} \desc{locally unsets the \idx+{firstuseflag} for all entries in whose labels are listed in the \meta{glossary labels list} comma-separated list. If the optional argument is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed} \field{seealso}{glsunset,glslocalunset,glsunsetall,glslocalresetall} } % \glslocalresetall \gcmd{gls\-local\-re\-set\-all} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{glossary labels list}} \desc{locally resets the \idx+{firstuseflag} for all entries in whose labels are listed in the \meta{glossary labels list} comma-separated list. If the optional argument is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed} \field{seealso}{glsreset,glslocalreset,glsresetall,glslocalunsetall} } % \ifglsused \gcmd{if\-gls\-used} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry has been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used}, does \meta{false} if the entry is marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{unused}, and does neither if the entry hasn't been defined (but will generate an error or warning according to \opt{undefaction})} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined,glsxtrifwasfirstuse} } % \GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Unused\-Or\-Undefined} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.34+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry hasn't been defined or hasn't been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used}, otherwise does \meta{true}. Note that this command will generate an error or warning (according to \opt{undefaction}) if the entry hasn't been defined, but will still do \meta{true}} \field{seealso}{ifglsused,glsxtrifwasfirstuse} } % \glscurrentfieldvalue \gcmd{gls\-current\-field\-value} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.23+} \desc{conditional commands such as \gls{ifglshasfield} set this to the field's value for use within the \meta{true} code} } % \ifglshasfield \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.03+} \syntax{\margm{field}\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{if the field identified by either its key or its \idx{internalfieldlabel} \meta{field} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} is set and non-empty, this sets \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} to the field value and does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifhasfield,ifglsfieldvoid} } % \ifglsfieldvoid \gcmd{if\-gls\-field\-void} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.50+} \syntax{\margm{field-label}\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{an expandable test to determine if the entry is undefined or the field is undefined or empty. The \meta{field-label} must be the field's \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrIfFieldUndef} }% % \ifglshasparent \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-parent} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{parent} field is set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshasdesc \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-desc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{description} field is set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshasdescsuppressed \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-desc\-suppressed} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{description} field is just \gls{nopostdesc} otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshassymbol \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-symbol} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.08a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{symbol} field is set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshaslong \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-long} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{long} field is set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshasshort \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-short} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.11a+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's \gloskey{short} field is set otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \ifglshaschildren \gcmd{if\-gls\-has\-children} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v3.02+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the given entry has child entries otherwise does \meta{false}. Note that this has to iterate over the set of defined entries for the entry's \idx{glossary} to find one that has the entry identified in its \gloskey{parent} field. A more efficient approach can be achieved with \app{bib2gls} and the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrIfHasNonZeroChildCount} } % COMMANDS: LOOPS % \forglsentries \gcmd{for\-gls\-entries} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{type}\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates over all entries in the given \idx{glossary} and, at each iteration, defines the command \meta{cs} to the current entry label and does \meta{body}. The optional argument \meta{type} is the \idx{glossary} label and defaults to \gls{glsdefaulttype} if omitted. This command can't be used with \app{bib2gls} since there are no defined entries until \app{bib2gls} has selected them and added them to the \ext{glstex} file} \field{seealso}{forallglsentries} } % \forallglsentries \gcmd{for\-all\-gls\-entries} {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{types}\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{does \gls{forglsentries} for each \idx{glossary}. The optional argument \meta{types} is a comma-separated list of \idx{glossary} labels. If omitted, all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed} } % \forallglossaries \gcmd{for\-all\-glossaries} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \syntax{\oargm{types}\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates overall all the \idx{glossary} labels given in the \meta{types} argument, defines the command \meta{cs} to the current label and does \meta{body}. If the optional argument is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed} } % \forallacronyms \gcmd{for\-all\-acronyms} { \banned \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.08+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates overall all \idxpl{glossary} that have been declared lists of acronyms, defines the command \meta{cs} to the current label and does \meta{body}. Use \gls{forallabbreviationlists} with \sty{glossaries-extra}} } % \forallabbreviationlists \gcmd{forallabbreviationlists} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\margm{body}} \desc{iterates overall all lists of abbreviations, defines the command \meta{cs} to the current label and does \meta{body}} \field{seealso}{forallglossaries} } % CATEGORIES \gidxpl{category}{\field{plural}{categories} \common \desc{with \sty{glossaries-extra}, each entry has an associated category (a simple label) assigned with the \gloskey{category} key. Each category can have a set of \attrs\ (assigned with commands like \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}), which can affect the way the entry is formatted. Some categories, such as \cat{general}, are supplied by \sty{glossaries-extra}} } % general category \gcat{general}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{newglossaryentry} and similar commands. This category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true}}}% % abbreviation category \gcat{abbreviation}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{newabbreviation}}}% % acronym category \gcat{acronym}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{newacronym} (as redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra}). This category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true} by default but this may be changed to \code{false} by certain \idx{abbrvstyle}}}% % symbol category \gcat{symbol}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol}. This category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true}}}% % number category \gcat{number}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{glsxtrnewnumber}. This category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true}}}% % index category \gcat{index}{\desc{the default \idx{category} for \gls{newterm} (as redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra}). This category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true}}}% % term category \gcat{term}{\desc{a \idx{catpostdeschook} is provided for this category, but no commands are provided that set the \gloskey{category} key to this label}} % CATEGORY ATTRIBUTES \gidxpl{categoryattribute}{\field{text}{category attribute}% \desc{a category can have a set of attributes (assigned with commands like \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}), which can affect the way the entry is formatted. Some attributes are recognised by certain commands. Custom attributes can also be defined and referenced in hooks or custom commands as required} } % regular \gcatattr{regular}% {% \common \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the entry should be treated as a regular entry (the \gloskey{first}\slash\gloskey{firstplural} key is used on \idx{firstuse} and the \gloskey{text}\slash\gloskey{plural} key is used on subsequent use). If set to \code{false}, the entry is assumed to be governed by the \idx{abbrvstyle} associated with the category or the default style for the \cat{abbreviation} category, if no style is associated with the entry's category. If this attribute isn't set, \code{true} is assumed. Certain \idxpl{abbrvstyle} set this attribute to \code{true} or \code{false}, depending on the complexity of the style} } % markwords \gcatattr{mark\-words}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the words in the long form marked up with \gls{glsxtrword} and separated by \gls{glsxtrwordsep}. If this attribute isn't set, \code{false} is assumed} } % markshortwords \gcatattr{mark\-short\-words}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the words in the short form marked up with \gls{glsxtrword} and separated by \gls{glsxtrwordsep}. If this attribute isn't set, \code{false} is assumed} } % discardperiod \gcatattr{discard\-period}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{this attribute is provided for abbreviations that end in a \idx{fullstop}. If set to \code{true}, indicates that the \idx{postlinkhook} will discard a \idx{fullstop} that follows \emph{non-plural} commands like \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext}} } % pluraldiscardperiod \gcatattr{plural\-discard\-period}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{as \catattr{discardperiod} but for plural commands like \gls{glspl}} } % insertdots \gcatattr{insert\-dots}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the abbreviation short form should have a \idx{fullstop} automatically inserted after every character} } % accessinsertdots \gcatattr{access\-insert\-dots}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the abbreviation accessibility replacement (provided in the \gloskey{shortaccess} key) should have a \idx{fullstop} automatically inserted after every character. Only checked if \catattr{insertdots} hasn't been set} } % retainfirstuseperiod \gcatattr{retain\-first\-use\-period} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.01+} \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set, the \idx{fullstop} won't be discarded for \idx{firstuse} with \catattr{discardperiod} or \catattr{pluraldiscardperiod}} } % noshortplural \gcatattr{no\-short\-plural}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the \gloskey{shortplural} field set to the same as the \gloskey{short} value by default} } % accessnoshortplural \gcatattr{access\-no\-short\-plural}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true} and \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} hasn't been set, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} field set to the same as the \gloskey{shortaccess} value by default} } % aposplural \gcatattr{apos\-plural}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the \gloskey{shortplural} field set to the short form followed by \code{'\gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}} by default} } % accessaposplural \gcatattr{access\-apos\-plural}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true} and \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} hasn't been set, this attribute indicates that abbreviations should have the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} field set to the short form followed by \code{'\gls{glsxtrpluralsuffix}} by default} } % nameshortaccess \gcatattr{name\-short\-access} {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if the \gloskey{access} hasn't been set then if this attribute is \code{true}, the \gloskey{access} field will be set to the \gloskey{shortaccess}} } % textshortaccess \gcatattr{text\-short\-access} {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if the \gloskey{textaccess} hasn't been set then if this attribute is \code{true}, the \gloskey{textaccess} field will be set to the \gloskey{shortaccess} and, likewise, if the \gloskey{pluralaccess} field hasn't been set it will be set to the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess}} } % firstshortaccess \gcatattr{first\-short\-access} {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if the \gloskey{firstaccess} hasn't been set then if this attribute is \code{true}, the \gloskey{firstaccess} field will be set to the \gloskey{shortaccess} and, likewise, if the \gloskey{firstpluralaccess} field hasn't been set it will be set to the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess}} } % tagging \gcatattr{tagging}% { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that abbreviations with the associated category use the command defined with \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} to tag initials} } % textformat \gcatattr{text\-format}% { \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{if set, the value should be the name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash) that should be used to encapsulate the link text (instead of \gls{glstextformat})} } % innertextformat \gcatattr{inner\-text\-format}% { \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{when used with \gls{glsxtrattrentrytextfmt}, the value should be the name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash)} } % nohyper \gcatattr{no\-hyper} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the hyperlink should be switched off for commands like \gls{gls}} } % nohyperfirst \gcatattr{no\-hyper\-first} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the hyperlink should be switched off on \idx{firstuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands} } % nohypernext \gcatattr{no\-hyper\-next} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the hyperlink should be switched off on \idx{subsequentuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands} } % indexonlyfirst \gcatattr{index\-only\-first} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that \idx{indexing} should only occur on \idx{firstuse}} } % indexname \gcatattr{index\-name} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{value}} \desc{used by the \idx{postnamehook} with \gls{glsxtrdoautoindexname} to indicate that an entry needs to be automatically indexed with \gls{index}. The value may be \code{true} or the encap} } % wrgloss \gcatattr{wr\-gloss} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{determines whether the \idx{indexing} is performed before or after the \idx{linktext}. If the value is \code{after} then \glsoptval{wrgloss}{after} otherwise it implements \glsoptval{wrgloss}{before}} } % hyperoutside \gcatattr{hyper\-out\-side} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the hyperlink should be outside of the outer formatting command} } % headuc \gcatattr{head\-uc}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if set to \code{true}, this attribute indicates that the text produced by commands like \gls{glsfmttext} should be converted to \idx+{allcaps} when they appear in a page header} } % encapnocase \gcatattr{encap\-no\-case} { \syntax{\meta{internal field list}} \desc{if set, all the listed fields (identified by their \idx{internalfieldlabel}) will have their values encapsulated with \gls{NoCaseChange} when an entry with the associated category is defined} } % encapinnerfmt \gcatattr{encap\-inner\-fmt} { \syntax{\meta{internal field list}} \desc{if set, all the listed fields (identified by their \idx{internalfieldlabel}) will have their values encapsulated with the inner formatting command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} when an entry with the associated category is defined} } % encapnocaseinnerfmt \gcatattr{encap\-no\-case\-inner\-fmt} { \syntax{\meta{internal field list}} \desc{combines \catattr{encapnocase} and \catattr{encapinnerfmt} for the same field set} } % entrycount \gcatattr{entry\-count} { \syntax{\meta{trigger-value}} \desc{when used with entry counting, this attribute provides the trigger value} } % unitcount \gcatattr{unit\-count} { \syntax{\meta{counter}} \desc{when used with unit entry counting, this attribute provides the name of the counter associated with the unit} } % recordcount \gcatattr{record\-count} { \syntax{\meta{trigger-value}} \desc{when used with record counting, this attribute provides the trigger value} } % multioptions \gcatattr{multioptions} { \syntax{\meta{options}} \desc{default options to apply to any multi-entry set for the given category} } % glossname \gcatattr{gloss\-name} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{indicates if any \idx{casechange} should be applied within \gls{glossentryname}} } % glossdesc \gcatattr{gloss\-desc} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{indicates if any \idx{casechange} should be applied within \gls{glossentrydesc}} } % glossnamefont \gcatattr{gloss\-name\-font} { \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{the control sequence name (without the leading backslash) to format the name within \gls{glossentryname}} } % glossdescfont \gcatattr{gloss\-desc\-font} { \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{the control sequence name (without the leading backslash) to format the description within \gls{glossentrydesc}} } % glosssymbolfont \gcatattr{gloss\-symbol\-font} { \syntax{\meta{cs-name}} \desc{the control sequence name (without the leading backslash) to format the symbol within \gls{glossentrysymbol}} } % linkcount \gcatattr{link\-count} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \desc{if true, link counting is enabled} } % linkcountmaster \gcatattr{link\-count\-master} { \syntax{\meta{counter-name}} \desc{if link counting is enabled, the value should be the name of the counter that needs to have its reset list updated} } % dualindex \gcatattr{dual\-index} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{if set, implement dual indexing} } % targeturl \gcatattr{target\-url} { \syntax{\meta{url}} \desc{if set, indicates the target URL for the hyperlinks created by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands} } % targetname \gcatattr{target\-name} { \syntax{\meta{anchor}} \desc{if set, the named anchor within the URL provided by \catattr{targeturl}} } % targetcategory \gcatattr{target\-category} { \syntax{\meta{anchor}} \desc{if set, the named anchor category within the URL provided by \catattr{targeturl} (combined with \catattr{targetname})} } % externallocation \gcatattr{external\-location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \syntax{\meta{PDF filename}} \desc{if set, the value is the filename of the external target PDF document (used by \gls{glsxtrsupphypernumber})} } % combinedsep \gcatattr{combined\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\meta{separator}} \desc{if set, indicates separator to use in \gls{glscombinedsep}} } % combinedsepfirst \gcatattr{combined\-sep\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\meta{separator}} \desc{if set, indicates separator to use in \gls{glscombinedsepfirst}} } % combinedfirstsepfirst \gcatattr{combined\-first\-sep\-first} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\meta{separator}} \desc{if set, indicates separator to use in \gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}} } % combinedfirstsep \gcatattr{combined\-first\-sep} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\meta{separator}} \desc{if set, indicates separator to use in \gls{glscombinedfirstsep}} } % COMMANDS: bib2gls % \glsxtrresourcefile \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-resource\-file}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.11+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{basename}} \field{seealso}{idx.resourceopt,GlsXtrLoadResources} \desc{for use with \app{bib2gls}, this both sets up the options for the \idx{resourceset} (which \app{bib2gls} can detect from the \ext{aux} file) and inputs the file \metafilefmt{}{basename}{.glstex} file created by \app{bib2gls}} } % \GlsXtrLoadResources \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Load\-Resources}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.11+} \syntax{\oargm{options}} \field{seealso}{idx.resourceopt} \desc{a shortcut that uses \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}\oargm{options}\margm{basename}, where the \meta{basename} is obtained from \gls{jobname} and \gls{glsxtrresourcecount}} } % \glsxtrresourcecount \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-resource\-count}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \desc{a count register that is incremented on each use of \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} to provide a unique basename for each \idx{resourceset}} } % \glsxtrresourceinit \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-resource\-init}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{may be defined to temporarily change command definitions before information is written to the \ext{aux} file by the protected write used by \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} } % \GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Resource\-Init\-Esc\-Sequences} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.51+} \desc{may be added to the definition of \gls{glsxtrresourceinit} to temporarily change the definitions of commands that may be used in regular expressions or within the \resourceopt{assign-fields} resource option} } % \GlsXtrDefaultResourceOptions \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Default\-Resource\-Options}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.40+} \desc{expands to default \idxpl{resourceopt}} } % \glsxtr@resource \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-@\-resource}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{basename}} \desc{used in the \ext{aux} file to provide the \idxpl{resourceopt} for \app{bib2gls} for each \idx{resourceset}. Ignored by \LaTeX} } % \glsxtr@record \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-@\-record}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{h-prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{encap}\margm{location}} \desc{used in the \ext{aux} file to provide the \record\ for \app{bib2gls} (\opteqvalref{record}{only}). Ignored by \LaTeX} } % \glsxtr@record@nameref \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-@\-record\-@\-name\-ref}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{h-prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{encap}\margm{location}\margm{current title}\margm{current anchor}\margm{the-h-counter}} \desc{used in the \ext{aux} file to provide the \optvalref{record}{nameref} \record\ for \app{bib2gls}. Ignored by \LaTeX} } % \glsxtrMFUsave \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-MFU\-save} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{used on the first instance of \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}, this will add \gls{MFUsave} to the begin document hook and then disable itself. This is provided to help \app{bib2gls} pick up any of \sty{mfirstuc}['s] exclusions, blockers and mappings to assist with its \idx{sentencecase} function} } % \bibgls@input \gcmd{bib\-gls\-@\-in\-put} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{filename}} \desc{indicates that the \app{bib2gls} records are in the file identified in the argument \meta{filename}, which corresponds to the file \metafilefmt{}{basename}{.aux} identified in the option \optval{bibglsaux}{\meta{basename}}} } % \IfTeXParserLib \gcmd{If\-TeX\-Parser\-Lib} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{\TeX\ parser lib code}\margm{\LaTeX\ code}} \desc{defined by \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} to \meta{\LaTeX\ code} but defined by \app{bib2gls}['s] interpreter to expand to \meta{\TeX\ parser lib code}} } % \glshex \gcmd{gls\-hex} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.21+} \syntax{\meta{hex}} \desc{expands to \code{\gls{string}\gls{u}\meta{hex}}} \field{seealso}{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} } % \u \gcmd{u} { \syntax{\meta{hex}} \desc{recognised by \app{bib2gls} within some \idxpl{resourceopt} as identifying the Unicode character given by \meta{hex}. Since \csfmt{u} is defined by the \LaTeX\ kernel as an accent command, you need to protect it from expansion while the options are written to the \ext{aux} file (\code{\gls{string}\csfmt{u}\meta{hex}})} \field{seealso}{glshex,GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} } % \glscapturedgroup \gcmd{gls\-captured\-group} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.31+} \syntax{\meta{n}} \desc{expands to \code{\gls{string}\gls{dollar}\meta{n}}. Note that this isn't the same as \gls{MGP}} } % \glshashchar \gcmd{gls\-hash\-char} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to a literal hash \idx{sym.hash}} } % \cs \gcmd{cs} { \syntax{\margm{csname}} \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{csname}} } % \CS \gcmd{CS} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{CS}} } % \NULL \gcmd{NULL} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{NULL}} } % \IN \gcmd{IN} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{IN}} } % \NIN \gcmd{NIN} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{NIN}} } % \PREFIXOF \gcmd{PREFIX\-OF} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{PREFIXOF}} } % \NOTPREFIXOF \gcmd{NOT\-PREFIX\-OF} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{NOTPREFIXOF}} } % \SUFFIXOF \gcmd{SUFFIX\-OF} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{SUFFIXOF}} } % \NOTSUFFIXOF \gcmd{NOT\-SUFFIX\-OF} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{NOTSUFFIXOF}} } % \LC \gcmd{LC} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{LC}} } % \UC \gcmd{UC} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{UC}} } % \TITLE \gcmd{TITLE} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{TITLE}} } % \FIRSTLC \gcmd{FIRSTLC} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{FIRSTLC}} } % \FIRSTUC \gcmd{FIRSTUC} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{FIRSTUC}} } % \MGP \gcmd{MGP} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{MGP}. Note that this isn't the same as \gls{glscapturedgroup}} } % \LEN \gcmd{LEN} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{LEN}} } % \CAT \gcmd{CAT} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{CAT}} } % \TRIM \gcmd{TRIM} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{TRIM}} } % \INTERPRET \gcmd{INTERPRET} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{INTERPRET}} } % \LABELIFY \gcmd{LABELIFY} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{LABELIFY}} } % \LABELIFYLIST \gcmd{LABELIFYLIST} { \desc{defined by \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} to expand to detokenized \csfmt{LABELIFYLIST}} } % \GlsXtrBibTeXEntryAliases \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Bib\-TeX\-Entry\-Aliases} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.29+} \desc{expands to the \BibTeX\ to \app{bib2gls} entry aliases for use in \resourceopt{entry-type-aliases}} } % \GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Provide\-Bib\-TeX\-Fields} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.29+} \desc{provides the standard \BibTeX\ fields as glossary entry keys (using \gls{glsaddstoragekey})} } % \glsxtrbibaddress \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-address} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{address} field} } % \glsxtrbibauthor \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-author} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{author} field} } % \glsxtrbibbooktitle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-book\-title} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{booktitle} field} } % \glsxtrbibchapter \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-chapter} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{chapter} field} } % \glsxtrbibedition \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-edition} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{edition} field} } % \glsxtrbibhowpublished \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-how\-published} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{howpublished} field} } % \glsxtrbibinstitution \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-institution} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{institution} field} } % \glsxtrbibjournal \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-journal} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{journal} field} } % \glsxtrbibmonth \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-month} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{month} field} } % \glsxtrbibnote \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-note} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{note} field} } % \glsxtrbibnumber \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-number} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{number} field} } % \glsxtrbiborganization \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-organization} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{organization} field} } % \glsxtrbibpages \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-pages} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{pages} field} } % \glsxtrbibpublisher \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-publisher} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{publisher} field} } % \glsxtrbibschool \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-school} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{school} field} } % \glsxtrbibseries \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-series} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{series} field} } % \glsxtrbibtitle \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-title} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{title} field} } % \glsxtrbibvolume \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-volume} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{volume} field} } % \glsxtrbibtype \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-bib\-type} { \note{defined by \gls{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields}} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{accesses the \fieldfmt{bibtextype} field} } % \glsxtrprovidecommand \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-provide\-command} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\oargm{n}\oargm{default}\margm{definition}} \desc{just uses \gls{providecommand} within the \LaTeX\ document but is treated as \gls{renewcommand} by \app{bib2gls}['s] interpreter} } % \glsrenewcommand \gcmds{gls\-re\-new\-command} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\oargm{n}\oargm{default}\margm{definition}} \desc{like \gls{renewcommand} but only issues a warning instead of an error if the command hasn't been defined} } % \GlsXtrIndexCounterLink \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Index\-Counter\-Link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.29+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{creates a hyperlink (if supported) to the target obtained from \glosfield{indexcounter}, if the field has been defined with the given hyperlink text (otherwise just does \meta{text})} } % \Alpha \gcmd{Alpha} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{A}}} } % \Beta \gcmd{Beta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{B}}} } % \Epsilon \gcmd{Epsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{E}}} } % \Zeta \gcmd{Zeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{Z}}} } % \Eta \gcmd{Eta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{H}}} } % \Iota \gcmd{Iota} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{I}}} } % \Kappa \gcmd{Kappa} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{K}}} } % \Mu \gcmd{Mu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{M}}} } % \Nu \gcmd{Nu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{N}}} } % \Omicron \gcmd{Omicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{O}}} } % \omicron \gcmd{omicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{O}}} } % \Rho \gcmd{Rho} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{P}}} } % \Tau \gcmd{Tau} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{T}}} } % \Chi \gcmd{Chi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{X}}} } % \Digamma \gcmd{Digamma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand}, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{F}}} } % \Upalpha \gcmd{Upalpha} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{A}}} } % \Upbeta \gcmd{Upbeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{B}}} } % \Upepsilon \gcmd{Upepsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{E}}} } % \Upzeta \gcmd{Upzeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{Z}}} } % \Upeta \gcmd{Upeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{H}}} } % \Upiota \gcmd{Upiota} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{I}}} } % \Upkappa \gcmd{Upkappa} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{K}}} } % \Upmu \gcmd{Upmu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{M}}} } % \Upnu \gcmd{Upnu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{N}}} } % \Upomicron \gcmd{Upomicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{O}}} } % \upomicron \gcmd{upomicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{o}}} } % \Uprho \gcmd{Uprho} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{P}}} } % \Uptau \gcmd{Uptau} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{T}}} } % \Upchi \gcmd{Upchi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{defined with \gls{providecommand} and only if \sty{upgreek} has been loaded, this just does \code{\cmd{mathrm}\marg{X}}} } % \glsxtrcontrolrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-control\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to control character sort rules} } % \glsxtrspacerules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-space\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to space character sort rules} } % \glsxtrnonprintablerules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-non\-printable\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to non-printable character sort rules} } % \glsxtrcombiningdiacriticrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-combining\-diacritic\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to all the combining diacritic sort rules} } % \glsxtrcombiningdiacriticIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-combining\-diacritic\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of combining diacritic sort rules} } % \glsxtrcombiningdiacriticIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-combining\-diacritic\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of combining diacritic sort rules} } % \glsxtrcombiningdiacriticIIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-combining\-diacritic\-III\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the third set of combining diacritic sort rules} } % \glsxtrcombiningdiacriticIVrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-combining\-diacritic\-IV\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the fourth set of combining diacritic sort rules} } % \glsxtrhyphenrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-hyphen\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to hyphen character sort rules} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to all sets of general punctuation sort rules} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of general punctuation (including currency) sort rules} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncmarksrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-marks\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{punctuation mark subset of \gls{glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules}} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncaccentsrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-accents\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{punctuation accent subset of \gls{glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules}} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncquoterules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-quote\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{punctuation quote subset of \gls{glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules}} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncbracketrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-bracket\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{punctuation bracket subset of \gls{glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules}} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncsignrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-sign\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{punctuation sign subset of \gls{glsxtrgeneralpuncIrules}} } % \glsxtrgeneralpuncIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-general\-punc\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of general punctuation (including currency) sort rules} } % \glsxtrcurrencyrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-currency\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to currency character sort rules} } % \glsxtrdigitrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-digit\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to 0--9 digit character sort rules (includes superscript and subscript digits)} } % \glsxtrBasicDigitrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Basic\-Digit\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the Basic Latin digit character sort rules} } % \glsxtrSubScriptDigitrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Sub\-Script\-Digit\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the 0--9 subscript digit character sort rules} } % \glsxtrSuperScriptDigitrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Super\-Script\-Digit\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the 0--9 superscript digit character sort rules} } % \glsxtrfractionrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fraction\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the number forms fraction character sort rules} } % \glsxtrIgnorableRules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Ignorable\-Rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{a shortcut that expands to the control rules, space rules and non-printable rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralInitRules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Init\-Rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{a shortcut that expands to the ignorable rules, combining diacritic rules, hyphen rules, general punctuation rules, digit rules, and fraction rules} } % \glsxtrLatinA \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinA} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin A (includes 0x00AA and 0x2090)} } % \glsxtrLatinE \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinE} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin E (includes 0x2091)} } % \glsxtrLatinH \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinH} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin H (includes 0x2095)} } % \glsxtrLatinI \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinI} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin I (includes 0x2071)} } % \glsxtrLatinK \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinK} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin K (includes 0x2096)} } % \glsxtrLatinL \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinL} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin L (includes 0x2097)} } % \glsxtrLatinM \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinM} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin M (includes 0x2098)} } % \glsxtrLatinN \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinN} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin N (includes 0x2099)} } % \glsxtrLatinO \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinO} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin O (includes 0x00BA and 0x2092)} } % \glsxtrLatinP \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinP} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin P (includes 0x209A)} } % \glsxtrLatinS \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinS} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin S (includes 0x209B)} } % \glsxtrLatinT \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinT} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin T (includes 0x209C)} } % \glsxtrLatinX \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-LatinX} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin X (includes 0x2093)} } % \glsxtrLatinSchwa \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-Schwa} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin schwa} } % \glsxtrLatinEszettSs \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-EszettSs} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to rule for \ss and \char"017F\relax s} } % \glsxtrLatinEszettSz \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-EszettSz} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to rule for \ss and \char"017F\relax z} } % \glsxtrLatinEth \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-Eth} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin eth} } % \glsxtrLatinThorn \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-Thorn} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin thorn} } % \glsxtrLatinAELigature \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-AE\-Ligature} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin ae-ligature} } % \glsxtrLatinOELigature \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-OE\-Ligature} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin oe-ligature} } % \glsxtrLatinAA \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-AA} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin \aa} } % \glsxtrLatinWynn \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-Wynn} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin wynn} } % \glsxtrLatinInsularG \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-InsularG} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin insular G and g, G} } % \glsxtrLatinOslash \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-O\-slash} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin \o} } % \glsxtrLatinLslash \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Latin\-L\-slash} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of Latin \l} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinAtoMrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-A\-to\-M\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the A--M subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinNtoZrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-N\-to\-Z\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the N--Z subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinAtoGrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-A\-to\-G\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the A--G subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinHtoMrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-H\-to\-M\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the H--M subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinNtoSrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-N\-to\-S\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the N--S subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinTtoZrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-T\-to\-Z\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the T--Z subset of General Latin I sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinIIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-III\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the third set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinIVrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-IV\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the fourth set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinVrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-V\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the fifth set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinVIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-VI\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the sixth set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinVIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-VII\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the seventh set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrGeneralLatinVIIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-General\-Latin\-VIII\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the eighth set of General Latin sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathUpGreekIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Up\-Greek\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of math upright Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathUpGreekIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Up\-Greek\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of math upright Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicGreekIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Greek\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of math italic Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicGreekIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Greek\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of math italic Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicUpperGreekIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Upper\-Greek\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of math italic \idx{uppercase} Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicUpperGreekIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Upper\-Greek\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of math italic \idx{uppercase} Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicLowerGreekIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Lower\-Greek\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of math italic \idx{lowercase} Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathItalicLowerGreekIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Lower\-Greek\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of math italic \idx{lowercase} Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathGreekIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Greek\-I\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the first set of math Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrMathGreekIIrules \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Greek\-II\-rules} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{expands to the second set of math Greek sort rules} } % \glsxtrUpAlpha \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Alpha} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright alpha} } % \glsxtrUpBeta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Beta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright beta} } % \glsxtrUpGamma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Gamma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright gamma} } % \glsxtrUpDelta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Delta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright delta} } % \glsxtrUpEpsilon \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Epsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright epsilon} } % \glsxtrUpDigamma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Digamma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright digamma} } % \glsxtrUpZeta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Zeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright zeta} } % \glsxtrUpEta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Eta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright eta} } % \glsxtrUpTheta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Theta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright theta} } % \glsxtrUpIota \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Iota} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright iota} } % \glsxtrUpKappa \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Kappa} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright kappa} } % \glsxtrUpLambda \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Lambda} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright lambda} } % \glsxtrUpMu \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Mu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright mu} } % \glsxtrUpNu \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Nu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright nu} } % \glsxtrUpXi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Xi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright xi} } % \glsxtrUpOmicron \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Omicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright omicron} } % \glsxtrUpPi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Pi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright pi} } % \glsxtrUpRho \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Rho} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright rho} } % \glsxtrUpSigma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Sigma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright sigma} } % \glsxtrUpTau \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Tau} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright tau} } % \glsxtrUpUpsilon \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Upsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright upsilon} } % \glsxtrUpPhi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Phi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright phi} } % \glsxtrUpChi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Chi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright chi} } % \glsxtrUpPsi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Psi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright psi} } % \glsxtrUpOmega \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Up\-Omega} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math Greek upright omega} } % \glsxtrMathItalicAlpha \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Alpha} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek alpha} } % \glsxtrMathItalicBeta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Beta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek beta} } % \glsxtrMathItalicGamma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Gamma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek gamma} } % \glsxtrMathItalicDelta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Delta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek delta} } % \glsxtrMathItalicEpsilon \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Epsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek epsilon} } % \glsxtrMathItalicDigamma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Digamma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek digamma} } % \glsxtrMathItalicZeta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Zeta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek zeta} } % \glsxtrMathItalicEta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Eta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek eta} } % \glsxtrMathItalicTheta \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Theta} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek theta} } % \glsxtrMathItalicIota \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Iota} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek iota} } % \glsxtrMathItalicKappa \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Kappa} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek kappa} } % \glsxtrMathItalicLambda \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Lambda} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek lambda} } % \glsxtrMathItalicMu \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Mu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek mu} } % \glsxtrMathItalicNu \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Nu} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek nu} } % \glsxtrMathItalicXi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Xi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek xi} } % \glsxtrMathItalicOmicron \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Omicron} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek omicron} } % \glsxtrMathItalicPi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Pi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek pi} } % \glsxtrMathItalicRho \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Rho} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek rho} } % \glsxtrMathItalicSigma \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Sigma} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek sigma} } % \glsxtrMathItalicTau \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Tau} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek tau} } % \glsxtrMathItalicUpsilon \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Upsilon} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek upsilon} } % \glsxtrMathItalicPhi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Phi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek phi} } % \glsxtrMathItalicChi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Chi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek chi} } % \glsxtrMathItalicPsi \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Psi} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek psi} } % \glsxtrMathItalicOmega \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Omega} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the variations of math italic Greek omega} } % \glsxtrMathItalicPartial \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Partial} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the Unicode codepoint for math italic partial differential} } % \glsxtrMathItalicNabla \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Math\-Italic\-Nabla} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.27+} \desc{(sort rule) expands to the Unicode codepoint for nabla} } % \glsxtrSetWidest \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Set\-Widest} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{type}\margm{level}} \desc{written to the \ext{glstex} by the \resourceopt{set-widest} option} } % \glsxtrSetWidestFalback \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-Set\-Widest\-Fallback} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{type}\margm{level}} \desc{written to the \ext{glstex} by the \resourceopt{set-widest} option if \app{bib2gls} can't determine the widest name} } % \GlsXtrIfHasNonZeroChildCount \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-If\-Has\-Non\-Zero\-Child\-Count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.47+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{tests if the value in the \glosfield{childcount} field is non-zero (using \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldNonZero}). This requires the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option} } % \glsxtrdisplaysupploc \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-display\-supp\-loc} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.36+} \syntax{\margm{prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{format}\margm{src}\margm{location}} \desc{like \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc} but used for supplementary locations} } % \glsxtrmultisupplocation \gcmds{gls\-xtr\-multi\-supp\-location} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.36+} \syntax{\margm{src}\margm{location}\margm{format}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaysupploc} to format the location} } % \glsxtrdisplaylocnameref \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-display\-loc\-name\-ref} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{format}\margm{location}\margm{title}\margm{href}\margm{hcounter}\margm{file}} \desc{used to display \records\ created with \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}} } % \glsxtrtitlednamereflink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-titled\-name\-ref\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{format}\margm{location}\margm{title}\margm{file}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to display locations that have a title and are not associated with the \ctr{page} counter and don't have an associated \gls{glsxtrcounterlocfmt} command. The anchor is obtained from \gls{glsxtrrecentanchor}} } % \glsxtrlocationanchor \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-location\-anchor} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{defined by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to expand to the anchor constructed from \meta{counter} and \meta{hcounter}, which corresponds to the record counter} } % \glsxtrrecentanchor \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-recent\-anchor} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{defined by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to expand to the \meta{href} argument. This corresponds to the value of \gls{@currentHref} when the record was created} } % \glsxtractualanchor \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-actual\-anchor} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \desc{expands to the anchor required by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref}} } % \glsxtrsetactualanchor \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-actual\-anchor} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{counter}} \desc{hook used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to override the default definition of \gls{glsxtractualanchor}} } % \glsxtrlocfmt \gcmdmeta{gls\-xtr}{counter}{loc\-fmt} { \note{user defined} \syntax{\margm{location}\margm{title}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} for format a \location\ where the counter matches \meta{counter}} } % \glsxtrequationlocfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-equation\-loc\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.42+} \syntax{\margm{location}\margm{title}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to format a \location\ where the counter is \ctr{equation}} } % \glsxtrwrglossarylocfmt \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-wr\-glossary\-loc\-fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{location}\margm{title}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to format a \location\ where the counter is \ctr{wrglossary}} } % \glsxtrnamereflink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-name\-ref\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{format}\margm{title}\margm{target}\margm{file}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrdisplaylocnameref} to create a \location\ hyperlink} } % \glsxtrfmtinternalnameref \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fmt\-internal\-name\-ref} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{target}\margm{format}\margm{file}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrnamereflink} to create an internal \location\ hyperlink} } % \glsxtrfmtexternalnameref \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-fmt\-external\-name\-ref} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{target}\margm{format}\margm{title}\margm{file}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrnamereflink} to create an external \location\ hyperlink} } % \glsxtrnameloclink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-name\-loc\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.37+} \syntax{\margm{prefix}\margm{counter}\margm{format}\margm{location}\margm{text}\margm{file}} \desc{create an external \location\ hyperlink using the prefix and counter} } % RESOURCE OPTIONS \gidx{resourceopt}{\name{resource options}% \field{text}{resource option}% \desc{these options may be used in the optional argument of \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} and \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}} } % resource option loc-prefix \gresourceopt{loc\dhyphen prefix}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \desc{inserts a prefix in front of \idxpl{locationlist}} } % resource option loc-suffix \gresourceopt{loc\dhyphen suffix}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \desc{inserts a suffix at the end of \idxpl{locationlist}} } % resource option group-level \gresourceopt{group\dhyphen level} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{0} \desc{if the \switch{group} switch is used, this indicates which \idxpl{hierarchicallevel} should have the \gloskey{group} field set. The default is 0, which means the \idx{group} is only set for top-level entries. This option has no effect if the default \switch{no-group} is in effect} } % resource option label-prefix \gresourceopt{label\dhyphen prefix}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{inserts a prefix in front of primary entry labels} } % resource option dual-prefix \gresourceopt{dual\dhyphen prefix}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{dual.} \desc{inserts a prefix in front of dual entry labels} } % resource option src \gresourceopt{src}% {% \syntax{\meta{list}} \initvalcs{jobname} \desc{a comma-separated list of \ext+{bib} files that contain the entry data (the file extension may be omitted)} } % resource option selection \gresourceopt{selection}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{recorded and deps and see} \desc{the selection criteria} } % resource option sort-field \gresourceopt{sort\dhyphen field}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{sort} \desc{the field to use for sorting} } % resource option sort-replace \gresourceopt{sort\dhyphen replace}% {% \syntax{\meta{regex list}} \desc{the value is a command separated list of \margm{regex}\margm{replacement} pairs to perform on the sort value} } % resource option save-locations \gresourceopt{save\dhyphen locations}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{true} \defval{true} \desc{determines whether or not to save the \idx{locationlist}. This was originally a boolean option but as from \app{bib2gls} v3.0 it now takes additional values} } % resource option loc-counters \gresourceopt{loc\dhyphen counters}% {% \syntax{\meta{counter list}} \desc{indicates that the \idx{locationlist} should be divided up into counter groups corresponding to the listed counters} } % resource option sort \gresourceopt{sort}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{doc} \desc{identifies the sort method. The default is to use the document's language or (if not set) the default locale} } % resource option save-index-counter \gresourceopt{save\dhyphen index\dhyphen counter}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{false} \desc{determines whether or not to create the \glosfield{indexcounter} \idx{internalfield} with the value set to the first \ctr{wrglossary} \location. This option is designed to be used with the \opt{indexcounter} package option} } % resource option save-child-count \gresourceopt{save\dhyphen child\dhyphen count}% {% \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{if true, each entry will have the total number of child entries stored in the \glosfield{childcount} field and the list of children will be stored in the \glosfield{childlist} field} } % resource option post-description-dot \gresourceopt{post\dhyphen description\dhyphen dot}% {% \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{none} \desc{appends a \idx{fullstop} to the \gloskey{description} field. Allowed values: \optfmt{none} (no change), \optfmt{all} (append for all selected entries), \optfmt{check} (only appends according to certain criteria). Note this inserts the punctuation into the field value not in the \idx{postdeschook}. See the \app{bib2gls} manual for further details.} } % resource option alias-loc \gresourceopt{alias\dhyphen loc} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{transfer} \desc{if an entry has an \gloskey{alias} field, this setting indicates whether to keep the \idx{locationlist}, transfer it, or omit it} } % resource option see \gresourceopt{see} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{transfer} \desc{if an entry has an \gloskey{see} field, this setting indicates whether to show the cross-reference at the start or end of the \idx{locationlist} or omit it} } % resource option seealso \gresourceopt{seealso} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{transfer} \desc{if an entry has an \gloskey{seealso} field, this setting indicates whether to show the cross-reference at the start or end of the \idx{locationlist} or omit it} } % resource option alias \gresourceopt{alias} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \initval{transfer} \desc{if an entry has an \gloskey{alias} field, this setting indicates whether to show the cross-reference at the start or end of the \idx{locationlist} or omit it} } % resource option supplemental-locations \gresourceopt{supplemental\dhyphen locations} { \syntax{\meta{basename list}} \desc{add \locations\ from the supplemental documents to the corresponding entry's \idx{locationlist}} } % resource option prune-xr \gresourceopt{prune\dhyphen xr} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \desc{shortcut option that enables pruning for both the \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} fields} } % resource option sort-label-list \gresourceopt{sort\dhyphen label\dhyphen list} { \syntax{\meta{field-list}:\meta{sort}:\meta{csname}} \desc{instructs \app{bib2gls} to sort the given field values (which must contain comma-separated lists of labels) according to the given sort method. The final \code{:\meta{csname}} is optional and indicates that the sort value should be obtained by encapsulating the item with the command with the given control sequence name (which needs to be recognised by \app{bib2gls})} } % resource option compound-adjust-name \gresourceopt{compound\dhyphen adjust\dhyphen name} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{adjusts the \gloskey{name} of main entries in compound sets} } % resource option description-case-change \gresourceopt{description\dhyphen case\dhyphen change} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{applies a \idx{casechange} to the \gloskey{description} field} } % resource option name-case-change \gresourceopt{name\dhyphen case\dhyphen change} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{applies a \idx{casechange} to the \gloskey{name} field} } % resource option entry-type-aliases \gresourceopt{entry\dhyphen type\dhyphen aliases} { \syntax{\meta{key=val list}} \desc{the value is a comma-separated list of \code{\meta{org type}\dequals\meta{new type}} elements, where \meta{org type} is the original entry type given in the \ext{bib} file (without the leading \code{@}) and \meta{new type} is the entry type it should be treated as} } % resource option combine-dual-locations \gresourceopt{combine\dhyphen dual\dhyphen locations} { \syntax{\meta{value}} \desc{indicates whether or not to combine the \idxpl{locationlist} for the primary and dual entries, and indicates which entry (either or both) should have the \idx{locationlist}} } % resource option type \gresourceopt{type} { \syntax{\meta{glossary-type}} \desc{indicates that primary entries should be assigned to the given \idx{glossary}} } % resource option category \gresourceopt{category} { \syntax{\meta{category-label}} \desc{indicates that primary entries should be assigned to the given category} } % resource option group \gresourceopt{group} { \syntax{\meta{group-label}} \desc{indicates that primary entries should have the \gloskey{group} field set to the given value} } % resource option trigger-type \gresourceopt{trigger\dhyphen type} { \syntax{\meta{glossary-type}} \desc{indicates that entries with trigger records should be assigned to the given \idx{glossary}} } % resource option dual-type \gresourceopt{dual\dhyphen type} { \syntax{\meta{glossary-type}} \desc{indicates that dual entries should be assigned to the given \idx{glossary}} } % resource option dual-field \gresourceopt{dual\dhyphen field} { \syntax{\meta{field-name}} \initval{false} \defval{dual} \desc{indicates that dual entry labels should be stored in the given field} } % resource option dual-backlink \gresourceopt{dual\dhyphen backlink} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{switches on all the dual backlink settings} } % resource option flatten \gresourceopt{flatten} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{if true, sorting will ignore hierarchy and the \gloskey{parent} key won't be used in the \ext{glstex} file, but the parent entry will still be considered a dependency (unlike \resourceoptvalm{ignore-fields}{parent})} } % resource option ignore-fields \gresourceopt{ignore\dhyphen fields} { \syntax{\margm{field list}} \desc{instructs \app{bib2gls} to ignore the listed fields} } % resource option secondary \gresourceopt{secondary} { \syntax{\meta{sort}:\meta{field}:\meta{type}} \desc{re-sorts the entries according to the given sort method, using the value in the given \meta{field} as the sort value, and copies the entry to the glossary identified by \meta{type}. The \code{:\meta{field}} may be omitted, in which case the \gloskey{sort} field is assumed} } % resource option symbol-sort-fallback \gresourceopt{symbol\dhyphen sort\dhyphen fallback} { \syntax{\margm{field}} \desc{if the \gloskey{sort} key is being used to obtain the sort value but the \gloskey{sort} key hasn't been set for any symbol entries (for example, \atentry{symbol} or \atentry{number}) then the sort value will be obtained from the given \meta{field} instead. If the \gloskey{sort} key has been set or if a different field is being used for sorting, then this option has no effect} } % resource option field-aliases \gresourceopt{field\dhyphen aliases} { \syntax{\margm{src-field=target-field list}} \desc{makes \meta{src-field} an alias of \meta{target-field} for each pair in the list} } % resource option replicate-fields \gresourceopt{replicate\dhyphen fields} { \syntax{\margm{key=value list}} \desc{where each element in the \meta{key=value list} is in the form \code{\meta{src-field}\dequals\meta{dest-field list}}, this copies the value of the field identified by \meta{src-field} to each field in the comma-separated \meta{dest-field list}} } % resource option assign-fields \gresourceopt{assign\dhyphen fields} { \syntax{\margm{key=value list}} \desc{where each element in the \meta{key=value list} is in the form \code{\meta{dest-field}\dequals\meta{expression}} that assigns the value of \meta{dest-field} to the value obtained from \meta{expression}, providing a more complex alternative to \resourceopt{replicate-fields}} } % resource option interpret-fields \gresourceopt{interpret\dhyphen fields} { \syntax{\margm{field list}} \desc{replaces each field in the list with its interpreted value} } % resource option set-widest \gresourceopt{set\dhyphen widest} { \syntax{\meta{boolean}} \initval{false} \defval{true} \desc{instructs \app{bib2gls} to determine the widest entry name for use with styles like \glostyle{alttree}. Only suitable for textual names} } % resource option sort-rule \gresourceopt{sort\dhyphen rule} { \syntax{\margm{value}} \desc{the comparator rule to use with \resourceoptval{sort}{custom}} } % COMMANDS: LANGUAGE-SENSITIVE % \glossaryname \gcmd{glossary\-name}% {% \initval{Glossary}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the default \idx{glossary} title (provided by \sty{glossaries} if not already defined)} }% % \indexname \gcmd{index\-name}% {% \initval{Index}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the index title} }% % \acronymname \gcmd{acronym\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Acronyms}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the \code{acronym} \idx{glossary}} }% % \abbreviationsname \gcmd{abbre\-vi\-a\-tions\-name}% {% \initval{Abbreviations}% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the \code{abbreviations} \idx{glossary}. The default is \qt{Abbreviations} or \gls{acronymname} if \sty{babel} has been detected} }% % \glsnumbersgroupname \gcmd{gls\-numbers\-group\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Numbers}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the \code{numbers} \idx{group} and (if the \opt{numbers} package option is used) the \code{numbers} \idx{glossary}} }% % \glssymbolsgroupname \gcmd{gls\-symbols\-group\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Symbols}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the \code{symbols} \idx{group} and (if the \opt{symbols} package option is used) the \code{symbols} \idx{glossary}} }% % \seename \gcmd{see\-name}% {% \initval{see}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{used as a cross-reference tag (provided by \sty{glossaries} if not already defined)} }% % \seealsoname \gcmd{see\-also\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.16+} \initval{see also}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{used as a cross-reference tag. The default value is \gls{alsoname}, if that command has been defined, or \qt{see also}} }% % \alsoname \gcmd{also\-name}% {% \initval{see also}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{used as a cross-reference tag (provided by language packages, such as \sty{babel})} }% % \entryname \gcmd{entry\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Notation}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the name column for headed \env{tabular}-like styles} }% % \descriptionname \gcmd{description\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Description}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the description column for headed \env{tabular}-like styles} }% % \symbolname \gcmd{symbol\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Symbol}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the symbol column for headed \env{tabular}-like styles} }% % \pagelistname \gcmd{page\-list\-name}% {% \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \initval{Page List}% \note{language-sensitive} \desc{expands to the title of the \idx{locationlist} column for headed \env{tabular}-like styles} }% % COMMANDS: PLURAL SUFFIXES % \glspluralsuffix \gcmd{gls\-plural\-suffix}{ \desc{expands to the letter \qt{s} and is used to form default plurals. This command isn't language-sensitive as there's guarantee when it will be expanded. (It may be expanded when the entry is defined or it may be expanded when the entry is used). If you need to suppress this suffix for abbreviations, use the \catattr{noshortplural} attribute. If you need an apostrophe before the \qt{s} for single-letter abbreviations to avoid ambiguity, use the \catattr{aposplural} attribute} } % \acrpluralsuffix \gcmd{acr\-plural\-suffix}{ \banned \desc{used for the plural suffixes for the base package's acronym mechanism. Not used with \sty{glossaries-extra}'s abbreviations, which use \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}, \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} and commands provided for use with particular \idxpl{abbrvstyle}. This command should not be used with \sty{glossaries-extra}} } % \glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-abbrv\-plural\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.12+} \initvalcs{glspluralsuffix} \desc{the default plural suffix used for abbreviations} } % \abbrvpluralsuffix \gcmd{abbrv\-plural\-suffix}{ %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{style-sensitive abbreviation suffix. This is the command that's actually used in the value of the \gloskey{shortplural} key when an entry is defined with \gls{newabbreviation} (unless suppressed with the \catattr{noshortplural} attribute). This command is redefined by the \idxpl{abbrvstyle} to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} or the style's custom suffix command (such as \gls{glsxtrscsuffix})} } % \glsxtrscsuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-sc\-suffix}{ %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} 0.5+} \desc{the plural suffix used by the \idx{smallcaps} (\qt{sc}) \idxpl{abbrvstyle}. This switches off the \idx{smallcaps} font to prevent the suffix from also appearing in \idx{smallcaps}} } % \glsxtrsmsuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-sm\-suffix}{ %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} 0.5+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by the smaller (\qt{sm}) \idxpl{abbrvstyle} (such as \abbrstyle{short-sm-long})} } % \glsxtremsuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-em\-suffix}{ %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} 0.5+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by the emphasized (\qt{em}) \idxpl{abbrvstyle}} } % \glsxtrusersuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-user\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user}} } % \glsxtrscusersuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-sc\-user\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{the plural suffix used by styles like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user}} } % \glsxtrhyphensuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-hyphen\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.17+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by the \qt{hyphen} \idxpl{abbrvstyle} (such as \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen})} } % \glsxtronlysuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-only\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.17+} \initvalcs{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by the \qt{only} \idxpl{abbrvstyle} (such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only})} } % \glsxtrsconlysuffix \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-sc\-only\-suffix}{ \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \initvalcs{glsxtrscsuffix} \desc{the plural suffix used by the \qt{sc-only} \idxpl{abbrvstyle} (such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-sc-only})} } % COMMANDS: POST-LINK HOOKS % \glspostlinkhook \gcmd{gls\-post\-link\-hook}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.16+} \desc{a \idx{postlinkhook} used after all the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This is redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} to use \gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}} } % \glsxtrpostlinkhook \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-hook}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+}% \desc{a \idx{postlinkhook} that checks if a following \idx{fullstop} needs to be discarded, in which case it does \gls{glsxtrpostlinkendsentence}, otherwise it does \gls{glsxtrpostlink}} } % \glsxtrpostlinkendsentence \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-end\-sentence} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+}% \desc{a \idx{postlinkhook} that's used if a \idx{fullstop} is discarded in order to adjust the space factor (to denote the end of a sentence). If the \idx{catpostlinkhook} exists, and will be applied and the \idx{fullstop} will be restored} } % \glsxtrpostlink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+}% \desc{a \idx{postlinkhook} that does \gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat} if that command has been defined, where the category label is obtained from the entry that has just been referenced with a \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} command (using \gls{glslabel}). Does nothing if \gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat} isn't defined} } % \glsxtrpostlink \gcmd{glsxtrpostlinkcat}{% \name{{}\csfmt{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\meta{category}}} %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+}% \desc{the \idx{postlinkhook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}} } % \glsdefpostlink \gcmd{gls\-def\-post\-link}{% \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{definition}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+}% \desc{defines \idx{postlinkhook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category}. This simply (re)defines \gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat} for the given \meta{category} to \meta{definition}} } % \glspretopostlink \gcmd{gls\-pre\-to\-post\-link}{% \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{code}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+}% \desc{prepends \meta{code} to \idx{postlinkhook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category} (or simply defines it, if it doesn't already exist)} } % \glsapptopostlink \gcmd{gls\-app\-to\-post\-link}{% \syntax{\margm{category}\margm{code}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+}% \desc{appends \meta{code} to \idx{postlinkhook} associated with the category identified by the label \meta{category} (or simply defines it, if it doesn't already exist)} } % \glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-Add\-Desc\-On\-First\-Use}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+}% \desc{may be used within a \idx{postlinkhook} to display the description in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-Add\-Symbol\-On\-First\-Use}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+}% \desc{may be used within a \idx{postlinkhook} to display the symbol in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolDescOnFirstUse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-Add\-Symbol\-Desc\-On\-First\-Use}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+}% \desc{may be used within a \idx{postlinkhook} to display the symbol and description in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}} } % \glsxtrpostlinkSymbolDescSep \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-post\-link\-Symbol\-Desc\-Sep}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+}% \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolDescOnFirstUse} to separate the symbol and description, if both are set} } % \glsxtrdiscardperiod \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-discard\-period}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{discarded}\margm{no discard}\meta{token}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}}% \desc{if \meta{token} is a \idx{fullstop} and the entry's \idxpl{categoryattribute} indicate that a \idx{fullstop} should be discarded (such as \catattr{discardperiod}), then \meta{discarded} is performed, otherwise \meta{no discard} is done and the \meta{token} is processed. The actual test to determine if \meta{token} is a \idx{fullstop} is performed by \gls{glsxtrifperiod}. This command is used in \glspl{postlinkhook}} } % \glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-custom\-discard\-period} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.23+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \initval{\meta{false}} \desc{user hook to trigger a check for a following \idx{fullstop}. This should do \meta{true} if there should be a check for a following \idx{fullstop} otherwise should do \meta{false}} } % \glsxtrifperiod \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-period}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}\meta{token}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}}% \desc{does \meta{true} if \meta{token} is a \idx{fullstop}, otherwise does \meta{false}} } % \glsxtrdiscardperiodretainfirstuse \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-discard\-period\-retain\-first\-use}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+}% \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{discarded}\margm{no discard}\meta{token}} \desc{used to discard a following \idx{fullstop} when the \catattr{retainfirstuseperiod} attribute is set} } % \glsxtrdopostpunc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-do\-post\-punc}{% \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \syntax{\margm{code}\meta{token}} \desc{if \meta{token} is a recognised punctuation character (see \gls{glsxtrifnextpunc}) this does the punctuation character and then \meta{code}, otherwise if does \meta{code} followed by \meta{token}} } % \glsxtrifnextpunc \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-next\-punc}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{true}\margm{false}} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}}% \desc{performs \meta{true} if this command is followed by a recognised punctuation character otherwise does \meta{false}. The list of recognised punctuation marks is initialised to \code{.,:;?!} (\idx{fullstop}, comma, colon, semicolon, question mark, and exclamation mark). Additional punctuation characters can be added with \gls{glsxtraddpunctuationmark}} } % \glsxtraddpunctuationmark \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-add\-punctuation\-mark}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{token(s)}} \desc{adds \meta{token(s)} to the list of punctuation characters used by \gls{glsxtrifnextpunc}. You may list multiple characters at the same time to add a batch, but don't add any separators (including spaces). Note that each character must be a single token, which means a single-byte character for \pdfLaTeX. Multi-byte characters (\idx{utf8}) will required a native Unicode engine (\XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX)} } % \glsxtrsetpunctuationmarks \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-set\-punctuation\-marks}{% %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{token list}} \desc{sets the punctuation list used by \gls{glsxtrifnextpunc}. The \meta{token list} must be a non-delimited list of single tokens that represent each punctuation character. Note that the element of the list must be a single token, which means a single-byte character for \pdfLaTeX\ (for example, \idx{ascii}). Multi-byte characters (\idx{utf8}) will required a native Unicode engine (\XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX)} } % COMMANDS: bib2gls % \bibglssettotalrecordcount \gcmd{bib\-gls\-set\-total\-record\-count} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{value}} \desc{sets the total record count for the given entry} \field{seealso}{switch.record-count} } % \bibglssetrecordcount \gcmd{bib\-gls\-set\-record\-count} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}\margm{value}} \desc{sets the \meta{counter} record count for the given entry} \field{seealso}{switch.record-count} } % \bibglssetlocationrecordcount \gcmd{bib\-gls\-set\-location\-record\-count} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.1+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}\margm{location}\margm{value}} \desc{sets the location record count for the given entry} \field{seealso}{switch.record-count-unit} } % \bibglsprimaryprefixlabel \gcmd{bib\-gls\-primary\-prefix\-label} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.8+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}} \desc{hook written to the \ext{glstex} file identifying the primary label prefix} } % \bibglsdualprefixlabel \gcmd{bib\-gls\-dual\-prefix\-label} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.8+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}} \desc{hook written to the \ext{glstex} file identifying the dual label prefix} } % \bibglstertiaryprefixlabel \gcmd{bib\-gls\-tertiary\-prefix\-label} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls} v1.8+} \syntax{\margm{label-prefix}} \desc{hook written to the \ext{glstex} file identifying the tertiary label prefix} } % \GlsXtrTotalRecordCount \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Total\-Record\-Count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the entry's total record count (stored in the \glosfield{recordcount} field) or to 0 if not set} } % \GlsXtrRecordCount \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Record\-Count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}} \desc{expands to the entry's record count for the given \idxc{locationcounter}{counter} (stored in the \glosfield{recordcount.counter} field) or to 0 if not set} } % \GlsXtrLocationRecordCount \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Location\-Record\-Count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{counter}\margm{location}} \desc{expands to the entry's record count for the given \idxc{locationcounter}{counter} and \location\ (stored in the \glosfield{recordcount.counter.location} field) or to 0 if not set} } % \glsxtrenablerecordcount \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-enable\-record\-count} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \desc{redefines the \idx{glslike} commands (except \gls{glsdisp}) to use the analogous record count commands (\gls{rgls} etc)} } % \rgls \gcmdspa{rgls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{gls} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rglsformat,switch.record-count} } % \rglspl \gcmdspa{rgls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{glspl} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rglsplformat,switch.record-count} } % \rGls \gcmdspa{rGls} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{Gls} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rGlsformat,switch.record-count} } % \rGlspl \gcmdspa{rGls\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{Glspl} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rGlsplformat,switch.record-count} } % \rGLS \gcmdspa{rGLS} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{GLS} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rGLSformat,switch.record-count} } % \rGLSpl \gcmdspa{rGLS\-pl} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert}} \desc{like \gls{GLSpl} but hooks into the entry's record count} \field{seealso}{glsxtrifrecordtrigger,rGlsplformat,switch.record-count} } % \glsxtrifrecordtrigger \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-if\-record\-trigger} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{true}\margm{false}} \desc{does \meta{true} if the entry's total record count (obtained with \gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue}) exceeds the value supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute, otherwise does \meta{false}} \field{seealso}{rgls,GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute,switch.record-count} } % \glsxtrrecordtriggervalue \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-record\-trigger\-value} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}} \desc{expands to the trigger value used by \gls{glsxtrifrecordtrigger}} \field{seealso}{rgls,switch.record-count} } % \glstriggerrecordformat \gcmd{gls\-trigger\-record\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{location}} \desc{used as a special location format that indicates that the record is a trigger record} \field{seealso}{rgls,switch.record-count} } % \GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Set\-Record\-Count\-Attribute} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{category-list}\margm{value}} \desc{sets the \catattr{recordcount} attribute to \meta{value} for each of the listed categories} } % \rglsformat \gcmd{rgls\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rgls} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \rglsplformat \gcmd{rgls\-pl\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rglspl} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \rGlsformat \gcmd{rGls\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rGls} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \rGlsplformat \gcmd{rGls\-pl\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rGlspl} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \rGLSformat \gcmd{rGLS\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rGLS} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \rGLSplformat \gcmd{rGLS\-pl\-format} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.21+} \syntax{\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}} \desc{format used by \gls{rGLSpl} if the entry's record count is more than the given trigger value} } % \bibglsnewdualindexsymbolsecondary \gcmd{bib\-gls\-new\-dual\-index\-symbol\-secondary} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls}} \syntax{\margm{label}\margm{options}\margm{name}\margm{description}} \desc{defines secondary terms provided with \atentry{dualindexsymbol}} } % \bibglssetlastgrouptitle \gcmd{bib\-gls\-set\-last\-group\-title} { \providedby{\app{bib2gls}} \syntax{\margm{cs}\margm{specs}} \desc{sets the last group title} } % \GlsXtrDualField \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Dual\-Field} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.30+} \initval{dual} \desc{expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used by \gls{GlsXtrDualBackLink}} } % \GlsXtrDualBackLink \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Dual\-Back\-Link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} v1.30+} \syntax{\margm{text}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{Adds a hyperlink to the given entry's dual (whose label is stored in the field given by \gls{GlsXtrDualField}) with the given hyperlink text} } % COMMANDS: ON THE FLY % \GlsXtrEnableOnTheFly \gcmds{Gls\-Xtr\-Enable\-On\-The\-Fly} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \desc{enables on the fly commands, such as \gls{glsxtr}} } % \glsxtr \gcmd{gls\-xtr} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\oargm{gls-options}\oargm{dfn-options}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{if \meta{entry-label} has already been defined, this just references it, otherwise the entry is defined. This command must be enabled with \gls{GlsXtrEnableOnTheFly}} } % \glsxtrpl \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\oargm{gls-options}\oargm{dfn-options}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtr} but shows the plural form} } % \Glsxtr \gcmd{Gls\-xtr} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\oargm{gls-options}\oargm{dfn-options}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtr} but applies \idx{sentencecase}} } % \Glsxtrpl \gcmd{Gls\-xtr\-pl} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\oargm{gls-options}\oargm{dfn-options}\margm{entry-label}} \desc{as \gls{glsxtrpl} but applies \idx{sentencecase}} } % \glsxtrcat \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-cat} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \initval{general} \desc{expands to the default category set by commands like \gls{glsxtr}} } % COMMANDS: OTHER % \GlsXtrInternalLocationHyperlink \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Internal\-Location\-Hyper\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.29+} \syntax{\margm{counter}\margm{prefix}\margm{location}} \desc{used by \gls{glsxtrlocationhyperlink} to create an internal hyperlink to the given location (advanced command, see documented code for use)} } % \glsxtrlocationhyperlink \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-location\-hyper\-link} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.14+} \syntax{\margm{counter}\margm{prefix}\margm{location}} \desc{used to create a hyperlink to either an external or an internal location, depending on whether or not \gls{glsxtrsupplocationurl} is defined and not empty (advanced command, see documented code for use)} } % \glsxtrundefaction \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-un\-def\-action} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \syntax{\margm{message}\margm{additional help}} \desc{will either produce an error or a warning, depending on the \opt{undefaction} setting. In the \envfmt{document} environment this will also generate the unknown marker (\idx{unknowntag})} } % \glsxtrundeftag \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-un\-def\-tag} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.08+} \initval{\glsxtrundeftag} \desc{expands to the unknown marker (\idx{unknowntag})} } % \ProvidesGlossariesExtraLang \gcmd{Provides\-Glossaries\-Extra\-Lang} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.3+} \syntax{\margm{tag}} \desc{should be placed at the start of a \sty{glossaries-extra} \ext{ldf} file} } % \RequireGlossariesExtraLang \gcmd{Require\-Glossaries\-Extra\-Lang} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.3+} \syntax{\margm{tag}} \desc{indicates that a \sty{glossaries-extra} \ext{ldf} file should be input, if it hasn't already been input} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningHead \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Head} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}\margm{file}} \desc{produces the header boilerplate text if a glossary file is missing} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningEmptyStart \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Empty\-Start} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{produces the boilerplate text if a glossary is probably empty} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningEmptyMain \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Empty\-Main} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{produces the boilerplate text if the probably empty glossary is the \code{main} one} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningEmptyNotMain \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Empty\-Not\-Main} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}} \desc{produces the boilerplate text if the probably empty glossary is not the \code{main} one} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningCheckFile \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Check\-File} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{file}} \desc{advisory message to check the file contents} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningAutoMake \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Auto\-Make} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-label}} \desc{advisory message when \opt{automake} has been used} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningMisMatch \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Mis\-Match} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{advisory message on mis-matching \gls{makenoidxglossaries}} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningBuildInfo \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Build\-Info} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{build advice} } % \GlsXtrRecordWarning \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Record\-Warning} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.31+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-type}} \desc{incorrect use of \gls{printglossary} with non-hybrid \opt{record}} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningTail \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-Tail} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \desc{final paragraph of missing glossary boilerplate text} } % \GlsXtrNoGlsWarningNoOut \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-No\-Gls\-Warning\-No\-Out} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{file}} \desc{advisory if no output file was created} } % \glspar \gcmd{gls\-par} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries}} \desc{paragraph break (for instances where \gls{par} can't be used directly)} } % \glsbackslash \gcmd{gls\-back\-slash} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.11+} \desc{expands to a literal backslash} } % \glspercentchar \gcmd{gls\-percent\-char} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.10+} \desc{expands to a literal percent sign} } % \glstildechar \gcmd{gls\-tilde\-char} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries} v4.10+} \desc{expands to a literal tilde character} } % \GlsXtrExpandedFmt \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Expanded\-Fmt} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.30+} \syntax{\margm{cs}\margm{content}} \desc{fully-expands \meta{content} and passes it to \meta{cs}, which must be a command that takes a single argument} } % \GlossariesExtraWarning \gcmd{Glossaries\-Extra\-Warning} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.0+} \syntax{\margm{message}} \desc{writes a warning in the transcript with the current line number. The \opt{nowarn} option redefines this command to do nothing} } % \GlossariesExtraWarningNoLine \gcmd{Glossaries\-Extra\-Warning\-No\-Line} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5+} \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \syntax{\margm{message}} \desc{writes a warning in the transcript without a corresponding line number. The \opt{nowarn} option redefines this command to do nothing} } % \GlossariesExtraInfo \gcmd{Glossaries\-Extra\-Info} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.51+} \syntax{\margm{message}} \desc{writes an information message to the transcript} } % \GlsXtrWarnDeprecatedAbbrStyle \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Warn\-Deprecated\-Abbr\-Style} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.04+} \syntax{\margm{old-name}\margm{new-name}} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that a deprecated abbreviation style has been used} } % \glsxtrNoGlossaryWarning \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-No\-Glossary\-Warning} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.3+} \syntax{\margm{glossary-type}} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that the given glossary is missing} } % \GlsXtrUnknownDialectWarning \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Unknown\-Dialect\-Warning} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.32+} \syntax{\margm{locale}\margm{root language}} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that a valid dialect label can't be determined for the given locale and root language} } % \glsxtrstarflywarn \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-star\-fly\-warn} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that the experimental starred version of \gls{GlsXtrEnableOnTheFly} has been used} } % \GlsXtrWarning \gcmd{Gls\-Xtr\-Warning} { %\providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v0.5.4+} \syntax{\margm{options}\margm{entry}} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that the given options list has been ignored by the given entry because it has already been defined} } % \glsxtrmglsWarnAllSkipped \gcmd{gls\-xtr\-mgls\-Warn\-All\-Skipped} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \syntax{\margm{message}\margm{insert}\margm{fmt-cs}} \desc{issues the given warning message with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} and does \code{\meta{fmt-cs}\margm{insert}} (this warning is used if all elements of a multi-entry set are skipped)} } % \mpglsWarning \gcmd{mpglsWarning} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.48+} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} indicating that \sty{glossaries-prefix} is required for \gls{mpgls} family of commands} } % \GlossariesAbbrStyleTooComplexWarning \gcmd{Glossaries\-Abbr\-Style\-Too\-Complex\-Warning} { \providedby{\sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+} \desc{issues a warning with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning} when a command is used that isn't supported by a complex abbreviation style} } % GENERAL COMMANDS AND ENVIRONMENTS (index only) \genv{document}{} \genv{description}{} \genv{equation}{} \genv{align}{} \genv{figure}{} \genv{table}{} \genv{tabular}{} \genv{long\-table}{}% longtable \genv{super\-tabular}{}% supertabular \genv{the\-index}{}% theindex \genv{multi\-cols}{}% multicols \genv{multi\-cols*}{}% multicols* \gcmd{item}{\syntax{\oarg{marker}}}% \item \gcmd{index\-space}{}% \indexspace \gcmd{hsize}{}% \hsize \gcmd{index}{}% \index \gcmd{actual\-char}{}% \actualchar \gcmd{level\-char}{}% \levelchar \gcmd{quote\-char}{}% \quotechar \gcmd{encap\-char}{}% \encapchar \gcmd{table\-of\-contents}{}% \tableofcontents \gcmd{char}{}% \char \gcmd{null}{}% \null \gcmd{relax}{}% \relax \gcmd{tab\-u\-lar\-new\-line}{}% \tabularnewline \gcmd{top\-rule}{}% \toprule \gcmd{mid\-rule}{}% \midrule \gcmd{bottom\-rule}{}% \bottomrule \gcmd{par\-indent}{}% \parindent \gcmd{line\-width}{}% \linewidth \gcmd{tab\-col\-sep}{}% \tabcolsep \gcmd{@gobble}{}% \@gobble \gcmd{@first\-of\-one}{}% \@firstofone \gcmd{@first\-of\-two}{}% \@firstoftwo \gcmd{@second\-of\-two}{}% \@secondoftwo \gcmd{par}{}% \par \gcmd{protect}{}% \protect \gcmd{string}{}% \string \gcmd{chapter}{}% \chapter \gcmd{section}{}% \section \gcmd{part}{}% \part \gcmd{expand\-after}{}% \expandafter \gcmd{expand\-once}{}% \expandonce \gcmd{un\-skip}{}% \unskip \gcmd{leave\-v\-mode}{}% \leavevmode \gcmd{let}{}% \let \gcmd{hfil}{}% \hfil \gcmd{caption}{}% \caption \gcmd{label}{}% \label \gcmd{ref}{}% \ref \gcmd{name\-ref}{}% \nameref \gcmd{Get\-Title\-String\-Disable\-Commands}{}% \GetTitleStringDisableCommands \gcmd{Get\-Title\-String\-Set\-up}{}% \GetTitleStringSetup \gcmd{textsc}{}% \textsc \gcmd{textbf}{}% \textbf \gcmd{textup}{}% \textup \gcmd{emph}{}% \emph \gcmd{underline}{}% \underline \gcmd{text\-smaller}{}% \textsmaller \gcmd{text\-larger}{}% \textlarger \gcmd{page\-ref}{}% \pageref \gcmd{job\-name}{}% \jobname \gcmd{input}{}% \input \gcmd{the\-page}{}% \thepage \gcmdmeta{the}{counter}{}{}% \the \gcmdmeta{theH}{counter}{}{}% \theH \gcmd{foreign\-language}{}% \foreignlanguage \gpunccmd{amp}{\&}{}% \& \gpunccmd{dollar}{\$}{}% \$ \gpunccmd{bksl}{\glsbackslash}{}% \\ \gpunccmd{cs.dot}{.}{}% \. \gpunccmd{cs.slash}{/}{}% \/ \gpunccmd{cs.pipe}{|}{}% \| \gpunccmd{cs.plus}{+}{}% \+ \gpunccmd{cs.lt}{<}{}% \< \gpunccmd{cs.gt}{<}{}% \> \gpunccmd{cs.star}{*}{}% \* \gpunccmd{cs.circum}{\textasciicircum}{}% \^ \gpunccmd{cs.openparen}{(}{}% \( \gpunccmd{cs.closeparen}{)}{}% \) \gpunccmd{cs.opensq}{[}{}% \[ \gpunccmd{cs.closesq}{]}{}% \] \gpunccmd{cs.quote}{"}{}% \" \gpunccmd{cs.tilde}{\textasciitilde}{}% \~ \gpunccmd{cs.hyphen}{-}{}% \- \gpunccmd{cs.question}{?}{}% \? \gpunccmd{cs.hash}{\#}{}% \# \gpunccmd{cs.colon}{:}{}% \: \gcmd{new\-command}{}% \newcommand \gcmd{re\-new\-command}{}% \renewcommand \gcmd{provide\-command}{}% \providecommand \gcmd{step\-counter}{}% \stepcounter \gcmd{ref\-step\-counter}{}% \refstepcounter \gcmd{@current\-label}{}% \@currentlabel \gcmd{@current\-label\-name}{}% \@currentlabelname \gcmd{@current\-Href}{}% \@currentHref \gcmd{cs\-def}{}% \csdef \gcmd{cs\-let}{}% \cslet \gcmd{cs\-let\-cs}{}% \csletcs \gcmd{let\-cs}{}% \letcs \gcmd{if\-cs\-undef}{}% \ifcsundef \gcmd{if\-undef}{}% \ifundef \gcmd{if\-def\-empty}{}% \ifdefempty \gcmd{if\-def\-string}{}% \ifdefstring \gcmd{if\-cs\-string}{}% \ifcsstring \gcmd{if\-cs\-void}{}% \ifcsvoid \gcmd{app\-to}{}% \appto \gcmd{pre\-to}{}% \preto \gcmd{list\-cs\-add}{}% \listcsadd \gcmd{list\-cs\-gadd}{}% \listcsgadd \gcmd{list\-cs\-eadd}{}% \listcseadd \gcmd{list\-cs\-xadd}{}% \listcsxadd \gcmd{do\-list\-cs\-loop}{}% \dolistcsloop \gcmd{for\-list\-cs\-loop}{}% \forlistcsloop \gcmd{if\-in\-list\-cs}{}% \ifinlistcs \gcmd{xif\-in\-list\-cs}{}% \xifinlistcs \gcmd{hyper\-target}{}% \hypertarget \gcmd{hyper\-link}{}% \hyperlink \gcmd{hyper\-ref}{}% \hyperref \gcmd{hl}{}% \hl \gcmd{so}{}% \so \gcmd{ul}{}% \ul \gcmd{mbox}{}% \mbox \gcmd{fbox}{}% \fbox \gcmd{text\-super\-script}{}% \textsuperscript \gcmd{text\-sub\-script}{}% \textsubscript \gcmd{foot\-note}{}% \footnote \gcmd{upper\-case}{}% \uppercase \gcmd{Make\-Upper\-case}{}% \MakeUppercase \gcmd{Make\-Text\-Upper\-case}{}% \MakeTextUppercase \gcmd{Make\-Text\-Lower\-case}{}% \MakeTextLowercase \gcmd{Make\-Lower\-case}{}% \MakeLowercase \gcmd{main\-matter}{}% \mainmatter \gcmd{front\-matter}{}% \frontmatter \gcmd{back\-matter}{}% \backmatter \gcmd{@start\-toc}{}% \@starttoc \gcmd{mark\-right}{}% \markright \gcmd{mark\-both}{}% \markboth \gcmd{pdf\-book\-mark}{}% \pdfbookmark \gcmd{tex\-or\-pdf\-string}{}% \texorpdfstring \gcmd{No\-Case\-Change}{}% \NoCaseChange \gcmd{pagestyle}{}% \pagestyle \gcmd{alph}{}% \alph \gcmd{Alph}{}% \Alph \gcmd{arabic}{}% \arabic \gcmd{roman}{}% \roman \gcmd{Roman}{}% \Roman \gcmd{@for}{}% \@for \gcmd{@endfortrue}{}% \@endfortrue \gcmd{alpha}{}% \alpha \gcmd{beta}{}% \beta \gcmd{Delta}{}% \Delta \gcmd{digamma}{}% \digamma \gcmd{up\-alpha}{}% \upalpha \gcmd{up\-beta}{}% \upbeta \gcmd{If\-Track\-ed\-Language\-File\-Exists}{}% \IfTrackedLanguageFileExists % GENERAL COUNTERS \gctr{page}{} \gctr{section}{} \gctr{chapter}{} \gctr{part}{} \gctr{equation}{} \gctr{figure}{} \gctr{table}{} % TERMS \gterm{indexingapp}{\name{indexing application}% \desc{an application (piece of software) separate from \protect\TeX/\protect\LaTeX\ that collates and sorts information that has an associated page reference. Generally the information is an index entry but in this case the information is a \idx{glossary} entry. There are two main indexing applications that are used with \TeX: \app+{makeindex} and \app+{xindy}. (There is also a new application called \app{xindex}, but this isn't supported by \sty{glossaries} or \sty{glossaries-extra}.) The \sty{glossaries-extra} package additionally supports \app{bib2gls}. These are all \idx{cli} applications.}% }% \gterm{indexing}{% \name{indexing (or recording)} \field{text}{indexing} \desc{the process of saving the \idx+{entrylocation} and any associated information that is required in the \idx{glossary}. In the case of \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, the \idx{entrylocation}, \idxc{locationencap}{encap}, entry item and sort value are written to a supplementary file associated with the \idx{glossary} that is subsequently read by \app{makeindex}\slash\app{xindy}. In the case of \app{bib2gls} and the \qt{noidx} method, the \idx{entrylocation}, \idxc{locationencap}{encap} and label is written to the \ext+{aux} file. With \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}, the current title and hyperlink target are also included. With \app{bib2gls}, each line of data in the \ext{aux} is referred to as a \qt{record} and indexing is referred to as \qt{recording}. The \optval{record}{hybrid} option indexes twice: a \app{bib2gls} record in the \ext{aux} file and a \app{makeindex}\slash\app{xindy} line in the corresponding file, See \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}} } \gterm{glossary}% {% \common \name{glossary} \field{plural}{glossaries} \desc{technically a glossary is an alphabetical list of words relating to a particular topic. For the purposes of describing the \sty{glossaries} and \sty{glossaries-extra} packages, a glossary is either the list produced by commands like \gls{printglossary} or \gls{printunsrtglossary} (which may or may not be ordered alphabetically) or a glossary is a set of entry labels where the set is identified by the glossary label or type} } \gidx{mini-glossary}{\field{plural}{mini-glossaries}} \gidx{glossmini}{\name{glossary, mini}\field{see}{idx.mini-glossary}} \gtermacr{cli}{CLI}{command-line interface}% {% \desc{an application that doesn't have a graphical user interface. That is, an application that doesn't have any windows, buttons or menus and can be run in \dickimawhref{latex/novices/html/terminal.html}{a command prompt or terminal}}% }% \gtermacr{gui}{GUI}{graphical user interface}% {% \desc{an application that has windows, buttons or menus} } \gtermacr{ascii}{ASCII}{American Standard Code for Information Interchange} {% \desc{a single-byte character encoding. Related blog article: \blog{binary-files-text-files-and-file-encodings/}{Binary Files, Text Files and File Encodings}} } \gtermacr{utf8}{UTF\glsxtrrevert{-8}}{Unicode Transformation Format (8-bit)} {% \desc{a variable-width encoding that uses 8-bit code units. This means that some characters are represented by more that one byte. \XeLaTeX\ and \LuaLaTeX\ treat the multi-byte sequence as a single token, but the older \LaTeX\ formats have single-byte tokens, which can cause complications, although these have mostly been addressed with the newer kernels introduced over the past few years. Related blog article: \blog{binary-files-text-files-and-file-encodings/}{Binary Files, Text Files and File Encodings}} } \gterm{idx.group}{\name{group (letters, numbers, symbols)} \field{text}{group}% \desc{a logical division within a \idx{glossary} that is typically a by-product of the \idx{indexingapp}['s] sorting algorithm. See also \gallerypage{logicaldivisions}{Gallery: Logical Glossary Divisions (type vs group vs parent)}}% }% \gterm{hierarchicallevel}{\name{hierarchical level}% \desc{a number that indicates how many ancestors an entry has. An entry with no parent has hierarchical level~0. If an entry has a parent then the hierarchical level for the entry is one more than the hierarchical level of the parent. Most styles will format an entry according to its hierarchical level, giving prominence to level~0 entries, although some may have a maximum supported limit. The \idx{unsrtfam} allow the hierarchical level to be locally adjusted by adding an offset (\printglossopt{leveloffset}) or to have hierarchy ignored (\printglossopt{flatten})} } \gterm{locationlist}{\name{location list}% \desc{a list of \idxpl+{entrylocation} (also called a number list). May be suppressed for all \idxpl{glossary} with the package option \opt{nonumberlist} or for individual \idxpl{glossary} with \printglossopt{nonumberlist}. With \app{bib2gls}, the list may also be suppressed with \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false}} } \gterm{locationencap}{\name{location encap (format)} \field{text}{location encap} \desc{a command used to encapsulate an \idx{entrylocation}. The control sequence name (without the leading backslash) is identified by the \glsopt{format} key. The default encap is \gls{glsnumberformat}} } \gterm{locationcounter}{\name{location counter} \desc{the counter used to obtain the \idx{entrylocation}} } \gterm{entrylocation}{\common\name{entry location}% \desc{the location of the entry in the document (obtained from the \idx{locationcounter} or from the \glsopt{thevalue} option). This defaults to the page number on which the entry has been referenced with any of the \idx{glslike}, \idx{glstextlike} or \gls{glsadd} commands. An entry may have multiple locations that form a list} } \gidx{numberlist}{\name{number list}\field{alias}{locationlist}} \gterm{ignoredlocation}{\name{ignored location (or record)}% \field{text}{ignored location} \desc{a \location\ that uses \encap{glsignore} as the \idxc{locationencap}{encap}. With \app{bib2gls}, this indicates that the entry needs to be selected but the \location\ isn't added to the \idx{locationlist}. With other methods, this will simply create an invisible \location, which can result in unwanted commas if the \idx{locationlist} has other items} } \gidx{locationignored}{\name{location, ignored\slash invisible}% \field{see}{ignoredlocation}} \gterm{ignoredglossary}{\name{ignored glossary}% \field{plural}{ignored glossaries}% \desc{a \idx{glossary} that has been defined using a command like \gls{newignoredglossary}. These \idxpl{glossary} are omitted by iterative commands, such as \gls{printglossaries} and \gls{printunsrtglossaries}. An ignored \idx{glossary} can only be displayed with \gls{printunsrtglossary} or \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}} } \gidx{glossaryignored}{\name{glossary, ignored}\field{see}{ignoredglossary}} \gterm{firstuseflag}{\name{first use flag}% \common \desc{a conditional that keeps track of whether or not an entry has been referenced by any of the \idx{glslike} commands (which can adjust their behaviour according to whether or not this flag is true). The conditional is true if the entry hasn't been used by one of these commands (or if the flag has been reset) and false if it has been used (or if the flag has been unset). Note that multi-entries have their own flag that's distinct from the first use flags of the individual elements} } \gterm{firstuse}{\name{first use}% \common \desc{the first time an entry is used by a command that unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} (or the first time since the flag was reset). For multi-entry sets, see \idx{mfirstuse}} } \gterm{firstusetext}{\name{first use text}% \common \desc{the \idx{linktext} that is displayed on \idx{firstuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands} } \gterm{subsequentuse}{\name{subsequent use} \common \desc{using an entry that unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} when it has already been unset} } \gterm{mfirstuseflag}{\name{multi-entry first use flag}% \desc{a conditional that keeps track of whether or not a multi-entry has been used. This is distinct from the \idxpl{firstuseflag} of the individual elements} } \gterm{mfirstuse}{\name{multi-entry first use}% \field{text}{first use} \desc{the first time a multi-entry is referenced (or the first time since the \idx{mfirstuseflag} was reset). This is not necessary the \idx{firstuse} of any of the individual entries that form the set} } \gterm{msubsequentuse}{\name{multi-entry subsequent use}% \field{text}{subsequent use} \desc{when a multi-entry that has already been marked as used is referenced. This is not necessary the \idx{subsequentuse} of any of the individual entries that form the set} } \gterm{glslike}{\common\name{{}\csfmt{gls}-like} \desc{commands like \gls{gls} and \gls{glsdisp} that change the \idx{firstuseflag}. These commands index the entry (if indexing is enabled), create a hyperlink to the entry's \idx{glossary} listing (if enabled) and unset the \idx{firstuseflag}. These commands end with the \idx{postlinkhook}} } \gterm{glstextlike}{\common\name{{}\csfmt{glstext}-like} \desc{commands like \gls{glstext} and \gls{glslink} that don't change the \idx{firstuseflag}. These commands index the entry (if indexing is enabled) and create a hyperlink to the entry's \idx{glossary} listing (if enabled). These commands end with the \idx{postlinkhook}} } \gterm{linktext}{\name{link text}% \desc{the text produced by \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands that have the potential to be a hyperlink} } \gterm{postlinkhook}{\name{post-link hook} \desc{a hook (command) that is used after \idx{linktext} to allow code to be automatically added. The base \sty{glossaries} package provides a general purpose hook \gls{glspostlinkhook}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package modifies this command to provide additional hooks, including \glspl{catpostlinkhook}} } \gterm{catpostlinkhook}{\name{category post-link hook} \desc{a \idx{postlinkhook} called \gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat} that is associated with a particular \idx{category}} } \gterm{postdeschook}{\name{post-description hook}% \desc{a hook (\gls{glspostdescription}) included in some \idxpl{glossarystyle} that is used after the description is displayed. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package modifies this command to provide additional hooks, including \glspl{catpostdeschook}. The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package modifies the predefined styles provided with \sty{glossaries} to ensure that they all use \gls{glspostdescription} to allow the \glspl{catpostdeschook} to be implemented} } \gterm{catpostdeschook}{\name{category post-description hook} \desc{a \gls{postdeschook} called \gls{glsxtrpostdesccategory} that is associated with a particular \idx{category}} } \gterm{postnamehook}{\name{post-name hook}% \desc{a hook (command) that is used after the name is displayed in \idxpl{glossarystyle}. These hooks are implemented by \gls{glossentryname}, which needs to be present in the \idx{glossarystyle}. The main hook is \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook}, which implements auto-indexing (see \sectionref{sec:autoindex}), performs a general purpose hook \gls{glsextrapostnamehook} and a \idx{category}-specific hook \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory}} } \gterm{catpostnamehook}{\name{category post-name hook} \desc{a \gls{postnamehook} called \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory} that is associated with a particular \idx{category}} } \gterm{standaloneentry}% {% \name{standalone entry} \desc{normally the \idx{linktext} target is created in the \idx{glossary}, where the entry's name and description (and optionally other information, such as the symbol) are shown. It may be that you don't want a list but need to have the name and description somewhere in the document text. These are standalone entries. Whilst it is possible to simply use \gls{glsentryname} and \gls{glsentrydesc}, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a way inserting the name that includes the hypertarget for the \idx{linktext} and obeys the \idx{postnamehook}} } \gterm{resourceset}% {% \name{resource set} \desc{all the settings (\idxpl{resourceopt}) and entries associated with a particular instance of \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} (or \gls{glsxtrresourcefile})} } \gterm{resourcefile}% {% \name{resource file} \desc{the \ext+{glstex} file created by \app{bib2gls} and loaded by \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} (or \gls{glsxtrresourcefile})} } \gterm{field}% {% \name{field} \desc{entry data is stored in fields. These may have a corresponding key used to set the value, such as \gloskey{name} or \gloskey{description}, but field values may also be set using commands like \gls{GlsXtrSetField}, in which case there doesn't need to be a corresponding key. Some fields are considered \idxpl{internalfield}. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, it will only recognise fields in the \ext{bib} file that have had a key defined in the document or that are special to \app{bib2gls}} } \gterm{internalfield}% {% \name{internal field} \desc{an internal \idx{field} may refer to a key that shouldn't be used in the \ext{bib} file (\idx{bib2glsinternalfield}), such as the \gloskey{group} field, or it may refer to the \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{label} used to internally represent the \idx{field} (which may or may not match the key used to set the \idx{field} or may not have an associated key), such as \fieldfmt{useri} which corresponds to the \gloskey{user1} key, or it may refer to a \idx{field} that is only ever used internally that should not be explicitly modified, such as the field used to store the entry's hierarchical level } } \gterm{bib2glsinternalfield}% {% \name{internal field (\appfmt{bib2gls})} \desc{a \idx{field} that is used or assigned by \app{bib2gls} that should typically not be used in the \ext+{bib} file} } \gterm{internalfieldlabel}% {% \name{internal field label} \desc{the field label that forms part of the internal control sequence used to store the field value. This may or may not match the key used to assign the value when defining the entry. See the \ctanmirrornofn{macros/latex/contrib/glossaries/glossaries-user.html\#tab:fieldmap}{\qt{Key to Field Mappings}} table in the \sty{glossaries} user manual} } \gterm{unsrtfam}% {% \name{print \qt{unsrt} glossary commands (and environment)} \field{text}{\qt{unsrt} family of commands} \desc{the set of commands used for displaying a \idx{glossary} or partial \idx{glossary} that have \qt{unsrt} in the name: \gls{printunsrtglossary}, \gls{printunsrtglossaries} (which internally uses \gls{printunsrtglossary}), and \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. These all simply iterate over the list of entries associated with the given \idx{glossary}, in the order in which they were added to the \idx{glossary} (hence \qt{unsrt}, which is short for \qt{unsorted}). The way that \app{bib2gls} works is that it sorts the entries according to the \idxpl{resourceopt} and adds the entries to the glossary in the required order. These commands may be used with or without \app{bib2gls}. If you don't use \app{bib2gls}, you will need to manually ensure that the entries are added in the desired order. The \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment may also be included in this category, although it only sets up the start and end of the \idx{glossary} for use with \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}} } \gterm{whatsit}% {% \desc{a command whose execution is delayed or an OS-specific special command. This includes writing to external files (which is what indexing does)} } \gterm{inlinefullform}% { \name{inline full form} \desc{the full form of an abbreviation obtained with \gls{glsxtrfull} or \gls{glsxtrfullpl} (or case-changing variants). This may or may not produce the same result as the full form on \idx{firstuse} of the corresponding \idx{glslike} command (the \idx{displayfullform}), depending on the abbreviation style} } \gterm{displayfullform}% { \name{display full form} \desc{the full form of an abbreviation obtained with the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or \gls{glspl} (or case-changing variants). This may or may not produce the same result as the \idx{inlinefullform} the corresponding \idx{glsxtrfull} command, depending on the abbreviation style} } \gterm{innerformatting} { \name{inner formatting} \desc{the formatting applied by the \glsopt{innertextformat} option, which redefines \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. The inner formatting can only be applied if \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} is embedded within the entry's display style} } % FILE EXTENSIONS \gext{log}{}% \gext{aux}{\common}% \gext{bib}{\common}% \gext{tex}{\common}% \gext{toc}{}% \gext{glstex}{}% \gext{glsdefs}{}% \gext{glslabels}{}% \gext{gls}{}% \gext{glo}{}% \gext{glg}{}% \gext{ist}{}% \gext{xdy}{}% \gext{acr}{}% \gext{gls-abr}{}% \gext{glo-abr}{}% \gext{glg-abr}{}% \gext{ldf}{}% % GENERAL INDEX \gpunc{unknowntag}{\name{\code{??} (unknown entry marker)} \field{text}{\code{??}}} \gpunc{sym.fullstop}{\name{\code{.} (full stop or period)} \field{see}{idx.fullstop} } \gpunc{sym.nbsp}{\name{\code{\textasciitilde} (non-breaking space)} \field{see}{idx.nbsp} } \gpunc{sym.hash}{\name{\code{\#}}} \gidx{uppercase}{\field{seealso}{idx.titlecase,idx.sentencecase,idx.allcaps}} \gidx{lowercase}{} \gidx{titlecase}{\name{title case}} \gidx{sentencecase}{\common\name{sentence case}} \gidx{allcaps}{\common\name{all caps}} \gidx{casechange}{\name{case change} \field{seealso}{idx.uppercase,idx.lowercase,idx.titlecase,idx.sentencecase,idx.allcaps}} \gidx{smallcaps}{\name{small caps}} \gidx{period}{\name{period (\code{.})}% \field{text}{period} \field{alias}{idx.fullstop} } \gidx{fullstop}{\name{full stop (\code{.})}% \field{text}{full stop} } \gidx{nbsp}{\name{non-breaking space (\code{\textasciitilde})} \field{symbol}{\code{\textasciitilde}} } \gidx{tab}{\name{tabulation (\code{\&})} \field{symbol}{\code{\&}} } \gidx{amp}{\name{\code{\&}}\field{alias}{idx.tab}} \gpunc{sym.startrange}{\name{\code{\nlctopenparen} (range start)} \field{symbol}{\code{\nlctopenparen}} } \gpunc{sym.endrange}{\name{\code{\nlctcloseparen} (range end)} \field{symbol}{\code{\nlctcloseparen}} } } \title{\styfmt{glossaries-extra.sty} v1.53: an extension to the \styfmt{glossaries} package} \author{Nicola L.C. Talbot\\[10pt] Dickimaw Books\\ \href{https://www.dickimaw-books.com/}{\nolinkurl{dickimaw-books.com}}} \date{2023-09-29 } \begin{document} \maketitle \htmlavailable \begin{abstract} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package is an extension to the \sty{glossaries} package, providing additional features. In particular, it provides a completely different abbreviation mechanism. You will need at least \sty{glossaries} version 4.19, but it is best to update both packages at the same time, if new releases are available for both of them. \end{abstract} \begin{warning} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package uses a different set of defaults to the base \sty{glossaries} package. This means that if you simply replace \sty{glossaries} with \sty{glossaries-extra} in an existing document, there may be some differences in the PDF, and you may encounter errors. See \sectionref{sec:defaults} for more details. \end{warning} \begin{information} This document assumes some familiarity with the \sty{glossaries} package. If you are new to \sty{glossaries}, you may prefer to start with the following: \begin{itemize} \item \ctanmirrordocnofn{macros/latex/contrib/glossaries/glossariesbegin}{The \styfmt{glossaries} package: a guide for beginners} \texdocref{glossariesbegin} \item \ctanmirrornofn{support/bib2gls/bib2gls-begin.pdf}{\styfmt{glossaries-extra} and \appfmt{bib2gls}: an introductory guide} \texdocref{bib2gls-begin} \end{itemize} \end{information} \frontmatter \tableofcontents \listofexamples \mainmatter \part{User Guide} \chapter{Introduction} \label{sec:intro} The \sty+{glossaries} package is a flexible package, but it's also a heavy-weight package that uses a lot of resources. As package developer, I'm caught between those users who complain about the drawbacks of a heavy-weight package with a large user manual and those users who want more features (which necessarily adds to the package weight and manual size). The \sty+{glossaries-extra} package is an attempt to provide a~compromise for this conflict. Version 4.22 of the \sty{glossaries} package is the last version to incorporate any major new features. Future versions of \sty{glossaries} will mostly just be bug fixes. New features will instead be added to \styfmt{glossaries-extra}. This means that the base \styfmt{glossaries} package won't increase in terms of package loading time and allocation of resources, but those users who do want extra features available will have more of a chance of getting their feature requests accepted. \begin{important} Some of the commands provided by the base \sty+{glossaries} package are incompatible with \sty+{glossaries-extra}. These are marked with \glssymbol{sym.banned} in this document. \end{important} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package internally loads the \sty{glossaries} package. As a general rule, it's better to defer loading the base \sty{glossaries} package to \sty{glossaries-extra} rather than loading the two packages separately. \section{Package Defaults} \label{sec:defaults} I'm not happy with some of the default settings assumed by the \sty{glossaries} package, and, judging from code I've seen, other users also seem unhappy with them, as certain package options are often used in questions posted on various sites. I can't change the default behaviour of \sty{glossaries} as it would break backward compatibility, but since \sty{glossaries-extra} is a separate package, I have decided to implement some of these commonly-used options by default. You can switch them back if they're not appropriate. The new defaults are: \begin{itemize} \item \optval{toc}{true} (add the glossaries to the table of contents). Use \optval{toc}{false} to switch this back off. \item \optval{nopostdot}{true} (suppress the terminating \idx{fullstop} after the description in the \idx{glossary}). Use \optval{nopostdot}{false} or just \opt{postdot} to restore the terminating \idx{fullstop}. Alternatively, if you are interested in switching to \app{bib2gls}, you can instruct \app{bib2gls} to insert it with the \resourceopt{post-description-dot} option. \item \opt{noredefwarn} (suppress the warnings that occur when the \env{theglossary} environment and \gls{printglossary} are redefined while \sty{glossaries} is loading). Note that this won't have any effect if the \sty{glossaries} package has already been loaded before you load the \sty{glossaries-extra} package. \item If \sty{babel} has been loaded, the \optval{translate}{babel} option is switched on. To revert to using the \sty{translator} interface, use \optval{translate}{true}. There is no change to the default if \sty{babel} hasn't been loaded. \item The default style used by \gls{newacronym} is \abbrstyle{short-nolong}. (That is, the long form is not shown on \idx{firstuse}.) To revert back to \qt{\meta{long} (\meta{short})} on \idx{firstuse} do: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short}} \end{codebox} In the above example, \abbrstyle{long-short} refers to the \sty{glossaries-extra} \idx{abbrvstyle} not the \sty{glossaries} acronym style of the same name. See \sectionref{sec:abbreviations} for further details. \end{itemize} \section{Example Differences Between \stytext{glossaries} and \stytext{glossaries-extra}} \label{sec:examplediffs} The examples below illustrate the difference in explicit package options between \sty{glossaries} and \sty{glossaries-extra}. There may be other differences resulting from modifications to commands provided by \sty{glossaries}. \subsection{Basic defaults} \label{sec:examplediffsbasic} \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} This is like: \begin{codebox*} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{toc},\opt{nopostdot}]\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox*} \subsection{Language defaults} \label{sec:examplediffslang} \begin{codebox*} \cmd{documentclass}[british]\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{\sty{babel}} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox*} This is like: \begin{codebox*} \cmd{documentclass}[british]\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{\sty{babel}} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{toc},\opt{nopostdot},\optval{translate}{babel}]\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox*} \subsection{Combined with \clstext{memoir}} \label{sec:examplediffsmemoir} \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{\cls{memoir}} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} This is like: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{\cls{memoir}} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{toc},\opt{nopostdot},\opt{noredefwarn}]\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} \emph{However} \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{\cls{memoir}} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} This is like: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{\cls{memoir}} \cmd{usepackage}[\optval{toc}{false},\optval{nopostdot}{false}]\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} Since by the time \sty{glossaries-extra} has been loaded, the base \sty{glossaries} package has already redefined \cls{memoir}['s] \idx{glossary}-related commands. \subsection{Abbreviations} \label{sec:examplediffsabbrv} Abbreviations are defined with \gls{newabbreviation}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. Explicit full form: \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{svm}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} This is the closest match to: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries} \gls{newacronym}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. Explicit full form: \gls{acrfull}\marg{svm}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} If you want to continue using \gls{newacronym} then you will need to change the style for the \cat{acronym} \idx{category}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short}} \gls{newacronym}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. Explicit full form: \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{svm}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{important} Don't use commands like \gls{glsfirst} or \gls{glstext} with abbreviations. See \sectionref{sec:abbreviations} for further details. \end{important} \subsection{Glossary Mid-Build Placeholder (\glsfmttext{printglossary})} \label{sec:examplediffprintgloss} Another noticeable change with \sty{glossaries-extra} is that by default \gls{printglossary} will now display information text in the document if the external \idx{glossary} file doesn't exist. This is explanatory text to help new users who can't work out what to do next to complete the document build. Once the document is set up correctly and the external files have been generated, this text will disappear. This change is mostly likely to be noticed by users with one or more redundant empty glossaries who ignore transcript messages, explicitly use \app+{makeindex}\slash\app+{xindy} on just the non-empty \idx{glossary} (or \idxpl{glossary}) and use the iterative \gls{printglossaries} command instead of \gls{printglossary}. For example, consider the following: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{acronym}]\marg{glossaries} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{newacronym}\marg{laser}\marg{laser}\marg{light amplification by stimulated emission of radiation} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{laser} \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The above document will only display the list of acronyms at the place where \gls{printglossaries} occurs. However it will also attempt to input the \ext{gls} file associated with the \code{main} \idx{glossary}. If you use \app{makeglossaries}, you'll get the warning message: \begin{transcript} Warning: File 'test.glo' is empty. Have you used any entries defined in glossary 'main'? Remember to use package option 'nomain' if you don't want to use the main glossary. \end{transcript} (where the original file is called \filefmt{test.tex}) but if you simply call \app{makeindex} directly to generate the \ext+{acr} file (without attempting to create the \ext{gls} file) then the transcript file will always contain the message: \begin{transcript} No file test.gls. \end{transcript} This doesn't occur with \app{makeglossaries} as it will create the \ext{gls} file containing the single command \gls{null}. If you simply change from \sty{glossaries} to \sty{glossaries-extra} in this document, you'll find a change in the resulting PDF if you don't use \app{makeglossaries} and you only generate the \ext{acr} file with \app{makeindex}. The transcript file will still contain the message about the missing \ext{gls}, but now you'll also see information in the actual PDF document. The simplest remedy is to follow the advice inserted into the document at that point, which is to add the \opt{nomain} package option: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{nomain},\opt{acronym},\opt{postdot}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short}} \gls{newacronym}\marg{laser}\marg{laser}\marg{light amplification by stimulated emission of radiation} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{laser} \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{information} Note the need to set the acronym style using \gls{setabbreviationstyle} before \gls{newacronym}. See \sectionref{sec:abbreviations} for further details. \end{information} \section{Further Reading} \label{sec:reading} The following documents and web pages are also available: \begin{itemize} \item \ctanmirrornofn{macros/latex/contrib/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-code.pdf}% {The \styfmt{glossaries-extra} documented code} \texdocref{glossaries-extra-code} \item \gallery{Gallery: \styfmt{glossaries}, \styfmt{glossaries-extra} and \appfmt{bib2gls}}. \item \dickimawhref{faq.php}{FAQs: \styfmt{glossaries}, \styfmt{glossaries-extra} and \appfmt{bib2gls}}. \item \dickimawhref{latex/buildglossaries/}{Incorporating \appfmt{makeglossaries} or \appfmt{makeglossaries-lite} or \appfmt{bib2gls} into the document build}. \item \ctanref{pkg/bib2gls}{The \appfmt{bib2gls} application}. \item \ctanref{pkg/glossaries}{The \styfmt{glossaries} package}. \end{itemize} \chapter{Package Options} \label{sec:pkgopts} \pkgdef{glossaries-extra} % This chapter describes the package options provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} that are either not defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package or are modified by \sty{glossaries-extra}. You can additionally pass the base package options to \sty{glossaries-extra}. For example, instead of: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{nonumberlist}}\marg{glossaries} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{abbreviations}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} you can simply do: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{abbreviations},\opt{nonumberlist}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} \begin{information} It's better not to load the \sty{glossaries} package first. Leave \sty{glossaries-extra} to load it, where possible, to allow for a smoother integration between the two packages. \end{information} After \sty{glossaries-extra} has been loaded, some of the \sty{glossaries-extra} package options may be changed with: \cmddef{glossariesextrasetup} where \meta{options} are the same as the relevant package option. \begin{important} Certain options can only be supplied as package options since the settings need to be known while \sty{glossaries-extra} is loading. \end{important} To change the base \sty{glossaries} package's options (that may be changed after the package has loaded), continue to use: \cmddef{setupglossaries} but don't use any of the options listed here in that command. \section{Glossary Lists} \label{sec:gloslistopts} % PACKAGE OPTION: nomissingglstext \optiondef{nomissingglstext} If true, this will suppress the warning written to the transcript and the warning text that will appear in the document if the external glossary files haven't been generated due to an incomplete document build. However, it's probably simpler just to fix whatever has caused the failure to build the external file or files. % PACKAGE OPTION: abbreviations \optiondef{abbreviations} This option has no value and can't be cancelled. If used, it will automatically create a new glossary with the label \code{abbreviations} and redefines \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} to this label. (The file extensions are \ext+{glg-abr}, \ext+{gls-abr} and \ext+{glo-abr}.) In addition, this option defines a shortcut command: \cmddef*{printabbreviations} which is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{printglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{glsxtrabbrvtype}},\meta{options}} \end{codebox} If \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is also loaded then this option will additionally provide \gls{printunsrtabbreviations} which uses \gls{printunsrtglossary} instead. The title of the new glossary is given by \cmddef*{abbreviationsname} If this command is already defined, it's left unchanged. Otherwise it's defined to \qt{Abbreviations} if \sty{babel} hasn't been loaded or \gls{acronymname} if \sty{babel} has been loaded. However, if you're using \sty{babel} it's likely you will need to change this. (See \sectionref{sec:lang} for further details.) \begin{information} If you don't use the \opt{abbreviations} package option, the \gls{abbreviationsname} command won't be defined (unless it's defined by an included language file). \end{information} If the \opt{abbreviations} option is used and the \opt{acronym} option provided by the \sty{glossaries} package hasn't been used, then \gls{acronymtype} will be set to \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} so that acronyms defined with \gls{newacronym} can be added to the list of abbreviations. If you want acronyms in the \code{main} glossary and other abbreviations in the \code{abbreviations} glossary then you will need to redefine \gls{acronymtype} to \code{main}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{acronymtype}}\marg{main} \end{codebox} Note that there are no analogous options to the \sty{glossaries} package's \opt{acronymlists} option (or associated commands) as the abbreviation mechanism is handled differently with \sty{glossaries-extra}. % PACKAGE OPTION: symbols \optiondef{symbols} This is passed to the base \sty{glossaries} package, but \sty{glossaries-extra} will additionally define: \cmddef*{glsxtrnewsymbol} which is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\meta{symbol}}, \gloskeyval{sort}{\meta{entry-label}},\gloskeyval{type}{symbols},\gloskeyval{category}{symbol}, \meta{options}} \end{codebox} Note that the \gloskey{sort} key is set to the \meta{entry-label} not the \meta{symbol} as the symbol will likely contain commands. If this isn't appropriate, you can override it by using the \gloskey{sort} key in the optional argument. This option also sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the \cat{symbol} category and provides the \idx{catpostdeschook}: \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescsymbol} If \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is also loaded then this option will additionally provide \gls{printunsrtsymbols} which uses \gls{printunsrtglossary}. % PACKAGE OPTION: numbers \optiondef{numbers} This is passed to the base \sty{glossaries} package but \sty{glossaries-extra} will additionally define: \cmddef*{glsxtrnewnumber} which is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\meta{number}}, \gloskeyval{sort}{\meta{entry-label}},\gloskeyval{type}{numbers},\gloskeyval{category}{number}, \meta{options}} \end{codebox} Note that the \gloskey{sort} key is set to the \meta{entry-label}. If this isn't appropriate, you can override it by using the \gloskey{sort} key in the optional argument. This option also sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the \cat{number} category and provides the \idx{catpostdeschook}: \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescnumber} If \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is also loaded then this option will additionally provide \gls{printunsrtnumbers} which uses \gls{printunsrtglossary}. % PACKAGE OPTION: acronyms \optiondef{acronyms} This is passed to the base \sty{glossaries} package (which defines \gls{printacronyms} and creates a new glossary with the label \code{acronym}) but if \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is loaded then this option will additionally provide \gls{printunsrtacronyms} which uses \gls{printunsrtglossary}. As with the base \sty{glossaries} package, this option redefines \gls{acronymtype} to \code{acronym}. Note that this option doesn't change \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype}. % PACKAGE OPTION: acronym \optiondef{acronym} If \optval{acronym}{true}, this behaves like \opt{acronyms}. Note that \optval{acronym}{false} won't work if the base \sty{glossaries} package was loaded before \sty{glossaries-extra}. % PACKAGE OPTION: index \optiondef{index} This is passed to the base \sty{glossaries} package but if \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is loaded then this option will additionally provide \gls{printunsrtindex} which uses \gls{printunsrtglossary}. The base package \opt{index} option also defines: \cmddef*{newterm} This definition is modified by \sty{glossaries-extra} to additionally set the \gloskey{category} to \cat{index} and sets the \gloskey{description} to discard the \idx{postdeschook} (\gls{nopostdesc}) but retain \gls{glsxtrpostdescription} so that the \idx{catpostdeschook} can still be applied. This option also sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the \cat{index} category and defines an associated \idx{catpostdeschook}: \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescindex} \section{Glossary Style Options} \label{sec:glosstyleopts} % PACKAGE OPTION: nopostdot \optiondef{nopostdot} This option is provided by \sty{glossaries} where it simply alters a corresponding conditional that's used inside \gls{glspostdescription} to determine whether or not to insert a \idx{fullstop}. The \opt{postpunc} option (see below) redefines \gls{glspostdescription}, so the \opt{nopostdot} option is modified by \sty{glossaries-extra} to reset the hook back to its original definition to counteract any use of the \opt{postpunc} option. \begin{important} This option will have no effect if the \idx{glossarystyle} doesn't include \gls{glspostdescription}. (Use \opt{stylemods} to ensure that all the predefined styles that show the description have this hook added.) \end{important} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you may prefer to use the \resourceopt{post-description-dot} resource option. % PACKAGE OPTION: postdot \optiondef{postdot} This is a shortcut for \optval{nopostdot}{false}. % PACKAGE OPTION: postpunc \optiondef{postpunc} This option redefines \gls{glspostdescription} to display the required punctuation. Note that this means the hook will no longer check for the \opt{nopostdot} conditional. \begin{important} This option will have no effect if the \idx{glossarystyle} doesn't include \gls{glspostdescription}. (Use \opt{stylemods} to ensure that all the predefined styles that show the description have this hook added.) \end{important} The \opt{postpunc} value may either be the required punctuation or one of the following keywords: \optionvaldef{postpunc}{dot} This redefines \gls{glspostdescription} to use a \idx{fullstop} but also adjusts the space factor. This isn't exactly the same as \optval{nopostdot}{false} since it removes the conditional from \gls{glspostdescription}. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you may prefer to use the \resourceopt{post-description-dot} resource option. \optionvaldef{postpunc}{comma} This redefines \gls{glspostdescription} to a comma. \optionvaldef{postpunc}{none} This redefines \gls{glspostdescription} to do nothing. This isn't exactly the same as \optval{nopostdot}{true} since it removes the conditional from \gls{glspostdescription}. % PACKAGE OPTION: stylemods \optiondef{stylemods} Loads the \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package (see \sectionref{sec:stylemods}), which patches the styles provided with the base \sty{glossaries} package so that they all use \gls{glspostdescription}. Extra hooks are also provided to make them easier to customize. The value may be one of the following: \optionvaldef{stylemods}{all} Loads all styles that are provided by both \sty{glossaries} and \sty{glossaries-extra}. \optionvaldef{stylemods}{default} Patches all the predefined styles that have been loaded, without loading any extra styles. This will typically be all the styles that are usually loaded by \sty{glossaries} (for example, \glostyle{list} and \glostyle{long}). Package options such as \opt{nolist} will alter which styles are loaded. In the case of \opt{nostyles}, no styles will be loaded, so none of them will be patched. \begin{information} It's pointless using both \opteqvalref{stylemods}{default} and \opt{nostyles}. Any \idx{glossarystyle} packages that are subsequently loaded won't be patched. \end{information} \optionvaldef{stylemods}{list} For each element \meta{tag} in \meta{list}, the corresponding package \styfmt{glossary\dhyphen\meta{tag}} will be loaded. You can use this in combination with \opt{nostyles} to only load the particular style package or packages that you require (without loading the full set of defaults). For example, \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{\marg{bookindex,longextra}}, \optval{style}{bookindex}]\marg{\sty{glossaries-extra}} \end{codebox} This prevents the base \sty{glossaries} package from loading the default set of styles, but loads \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods}, \sty{glossary-bookindex} and \sty{glossary-longextra}, and then sets the default style to \glostyle{bookindex}. \section{Loading Other Packages} \label{sec:otherpkgopts} Some options listed in other sections, such as the \opt{stylemods} and \opt{record} options, also load supplementary packages. % PACKAGE OPTION: prefix \optiondef{prefix} Loads the \sty{glossaries-prefix} package (if not already loaded). % PACKAGE OPTION: accsupp \optiondef{accsupp} Loads the \sty{glossaries-accsupp} package (if not already loaded). This option can only be used as a package option (not in \gls{glossariesextrasetup}) as \sty{glossaries-extra} needs to know whether or not to provide accessibility support while it's loading. \begin{important} The \sty{glossaries-accsupp} package is still experimental and so accessibility features are liable to change. \end{important} If you want to define styles that can interface with the accessibility support provided by \sty{glossaries-accsupp} use the \csfmt{glsaccess\meta{xxx}} type of commands instead of \csfmt{glsentry\meta{xxx}} (for example, \gls{glsaccesstext} instead of \gls{glsentrytext}). If \sty{glossaries-accsupp} hasn't been loaded those commands are equivalent (for example, \gls{glsaccesstext} just does \gls{glsentrytext}) but if it has been loaded, then the \csfmt{glsaccess\meta{xxx}} commands will add the accessibility information. See \sectionref{sec:accsupp} for further details. \section{Entry Definitions, References and Indexing} \label{sec:refindexopts} % PACKAGE OPTION: undefaction \optiondef{undefaction} This indicates what to do if an undefined \idx{glossary} entry is referenced. \begin{important} Undefined entries can't be picked up by any commands that iterate over a \idx{glossary} list. This includes \gls{forglsentries} and \gls{glsaddall}. \end{important} \optionvaldef{undefaction}{error} Produces an error message for undefined \idx{glossary} entries. \optionvaldef{undefaction}{warn} Only produces a warning message for undefined \idx{glossary} entries. The place where the entry has been referenced will be marked with \idx{unknowntag} (as with undefined labels or citations). The unknown marker is produced with: \cmddef{glsxtrundeftag} This defaults to two question marks. Note that \gls{ifglsused} will only display \idx{unknowntag} in the document text with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn} if the entry hasn't been defined, as the underlying boolean variable doesn't exist and so is neither true nor false. (There will also be a warning in the transcript.) You may prefer to use \gls{GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} instead. See \sectionref{sec:glsunset} for further details. If you want to write a custom command that needs to generate a warning or error for an undefined reference, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrundefaction} This will produce the unknown marker if used within the document environment. Depending on the \opt{undefaction}, \gls{glsxtrundefaction} will either create an error with the given \meta{message} and \meta{additional help} or will create a warning with the given \meta{message}. % PACKAGE OPTION: docdef \optiondef{docdef} This setting governs where \gls{newglossaryentry} can be used (preamble-only or anywhere before the first \idx{glossary} or anywhere within the document). Commands like \gls{newabbreviation} and \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol} that internally use \gls{newglossaryentry} are also governed by this option. Other commands, such as \gls{longnewglossaryentry} are always preamble-only. With just the base \sty{glossaries} package, \gls{newglossaryentry} is allowed in the \env{document} environment as long as you haven't used \gls{makenoidxglossaries}. There are, however, problems that can occur when entries are defined within the \env{document} environment (see the \sty{glossaries} documentation for further details). To encourage preamble-only use, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package prohibits the use of \gls{newglossaryentry} within the \env{document} environment by default, but if you really want this you can use this package option to allow it. \begin{information} Note that in the case of \app{bib2gls}, all entry data is originally defined in \ext{bib} files. The entry definitions (using commands like \gls{longnewglossaryentry} and \gls{newabbreviation}) are written to the \ext{glstex} files that are input in the preamble. \end{information} \optionvaldef{docdef}{false} Prohibits the use of \gls{newglossaryentry} within the \env{document} environment. All entries must be defined in the preamble. \optionvaldef{docdef}{true} Permits the use of \gls{newglossaryentry} in the \env{document} environment provided \gls{makenoidxglossaries} hasn't been used (as per the base \sty{glossaries} package). This will create a temporary \ext+{glsdefs} file that contains the entry definitions so that they can be available on the next \LaTeX\ run at the beginning of the document to allow any \idxpl{glossary} in the front matter to display correctly. If all your \idxpl{glossary} occur at the end of the document, consider using \opteqvalref{docdef}{restricted} instead. \optionvaldef{docdef}{restricted} Permits the use of \gls{newglossaryentry} in the \env{document} environment provided the entry definitions all occur before the first \idx{glossary} is displayed. This avoids the need for the \ext+{glsdefs} file. You will still need to take care about any changes made to the category code of characters that are required by the \meta{key}\dequals\meta{value} mechanism (that is, the comma and equal sign) and any \app+{makeindex} or \app+{xindy} special character that occurs in the \gloskey{sort} key or label. If any of those characters are made active in the document (for example, through \sty{babel} shortcuts), then it can cause problems with the entry definition. This option will allow \gls{newglossaryentry} to be used in the document with \gls{makenoidxglossaries}, but note that \gls{longnewglossaryentry} remains a preamble-only command. With this option, if an entry appears in the glossary before it has been defined, an error will occur (or a warning if the \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn} option is used). If you edit your document and either remove an entry or change its label, you may need to delete the document's temporary files (such as the \ext+{aux} and \ext+{gls} files). \optionvaldef{docdef}{atom} This option behaves like \opteqvalref{docdef}{restricted} but creates the \ext+{glsdefs} file for \href{https://atom.io/packages/autocomplete-glossaries}{atom's autocomplete support}. This file isn't input by \sty{glossaries-extra} and so associated problems with the use of this file are avoided, but it allows the autocomplete support to find the labels in the file. \begin{important} A \dickimawhrefnofn{bugtracker.php?key=173}{bug fix} in \sty{glossaries} v4.47 has changed the format of the \ext+{glsdefs} file slightly. \end{important} As with \opteqvalref{docdef}{restricted}, entries may be defined in the preamble or anywhere in the document, but they may only be referenced after they have been defined. Entries must be defined before the associated glossary is displayed. If you need a list of all entry labels for the use of an editor or helper script you may also want to consider the package options \opt{writeglslabels} and \opt{writeglslabelnames} provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. Note that with these options and with \opteqvalref{docdef}{atom}, only the entry labels that are visible to \LaTeX\ can be saved. So if you are using \app{bib2gls} you will only get the labels of the entries that have already been selected by \app{bib2gls}. The \ext+{bib} files can be found by parsing the \ext+{aux} file for \gls{glsxtr@resource} (listed in the \resourceopt{src} option or \gls{jobname}\filefmt{.bib} if \resourceopt{src} is missing). % PACKAGE OPTION: shortcuts \optiondef{shortcuts} Unlike the base \sty{glossaries} package option of the same name, this option isn't boolean but has multiple values. \begin{information} Multiple invocations of the \opt{shortcuts} option \emph{within the same option list} will override each other. Since these options define commands, the action can't be undone with a later \gls{glossariesextrasetup}. \end{information} \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{ac} Set the shortcut commands provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package for acronyms (such as \gls{ac}) but use the \sty{glossaries-extra} abbreviation commands, such as \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong}, instead of the analogous base commands, such as \gls{acrshort} and \gls{acrlong}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrshortcuts} for further details. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{abbreviations} Sets the abbreviation shortcuts (see \sectionref{sec:abbrshortcuts}). This setting doesn't switch on the acronym shortcuts provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{abbr} Synonym for \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{other} Implements the other (non-abbreviation) shortcut commands: \cmddef*{newentry} A synonym for \gls{newglossaryentry}. \cmddef*{newsym} A synonym for \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol} (provided that the \opt{symbols} package option is also used). \cmddef*{newnum} A synonym for \gls{glsxtrnewnumber} (provided that the \opt{numbers} package option is also used). \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{acother} Implements \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} and \optval{shortcuts}{other}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{abother} Implements \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} and \optval{shortcuts}{other}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{all} Implements \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac}, \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} and \optval{shortcuts}{other}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{acronyms} Sets the shortcuts provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package for acronyms (such as \gls{ac}). See the \sty{glossaries} package documentation for further details. Note that the short and long forms (\gls{acs} and \gls{acl}) don't use \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong} but use the original \gls{acrshort} and \gls{acrlong}, which aren't compatible with the \sty{glossaries-extra} abbreviation mechanism. The better option is to use \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac}. \begin{information} Don't use \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms} unless you have reverted \gls{newacronym} back to the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism. See \sectionref{sec:acrorevert} for further details. \end{information} \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{acro} Synonym for \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{acronyms}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{true} This setting is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. With \sty{glossaries-extra} it's equivalent to \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{all}. \optionvaldef{shortcuts}{false} This setting is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. With \sty{glossaries-extra} it's equivalent to \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{none}. % PACKAGE OPTION: indexcrossrefs \optiondef{indexcrossrefs} This is a boolean option that governs whether or not to automatically index any cross-referenced entries that haven't been marked as used at the end of the document. These are entries that are identified in one of the cross-referencing fields (\gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso}) of another used entry as opposed to entries that have the cross-referencing fields set. Since entries with the \gloskey{alias} key are intended as synonyms for another term, the target is expected to be indexed so entries with the \gloskey{alias} key set aren't affected by this option. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette}, \gloskeyval{description}{small vegetable marrow}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{marrow}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{marrow}, \gloskeyval{description}{long gourd with green skin}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{courgette}} \end{codebox} Suppose that \qt{marrow} is indexed (so that it appears in the glossary with the cross-reference to \qt{courgette}) but if courgette isn't indexed anywhere in the document (using commands like \gls{gls} or \gls{glsadd}) then there will be a broken cross-reference in the marrow \idx{locationlist} pointing to courgette, which doesn't appear in the glossary. With \opteqvalref{indexcrossrefs}{true}, the courgette entry will be indexed at the end of the document using \gls{glsadd} with \glsoptval{format}{glsxtrunusedformat}, which corresponds to the command \gls{glsxtrunusedformat}. Note that this special format \gls{glsxtrunusedformat} simply does \gls{unskip} and ignores its argument, which creates a blank location. If any of the cross-referenced entries have been indexed but haven't been marked as used (for example, with \gls{glsadd}) then this will cause a spurious comma in the \idx{locationlist}. This is a limitation of the way that \app+{makeindex} and \app+{xindy} work as they are general purpose indexing applications which require locations. If you have entries with cross-references, you may want to consider switching to \app{bib2gls} instead. \begin{information} Note that \app{bib2gls} can automatically find dependent entries when it parses the \ext{bib} source file, so the \opt{record} option automatically implements \opteqvalref{indexcrossrefs}{false}. \end{information} This function is implemented by code added to the end document hook that determines whether or not to use the command \gls{glsxtraddallcrossrefs}. This command iterates over all entries in all glossaries, which adds to the overall document build time, especially if you have defined a large number of entries, so this defaults to \opteqvalref{indexcrossrefs}{false}, but it will be automatically switched on if you use the \gloskey{see} or \gloskey{seealso} keys in any entries. See also \sectionref{sec:xr}. \optionvaldef{indexcrossrefs}{true} Enables this setting. \optionvaldef{indexcrossrefs}{false} Disables this setting even if the \gloskey{see} or \gloskey{seealso} key is present in any entries. % PACKAGE OPTION: autoseeindex \optiondef{autoseeindex} This is a boolean option that governs whether or not the \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} keys should automatically index the cross-reference when an entry is defined (see \sectionref{sec:xr}). With the base \sty{glossaries} package, the \gloskey{see} key was provided as a shortcut for \gls{glssee}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette}, \gloskeyval{description}{small vegetable marrow}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zucchini}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zucchini}, \gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{courgette}} \end{codebox} is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette}, \gloskeyval{description}{small vegetable marrow}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zucchini}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zucchini}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{glssee}\marg{zucchini}\marg{courgette} \end{codebox} This was designed for documents where only entries that are actually used in the document are defined and ensures that the cross-reference is included in the \idx{glossary}, even though it may not be referenced anywhere in the document. However, it becomes problematic if neither entry is required in the document. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package modifies the action of the \gloskey{see} key so that it also saves the value and will only perform the automated \gls{glssee} if \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{true}. Similarly for the \gloskey{seealso} key. \begin{information} Note that the \opt{record} option automatically implements \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{false} as the corresponding action can be implemented with \app{bib2gls}['s] \resourceopt{selection} option. \end{information} \optionvaldef{autoseeindex}{true} Enables automatic indexing using \gls{glssee} for the \gloskey{see} key (as per the base \sty{glossaries} package) and \gls{glsxtrindexseealso} for the \gloskey{seealso} key. For example, if an entry is defined as \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{foo}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{foo}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{see}{bar,baz}} \end{codebox} then, with \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{true} and the default \opt{indexcrossrefs} setting, this is equivalent to \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{foo}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{foo},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{glssee}\marg{foo}\marg{bar,baz} \gls{glossariesextrasetup}\marg{\opteqvalref{indexcrossrefs}{true}} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{foo}\marg{see}\marg{bar,baz} \end{codebox} \optionvaldef{autoseeindex}{false} The value of the \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} keys will be stored in their corresponding fields (and can be accessed using commands like \gls{glsxtrusesee} and \gls{glsxtruseseealso}) but the cross-reference won't be automatically \indexed. \begin{information} Note that \opt{indexcrossrefs} isn't automatically implemented by the presence of the \gloskey{see} key when \opt{autoseeindex} is false. \end{information} For example, if an entry is defined as \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{foo}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{foo}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{see}{bar,baz}} \end{codebox} then, with \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{false} and the default \opt{indexcrossrefs} setting, this is equivalent to \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{foo}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{foo}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{foo}\marg{see}\marg{bar,baz} \end{codebox} It's therefore possible with this option to remove the cross-references from the location lists and set their position within the \idx{glossarystyle}. Another method of preventing the automatic indexing is to define the entries before the external indexing files have been opened with \gls{makeglossaries}. Since the appropriate file isn't open, the information can't be written to it. This will need the package option \optval{seenoindex}{ignore} to prevent an error occurring. % PACKAGE OPTION: record \optiondef{record} This setting indicates whether or not \app{bib2gls} is required. \begin{information} This option can only be set in the preamble and can't be used after \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} or \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}. \end{information} With the recording setting on (\opteqvalref{record}{only}, \opteqvalref{record}{nameref} or \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid}), any of the commands that would typically index the entry (such as \gls{gls}, \gls{glstext} or \gls{glsadd}) will add a \record\ to the \ext{aux} file. \app{bib2gls} can then read this information to find out which entries have been used. (Remember that commands like \gls{glsentryname} don't index, so any use of these commands won't add a corresponding \record.) See \sectionref{sec:bib2gls} for further details. The hybrid method additionally performs the standard indexing action that's required for \app+{makeindex} or \app+{xindy} to work, but this can't be done until \app{bib2gls} has created the \ext{glstex} files that provide the entry definitions. In general, it's best to avoid the hybrid method. \optionvaldef{record}{off} Indexing is performed as per the base \sty{glossaries} package using either \gls{makeglossaries} or \gls{makenoidxglossaries}. This setting implements \opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}. \optionvaldef{record}{only} \Glsname{indexing} is performed by adding \app{bib2gls} \records\ in the \ext{aux} file. Neither \gls{makeglossaries} nor \gls{makenoidxglossaries} is permitted. Use \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} (or \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}) to set up \app{bib2gls} \idxpl{resourceopt}. Glossaries should be displayed with the \idx{unsrtfam}, such as \gls{printunsrtglossary}. This setting implements \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}, \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{false}, \opteqvalref{indexcrossrefs}{false} \opteqvalref{sort}{none}, and automatically loads the supplementary \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} package. (There should be no need to explicitly load \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls}.) This option also defines the \gloskey{location} and \gloskey{group} keys that are set by \app{bib2gls} to provide the \idx{locationlist} and \idx{group} information required by the \idx{unsrtfam}. The document build process is (assuming the file is called \filefmt{myDoc.tex}): \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} If you want letter \idxpl{group} you will need the \switch{group} or \switch{g} switch when invoking \app{bib2gls}: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls \switch{g} myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} \begin{important} Note that this setting will prevent the \gloskey{see} from automatically implementing \gls{glssee}. (\app{bib2gls} deals with the \gloskey{see} field.) You may explicitly use \gls{glssee} in the document, but \app{bib2gls} will ignore the cross-reference if the \gloskey{see} field was already set for that entry. \end{important} \optionvaldef{record}{nameref} As \opteqvalref{record}{only} but uses nameref \records, which include the current label information given by \gls{@currentlabel} and \gls{@currentHref}. This means that the title can be included in the \idxpl{entrylocation}, if available. This setting also supports location hypertargets that don't follow a simple \meta{h-prefix}\meta{\idxc{locationcounter}{the-counter}} format, which can't be used with other indexing options. See \sectionref{sec:recordnameref} for further details of this option. \begin{information} This option requires \sty{hyperref}, otherwise it will fall back on the usual location \records. \end{information} Note that \gls{@currentHref} is always globally updated whenever \gls{refstepcounter} is used, but \gls{@currentlabel} isn't. This can cause some undesired side-effects with some settings. Remember also that the \opt{indexcounter} option increments the associated counter every time an entry is \indexed, which affects this option. If the \idx{locationcounter} is the default \ctr{page}, only the \location\ number is shown. \optionvaldef{record}{alsoindex} Deprecated synonym of \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid}. \optionvaldef{record}{hybrid} This is a hybrid setting that uses \app{bib2gls} to fetch entry information from \ext{bib} files, but uses \app+{makeindex} or \app+{xindy} to create the \idx{glossary} files (which are input with \gls{printglossary}). Note that this requires a slower and more complicated build process (see below). This hybrid approach is provided for the rare instances where an existing \app{xindy} rule or module is too complicated to convert to a \app{bib2gls} rule but the entries need to be fetched from a \ext{bib} file. There's no benefit in using this option with \app{makeindex}. This setting does not load \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls}, as \app{bib2gls} is only being used to fetch the entry definitions. \begin{information} Since it's redundant to make \app{bib2gls} also sort and collate locations (in addition to \app{xindy} performing these tasks), use the resource options \resourceoptval{sort}{none} and \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false} for a faster build. Many of the other \idxpl{resourceopt} are likely to be irrelevant. \end{information} This setting must be used with \gls{makeglossaries} but not with its optional argument. Each \idx{glossary} should be displayed using \gls{printglossary} (or \gls{printglossaries} for all of them). \begin{important} This setting should not be used with \gls{makenoidxglossaries}. \end{important} You may need to change the transcript file used by \app{bib2gls} to avoid a clash with \app{xindy}['s] transcript file. This can be done with \app{bib2gls}['s] \switch{log-file} or \switch{t} option. The document build process is (assuming the file is called \filefmt{myDoc.tex}): \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls myDoc pdflatex myDoc makeglossaries myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} Note that, in this case, it's redundant to call \app{bib2gls} with the \switch{group} or \switch{g} switch as \app{xindy} will insert the group heading information into the corresponding \idx{glossary} file. \begin{information} If you want \app{bib2gls} to form the letter groups then this hybrid method is inappropriate. \end{information} % PACKAGE OPTION: bibglsaux \optiondef{bibglsaux} Alternatively, this setting can be implemented with: \cmddef{glsxtrsetbibglsaux} This option should only be used once. If used again no new file will be created. If the \meta{basename} value is empty, \records\ will be written to the normal \ext{aux} file. A document containing many \records\ can result in a large \ext+{aux} file with information that's only relevant to \app{bib2gls}. This option will create a new file called \metafilefmt{}{basename}{.aux} that will be used to store the \records. The file will be skipped by \LaTeX\ but will be picked up by \app{bib2gls} v3.0+ when it inputs the main \ext{aux} file. Note that this creates an extra write register. \begin{important} You should still supply the main \ext{aux} file when you run \app{bib2gls} as \metafilefmt{}{basename}{.aux} will only contain the \records\ and not the other information that \app{bib2gls} requires (such as the \idxpl{resourceopt}). \end{important} % PACKAGE OPTION: equations \optiondef{equations} This setting will cause the default \idx{locationcounter} to automatically switch to \ctr{equation} when inside a numbered equation environment, such as \env{equation} or \env{align}. The counter can be explicitly overridden with the \glsopt{counter} \idx{glsopt}. % PACKAGE OPTION: floats \optiondef{floats} This setting will cause the default \idx{locationcounter} to automatically switch to the corresponding counter when inside a floating environment, such as \env{figure} or \env{table}. The counter can be explicitly overridden with the \glsopt{counter} \idx{glsopt}. Remember that within floats it's the \gls{caption} command that actually uses \gls{refstepcounter}, so indexing before the caption will result in the wrong reference. The commands for use in captions and sections, such as \gls{glsfmttext} and \gls{glsfmtshort}, don't index. (See \sectionref{sec:headtitle}). You may want to consider using \gls{glsadd} after the caption (not before). For example: \begin{codebox} \cbeg{figure}[htbp] \cmd{centering} \cmd{includegraphics}\marg{example-image} \gls{caption}\marg{Sample \gls{glsfmttext}\marg{foobar} figure} \gls{glsadd}\marg{foobar} \cend{figure} \end{codebox} % PACKAGE OPTION: indexcounter \optiondef{indexcounter} This option defines the \idx{indexing} counter: \ctrdef*{wrglossary} which is incremented every time an entry is \indexed. This option automatically implements \optval{counter}{wrglossary}. This means that each \location\ will link to the relevant part of the page where the \idx{indexing} occurred (instead of to the top of the page). See the \app{bib2gls} documentation for the \resourceopt{save-index-counter} resource option for more details. \begin{warning} This option is primarily intended for use with \app{bib2gls} (v1.4+) and \sty{hyperref}. It can be used with \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}, but it will interfere with the \idx{locationlist} collation, so you won't have ranges and you'll have duplicate page numbers present. \end{warning} This option works by incrementing \ctr{wrglossary} with \gls{refstepcounter} and adding \gls{label}. This can cause a problem if the \idx{indexing} occurs in an \env{equation} environment as \sty{amsmath} forbids multiple occurrences of \gls{label} (resulting in the \qt{Multiple \gls{label}'s} error). It's best to change the counter to \ctr{page} or \ctr{equation} when in maths mode with this option. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \cmd{ifmmode} \gls{setupglslink}\marg{\glsoptval{counter}{page}}\cmd{fi}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsaddpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \cmd{ifmmode} \gls{setupglsadd}\marg{\glsoptval{counter}{page}}\cmd{fi}} \end{codebox} \section{Debugging} \label{sec:debuggingopts} % PACKAGE OPTION: debug \optiondef{debug} Enables debugging information for draft documents. This option is defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package, but is extended by \sty{glossaries-extra} to provide additional settings. If no value is provided, \optvalref{debug}{true} is assumed. The following values are available: \optionvaldef{debug}{false} This setting is provided by the \sty{glossaries} package and is the default. This switches off all debugging commands. \optionvaldef{debug}{true} This setting is provided by the \sty{glossaries} package and switches on logging information if an entry is \indexed\ before the relevant \idx{indexing} files have been opened (only applicable with \app+{makeindex} and \app+{xindy}). This option is extended by \sty{glossaries-extra} to also display the label of unknown entries before the \idx{unknowntag} marker. \begin{coderesult} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{debug}] \marg{glossaries-extra} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{example} \cend{document} \tcblower \glsshowtargetfonttext{[example]}\glslink{idx.unknowntag}{??} \end{coderesult} This uses \gls{glsshowtargetfonttext} for the annotation, which is provided by \sty{glossaries}. \optionvaldef{debug}{showaccsupp} Provided by \sty{glossaries}, this setting shows accessibility information (\sty{glossaries-accsupp}). \optionvaldef{debug}{all} Implements all debugging options. \optionvaldef{debug}{showwrgloss} This setting is only available with \sty{glossaries-extra}. This implements \opteqvalref{debug}{true} and shows a marker~(\glsxtrwrglossmark) just before the write operation is performed by indexing commands. With \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid} there will be two marks: one for the write operation to the \ext{aux} file and one for the associated \idx{glossary} file used by \app{makeindex}\slash\app{xindy}. The marker is produced with the command: \cmddef*{glsxtrwrglossmark} If the \opt{indexcounter} option has been used, this setting will also mark where the \ctr{wrglossary} counter has been incremented. The marker is produced with the command: \cmddef*{glsxtrwrglosscountermark} This marker is also inserted before the location in the definition of \gls{glsxtrwrglossarylocfmt}. \optionvaldef{debug}{showtargets} This setting is provided by \sty{glossaries} and displays the hyperlink target names whenever any \idx{glossary}-related commands create a hyperlink or hypertarget (for example, \gls{gls}, \gls{glstarget} or \gls{glshypernumber}). The default is to use marginal notes in \TeX's \qt{outer} mode and inline annotations for \qt{inner} or maths modes. This uses \gls{glsshowtargetinner} for inner and maths annotations and \gls{glsshowtargetouter} for the outer annotation. If there are many targets within a single paragraph this can lead to \qt{too many floats}, so \sty{glossaries-extra} provides a new package option \opt{showtargets} that can be used to easily switch to inline annotations for outer mode (rather than having to redefine \gls{glsshowtargetouter}). % PACKAGE OPTION: showtargets \optiondef{showtargets} Automatically implements \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets} and adjusts the annotations according to the \meta{value}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides supplementary commands to support this option. \cmddef*{glsxtrshowtargetouter} Formats annotations in outer mode. This is initially \gls{glsshowtargetouter} to match \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets}. \cmddef*{glsxtrshowtargetinner} Formats annotations in inner mode. This is initially \gls{glsshowtargetinner} to match \opteqvalref{debug}{showtargets}. \cmddef*{glsshowtargetinnersymleft} Shows the left annotation and marker. This uses the left symbol marker: \cmddef*{glsxtrshowtargetsymbolleft} \cmddef*{glsshowtargetinnersymright} Shows the right marker and annotation. This uses the right symbol marker: \cmddef*{glsxtrshowtargetsymbolright} \optionvaldef{showtargets}{left} A marker is placed to the left of the link/target and a marginal note is used in outer mode. \optionvaldef{showtargets}{right} A marker is placed to the right of the link/target and a marginal note is used in outer mode. \optionvaldef{showtargets}{innerleft} A marker and annotation are placed to the left of the link/target in all modes. \optionvaldef{showtargets}{innerright} A marker and annotation are placed to the right of the link/target in all modes. \optionvaldef{showtargets}{annoteleft} Markers are placed on either side of the link/target with the annotation on the left in all modes. \optionvaldef{showtargets}{annoteright} Markers are placed on either side of the link/target with the annotation on the right in all modes. \chapter{Defining Entries} \label{sec:newentry} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides commands, such as \gls{newglossaryentry}, to define entries. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides some additional commands, described in \sectionref{sec:newentrydefs}. For abbreviations, see \sectionref{sec:abbreviations}. If you use \app{bib2gls}, it will write command definitions within the \ext{glstex} file. See the \app{bib2gls} user manual for further information about those commands. The \sty{glossaries} user manual warns against using commands such as \gls{gls} within \idx{field} values. However, if you really need this, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides \gls{glsxtrp} (see \sectionref{sec:nested}). Alternatively, you may want to consider multi (compound) entries instead (see \sectionref{sec:multientries}). \section{Command Definitions} \label{sec:newentrydefs} \cmddef{longnewglossaryentry} This command is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to cater for entries with descriptions that contain paragraph breaks. (The \meta{key}\dequals\meta{value} interface doesn't support paragraph breaks in the value.) The base package only provides an unstarred version of this command, which automatically inserts \gls{leavevmode}\gls{unskip}\gls{nopostdesc} at the end of the description. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package replaces this with a single command: \cmddef{glsxtrpostlongdescription} which has the same effect, but can be redefined if required. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a starred form: \cmddef{longnewglossaryentry*} This doesn't insert the hook at the end of the description. \begin{information} For a general purpose post-description hook, see \sectionref{sec:postdeschooks}. \end{information} Additionally, the \opt{symbols} package option provides \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol}, and the \opt{numbers} package option provides \gls{glsxtrnewnumber}. See \sectionref{sec:gloslistopts} for further details. \section{Glossary Entry Keys} \label{sec:newkeys} In addition to the \idxpl+{gloskey} provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package (summarised in \sectionref{sec:gloskeys}) the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides: % KEY: category \optiondef{gloskey.category} Assigns the \idx{category} label. This should not contain any special or active characters as it's used to form command names. See \sectionref{sec:categories} for further details. % KEY: seealso \optiondef{gloskey.seealso} This key is analogous to the \gloskey{see} key but the tag is always given by \gls{seealsoname}. The value \meta{xr-list} should be a comma-separated list of entry labels. As with the \gloskey{see} key, this key automatically indexes the cross-reference by default. The cross-reference will be displayed in the \idx{locationlist} using \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat} (see \sectionref{sec:xr}). Use \opteqvalref{autoseeindex}{false} to prevent the automatic \idx{indexing}. (With \app{bib2gls}, adjust the \resourceopt{selection} criteria.) \begin{important} With just the base \sty{glossaries} package, the \gloskey{see} key simply performs this automated indexing. With \sty{glossaries-extra} the value is also saved. Similarly with the \gloskey{seealso} key. The value isn't saved with explicit use of \gls{glsxtrindexseealso} or \gls{glssee}. \end{important} % KEY: alias \optiondef{gloskey.alias} This is similar to the \gloskey{see} key but the value can only be a single entry label. In addition to automatically \idx{indexing} the cross-reference, this command will cause the entry with this key to have hyperlinks go to the aliased entry when referenced with commands like \gls{gls}. Whenever the entry is \indexed\ with commands like \gls{gls}, the \idx{indexing} will be performed on the target entry (the \gloskey{alias} value). See \sectionref{sec:xr} for further details. \begin{important} Any entry that has a \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} or \gloskey{alias} key set will be added to the glossary by default when using \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}. If you don't want this behaviour, use the \optval{autoseeindex}{false} package option and implement a \idx{postdeschook} to insert the cross-reference. Alternatively, consider switching to \app{bib2gls}. \end{important} If you use \app{bib2gls} (see \sectionref{sec:bib2gls}) then most of the \idxpl{gloskey} can be used as analogous fields in the \ext+{bib} file. For example, instead of writing the following code in your \ext+{tex} file: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck}, \gloskeyval{description}{a waterbird with webbed feet}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \end{codebox} You would write the following in a \ext+{bib} file: \begin{codebox} \atentry{entry}\marg{duck, \gloskeyval{name}{duck}, \gloskeyval{description}{a waterbird with webbed feet} } \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{svm, \gloskeyval{short}{SVM}, \gloskeyval{long}{support vector machine}, } \end{codebox} There are, however, some keys that are considered \idxc{bib2glsinternalfield}{internal fields} by \app{bib2gls}, in that they are defined as keys by \sty{glossaries-extra} and may be assigned in the \ext+{glstex} file that's input by \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}, but they should not be used in the \ext+{bib} files. For example, the \gloskey{sort} key (which is recommended with \app{xindy} where the \gloskey{name} contains symbols) should not be used in the \ext{bib} file. Instead, use the \resourceopt{sort-field} resource option or the system of sort fallbacks to choose the most appropriate field to obtain the sort value (see \gallerypage{bib2gls-sorting}{Gallery: Sorting}). The \gloskey{group} and \gloskey{location} keys are also considered \idxc{bib2glsinternalfield}{internal fields} and are only applicable with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \begin{information} The \gloskey{group} and \gloskey{location} keys are defined by the \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref} options and are only applicable with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} % KEY: group \optiondef{gloskey.group} This key is used by \app{bib2gls} within the \ext{glstex} file to set the \idx{group} label. This label is typically a by-product of the sorting method (see \sectionref{sec:glosgroups}). If it is explicitly set without reference to the order it can result in fragmented groups, see \gallerypage{logicaldivisions}{Gallery: Logical Glossary Divisions (type vs group vs parent)}. The group title can be set with \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}. You will need to invoke \app{bib2gls} with the \switch{group} (or \switch{g}) switch to ensure that this key is set, when required. \begin{important} Letter \idxpl{group} are a consequence of sorting, not the other way around. \end{important} % KEY: location \optiondef{gloskey.location} Used by \app{bib2gls} to store the formatted \idx{locationlist}. The unformatted \idxc{internalfield}{internal location list} is stored in the \glosfield{loclist} field, as with \gls{printnoidxglossary}. With the \idx{unsrtfam}, if the \gloskey{location} field isn't set, then it will try the \glosfield{loclist} field instead, using the same method as \gls{printnoidxglossary} to display the \locations. If you don't want locations with \app{bib2gls}, either use \printglossopt{nonumberlist} or use the \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false} resource option. The base \sty{glossaries} package provides \gls{glsaddkey} and \gls{glsaddstoragekey} to allow custom keys to be defined. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package additionally provides: \cmddef{glsxtrprovidestoragekey} This is like \gls{glsaddstoragekey} but does nothing if the key has already been defined. As with \gls{glsaddstoragekey}, the starred version switches on field expansion for the given key (provided that it hasn't already been defined). \cmddef{glsxtrifkeydefined} Tests if the given key has been defined as a \idx{gloskey}. \section{Plurals} \label{sec:plurals} Some languages, such as English, have a general rule that plurals are formed from the singular with a suffix appended. This isn't an absolute rule. There are plenty of exceptions (for example, geese, children, churches, elves, fairies, sheep). The \sty{glossaries} package allows the \gloskey{plural} key to be optional when defining entries. In some cases a plural may not make any sense (for example, the term is a symbol) and in some cases the plural may be identical to the singular. To make life easier for languages where the majority of plurals can simply be formed by appending a suffix to the singular, the \sty{glossaries} package lets the \gloskey{plural} field default to the value of the \gloskey{text} field with \gls{glspluralsuffix} appended. This command is defined to be just the letter \qt{s}. This means that the majority of terms don't need to have the \gloskey{plural} supplied as well, and you only need to use it for the exceptions. For languages that don't have this general rule, the \gloskey{plural} field will always need to be supplied, where needed. There are other plural fields, such as \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{longplural} and \gloskey{shortplural}. Again, if you are using a language that doesn't have a simple suffix rule, you'll have to supply the plural forms if you need them (and if a plural makes sense in the context). If these fields are omitted, the \sty{glossaries} package follows these rules: \begin{itemize} \item If \gloskey{firstplural} is missing, then \gls{glspluralsuffix} is appended to the \gloskey{first} field, if that field has been supplied. If the \gloskey{first} field hasn't been supplied but the \gloskey{plural} field has been supplied, then the \gloskey{firstplural} field defaults to the \gloskey{plural} field. If the \gloskey{plural} field hasn't been supplied, then both the \gloskey{plural} and \gloskey{firstplural} fields default to the \gloskey{text} field (or \gloskey{name}, if no \gloskey{text} field) with \gls{glspluralsuffix} appended. \item If the \gloskey{longplural} field is missing, then \gls{glspluralsuffix} is appended to the \gloskey{long} field, if the \gloskey{long} field has been supplied. \item If the \gloskey{shortplural} field is missing then, \emph{with the base \sty{glossaries} acronym mechanism}, \gls{acrpluralsuffix} is appended to the \gloskey{short} field. \end{itemize} The \emph{last case is changed} with \sty{glossaries-extra}. With this extension package, the \gloskey{shortplural} field defaults to the \gloskey{short} field with \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} appended unless overridden by category attributes. This suffix command is set by the abbreviation styles. This means that every time an abbreviation style is implemented, \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} is redefined, see \sectionref{sec:abbrvfieldslongshortpl} for further details. \section{Entry Aliases} \label{sec:alias} An entry can be made an alias of another entry using the \gloskey{alias} key. The value should be the label of the other term. There's no check for the other's existence when the aliased entry is defined. This is to allow the possibility of defining the other entry after the aliased entry. (For example, when used with \app{bib2gls}.) \cmddef*{glsxtraliashook} This hook is implemented when an entry is defined with the \gloskey{alias} key set. It does nothing by default. The value of the \gloskey{alias} field can be obtained with \code{\gls{glsxtralias}\margm{entry-label}}. If an entry \meta{entry-1} is made an alias of \meta{entry-2} then: \begin{itemize} \item If the \gloskey{see} field wasn't provided when \meta{entry-1} was defined, the \gloskey{alias} key will automatically trigger \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glssee}\margm{entry-1}\margm{entry-2} \end{compactcodebox} \item If the \sty{hyperref} package has been loaded then \code{\gls{gls}\margm{entry-1}} will link to \meta{entry-2}'s target. (Unless the \catattr{targeturl} attribute has been set for \meta{entry-1}'s category.) \item With \opteqvalref{record}{off} or \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid}, the \glsopt{noindex} setting will automatically be triggered when referencing \meta{entry-1} with commands like \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext}. This prevents \meta{entry-1} from having a \idx{locationlist} (aside from the cross-reference added with \gls{glssee}) unless it's been explicitly indexed with \gls{glsadd} or if the indexing has been explicitly set using \glsoptval{noindex}{false}. See \sectionref{sec:glssee} for adjusting the indexing hook. Note that with \opteqvalref{record}{only}, the \idx{locationlist} for aliased entries is controlled with \app{bib2gls}['s] settings. \end{itemize} The value of the \gloskey{alias} field can be accessed with \gls{glsxtralias} (see \sectionref{sec:getsee}). \section{Setting or Updating Fields} \label{sec:setfields} See \sectionref{sec:getfields} for accessing field values and \sectionref{sec:fieldconditionals} for testing field values. \begin{warning} Modifications to fields only have an effect from that point onwards and may be localised to the current scope. If you are using \opteqvalref{docdef}{true}, any changes to the field values won't be saved in the \ext+{glsdefs} file. \end{warning} Some of these commands are subtly different from each other. For example, \gls{glsfielddef} (provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package), \gls{glsxtrdeffield} and \gls{GlsXtrSetField} all assign a value to a field, but \gls{glsfielddef} requires that both the entry and the field exists (so it can't be used to set an unknown \idx{internalfield}), \gls{GlsXtrSetField} requires that the entry exists (so it can be used to set an \idx{internalfield} that doesn't have an associated key provided that the entry has been defined), and \gls{glsxtrdeffield} doesn't perform any existence checks (which means that it can be used to assign \idxpl{internalfield} before the entry is actually defined). The commands described in this section don't require the \idx{field} to have an associated \idx{gloskey}, so you need to be careful not to misspell the field labels. \begin{information} Assigning or changing fields using the commands described here won't alter related fields. For example, if you use the \gloskey{text} key but not the \gloskey{plural} key when you define an entry with \gls{newglossaryentry}, the \gloskey{plural} key will automatically be set as well, but if you change the value of the \gloskey{text} field after the entry has been defined, the \gloskey{plural} field won't be changed. Particular care is required if the field contributes in some way to the \idx{indexing} information, as this information is typically initialised when the entry is first defined. This includes the \gloskey{sort} and \gloskey{parent} keys, which should not be changed after the entry has been defined. \end{information} With \app{bib2gls}, entries aren't defined on the first \LaTeX\ run. This means that commands that test for existence will produce a warning and (within the \env{document} environment) the \idx{unknowntag} unknown marker. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{record}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{myentries},\resourceoptval{selection}{all}} \cbeg{document} Defining info \gls{glsxtrdeffield}\marg{sample}\marg{info}\marg{some information}. Defining note \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{sample}\marg{note}\marg{some note}. \codepar Info: \gls{glsxtrusefield}\marg{sample}\marg{info}. Note: \gls{glsxtrusefield}\marg{sample}\marg{note}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} On the first \LaTeX\ run, this produces: \begin{resultbox} Defining info . Defining note \glslink{idx.unknowntag}{??}. Info: some information. Note: . \end{resultbox} At this point the \code{sample} entry hasn't been defined, so referencing it in \gls{GlsXtrSetField} results in a warning and the double question mark \idx{unknowntag} unknown marker in the text. The field (\code{note}) isn't saved, so nothing is shown when the field is referenced with \gls{glsxtrusefield}. Whereas \gls{glsxtrdeffield} does save the field with the label \code{info} associated with the label \code{sample}, even though the \code{sample} entry hasn't actually been defined. The field can then be later obtained with \gls{glsxtrusefield}. Once \app{bib2gls} has been run, the \code{sample} entry should now have its definition in the \ext{glstex} file, which is loaded by \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} and the \code{note} field can be set. \cmddef{glsxtrdeffield} This uses \sty{etoolbox}'s \gls{csdef} command to locally set the \idx{field} given by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} to \meta{value} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. No existence check is performed. \cmddef{glsxtredeffield} This is like \gls{glsxtrdeffield} but (protected) fully expands the value before assigning it to the field. \cmddef{glsxtrapptocsvfield} This command is designed for fields that should contain comma-separated lists. If the field hasn't been defined, this behaves like \gls{glsxtrdeffield} otherwise it will append a comma followed by \meta{element} (unexpanded) to the field value. No existence check is performed. This field can be iterated over using \gls{glsxtrforcsvfield} or formatted using \gls{glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist}. See \sectionref{sec:csvfields} for further details. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldlistadd} Appends the given value to the given entry's field (identified using the \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{field's internal label}) using \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{listcsadd}. The field value can later be iterated over using \gls{glsxtrfielddolistloop} or \gls{glsxtrfieldforlistloop}. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldlistgadd} As above but uses \gls{listcsgadd} to make a global change. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldlisteadd} As above but uses \gls{listcseadd} to expand the value. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldlistxadd} As above but uses \gls{listcsxadd} to make a global change. \cmddef{glsxtrsetfieldifexists} This is used by the commands \gls{GlsXtrSetField}, \gls{gGlsXtrSetField}, \gls{xGlsXtrSetField}, \gls{eGlsXtrSetField}, \gls{GlsXtrLetField}, \gls{csGlsXtrLetField} and \gls{GlsXtrLetFieldToField} to produce an error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) if the entry doesn't exist. This can be redefined to add extra checks (for example, to prohibit changing certain fields). \cmddef{GlsXtrSetField} This uses \sty{etoolbox}'s \gls{csdef} command to locally set the \idx{field} given by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} to \meta{value} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. This command is written to the \ext{glstex} file by \app{bib2gls} to set fields that don't have a corresponding key. \cmddef{gGlsXtrSetField} This is like \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but uses a global assignment. \cmddef{eGlsXtrSetField} This is like \gls{GlsXtrSetField} but (protected) fully expands the value first. \cmddef{xGlsXtrSetField} This is like \gls{eGlsXtrSetField} but uses a global assignment. \cmddef{GlsXtrLetField} This uses \sty{etoolbox}'s \gls{cslet} command to locally set the \idx{field} given by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} to \meta{cs} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. \cmddef{csGlsXtrLetField} This uses \sty{etoolbox}'s \gls{csletcs} command to locally set the \idx{field} given by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} to the control sequence given by \meta{cs-name} for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. \cmddef{GlsXtrLetFieldToField} This assigns the field identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field1-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry1-label} to the value of the \idx{field} identified by \meta{field2-label} for the entry identified by \meta{entry2-label} \chapter{Abbreviations} \label{sec:abbreviations} The acronym mechanism implemented by the base \sty+{glossaries} package is insufficiently flexible for some documents. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a completely different mechanism to deal with abbreviations in a more flexible manner. The two methods are incompatible. However, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides predefined styles that emulate the appearance of the styles provided by the base package. If you have previously used just the base \sty+{glossaries} package, consult \tableref{tab:acrabbrvstyles} for the closest matching abbreviation style. \section{Defining Abbreviations} \label{sec:newabbr} Abbreviations are defined using: \cmddef{newabbreviation} where \meta{entry-label} is the entry's label (used in commands like \gls{gls}), \meta{short} is the short form (the abbreviation) and \meta{long} is the long form (what the abbreviation is short for). The optional argument \meta{options} may be used to set additional keys (as per the \idxc{gloskey}{options list} in \gls{newglossaryentry}), such as \gloskey{type} or \gloskey{category}. This command internally uses \gls{newglossaryentry} and sets the \gloskey{type} to \gls{glsxtrabbrvtype} and the \gloskey{category} to \cat{abbreviation}. The category (see \sectionref{sec:categories}) determines the abbreviation style. The style for a particular category is set using \gls{setabbreviationstyle}. If the optional argument is omitted, the \cat{abbreviation} category is assumed (see \sectionref{sec:abbrstyle} for further details). The following example document sets up three different abbreviation styles: \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} for the \cat{abbreviation} category, \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only} for the custom \code{genus} category, and \abbrstyle{short-nolong} for the custom \code{common} category. Note that the custom \code{title} category doesn't have an associated style. \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc}} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only}} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{common}\marg{\abbrstyle{short-nolong}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{xml}\marg{extensible markup language} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus}}\marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus}}\marg{myristica}\marg{M.}\marg{Myristica} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{common}}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{title}}\marg{dr}\marg{Dr}\marg{Doctor} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium}, \gls{gls}\marg{myristica}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{dr}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium}, \gls{gls}\marg{myristica}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{dr}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multiple abbreviation styles}, description={Example document with multiple abbreviation styles}, label={ex:multiabbrvstyles} ] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{long-only-short-only}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{common}\marg{short-nolong}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{xml}\marg{extensible markup language}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus}}\marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus}}\marg{myristica}\marg{M.}\marg{Myristica}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{common}}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{title}}\marg{dr}\marg{Dr}\marg{Doctor} } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium}, \gls{gls}\marg{myristica}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{dr}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium}, \gls{gls}\marg{myristica}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{dr}. } \end{resultbox} If the category doesn't have an associated style, the style for the \cat{abbreviation} category will be used, as with the \code{dr} entry above, which uses the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style because no style has been associated with its custom \code{title} category. There are two categories that have an abbreviation style set by default: \cat{abbreviation} and \cat{acronym}. These are initialised as follows: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short}} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{short}} \end{codebox} This means that abbreviations defined with the default \cat{abbreviation} category will show the long form followed by the short form in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}, and those defined with the \gloskey{category} set to \cat{acronym} will only show the short form (that is, the long form won't be shown on \idx{firstuse}). To make it easier to migrate a file containing entries defined with \gls{newacronym}, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines \gls{newacronym} to do: \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskey{type}=\gls{acronymtype},\gloskey{category}=\cat{acronym},\meta{options}}\margm{entry-label}\margm{short}\margm{long} \end{codebox} Note that this sets the \gloskey{category} to \cat{acronym}, which means that any abbreviations defined with \gls{newacronym} will use the \abbrstyle{short} style by default. If you want to use a different style, you need to set the abbreviation style for the \cat{acronym} category. For example, to use the \abbrstyle{long-short} style: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short}} \end{codebox} This must be placed before the first instance of \gls{newacronym}. \begin{information} You can't use \gls{setacronymstyle} with \sty{glossaries-extra}. \end{information} If you have defined any acronym styles with \gls{newacronymstyle}, you will have to migrate them over to \gls{newabbreviationstyle}. However, most of the predefined abbreviation styles are flexible enough to adapt to common abbreviation formats. It is possible to revert \gls{newacronym} back to using the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism (\sectionref{sec:acrorevert}), but it should generally not be necessary. Terms defined with \gls{newabbreviation} (and \gls{newacronym}) can be referenced in the main document text using commands like \gls{gls}. (If you want to use shortcut commands like \gls{ac}, use the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac} package option.) Remember that you can use the \glsopt{prereset} and \glsopt{preunset} options to reset or unset the \idx{firstuseflag} (see \sectionref{sec:glsunset}). Alternatively, you can use the commands described in \sectionref{sec:abbrvfieldrefs}. For headings and captions, see \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}. \begin{important} Avoid using \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{glsfirstplural}, \gls{glstext} and \gls{glsplural} with abbreviations. Many of the abbreviation styles are too complex to work with these commands (particularly the case-changing variants or with the \meta{insert} final optional argument or with \glsopt{innertextformat}). Instead, use commands like \gls{gls}, \gls{glsxtrshort}, \gls{glsxtrlong} and \gls{glsxtrfull}. \end{important} \subsection{Abbreviation Fields: \optfmt{long} and \optfmt{short}} \label{sec:abbrvfieldslongshort} The \meta{short} and \meta{long} arguments are internally assigned with the \gloskey{short} and \gloskey{long} keys (so don't use those keys in \meta{options}), but the short and long values may first be modified by category attributes, such as \catattr{markwords} or \catattr{markshortwords}. As with other entries, avoid nested links (see \sectionref{sec:nested}). This means avoid using the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands within \meta{short} and \meta{long}. \begin{information} If an abbreviation can be formed by combining other entries, consider using the multi (compound) entry function (see \sectionref{sec:multientries}). \end{information} \subsection{Abbreviation Fields: \optfmt{longplural} and \optfmt{shortplural}} \label{sec:abbrvfieldslongshortpl} The \gloskey{longplural} key defaults to \meta{long}\gls{glspluralsuffix} and the \gloskey{shortplural} key defaults to \meta{short}\gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}. The \catattr{aposplural} attribute will instead set the \gloskey{shortplural} to \code{\meta{short}'\gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}} and the \catattr{noshortplural} attribute will set \gloskey{shortplural} to just \meta{short} (see \sectionref{sec:categories}). If these values are not appropriate, you will need to explicitly set the \gloskey{longplural} and \gloskey{shortplural} keys in \meta{options}. The short plural suffix \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} is redefined by the abbreviation style. Some styles, such as the \abbrstyle{long-short} style, simply redefine \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} to just: \cmddef{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} which is defined to \gls{glspluralsuffix}. Some styles, such as the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style, redefine \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix} to include code to counteract the formatting of the abbreviation. \begin{information} If you want to change the default short plural suffix, you need to redefine \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} not \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}. If you don't want the suffix added, then set the \catattr{noshortplural} attribute to \code{true}. \end{information} \subsection{Abbreviation Fields: \optfmt{name} and \optfmt{description}} \label{sec:abbrvfieldsnamedesc} The \gloskey{name} key is set according to the abbreviation style. There should not be any need to explicitly set it. Some styles require the \gloskey{description} key to be set in \meta{options}, but other styles will set the \gloskey{description} to the long form. \subsection{Abbreviation Fields: \optfmt{type}} \label{sec:abbrvfieldstype} Abbreviations can be assigned to a particular \idx{glossary} using the \gloskey{type} key in \meta{options}. The default for \gls{newabbreviation} is: \cmddef{glsxtrabbrvtype} This is initialised to \gls{glsdefaulttype} (the default glossary), but the \opt{abbreviations} package option will redefine it to \code{abbreviations}. The default \gloskey{type} for \gls{newacronym} is: \cmddef{acronymtype} This is initialised to \gls{glsdefaulttype}, but the \opt{acronyms} package option will redefine it to \code{acronym}. \subsection{General Hooks} \label{sec:abbrvgeneralhooks} The following are general purpose hooks used within \gls{newabbreviation}. Note that there are additional hooks that are used by the abbreviation styles (see \sectionref{sec:abbrstyleinit}). \cmddef{glsxtrnewabbrevpresetkeyhook} This hook is provided for further customisation, if required. It's implemented before the entry is defined (before the \gloskey{shortplural} and \gloskey{longplural} keys supplied in \meta{options} are parsed). Does nothing by default. The arguments are a legacy throwback to old versions that didn't have \gls{glsxtrorgshort}. \cmddef{newabbreviationhook} This hook is performed just before the entry is defined. Does nothing by default. \section{Examples: \appfmt{makeindex} vs \appfmt{bib2gls}} \label{sec:abbrvmakeindexvsbib2gls} Example document using \app{makeindex}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{XML}\marg{extensible markup language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label{ex:newabbVSnewacVSnewentry}, title={\cmd{newabbreviation} vs \cmd{newacronym} vs \cmd{newglossaryentry}}, description={Example document illustrating the difference between \cmd{newabbreviation}, \cmd{newacronym} and \cmd{newglossaryentry}}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{XML}\marg{extensible markup language}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration}% } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Note that the long form of NASA isn't displayed on the \idx{firstuse} of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{nasa}}. This is because the \cat{acronym} category uses the \abbrstyle{short} style by default. In the above example, all entries are placed in the main (default) glossary. The package options \opt{abbreviations} and \opt{acronyms} can be used to split them off into separate glossaries. If you use \app{bib2gls}, the analogous \ext!{bib} entry types are \atentry{abbreviation} and \atentry{acronym}. The above example can be rewritten to use \app{bib2gls}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\gls{jobname}.bib} \atentry{entry}\marg{sample, \gloskeyval{name}{sample}, \gloskeyval{description}{an example} } \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{xml, \gloskeyval{short}{XML}, \gloskeyval{long}{extensible markup language} } \atentry{acronym}\marg{nasa, \gloskeyval{short}{NASA}, \gloskeyval{long}{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} } \cend{filecontents*} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label{ex:atabbVSatacVSatentry}, title={\code{@abbreviation} vs \code{@acronym} vs \code{@entry}}, description={Example document illustrating the difference between \code{@abbreviation}, \code{@acronym} and \code{@entry}}] {% \cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\gls{jobname}.bib}^^J% @entry{sample,^^J% name={sample},^^J% description={an example}^^J% }^^J% @abbreviation{xml,^^J% short={XML},^^J% long={extensible markup language}^^J% }^^J% @acronym{nasa,^^J% short={NASA},^^J% long={National Aeronautics and Space Administration}^^J% }^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml} and \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \section{Referencing (Using) Abbreviations} \label{sec:abbrvfieldrefs} Since \gls{newabbreviation} internally uses \gls{newglossaryentry}, you can reference abbreviations with the \gls{glslike} commands as with other entries. Remember that you can use the \glsopt{prereset} and \glsopt{preunset} options to reset or unset the \idx{firstuseflag} (see \sectionref{sec:glsunset}). In general it's best not to use \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{glsfirstplural}, \gls{glstext}, \gls{glsplural} or their case-changing variants as many of the abbreviation styles are too complicated for those commands. If you specifically want the full form, use \gls{gls} with \glsopt{prereset} or use \gls{glsxtrfull}. If you specifically want the short form for a particular instance, use \gls{gls} with \glsopt{preunset} or use \gls{glsxtrshort}. If you only want the long form for a particular instance, use \gls{glsxtrlong}. If you never want the short form with \gls{gls}, use one of the \qt{noshort} styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-noshort}. If you never want the long form with \gls{gls}, use one of the \qt{nolong} styles, such as \abbrstyle{short-nolong}. \begin{information} If you need to use abbreviations in headings or captions, use commands like \gls{glsfmtshort} and \gls{glsfmtlong} (see \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}). Commands like \gls{glsentryname} are likely to contain non-expandable content. \end{information} Example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{tableofcontents} \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing the \gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{svm}} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{gls}\marg{html} (incorrect)} First use (not!): \gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{glsreset}\marg{html} \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html} (incorrect)} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{glsreset}\marg{html} \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{glsfmtshort}\marg{html}} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:abbrhyper}, title={Referencing an abbreviation (with \styfmt{hyperref})}, description={Example document illustrating referencing an abbreviation (with hyperref)}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% } {% \gls{tableofcontents}^^J% \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing the \gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{svm}}^^J% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{svm}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{gls}\marg{html} (incorrect)}^^J% First use (not!): \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}^^J% \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html} (incorrect)}^^J% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \codepar \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}^^J% \cmd{section}\marg{Introducing \gls{glsfmtshort}\marg{html}}^^J% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} In the above example, compare the first section heading (which references an abbreviation with \gls{glsfmtlong}) with the second section heading (which references an abbreviation with \gls{gls}). Note that the \idx{firstuse} of the \code{html} entry actually occurs in the table of contents, which results in the full form showing in the table of contents, but only the abbreviation is shown in the actual section~2 heading. The PDF bookmark shows the entry label (\code{html}) not the abbreviation (HTML). There is also a nested link for section~2 in the table of contents. In some PDF viewers (such as Okular), this will lead to section~2 but, in others (such as Evince), it will lead to the HTML entry target in the glossary. Similarly for section~3. As with the base \sty{glossaries} package, the unformatted short and long forms can be obtained with \gls{glsentryshort} and \gls{glsentrylong} or, for the plural forms, \gls{glsentryshortpl} and \gls{glsentrylongpl}. These are analogous to commands like \gls{glsentrytext} and may be used in expandable contexts. The sentence case versions (\gls{Glsentryshort}, \gls{Glsentrylong}, \gls{Glsentryshort}, and \gls{Glsentrylong}) are all robust in \sty{glossaries} v4.49 and lower. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, they can expand in PDF bookmarks, but outside of PDF bookmarks they will expand to a robust internal command. \begin{important} Don't use the base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym commands, such as \gls{acrshort}. These aren't compatible with \gls{newabbreviation}. \end{important} Each abbreviation style has a \idx{displayfullform}, which is the format produced with the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls}, and an \idx{inlinefullform}, which is the format produced by \gls{glsxtrfull}. For some styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-short}, the \idxc{displayfullform}{display} and \idxc{inlinefullform}{inline} forms are identical. \Exampleref{ex:glsVSfullVSfirst} demonstrates the difference between the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} compared with the \idx{inlinefullform} for the \abbrstyle{footnote} abbreviation style. The example also uses \gls{glsfirst} to demonstrate that it produces an undesirable result with the selected abbreviation style. \begin{coderesult}[float] \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{footnote} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{glsfirst}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots} \cend{document} \tcblower \createexample*[fontsize={20}, label={ex:glsVSfullVSfirst}, title={First use of \cmd{gls} vs \cmd{glsxtrfull} vs \cmd{glsfirst}}, description={Example document illustrating the difference between the first use of \cmd{gls} compared with \cmd{glsxtrfull} and \cmd{glsfirst}}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{footnote}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration}^^J% } {% \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots}^^J% \codepar \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots}^^J% \codepar \gls{glsfirst}\marg{nasa}\oarg{'s} space exploration\cmd{ldots}^^J% } \end{coderesult} In \exampleref{ex:glsVSfullVSfirst}, the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} puts the long form in the footnote but correctly inserts the final optional argument before the footnote marker. The \idx{inlinefullform} (obtained with \gls{glsxtrfull}) doesn't use a footnote, but instead shows the long form in parentheses after the short form. The insert material is correctly placed after the short form. Compare this with the final line, which uses \gls{glsfirst}. This shows the long form in the footnote, but the inserted material can't be shifted before the footnote marker, which results in the strange \qt{NASA\textsuperscript{2}'s}. The following commands are included in the set of \idx{glstextlike} commands. They have the \idxc{glsopt}{same options} as \gls{glstext} and don't change the \idx{firstuseflag}. They will index (unless \glsopt{noindex} is used), create a hyperlink (if enabled), and use the \idx{postlinkhook}. \cmddef{glsxtrshort} Displays the short form using the abbreviation style's formatting. \cmddef{Glsxtrshort} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrshort} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrshortpl} Displays the short plural form using the abbreviation style's formatting. \cmddef{Glsxtrshortpl} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortpl} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrlong} Displays the long form using the abbreviation style's formatting. As from v1.49, this command simulates \idx{firstuse} by defining \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to do its first argument. This is done via the command: \cmddef{glsxtrsetlongfirstuse} which is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrsetlongfirstuse}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \cmd{let}\gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\gls+{@firstoftwo}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} This command takes the entry label as the argument, which is ignored by default. To restore the original behaviour, redefine this command as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrsetlongfirstuse}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \cmd{letcs}\gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\marg{@secondoftwo}\comment{} } \end{codebox} This command is also used by the case-changing and plural variants listed below. \cmddef{Glsxtrlong} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrlong} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrlongpl} Displays the long plural form using the abbreviation style's formatting. \cmddef{Glsxtrlongpl} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongpl} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrfull} Displays the \idx{inlinefullform} using the abbreviation style's formatting. Depending on the style, this may not be the same as the text produced with the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls}. \cmddef{Glsxtrfull} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrfull} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrfullpl} Displays the \idxc{inlinefullform}{inline full plural form} using the abbreviation style's formatting. Depending on the style, this may not be the same as the text produced with the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl}. \cmddef{Glsxtrfullpl} As above, but \idx{sentencecase} version. \cmddef{GLSxtrfullpl} As above, but \idx{allcaps} version. \cmddef{glsxtrsetupfulldefs} This hook is used within \gls{glsxtrfull}, \gls{glsxtrfullpl} and the case-changing variations to initialise \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} in case it's required in the \idx{postlinkhook}. The default definition is to simulate \idx{firstuse}. Note that changing this can cause unexpected results with abbreviation styles that set the \idx{postlinkhook}, such as \abbrstyle{short-postlong-user}. \cmddef{glsxtrfullsaveinsert} This hook is used within \gls{glsxtrfull}, \gls{glsxtrfullpl} and the case-changing variations to initialise the \gls{glsinsert} placeholder. The default definition is to use \gls{glsxtrsaveinsert}. If the insert isn't saved, it can't be used within the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \gls{glsxtrfull} etc. This affects the behaviour of the \qt{post-hyphen} abbreviation styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen}. \subsection{Prefixes} \label{sec:abbrprefixes} If you are using the \sty{glossaries-prefix} package (which can be loaded via the \opt{prefix} package option), then there are commands similar to \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong} that insert the corresponding prefix and separator at the front if the short or long form, if the prefix has been set and is non-empty. In all cases, the separator is \gls{glsprefixsep}, as with \gls{pgls}. \begin{important} These commands require \sty{glossaries-prefix}. \end{important} \cmddef{pglsxtrshort} As \gls{glsxtrshort} but inserts the \gloskey{prefix} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefix} value is set and non-empty. \cmddef{Pglsxtrshort} As \gls{pglsxtrshort} but \idx{sentencecase}. Note the initial \qt{P} in the command name, which matches \gls{Pgls} (similarly for the other prefix \idx{sentencecase} commands). \cmddef{PGLSxtrshort} As \gls{pglsxtrshort} but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{pglsxtrshortpl} As \gls{glsxtrshortpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixplural} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixplural} value is set and non-empty. \cmddef{Pglsxtrshortpl} As \gls{pglsxtrshortpl} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSxtrshortpl} As \gls{pglsxtrshortpl} but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{pglsxtrlong} As \gls{glsxtrlong} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirst} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixfirst} value is set and non-empty. \cmddef{Pglsxtrlong} As \gls{pglsxtrlong} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSxtrlong} As \gls{pglsxtrlong} but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{pglsxtrlongpl} As \gls{glsxtrlongpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} value is set and non-empty. \cmddef{Pglsxtrlongpl} As \gls{pglsxtrlongpl} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSxtrlongpl} As \gls{pglsxtrlongpl} but \idx{allcaps}. \subsection{Abbreviation Shortcut Commands} \label{sec:abbrshortcuts} The abbreviation shortcut commands can be enabled using the \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations} package option (or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbr} or \opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac}). The provided shortcut commands listed in \tableref{tab:abbrshortcuts}. Note that \gls{glsxtrenablerecordcount} will switch the shortcuts that use the \gls{cgls}-like commands to the corresponding \gls{rgls}-like command. \begin{table}[htbp] \caption{Abbreviation Shortcut Commands} \label{tab:abbrshortcuts} \centering \begin{tabular}{lll} \bfseries Shortcut & \bfseries Shortcut & \bfseries Equivalent Command\\ \bfseries (\opteqvalref{shortcuts}{abbreviations}) & \bfseries (\opteqvalref{shortcuts}{ac})\\ \inlineglsdef{ab} & \inlineglsdef{ac} & \gls{cgls}\\ \inlineglsdef{abp} & \inlineglsdef{acp} & \gls{cglspl}\\ \inlineglsdef{as} & \inlineglsdef{acs} & \gls{glsxtrshort}\\ \inlineglsdef{asp} & \inlineglsdef{acsp} & \gls{glsxtrshortpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{al} & \inlineglsdef{acl} & \gls{glsxtrlong}\\ \inlineglsdef{alp} & \inlineglsdef{aclp} & \gls{glsxtrlongpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{af} & \inlineglsdef{acf} & \gls{glsxtrfull}\\ \inlineglsdef{afp} & \inlineglsdef{acfp} & \gls{glsxtrfullpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{Ab} & \inlineglsdef{Ac} & \gls{cgls}\\ \inlineglsdef{Abp} & \inlineglsdef{Acp} & \gls{cglspl}\\ \inlineglsdef{As} & \inlineglsdef{Acs} & \gls{Glsxtrshort}\\ \inlineglsdef{Asp} & \inlineglsdef{Acsp} & \gls{Glsxtrshortpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{Al} & \inlineglsdef{Acl} & \gls{Glsxtrlong}\\ \inlineglsdef{Alp} & \inlineglsdef{Aclp} & \gls{Glsxtrlongpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{Af} & \inlineglsdef{Acf} & \gls{Glsxtrfull}\\ \inlineglsdef{Afp} & \inlineglsdef{Acfp} & \gls{Glsxtrfullpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{AB} & \inlineglsdef{AC} & \gls{cGLS}\\ \inlineglsdef{ABP} & \inlineglsdef{ACP} & \gls{cGLSpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{AS} & \inlineglsdef{ACS} & \gls{GLSxtrshort}\\ \inlineglsdef{ASP} & \inlineglsdef{ACSP} & \gls{GLSxtrshortpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{AL} & \inlineglsdef{ACL} & \gls{GLSxtrlong}\\ \inlineglsdef{ALP} & \inlineglsdef{ACLP} & \gls{GLSxtrlongpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{AF} & \inlineglsdef{ACF} & \gls{GLSxtrfull}\\ \inlineglsdef{AFP} & \inlineglsdef{ACFP} & \gls{GLSxtrfullpl}\\ \inlineglsdef{newabbr} & \gls{newabbr} & \gls{newabbreviation} \end{tabular} \end{table} \section{Tagging Initials} \label{sec:tagging} Initial tagging allows you to highlight the initials that form the abbreviation when the long form is shown in the glossary. \cmddef{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} \begin{information} \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} must be placed before the abbreviations are defined. \end{information} This command (robustly) defines \meta{cs} (a control sequence) to accept a single argument, which is the letter (or letters) that needs to be tagged. The normal behaviour of \meta{cs} within the document is to simply do its argument, but in the glossary it's activated for those categories that have the \catattr{tagging} attribute set to \qt{true}. For those cases it will use: \cmddef{glsxtrtagfont} This command defaults to \code{\gls{underline}\margm{text}} but may be redefined as required. The control sequence \meta{cs} can't already be defined when used with the unstarred version of \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} for safety reasons. The starred version will overwrite any previous definition of \meta{cs}. As with redefining any commands, ensure that you don't redefine something important. The first argument of \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} is a comma-separated list of category names. The \catattr{tagging} attribute will automatically be set to \code{true} for those categories. You can later set this attribute for other categories (see \sectionref{sec:categories}) but this must be done before the glossary is displayed. For example, the following uses initial tagging for both the \cat{acronym} and \cat{abbreviation} categories. The custom command \csfmt{itag} is defined as the tagging command. \begin{codebox} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging}\marg{\cat{acronym},\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{\cmd{itag}} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc}} \gls{newacronym} \oarg{description=\marg{a system for detecting the location and speed of ships, aircraft, etc, through the use of radio waves}\comment{description of this term} } \marg{radar}\comment{identifying label} \marg{radar}\comment{short form} \marg{\cmd{itag}\marg{ra}dio \cmd{itag}\marg{d}etection \cmd{itag}\marg{a}nd \cmd{itag}\marg{r}anging} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{XML} \marg{e\cmd{itag}\marg{x}tensible \cmd{itag}\marg{m}arkup \cmd{itag}\marg{l}anguage} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{other}}\marg{tne}\marg{TNE} \marg{\cmd{itag}\marg{t}agging \cmd{itag}\marg{n}ot \cmd{itag}\marg{e}nabled} \codepar \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{radar}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{tne}. \codepar Long form only: \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{radar}, \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{xml}, \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{tne}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:tagging}, title={Tagging abbreviation initials}, description={Example document illustrating the use of \cmd{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} to tag initial letters that form the abbreviation}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging}\marg{acronym,abbreviation}\marg{\cmd{itag}}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{acronym}\marg{short-nolong-desc}^^J% \gls{newacronym}^^J% \oarg{description=\marg{a system for detecting the location and speed of ships, aircraft, etc, through the use of radio waves}\comment{description of this term} }^^J \marg{radar}\comment{identifying label} \marg{radar}\comment{short form} \marg{\cmd{itag}\marg{ra}dio \cmd{itag}\marg{d}etection \cmd{itag}\marg{a}nd \cmd{itag}\marg{r}anging} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{xml}\marg{XML}^^J \marg{e\cmd{itag}\marg{x}tensible \cmd{itag}\marg{m}arkup \cmd{itag}\marg{l}anguage} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{other}}\marg{tne}\marg{TNE}^^J \marg{\cmd{itag}\marg{t}agging \cmd{itag}\marg{n}ot \cmd{itag}\marg{e}nabled} } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{radar}, \gls{gls}\marg{xml}, \gls{gls}\marg{tne}. \codepar Long form only: \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{radar}, \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{xml}, \gls{glsxtrlong}\marg{tne}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The underlining of the tagged letters only occurs in the glossary and then only for entries with the \catattr{tagging} attribute set. \section{Abbreviation Styles} \label{sec:abbrstyle} The style for a particular category is set using: \cmddef{setabbreviationstyle} If the \meta{category} is omitted, \cat{abbreviation} is assumed. Remember that \gls{newacronym} sets the \gloskey{category} to \cat{acronym} so with \gls{newacronym} you need to change the style with: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\margm{style-name} \end{codebox} \begin{important} The abbreviation style must be set before the abbreviation with the corresponding category is defined. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, the style must be set before \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}. \end{important} The style associated with the \cat{abbreviation} category will be used if an abbreviation is defined with a category that doesn't have an associated style. Once you have defined an abbreviation with a given category, you can't subsequently change the style for that category. You can't have more than one style per category. The default style for the \cat{abbreviation} category is \abbrstyle{long-short} and the default style for the \cat{acronym} category is \abbrstyle{short-nolong}. In the example below, the custom \code{latin} category doesn't have an associated abbreviation style, so it uses the style assigned to the \cat{abbreviation} category, not the \cat{acronym} category. The only reason that the \qt{radar} abbreviation (defined with \gls{newacronym}) uses the style associated with the \cat{acronym} category is because the default definition of \gls{newacronym} sets \gloskeyval{category}{\cat{acronym}}. \begin{coderesult} \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{footnote} \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging} \gls{newacronym}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{latin}}\marg{ibid}\marg{ibid}\marg{ibidem} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{radar} and \gls{gls}\marg{ibid}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \tcblower \createexample*[fontsize=20, label={ex:fallbackabbrstyle}, title={Category without an associated abbreviation style}, description={Example document that has an abbreviation with a category that doesn't have an associated abbreviation style}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{acronym}\marg{footnote}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\oarg{category=latin}\marg{ibid}\marg{ibid}\marg{ibidem} } {% \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{radar} and \gls{gls}\marg{ibid}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{coderesult} \subsection{Predefined Abbreviation Styles} \label{sec:predefabbrstyles} There are two types of abbreviation styles: those that treat the abbreviation as a regular entry (so that \gls{gls} uses \gls{glsgenentryfmt} and is encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrregularfont}) and those that don't treat the abbreviation as a regular entry (so that \gls{gls} uses \gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt} and is encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}). See \sectionref{sec:entryfmt} for further details of those commands. \begin{information} The non-regular abbreviation styles allow for more complex formats than the regular styles. \end{information} The regular entry abbreviation styles set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the category assigned to each abbreviation with that style. This means that on \idx{firstuse}, \gls{gls} uses the value of the \gloskey{first} field and on subsequent use \gls{gls} uses the value of the \gloskey{text} field (and analogously for the plural and case-changing versions). The non-regular abbreviation styles don't set the \catattr{regular} attribute, unless it has already been set, in which case it will be changed to \code{false}. The \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{text} fields (and their plural forms) are set, but they aren't used by commands like \gls{gls}, which instead use formatting commands, such as \gls{glsxtrfullformat} and \gls{glsxtrsubsequentfmt}, which are defined by the style. In both cases, the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} may not match the text produced by \gls{glsfirst} (and likewise for the plural and case-changing versions). The \gloskey{short} and \gloskey{long} fields are set as appropriate and may be accessed through commands like \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong}. These may appear slightly differently to the way the short or long form is displayed within \gls{gls}, depending on the style. The sample file \ctanmirrornofn{macros/latex/contrib/glossaries-extra/samples/sample-abbr-styles.pdf}{\filefmt{sample-abbr-styles.pdf}} demonstrates all predefined styles described here. \begin{important} For the \qt{sc} styles that use \gls{textsc}, be careful about your choice of fonts as some only have limited support. For example, you may not be able to combine bold and small-caps. If you're using \pdfLaTeX, I recommend that you at least use the \sty{fontenc} package with the \optfmt{T1} option or something similar. \end{important} The predefined styles have helper commands to make it easier to modify the format. These are described in \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmds}. Table~\ref{tab:acrabbrvstyles} lists the nearest equivalent \sty{glossaries-extra} abbreviation styles for the predefined acronym styles provided by \sty{glossaries}, but note that the new styles use different formatting commands. \begin{table}[htbp] \caption[Base Acronym Styles Verses New Abbreviation Styles]{Base Acronym Styles \glsfmttext{setacronymstyle}\margm{base-style-name} Verses New Abbreviation Styles \glsfmttext{setabbreviationstyle}\oargm{category}\margm{new-style-name}} \label{tab:acrabbrvstyles} \centering \begin{tabular}{lp{0.7\textwidth}} \bfseries Base Style Name & \bfseries New Style Name\\ \acrstyle{long-sc-short} & \abbrstyle{long-short-sc}\\ \acrstyle{long-sm-short} & \abbrstyle{long-short-sm}\\ \acrstyle{long-sp-short} & \abbrstyle{long-short} \newline with \code{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullsep}}\marg{\gls{glsabspace}}}\\ \acrstyle{short-long} & \abbrstyle{short-long}\\ \acrstyle{sc-short-long} & \abbrstyle{short-sc-long}\\ \acrstyle{sm-short-long} & \abbrstyle{short-sm-long}\\ \acrstyle{long-short-desc} & \abbrstyle{long-short-desc}\\ \acrstyle{long-sc-short-desc} & \abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}\\ \acrstyle{long-sm-short-desc} & \abbrstyle{long-short-sm-desc}\\ \acrstyle{long-sp-short-desc} & \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} \newline with \code{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullsep}}\marg{\gls{glsabspace}}}\\ \acrstyle{short-long-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-long-desc}\\ \acrstyle{sc-short-long-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-sc-long-desc}\\ \acrstyle{sm-short-long-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-sm-long-desc}\\ \acrstyle{dua} & \abbrstyle{long-noshort}\\ \acrstyle{dua-desc} & \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc}\\ \acrstyle{footnote} & \abbrstyle{short-footnote}\\ \acrstyle{footnote-sc} & \abbrstyle{short-sc-footnote}\\ \acrstyle{footnote-sm} & \abbrstyle{short-sm-footnote}\\ \acrstyle{footnote-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc}\\ \acrstyle{footnote-sc-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-sc-footnote-desc}\\ \acrstyle{footnote-sm-desc} & \abbrstyle{short-sm-footnote-desc} \end{tabular} \end{table} The example documents used to illustrate the predefined styles in the sub-sections below are all in the form (document class and options may vary): \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\margm{style-name} \gls{newabbreviation}\oargm{options}\marg{ex}\margm{short}\marg{long form} \cbeg{document} First: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert]. Next: \gls{gls}\marg{ex}[-insert]. Full: \gls{glsxtrfull}\marg{ex}[-insert]. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} where \meta{style-name} is the name of the abbreviation style, \meta{short} is either \qt{SHRT FM} or (for the \idx{smallcaps} examples) \qt{shrt fm}. The styles that require the \gloskey{description} or \gloskey{user1} key to be set will include that in \meta{options} otherwise the optional argument of \gls{newabbreviation} will be omitted. The examples with a style that requires \gls{textsmaller} will load \sty{relsize}. The \qt{hyphen} styles set the \catattr{markwords} and \catattr{markshortwords} attributes. Note that \sty{hyperref} is loaded with the \optfmt{colorlinks} option, so the hyperlink text will be red. The naming scheme for abbreviation styles is as follows: \begin{itemize} \item \meta{field1}[\code{-}\meta{modifier1}]\code{-}[post]\meta{field2}[\code{-}\meta{modifier2}][\code{-user}] This is for the parenthetical styles. The \code{-}\meta{modifier} parts may be omitted. These styles display \meta{field1} followed by \meta{field2} in parentheses. If \meta{field1} or \meta{field2} starts with \qt{no} then that element is omitted from the \idxc{displayfullform}{display style} (no parenthetical part) but is included in the \idxc{inlinefullform}{inline style}. If \code{post} is present then \meta{field2} is placed after the \gls{linktext} using the \idx{postlinkhook}. Note that this will use the singular form of \meta{field2} by default, even if \gls{glspl} is used. The corresponding non-post style will use the matching form for \meta{field2}. If the \code{-}\meta{modifier} part is present and is one of \code{sc}, \code{sm} or \code{em}, then the field has a font changing command applied to it. The modifier \code{-only} indicates that field is only present according to whether or not the entry has been used. The modifier \code{-hyphen} indicates the style will substitute inter-word spaces (that have been marked up with the \catattr{markwords} or \catattr{markshortwords} attributes) will be changed to spaces if the inserted material starts with a hyphen (but not for the set of \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong} commands). If the \code{-user} part is present, then the value of the field given by \gls{glsxtruserfield} (\gloskey{user1}), if set, is inserted into the parenthetical material. Examples: \begin{itemize} \item\abbrstyle{long-noshort-sc}: \meta{field1} is the long form, the short form is set in \idx{smallcaps} but omitted in the display style. \item\abbrstyle{long-em-short-em}: both the long form and the short form are emphasized. The short form is in parentheses. \item\abbrstyle{long-short-em}: the short form is emphasized but not the long form. The short form is in parentheses. \item\abbrstyle{long-short-user}: if the \gloskey{user1} key has been set, this produces the style \meta{long} (\meta{short}, \meta{user1}) otherwise it just produces \meta{long} (\meta{short}). \item\abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen}: the short form and the inserted material (provided by the final optional argument of commands like \gls{gls}) is moved to the post-link hook. The long form is formatted according to \gls{glslonghyphenfont} (or \gls{glsfirstlonghyphenfont} on first use). The short form is formatted according to \gls{glsabbrvhyphenfont} (or \gls{glsfirstabbrvhyphenfont} on first use). \end{itemize} \item \meta{style}\code{-noreg} Some styles set the \catattr{regular} attribute. In some cases, there's a version of the style that doesn't set this attribute. For example, \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em} sets the \catattr{regular} attribute. The \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em-noreg} style is a minor variation of that style that sets the attribute to \code{false}. There are a few \qt{noshort} styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-noshort-noreg}, where there isn't a corresponding regular version. This is because the style won't work properly with the \catattr{regular} attribute set, but the naming scheme is maintained for consistency with the other \qt{noshort} styles. \item \meta{field1}[\code{-}\meta{modifier1}]\code{-}[\code{post}]\code{footnote} The display style uses \meta{field1} followed by a footnote with the other field in it. If \code{post} is present then the footnote is placed after the \gls{linktext} using the post-link hook. The inline style does \meta{field1} followed by the other field in parentheses. If \code{-}\meta{modifier1} is present, \meta{field1} has a font-changing command applied to it. Examples: \begin{itemize} \item \abbrstyle{short-footnote}: short form in the text with the long form in the footnote. \item \abbrstyle{short-sc-postfootnote}: short form in smallcaps with the long form in the footnote outside of the \gls{linktext}. \end{itemize} \begin{important} Take care with the footnote styles. Remember that there are some situations where \gls{footnote} doesn't work. \end{important} \item \meta{style}\code{-desc} Like \meta{style} but the \gloskey{description} key must be provided when defining abbreviations with this style. Examples: \begin{itemize} \item \abbrstyle{short-long-desc}: like \abbrstyle{short-long} but requires a description. \item \abbrstyle{short-em-footnote-desc}: like \abbrstyle{short-em-footnote} but requires a description. \end{itemize} \end{itemize} Not all combinations that fit the above syntax are provided. Pre-version 1.04 styles that didn't fit this naming scheme are either provided with a synonym (where the former name wasn't ambiguous) or provided with a deprecated synonym (where the former name was confusing). \subsubsection{Regular Styles} \label{sec:predefregabbrvstyles} The following abbreviation styles set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for all categories that have abbreviations defined with any of these styles. This means that they are treated like ordinary entries and are encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrregularfont} not \gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}. The \idx{glslike} commands are formatted according to \gls{glsgenentryfmt}. \paragraph{Short Styles} \label{sec:predefregabbrvstylesshort}These styles only show the short form on both \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsnolong} for style commands. \abbrstyledef{short-nolong} Only the short form is shown on \idx{firstuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands. The \idx{inlinefullform} uses the same parenthetical style as \abbrstyle{short-long} (\gls{glsxtrshortlongformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{short-sc-nolong}, \abbrstyle{short-sm-nolong} and \abbrstyle{short-em-nolong}. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{short-nolong} The long form is formatted with \gls{glslongdefaultfont} for the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands. The short form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont} for \idx{subsequentuse} and for the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. The name is set to the short form (\gls{glsxtrshortnolongname}) and the description is set to the unencapsulated long form. \abbrstyledef{short} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-nolong}. \abbrstyledef{short-nolong-desc} As \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but the description must be supplied in the optional argument of \gls{newabbreviation}. Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{short-sc-nolong-desc}, \abbrstyle{short-sm-nolong-desc} and \abbrstyle{short-em-nolong-desc}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{short-nolong-desc} The name is set to the short form followed by the long form in parentheses (\gls{glsxtrshortdescname}), and the sort is set to just the short form. \abbrstyledef{short-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc}. \abbrstyledef{nolong-short} The same as \abbrstyle{short-nolong} except for the \idx{inlinefullform}, which shows the same parenthetical style as \abbrstyle{long-short} (\gls{glsxtrlongshortformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{nolong-short-sc}, \abbrstyle{nolong-short-sm} and \abbrstyle{nolong-short-em}. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{nolong-short} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-nolong} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelc{short-sc-nolong} \abbrstyledef{short-sc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-sc-nolong}. \abbrstyledef{short-sc-nolong-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc{short-sc-nolong-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-sc-nolong-desc}. \abbrstyledef{nolong-short-sc} This style is like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelc{nolong-short-sc} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-nolong} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesm{short-sm-nolong} \abbrstyledef{short-sm} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-sm-nolong}. \abbrstyledef{short-sm-nolong-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdesc{short-sm-nolong-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-sm-nolong-desc}. \abbrstyledef{nolong-short-sm} This style is like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesm{nolong-short-sm} \abbrstyledef{short-em-nolong} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleuc{short-em-nolong} \abbrstyledef{short-em} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-em-nolong}. \abbrstyledef{short-em-nolong-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{short-em-nolong-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-em-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-em-nolong-desc}. \abbrstyledef{nolong-short-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{nolong-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleuc{nolong-short-em} \paragraph{Long Styles} \label{sec:predefregabbrvstyleslong}These styles only show the long form on both \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsnoshort} for style commands. \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-desc} Only the long form is shown on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands (\gls{glsxtrlongformat}). The \idx{inlinefullform} uses the same parenthetical style as \abbrstyle{long-short} (\gls{glsxtrlongshortformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{long-noshort-sc-desc}, \abbrstyle{long-noshort-sm-desc} and \abbrstyle{long-noshort-em-desc}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-noshort-desc} The long form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstlongdefaultfont} on \idx{firstuse} and \gls{glslongdefaultfont} for \idx{subsequentuse} and for the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands. The short form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} within the \idx{inlinefullform} and with \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont} for the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. The name is set to the long form (\gls{glsxtrlongnoshortdescname}) and the description must be supplied. \abbrstyledef{long-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc}. \abbrstyledef{long-noshort} This is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but the name is set to the short form (\gls{glsxtrlongnoshortname}) and the description is set to the unencapsulated long form. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-noshort} \abbrstyledef{long} A synonym for \abbrstyle{long-noshort}. \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-sc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelc{long-noshort-sc} \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-sc-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc{long-noshort-sc-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-sm} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesm{long-noshort-sm} \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-sm-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdesc{long-noshort-sm-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-noshort-em} \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-em-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-noshort-em-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-em-noshort-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glslongemfont} and \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). This emphasizes both the long and short forms. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-em-noshort-em} \abbrstyledef{long-em-noshort-em-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glslongemfont} and \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). This emphasizes both the long and short forms. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-em-noshort-em-desc} \subsubsection{Non-Regular Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyles} The following abbreviation styles will set the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false} if it has previously been set. If it hasn't already been set, it's left unset. Other attributes may also be set, depending on the style. The non-regular styles are too complicated to use \gls{glsgenentryfmt} as the display style (with the \idx{glslike} commands). Instead they use \gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt}. This means that these styles won't work if you provide your own custom display style (using \gls{defglsentryfmt}) that doesn't check for the \catattr{regular} attribute. \begin{important} Avoid using \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{glsfirstplural}, \gls{glstext} and \gls{glsplural} (or their case-changing variants) with these styles. There are also some styles that can be problematic with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} \paragraph{Long (Short) Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleslongshort}These styles show the long form followed by the short form in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse} only the short form is shown. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsparen} for style commands. \abbrstyledef{long-short} The \meta{insert} is placed after the long form on \idx{firstuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands and after the short form on \idx{subsequentuse}. The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform} (\gls{glsxtrlongshortformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{long-short-sc}, \abbrstyle{long-short-sm}, \abbrstyle{long-short-em} and \abbrstyle{long-em-short-em}. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-short} The long form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstlongdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glslongdefaultfont} for the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands. The short form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont} for \idx{subsequentuse} and for the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. The name is set to the short form (\gls{glsxtrlongshortname}) and the description is set to the unencapsulated long form. \abbrstyledef{long-short-desc} As \abbrstyle{long-short} but the description must be supplied in the optional argument of \gls{newabbreviation}. Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}, \abbrstyle{long-short-sm-desc}, \abbrstyle{long-short-em-desc} and \abbrstyle{long-em-short-em-desc}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-short-desc} The name and sort are set to the long form followed by the short form in parentheses (\gls{glsxtrlongshortdescname} and \gls{glsxtrlongshortdescsort}). \abbrstyledef{long-short-sc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelc{long-short-sc} \abbrstyledef{long-short-sc-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc{long-short-sc-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-short-sm} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesm{long-short-sm} \abbrstyledef{long-short-sm-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdesc{long-short-sm-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-short-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-short-em} \abbrstyledef{long-short-em-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-short-em-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-em-short-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} and \gls{glslongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). That is, both the long and short forms are emphasized. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-em-short-em} \abbrstyledef{long-em-short-em-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} and \gls{glslongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). That is, both the long and short forms are emphasized. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-em-short-em-desc} \paragraph{Long (Short, User) Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleslongshortuser}These styles are like the long (short) styles in \sectionref{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleslongshort} but additional content can be supplied in the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield}, which will be placed in the parenthetical content on \idx{firstuse} (if set). The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform}. These styles use the commands \gls{glsxtrusersuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvuserfont}, \gls{glsfirstabbrvuserfont}, \gls{glslonguserfont} and \gls{glsfirstlonguserfont} (except where noted). See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsuser} for style commands. If you need to change the font, you can redefine the associated commands (listed above). However, since \idx{smallcaps} are awkward because the short plural suffix needs to counteract the \idx{smallcaps}, \idx{smallcaps} versions are provided. \abbrstyledef{long-short-user} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but it includes the additional content in the parentheses on \idx{firstuse} or the \idx{inlinefullform}. The description is obtained from \gls{glsuserdescription}, which can be redefined to include the additional information, if required. \abbrvstyleexampleucuser{long-short-user} \abbrstyledef{long-short-user-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname}. \abbrvstyleexampleucuserdesc{long-short-user-desc} \begin{important} This style is incompatible with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} If you need to use \gls{GLSname} with this style, you'll have to redefine \gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname} so that the field name doesn't include the entry label. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname}}\marg{\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\% \cmd{space}(\cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}})\% } \end{codebox} \abbrstyledef{long-postshort-user} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} but the parenthetical material is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}. Note that, unlike \abbrstyle{long-short-user}, the plural form isn't used in the parenthetical material. If you require this, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrpostusershortformat}. \abbrvstyleexampleucuser{long-postshort-user} \abbrstyledef{long-postshort-user-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname}. \abbrvstyleexampleucuserdesc{long-postshort-user-desc} \begin{important} This style is incompatible with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} If you need to use \gls{GLSname} with this style, you'll have to redefine \gls{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname} so that the field name doesn't include the entry label, as for \abbrstyle{long-short-user-desc}. \abbrstyledef{long-postshort-sc-user} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscusersuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscuserfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscuserfont}. The name value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortscusername}. \abbrvstyleexamplelcuser{long-postshort-sc-user} \abbrstyledef{long-postshort-sc-user-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname}. \abbrvstyleexamplelcuserdesc{long-postshort-sc-user-desc} \begin{important} This style is incompatible with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} If you need to use \gls{GLSname} with this style, you'll have to redefine \gls{glsxtrlongshortscuserdescname} so that the field name doesn't include the entry label. \paragraph{Short (Long) Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesshortlong}These styles show the short form followed by the long form in parentheses on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse} only the short form is shown. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsparen} for style commands. \abbrstyledef{short-long} The \meta{insert} is placed after the short form on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands. The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform} (\gls{glsxtrshortlongformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{short-sc-long}, \abbrstyle{short-sm-long}, \abbrstyle{short-em-long} and \abbrstyle{short-em-long-em}. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{short-long} The long form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstlongdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glslongdefaultfont} for the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands. The short form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont} for \idx{subsequentuse} and for the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. The name is set to the short form (\gls{glsxtrlongshortname}) and the description is set to the unencapsulated long form. \abbrstyledef{short-long-desc} As \abbrstyle{short-long} but the description must be supplied in the optional argument of \gls{newabbreviation}. Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{short-sc-long-desc}, \abbrstyle{short-sm-long-desc}, \abbrstyle{short-em-long-desc} and \abbrstyle{short-em-long-em-desc}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{short-long-desc} The name is set to the short form followed by the long form in parentheses (\gls{glsxtrshortlongdescname}), and the sort is set to just the short form (\gls{glsxtrshortlongdescsort}). \abbrstyledef{short-sc-long} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelc{short-sc-long} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-long-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc{short-sc-long-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-long} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesm{short-sm-long} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-long-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdesc{short-sm-long-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-em-long} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleuc{short-em-long} \abbrstyledef{short-em-long-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{short-em-long-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-em-long-em} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} and \gls{glslongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). That is, both the long and short forms are emphasized. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{short-em-long-em} \abbrstyledef{short-em-long-em-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont}, \gls{glsfirstlongemfont} and \gls{glslongemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). That is, both the long and short forms are emphasized. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{short-em-long-em-desc} \paragraph{Short (Long, User) Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesshortlonguser}These styles are like the short (long) styles in \sectionref{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesshortlong} but additional content can be supplied in the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield}, which will be placed in the parenthetical content on \idx{firstuse} (if set). The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform}. These styles use the commands \gls{glsxtrusersuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvuserfont}, \gls{glsfirstabbrvuserfont}, \gls{glslonguserfont} and \gls{glsfirstlonguserfont} (except where noted). See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsuser} for style commands. \abbrstyledef{short-long-user} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it includes the additional content in the parentheses on \idx{firstuse} or the \idx{inlinefullform}. The description is obtained from \gls{glsuserdescription}, which can be redefined to include the additional information, if required. \abbrvstyleexampleucuser{short-long-user} \abbrstyledef{short-long-user-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long-user} but the description must be provided. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname} and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlongdescsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleucuserdesc{short-long-user-desc} \begin{important} This style is incompatible with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} If you need to use \gls{GLSname} with this style, you'll have to redefine \gls{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname} so that the field name doesn't include the entry label. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname}}\marg{\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\% \cmd{space}(\cmd{protect}\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}})\% } \end{codebox} \abbrstyledef{short-postlong-user} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but it includes the additional content in the parentheses on \idx{firstuse} or the \idx{inlinefullform}. The parenthetical content is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook} which can avoid overly long hyperlinks. The description is obtained from \gls{glsuserdescription}, which can be redefined to include the additional information, if required. \abbrvstyleexampleucuser{short-postlong-user} \abbrstyledef{short-postlong-user-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postlong-user} but the description must be provided. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname}. The sort value is the short form. \abbrvstyleexampleucuserdesc{short-postlong-user-desc} \begin{important} This style is incompatible with \gls{GLSname}. \end{important} If you need to use \gls{GLSname} with this style, you'll have to redefine \gls{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname} so that the field name doesn't include the entry label, as for \abbrstyle{short-long-user-desc}. \paragraph{Hyphen Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleshyphen}These styles test if the inserted material start with a hyphen. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral}, \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsparen} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdshyphen} for style commands. \begin{information} These styles are designed to be used with the \catattr{markwords} attribute and (if the short form has spaces) the \catattr{markshortwords} attribute. If the inserted material starts with a hyphen, the spaces will be replaced with hyphens. This replacement won't take place if the corresponding attribute wasn't used to mark the inter-word spaces. \end{information} Note that \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrlong} (and their plural and case-changing variants) don't perform the inter-word space substitution. The \idx{inlinefullform} is slightly different from the \idx{displayfullform} for the \qt{post} styles. \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-short} but checks the inserted material for a leading hyphen. The description is the long form encapsulated with \gls{glslonghyphenfont}. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortname}, and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlonghyphenshortsort}. The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchyp{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} but places the insert and parenthetical material in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{displayfullform}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchyp{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} Note that the \idx{inlinefullform} (\gls{glsxtrfull}) doesn't show the insert in the \idx{postlinkhook}, but instead places it at the end of the \idx{linktext}. This is because only the \idx{glslike} commands (not the \idx{glstextlike} commands) set the placeholder \gls{glsinsert} to the supplied insert. If you want the insert to show in the parenthetical part of the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{inlinefullform} you need to redefine \gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert}}[2]\marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsinsert}\marg{\#2}} \end{codebox} \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortdescname}, and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongshortdescsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc{long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc} but places the insert and parenthetical material in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{displayfullform}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen-desc} Note that as with the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style, the insert isn't included in the \idx{postlinkhook} by default for the \idx{inlinefullform}. If you want the insert to show in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{inlinefullform} you need to redefine \gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert}. \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc-noreg} but checks the inserted material for a leading hyphen. The description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongnoshortdescname}, and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlonghyphennoshortdescsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc{long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg} \abbrstyledef{long-hyphen-noshort-noreg} This style is like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-noreg} but checks the inserted material for a leading hyphen. The description is set to the unencapsulated long form. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlongnoshortname}, and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrlonghyphennoshortsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchyp{long-hyphen-noshort-noreg} \abbrstyledef{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-long} but checks the inserted material for a leading hyphen. The description is the long form encapsulated with \gls{glslonghyphenfont}. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlongname} and the sort value is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshorthyphenlongsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchyp{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} \abbrstyledef{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} but the insert and parenthetical material are placed in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{displayfullform}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchyp{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen} Note that as with the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style, the insert isn't included in the \idx{postlinkhook} by default for the \idx{inlinefullform}. If you want the insert to show in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{inlinefullform} you need to redefine \gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert} (as described above, for the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style). \abbrstyledef{short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlongdescname}, and the sort is obtained from \gls{glsxtrshortlongdescsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc{short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc} but the insert and parenthetical material are placed in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{displayfullform}. \abbrvstyleexampleuchypdesc{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen-desc} Note that as with the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style, the insert isn't included in the \idx{postlinkhook} by default for the \idx{inlinefullform}. If you want the insert to show in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \idx{inlinefullform} you need to redefine \gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert} (as described above, for the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style). \paragraph{Only Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesonly}These styles only show the long form on \idx{firstuse} and only show the short form on \idx{subsequentuse}. The \idx{inlinefullform} is the same as the \idx{displayfullform}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral}, \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsparen} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsonly} for style commands. The \idx{inlinefullform} uses a parenthetical style with the long form followed by the short form in parentheses. \abbrstyledef{long-only-short-only} The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtronlyname} and the sort value is just the short form. The description is the long form encapsulated with \gls{glslongonlyfont}. \abbrvstyleexampleuc{long-only-short-only} \abbrstyledef{long-only-short-only-desc} This is like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only} but the description must be supplied. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtronlydescname} and the sort is obtained from \gls{glsxtronlydescsort}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdesc{long-only-short-only-desc} \abbrstyledef{long-only-short-sc-only} This is like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only} but uses \idx{smallcaps}. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrsconlyname}, and it uses \gls{glsabbrvsconlyfont}, \gls{glsfirstabbrvsconlyfont} and \gls{glsxtrsconlysuffix} for the abbreviation fonts and plural suffix. \abbrvstyleexamplelc{long-only-short-sc-only} \abbrstyledef{long-only-short-sc-only-desc} This is like \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc} but uses \idx{smallcaps}. The name is obtained from \gls{glsxtrsconlydescname}, and the sort is obtained from \gls{glsxtrsconlydescsort}. \abbrvstyleexamplelcdesc{long-only-short-sc-only-desc} \paragraph{Footnote Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesfootnote}These styles show the short form (\gls{glsxtrshortformat}) with the long form as a footnote on \idx{firstuse}. On \idx{subsequentuse} only the short form is shown. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfootnote} for style commands. The \idx{inlinefullform} uses the same parenthetical style as \abbrstyle{short-long} (\gls{glsxtrshortlongformat}). Font variations are available with \abbrstyle{short-sc-footnote}, \abbrstyle{short-sm-footnote} and \abbrstyle{short-em-footnote}. \abbrstyledef{short-footnote} The \meta{insert} is placed after the short form on \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse} of the \idx{glslike} commands. \abbrvstyleexampleucfn{short-footnote} The long form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstlongfootnotefont} within the full form and with \gls{glslongfootnotefont} for the \gls{glsxtrlong} set of commands. The short form is formatted with \gls{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} within the full form and with \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont} for \idx{subsequentuse} and for the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. The name is set to the short form (\gls{glsxtrfootnotename}) and the description is set to the unencapsulated long form. This style automatically sets the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute to \code{true} for the entry's category. \abbrstyledef{footnote} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-footnote}. \abbrstyledef{short-footnote-desc} As \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but the description must be supplied in the optional argument of \gls{newabbreviation}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdescfn{short-footnote-desc} The name is set to the short form followed by the long form in parentheses (\gls{glsxtrfootnotedescname}), and the sort is set to just the short form (\gls{glsxtrfootnotedescsort}). \abbrstyledef{footnote-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc}. \abbrstyledef{short-postfootnote} Similar to \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but the footnote command is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}. This avoids the problem of nested hyperlinks caused by the footnote marker hyperlink being inside the \idx{linktext} (which is why the \abbrstyle{short-footnote} style switches on the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute). Using the \idx{postlinkhook} makes it possible to check for following punctuation so that the footnote marker can be shifted after the punctuation character. \abbrvstyleexampleucfn{short-postfootnote} \abbrstyledef{postfootnote} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote}. \abbrstyledef{short-postfootnote-desc} Similar to \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but the footnote command is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook} as with \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote}. \abbrvstyleexampleucdescfn{short-postfootnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{postfootnote-desc} A synonym for \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc}. \abbrstyledef{short-sc-footnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcfn{short-sc-footnote} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-footnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdescfn{short-sc-footnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-postfootnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcfn{short-sc-postfootnote} \abbrstyledef{short-sc-postfootnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvscfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplelcdescfn{short-sc-postfootnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-footnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmfn{short-sm-footnote} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-footnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdescfn{short-sm-footnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-postfootnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmfn{short-sm-postfootnote} \abbrstyledef{short-sm-postfootnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtrsmsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvsmfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexamplesmdescfn{short-sm-postfootnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-em-footnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucfn{short-em-footnote} \abbrstyledef{short-em-footnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-footnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdescfn{short-em-footnote-desc} \abbrstyledef{short-em-postfootnote} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucfn{short-em-postfootnote} \abbrstyledef{short-em-postfootnote-desc} This style is like \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote-desc} but it uses \gls{glsxtremsuffix}, \gls{glsabbrvemfont} and \gls{glsfirstabbrvemfont} (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}). \abbrvstyleexampleucdescfn{short-em-postfootnote-desc} \paragraph{Short Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesshort}These styles only show the short form on both \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsnolong} for style commands. They are essentially identical to the corresponding regular style listed in \sectionref{sec:predefnonregabbrvstylesshort} except that they change the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}. \abbrstyledef{short-nolong-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{short-nolong} style. \abbrstyledef{short-nolong-desc-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc} style. \abbrstyledef{nolong-short-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{nolong-short} style. \paragraph{Long Styles} \label{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleslong}These styles only show the long form on both \idx{firstuse} and \idx{subsequentuse}. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral} and \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsnoshort} for style commands. They are essentially identical to the corresponding regular style listed in \sectionref{sec:predefnonregabbrvstyleslong} except that they change the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{false}. \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-desc-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} style. \abbrstyledef{long-noshort-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{long-noshort} style. \abbrstyledef{long-em-noshort-em-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em} style. \abbrstyledef{long-em-noshort-em-desc-noreg} This style is a non-regular version of the \abbrstyle{long-em-noshort-em-desc} style. \subsubsection{Formatting Commands and Hooks} \label{sec:abbrvcmds} These commands are used by the predefined abbreviation styles. These are considered user commands, which you can redefine to customize the style. \paragraph{General} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsgeneral}These commands apply to all styles. \cmddef{ifglsxtrinsertinside} This conditional is used to determine whether the \meta{insert} part should go inside or outside of the style's font formatting commands. The default setting is false. \cmddef{glsxtrinsertinsidetrue} Set the insert inside conditional to true. \cmddef{glsxtrinsertinsidefalse} Set the insert inside conditional to false. \cmddef{glsxtrparen} Used for parenthetical content in the \idx{inlinefullform} and also, for some styles, the \idx{displayfullform}. Note that this formats the opening and closing parentheses according to the \idx{innerformatting}, but not the argument, which should already incorporate it. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrparen}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}\marg{(}\#1\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}\marg{)}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrfullsep} Separator placed before \gls{glsxtrparen}. This is a space by default, but it includes the \idx{innerformatting}. The argument (the entry label) is ignored by default: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullsep}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}\marg{ }} \end{codebox} You can redefine this to use \gls{glsabspace} if you want to have a non-breakable space if the short form is less than \gls{glsacspacemax} in width. (You can use \gls{glsacspace} instead, but note that \gls{glsacspace} doesn't incorporate the \idx{innerformatting}.) \cmddef{glsabbrvdefaultfont} Abbreviation font command used by styles that don't have specific font markup (for example, \abbrstyle{long-short} but not \abbrstyle{long-em-short-em}). This just does its argument. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont} \Idx{firstuse} abbreviation font command used by styles that don't have specific font markup. This is defined to just use \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrdefaultrevert} This is the default definition of \gls{glsxtrrevert} used by styles that don't have specific font markup. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrdefaultrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glslongdefaultfont} Long form font command used by styles that don't have specific font markup. This just does its argument. \cmddef{glsfirstlongdefaultfont} \Idx{firstuse} long form font command used by styles that don't have specific font markup. This is defined to just use \gls{glslongdefaultfont}. \paragraph{Parenthetical Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsparen}These commands apply to the parenthetical styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-short}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-short}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortdescsort} This command should expand to the sort value used by styles such as \abbrstyle{long-short-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls+{expandonce}\gls{glsxtrorglong}\cmd{space} (\gls{expandonce}\gls{glsxtrorgshort}) \end{codebox} Note that this uses the original \meta{long} and \meta{short} values supplied to \gls{newabbreviation}. \begin{information} This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortdescname} This command should expand to the name value used by styles such as \abbrstyle{long-short-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxplongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrparen} \marg{\gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}} \end{codebox} This essentially expands to \meta{long} (\meta{short}) but includes the style font changing commands, the inner text formatting, and accessibility support. \cmddef{glsxtrshortlongname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrshortlongdescsort} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{sort} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc}. The default definition is just \code{\gls+{expandonce}\gls{glsxtrorgshort}}. \begin{information} This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtrshortlongdescname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrparen} {\gls{glsxplongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}} \end{codebox} \paragraph{User Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsuser}These commands apply to the \qt{user} styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-short-user}. \cmddef{glsxtruserfield} This command should expand to the \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} of the field used to store the additional information that should be shown in the parenthetical material on \idx{firstuse}. The default is \code{useri}, which corresponds to the \gloskey{user1} key. \cmddef{glsxtruserparensep} The separator used within the parenthetical content. This defaults to a comma followed by a space. \cmddef{glsxtruserfieldfmt} Used to encapsulate the value of the field given by \gls{glsxtruserfield} within \gls{glsxtruserparen} and \gls{GLSxtruserparen}. This simply does its argument by default. The \idx{innerformatting} with both \gls{glsxtruserparen} and \gls{GLSxtruserparen}, and the case-change with the latter, will be included in the argument of \gls{glsxtruserfieldfmt}. For example, to emphasize the user value and separate it with a semi-colon instead of a comma: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserparensep}}\marg{; } \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserfieldfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsabbrvuserfont} Formatting for the \qt{user} short form. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvuserfont} Formatting for the \qt{user} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvuserfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrusersuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{user} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}. \cmddef{glslonguserfont} Formatting for the \qt{user} long form. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstlonguserfont} Formatting for the \qt{user} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glslonguserfont}. \cmddef{glsabbrvscuserfont} Formatting for the \qt{sc-user} short form. This uses \gls{glsabbrvscfont}, which in turn uses \gls{textsc} to apply a \idx{smallcaps} style, so your document font needs to support it. \begin{information} \gls{textsc} uses small capital glyphs for \idx{lowercase} characters. \Idx{uppercase} characters show as normal capitals. This means that you need to use \idx{lowercase} characters in the abbreviation. \end{information} \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvscuserfont} Formatting for the \qt{sc-user} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvscuserfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrscuserrevert} Counteracts the effect of \gls{glsabbrvscuserfont}. The default is \gls{glsxtrscrevert}. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvscuserfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrscuserrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glsxtrscusersuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{sc-user} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}. \cmddef{glsuserdescription} The description field is set to this, where the \meta{text} argument is the long form, for the \qt{user} styles where the description is set by default. This is defined to ignore its second argument: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsuserdescription}}[2]\marg{\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} If you want to include the information contained in the field identified by \gls{glsxtruserfield}, the second argument provides a way of accessing that field without relying on the \gls{glscurrententrylabel} placeholder. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsuserdescription}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\#1}\% \gls{ifglshasfield}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserfield}}\marg{\#2}\% \marg{, \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}\% \marg{}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtruserparen} If the field given by \gls{glsxtruserfield} has been set, this essentially does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\margm{entry-label}\gls{glsxtrparen}\marg{\meta{text}, \meta{user-value}} \end{compactcodebox} otherwise it does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\margm{entry-label}\gls{glsxtrparen}\marg{\meta{text}} \end{compactcodebox} It's a little more complicated than this as the definition includes the \idx{innerformatting} around the comma and the field value (\meta{user-value}). The comma separator is given by \gls{glsxtruserparensep}, and the field value is encapsulated with \gls{glsxtruserfieldfmt} (with the \idx{innerformatting} inside). If you redefine this command, you will also need to redefine the following one in a similar manner. \cmddef{GLSxtruserparen} As above but the content of the field given by \gls{glsxtruserfield} is converted to \idx{allcaps}. Note that simply applying an \idx{uppercase} command to \gls{glsxtruserparen} can fail as it can cause the label to be converted to \idx{allcaps}, which is the reason why a separate command to internally perform the case-change is provided. \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortuserdescname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-short-user-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtruserparen} \marg{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortscusername} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user} styles where the description is automatically set. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvscuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortscuserdescname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtruserparen} \marg{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvscuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrshortlonguserdescname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvuserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtruserparen} \marg{\cmd{protect}\gls{glslonguserfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongpltok}}}\% \marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtruserlongshortformat} This command is used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} by styles like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} to format the long form followed by the short form (with optional user information) in parentheses. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserlongshortformat}}[4]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}\% \gls{glsxtrusershortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#4}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{Glsxtruserlongshortformat} As above but for \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtruserlongshortformat} As above but for \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtruserlongshortplformat} This command is used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl} or with \gls{glsxtrfullpl} by styles like \abbrstyle{long-short-user} to format the plural long form followed by the plural short form (with optional user information) in parentheses. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserlongshortplformat}}[4]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrlongplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}\% \gls{glsxtrusershortplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#4}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{Glsxtruserlongshortplformat} As above but for \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtruserlongshortplformat} As above but for \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrusershortlongformat} This command is used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} by styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user} to format the short form followed by the long form (with optional user information) in parentheses. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortlongformat}}[4]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrshortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}\% \gls{glsxtruserlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#4}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{Glsxtrusershortlongformat} As above but for \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrusershortlongformat} As above but for \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrusershortlongplformat} This command is used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl} or with \gls{glsxtrfullpl} by styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user} to format the plural short form followed by the plural long form (with optional user information) in parentheses. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortlongplformat}}[4]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrshortplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}\% \gls{glsxtruserlongplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#4}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{Glsxtrusershortlongplformat} As above but for \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrusershortlongplformat} As above but for \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrusershortformat} Used to format the singular short form in parentheses (with \gls{glsxtruserparen}) on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or \gls{Gls} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} or \gls{Glsxtrfull} for styles like \abbrstyle{long-short-user}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtruserparen}\marg{\gls{glsxtrshortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}}\marg{\#1}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrusershortplformat} As \gls{glsxtrusershortformat} but for the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} for styles like \abbrstyle{long-short-user}. This has a similar definition to the above but with \gls{glsxtrshortplformat}. \cmddef{GLSxtrusershortformat} As \gls{glsxtrusershortformat} but is used with the \idx{allcaps} \gls{GLS} or \gls{GLSxtrfull}. This uses \gls{GLSxtruserparen} instead of \gls{glsxtruserparen}. \cmddef{GLSxtrusershortplformat} As \gls{glsxtrusershortplformat} but is used with the \idx{allcaps} \gls{GLSpl} or \gls{GLSxtrfullpl}. This uses \gls{GLSxtruserparen} instead of \gls{glsxtruserparen}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostusershortformat} Used in the \idx{postlinkhook} to format the short form in parentheses for styles like \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostusershortformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\gls{GLSxtrusershortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% } \end{codebox} Note that this doesn't check if the plural form was used. If you require this, you will need to redefined this command to include \gls{glsifplural}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostusershortformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsifplural} \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\gls{GLSxtrusershortplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\gls{GLSxtrusershortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrusershortformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% }\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtruserlongformat} Used to format the singular long form in parentheses (with \gls{glsxtruserparen}) on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or \gls{Gls} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserlongformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtruserparen}\marg{\gls{glsxtrlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}}\marg{\#1}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{GLSxtruserlongformat} As \gls{glsxtruserlongformat} but \idx{allcaps}. This uses \gls{GLSxtruserparen} instead of \gls{glsxtruserparen}. \cmddef{glsxtruserlongplformat} As \gls{glsxtruserlongformat} but for the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl} or with \gls{glsxtrfull} for styles like \abbrstyle{short-long-user}. This has a similar definition to \gls{glsxtruserlongformat} but with \gls{glsxtrlongplformat}. \cmddef{GLSxtruserlongplformat} As \gls{glsxtruserlongplformat} but \idx{allcaps}. This uses \gls{GLSxtruserparen} instead of \gls{glsxtruserparen}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostuserlongformat} Used in the \idx{postlinkhook} to format the long form in parentheses for styles like \abbrstyle{short-postlong-user}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostuserlongformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\gls{GLSxtruserlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtruserlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% } \end{codebox} Note that, as with \gls{glsxtrpostusershortformat}, this doesn't check if the plural form was used. If you require this, you will need to redefined this command to include \gls{glsifplural}. \paragraph{Footnote Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsfootnote}These commands are only used by the footnote styles. \cmddef{glsxtrfootnotename} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrfootnotedescname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{footnote-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrparen} \marg{\gls{glsxplongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}}\% \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrfootnotedescsort} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{sort} key for styles like \abbrstyle{footnote-desc}. The default definition is simply \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}. \begin{information} This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} \cmddef{glslongfootnotefont} The formatting command used for the long form in the footnote styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glslongdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstlongfootnotefont} The formatting command used for the \idx{firstuse} long form in the footnote styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glslongfootnotefont}. \cmddef{glsxtrabbrvfootnote} The command that produces the footnote. The default definition ignores the first argument: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbrvfootnote}}[2]\marg{\gls{footnote}\marg{\#2}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrfootnotelongformat} This command is used within the footnote to display the long form formatted with \meta{fmt-cs} for the footnote styles on \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls}, \gls{Gls} and \gls{GLS}. The default definition is simply: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfootnotelongformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}\% } \end{codebox} For example, if the footnote should start with an \idx{uppercase} letter then simply redefine this to use \gls{Glsxtrlongformat} instead: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfootnotelongformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{Glsxtrlongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrfootnotelongplformat} This command is used within the footnote to display the plural long form formatted with \meta{fmt-cs} for the footnote styles on \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl}, \gls{Glspl} and \gls{GLSpl}. The default definition is simply: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfootnotelongplformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrlongplformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrpostfootnotelongformat} This command is used for the \qt{postfootnote} styles. This is simply defined to do \gls{glsxtrfootnotelongformat}. Note that there's no plural equivalent as the \qt{postfootnote} styles don't check if the plural command (\gls{glspl} etc) was used. \paragraph{No-Long Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsnolong}These commands are used by the \qt{nolong} styles. \cmddef{glsxtrshortnolongname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-nolong}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrshortdescname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{short-nolong-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\% \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrparen} \marg{\gls{glsxplongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}}\% \end{codebox} \paragraph{No-Short Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsnoshort}These commands are used by the \qt{noshort} styles. \cmddef{glsxtrlongnoshortdescname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxplongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrlongnoshortname} This command should expand to the value of the \gloskey{name} key for styles like \abbrstyle{long-noshort}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}} \end{codebox} \paragraph{Hyphen Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdshyphen}These are commands used by the \qt{hyphen} styles. They are designed to work with the \catattr{markwords} and \catattr{markshortwords} attributes. \cmddef{glsabbrvhyphenfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the hyphen styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvhyphenfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the hyphen styles on \idx{firstuse}. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvhyphenfont}. \cmddef{glslonghyphenfont} The formatting command used for the long form in the hyphen styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glslongdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstlonghyphenfont} The formatting command used for the long form in the hyphen styles on \idx{firstuse}. The default is to simply use \gls{glslonghyphenfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrhyphensuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{hyphen} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphenshortsort} Expands to the sort value for the styles like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen}. This defaults to the original short value (\gls{glsxtrorgshort}). This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \cmddef{glsxtrshorthyphenlongsort} Expands to the sort value for the styles like \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen}. This defaults to the original short value (\gls{glsxtrorgshort}). This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphennoshortsort} Expands to the sort value for the styles like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-noshort-noreg}. This defaults to the original short value (\gls{glsxtrorgshort}). This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphennoshortdescsort} Expands to the sort value for the styles like \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg}. This defaults to the original long value (\gls{glsxtrorglong}). This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphenshort} Formats the long and short form for the full or \idx{firstuse} \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen} style. This uses \gls{glsxtrifhyphenstart} to test if the \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen. If it does, \gls{glsxtrwordsep} is locally set to \gls{glsxtrwordsephyphen} to replace the inter-word spaces with hyphens. The short form is placed in parentheses with \gls{glsxtrparen}, preceded by the \gls{glsxtrfullsep} separator. The \meta{insert} is placed after both the long and the short form. \cmddef{GLSxtrlonghyphenshort} As above, but the \meta{insert} is converted to \idx{allcaps}. The \meta{short} and \meta{long} arguments should be supplied as \idx{allcaps}. Note that it's not possible to simply do \gls{glsxtrlonghyphenshort} with \code{\gls{MakeUppercase}\margm{insert}} as the argument as this will interfere with the check to determine if \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphennoshort} Formats the long form for the full or \idx{firstuse} \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg} style. This uses \gls{glsxtrifhyphenstart} to test if the \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen. If it does, \gls{glsxtrwordsep} is locally set to \gls{glsxtrwordsephyphen} to replace the inter-word spaces with hyphens. The \meta{insert} is placed after the long form. \cmddef{GLSxtrlonghyphennoshort} As above but converts \meta{insert} to \idx{allcaps}. The \meta{long} argument should already be in \idx{allcaps}. Note that it's not possible to simply do \gls{glsxtrlonghyphennoshort} with \code{\gls{MakeUppercase}\margm{insert}} as the argument as this will interfere with the check to determine if \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen. \cmddef{glsxtrlonghyphen} Formats the long form for the full or \idx{firstuse} \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style. This is similar to the above, but the \meta{insert} argument is only used to check if it starts with a hyphen. The actual \meta{insert} is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}. \cmddef{xpglsxtrposthyphenshort} This command is used in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style on \idx{firstuse}. It expands the placeholder commands (\gls{glslabel} and \gls{glsinsert}) and uses \gls{GLSxtrposthyphenshort} for \idx{allcaps} or \gls{glsxtrposthyphenshort} otherwise. Note that this doesn't show the plural by default. If you require the plural form, you need to redefine this to add a check with \gls{glsifplural}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{xpglsxtrposthyphenshort}}\marg{\% \gls{glsifplural} \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{GLSxtrposthyphenshortpl}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphenshortpl}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{GLSxtrposthyphenshort}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphenshort}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% }\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrposthyphenshort} If \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen, \gls{glsxtrwordsep} is locally set to \gls{glsxtrwordsephyphen} to replace the inter-word spaces with hyphens. The \meta{insert} encapsulated with \gls{glsfirstlonghyphenfont} is then done (to complete the long form, which has already been displayed with \gls{glsxtrlonghyphen} in the \idx{linktext}). Then the short form followed by the \meta{insert} is placed in parentheses (with \gls{glsxtrparen} preceded by \gls{glsxtrfullsep}). \cmddef{GLSxtrposthyphenshort} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrposthyphenshortpl} As \gls{glsxtrposthyphenshort} but plural. \cmddef{GLSxtrposthyphenshortpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{xpglsxtrposthyphensubsequent} This command is used in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style on \idx{subsequentuse}. It expands the placeholder commands (\gls{glslabel} and \gls{glsinsert}) and uses \gls{GLSxtrposthyphensubsequent} for \idx{allcaps} or \gls{glsxtrposthyphensubsequent} otherwise. \cmddef{glsxtrposthyphensubsequent} This command is used in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style on \idx{subsequentuse}. Only the \meta{insert} is done. \cmddef{GLSxtrposthyphensubsequent} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshorthyphenlong} Formats the short and long form for the full or \idx{firstuse} \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-long-hyphen} style. Similar to \gls{glsxtrlonghyphenshort} but the short and long forms are swapped. \cmddef{GLSxtrshorthyphenlong} As above, but the \meta{insert} is converted to \idx{allcaps}. The \meta{short} and \meta{long} arguments should be supplied as \idx{allcaps}. Note that it's not possible to simply do \gls{glsxtrshorthyphenlong} with \code{\gls{MakeUppercase}\margm{insert}} as the argument as this will interfere with the check to determine if \meta{insert} starts with a hyphen. \cmddef{glsxtrshorthyphen} Formats the short form for the full or \idx{firstuse} \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen} style. The \meta{insert} argument is only used to check if it starts with a hyphen. The actual \meta{insert} is placed in the \idx{postlinkhook}. \cmddef{xpglsxtrposthyphenlong} This command is used in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen} style on \idx{firstuse}. It expands the placeholder commands (\gls{glslabel} and \gls{glsinsert}) and uses \gls{GLSxtrposthyphenlong} for \idx{allcaps} or \gls{glsxtrposthyphenlong} otherwise. Note that this doesn't show the plural by default. If you require the plural form, you need to redefine this to add a check with \gls{glsifplural}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{xpglsxtrposthyphenlong}}\marg{\% \gls{glsifplural} \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{GLSxtrposthyphenlongpl}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphenlongpl}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifallcaps} \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{GLSxtrposthyphenlong}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphenlong}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% }\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrposthyphenlong} This command is used in the \idx{postlinkhook} for the \abbrstyle{short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen} style on \idx{firstuse}. Similar to \gls{glsxtrposthyphenshort} but shows the long form instead of the short form. \cmddef{GLSxtrposthyphenlong} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrposthyphenlongpl} As \gls{glsxtrposthyphenlong} but plural. \cmddef{GLSxtrposthyphenlongpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \paragraph{Only Styles} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsonly}These are commands used by the \qt{only} styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only}. \cmddef{glsabbrvonlyfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the only styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvonlyfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the only styles on \idx{firstuse}. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvonlyfont}. \cmddef{glslongonlyfont} The formatting command used for the long form in the only styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glslongdefaultfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstlongonlyfont} The formatting command used for the long form in the only styles on \idx{firstuse}. The default is to simply use \gls{glslongonlyfont}. \cmddef{glsxtronlysuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{only} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}. \cmddef{glsabbrvsconlyfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the \qt{sc-only} styles. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvscfont}. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvsconlyfont} The formatting command used for the short form in the \qt{sc-only} styles on \idx{firstuse}. The default is to simply use \gls{glsabbrvsconlyfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrsconlyrevert} Counteracts the effect of \gls{glsabbrvsconlyfont}. The default is \gls{glsxtrscrevert}. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvsconlyfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrsconlyrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glsxtrsconlysuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{sc-only} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrscsuffix}. \cmddef{glsxtronlyname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for the \qt{only} styles. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvonlyfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtronlydescname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for the \qt{only} styles where the description should be described, such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glslongfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtronlydescsort} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{sort} key for the \qt{only} styles where the description should be described, such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc}. The default definition is \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}. \begin{information} This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtrsconlyname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for the \qt{sc-only} styles. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvsconlyfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrsconlydescname} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{name} key for the \qt{sc-only} styles where the description should be described. The default definition is to simply use \gls{glsxtronlydescname}. \cmddef{glsxtrsconlydescsort} Expands to the value for the \gloskey{sort} key for the \qt{sc-only} styles where the description should be described, such as \abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc}. The default definition is to simply use \gls{glsxtronlydescsort}. \begin{information} This command is irrelevant with the \idx{unsrtfam}. \end{information} \paragraph{Fonts} \label{sec:abbrvcmdsfonts}These are commands used by styles that use a particular font shape or size, identified by one of the following two-letter tags: \qt{sc} (\gls{textsc}), \qt{sm} (\gls{textsmaller}) or \qt{em} (\gls{emph}). \begin{information} For the \qt{sc-user} styles, see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsuser}. For the \qt{sc-only} styles, see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmdsonly}. \end{information} \cmddef{glsabbrvscfont} Formatting for the \qt{sc} short form. This uses \gls{textsc} to apply a \idx{smallcaps} style, so your document font needs to support it. \begin{information} \gls{textsc} uses small capital glyphs for \idx{lowercase} characters. \Idx{uppercase} characters show as normal capitals. This means that you need to use \idx{lowercase} characters in the abbreviation. \end{information} \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvscfont} Formatting for the \qt{sc} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvscfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrscrevert} Counteracts the effect of \gls{glsabbrvscfont}. This defaults to \gls{glstextup}. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvscfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrscrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glsxtrscsuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{sc} styles. This needs to counteract the smallcaps, so it's defined as: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protect}\gls{glstextup}{\gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsabbrvsmfont} Formatting for the \qt{sm} short form. This uses \gls{textsmaller}, which is defined by the \sty{relsize} package. You will need to load that package if you want to use any of the \qt{sm} styles. \begin{information} \gls{textsmaller} reduces the font size, so if you want to use it to simulate \idx{smallcaps}, you need to use \idx{uppercase} characters in the abbreviation. \end{information} \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvsmfont} Formatting for the \qt{sm} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvsmfont}. \cmddef{glsxtrsmrevert} Counteracts the effect of \gls{glsabbrvsmfont}. This defaults to \gls{textlarger}. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvsmfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtrsmrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glsxtrsmsuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{sm} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}. \cmddef{glsabbrvemfont} Formatting for the \qt{em} short form. This uses \gls{emph}. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvemfont} Formatting for the \qt{em} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glsabbrvemfont}. \cmddef{glsxtremrevert} Counteracts the effect of \gls{glsabbrvemfont}. This defaults to \gls{textup}. If you redefine \gls{glsabbrvemfont}, you will need to redefine \gls{glsxtremrevert} as applicable. \cmddef{glsxtremsuffix} Short plural suffix used by the \qt{em} styles. This defaults to \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}. \cmddef{glslongemfont} Formatting for the \qt{em} long form. This uses \gls{emph}. \cmddef{glsfirstlongemfont} Formatting for the \qt{em} short form shown on \idx{firstuse}. This defaults to \gls{glslongemfont}. \subsection{Advanced Style Commands} \label{sec:advancedabbrstylecmds} These commands should typically not be needed in a document, but are provided for advanced users. See \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmds} for commands to adjust the predefined abbreviation styles. \cmddef{glssetabbrvfmt} Sets the current formatting commands (\sectionref{sec:abbrstylefmts}) associated with the abbreviation style associated with the given category. That is, the command redefinitions provided in the third argument (\meta{display definitions}) of \gls{newabbreviationstyle} are applied. If no abbreviation style has been set for the given category, the style associated with the \cat{abbreviation} category is used. This command is used: \begin{itemize} \item At the start of \gls{glsentryfmt} if the current entry has the \gloskey{short} field set. This ensures that the \idx{glslike} commands use the appropriate formatting. \item At the start of \gls{glsxtrassignfieldfont} if the current entry has the \gloskey{short} field set. This ensures that the \idx{glslike} commands use the appropriate formatting (where possible). \item At the start of \gls{glsxtrshort}, \gls{glsxtrlong}, \gls{glsxtrfull} and their plural and case-changing variants. \item At the start of \gls{glossentryname}, \gls{glossentrynameother}, \gls{glossentrydesc}, \gls{Glossentrydesc}, \gls{glossentrysymbol} and \gls{Glossentrysymbol}. \end{itemize} \cmddef{glsuseabbrvfont} A robust command that applies the abbreviation font for the given category to the supplied text. \cmddef{glsuselongfont} A robust command that applies the long font for the given category to the supplied text. \cmddef{GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleSetup} This implements the given abbreviation style's setup code. Note that this expects the placeholder macros and token registers to be set. This may be used in the \meta{setup} of \gls{newabbreviationstyle} to inherit the setup code of a related style. \cmddef{GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleFmts} This implements the given abbreviation style's display definitions code. This may be used in the \meta{display definitions} of \gls{newabbreviationstyle} to inherit the formatting of a related style. \cmddef{xpglsxtrpostabbrvfootnote} This is used by styles like \abbrstyle{postfootnote} to ensure that the label and inner and outer formatting are expanded before being passed to \gls{glsxtrpostabbrvfootnote}, otherwise they may lose their definitions before the footnote text is typeset. \cmddef{glsxtrpostabbrvfootnote} This is used by the footnote styles that defer the footnote to the \idx{postlinkhook}. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newrobustcmd}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostabbrvfootnote}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrabbrvfootnote}\marg{\#1}\% \marg{\#2\gls{glsxtrpostfootnotelongformat}\marg{\#1}\marg{\gls{glsfirstlongfootnotefont}}}\% } \end{codebox} The second argument will be the expansion of \gls{glsxtrassignlinktextfmt}, to allow the \idx{innerformatting} to be picked up, if required. \cmddef{glsxtrifhyphenstart} This command is used by the hyphen styles to determine if the insert material starts with a hyphen. Does \meta{true} if \meta{text} starts with a hyphen otherwise does \meta{false}. \cmddef{GlsXtrWarnDeprecatedAbbrStyle} This command is used to generate a warning (with \gls{GlossariesExtraWarning}) if a deprecated abbreviation style is used. \subsection{Defining New Abbreviation Styles} \label{sec:newabbrvstyle} If none of the predefined styles suit your requirements, you can define your own custom style using: \cmddef{newabbreviationstyle} The first argument is the style name. This is used internally to form control sequences, so the name shouldn't contain any special characters. The second argument sets up the information that's required when an abbreviation is defined (which is why the style must be set before the abbreviations with that style are defined). The relevant commands for this argument are listed in \sectionref{sec:abbrstyleinit}. The third argument defines the commands that determine how the display style (\gls{gls}) and the inline style (\gls{glsxtrfull}) are formatted. The relevant commands for this argument are listed in \sectionref{sec:abbrstylefmts}. \cmddef{renewabbreviationstyle} Redefines an existing abbreviation style. \cmddef{letabbreviationstyle} Defines a synonym of an existing abbreviation style. \subsubsection{Style Initialisation Hooks} \label{sec:abbrstyleinit} The style initialisation hooks should be placed in the second argument (\meta{setup}) of \gls{newabbreviationstyle}. They ensure that all the fields are correctly initialised when the entry is defined with the underlying \gls{newglossaryentry} command. They may also be used to set category attributes. The following is prepended to \meta{setup} to initialise the final hook: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation}}\marg{} \end{codebox} When an entry is defined with \gls{newabbreviation}, the following steps are performed: \begin{enumerate} \item Token registers are initialised to the information provided in the arguments of \gls{newabbreviation}: \gls{glskeylisttok}, \gls{glslabeltok}, \gls{glsshorttok} and \gls{glslongtok}. \item The commands \gls{glsxtrorgkeylist}, \gls{glsxtrorgshort} and \gls{glsxtrorglong} are defined to the options, short and long values supplied to \gls{newabbreviation}. (The \gls{glskeylisttok} \gls{glsshorttok} and \gls{glslongtok} token registers may be changed before the entry is actually defined. These commands may be used to obtain the original values.) \item \gls{ExtraCustomAbbreviationFields} is initialised to do nothing. \item Accessibility settings are initialised, if required. These redefine \gls{ExtraCustomAbbreviationFields} to set the accessibility fields. \item The command \gls{glscategorylabel} is defined to \code{abbreviation}. \item The options list is parsed for the following keys: \gloskey{category} and, if accessibility is enabled, \gloskey{access}, \gloskey{textaccess}, \gloskey{pluralaccess}, \gloskey{firstaccess}, \gloskey{firstpluralaccess}, \gloskey{shortaccess}, \gloskey{shortpluralaccess}, \gloskey{longaccess}, and \gloskey{longpluralaccess}. \item The abbreviation style is applied for the category given by \gls{glscategorylabel} (which may have been changed when the options were parsed in the previous step) or the fallback if no abbreviation style is associated with that category. This performs both the \meta{setup} and \meta{display definitions} provided when the style was defined with \gls{newabbreviationstyle}. \item The long plural form is initialised to its default value (\meta{long}\gls{glspluralsuffix}). \item The \catattr{markwords} attribute, if set, is implemented for the singular long form. It will also mark the entry as having a description with formatting (using \gls{glsexclapplyinnerfmtfield}). \item The \catattr{markshortwords} attribute is implemented, if set, otherwise the \catattr{insertdots} attribute is implemented, if set, for the singular short form. \item The \catattr{aposplural} attribute is implemented, if set, otherwise the \catattr{noshortplural} attribute is implemented, if set. This step will set the default short plural. \item \gls{glsshorttok} is updated to reflect any changes. \item The \gls{glsxtrnewabbrevpresetkeyhook} hook is performed. \item The options list is parsed for the \gloskey{shortplural} and \gloskey{longplural} keys. The \gls{glskeylisttok} token is updated to only include the remaining keys that haven't yet been processed. \item The \catattr{markwords} attribute, if set, is implemented for the plural long form. \item The \catattr{markshortwords} attribute, if set, otherwise the \catattr{insertdots} attribute, if set, is implemented for the plural short form. \item The \gls{glsshortpltok} and \gls{glslongpltok} registers are set. \item \gls{newabbreviationhook} performed. \item The entry is defined using \gls{newglossaryentry} with the key value list: \begin{codebox} \gloskeyval{type}{\gls{glsxtrabbrvtype}}, \gloskeyval{category}{abbreviation}, \gloskeyval{short}{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}, \gloskeyval{shortplural}{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshortpltok}}, \gloskeyval{long}{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}}, \gloskeyval{longplural}{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongpltok}}, \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}, \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields}, \gls{ExtraCustomAbbreviationFields} \cmd{the}\gls{glskeylisttok} \end{codebox} \item Add the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} keys to the list of \idx{innerformatting} exclusions, as they include formatting commands. \item Final hook \gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation} performed. \end{enumerate} Note that when these hooks (except the last) are used, the entry hasn't yet been defined. However, some information will have already been picked up from the arguments of \gls{newabbreviation}. These can be accessed in the hooks using the following (but make sure they are fully expanded): \cmddef{glscategorylabel} Expands to the entry's category label. \cmddef{glskeylisttok} A token register that contains the options that were passed to \gls{newabbreviation} with pre-processed options removed. Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glskeylisttok}} to expand it. The original option list, as supplied to \gls{newabbreviation}, can be obtained with: \cmddef{glsxtrorgkeylist} (Not a token register.) \cmddef{glslabeltok} A token register that contains the entry's label. Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}} to expand it. \cmddef{glsshorttok} A token register that contains the short form (which may have been modified after being passed to \gls{newabbreviation}). Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}} to expand it. The original short form, as supplied to \gls{newabbreviation}, can be obtained with: \cmddef{glsxtrorgshort} (Not a token register.) \cmddef{glsshortpltok} A token register that contains the short plural form (which may have been obtained from the short form or modified after being passed to \gls{newabbreviation}). Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshortpltok}} to expand it. \cmddef{glslongtok} A token register that contains the long form (which may have been modified after being passed to \gls{newabbreviation}). Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongtok}} to expand it. The original long form, as supplied to \gls{newabbreviation}, can be obtained with: \cmddef{glsxtrorglong} (Not a token register.) \cmddef{glslongpltok} A token register that contains the long plural form (which may have been obtained from the long form or modified after being passed to \gls{newabbreviation}). Use \code{\cmd{the}\gls{glslongpltok}} to expand it. \cmddef{ExtraCustomAbbreviationFields} Expands to additional field definitions for the entry. This is used to add the accessibility fields (such as \gloskey{shortaccess}), if enabled. The abbreviation style may append (\gls{appto}) or prepend (\gls{preto}) additional information, if required, to this hook. \begin{important} If you alter this hook, make sure that you include the trailing comma after each \code{\meta{key}\dequals\marg{value}}, including the last one. \end{important} \cmddef{CustomAbbreviationFields} Expands to the default field definitions for the entry. Take care to protect any commands that shouldn't be expanded. The comma may be omitted from the final \code{\meta{key}\dequals\marg{value}}. \cmddef{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation} A hook that's used after the entry has been defined (at the end of \gls{newabbreviation}). This can be used to set category attributes, define the \idx{postlinkhook}, or mark the entry as having a complex style (with \gls{glsxtrsetcomplexstyle}). For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short} abbreviation style includes the following in \meta{setup}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation}}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrsetcomplexstyle}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{3}\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{regular}\% \marg{\% \gls{glssetattribute}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{regular}\marg{false}\% }\% \marg{}\% } \end{codebox} Note that in the above, the commands within the definition of \gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation} are all expanded when that hook is used. However, if this hook defines other commands or hooks that will be used later, then make sure that the definitions of those commands use the inner hook's own placeholder commands. \begin{information} Remember that the \idx{postlinkhook} uses \gls{glslabel} to reference the current label. Don't use \gls{glslabeltok} as that will contain the label of the last abbreviation to be defined. \end{information} For example, the \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen} style has: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation}}\marg{\% \gls{glsexclapplyinnerfmtfield}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{desc}\% \gls{csdef}\marg{glsxtrpostlink\gls{glscategorylabel}}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphenshort}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{expandafter}\gls{glsxtrposthyphensubsequent}\gls{expandafter}\gls{glslabel} \gls{expandafter}\marg{\gls{glsinsert}}\% }\% }\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{regular}\% \marg{\% \gls{glssetattribute}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glslabeltok}}\marg{regular}\marg{false}\% }\% \marg{}\% } \end{codebox} In the above, \gls{glslabeltok} and \gls{glscategorylabel} are used in the parts that will be expanded at the end of \gls{newabbreviation}, but \gls{glslabel} and \gls{glsinsert} are used in the definition of the \idx{postlinkhook}, which won't be expanded until the entry is referenced in the document with a command such as \gls{gls}. (The use of \gls{expandafter} is included to assist \glsopt{innertextformat}.) \cmddef{glsxtrsetcomplexstyle} This command should go in the definition of \gls{GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation} to indicate that the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has an abbreviation style that is complex. The second argument \meta{n} should be numeric and indicates why it doesn't work with \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{Glsfirst}, \gls{GLSfirst}, \gls{glsfirstplural}, \gls{Glsfirstplural} or \gls{GLSfirstplural}: 1 (all caps doesn't work), 2 (all caps and insert doesn't work), 3 (insert doesn't work). \cmddef{glsfirstinnerfmtabbrvfont} This is a robust command that applies both \gls{glsfirstabbrvfont} and the inner formatting command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. This is used by the following command. \cmddef{glsfirstxpabbrvfont} If the \catattr{markshortwords} attribute is true, this does \code{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsfirstabbrvfont}\margm{text}} otherwise it does \code{\gls{glsfirstinnerfmtabbrvfont}\margm{text}}. This command is designed to be used within \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields} to set the \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{firstplural} keys, so it needs to partially expand within \gls{newabbreviation}. For example, the \abbrstyle{postfootnote} includes the following lines in the definition of \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields}: \begin{codebox} \gloskeyval{first}{\gls{glsfirstxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshorttok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}},\% \gloskeyval{firstplural}{\gls{glsfirstxpabbrvfont}\marg{\cmd{the}\gls{glsshortpltok}}\marg{\gls{glscategorylabel}}}, \end{codebox} This will be expanded before being passed to \gls{newglossaryentry}. If the \catattr{markshortwords} attribute is true, this will end up as: \begin{codebox} \gloskeyval{first}{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsfirstabbrvfont}\margm{short}},\% \gloskeyval{firstplural}{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsfirstabbrvfont}\margm{shortpl}} \end{codebox} otherwise it will end up as: \begin{codebox} \gloskeyval{first}{\gls{glsfirstinnerfmtabbrvfont}\margm{short}},\% \gloskeyval{firstplural}{\gls{glsfirstinnerfmtabbrvfont}\margm{shortpl}},\% \end{codebox} where \meta{short} and \meta{shortpl} are, respectively, the values in the \gls{glsshorttok} and \gls{glsshortpltok} registers. \begin{information} The placeholder registers and macros (such as \gls{glsshorttok} and \gls{glscategorylabel}) must be expanded before being passed to \gls{newglossaryentry} as their values are unreliable outside of \gls{newabbreviation}. \end{information} \cmddef{glsinnerfmtabbrvfont} This is a robust command that applies both \gls{glsabbrvfont} and the inner formatting command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. This is used by the following command. \cmddef{glsxpabbrvfont} If the \catattr{markshortwords} attribute is true, this does \code{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsabbrvfont}\margm{text}} otherwise it does \code{\gls{glsinnerfmtabbrvfont}\margm{text}}. This command is designed for the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} keys within \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields}. \cmddef{glsfirstinnerfmtlongfont} This is a robust command that applies both \gls{glsfirstlongfont} and the inner formatting command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. This is used by the following command. \cmddef{glsfirstxplongfont} If the \catattr{markwords} attribute is true, this does \code{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsfirstlongfont}\margm{text}} otherwise it does \code{\gls{glsfirstinnerfmtlongfont}\margm{text}}. This command is designed for the \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{firstplural} keys within \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields}. \cmddef{glsinnerfmtlongfont} This is a robust command that applies both \gls{glslongfont} and the inner formatting command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. This is used by the following command. \cmddef{glsxplongfont} If the \catattr{markwords} attribute is true, this does \code{\cmd{protect}\gls{glslongfont}\margm{text}} otherwise it does \code{\gls{glsinnerfmtlongfont}\margm{text}}. This command is designed for the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} keys within \gls{CustomAbbreviationFields} (if they should include the long form in their value, such as the \abbrstyle{long-noshort-desc} style). \cmddef{glsxtrAccSuppAbbrSetNoLongAttrs} If accessibility support has been enabled with \opt{accsupp}, this command will initialise support for the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} fields for the given category (using \gls{glsxtrprovideaccsuppcmd}). The \catattr{nameshortaccess}, \catattr{firstshortaccess} and \catattr{textshortaccess} attributes are set to \code{true}. (Does nothing if accessibility support has not been enabled.) This command is provided for abbreviation styles where the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{text} are just the formatted abbreviation. The \gloskey{first} field may just be the long form or may be a combination of short and long. \cmddef{glsxtrAccSuppAbbrSetNameLongAttrs} If accessibility support has been enabled with \opt{accsupp}, this command will initialise support for the \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} fields for the given category (using \gls{glsxtrprovideaccsuppcmd}). The \catattr{firstshortaccess} and \catattr{textshortaccess} attributes are set to \code{true}. (Does nothing if accessibility support has not been enabled.) This command is provided for abbreviation styles where the \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{text} are just the formatted abbreviation. The \gloskey{name} field may just be the long form or may be a combination of short and long. \cmddef{glsxtrAccSuppAbbrSetFirstLongAttrs} If accessibility support has been enabled with \opt{accsupp}, this command will initialise support for the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} fields for the given category (using \gls{glsxtrprovideaccsuppcmd}). The \catattr{nameshortaccess} and \catattr{textshortaccess} attributes are set to \code{true}. (Does nothing if accessibility support has not been enabled.) This command is provided for abbreviation styles where the \gloskey{name} and \gloskey{text} are just the formatted abbreviation. The \gloskey{first} field may just be the long form or may be a combination of short and long. \cmddef{glsxtrAccSuppAbbrSetTextShortAttrs} If accessibility support has been enabled with \opt{accsupp}, this command will initialise support for the \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} fields for the given category (using \gls{glsxtrprovideaccsuppcmd}). The \catattr{textshortaccess} attribute is set to \code{true}. (Does nothing if accessibility support has not been enabled.) This command is provided for abbreviation styles where the \gloskey{text} is just the formatted abbreviation. The \gloskey{name} and \gloskey{first} fields may just be the long form or may be a combination of short and long. The \gloskey{name} may also be short but followed by the long form in the description. \cmddef{glsxtrAccSuppAbbrSetNameShortAttrs} If accessibility support has been enabled with \opt{accsupp}, this command will initialise support for the \gloskey{name} field for the given category (using \gls{glsxtrprovideaccsuppcmd}). The \catattr{nameshortaccess} attribute is set to \code{true}. (Does nothing if accessibility support has not been enabled.) This command is provided for abbreviation styles where only the \gloskey{name} is just the formatted abbreviation. The \gloskey{first} and \gloskey{text} fields may just be the long form or may be a combination of short and long. \subsubsection{Style Formatting Commands} \label{sec:abbrstylefmts} The final \meta{display definitions} argument of \gls{newabbreviationstyle} should contain the redefinitions of the style commands listed here that are used to format abbreviations. Whenever an abbreviation style is activated with commands like \gls{setabbreviationstyle}, \gls{newabbreviation} or \gls{glssetabbrvfmt}, \meta{display definitions} are implemented. \begin{important} If you simply want to adjust the formatting of one of the predefined styles, you should redefine the associated commands listed in \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmds}. \end{important} The following initialisation is always prepended to \meta{display definitions} so you can omit them if the default is appropriate for your style: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrinlinefullformat}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullformat}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{Glsxtrinlinefullformat}}\marg{\gls{Glsxtrfullformat}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GLSxtrinlinefullformat}}\marg{\gls{GLSxtrfullformat}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrinlinefullplformat}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrfullplformat}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{Glsxtrinlinefullplformat}}\marg{\gls{Glsxtrfullplformat}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GLSxtrinlinefullplformat}}\marg{\gls{GLSxtrfullplformat}}\% \cmd{let}\gls{glsxtrsubsequentfmt}\gls{glsxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} \cmd{let}\gls{glsxtrsubsequentplfmt}\gls{glsxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} \cmd{let}\gls{Glsxtrsubsequentfmt}\gls{Glsxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} \cmd{let}\gls{Glsxtrsubsequentplfmt}\gls{Glsxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} \cmd{let}\gls{GLSxtrsubsequentfmt}\gls{GLSxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} \cmd{let}\gls{GLSxtrsubsequentplfmt}\gls{GLSxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} \end{codebox} In the event that any styles omit defining the newer \gls{GLSxtrfullformat} or \gls{GLSxtrfullplformat}, these are also initialised to defaults but ideally they should have their definitions provided. The minimal set of commands that should have their definitions provided are the abbreviation plural suffix (\gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}) the \idxpl{displayfullform}: \gls{glsxtrfullformat}, \gls{glsxtrfullplformat} and their case-changing variants. The \idx{inlinefullform} commands only need to be provided if they behave differently from the \idx{displayfullform}. The subsequent use commands only need to be provided if the default (only show the short form) isn't suitable. \begin{important} The content of \meta{display definitions} is placed within the definition of an internal control sequence, so remember to use \code{\#\#} instead of \code{\#} to reference command parameters. \end{important} \paragraph{Suffix and Fonts} These are the generic suffix and font commands that vary according to the abbreviation style. The style should provide the appropriate definitions. The suffix should always be provided. The font commands are only required if the style applies any font formatting to either the long or short form. \cmddef{abbrvpluralsuffix} The plural suffix for the short form. For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short} style defines this to just use \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}, but the smallcaps styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} define this to \gls{glsxtrscsuffix} in order to counteract the small caps font. \cmddef{glsfirstabbrvfont} The font formatting command for the short form on \idx{firstuse}. For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style has: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\gls{glsfirstabbrvfont}\oarg{1}\marg{\gls{glsfirstabbrvscfont}\marg{\#\#1}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsabbrvfont} The font formatting command for the short form. For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style has: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\gls{glsabbrvfont}\oarg{1}\marg{\gls{glsabbrvscfont}\marg{\#\#1}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrrevert} This command is designed to counteract the effect of \gls{glsabbrvfont} if, for some reason, it shouldn't be applied to part of the abbreviation. For example, you may prefer not to have digits reduced with the smaller (\qt{sm}) styles. \cmddef{glsfirstlongfont} The font formatting command for the long form on \idx{firstuse}. For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style has: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsfirstlongfont}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsfirstlongdefaultfont}\marg{\#\#1}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{glslongfont} The font formatting command for the long form. For example, the \abbrstyle{long-short-sc} style has: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glslongfont}}[1]\marg{\gls{glslongdefaultfont}\marg{\#\#1}} \end{codebox} \paragraph{First Use Display Format} These commands always need to be provided. \cmddef{glsxtrfullformat} The singular \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls}. \cmddef{glsxtrfullplformat} The plural \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{glspl}. \cmddef{Glsxtrfullformat} The \idx{sentencecase} singular \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{Gls}. \cmddef{Glsxtrfullplformat} The \idx{sentencecase} plural \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{Glspl}. \cmddef{GLSxtrfullformat} The \idx{allcaps} singular \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{GLS}. \cmddef{GLSxtrfullplformat} The \idx{allcaps} plural \idx{displayfullform} used on the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{GLSpl}. \paragraph{Subsequent Use Display Format} These commands only need to be provided if the \idx{glslike} commands don't simply show the short form. \cmddef{glsxtrsubsequentfmt} The singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{gls}. \cmddef{glsxtrsubsequentplfmt} The plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{glspl}. \cmddef{Glsxtrsubsequentfmt} The \idx{sentencecase} singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{Gls}. \cmddef{Glsxtrsubsequentplfmt} The \idx{sentencecase} plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{Glspl}. \cmddef{GLSxtrsubsequentfmt} The \idx{allcaps} singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{GLS}. \cmddef{GLSxtrsubsequentplfmt} The \idx{allcaps} plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{GLSpl}. The defaults all show the short form and insert encapsulated with the \idx{innerformatting} \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} and \gls{glsabbrvfont}. The purpose of the \idx{innerformatting} is to get it as close as possible to the actual text so \gls{glsabbrvfont} is placed outside of \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}. The \catattr{markshortwords} attribute complicates matters as it inserts \gls{glsxtrword} and \gls{glsxtrwordsep} into the actual field value. In that case, the \idx{innerformatting} is within \gls{glsxtrword} and \gls{glsxtrwordsep}, so only the insert material needs to be formatted. If a custom style doesn't need to support \glsopt{innertextformat} or \gls{ifglsxtrinsertinside}, it can reduce the complexity by omitting the \idx{innerformatting} and conditionals, but this lack of support should be documented if the style is made generally available. \cmddef{glsxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} The default singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{gls}. \cmddef{glsxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} The default plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{glspl}. \cmddef{Glsxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} The default \idx{sentencecase} singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{Gls}. \cmddef{Glsxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} The default \idx{sentencecase} plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{Glspl}. \cmddef{GLSxtrdefaultsubsequentfmt} The default \idx{allcaps} singular form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{GLS}. \cmddef{GLSxtrdefaultsubsequentplfmt} The default \idx{allcaps} plural form for \idx{subsequentuse} of \gls{GLSpl}. \paragraph{Inline Full Format} These commands only need to be provided if the \idx{inlinefullform} is different from the \idx{displayfullform}. \cmddef{glsxtrinlinefullformat} The singular full form of \gls{glsxtrfull}. \cmddef{glsxtrinlinefullplformat} The plural full form of \gls{glsxtrfullpl}. \cmddef{Glsxtrinlinefullformat} The \idx{sentencecase} singular full form of \gls{Glsxtrfull}. \cmddef{Glsxtrinlinefullplformat} The \idx{sentencecase} plural full form of \gls{Glsxtrfullpl}. \cmddef{GLSxtrinlinefullformat} The \idx{allcaps} singular full form of \gls{GLSxtrfull}. \cmddef{GLSxtrinlinefullplformat} The \idx{allcaps} plural full form of \gls{GLSxtrfullpl}. \paragraph{Wrapper Commands} These are commands that can be used in the definitions of the above to ensure that the appropriate accessibility fields and inner formatting is supported. \cmddef{glsxtrlongformat} This command is used in the definition of \gls{glsxtrlong} in some of the predefined abbreviation styles to format the \gloskey{long} value of the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} with the command \meta{fmt-cs}, which should take one argument. Accessibility support is implemented with \gls{glsaccesslong} if the \catattr{markwords} attribute is true otherwise with \gls{glsaccessfmtlong} using \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} for the \idx{innerformatting}. This is then encapsulated (including or excluding the \meta{insert}, according to \gls{ifglsxtrinsertinside}) with \meta{fmt-cs}. If the \meta{insert} content needs to be placed outside of \meta{fmt-cs}, it will be individually encapsulated with the \idx{innerformatting}. \cmddef{Glsxtrlongformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongplformat} As \gls{glsxtrlongformat}, but for the \gloskey{longplural} field. \cmddef{Glsxtrlongplformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongplformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongformatgrp} As \gls{glsxtrlongformat}, but adds grouping around \meta{insert} (with the \idx{innerformatting} inside the group). \cmddef{Glsxtrlongformatgrp} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongformatgrp} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongplformatgrp} As \gls{glsxtrlongplformat}, but adds grouping around \meta{insert} (with the \idx{innerformatting} inside the group). \cmddef{Glsxtrlongplformatgrp} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongplformatgrp} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortformat} This command is used in the definition of \gls{glsxtrshort} and in some of the predefined abbreviation styles to format the \gloskey{short} value of the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} with the command \meta{fmt-cs}, which should take one argument. Accessibility support is implemented with \gls{glsaccessshort} if the \catattr{markshortwords} attribute is true otherwise with \gls{glsaccessfmtshort} using \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} for the \idx{innerformatting}. This is then encapsulated (including or excluding the \meta{insert}, according to \gls{ifglsxtrinsertinside}) with \meta{fmt-cs}. If the \meta{insert} content needs to be placed outside of \meta{fmt-cs}, it will be individually encapsulated with the \idx{innerformatting}. \cmddef{Glsxtrshortformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortplformat} As \gls{glsxtrshortformat}, but for the \gloskey{shortplural} field. \cmddef{Glsxtrshortplformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortplformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortformatgrp} As \gls{glsxtrshortformat}, but adds grouping around \meta{insert} (with the \idx{innerformatting} inside the group). \cmddef{Glsxtrshortformatgrp} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortformatgrp} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortplformatgrp} As \gls{glsxtrshortplformat}, but adds grouping around \meta{insert} (with the \idx{innerformatting} inside the group). \cmddef{Glsxtrshortplformatgrp} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortplformatgrp} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortformat} A shortcut designed for \meta{long} (\meta{short}) styles. This is defined as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrlongformat}\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}\margm{long-fmt-cs}% \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\margm{entry-label}% \gls{glsxtrparen}\margm{\gls{glsxtrshortformat}\margm{entry-label}\marg{}\margm{short-fmt-cs}}% \end{codebox} Note that the \meta{insert} is only placed after the long form. \cmddef{Glsxtrlongshortformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongshortformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrlongshortplformat} As \gls{glsxtrlongshortformat} but uses the plural versions \gls{glsxtrlongplformat} and \gls{glsxtrshortplformat}. \cmddef{Glsxtrlongshortplformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrlongshortplformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortlongformat} A shortcut designed for \meta{short} (\meta{long}) styles. This is defined as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrshortformat}\margm{entry-label}\margm{insert}\margm{short-fmt-cs}% \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\margm{entry-label}% \gls{glsxtrparen}\margm{\gls{glsxtrlongformat}\margm{entry-label}\marg{}\margm{long-fmt-cs}}% \end{codebox} Note that the \meta{insert} is only placed after the short form. The syntax is the same as for \gls{glsxtrlongshortformat} even though \gls{glsxtrlongformat} and \gls{glsxtrshortformat} are flipped within the definition. \cmddef{Glsxtrshortlongformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortlongformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsxtrshortlongplformat} As \gls{glsxtrshortlongformat} but uses the plural versions \gls{glsxtrshortplformat} and \gls{glsxtrlongplformat}. \cmddef{Glsxtrshortlongplformat} As above, but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSxtrshortlongplformat} As above, but \idx{allcaps}. \section{Restoring Base Acronym Mechanism} \label{sec:acrorevert} It's possible to revert \gls{newacronym} back to the definition provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. However, if you do this, you will lose all the abbreviation features provided by \sty{glossaries-extra}. \begin{important} Where possible, avoid this. If you're simply trying to make the long form appear on \idx{firstuse} with \gls{newacronym}, set the abbreviation style using: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{acronym}\marg{long-short} \end{codebox} \end{important} If you really need to use the original base \sty{glossaries} package's acronym mechanism, it's better to stick with just \sty{glossaries} and not use \sty{glossaries-extra}. However, it may be that you need to use a \sty{glossaries-extra} feature, such as \gls{printunsrtglossary}, but you have a custom acronym style that you can't implement using the \sty{glossaries-extra} abbreviation mechanism. This is a rare edge case for unusual formats, as it should be possible to implement most common abbreviation formats using the predefined styles. \begin{warning} Unpredictable results will occur if \gls{RestoreAcronyms} or \gls{MakeAcronymsAbbreviations} are used after abbreviations or acronyms have been defined. \end{warning} \cmddef{RestoreAcronyms} Restores \gls{newacronym} back to the original base \sty{glossaries} interface. Note that this doesn't affect \gls{newabbreviation}. It also sets the \catattr{regular} attribute for the \cat{acronym} category to \code{false} and sets the acronym style to \code{long-short} (which is the default for the base package). The display style for each \idx{glossary} identified in the acronym lists is switched to the default acronym display style. \cmddef{MakeAcronymsAbbreviations} Counteracts \gls{RestoreAcronyms}. \chapter{Referencing (Using) Entries} \label{sec:glsref} Entries can be referenced using the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, as described in the base \sty{glossaries} manual. There are some additional commands provided by \sty{glossaries-extra}: \begin{itemize} \item abbreviation commands, such as \gls{glsxtrshort} (see \sectionref{sec:abbreviations}); \item commands for use in captions or section headings, such as \gls{glsfmttext} (see \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}); \item commands, such as \gls{glsxtrp}, designed for use within fields to help mitigate the problems of nesting (see \sectionref{sec:nested}); \item commands, such as \gls{mgls}, that are designed for referencing multi (or compound) entries (see \sectionref{sec:multientries}); \item commands, such as \gls{glsaccessname}, used to incorporate accessibility support (see \sectionref{sec:glsaccessfield}); \item commands, such as \gls{dgls}, that are designed for \app{bib2gls}['s] dual entries (see \sectionref{sec:dgls}); \item commands, such as \gls{rgls}, that depend on the number of entry records (see \sectionref{sec:recordcount}). \end{itemize} Additionally, the entry counting commands, such as \gls{cgls}, provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package are modified by \sty{glossaries-extra} (see \sectionref{sec:entrycount}). The \idx{glslike} commands are designed to produce text at that point in the document (the \idx{linktext}, \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}), index the entry (to ensure that it appears in the glossary, \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}) and unset the \idx{firstuseflag} (which can alter the \idx{linktext}, \sectionref{sec:glsunset}). Additional information can be appended automatically with the \idx{postlinkhook} (\sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}). The \idx{linktext} is given by the entry style (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmt}) or by the final argument of \gls{glsdisp}. The \idx{glstextlike} commands are designed to produce text at that point in the document (the \idx{linktext}, \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}) and index the entry (to ensure that it appears in the glossary, \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}). Additional information can be appended automatically with the \idx{postlinkhook} (\sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}). The \idx{linktext} is determined by the calling command. For example, the corresponding field value (possibly encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrregularfont} and the inner formatting) for commands like \gls{glstext} or the final argument of \gls{glslink}. The \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands can all be used with a star (\code{*}) or plus (\code{+}) modifier. The star modifier automatically implements \glsoptval{hyper}{false} (disables the hyperlink) and the plus modifier automatically implements \glsoptval{hyper}{true} (forces the hyperlink on, if supported). With \sty{glossaries-extra}, it's possible to define an additional modifier for your own use with: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetAltModifier} The \meta{token} must be a single token, so a multi-byte \idx{utf8} character will required a native Unicode engine (\XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX). For example, the following: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetAltModifier}\marg{!}\marg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore}} \end{codebox} means that \code{\gls{gls}!\margm{label}} will be equivalent to \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore}}\margm{label}}. It's also possible to redefine the star and plus modifiers: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetStarModifier} This sets the options to use for the star modifier. \cmddef{GlsXtrSetPlusModifier} This sets the options to use for the plus modifier. For example, the following: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetPlusModifier}\marg{\glsopt{noindex}} \end{codebox} means that the star modifier will now suppress \idx{indexing} instead of switching on the hyperlink. The \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands have a complicated internal structure, which can be viewed as a series of layers. The outermost common layer is: \begin{compactcodebox} \comment{save settings} \comment{initialise options, see \sectionref{sec:glsopts}} \gls{glslinkwrcontent}\margm{index \& fmt content} \comment{restore settings} \comment{\idx{postlinkhook}, see \sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}} \end{compactcodebox} The \meta{index \& fmt content} consists of the \idx{indexing} (see \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}) and the (possibly hyperlinked) formatted text, see \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}. The \meta{index \& fmt content} code is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glslinkwrcontent} In v1.48, this was added to scope the \idx{linktext} and \idx{indexing} code, which helped to prevent unwanted spacing caused by the \idx{whatsit} and also helped to prevent some setting leakage, in the event of nesting (see \sectionref{sec:nested}), but this caused spacing issues when used in math mode, so from v1.49 this command now simply does its argument. The \idx{whatsit} is now scoped with \gls{glsencapwrcontent} instead. The \gls{glsxtrp} command, designed for nested use, deals with the problem by suppressing the \idx{postlinkhook} and adding an outer group. For example, \code{\gls{glsxtrp}\marg{short}\marg{html}} behaves like: \begin{compactcodebox} \marg{\gls{let}\gls{glspostlinkhook}\gls{relax} \gls{glsxtrshort}\oarg{noindex,nohyper}\marg{html}} \end{compactcodebox} Note that the code to suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} has been moved to \gls{glsxtrpInit}, so it is now possible to allow the \idx{postlinkhook} but it won't be able to lookahead beyond the added outer group. Depending on the settings (the \glsopt{wrgloss} option or the \catattr{wrgloss} attribute), the indexing may come before the text: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslinkwrcontent}\marg{\meta{index}\meta{fmt content}} \end{compactcodebox} or after the text: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslinkwrcontent}\marg{\meta{fmt content}\meta{index}} \end{compactcodebox} or may be suppressed with \glsopt{noindex}: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslinkwrcontent}\marg{\meta{fmt content}} \end{compactcodebox} The \meta{fmt content} part is described in \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}. The \meta{index} part is the actual \idx{indexing} (see \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}) but also increments the index count, if applicable. Both the associated \idx{whatsit} and increment are encapsulated with \gls{glsencapwrcontent}. \begin{important} Avoid using \gls{glstext}, \gls{glsplural}, \gls{glsfirst} and \gls{glsfirstplural} (and their case-changing variants) with entries that have been defined with \gls{newabbreviation}. Some of the abbreviation styles are too complicated to work with those commands. Instead, use commands like \gls{glsxtrshort}, \gls{glsxtrfull} or use \gls{gls} with the \glsopt{prereset} or \glsopt{preunset} options. \end{important} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides a way to adjust the formatting of the \idx{linktext} for the \idx{glslike} commands according to the glossary type with \gls{defglsentryfmt}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package changes the default entry formatting (\sectionref{sec:entryfmt}) and provides additional ways of modifying the displayed content (\sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}). The heading commands (described in \sectionref{sec:headtitle}) are designed to prevent indexing or changes to the \idx{firstuseflag} if they appear in the table of contents (or list of figures, etc) or if they appear in the page header. Although the base \sty{glossaries} package warns against nested \idx{linktext}, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides \gls{glsxtrp} which can be used instead of \gls{gls} in field values to overcome some of the associated problems. See \sectionref{sec:nested} for further details. If you need to simply access a \idx{field} value without any formatting, see \sectionref{sec:getfields}. (See \sectionref{sec:setfields} to set \idx{field} values.) If you want to encapsulate the value with the appropriate accessibility tag, see \sectionref{sec:glsaccessfield}. Commands such as \gls{glsadd} (see \sectionref{sec:wrglossary}) and \gls{glssee} (see \sectionref{sec:xr}) are designed to only index (to ensure the entry appears in the glossary) without producing any text or changing the \idx{firstuseflag}. The \idx{glslike}, \idx{glstextlike} and \gls{glsadd} commands all have an initial optional argument that can be used to override the default actions. Some options are only applicable for particular subsets of referencing commands. For example, \glsopt{noindex} is pointless for \gls{glsadd} since the sole purpose of that command is to index. Whereas \glsopt{types} is only available with \gls{glsaddall}. \section{Options} \label{sec:glsopts} \glsstartrange{idx.glsopt}% Some options are provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package, but there are some additional options provided by \sty{glossaries-extra}, which are listed in \sectionref{sec:xtrglsopts}. Below, \meta{option-list} indicates the options that are passed in the optional argument of the calling command (such as \gls{gls}). The order that the options are applied is: \begin{enumerate} \item \glsopt{prereset}, \glsopt{preunset} and \glsopt{postunset} options are initialised by \gls{glsinitreunsets}; \item \glsopt{hyper} is initialised by \gls{glsxtrchecknohyperfirst} (\gls{glsfirst}-like only); \item \glsopt{wrgloss} option is initialised by \gls{glsxtrinitwrgloss} (not implemented by \gls{glsadd} or \gls{glsxtrfmt}); \item \glsopt{hyperoutside} option is initialised by \gls{glsxtrinithyperoutside} (not implemented by \gls{glsadd} or \gls{glsxtrfmt}); \item initialise \glsoptval{noindex}{false} (not \gls{glsadd}); \item options identified by \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}, \gls{GlsXtrAppToDefaultGlsOpts} or \gls{GlsXtrPreToDefaultGlsOpts} (not implemented by \gls{glsadd}); \item (\gls{glsxtrfmt} only) options provided in \gls{GlsXtrFmtDefaultOptions}; \item (\idx{glslike} only) the \opt{hyperfirst} package option, \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute and \catattr{nohypernext} attributes are checked to determine if the \glsopt{hyper} option should be switched off (tests followed by \gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook}); \item \gls{glslinkpresetkeys} (not implemented by \gls{glsadd} or \gls{glsxtrfmt}); \item (\gls{glsadd} only) \gls{glsaddpresetkeys}; \item \meta{option-list}; \item \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys} (provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package, not implemented by \gls{glsadd} or \gls{glsxtrfmt}); \item (\gls{glsadd} only) \gls{glsaddpostsetkeys}. \end{enumerate} \subsection{Setting Up Defaults} \label{sec:defaultglsopts} You can (locally) set your preferred default options for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands using: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts} The \meta{options} may be any options that you can pass to those commands. These options also apply to \gls{glsxtrfmt} but not to \gls{glsadd}. \begin{information} Note that multiple instances of \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts} will override each other. \end{information} If you want to add to the existing options, you can use one of the following commands (both may be scoped). \cmddef{GlsXtrAppToDefaultGlsOpts} Appends \meta{options} to the list of default options. \cmddef{GlsXtrPreToDefaultGlsOpts} Prepends \meta{options} to the list of default options. For example, to prevent indexing in the front matter and back matter but not in the main matter: \begin{codebox} \gls+{frontmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsopt{noindex}} \ldots \gls+{mainmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{} \ldots \gls+{backmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsopt{noindex}} \end{codebox} Note that \glsoptval{noindex}{false} is now set before the options given in \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts} to ensure that the setting is correctly initialised, so as from v1.49 you can simply set an empty options list to reset the default. Prior to v1.49, it was necessary to ensure that the \glsopt{noindex} key was always present in the options list to avoid instability. So for pre v1.49, the line after \gls{mainmatter} in the above would need to be: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsoptval{noindex}{false}} \end{codebox} The default \idx{locationencap} is \encap{glsnumberformat} but can be changed (locally) with: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat} This can be overridden by explicitly setting the \glsopt{format} key. The default options for \gls{glsxtrfmt} only are given by: \cmddef{GlsXtrFmtDefaultOptions} This command should simply expand to the required list of options. These options are set after any options given in \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts} and before \meta{option-list}. \cmddef{glslinkpresetkeys} This hook is performed after any settings provided in \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts} but before \meta{option-list}. This hook also applies to \gls{glsxtrfmt} but not to \gls{glsadd}. Note that \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys}, provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package, is performed after \meta{option-list} is processed. \cmddef{glsaddpresetkeys} This hook, which is only used by \gls{glsadd}, is performed before \meta{option-list}. \cmddef{glsaddpostsetkeys} This hook, which is only used by \gls{glsadd}, is performed after \meta{option-list}. \cmddef{glsinitreunsets} This hook initialises the pre unset/reset options to: \glsoptval{prereset}{none} and \glsoptval{preunset}{none}. It also initialises the \glsopt{postunset} setting to perform the post-unset (where applicable) but it will retain the current local/global setting. This hook will also implement the local repeat unset feature of \gls{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal}. \cmddef{glsxtrchecknohyperfirst} This hook is only used by \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{glsfirstplural} and their case-changing variants. The hook will implement \glsoptval{hyper}{false} if the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute is set to \code{true}. \cmddef{glsxtrinitwrgloss} This hook initialises the default setting of the \glsopt{wrgloss} option. If the \catattr{wrgloss} attribute is set to \code{after} then this implements \glsoptval{wrgloss}{after} otherwise it implements \glsoptval{wrgloss}{before}. This setting can subsequently be overridden by \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}, \gls{glslinkpresetkeys}, the \meta{option-list} argument or \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys}. This hook also applies to \gls{glsxtrfmt} but not to \gls{glsadd}. If you prefer to have the default to place the \idx{indexing} after the \idx{linktext}, you can redefine this hook as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrinitwrgloss}}\marg{\% \gls{glsifattribute}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\marg{\catattr{wrgloss}}\marg{before}\% {\% \gls+{glsxtrinitwrglossbeforetrue} }\% {\% \gls+{glsxtrinitwrglossbeforefalse} }\% } \end{codebox} \cmddef{glsxtrinithyperoutside} This hook initialises the default setting of the \glsopt{hyperoutside} option. If the \catattr{hyperoutside} attribute is set to \code{false} then this implements \glsoptval{hyperoutside}{false} otherwise it implements \glsoptval{hyperoutside}{true}. This setting can subsequently be overridden by \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}, \gls{glslinkpresetkeys}, the \meta{option-list} argument or \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys}. This hook also applies to \gls{glsxtrfmt} but not to \gls{glsadd}. Within any of the hooks that are used by the \idx{glslike}, \idx{glstextlike} or \gls{glsxtrfmt} commands, you can set options using: \cmddef{setupglslink} Within any of the hooks that are used by \idx{glsadd}, you can set options with: \cmddef{setupglsadd} \subsection{Additional Options} \label{sec:xtrglsopts} Options for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands that are provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package also apply to new commands like \gls{glsxtrfmt} and \gls{glsfmttext}. In addition, the options below are provided by \sty{glossaries-extra}. Note that some options, such as \glsopt{postunset}, only apply to the \idx{glslike} commands. Options that relate to the hyperlink, formatting, \idx{firstuseflag} or whether\slash where (\glsopt{noindex}\slash\glsopt{wrgloss}) to perform \idx{indexing} aren't available for \gls{glsadd}. \optiondef{glsopt.hyperoutside} This boolean option determines whether the hyperlink should be inside or outside of \gls{glstextformat} (see \sectionref{sec:glstextformat}). If true, the \idx{linktext} is encapsulated as: \begin{codebox} \meta{hyperlink-cs}\margm{target}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}\margm{text}} \end{codebox} otherwise it's encapsulated as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glstextformat}\marg{\meta{hyperlink-cs}\margm{target}\margm{text}} \end{codebox} where \meta{hyperlink-cs} is the command that generates the hyperlink (if enabled). \optiondef{glsopt.textformat} The value of this key should be the name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash). If this option is set, the given control sequence will be used instead of \gls{glstextformat} to encapsulate the \idx{linktext}. Note that this control sequence should take a single argument (the \idx{linktext}). See \sectionref{sec:glstextformat} for further details. \begin{information} This option will override the \catattr{textformat} attribute. \end{information} \optiondef{glsopt.innertextformat} The value of this key should be the name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash). The command \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} (which shouldn't be redefined) is assigned to this control sequence at the start of the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This command is used within the predefined abbreviation styles and within \gls{glsgenentryfmt} to encapsulate the entry field values. \begin{information} Custom styles that don't use \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} won't support this key. See \sectionref{sec:innertextformat} for further details. \end{information} Some formatting commands require direct access to the actual text or else the content has to be placed inside a box (which inhibits line-breaking). These commands won't work with \glsopt{textformat} as the text is usually too deeply embedded. This option provides a way of using those problematic commands, however there's still no guarantee that they will work (for example, in the case of custom styles or where the field value itself contains commands). \optiondef{glsopt.postunset} This option only applies to the \idx{glslike} commands and indicates whether or not to unset the \idx{firstuseflag} after the \idx{linktext}. It may take one of three values: \optfmt{global} (behaves like \glsoptval{local}{false}), \optfmt{local} (behaves like \glsoptval{local}{true}) or \optfmt{none} (doesn't unset the \idx{firstuseflag} after the \idx{firstuse}). See \sectionref{sec:glsunset}. \optiondef{glsopt.prereset} This option may take one of three values: \optfmt{none} (no reset), \optfmt{local} or \optfmt{global}. This option (if not \optfmt{none}) will reset the \idx{firstuseflag} before the \idx{linktext} and additionally change \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} so that it indicates that this was the \idx{firstuse} of the entry. See \sectionref{sec:glsunset}. Note that this is different from using \gls{glslocalreset} or \gls{glsreset} before the \idx{glstextlike} commands. Normally \gls{glstext} and \gls{glsplural} will define \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} so that it indicates that this was not the \idx{firstuse} of the entry (regardless of whether or not the entry has actually been used). For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample}, \gloskeyval{first}{sample first use},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} Text field: \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}. \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Force reset: \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar Force reset: \gls{glstext}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Illustrating the \optfmt{prereset} option}, label={ex:prereset}, description={Example document illustrating the use of the prereset option}] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{name={sample},^^J first=\marg{sample first use},^^J description=\marg{an example}} }{% Text field: \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}. \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Force reset: \gls{gls}\oarg{prereset}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar Force reset: \gls{glstext}\oarg{prereset}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \end{resultbox} Note that \gls{gls} unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} (unless \glsoptval{postunset}{none}), so the sample entry is marked as used afterwards, but \gls{glstext} doesn't alter the \idx{firstuseflag}, after the \idx{linktext} so the sample entry is still marked as unused afterwards. \optiondef{glsopt.preunset} This option may take one of three values: \optfmt{none} (no unset), \optfmt{local} or \optfmt{global}. This option (if not \optfmt{none}) will unset the \idx{firstuseflag} before the \idx{linktext} and additionally change \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} so that it indicates that this wasn't the \idx{firstuse} of the entry. See \sectionref{sec:glsunset}. \begin{information} The \glsopt{preunset} key is always performed after the \glsopt{prereset} key. \end{information} Note the effect of using a global reset but a local unset in the example below. Both options are performed, but the unset locally overrides the global reset. \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample}, \gloskeyval{first}{sample first use},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \marg{\gls{glsfirst}\oarg{\glsoptval{preunset}{local},\glsoptval{prereset}{global}}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \marg{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{preunset}{local},\glsoptval{prereset}{global}}\marg{sample}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Combining \optfmt{prereset} and \optfmt{preunset}}, label={ex:preresetpreunset}, description={Example document illustrating the use of the prereset and preunset options}] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{name=\marg{sample},^^J first=\marg{sample first use},^^J description=\marg{an example}} }{% \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Used?^^J% \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \marg{\gls{glsfirst}\oarg{preunset=local,prereset=global}\marg{sample}.^^J% Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \marg{\gls{gls}\oarg{preunset=local,prereset=global}\marg{sample}.^^J% Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{sample}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \end{resultbox} Remember that \gls{gls} globally unsets the \idx{firstuseflag} (unless changed with \glsopt{postunset}), which counteracts \glsoptval{prereset}{global}. \optiondef{glsopt.noindex} This is a boolean option that determines whether or not to suppress the normal \idx{indexing}. For example, to prevent any \locations\ in the front matter or back matter appearing in the glossary: \begin{codebox} \gls{frontmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsopt{noindex}} \ldots \gls{mainmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsoptval{noindex}{false}} \ldots \gls{backmatter} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}\marg{\glsopt{noindex}} \end{codebox} Note that if you are using auto-indexing (see \sectionref{sec:autoindex}), \glsoptval{noindex}{false} will also suppress the auto-indexing. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you may want to consider instead using \glsoptval{format}{glsignore} to create an ignored \location\ that ensures the entry is selected without adding a \location\ to the \idx{locationlist}. (Don't use this method for the other \idx{indexing} methods as you'll end up with invisible \locations\ with spurious commas in your \idxpl{locationlist}.) \optiondef{glsopt.wrgloss} This option may take one of two values, \optfmt{before} or \optfmt{after}, which indicate whether the \idx{indexing} should occur before or after the \idx{linktext}. The \idx{indexing} creates a \idx{whatsit} that can interfere with spacing or cause other problems. The other thing to consider is where the \idx{linktext} is long, such as a phrase or full form of an abbreviation, that may be split by a page break. You will need to decide if you want the \idx{indexing} before the \idx{linktext}, so that the \location\ is at the end of the page where the text starts, or if you want the \idx{indexing} after the \idx{linktext}, so that the \location\ is at the start of the next page where the text ends. This option corresponds to a conditional: \cmddef*{ifglsxtrinitwrglossbefore} The hook \gls{glsxtrinitwrgloss} sets this conditional according to whether or not the \catattr{wrgloss} attribute has been set to \code{after}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrinitwrgloss}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsifattribute}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\marg{wrgloss}\marg{after}\comment{} \marg{\gls{glsxtrinitwrglossbeforefalse}}\comment{} \marg{\gls{glsxtrinitwrglossbeforetrue}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} \optiondef{glsopt.thevalue} Sets the \idx{entrylocation} to the given value instead of obtaining it from the \idx{locationcounter}. If you are using \sty{hyperref} you may also need to set the location's hypertarget with \glsopt{theHvalue}. \begin{information} This option is primarily intended for use with \app{bib2gls} to supply \locations\ that don't have an associated counter within the document, such as an external location. If you want to automatically add locations from a supplemental document to an entry's \idx{locationlist}, you can use the \resourceopt{supplemental-locations} resource option. See the \app{bib2gls} user manual for further details. \end{information} For example, to \idxc{indexing}{index} a \location\ in a supplementary document: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{\marg{Suppl.\cmd{ }2.45}}}\marg{sample} \end{codebox} This will add \qt{Suppl.\ 2.45} to the \idx{locationlist} for the \qt{sample} entry. \begin{important} Note that the value must conform to the \idx{indexingapp}['s] location syntax. For \app+{makeindex}, this is limited to \code{Roman}, \code{roman}, \code{arabic}, \code{alph} and \code{Alph}. With \app+{xindy}, the location syntax must be defined in the \app{xindy} module (standard location syntaxes are supplied by default). There's no restriction on the location syntax for \app{bib2gls}, although if it can't deduce a numerical value it won't be able to form a range. \end{important} If you want a hyperlink to an external file, you can use: \cmddef*{glsxtrsupphypernumber} as the formatting command for the \idx{locationencap}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{S.2},\glsoptval{format}{glsxtrsupphypernumber}}\marg{sample} \end{codebox} The path to the external file needs to be set in the \catattr{externallocation} category attribute. \begin{information} The hyperlink for the supplementary location may or \emph{may not} take you to the relevant place in the external PDF file \emph{depending on your PDF viewer}. Some may not support external links, and some may take you to the first page or last visited page. \end{information} For example, if both \filefmt{sample-suppl-hyp.pdf} and \filefmt{sample-suppl-main-hyp.pdf} are in the same directory, then viewing \filefmt{sample-suppl-main-hyp.pdf} in Evince will take you to the correct location in the linked document (when you click on the S.2 external link), but Okular will take you to the top of the first page of the linked document. This method can only be used where there is one external source for the designated category (identified by the \catattr{externallocation} attribute). For multiple sources, you need to use \app{bib2gls} v1.7+, which is the better method in general as it can automatically fetch the relevant locations from the \ext{aux} files of the designated external documents without the need to explicitly use \gls{glsadd}. \optiondef{glsopt.theHvalue} Sets the hypertarget corresponding to the \location, which will be used if the \glsopt{format} supports hyperlinks. This is analogous to \sty{hyperref}['s] \theHcountername\ that provides the hypertarget for a reference to \thecountername. \begin{information} This option is primarily intended for use with the \glsopt{thevalue} option. \end{information} Unless you are using \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}, you must ensure that it's possible to form \meta{the-H-value} from \meta{h-prefix}\meta{thevalue} for some \meta{h-prefix} (where \meta{thevalue} is given by \glsopt{thevalue} or the value of the \location\ counter). This restriction is due to the limitations imposed by \app+{makeindex} and \app+{xindy}. \optiondef{glsopt.prefix} This option locally redefines \gls{glolinkprefix} to \meta{link-prefix}. If you are using \gls{printunsrtglossary} to redisplay a list (possibly in a different order) then you will need some way of changing the entry targets to avoid duplicate hyperlink targets. One way of achieving this is to redefine \gls{glolinkprefix} for the subsequent lists. You will then need to use the \glsopt{prefix} option in commands like \gls{gls} to ensure that the hyperlink for the \idx{linktext} points to the desired list. \begin{information} This option is intended for use with the \idx{unsrtfam} and \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary} (which is used by \app{bib2gls}). The other \idx{indexing} methods don't support repeated lists. \end{information} \glsendrange{idx.glsopt}% \section{Case Changing} \label{sec:casechange} Case-changing commands, such as \gls{Gls} and \gls{GLS}, perform the conversion using commands provided by \sty{mfirstuc}. The underlying commands provided by \sty{mfirstuc} were redesigned in v2.08 to use the newer, better case-changing commands available with the \LaTeX3 kernel. The base \sty{glossaries} package v4.50 and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49 were developed concurrently with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08 to take advantage of the new features. Version 1.49 of \sty{glossaries-extra} was also developed concurrently with \app{bib2gls} v3.0 which, in turn, was developed alongside version 0.9.2.7b of the \TeX\ parser library. It's not possible to upload all these new versions at the same time, so it will be necessary to stagger their deployment. The new case-changing features will work best when all these new versions are installed. In the interim, a reduced feature set will be used. \subsection{Sentence Case Commands} \label{sec:firstuc} Both the base \sty{glossaries} package and the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provide \idx{sentencecase} commands, which convert the first letter to \idx{uppercase}. These are provided for situations where an entry is referenced at the start of a sentence. Sentence-casing is also implemented when the attributes \catattr{glossname} or \catattr{glossdesc} are set to \code{firstuc}. The case conversion is performed using: \cmddef{glssentencecase} The default definition uses \gls{makefirstuc}, which is provided by the \sty{mfirstuc} package. This was originally part of the base \sty{glossaries} package, but was split into a separately distributed package in 2015. Back then, there was no expandable sentence-case command. There was also a problem with referencing entries where \idx{linktext} was encapsulated with a text-block command (which occurs, in particular, with acronym and abbreviation styles). The first letter of the text-block command's argument needed to be obtained, which resulted in some trickery that proved problematic with \idx{utf8}. The \LaTeX3 kernel now provides a suitable expandable command that works with \idx{utf8}, and \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ provides \gls{MFUsentencecase} that directly interfaces with it. If an older version of \sty{mfirstuc} is installed, \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+ will provide \gls{MFUsentencecase}. You can use this in expandable contents. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentrytext}\marg{label}}} \end{codebox} However, in the above example, it's simpler to do: \begin{codebox} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{label}} \end{codebox} If \sty{hyperref} has been loaded, \code{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{label}} will now expand to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentrytext}\marg{label}} \end{compactcodebox} in the PDF bookmark. Internally, \gls{makefirstuc} now uses \gls{MFUsentencecase} to perform the case conversion, but it still parses its argument to determine if it starts with \code{\meta{cs}\margm{text}}. This means that with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+, you now don't have to worry about \idx{utf8} characters occurring at the start of the text. For example, with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.07 you would need to do something like: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{elite}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\marg{\'e}lite}, \gloskeyval{description}{...}} \end{codebox} in order for \code{\gls{Gls}\marg{elite}} to work. Whereas with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08, you can now simply do: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{elite}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\'elite}, \gloskeyval{description}{...}} \end{codebox} (As from \sty{glossaries} v4.47, it should be possible to use \idx{utf8} characters in the label as well.) Whilst you can redefine \gls{glssentencecase} to use \gls{MFUsentencecase} directly (without using \gls{makefirstuc} as an intermediary), this may result in content being expanded that wouldn't have been expanded previously. In particularly, if \meta{cs} isn't robust and expands to content that includes labels then the case-change can fail. You also won't be able to take advantage of the blockers and mappings that are only recognised as such by \gls{makefirstuc}. If you use \gls{MFUsentencecase} instead, blockers and mappings will be treated as exclusions, which are likely to result in unwanted side-effects. Both \gls{makefirstuc} and \gls{MFUsentencecase} recognise exclusions. These are text-block commands which take a single mandatory argument that needs to be skipped. For example, in the following \code{\gls{glsadd}\marg{example}} needs to be skipped: \begin{codebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsadd}\marg{example}some text} \end{codebox} Exclusions are identified with \gls{MFUexcl}. If you have an older version of \sty{mfirstuc}, this won't be defined, so \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+ provide: \cmddef{glsmfuexcl} This will use \gls{MFUexcl} with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+. With older versions, a definition will be provided that works with \gls{MFUsentencecase}, but exclusions won't be recognised by \gls{makefirstuc}. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50, \gls{glsadd} will be identified as an exclusion (via \gls{glsmfuexcl}), but the optional argument will cause a problem if present. See the \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ manual for a workaround. Note that commands such as \gls{glsaddall} and \gls{glsaddeach} aren't identified as exclusions as they aren't expected to occur in text that may require a case-change. With glossary entry references, there are commands that take a label as the argument, which shouldn't have any case-changed applied, but also shouldn't be skipped. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{makefirstuc}\marg{\gls{GLS}\marg{example} something} \end{codebox} In this situation, there shouldn't be any case-change as \gls{GLS} already implements a case-change. This type of command is referred to as a blocker in the \sty{mfirstuc} manual, as it indicates a command that should prevent any case-change if it's encountered at the start of the text. Blockers are identified with \gls{MFUblocker}. If you have an older version of \sty{mfirstuc}, this won't be defined, so \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+ provide: \cmddef{glsmfublocker} This will use \gls{MFUblocker} with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+. With older versions, it will simply use \gls{glsmfuexcl} which will instead identify the command as an exclusion and won't be recognised by \gls{makefirstuc}. See the \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ manual for further information about blockers. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50+, commands like \gls{GLS} will be identified as blockers using \gls{glsmfublocker}, and \sty{glossaries-extra} now identifies similar commands, such as \gls{rGLS} as blockers. Finally, there are mappings. These are commands that should be substituted with another command, which is expected to perform the case-change. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{makefirstuc}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{example} something} \end{codebox} This shouldn't skip or block \gls{gls} but instead should convert the text to: \begin{codebox} \gls{Gls}\marg{example} something \end{codebox} This is implemented by adding a mapping from \gls{gls} to \gls{Gls}. Mappings are added using \gls{MFUaddmap}. If you have an older version of \sty{mfirstuc}, this won't be defined, so \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+ provide: \cmddef{glsmfuaddmap} This will use \gls{MFUaddmap} with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+. With older versions, it will simply use \gls{glsmfuexcl} which will instead identify the command as an exclusion and won't be recognised by \gls{makefirstuc}. See the \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ manual for further information about mappings. As from \sty{glossaries} v4.50+, commands like \gls{gls} will be mapped to the appropriate \idx{sentencecase} command using \gls{glsmfuaddmap}, and \sty{glossaries-extra} now identifies similar mappings, such as \gls{rgls} mapped to \gls{rGls}. In order to integrate the full set of features provided by \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+, you will need both \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ and \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.49+. \subsection{Lower Case} \label{sec:lowercase} \cmddef{glslowercase} This is defined by \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ to use the \LaTeX3 command to convert to \idx+{lowercase}. If an older version of \sty{glossaries} is present, then this command will be provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} but it will be defined to use \gls{MakeTextLowercase} instead. This command is primarily provided for use with \idx{smallcaps} styles to convert an abbreviation to \idx{lowercase}, but isn't actually used anywhere by default. \subsection{Upper Case} \label{sec:uppercase} \cmddef{glsuppercase} This is defined by \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ to use the \LaTeX3 command to convert to \idx+{uppercase} (\idx+{allcaps}). If an older version of \sty{glossaries} is present, then this command will be provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} but it will be defined to just use \gls{mfirstucMakeUppercase}, which is provided by \sty{mfirstuc}. This command is used by \idx{allcaps} commands such as \gls{GLSxtrusefield}. \subsection{Title Case} \label{sec:titlecase} \cmddef{glscapitalisewords} This is defined by \sty{glossaries} v4.48 to use \gls{capitalisewords} to convert to \idx+{titlecase}. If you experience any errors with \idx{titlecase} commands, such as \gls{glsentrytitlecase}, or attributes such as \catattr{glossdesc} then try redefining this command to use \code{\gls{capitalisefmtwords}*} instead. See the \sty{mfirstuc} manual for further details. \section{Entries in Sectioning Titles, Headers, Captions and Contents} \label{sec:headtitle} The \sty{glossaries} user manual cautions against using commands like \gls{gls} in chapter or section titles. The principle problems are: \begin{itemize} \item if you have a table of contents, the \idx{firstuseflag} will be unset in the contents rather than later in the document; \item if you have the \idxpl{locationlist} displayed in the \idx{glossary}, unwanted \locations\ will be added to it corresponding to the table of contents (if present) and every page that contains the entry in the page header (if the page style in use adds the chapter or section title to the header); \item if the page style in use adds the chapter or section title to the header and attempts to convert it to \idx{uppercase}, the entry label (in the argument of \gls{gls} etc) will be converted to \idx{uppercase} and the entry won't be recognised; \item if you use \sty{hyperref}, commands like \gls{gls} can't be expanded to a simple string and only the label will appear in the PDF bookmark (with a warning from \sty{hyperref}); \item if you use \sty{hyperref}, you will end up with nested hyperlinks in the table of contents. \end{itemize} Similar problems can also occur with captions (except for the page header and bookmark issues). The \sty{glossaries-extra} package tries to resolve the header problem by modifying \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc}. If this causes unwanted side-effects, you can restore their former definitions using: \cmddef{glsxtrRevertMarks} This will revert \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc} back to the definitions in effect when \sty{glossaries-extra} was loaded. Alternatively, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrRevertTocMarks} This will only revert \gls{@starttoc}. If you use \gls{glsxtrRevertMarks} or \gls{glsxtrRevertTocMarks}, you will need to employ the simplistic approach, described in \sectionref{sec:simplisticapproach}, which is the method recommended by the \sty{glossaries} user manual. Otherwise, you can use the commands described in \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}, which provide a better solution. \subsection{Simplistic Approach} \label{sec:simplisticapproach} To get around all these problems, the \sty{glossaries} user manual recommends using the expandable non-hyperlink commands, such as \gls{glsentrytext} (for regular entries) or \gls{glsentryshort} (for abbreviations). This is the simplest solution, but doesn't allow for special formatting that's applied to the entry through commands like \gls{glstext} or \gls{glsxtrshort}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample}, \gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}},\gloskeyval{description}{alpha}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{tableofcontents} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{texorpdfstring}\marg{\gls{Glsentrytext}\marg{sample} and \gls{glsentrytext}\marg{alpha}}\marg{Sample and alpha}} \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:simpleseccmds}, title={References in section headings (simplistic approach)}, description={Example document that uses a simplistic approach to referencing entries in section titles}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}},\gloskeyval{description}{alpha}} } {% \gls{tableofcontents}^^J% \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{texorpdfstring}\marg{\gls{Glsentrytext}\marg{sample} and \gls{glsentrytext}\marg{alpha}}\marg{Sample and alpha}}^^J% \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}.^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}.^^J% \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossary} } \end{resultbox} This solves some problems: it avoids nested links in the table of contents, the \idx{firstuseflag} isn't prematurely unset and the PDF bookmarks has a reasonable substitution, but it still isn't a complete solution as the above document will fail if the page style is changed to \code{headings} and a page break is inserted before the section (after \gls{tableofcontents}), which will lead to the error: \begin{transcript} Glossary entry `SAMPLE' has not been defined. \end{transcript} This is because the case-change applied to the header converts the label \qt{sample} to \qt{SAMPLE}, which doesn't correspond to a defined entry. (This can now be avoided with \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+.) If the case conversion is applied by, then the case-change can be prevented by encapsulating the label with \gls{NoCaseChange}, but this ends up quite complicated. This is actually what the commands describe in \sectionref{sec:headingcommands} do when they are in a heading. This allows for older versions of \sty{mfirstuc} that don't recognise exclusions. See \sectionref{sec:casechange} for further details. \begin{information} The \gls{NoCaseChange} command was originally provided by the \sty{textcase} package to prevent \gls{MakeTextUppercase} from applying a case-change. The functionality of the \sty{textcase} package has now been absorbed into the \LaTeX\ kernel, which means that as from 2022, \sty{textcase} is deprecated and \gls{NoCaseChange} is defined by the kernel. \end{information} \subsection{New Commands Designed for Chapter/Section Headings or Captions} \label{sec:headingcommands} This section is irrelevant if you use \gls{glsxtrRevertMarks} to restore the definitions of \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc}. If you use \gls{glsxtrRevertTocMarks}, then this section is only applicable to \gls{markright} and \gls{markboth}. The commands listed here are provided for use within captions or section headings. They are designed to overcome some of the problems illustrated in the previous section. Note that they only have a single argument, the entry label. There are no optional arguments. Below, \qt{header} refers to page header text added with \gls{markright} or \gls{markboth}, and \qt{contents} refers to the table of contents or any other \qt{list of} that uses \gls{@starttoc}, such as the list of figures. Each command \csfmt{glsfmt\meta{field}} (such as \gls{glsfmttext} or \gls{glsfmtshort}) behaves like an analogous \csfmt{gls\meta{field}} or \csfmt{glsxtr\meta{field}} command (such as \gls{glstext} or \gls{glsxtrshort}) but with the options \glsopt{noindex} and \glsoptval{hyper}{false} and no insert. When they occur within a header, they are protected from having any case-change applied (which will interfere with the entry label). Since this means they won't appear in \idx{allcaps} in the header, the \catattr{headuc} attribute may be set to use the \idx{allcaps} \csfmt{GLS\meta{field}} or \csfmt{GLSxtr\meta{field}} instead (such as \gls{GLStext} or \gls{GLSxtrshort}). There is currently only support for the \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{text}, \gloskey{plural}, \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{short}, \gloskey{shortplural}, \gloskey{long}, and \gloskey{longplural} fields, and also limited support for the full form of abbreviations. For other fields, you will need to follow the recommendation of the \sty{glossaries} manual (as discussed above in \sectionref{sec:simplisticapproach}). The previous example can be rewritten as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}}, \gloskeyval{description}{alpha}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{tableofcontents} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{sample} and \gls{glsfmttext}\marg{alpha}} \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:glsfmttext}, title={References in section headings using \cmd{glsfmttext}}, description={Example document that references entries in section titles}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}{\cmd{alpha}}},\gloskeyval{description}{alpha}} } {% \gls{tableofcontents} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{sample} and \gls{glsfmttext}\marg{alpha}} \codepar First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample} and \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossary} } \end{resultbox} Note that this still results in \qt{Token not allowed in a PDF string} warnings from \sty{hyperref}. This is due to the maths shift and \csfmt{alpha}, and is something that would also occur if the section title explicitly contained \code{\$\cmd{alpha}\$}. If this is likely to happen, the issue can be solved by placing \gls{texorpdfstring} within the field value. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsnoexpandfields} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{description}{alpha}, \gloskeyval{name}{\gls{texorpdfstring}\marg{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}}\marg{alpha}}} \end{codebox} Note the need to prevent field expansion with \gls{glsnoexpandfields}, otherwise \gls{texorpdfstring} will be prematurely expanded while the entry is being defined. The options \glsopt{noindex} and \glsoptval{hyper}{false} are hard-coded when the commands listed below, such as \gls{glsfmtshort}, occur in the header or contents, but within the actual section title or caption in the document text, those options are obtained from: \cmddef{glsxtrtitleopts} This simply expands to the option list. For example, you may actually want a hyperlink and \idx{indexing} to occur in the document body, in which case redefine \gls{glsxtrtitleopts} to do nothing: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls+{pagestyle}\marg{headings} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{general}\marg{headuc}\marg{true} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrtitleopts}}\marg{} \codepar \cbeg{document} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{sample}} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:glslinkinsechead}, title={Reference with hyperlink in section headings}, description={Example document that references an entry with a hyperlink in a section title}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \cmd{pagestyle}\marg{headings}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{general}\marg{headuc}\marg{true}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrtitleopts}}\marg{} } {% \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{Glsfmttext}\marg{sample}}^^J% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossary} } \end{resultbox} % short \cmddef{glsfmtshort} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrshort} but expands to just \gls{glsentryshort} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtshort} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrshort} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryshort}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtshort} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrshort} but expands to just \gls{glsentryshort} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % prefix short \cmddef{pglsfmtshort} As \gls{glsfmtshort} but inserts the \gloskey{prefix} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefix} value is set and non-empty. Provided for use with \sty{glossaries-prefix}. \cmddef{Pglsfmtshort} As \gls{pglsfmtshort} but \idx{sentencecase}. Note the initial \qt{P} in the command name, which matches \gls{Pgls} (similarly for the other prefix \idx{sentencecase} commands). \cmddef{PGLSfmtshort} As \gls{pglsfmtshort} but \idx{allcaps}. % short plural \cmddef{glsfmtshortpl} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrshortpl} but expands to just \gls{glsentryshortpl} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtshortpl} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrshortpl} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryshortpl}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtshortpl} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrshortpl} but expands to just \gls{glsentryshortpl} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % prefix short plural \cmddef{pglsfmtshortpl} As \gls{glsfmtshortpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixplural} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixplural} value is set and non-empty. Provided for use with \sty{glossaries-prefix}. \cmddef{Pglsfmtshortpl} As \gls{pglsfmtshortpl} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSfmtshortpl} As \gls{pglsfmtshortpl} but \idx{allcaps}. % long \cmddef{glsfmtlong} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrlong} but expands to just \gls{glsentrylong} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtlong} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrlong} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentrylong}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtlong} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrlong} but expands to just \gls{glsentrylong} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % prefix long \cmddef{pglsfmtlong} As \gls{glsfmtlong} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirst} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixfirst} value is set and non-empty. Provided for use with \sty{glossaries-prefix}. \cmddef{Pglsfmtlong} As \gls{pglsfmtlong} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSfmtlong} As \gls{pglsfmtlong} but \idx{allcaps}. % long plural \cmddef{glsfmtlongpl} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrlongpl} but expands to just \gls{glsentrylongpl} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtlongpl} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrlongpl} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentrylongpl}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtlongpl} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrlongpl} but expands to just \gls{glsentrylongpl} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % prefix long plural \cmddef{pglsfmtlongpl} As \gls{glsfmtlongpl} but inserts the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} field and separator, if the \gloskey{prefixfirstplural} value is set and non-empty. Provided for use with \sty{glossaries-prefix}. \cmddef{Pglsfmtlongpl} As \gls{pglsfmtlongpl} but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{PGLSfmtlongpl} As \gls{pglsfmtlongpl} but \idx{allcaps}. % full The full form is slightly different as it doesn't correspond to an individual \idx{field} but instead is formed from a combination of the short and long \idxpl{field} (the order depending on the abbreviation style). Since it's too complicated to simply expand to the appropriate style, a simple expandable command is provided for the PDF bookmarks: \cmddef{glspdffmtfull} This just expands to the long form followed by the short form in parentheses: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glspdffmtfull}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsentrylong}\marg{\#1} (\gls{glsentryshort}\marg{\#1})} \end{compactcodebox} You will need to redefine this if you require the short form first. There is an analogous command for the plural: \cmddef{glspdffmtfullpl} This has a similar definition to \gls{glspdffmtfull} but uses \gls{glsentrylongpl} and \gls{glsentryshortpl}. \cmddef{glsfmtfull} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrfull} but expands to just \gls{glspdffmtfull} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtfull} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrfull} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glspdffmtfull}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtfull} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrfull} but expands to just \gls{glspdffmtfull} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % full plural \cmddef{glsfmtfullpl} This normally behaves like \gls{glsxtrfullpl} but expands to just \gls{glspdffmtfullpl} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtfullpl} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsxtrfullpl} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glspdffmtfullpl}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtfullpl} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSxtrfull} but expands to just \gls{glspdffmtfull} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % name \cmddef{glsfmtname} This normally behaves like \gls{glsname} but expands to just \gls{glsentryname} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtname} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsname} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryname}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtname} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSname} but expands to just \gls{glsentryname} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % text \cmddef{glsfmttext} This normally behaves like \gls{glstext} but expands to just \gls{glsentrytext} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmttext} This normally behaves like \gls{Glstext} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentrytext}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmttext} This normally behaves like \gls{GLStext} but expands to just \gls{glsentrytext} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % plural \cmddef{glsfmtplural} This normally behaves like \gls{glsplural} but expands to just \gls{glsentryplural} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtplural} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsplural} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryplural}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtplural} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSplural} but expands to just \gls{glsentryplural} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % first \cmddef{glsfmtfirst} This normally behaves like \gls{glsfirst} but expands to just \gls{glsentryfirst} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtfirst} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsfirst} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryfirst}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtfirst} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSfirst} but expands to just \gls{glsentryfirst} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. % first plural \cmddef{glsfmtfirstpl} This normally behaves like \gls{glsfirstplural} but expands to just \gls{glsentryfirstplural} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{Glsfmtfirstpl} This normally behaves like \gls{Glsfirstplural} but expands to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryfirstplural}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \cmddef{GLSfmtfirstpl} This normally behaves like \gls{GLSfirstplural} but expands to just \gls{glsentryfirstplural} in PDF bookmarks and is adjusted when appearing in the header or contents. \subsection{Advanced Commands} \label{sec:headingsadvanced} \begin{information} This section is intended for advanced users and package developers. \end{information} The commands described here are irrelevant if you use \gls{glsxtrRevertMarks} to restore the definitions of \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc}. If you use \gls{glsxtrRevertTocMarks}, then this section is only applicable to \gls{markright} and \gls{markboth}. If you need to know whether or not some code is inside a header or contents list, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrifinmark} This does \meta{true} if the command occurs within \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} or \gls{@starttoc} otherwise does \meta{false}. If you need to know whether or not some code is inside a contents list (but not the header), you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrifintoc} This does \meta{true} if the command occurs within \gls{@starttoc} otherwise it does \meta{false}. (The modified definition of \gls{@starttoc} sets \gls{glsxtrifintoc} to \gls{@firstoftwo} at the start and to \gls{@secondoftwo} at the end.) If you need to know whether or not some code is in the PDF bookmarks or heading, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading} This does the applicable argument depending on whether the command occurs within a title\slash caption or PDF bookmark or heading. If this command occurs within the \ext+{toc} file, it will do its \meta{heading} argument but if \gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading} expands while it's being written to the \ext{toc} file, then it will expand to \meta{title}. This can be illustrated in the following document: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{report} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{lipsum} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \cmd{pagestyle}\marg{headings} \cbeg{document} \gls+{tableofcontents} \cmd{chapter}\marg{\gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading}\marg{Title}\marg{PDF}\marg{Heading} \gls{glsxtrifinmark}\marg{in mark}\marg{not in mark}} \cmd{lipsum} \cmd{chapter}\marg{\cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading}\marg{Title}\marg{PDF}\marg{Heading} \cmd{protect}\gls{glsxtrifinmark}\marg{in mark}\marg{not in mark}} \cmd{lipsum} \cend{document} \end{codebox} In the first case, \gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading} expands as it's being written to the \ext{toc} file, so it expands to \qt{Title}. In the second case, \gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading} is protected so that command is written to the \ext{toc} file. On the next \LaTeX, when the table of contents is displayed, this command will expand to \qt{Heading}, because it's in the \ext{toc} file. Similarly, in the first case, \gls{glsxtrifinmark} will expand to \qt{not in mark} as it's written to the \ext{toc} file, but in the second case it's expansion is prevented, so it will expand to \qt{in mark} in the table of contents. If \sty{gettitlestring} has been loaded (used by \sty{nameref} to provide \gls{nameref}) then adjustments for both \gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading} and \gls{glsxtrifinmark} will be added to \gls{GetTitleStringDisableCommands}, but bear in mind that you will need to use the following for it to have an effect: \begin{codebox*} \gls{GetTitleStringSetup}\marg{expand} \end{codebox*} The commands described in \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}, such as \gls{glsfmtshort}, are essentially defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{texorpdfstring} \marg{\cmd{glsxtrtitle\meta{field}}\margm{entry-label}}\comment{title} \marg{\cmd{glsentry\meta{field}}\margm{entry-label}}\comment{bookmark} \end{compactcodebox} If \gls{texorpdfstring} isn't defined, then the definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{glsxtrtitle\meta{field}}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} For example, \gls{glsfmtshort} is defined as (with \sty{hyperref}): \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsfmtshort}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{texorpdfstring}\marg{\gls{glsxtrtitleshort}\marg{\#1}}\marg{\gls{glsentryshort}\marg{\#1}}\% } \end{compactcodebox} This ensures that \gls{glsfmtshort} expands to just \gls{glsentryshort} within the PDF bookmarks. Provided the field value doesn't contain any problematic commands, this allows the actual value to be added to the bookmarks. Unfortunately the case-changing commands can't expand and therefore aren't appropriate for the bookmarks (which need to be a PDF string). This means that the \idx{sentencecase} and \idx{allcaps} commands also use the unmodified field value for the bookmark. For example, \gls{Glsfmtshort} is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{Glsfmtshort}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{texorpdfstring}\marg{\gls{Glsxtrtitleshort}\marg{\#1}}\marg{\gls{glsentryshort}\marg{\#1}}\% } \end{compactcodebox} The \csfmt{glsxtrtitle\meta{field}} set of commands all default to the corresponding \idx{glstextlike} command with the options given by \gls{glsxtrtitleopts} and an empty insert final argument. These title commands are redefined by \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} to the corresponding \csfmt{glsxtrhead\meta{field}} command. These \qt{head} commands use \gls{NoCaseChange} to prevent interference from page headers that convert to \idx{allcaps} (which can inappropriately convert the entry label to \idx{allcaps}). Instead, the \catattr{headuc} attribute needs to be set to \code{true} to use the appropriate \idx{allcaps} command. A shortcut command is provided to test for this attribute: \cmddef{glsxtrifheaduc} This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrifheaduc}}[3]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifintoc}\marg{\#3}\marg{\gls{glsifattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{headuc}}\marg{true}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}}\% } \end{compactcodebox} Since the header commands also end up in the contents, where the \idx{allcaps} conversion should not be applied, the definition includes \gls{glsxtrifintoc} to skip the check in the contents. \cmddef{glsxtrtitleshort} The normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshort}. This is redefined by \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} to \gls{glsxtrheadshort}. The default is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\margm{entry-label}\oarg{} \end{compactcodebox} (This is performed indirectly via an internal command that ensures that \gls{glsxtrtitleopts} is expanded before being passed in the optional argument.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadshort} Used to display the short form in the page header. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrheadshort}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{protect}\gls{NoCaseChange} \marg{\% \gls{glsifattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{headuc}}\marg{true}\% \marg{\% \gls{GLSxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}\oarg{}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}\oarg{}\% }\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} The \idx{sentencecase} commands also check the \catattr{headuc} attribute. \cmddef{Glsxtrtitleshort} The normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshort}. This is redefined by \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} to \gls{Glsxtrheadshort}. The default is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{Glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\margm{entry-label}\oarg{} \end{compactcodebox} (Again, this is performed indirectly via an internal command that ensures that \gls{glsxtrtitleopts} is expanded before being passed in the optional argument.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadshort} Used to display the \idx{sentencecase} short form in the page header. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{Glsxtrheadshort}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{protect}\gls{NoCaseChange} \marg{\% \gls{glsifattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{headuc}}\marg{true}\% \marg{\% \gls{GLSxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}\oarg{}\% }\% \marg{\% \gls{Glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}\oarg{}\% }\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{GLSxtrtitleshort} The normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshort}. This is redefined by \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} to \gls{GLSxtrheadshort}. The default uses \gls{GLSxtrshort} in a similar way to \gls{glsxtrtitleshort} and \gls{Glsxtrtitleshort}. \cmddef{GLSxtrheadshort} Used to display the \idx{allcaps} short form in the page header. In this case, there's no need to check to the \catattr{headuc} attribute, but the label needs to be protected from any potential case-change: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{GLSxtrheadshort}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{protect}\gls{NoCaseChange} \marg{\% \gls{GLSxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}\oarg{}\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} All the similar commands listed below are defined in an analogous way, except for the \sty{glossaries-prefix} commands, where only the \idx{sentencecase} title version is provided. This is because commands like \gls{Pglsfmtshort} have to determine whether or not to use \gls{glsfmtshort} or \gls{Glsfmtshort} depending on whether or not the prefix has been set. Whereas commands like \gls{pglsfmtshort} simply need to insert the prefix and separator if set and then use the corresponding \gls{glsfmtshort}. \cmddef{Pglsxtrtitleshort} The normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtshort}. \cmddef{Pglsxtrtitleshortpl} The normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtshortpl}. \cmddef{Pglsxtrtitlelong} The normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtlong}. \cmddef{Pglsxtrtitlelongpl} The normal behaviour of \gls{Pglsfmtlongpl}. % short plural \cmddef{glsxtrtitleshortpl} The title plural short form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshortpl}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadshortpl} The header plural short form. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitleshortpl} The title plural \idx{sentencecase} short form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshortpl}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadshortpl} The header plural \idx{sentencecase} short form. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitleshortpl} The title plural \idx{allcaps} short form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshortpl}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadshortpl} The header plural \idx{allcaps} short form. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtshortpl} when it occurs in a header.) % long \cmddef{glsxtrtitlelong} The title long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlong}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadlong} The header long form. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlong} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlelong} The title \idx{sentencecase} long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlong}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadlong} The header \idx{sentencecase} long form. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlong} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlelong} The title \idx{allcaps} long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlong}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadlong} The header \idx{allcaps} long form. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlong} when it occurs in a header.) % long plural \cmddef{glsxtrtitlelongpl} The title plural long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlongpl}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadlongpl} The header plural long form. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlelongpl} The title plural \idx{sentencecase} long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlongpl}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadlongpl} The header plural \idx{sentencecase} long form. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlelongpl} The title plural \idx{allcaps} long form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlongpl}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadlongpl} The header plural \idx{allcaps} long form. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtlongpl} when it occurs in a header.) % full \cmddef{glsxtrtitlefull} The title full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfull}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadfull} The header full form. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfull} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlefull} The title \idx{sentencecase} full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfull}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadfull} The header \idx{sentencecase} full form. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfull} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlefull} The title \idx{allcaps} full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfull}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadfull} The header \idx{allcaps} full form. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfull} when it occurs in a header.) % full plural \cmddef{glsxtrtitlefullpl} The title plural full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfullpl}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadfullpl} The header plural full form. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfullpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlefullpl} The title plural \idx{sentencecase} full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfullpl}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadfullpl} The header plural \idx{sentencecase} full form. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfullpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlefullpl} The title plural \idx{allcaps} full form. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfullpl}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadfullpl} The header plural \idx{allcaps} full form. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfullpl} when it occurs in a header.) % name \cmddef{glsxtrtitlename} The title \gloskey{name} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtname}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadname} The header \gloskey{name} field. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtname} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlename} The title \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{name} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtname}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadname} The header \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{name} field. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtname} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlename} The title \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{name} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtname}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadname} The header \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{name} field. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtname} when it occurs in a header.) % text \cmddef{glsxtrtitletext} The title \gloskey{text} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmttext}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadtext} The header \gloskey{text} field. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmttext} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitletext} The title \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{text} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmttext}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadtext} The header \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{text} field. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmttext} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitletext} The title \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{text} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmttext}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadtext} The header \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{text} field. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmttext} when it occurs in a header.) % plural \cmddef{glsxtrtitleplural} The title \gloskey{plural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtplural}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadplural} The header \gloskey{plural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtplural} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitleplural} The title \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{plural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtplural}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadplural} The header \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{plural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtplural} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitleplural} The title \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{plural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtplural}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadplural} The header \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{plural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtplural} when it occurs in a header.) % first \cmddef{glsxtrtitlefirst} The title \gloskey{first} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfirst}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadfirst} The header \gloskey{first} field. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfirst} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlefirst} The title \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{first} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfirst}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadfirst} The header \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{first} field. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfirst} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlefirst} The title \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{first} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfirst}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadfirst} The header \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{first} field. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfirst} when it occurs in a header.) % firstplural \cmddef{glsxtrtitlefirstplural} The title \gloskey{firstplural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfirstpl}.) \cmddef{glsxtrheadfirstplural} The header \gloskey{firstplural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{glsfmtfirstpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{Glsxtrtitlefirstplural} The title \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{firstplural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfirstpl}.) \cmddef{Glsxtrheadfirstplural} The header \idx{sentencecase} \gloskey{firstplural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{Glsfmtfirstpl} when it occurs in a header.) \cmddef{GLSxtrtitlefirstplural} The title \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{firstplural} field. (Normal behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfirstpl}.) \cmddef{GLSxtrheadfirstplural} The header \idx{allcaps} \gloskey{firstplural} field. (The behaviour of \gls{GLSfmtfirstpl} when it occurs in a header.) The definitions of \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc} are saved (using \gls{let}) when \sty{glossaries-extra} loads. \cmddef{@glsxtr@org@markright} The previous definition of \gls{markright}. \cmddef{@glsxtr@org@markboth} The previous definition of \gls{markboth}. \cmddef{@glsxtr@org@@starttoc} The previous definition of \gls{@starttoc}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} definitions of \gls{markright}, \gls{markboth} and \gls{@starttoc} all start and end with hooks that redefine commands that are sensitive to being in the header or contents. \cmddef{glsxtrmarkhook} This saves the original definitions and redefines the sensitive commands. This includes \gls{MakeUppercase} which is \gls{let} to \gls{MakeTextUppercase}. \cmddef{@glsxtrinmark} This redefines \gls{glsxtrifinmark} to just do its first argument (\meta{true}). \cmddef{@glsxtrnotinmark} This redefines \gls{glsxtrifinmark} to just do its second argument (\meta{false}). \cmddef{glsxtrrestoremarkhook} This restores the sensitive commands to the saved definitions. (For use where grouping will cause interference.) For example, \gls{markboth} is redefined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{markboth}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} \gls{@glsxtr@org@markboth} \marg{\gls{@glsxtrinmark}\#1\gls{@glsxtrnotinmark}}\% \marg{\gls{@glsxtrinmark}\#2\gls{@glsxtrnotinmark}}\% \gls{glsxtrrestoremarkhook} } \end{compactcodebox} \section{Nested Links} \label{sec:nested} Complications arise when you use the \idx{glslike} commands in the value of the \gloskey{name} field (or \gloskey{text} or \gloskey{first} fields, if set). This tends to occur with abbreviations that extend other abbreviations. For example, SHTML is an abbreviation for SSI enabled HTML, where SSI is an abbreviation for Server Side Includes and HTML is an abbreviation for Hypertext Markup Language. For example, things can go wrong if the following is used with the \sty{glossaries} package: \begin{badcodebox} \gls{newacronym}\marg{ssi}\marg{SSI}\marg{Server Side Includes} \gls{newacronym}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{Hypertext Markup Language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{shtml}\marg{S\gls{gls}\marg{html}}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{ssi} enabled \gls{gls}\marg{html}} \end{badcodebox} The main problems are: \begin{enumerate} \item\label{itm:nestedfirstucprob} With older versions of \sty{mfirstuc} and \sty{glossaries}, the \idx{sentencecase} commands, such as \gls{Gls}, won't work for the \code{shtml} entry on \idx{firstuse} if the long form is displayed before the short form (which is the default abbreviation style). This will attempt to do \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{gls}\marg{\gls+{uppercase} ssi} enabled \gls{gls}\marg{html} \end{compactcodebox} which just doesn't work. Grouping the \code{\gls{gls}\marg{ssi}} doesn't work either as this will effectively try to do: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls+{uppercase}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{ssi}} enabled \gls{gls}\marg{html} \end{compactcodebox} This will upper case the label \code{ssi} so the entry won't be recognised. This problem will also occur if you use the \idx{allcaps} version, such as \code{\gls{GLS}\marg{shtml}}. With \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ and \sty{glossaries} v1.49+, this issue should now be resolved for \idx{sentencecase} where \code{\gls{gls}\marg{ssi}} will be mapped to \code{\gls{Gls}\marg{ssi}} within \code{\gls{Gls}\marg{shtml}}. The \idx{allcaps} command \code{\gls{GLS}\marg{shtml}} will treat \gls{gls} as an exclusion and so won't perform a case-change. See \sectionref{sec:casechange} for further details. \item\label{itm:nonexpandprob} The long and abbreviated forms accessed through \gls{glsentrylong} and \gls{glsentryshort} are no longer expandable and so can't be used be used in contexts that require this, such as PDF bookmarks. \item\label{itm:nestedsortprob} The nested commands may end up in the \gloskey{sort} key, which will confuse the indexing. \item\label{itm:inconsistentfirstuseprob} The \code{shtml} entry produces inconsistent results depending on whether the \code{ssi} or \code{html} entries have been used. Suppose both \code{ssi} and \code{html} are used before \code{shtml}. For example: \begin{coderesult} This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}, \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}. \tcblower This section discusses server side includes (SSI), hypertext markup language (HTML) and SSI enabled HTML (SHTML). \end{coderesult} In the above, the \idx{firstuse} of the \code{shtml} entry produces \qt{SSI enabled HTML (SHTML)}. Now let's suppose the \code{html} entry is used before the \code{shtml} but the \code{ssi} entry is used after the \code{shtml} entry, for example: \begin{coderesult} The sample files are either \gls{gls}\marg{html} or \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}, but let's first discuss \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \tcblower The sample files are either hypertext markup language (HTML) or server side includes (SSI) enabled HTML (SHTML), but let's first discuss SSI. \end{coderesult} In this case, the \idx{firstuse} of the \code{shtml} entry now produces \qt{server side includes (SSI) enabled HTML (SHTML)}, which looks a bit cumbersome. Now let's suppose the \code{shtml} entry is used before (or without) the other two entries: \begin{coderesult} This article is an introduction to \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}. \tcblower This article is an introduction to server side includes (SSI) enabled hypertext markup language (HTML) (SHTML). \end{coderesult} Now the \idx{firstuse} of the \code{shtml} entry produces \qt{server side includes (SSI) enabled hypertext markup language (HTML) (SHTML)}, which looks strange. This is all aggravated when using just the base \sty{glossaries} package when the acronym style is set with \gls{setacronymstyle}. For example: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{setacronymstyle}\marg{\acrstyle+{long-short}} \end{compactcodebox} as this references the label through the use of \gls{glslabel} when displaying the long and short forms, but this value changes with each use of \gls{gls}, so instead of displaying \qt{(SHTML)} at the end of the \gls{firstuse}, it now displays \qt{(HTML)}, since \gls{glslabel} has been changed to \code{html} by \code{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}. \begin{information} In v1.48, the \sty{glossaries-extra} package added grouping with \gls{glslinkwrcontent}, which scoped the \idx{linktext}. Unfortunately this grouping caused problems in math mode and had to be removed in v1.49. You can redefine \gls{glslinkwrcontent} to put the grouping back, but it still won't scope the definitions of the placeholder commands, such as \gls{glslabel}, which need to be outside of this scope for the benefit of the \idx{postlinkhook}. \end{information} Another oddity occurs if you reset the \code{html} entry between uses of the \code{shtml} entry. For example: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} ... \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}\gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \end{compactcodebox} The next use of \code{shtml} produces \qt{Shypertext markup language (HTML)}, which is downright weird. (This is a result of the short form being set to \code{S\gls{gls}\marg{html}}, but \code{\gls{gls}\marg{html}} is showing the full form.) Even without this, the short form has nested formatting commands, which amount to \code{\gls{acronymfont}\marg{S\gls{acronymfont}\marg{HTML}}}. This may not be a problem for some styles, but if you use one of the \qt{sm} styles (that use \gls{textsmaller}), this will produce an odd result. \item\label{itm:indexingprob} Each time the \code{shtml} entry is used, the \code{html} entry will also be indexed and marked as used, and on \idx{firstuse} this will happen to both the \code{ssi} and \code{html} entries. This kind of duplication in the location list isn't usually particularly helpful to the reader. \item\label{itm:nestedhyplinkprob} If \sty{hyperref} is in use, you'll get nested hyperlinks and there's no consistent way of dealing with this across the available PDF viewers. If on the \idx{firstuse} case, the user clicks on the \qt{HTML} part of the \qt{SSI enabled HTML (SHTML)} link, they may be directed to the HTML entry in the glossary or they may be directed to the SHTML entry in the glossary. \end{enumerate} For these reasons, with just the base \sty{glossaries} package, it's better to use the simple expandable commands like \gls{glsentrytext} or \gls{glsentryshort} in the definition of other entries. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides two other ways of dealing with these problems: \begin{enumerate} \item If the term can simply be treated as a series of previously defined entries, then consider using multi-entries (or compound sets), as described in \sectionref{sec:multientries}. This deals with all the issues, including case-changing. \item Use the partially-expandable \gls{glsxtrp}, described below. \end{enumerate} \cmddef{glsxtrp} where \meta{field} is the \idx{internalfieldlabel}. This command partially expands, so it will expand to just the \idx{field} value if it occurs in the PDF bookmarks. Otherwise it will behave much like the commands described in \sectionref{sec:headingcommands}, but with additional outer scoping and the \idx{postlinkhook} is suppressed. Rather than testing the existence of the given field, this tests the existence of \csfmt{gls\meta{field}} or \csfmt{glsxtr\meta{field}}, which means that it may be confused if the \meta{field} argument is set to something that isn't a field but happens to match either of those command names (such as \code{full}). The \idx{postlinkhook} is suppressed by the initialisation command: \cmddef{glsxtrpInit} This is used inside the added outer scoping and is simply defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}{\gls{glsxtrpInit}}\oarg{2}\marg{\cmd{let}\gls{glspostlinkhook}\cmd{relax}} \end{compactcodebox} It is possible to redefine this command to allow the \idx{glspostlinkhook} to be used, but any look-ahead (such as checking for a following punctuation character) won't work because of the added grouping. The arguments are ignored by default. If you want to redefine \gls{glsxtrpInit} the first argument is the name of the control sequence that will be used, without the leading backslash (for example, \code{glstext} or \code{glsxtrshort}) and the second argument is the entry's label. Note that, as with commands like \gls{glsfmtshort}, there's no optional argument. The default settings are \glsopt{noindex} and \glsoptval{hyper}{false}. You can change this with: \cmddef{glsxtrsetpopts} The argument should be the new default options. At the start of each glossary, the default options are locally changed with: \cmddef{glossxtrsetpopts} This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glossxtrsetpopts}}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrsetpopts}\marg{noindex}\% } \end{compactcodebox} This allows hyperlinks for any instance of \gls{glsxtrp} that occurs in the name or description, where it shouldn't be problematic. There are also \idx{sentencecase} and \idx{allcaps} versions. \cmddef{Glsxtrp} This uses the corresponding \idx{sentencecase} command \csfmt{Gls\meta{field}} or \csfmt{Glsxtr\meta{field}}. \cmddef{GLSxtrp} This uses the corresponding \idx{allcaps} command \csfmt{GLS\meta{field}} or \csfmt{GLSxtr\meta{field}}. There are some shortcut commands for the most common fields: \cmddef{glsps} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{glsxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}, and \cmddef{glspt} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{glsxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}. As well as \idx{sentencecase} and \idx{allcaps} versions: \cmddef{Glsps} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{Glsxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}, \cmddef{Glspt} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{Glsxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}, \cmddef{GLSps} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{GLSxtrp}\marg{short}\margm{entry-label}}, and \cmddef{GLSpt} which is equivalent to \code{\gls{GLSxtrp}\marg{text}\margm{entry-label}}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-em-short-em} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{SSI}\marg{server-side includes} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{SHTML}\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi}} \cbeg{document} \gls{tableofcontents} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{shtml}} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:nestedlinkglspl}, title={Nested link text with \cmd{glspl}}, description={Example document illustrating an entry that references other entries within one of its fields}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-em-short-em}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{SSI}\marg{server-side includes}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{SHTML}\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi}} } {% \gls{tableofcontents}^^J% \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{shtml}}^^J% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The way that this works is as follows: \begin{itemize} \item \code{\gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{shtml}} expands to \code{\gls{glsentrylong}\marg{shtml}} within the PDF bookmarks, which expands to the value of the \gloskey{long} field: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi} \end{compactcodebox} This means that \gls{glsps} (within the PDF bookmarks) in turn expands to \gls{glsentryshort}. So the bookmark text (which can't contain any formatting commands) ends up as \qt{HTML enabled SSI}. \item \code{\gls{glsfmtlong}\marg{shtml}} essentially behaves like \gls{glsxtrlong}, but with the \idx{indexing} and hyperlink suppressed. The \idx{linktext} is the value of the \gloskey{long} field encapsulated with the abbreviation style's formatting command (\gls{glslongemfont} in this case): \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslongemfont}\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi}} \end{compactcodebox} This then becomes: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslongemfont}\marg{\marg{\gls{let}\gls{glspostlinkhook}\gls{relax} \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html}} enabled \marg{\gls{let}\gls{glspostlinkhook}\gls{relax} \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{ssi}}} \end{compactcodebox} Note the grouping and localised suppression of the \idx{postlinkhook}. \end{itemize} Note that in the above example, with older versions of \sty{mfirstuc} and \sty{glossaries}, it's not possible to use \code{\gls{Glsxtrlong}\marg{shtml}} or similar. The problem here is that it will attempt to do: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{makefirstuc}\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi}} \end{compactcodebox} This will essentially end up as: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsps}\marg{\gls{uppercase} html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi} \end{compactcodebox} which doesn't work. If you want to protect against automated case-changes, such as using the \catattr{glossdesc} attribute, insert an empty brace at the start: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{SHTML}\marg{\marg{}\gls{glsps}\marg{html} enabled \gls{glsps}\marg{ssi}} \end{compactcodebox} Alternatively, upgrade to \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ and \sty{glossaries} v4.50+. See \sectionref{sec:casechange}. \section{Adjusting the Text Style} \label{sec:entryfmtmods} The \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands produce text that's essentially formatted either as (\glsoptval{hyperoutside}{true}): \begin{compactcodebox} \meta{hyper-cs}\margm{target}\marg{\meta{textformat-cs}\margm{content}}\meta{post-link hook} \end{compactcodebox} or (\glsoptval{hyperoutside}{false}): \begin{compactcodebox} \meta{textformat-cs}\marg{\meta{hyper-cs}\margm{target}\margm{content}}\meta{post-link hook} \end{compactcodebox} If hyperlinks are enabled then \meta{hyper-cs} creates the hyperlink based on \meta{target} with the hyperlink text given by the second argument. If hyperlinks aren't enabled then \meta{hyper-cs} ignores the \meta{target} argument and simply does the second argument. The \meta{content} part is the \idx{linktext}, which includes the final optional \meta{insert} (if supplied). The actual content depends on the command used (for example, \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext}). The \idx{glslike} commands all use the entry display style associated with the entry's \idx{glossary} type, (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmt}). The \idx{glstextlike} commands set the \meta{content} to the corresponding field value with the insert appended, all encapsulated with the inner formatting (see \sectionref{sec:innertextformat}), with appropriate case-changing, if required. The abbreviation commands (\gls{glsxtrshort}, \gls{glsxtrlong}, \gls{glsxtrfull} etc) are considered part of the set of \idx{glstextlike} commands, but the content is set according to the abbreviation style (see \sectionref{sec:abbrstyle}). The commands \gls{glsdisp} and \gls{glslink} both have the content part explicitly set in their final argument. There's no insert optional argument as it can simply be included in the content part. The difference between them is that \gls{glsdisp} is considered a \idx{glslike} command (it unsets the \idx{firstuseflag}, \sectionref{sec:glsunset}, and uses the entry display style, \sectionref{sec:entryfmt}), whereas \gls{glslink} is considered a \idx{glstextlike} command. The \meta{post-link hook} part is described in \sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}. The \meta{textformat-cs} command is the \emph{outer} formatting command, described in \sectionref{sec:glstextformat}. This doesn't include the \idx{postlinkhook}. If you want to include the \idx{postlinkhook} then you need to encapsulate the entire \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} command (including the final optional argument, if present, and following punctuation, if the \idx{postlinkhook} looks ahead for punctuation). Some sensitive formatting commands need to have the actual text in their argument (or else have the argument in an unbreakable box). The \meta{content} part is usually too complicated for these commands. To help support this type of command, there is also an \idxc{innerformatting}{inner format}, which is described in \sectionref{sec:innertextformat}. In general, unless you require one of these sensitive commands, avoid setting the inner text format as it requires support from the underlying style (either the entry format style or the abbreviation style), which may not be available. The following example document is ugly, but demonstrates the outer formatting (\texttt{type\-writer} font), middle formatting (\textbf{bold} for regular entries and \textit{italic} for abbreviations), inner formatting (highlighted in yellow), hyperlinks (red), and the \idx{catpostlinkhook} (the description follows in parentheses for general entries on \idx{firstuse}). \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{courier} \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{xcolor} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{nogroupskip}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \comment{outer formatting:} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}}[1]\marg{\cmd{texttt}\marg{\#1}} \comment{middle formatting:} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textit}\marg{\#1}} \comment{inner formatting:} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{hl}\marg{\#1}} \comment{post-link hook for 'general' category:} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \comment{define entries:} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[fontsize={14}, label={ex:linktextstyles}, title={Link text styles: outer, middle, inner, hyperlinks and post-link hook}, description={An example document that illustrates the outer, middle and inner formatting, hyperlinks and a category post-link hook}] { \cmd{usepackage}\marg{courier}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{xcolor}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[nogroupskip]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \% outer formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}}[1]\marg{\cmd{texttt}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% middle formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textit}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% inner formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{hl}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% post-link hook for 'general' category:^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \% define entries:^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} } { First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Note that the hyperlink, outer and middle formatting aren't applied to the \idx{postlinkhook}. The \cat{acronym} category has the \abbrstyle{short-nolong} abbreviation style, which sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to true. This means that the NASA entry uses the regular middle format (\gls{glsxtrregularfont}) not the abbreviation middle format (\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}). If you have a formatting command that needs to have its argument fully-expanded before being applied, you may be able to use: \cmddef{GlsXtrExpandedFmt} This fully-expands \meta{content} and does \code{\meta{cs}\margm{expanded-content}}, where \meta{cs} is a command that takes a single argument. For example, to use \sty{soul}['s] underlining command \gls{ul}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}\oarg{1}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrExpandedFmt}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} (See \exampleref{ex:protectinnertextformat}.) This isn't guaranteed to work as the \idx{linktext} may contain fragile content. The inner formatting can be unpredictable. For example, abbreviation styles are complicated and so the inner formatting command is included in some of the field values, such as the \gloskey{name}, which is why the abbreviation name is highlighted in the \idx{glossary}. In the above example, the inner formatting is included in the \idx{catpostlinkhook}, but only because \gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse} is designed to include it. If the \idx{catpostlinkhook} was simply defined as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\marg{ (\gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\gls{glslabel}})}\marg{}} \end{codebox} then the inner formatting won't be applied, since it's not included in the hook. This is demonstrated in a slightly modified version of the above document (initial part of preamble that deals with loading packages and redefining formatting commands as before): \begin{codebox} \comment{post-link hook for 'general' category:} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\marg{ (\gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\gls{glslabel}})}\marg{}} \comment{this style sets the post-link hook for 'abbreviation' category:} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-postshort-user}} \comment{this style sets the post-link hook for 'acronym' category:} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{\cat{acronym}}\marg{\abbrstyle{short-postfootnote}} \comment{define entries:} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[graphicsopts={scale=0.5},fontsize={14}, label={ex:linktextstylescustom}, title={Link text styles: outer, middle, inner, hyperlinks and post-link hooks (custom and abbreviation style)}, description={An example document that illustrates the outer, middle and inner formatting, and hyperlinks, with a custom category post-link hook and abbreviation style that sets the category post-link hook}] { \cmd{usepackage}\marg{courier}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{xcolor}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[nogroupskip]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \% outer formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}}[1]\marg{\cmd{texttt}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% middle formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textit}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% inner formatting:^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{hl}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \% post-link hook for 'general' category:^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\marg{ (\gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\gls{glslabel}})}\marg{}}^^J% \% this style sets the post-link hook for 'abbreviation' category:^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-postshort-user}^^J% \% this style sets the post-link hook for 'acronym' category:^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{acronym}\marg{short-postfootnote}^^J% \% define entries:^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\marg{nasa}\marg{NASA}\marg{National Aeronautics and Space Administration} } { First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{nasa}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The \qt{post} abbreviation styles put some content into the \idx{postlinkhook} and provide support for the inner formatting. The above example sets the abbreviation style to \abbrstyle{long-postshort-user}. This sets up the \idx{postlinkhook} for the associated category (\cat{abbreviation}, in this case) to show the parenthetical material. Be aware that this will override any previous definition of that hook. This style supports the inner formatting (so the parenthetical material is highlighted). Similarly, the \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} style is applied to the \cat{acronym} category, and sets the \idx{postlinkhook} for that category (which looks head for punctuation). The inner formatting is applied to the footnote text but not the marker. The \idx{postlinkhook} for the \cat{general} category is now much simpler and doesn't include support for the inner formatting, so it's not highlighted. None of the post-link content is incorporated into the hyperlink, outer or middle formatting. In general, it's better to adjust the abbreviation's style commands (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvcmds}) rather than use the middle or inner formatting if abbreviations need to be displayed in a particular font. \subsection{Outer Formatting} \label{sec:glstextformat} By default, the outer formatting is produced with \gls{glstextformat}, which is defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package. However it can be replaced by the \catattr{textformat} category attribute or by the \glsopt{textformat} option. The order of precedence (not cumulative) is: the option supplied to the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} command, the category attribute, \gls{glstextformat}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{ (\gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\gls{glslabel}})} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{strong}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\cmd{color}\marg{green}\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \cmd{strong}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}}. \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{textformat}}\marg{strong} \gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{hyperoutside}{false}}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \codepar \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{textformat}{textsf}}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Changing the outer text format}, label={ex:textformat}, description={Example document illustrating the difference between \cmd{glstextformat}, the \optfmt{textformat} category attribute, and the \optfmt{textformat} option}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{ (\gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\gls{glslabel}})}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{strong}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\cmd{color}\marg{green}\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstextformat}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} }{% \gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \cmd{strong}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}}. \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{general}\marg{textformat}\marg{strong} \gls{gls}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \gls{gls}\oarg{hyperoutside=false}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. \codepar \gls{gls}\oarg{textformat=textsf}\marg{sample}\oarg{-insert}. } \end{resultbox} The red text colour is from the hyperlink (red is the default with \sty{hyperref}['s] \optfmt{colorlinks} option). The green from the custom \csfmt{strong} command is cancelled by the hyperlink colour change when the hyperlink is inside \csfmt{strong}. After the \catattr{textformat} attribute is set, the \gls{glstextformat} command isn't used, which is why the remaining lines don't have any italic. The final line uses the \glsopt{textformat} option, which overrides the \catattr{textformat} attribute, so neither \gls{glstextformat} nor the custom \csfmt{strong} are used. Note that the only time that the \idx{postlinkhook} is included in the formatting is when the entire \gls{gls} command has been encapsulated. \subsection{Middle Formatting} \label{sec:middleformat} The middle formatting comes between the outer formatting (\sectionref{sec:glstextformat} above) and the \idx{innerformatting} (\sectionref{sec:innertextformat} below). The middle formatting is implemented by the entry format style (\sectionref{sec:entryfmt}) for the \idx{glslike} commands or is initialised by \gls{glsxtrassignfieldfont} for the \idx{glstextlike} commands. If you provide your own custom entry format style you will need to add support for the middle formatting, if required. \cmddef{glsxtrregularfont} The command to use for regular entries. This is initialised to just do its argument. \cmddef{glsxtrabbreviationfont} The command to use for abbreviations that considered non-regular entries. The following document has a regular entry (sample), a regular abbreviation (radar, which uses \abbrstyle{short-nolong} the default \cat{acronym} style), and a non-regular abbreviation (HTML, which uses \abbrstyle{long-short} the default \cat{abbreviation} style): \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\#1}} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{radar}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Middle formatting}, label={ex:middleformat}, description={Example document illustrating middle formatting applied with \cmd{glsxtrregularfont} for regular entries and \cmd{glsxtrabbreviationfont} for non-regular abbreviations}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{textbf}\marg{\#1}} } {% \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{radar}. } \end{resultbox} Note that even though radar is an abbreviation, it's considered a regular entry because it uses a regular style. \cmddef{glsxtrassignfieldfont} This command is used by all the \idx{glstextlike} commands to initialise the internal command used to encapsulate the field value. This will either be set to \gls{glsxtrregularfont} (for regular entries) or \gls{@firstofone} otherwise. Note that this doesn't use \gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont} as non-regular abbreviations are too complicated to work with \gls{glstext}, \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{glsplural}, \gls{glsfirstplural} or their case-changing variants. Instead, use the \idx{glslike} commands or the abbreviation commands, such as \gls{glsxtrshort}. \subsection{Inner Formatting} \label{sec:innertextformat} If you want to format the \idx{linktext}, the best method is to either use the outer formatting or encapsulate the entire \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} command, as described in \sectionref{sec:glstextformat}. However, there are some sensitive commands that don't work if the command argument doesn't simply contain text. \begin{information} Sometimes the issue may occur when the sensitive command that needs to encapsulate \gls{gls} doesn't like boolean variables being changed (which occurs when the \idx{firstuseflag} is unset). If this is the case, you may want to consider buffering as an alternative (see \sectionref{sec:unsetbuffer}). \end{information} For example, if the sample document from \sectionref{sec:glstextformat} is adjusted to include the \sty{soul} package and the following line is added to the document: \begin{codebox} \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{textformat}{hl}}\marg{sample} \end{codebox} then the document build will fail with the error: \begin{quote} ! Package soul Error: Reconstruction failed. \end{quote} Once solution is to do the following instead: \begin{codebox} \gls+{hl}\marg{\gls+{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{sample}}} \end{codebox} This will now work, but the box will prevent hyphenation, so it's only useful if the \idx{linktext} is short, such as a symbol. If the \idx{linktext} is long (such as a phrase or the \idx{firstuse} of an abbreviation), this method can produce undesirable results with overfull or underfull lines. The \idx{innerformatting} is designed to provide a workaround, but it must be implemented deep within the entry style formatting. This means that if you provide your own custom style, you will need to add the appropriate commands if you want that style to support inner formatting. You may also need to switch to using \gls{MFUsentencecase} instead of \gls{makefirstuc} if any of the \idx{sentencecase} commands are required: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}}[1]\marg{\gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} Although there's no guarantee that this will work for some particularly problematic formatting commands. With the default entry style, the above example can be changed to: \begin{codebox} \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{innertextformat}{hl}}\marg{sample} \end{codebox} \begin{warning} The inner formatting may be split up in order to move them into the arguments of internal commands, such as those used for case-changing. This can result in unwanted side-effects. \end{warning} The following uses \gls{fbox} (which draws a frame around its argument) and \sty{soul}['s] \gls{so} (which spaces out the letters): \begin{codebox} \comment{requires glossaries.sty v4.50+ and mfirstuc v2.08+} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}}[1]\marg{\gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\#1}} \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging} \cbeg{document} \gls{Gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{innertextformat}{fbox}}\marg{radar}['s] system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{Gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{innertextformat}{so}}\marg{radar}['s] system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{fbox}\marg{\gls{Gls}\marg{radar}['s]} system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{so}\marg{\gls+{mbox}\marg{\gls{Gls}\marg{radar}['s]}} system\cmd{ldots} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Inner formatting}, label={ex:innerformat}, description={Example document illustrating inner formatting}] {% \comment{requires glossaries.sty v4.50+ and mfirstuc v2.08+} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}}[1]\marg{\gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \gls{newacronym}\marg{radar}\marg{radar}\marg{radio detection and ranging} } {% \gls{Gls}\oarg{innertextformat=fbox}\marg{radar}['s] system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{Gls}\oarg{innertextformat=so}\marg{radar}['s] system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{fbox}\marg{\gls{Gls}\marg{radar}['s]} system\cmd{ldots} \codepar \gls{so}\marg{\gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{Gls}\marg{radar}['s]}} system\cmd{ldots} } \end{resultbox} Note the fragmentation of the inner formatting. The use of \gls{mbox} in the final line prevents an error but the letters aren't spaced out. The only way to deal with this case is to use \gls{glsdisp} or \gls{glslink} with the text explicitly written: \begin{codebox} \gls{glslink}\marg{radar}\marg{\gls{so}\marg{Radar's}} system\cmd{ldots} \end{codebox} \begin{warning} The above example requires \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+. \end{warning} Below are the commands used to support inner formatting. \cmddef{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} This is the command that's used to encapsulate any content that should have the \idx{innerformatting} applied. It should not be redefined within the document as it's initialised within the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. It's used within \gls{glsgenentryfmt} and included in the helper commands used by the predefined abbreviation styles. Sometimes it may be necessary to include \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} within the actual field value to ensure that it's as close as possible to the text. This is performed automatically when an entry is defined if the \catattr{encapinnerfmt} or \catattr{encapnocaseinnerfmt} attributes are set. Note that even in this case, fragmentation will occur with \idx{sentencecase} commands like \gls{Gls} or with the insert optional argument, as in the above example with \gls{fbox} and \gls{so}. \cmddef{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt} This is the default command that \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} will be \gls{let} to within the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands before their options are processed. This simply does its argument but may be redefined. (See \exampleref{ex:protectinnertextformat}.) \cmddef{glsxtrattrentrytextfmt} This command applies formatting according to whether or not the \catattr{innertextformat} attribute is set. It isn't used by default as it should rarely be needed and increases complexity. However, if you would like to provide support for the \catattr{innertextformat} attribute, you can redefine \gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt} to use \gls{glsxtrattrentrytextfmt}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrattrentrytextfmt}} \end{codebox} \begin{information} This command expects the entry label to be stored in \gls{glslabel} (from which it obtains the category label). \end{information} The \idx{glslike} commands use \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} within \gls{glsgenentryfmt} for regular entries or within the abbreviation style commands for non-regular abbreviations (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmt}). The \idx{glstextlike} commands all essentially perform the following steps: \begin{enumerate} \item Initialise the middle formatting command \meta{field-font-cs} used for encapsulating the field with \gls{glsxtrassignfieldfont} (see \sectionref{sec:middleformat}). \item If \gls{glsifapplyinnerfmtfield} indicates that the field value should be encapsulated by \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}, then this essentially does (or appropriate case-change equivalent): \begin{codebox} \meta{field-font-cs}\marg{\cmd{glsaccessfmt\meta{field}}\margm{insert}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}}\margm{entry-label}\margm{internal-field}} \end{codebox} otherwise it does: \begin{codebox} \meta{field-font-cs}\marg{\cmd{glsaccess\meta{field}}\margm{entry-label}\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}\margm{insert}} \end{codebox} (See \sectionref{sec:accsupp} for the \qt{access} commands.) \end{enumerate} For example, the \idx{linktext} for \gls{glstext} is: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsifapplyinnerfmtfield}\margm{entry-label}\marg{text}\% \marg{\% \meta{field-font-cs}\marg{\gls{glsaccessfmttext}\margm{insert}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}}\margm{entry-label}}\% }\% \marg{\% \meta{field-font-cs}\marg{\gls{glsaccesstext}\margm{entry-label}\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}\margm{insert}}\% } \end{codebox} The \csfmt{glsaccessfmt\meta{field}} commands internally use \gls{glsfmtfield} to apply the \idx{innerformatting}. \cmddef{glsifapplyinnerfmtfield} This determines whether or not the field identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} for the given entry should have its value encapsulated by the \idx{innerformatting} command. False indicates that the field value already contains the \idx{innerformatting} command. \cmddef{glsexclapplyinnerfmtfield} Locally adds the given field identified by its \idx{internalfieldlabel} to the exclusion list for the given entry. \cmddef{glsfmtfield} This command applies the formatting command \meta{cs} (which takes one argument) to the entry's field value identified by the given \idx{internalfieldlabel}, including \meta{insert} appended. This ensures that the internal control sequence used to store the field's value is expanded before \meta{cs} is applied. \cmddef{Glsfmtfield} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSfmtfield} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \subsection{Post Link Hook} \label{sec:postlinkhook} The \idx{postlinkhook} is a convenient way of automatically appending content after each instant of the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. The simplest method of implementing this is with the \idx{catpostlinkhook}, which is only applied to entries that have the given category. For example, the following will place an asterisk (*) after all entries with the default \cat{general} category: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{*} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{symbol}{X}, \gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} \gls{Gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}, \gls{glsdesc}\marg{sample} and \gls{glssymbol}\marg{sample}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Category post-link hook}, label={ex:catpostlink}, description={Example document illustrating a simple category post-link hook}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{*}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{symbol}{X},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} } {% \gls{Gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}, \gls{glsdesc}\marg{sample} and \gls{glssymbol}\marg{sample}. } \end{resultbox} Typically, the \idx{catpostlinkhook} is more likely to include some conditional, such as to only insert text on \idx{firstuse}. For example, \gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse} can be used to insert the description in parentheses after the \idx{firstuse}. \begin{warning} The \qt{post} abbreviation styles all set the \idx{catpostlinkhook}, which will overwrite any previous definition for the abbreviation's category. \end{warning} Within the \idx{postlinkhook}, you can use the placeholder commands, such as \gls{glslabel} (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmt}), but note that you can't use \gls{ifglsused} to determine whether or not the entry has been used, since the \idx{postlinkhook} comes after the entry has been unset. Instead, use \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}. Additional commands provided for use within the \idxpl{postlinkhook} are described in this section. The \idx{postlinkhook} is implemented with \gls{glspostlinkhook}, which is defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package. It's used at the end of the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. The original base definition does nothing, but \sty{glossaries-extra} redefines this: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glspostlinkhook}}\marg{\% \gls{ifglsentryexists}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}}\marg{}\% } \end{compactcodebox} This uses: \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkhook} which is the main \sty{glossaries-extra} \idx{postlinkhook}. \begin{important} If you are migrating over from only using the base \sty{glossaries} package and you have redefined \gls{glspostlinkhook}, consider moving your modifications to the \idx{catpostlinkhook} or prepend to \gls{glsxtrpostlink}, as some attributes and abbreviation styles rely on the features provided by \gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}. \end{important} The main \idx{postlinkhook} is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrdiscardperiod}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkendsentence}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod} \marg{\gls{glsxtrifperiod}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkendsentence}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlink}}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlink}}\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} This checks if a following \idx{fullstop} needs to be discarded and does the inner \idx{postlinkhook} \gls{glsxtrpostlink}. Note that \gls{glsxtrdiscardperiod} and \gls{glsxtrifperiod} look ahead for a following token, so if you need to modify this command, insert your custom code at the start or add it to the \idx{catpostlinkhook} instead. \cmddef{glsxtrdiscardperiod} This discards \meta{token} if it's a \idx{fullstop} and the entry's \idxpl{categoryattribute} indicate that a \idx{fullstop} should be discarded (such as \catattr{discardperiod}). If the punctuation character is discarded, this will then do \meta{discarded}, otherwise it will do \meta{no discard} and process \meta{token} as usual. If the \catattr{retainfirstuseperiod} attribute is set, then the following command is used to determine whether or not to discard \meta{token}. \cmddef{glsxtrdiscardperiodretainfirstuse} This was introduced in v1.49 and is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrdiscardperiodretainfirstuse}}[3]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifwassubsequentorshort}\marg{\gls{glsxtrifperiod}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}}\marg{\#3}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} This will only discard the \idx{fullstop} if it follows the \idx{subsequentuse} of a \idx{glslike} command or if it follows one of the \gls{glsxtrshort} set of commands. Note that this has a different effect from pre v1.49 with the \idx{glstextlike} commands, but it's more appropriate since it's typically only the short form that requires the period to be discarded. To restore the original behaviour: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrdiscardperiodretainfirstuse}}[3]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}\marg{\#3}\marg{\gls{glsxtrifperiod}\marg{\#2}\marg{\#3}}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} If you want your own custom code to determine whether or not to check for a period (instead of using known category attributes), you can redefine: \cmddef{glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod} This should expand to \meta{true} if a check should be performed, otherwise it should expand to \meta{false}. The default definition simply does \meta{false}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkendsentence} This is done if a \idx{fullstop} is discarded. If there is a \idx{catpostlinkhook} for the entry's category, that hook is performed (\gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat} not \gls{glsxtrpostlink}) and the \idx{fullstop} is put back followed by a space factor adjustment. Otherwise, just the space factor adjustment is done. The test to determine whether or not \meta{token} is a \idx{fullstop} is determined by: \cmddef{glsxtrifperiod} It may be useful to test for other punctuation characters. For example, styles such as \abbrstyle{short-postfootnote} will move the footnote after certain punctuation characters. \cmddef{glsxtrifnextpunc} This does \meta{true} if it's followed by one of the set of recognised punctuation characters, otherwise it does false. The set is initialised to \code{.,:;?!} (\idx{fullstop}, comma, colon, semi-colon, question mark, and exclamation mark). A convenient way of moving code after the punctuation character is to use: \cmddef{glsxtrdopostpunc} If \meta{token} is a recognised punctuation character, this will place \meta{code} after the token, otherwise it will be placed before the token. The earlier example can be adapted to put the asterisk after following punctuation: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdopostpunc}\marg{*}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{symbol}{X}, \gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} \gls{Gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}, (\gls{glsdesc}\marg{sample}) and \gls{glssymbol}\marg{sample}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Category post-link hook with punctuation lookahead}, label={ex:catpostlinkpunc}, description={Example document illustrating a category post-link hook that transfers content after a following punctuation character}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdopostpunc}\marg{*}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{symbol}{X},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} } {% \gls{Gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{glstext}\marg{sample}, (\gls{glsdesc}\marg{sample}) and \gls{glssymbol}\marg{sample}. } \end{resultbox} Note that the asterisk isn't moved after the closing parenthesis. This is because that character isn't included in the default list. You can add additional punctuation marks with: \cmddef{glsxtraddpunctuationmark} You may list multiple characters at the same time to add a batch, but don't add any separators (including spaces). \begin{important} Note that each character must be a single token, which means a single-byte character for \pdfLaTeX. Multi-byte characters (\idx{utf8}) will required a native Unicode engine (\XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX). \end{important} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtraddpunctuationmark}\marg{-'/} \end{codebox} This adds three extra punctuation marks (hyphen, apostrophe and slash). Note that this doesn't allow for closing double-quotes and will break \code{'{}'} (double apostrophe sequence for a closing double-quote) if found. The following will only work with \XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX: \begin{unicodebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontspec} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{glsxtraddpunctuationmark}\marg{\textrm{\textquotedblright}} \end{unicodebox} You can set the list with: \cmddef{glsxtrsetpunctuationmarks} This will remove the default set as well as any additional characters. As above, each character must be a single token with no separators in the list. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrsetpunctuationmarks}\marg{.?!} \end{codebox} This sets the list to just three punctuation characters (so comma, colon, and semi-colon are no longer recognised). \cmddef{glsxtrpostlink} This does the \idx{catpostlinkhook} (or nothing if it hasn't been defined): \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlink}}\marg{\% \cmd{csuse}\marg{glsxtrpostlink\gls{glscategory}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}}\% } \end{compactcodebox} Customisation is best performed within the \idx{catpostlinkhook}, which can be defined (or redefined) with: \cmddef{glsdefpostlink} The first argument is the category label and the second is the code to perform. Note that this doesn't check if the hook has already been defined for the category. The hook is a command in the form \gls{glsxtrpostlinkcat}. If the category label only consists of letters, you can also use \gls{newcommand} or \gls{renewcommand} instead. \cmddef{glspretopostlink} Similar to the above but prepends \meta{code} to the associated hook (or simply defines it, if the hook doesn't already exist). \cmddef{glsapptopostlink} Similar to the above but appends \meta{code} to the associated hook. \begin{warning} Take care not to choose category labels that will cause a conflict. For example, \code{endsentence} and \code{hook} will conflict with the commands \gls{glsxtrpostlinkendsentence} and \gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}. \end{warning} If you want code in the \idx{postlinkhook} that's not dependent on the category, consider prepending it to \gls{glsxtrpostlink} or \gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook}. Don't append it to \gls{glsxtrpostlinkhook} otherwise it will interfere with the punctuation lookahead. For convenience, some commands are provided that may be of use in the \idx{catpostlinkhook}: \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse} This will add the \gloskey{description} in parentheses if the hook follows the \idx{firstuse} of the entry. This incorporates the inner formatting and description accessibility support, if provided. \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse} This will add the \gloskey{symbol} in parentheses if that field is set and the hook follows the \idx{firstuse} of the entry. This incorporates the inner formatting and symbol accessibility support, if provided. \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolDescOnFirstUse} This will add the \gloskey{symbol}, if that field is set, and the \gloskey{description} (both within the same set of parentheses), if the hook follows the \idx{firstuse} of the entry. This incorporates the inner formatting and accessibility support, if provided. The separator between the symbol and description is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrpostlinkSymbolDescSep} The default is a comma followed by a space. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{symbol}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse}} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{number}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolDescOnFirstUse}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{alpha},\gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}}, \gloskeyval{description}{a symbol},\gloskeyval{category}{\cat{symbol}}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pi}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pi},\gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}}, \gloskeyval{description}{a constant},\gloskeyval{category}{\cat{number}}} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Category post-link hooks}, label={ex:catpostlinkfirstuse}, description={Example document that uses category post-link hooks to append additional information after the link text on first use}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{general}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{symbol}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse}}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{number}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{alpha},\gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}},^^J% \gloskeyval{description}{a symbol},\gloskeyval{category}{symbol}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pi}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pi},\gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}},^^J% \gloskeyval{description}{a constant},\gloskeyval{category}{number}} } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi}. \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}, \gls{gls}\marg{alpha}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi}. } \end{resultbox} The following commands are also provided for use in the \idx{postlinkhook}: \cmddef{glsxtrcurrentfield} This expands to empty if the calling command isn't associated with one specific field (such as \gls{glslink}, the \idx{glslike} commands, the \idx{inlinefullform} commands) otherwise it will expand to the name of the key associated with the \emph{singular} form of the command. For example, this command will expand to \code{text} for both \gls{glstext} and \gls{glsplural}, to \code{description} for both \gls{glsdesc} and \gls{glsdescplural}, and to \code{short} for both \gls{glsxtrshort} and \gls{glsxtrshortpl}. Whereas it will expand to nothing for both \gls{gls} and \gls{glsxtrfull}. \cmddef{glsxtrifwasglslike} This expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command and to \meta{false} otherwise. \cmddef{glsxtrifwasglslikeandfirstuse} This expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command and was the \idx{firstuse} otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. This is simply a shortcut command that uses both \gls{glsxtrifwasglslike} and \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}. \cmddef{glsxtrifwassubsequentuse} This expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command and was the \idx{subsequentuse} otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. This is simply a shortcut command that uses both \gls{glsxtrifwasglslike} and \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}. \cmddef{glsxtrifwassubsequentorshort} This expands to \meta{true} if the calling command was a \idx{glslike} command and was the \idx{subsequentuse} or if the calling command set \gls{glsxtrcurrentfield} to \code{short}. Otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. \cmddef{glsxtrifallcaps} This simply does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glscapscase}\margm{not all caps}\margm{not all caps}\margm{all caps} \end{compactcodebox} It's not usually necessary for the \idx{postlinkhook} to differentiate between no case-change and \idx+{sentencecase}, so this provides a convenient shortcut if only the \idx+{allcaps} case needs to be different. It's possible you may also want to reference the inserted material. For the \idx{glslike} commands, this can be obtained with the placeholder \gls{glsinsert}, but it's not normally set by the \idx{glstextlike} commands, which don't use the entry format style (\sectionref{sec:entryfmt}) and instead incorporate the inserted material at the end of the \idx{linktext}. If you want the \idx{postlinkhook} to be able to access the inserted material for the \idx{glstextlike} commands, you must first save it, by redefining the following: \cmddef{glsxtrsaveinsert} This is used by the \idx{glstextlike} commands to initialise \gls{glsinsert}. The default is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrsaveinsert}}[2]\marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsinsert}\marg{}} \end{compactcodebox} For example, to always save the insert: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrsaveinsert}}[2]\marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsinsert}\marg{\#2}} \end{codebox} The first argument can be used to conditionally assign the insert. For example, the following will only save it for entries with the \cat{general} category: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrsaveinsert}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\#1}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsinsert}\marg{\#2}}\marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsinsert}\marg{}}\% } \end{codebox} If you only want to save the insert for the \gls{glsxtrfull} set of commands, you can redefine \gls{glsxtrfullsaveinsert} instead (see \sectionref{sec:abbrvfieldrefs}). \cmddef{glsxtrassignlinktextfmt} This contains the assignments required to ensure that \gls{glslabel}, \gls{glstextformat} and \gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt} have the definitions they had within the \idx{linktext}. They would ordinarily still have those definitions within the \idx{postlinkhook}, but if, for example, the hook contains content that may be deferred, such as a footnote, then judicious use and expansion of \gls{glsxtrassignlinktextfmt} can allow the deferred code to pick up the label, outer and inner formatting. For example, the \idx{postlinkhook} might contain: \begin{codebox} \gls+{expandafter}\gls+{footnote}\gls{expandafter} \marg{\gls{glsxtrassignlinktextfmt}\gls{glstextformat}\marg{\% \gls{Glsaccessfmtdesc}\marg{}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgenentrytextfmt}}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}}.} \end{codebox} \subsection{Entry Format Style} \label{sec:entryfmt} \begin{information} This section is for advanced users. Minor modifications can be made by adjusting the outer formatting (\sectionref{sec:glstextformat}), the \idx{postlinkhook} (\sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}) or the abbreviation style commands (\sectionref{sec:abbrvcmds}). \end{information} The \idx{glslike} commands have the \idx{linktext} set to the entry format style corresponding to the entry's glossary \gloskey{type}. This can be changed with \gls{defglsentryfmt}, but the default style is given by \gls{glsentryfmt}, which is defined by the base \sty{glossaries} package. This uses the placeholder commands to determine the appropriate text. These are described in the \sty{glossaries} manual, but to recap they are: \gls{glslabel} (the entry's label), \gls{glscustomtext} (text provided by \gls{glsdisp} or empty otherwise), \gls{glsinsert} (supplied in the final optional argument except for \gls{glsdisp}, empty by default), \gls{glsifplural}, and \gls{glscapscase}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines \gls{glsentryfmt} to test whether or not the entry is an abbreviation and, if so, whether or not the entry should be treated as a regular entry: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsentryfmt}}\marg{\% \gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\gls{glslabel}} \marg{\gls{glssetabbrvfmt}\marg{\gls{glscategory}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}}}\marg{}\% \gls{glsifregular}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}\marg{\gls{glsgenentryfmt}}}\% \marg{\% \gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt}}}\% \marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}\marg{\gls{glsgenentryfmt}}}\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} This uses \gls{ifglshasshort} to determine whether or not the entry is an abbreviation. If it is, then \gls{glssetabbrvfmt} is used to setup the abbreviation style commands for the entry's category. Then there's a check (with \gls{glsifregular}) to determine whether or not the entry should be treated as a regular entry. Note that if the \catattr{regular} attribute hasn't been set to \code{true}, the entry will still be treated as a regular entry if it doesn't have the \gloskey{short} field set. Regular entries are formatted according to: \cmddef{glsgenentryfmt} This is the generic regular entry format. It's encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrregularfont}, but note that if the entry is an abbreviation, it will still use the abbreviation style formatting commands, which are contained within the \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{text} and \gloskey{plural} field values. The generic regular entry format \gls{glsgenentryfmt} is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package, but is redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} to support inner formatting (\sectionref{sec:innertextformat}) and accessibility (\sectionref{sec:accsupp}), if required. Abbreviations that aren't considered regular, are formatted according to: \cmddef{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt} This is the generic non-regular abbreviation format. It's encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}. Unlike \gls{glsgenentryfmt} this doesn't reference the \gloskey{first}, \gloskey{firstplural}, \gloskey{text} or \gloskey{plural} fields, but instead uses the abbreviation formatting commands \gls{glsxtrfullformat}, \gls{glsxtrsubsequentfmt} and their plural and case-changing variants. If you want to define your own custom entry format, you will need to consider whether or not your format should support regular and non-regular abbreviation styles. Further detail can be found in the documented code: \texdocref{glossaries-extra-code} \section{Hyperlinks} \label{sec:hyper} The \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands will automatically create a hyperlink by default, if \sty{hyperref} has been loaded (before \sty{glossaries}\slash \sty{glossaries-extra}). The hyperlink can be switched off with \glsoptval{hyper}{false} but will also be switched off if the entry was assigned to an \idx{ignoredglossary} that was defined with the unstarred \gls{newignoredglossary}. The \optval{hyperfirst}{false} package option and the category attributes \catattr{nohyper}, \catattr{nohyperfirst} and \catattr{nohypernext} can also be used to automatically switch off the hyperlink. See also the \glsopt{hyperoutside} option that determines whether the hyperlink should be inside or outside of the outer formatting. The hyperlink target is usually created by \gls{glstarget} which is used by all the predefined \idxpl{glossarystyle} by the standalone commands, such as \gls{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryName}. This can result in duplicate targets if you have multiple \idxpl{glossary} or both standalone entries and a \idx{glossary}. There are ways of getting around this, such as changing the target prefix or using \printglossoptval{target}{false} when displaying the \idx{glossary}. However, the simplest method is to redefine \gls{glstarget} to use: \cmddef{glsxtrtarget} This behaves in a similar manner to \gls{glstarget} but first tests the field obtained by expanding: \cmddef{glsxtrtargetfield} By default, this expands to \fieldfmt{target}. If this field is undefined (according to \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldUndef}) the target will be created in the way that \gls{glstarget} would ordinarily create it (if hyperlinks are enabled). The field will then be set to the target. If the field has been defined then the target won't be created and the \meta{text} is simply displayed. In order to use this feature just redefine \gls{glstarget}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstarget}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrtarget}} \end{codebox} The target for an entry with the label \meta{entry-label} is in the form \meta{prefix}\meta{entry-label}. The \meta{prefix} is normally \gls{glolinkprefix} but may be changed with the \printglossopt{prefix} option when displaying the \idx{glossary}. The target can also be changed to a link to an external file with the \catattr{targeturl} category attribute. \section{Label Prefixes} \label{sec:labelprefixes} It's possible that you may want to prefix labels to ensure uniqueness. For example, this manual references both the \gls{makeglossaries} command and the \app{makeglossaries} Perl script. They are both defined as \idx{glossary} entries, but they can't both have the label \code{makeglossaries}. This manual uses \app{bib2gls} and is quite complicated, but a simplified version is as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{csfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{texttt}\marg{\glsbackslash\#1}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{appfmt}}[1]\marg{\cmd{texttt}\marg{\#1}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cs.makeglossaries}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{csfmt}\marg{makeglossaries}}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{app.makeglossaries}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{appfmt}\marg{makeglossaries}}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \end{codebox} So the label \code{cs.makeglossaries} refers to \gls{makeglossaries} and \code{app.makeglossaries} refers to \app{makeglossaries}. If you have a lot of prefixes like this, you may prefer to have a command that automatically adds the prefix. For example, \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{cs}}[2][]\marg{\gls{gls}\oarg{\#1}\marg{cs.\#2}} \end{codebox} The problem with this is that the custom command \csfmt{cs} doesn't allow for the \cmdmod{star}, \cmdmod{plus} and \cmdmod{alt-mod} modifiers (such as \code{\gls{gls}*} or \code{\gls{gls}+}). Instead you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrnewgls} which defines the command \begin{compactcodebox} \meta{cs}\meta{modifier}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\oargm{insert} \end{compactcodebox} that behaves like \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{gls}\meta{modifier}\oarg{\meta{default options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{entry-label}}\oargm{insert} \end{compactcodebox} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrnewgls}\marg{cs.}\marg{\cmd{cs}} \end{codebox} or (to default to no hyperlinks) \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrnewgls}\oarg{\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{sym.}\marg{\cmd{cs}} \end{codebox} now you can use \code{\cmd{cs}+\marg{M}} to behave like \code{\gls{gls}+\marg{cs.M}}. If you also want the plural and \idx{sentencecase} versions you can use \cmddef{glsxtrnewglslike} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrnewglslike}\oarg{\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{idx.}\marg{\cmd{idx}}\marg{\cmd{idxpl}}\marg{\cmd{Idx}}\marg{\cmd{Idxpl}} \end{codebox} For the \idx{allcaps} versions: \cmddef{glsxtrnewGLSlike} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrnewGLSlike}\oarg{\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{idx.}\marg{\cmd{IDX}}\marg{\cmd{IDXpl}} \end{codebox} For commands that require the link text to be specified, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrnewglslink} which defines \code{\meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{label}\margm{text}} to behave like \code{\gls{glslink}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{label}}\margm{text}}, or \cmddef{glsxtrnewglsdisp} which defines \code{\meta{cs}\oargm{options}\margm{label}\margm{text}} to behave like \code{\gls{glsdisp}\oarg{\meta{default-options},\meta{options}}\marg{\meta{prefix}\meta{label}}\margm{text}}. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, it can pick up the custom commands that are defined using the above, so it can detect dependencies when it parses fields such as \gloskey{description}. If you provide your own custom command with just \gls{newcommand} that has syntax that starts with \oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}, then you can notify \app{bib2gls} using: \cmddef{glsxtridentifyglslike} where \meta{label-prefix} is the prefix to apply to the label that's passed to the command \meta{cs}. The information is written to the \ext{aux} file so that \app{bib2gls} can add the given command to those it looks for when searching for dependencies. Another possibility when using \app{bib2gls} is to set up known label prefixes, see \sectionref{sec:dgls} for further details. If you use \app{bib2gls} with record counting, there are commands to \gls{glsxtrnewgls} for \gls{rgls}: \cmddef{glsxtrnewrgls} and for \gls{rgls}, \gls{rglspl}, \gls{rGls} and \gls{rGlspl}: \cmddef{glsxtrnewrglslike} and for \idx{allcaps}: \cmddef{glsxtrnewrGLSlike} Defining commands in this manner (rather than simply using \csfmt{newcommand}) also allows the command to be identified as a \idx{sentencecase} blocker to prevent the label from being converted or, in the case of \gls{glsxtrnewglslike} and \gls{glsxtrnewrglslike}, as a mapping. See \sectionref{sec:casechange} for further details. \section{Indexing} \label{sec:wrglossary} \Idx{indexing} is normally performed implicitly by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands, but this action can be prevented, such as by using the option \glsoptval{noindex}{true}. These commands also generate text (the \idx{linktext}, \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}). If you want to simply index an entry (to ensure that an entry is shown in the \idx{glossary}) without producing any text then you can use \gls{glsadd}. \Idx{indexing} is also performed by cross-referencing commands, such as \gls{glssee}. In the case of \app{makeindex}, \gls{glssee} simply behaves like \gls{glsadd} with a special format and the \location\ set to Z (which pushes it to the end of the \idx{locationlist}). Entries in \idxpl{ignoredglossary} can only be \indexed\ with \app{bib2gls}. If you want \emph{all} defined entries to appear in the \idx{glossary}, regardless of whether or not they have been used in the document, then you can use \gls{glsaddall} or \gls{glsaddallunused} (both provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package). These both iterate over all entries (in all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary}). In the first case (\gls{glsaddall}), every entry is \indexed\ with the \gls{glsadd} options provided in the optional argument of \gls{glsaddall}. In the second case (\gls{glsaddallunused}), only those entries that haven't been marked as \idxc{firstuseflag}{used} so far will be indexed using \code{\gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore}}\margm{label}}. See the \sty{glossaries} manual for further details of those commands. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a similar command: \cmddef{glsaddallunindexed} This is like \gls{glsaddallunused} but indexes all entries that haven't been \indexed\ so far (again using the option \glsoptval{format}{glsignore}). This is preferable to \gls{glsaddallunused} if you have to reset the \idx{firstuseflag} for any entries. As with \gls{glsaddallunused}, if this command is required, it should be placed near the end of the document. Indexing any entries after either of these commands are used will cause spurious commas in the \idxpl{locationlist}. \begin{important} Iterative commands such as \gls{glsaddall}, \gls{glsaddallunused} and \gls{glsaddallunindexed} should not be used with \app{bib2gls}. Use the \resourceoptval{selection}{all} option instead. \end{important} If you want to index a specific subset of entries, rather than all entries for a given glossary, you can use: \cmddef{glsaddeach} This does \code{\gls{glsadd}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}} for each entry in the comma-separated \meta{entry label list}. This command may be used with \app{bib2gls}, although it may be simpler to adjust the selection criteria or use filtering. Explicit ranges can be formed by including \idx{sym.startrange} and \idx{sym.endrange} at the start of the \glsopt{format} value. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}}}\marg{example} \ldots \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{endrange}}}\marg{example} \end{codebox} (See the \sty{glossaries} manual for further details.) However, the isolated open and close parentheses can upset syntax highlighting. So the \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides the following commands, which automatically add \sym{startrange} and \sym{endrange}. \cmddef{glsstartrange} This effectively does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsaddeach}\oarg{\meta{options},\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}\meta{encap}}}\margm{entry-label list} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glsendrange} This effectively does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsaddeach}\oarg{\meta{options},\glsoptval{format}{\sym{endrange}\meta{encap}}}\margm{entry-label list} \end{compactcodebox} The default value of \meta{encap} will be the same as the default number format (which can be changed with \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat}). If you want a different default for ranges, use: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetDefaultRangeFormat} This sets the default format for \gls{glsstartrange} and \gls{glsendrange}. Note that this format won't be applied if you explicitly create a range with \gls{glsadd} or \gls{glsaddeach}. Alternatively, you can use \glsoptval{format}{encap} in \meta{options}, but remember that this will need to be the same in both \gls{glsstartrange} and \gls{glsendrange}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsstartrange}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\encap{hyperbf}}}\marg{example} \ldots \gls{glsendrange}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\encap{hyperbf}}}\marg{example} \end{codebox} This is the same as: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultRangeFormat}\marg{\encap{hyperbf}} \gls{glsstartrange}\marg{example} \ldots \gls{glsendrange}\marg{example} \end{codebox} which is the same as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}\encap{hyperbf}}}\marg{example} \ldots \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{endrange}\encap{hyperbf}}}\marg{example} \end{codebox} The mandatory argument of \gls{glsstartrange} and \gls{glsendrange} may be a comma-separated list of entry labels. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsstartrange}\marg{duck,goose} \ldots \gls{glsendrange}\marg{duck,goose} \end{codebox} This is essentially the same as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}}}\marg{duck}\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{startrange}}}\marg{goose} \ldots \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{endrange}}}\marg{duck}\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{\sym{endrange}}}\marg{goose} \end{codebox} \cmddef{GlsXtrAutoAddOnFormat} This will make the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands automatically use \code{\gls{glsadd}\oargm{gls\-add options}\margm{entry-label}} whenever a \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} command is used for the entry given by \meta{entry-label} when the \glsopt{format} matches one of the formats in the comma-separated \meta{format list} The optional argument \meta{label} defaults to \gls{glslabel} (which will match \meta{entry-label} that was used with \gls{gls} etc) and indicates the entry label to use in \gls{glsadd} and so needs to be expandable. The \meta{format list} is a comma-separated list of format values that will trigger the automated adding. The \meta{glsadd options} are the options to pass to \gls{glsadd} with \glsoptval{format}{\marg{format}} prepended to the list. For example, with: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrAutoAddOnFormat}\marg{hyperbf}\marg{\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}} \end{codebox} then \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf}}\marg{sample}} will be equivalent to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf},\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}}\marg{sample}\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf}}\marg{sample} \end{compactcodebox} Note that the explicit range markers will prevent a match unless you include them in \meta{format list} (in which case, be sure to add both the start and end formats). Here's another example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrAutoAddOnFormat}\oarg{dual.\gls{glslabel}}\marg{hyperbf}\marg{} \end{codebox} In this case \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf}}\marg{sample}} will now be equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf}}\marg{dual.sample}\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{hyperbf}}\marg{sample} \end{codebox} \begin{important} \gls{GlsXtrAutoAddOnFormat} is not applied to \gls{glsadd} as it could cause an infinite loop. \end{important} In the context of \sty{glossaries} and \sty{glossaries-extra}, \idx{indexing} refers to the mechanism used to ensure that an entry is included in its associated glossary. (If you also want to use \gls{index}, see \sectionref{sec:autoindex}.) This includes any entries that simply cross-reference another entry. The default is to use \app{makeindex}, which is a general purpose \idx{indexingapp}. Each time an entry is \indexed, a line is added to an associated file that contains the \idx{indexing} information, which includes the sort value, the \idxc{hierarchicallevel}{hierarchical information} (if the entry has a parent) and an associated \location\ (the page number, by default). This information is used to sort the entries and collate the \locations\ into a compact \idx{locationlist}. The \opt{xindy} package option switches to using \app{xindy} syntax, but the process is much the same. Since both \app+{makeindex} and \app+{xindy} are general purpose \idxpl{indexingapp} they require an associated \location\ (or a cross-reference) since indexes are typically used to lookup the \locations\ in the document where the term occurs. Although \idxpl{glossary} are similar to indexes they can simply be used to provide brief summaries of each term without any \locations. The way that \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy} work means that valid \locations\ (that is, \locations\ that conform to \app{makeindex}\slash\app{xindy} syntax) must be supplied even if no \idx{locationlist} is required. If an invalid \location\ is used, an error will occur during the \app{makeindex}\slash\app{xindy} step in the build process, even if the \location\ will eventually be ignored when typesetting the \idx{glossary}. All \idxpl{locationlist} can be suppressed with the \opt{nonumberlist} option (which simply discards the \idx{locationlist} for each entry), but there are occasions where only some \locations\ need to be suppressed. The main way of hiding a \location\ is to encapsulate the \location\ with a command that does nothing. The \gls{glsignore} command is used for this purpose (\glsoptval{format}{glsignore}). However, it's important to remember that even though the \location\ isn't shown, it's still present in the \idx{locationlist}. This means that you will end up with spurious commas if there's more than one item in the \idx{locationlist}. The \qt{noidx} method similarly writes indexing information, but in this case the information is written to the \ext{aux} file. Again, empty locations can cause spurious commas in the \idxpl{locationlist}. The only method that recognises \gls{glsignore} as a special \qt{\idx{ignoredlocation}} is \app{bib2gls}, where this format will trigger the entry's selection but won't add the \idx{ignoredlocation} to the \idx{locationlist}. This avoids the problem of spurious commas caused by invisible locations. The \location\ corresponds to a counter. The default is the \ctr{page} counter, but may be changed with the \opt{counter} package option, the \meta{counter} optional argument of \gls{newglossary}, the \gloskey{counter} key when defining an entry, or the \glsopt{counter} option when \idx{indexing} an entry. Note that \app{bib2gls} v3.0+ converts an empty \location\ (which can occur when the \idx{locationcounter} is 0 and should be formatted as a Roman numeral) to an \idx{ignoredlocation}. For example, if you use \optval{counter}{\ctr{part}} but have \gls{gls} before the first \gls{part}. An empty \location\ will trigger an error with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}. \begin{warning} Since no entries are defined on the first \LaTeX\ run with \app{bib2gls}, there's no way of determining the entry's \idx{glossary} \gloskey{type} or of finding if the entry's \gloskey{counter} key has been set. This means that if the counter has been assigned to either the entry's \idx{glossary} or to the entry itself, the \idx{locationcounter} can't be implemented until the entry has been defined. A second build is required to ensure that the \locations\ use the correct counter. \end{warning} The \idx{locationcounter} must expand to syntax that's recognised by the \idx{indexingapp}. This is very restrictive with \app{makeindex}, which only recognises Western Arabic (\gls{arabic}), \idx{lowercase} Roman numerals (\gls{roman}), \idx{uppercase} Roman numerals (\gls{Roman}), \idx{lowercase} Basic Latin (\gls{alph}) and \idx{uppercase} Basic Latin (\gls{Alph}), with optionally a separator (hyphen by default). With \app{xindy}, the syntax must be defined (see the \sty{glossaries} manual for further details). There's no restriction on the location syntax with \app{bib2gls}. The only limitation is that if \app{bib2gls} can't determine an associated numeric value according to its location parser, it won't form ranges. This means that with \app{bib2gls}, you can set arbitrary text as the \location\ (that's not related to a counter) with \glsopt{thevalue}. You can also use \glsopt{thevalue} with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, but only if the value matches the required \location\ syntax. Both \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy} order the \locations\ in the \idxpl{locationlist}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{Z}}\marg{sample} (Z), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{4}}\marg{sample} (4), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{xi}}\marg{sample} (xi), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{2}}\marg{sample} (2), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{iii}}\marg{sample} (iii), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{A}}\marg{sample} (A). \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:mkidxloclistorder}, title={Location list ordering (\appfmt{makeindex})}, description={Example document with contrived locations that result in an ordered location list consisting of iii, xi, 2, 4, A, Z}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} } {% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=Z}\marg{sample} (Z), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=4}\marg{sample} (4),^^J% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=xi}\marg{sample} (xi), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=2}\marg{sample} (2),^^J% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=iii}\marg{sample} (iii), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=A}\marg{sample} (A).^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} With \app{makeindex}, the \idx{locationlist} is grouped into the different number formats (\gls{roman}, \gls{arabic} and \gls{Alph}), with each group ordered numerically. The same result can be produced with \app{xindy} by adding the \opt{xindy} package option to the above example. With \app{bib2gls}, the \idx{locationlist} is always in order of \idx{indexing}. The above example document can be converted to use \app{bib2gls} as follows: \begin{codebox} \cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\cmd{jobname}.bib} \atentry{entry}\marg{sample,\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cend{filecontents*} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{record}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{Z}}\marg{sample} (Z), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{4}}\marg{sample} (4), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{xi}}\marg{sample} (xi), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{2}}\marg{sample} (2), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{iii}}\marg{sample} (iii), \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{thevalue}{A}}\marg{sample} (A). \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:b2gloclistorder}, title={Location list ordering (\appfmt{bib2gls})}, description={Example document with contrived locations that result in a location list consisting of Z, 4, xi, 2, ii, A, which corresponds to the record order}] {% \cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% @entry\marg{sample,name=\marg{sample},description=\marg{an example}}^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[record]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} } {% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=Z}\marg{sample} (Z), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=4}\marg{sample} (4),^^J% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=xi}\marg{sample} (xi), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=2}\marg{sample} (2),^^J% \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=iii}\marg{sample} (iii), \gls{gls}\oarg{thevalue=A}\marg{sample} (A).^^J% \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This example is contrived. For most documents, the order of \idx{indexing} will likely match the desired \idx{locationlist} order. Another important difference between \app{bib2gls} and the other indexing methods is the treatment of cross-references identified by the cross-reference keys \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias}. With \app{bib2gls}, the cross-referencing information is picked up when \app{bib2gls} parses the \ext{bib} file and is used to establish dependencies, which ensures that when entries with cross-references are selected, their cross-referenced entries will also be selected. With the other methods, cross-references are added to an entry's \idx{locationlist} by \idx{indexing} the entry with a special format. The \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias} keys automatically trigger this \idx{indexing} unless \optval{autoseeindex}{false}. See \sectionref{sec:xr} for further details. Every time an entry is \indexed, the following hook is also used: \cmddef{glsxtrdowrglossaryhook} This does nothing by default. The argument is the entry's label. The \idx{indexing} code is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsencapwrcontent} This adds grouping, which helps to prevent spacing issues caused by the \idx{whatsit} that's created by the \idx{indexing}. The base \sty{glossaries} package always performs the \idx{indexing} before the \idx{linktext} for the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This means that if a page break occurs in the middle of the \idx{linktext}, the \location\ will refer to the page number at the start of the \idx{linktext} (assuming the default \ctr{page} \idx{locationcounter}). With \sty{glossaries-extra}, you can use the option \glsoptval{wrgloss}{after} to have the \idx{indexing} occur after the \idx{linktext}. The \catattr{wrgloss} attribute can also be used. The default setting is initialised with \gls{glsxtrinitwrgloss} (see \sectionref{sec:defaultglsopts}). Every time an entry is \indexed, an \idx{internalfield} associated with the entry's label is globally updated to keep a count of the number of times the entry has been \indexed. The value can be accessed with: \cmddef{glsentryindexcount} This command will expand to 0 if the entry hasn't been \indexed\ or hasn't been defined. To test if the value is greater than 0 (that is, to test if the entry has been \indexed\ yet), use: \cmddef{glsifindexed} This expands to \meta{true} if the entry is defined and has been \indexed, otherwise it expands to \meta{false}. No warning or error occurs if the entry hasn't been defined. Note that the index count is a running total. This is not the same as the \record\ count saved by \app{bib2gls}['s] \switch{record-count} switch, which represents the total number of \records\ for the given entry from the previous \LaTeX\ run. The base \sty{glossaries} package defines: \cmddef{glswriteentry} This command conditionally writes the indexing code (supplied by the second argument \meta{code}). The original definition simply tests whether or not the \opt{indexonlyfirst} setting is on. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines this command to perform additional checks to determine whether or not the \idx{indexing} code should be performed. The modified definition uses: \cmddef{glsxtrifindexing} to test the \glsopt{noindex} setting. This does \meta{false} if \glsoptval{noindex}{true}, otherwise it does \meta{true}. \cmddef{ifglsindexonlyfirst} This is a conditional that corresponds to the \opt{indexonlyfirst} package option. \Idx{firstuse} is tested using \gls{GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} rather than \gls{ifglsused}. The \catattr{indexonlyfirst} attribute is also tested. If the \qt{index only first} setting is on and the entry has been \idxc{firstuseflag}{used}, \meta{code} isn't performed but auto-indexing via \gls{glsxtrdoautoindexname} is still performed (see \sectionref{sec:autoindex}). \begin{warning} Since no entries are defined on the first \LaTeX\ run with \app{bib2gls}, there's no way of keeping track of whether or not an entry has been used or what its \gloskey{category} is, which is required to query the \catattr{indexonlyfirst} attribute, so for the first document build all instances will be \indexed. A second build is required for the \qt{index only first} feature. \end{warning} \section{Cross-Referencing} \label{sec:xr} The base \sty{glossaries} package only provides the \gloskey{see} key, which automatically \idxc{indexing}{indexes} the cross-reference using \gls{glssee}. The value of this key isn't saved and can't be accessed later. (The key was simply provided as a shortcut.) The \idx{indexing} ensures that the cross-reference is shown in the \idx{locationlist}. \begin{important} The auto-indexing feature of the \gloskey{see} key was intended as a shortcut where only entries required in the document are defined. If you want to have a large file containing entries that may or may not be required in the document, then using \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} or \gloskey{alias} can cause unwanted entries to appear in the glossary. In this case, see \sectionref{sec:seenoindex}. \end{important} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package saves the value of the \gloskey{see} key and additionally provides the \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias} keys that perform similar functions. The values of the \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias} keys can all be accessed at a later point in the document. If an entry with a cross-reference has been included in the glossary, there's no guarantee that the cross-referenced entry will also be included. It won't be included if it hasn't been indexed anywhere in the document. You can use the \opt{indexcrossrefs} package option to search for cross-references that require \idx{indexing} at the end of the document, but note that this can be time-consuming if you have a large number of entries. \begin{information} With \app{bib2gls} you can simply change the selection criteria (\resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see} or \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see not also}) to ensure that all cross-referenced entries are included even if they haven't been \indexed\ in the document. \end{information} Example (\gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso} keys): \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pumpkin}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pumpkin},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cucumber}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cucumber},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{melon}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{melon},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gourd}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gourd},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{pumpkin,cucumber,melon}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{marrow}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{marrow},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{courgette}} \end{codebox} When the \code{gourd} entry is defined, the cross-reference will automatically be \indexed\ using \gls{glssee}. This means that the \code{gourd} entry will appear in the glossary, regardless of whether or not it is used in the document, with \qt{\emph{see} pumpkin, cucumber \& melon} in the \idx{locationlist}. If \code{gourd} is also \indexed\ in the document, then those \locations\ will also be added to the gourd's \idx{locationlist}. The cross-referenced entries (pumpkin, cucumber and melon) will only appear in the glossary if they are also \indexed\ in the document. This can be implemented automatically with \opt{indexcrossrefs}. The \gloskey{seealso} key in the \code{marrow} entry functions in much the same way, but it is \indexed\ with \gls{glsxtrindexseealso}. This means that the \code{marrow} entry will have \qt{\emph{see also} courgette} in its \idx{locationlist}. The \gloskey{see} key may optionally start with \oargm{tag} to replace the default \gls{seename} tag with \meta{tag}. The \gloskey{seealso} key doesn't permit this. For example, the following is permitted: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gourd}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gourd},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{[related topics]pumpkin,cucumber,melon}} \end{codebox} but you can't replace \gloskey{see} with \gloskey{seealso} in the above as it would assume that the first label in the list is \code{[related topics]pumpkin} which is incorrect. The tag would have to be removed: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gourd}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gourd},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{pumpkin,cucumber,melon}} \end{codebox} (You could then redefine \gls{seealsoname} to \code{related topics}, if required or redefine \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat} as applicable.) Example (\gloskey{alias} key): \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zucchini}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zucchini},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{alias}{courgette}} \end{codebox} When the \code{zucchini} entry is defined, the \gloskey{alias} key will automatically \idxc{indexing}{index} zucchini with \code{\gls{glssee}\marg{zucchini}\marg{courgette}}. This means that the \code{zucchini} entry will be present in the glossary with \qt{\emph{see} courgette} in the \idx{locationlist}. If the \code{zucchini} entry is referenced in the document using a command like \gls{gls}, then the hyperlink (if enabled) will go to the \code{courgette} entry (not the \code{zucchini} entry) but the \code{zucchini} entry won't be indexed. If you want the \code{zucchini} entry \locations\ added to the \code{courgette} entry, you can redefine \gls{glsxtrsetaliasnoindex} (see \sectionref{sec:glssee}) or, with \app{bib2gls}, use the \resourceoptval{alias-loc}{transfer} setting. \begin{information} With \app{bib2gls}, cross-references are selected according to the \resourceopt{selection} criteria. See the \app{bib2gls} manual for further details. \end{information} \subsection{Entries that may not be required} \label{sec:seenoindex} If you have a file containing a large number of entry definitions shared across multiple documents, then the use of the \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} or \gloskey{alias} key can cause unwanted entries to appear in the document. This can be demonstrated as follows. Suppose the file \filefmt{myentries.tex} contains: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pumpkin}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pumpkin},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cucumber}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cucumber},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{melon}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{melon},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gourd}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gourd},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{pumpkin,cucumber,melon}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cucurbit}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cucurbit},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{gourd}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{marrow}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{marrow},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{courgette}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zucchini}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zucchini},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{alias}{courgette}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{broccoli}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{broccoli},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cauliflower}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cauliflower},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{broccoli}} \end{codebox} Some of these entries have a cross-reference key set, but not all of these entries are required in the document: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}} \marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{loadglsentries}\marg{myentries} \cbeg{document} This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:autoseeindextrue}, title={Cross-references (\optfmt{autoseeindex\dequals true})}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields with the default auto-indexing of the cross-referenced terms}] {% \usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}^^J% \usepackage[nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]^^J% {glossaries-extra}^^J% \makeglossaries^^J% \newglossaryentry{pumpkin}{name={pumpkin},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucumber}{name={cucumber},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{melon}{name={melon},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{gourd}{name={gourd},description={},^^J% see={pumpkin,cucumber,melon}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucurbit}{name={cucurbit},description={},^^J% see={gourd}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{courgette}{name={courgette},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{marrow}{name={marrow},description={},^^J% seealso={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{zucchini}{name={zucchini},description={},^^J% alias={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{broccoli}{name={broccoli},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cauliflower}{name={cauliflower},description={}, seealso={broccoli}}^^J% } { This document is only discussing \glspl{courgette} (baby \glspl{marrow}, also called a \gls{zucchini}), \glspl{pumpkin} and \glspl{melon}.^^J% \printglossaries } \end{resultbox} Note that the glossary includes cucurbit and gourd, which aren't referenced in the document. They could be useful as a redirect for the reader, but the gourd entry cross-references the cucumber entry, which isn't included in the glossary, so the hyperlink target is undefined. The cauliflower entry has also been included in the glossary, but in this case it's not useful for the reader as neither cauliflower nor broccoli (which it cross-references) are mentioned in the document. As with the cucumber cross-reference, the broccoli cross-reference hyperlink target is undefined. There are a number of methods to address some of these problems. The first method has the cross-referencing keys in the \ext{tex} file (as above), but disables the auto-indexing: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{autoseeindex}{false},\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex}, \optval{style}{bookindex}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{loadglsentries}\marg{myentries} \cbeg{document} This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:autoseeindexfalse}, title={Cross-references (\optfmt{autoseeindex\dequals false})}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields without the auto-indexing of the cross-referenced terms}] {% \usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}^^J% \usepackage[autoseeindex=false,nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]^^J% {glossaries-extra}^^J% \makeglossaries^^J% \newglossaryentry{pumpkin}{name={pumpkin},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucumber}{name={cucumber},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{melon}{name={melon},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{gourd}{name={gourd},description={},^^J% see={pumpkin,cucumber,melon}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucurbit}{name={cucurbit},description={},^^J% see={gourd}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{courgette}{name={courgette},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{marrow}{name={marrow},description={},^^J% seealso={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{zucchini}{name={zucchini},description={},^^J% alias={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{broccoli}{name={broccoli},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cauliflower}{name={cauliflower},description={}, seealso={broccoli}}^^J% } { This document is only discussing \glspl{courgette} (baby \glspl{marrow}, also called a \gls{zucchini}), \glspl{pumpkin} and \glspl{melon}.^^J% \printglossaries } \end{resultbox} This doesn't show the zucchini entry or any of the cross-references in the \idx{glossary} because the information hasn't been added to the \idx{indexing} files. One way around this is to insert the cross-reference in a \idx{postdeschook}. \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{autoseeindex}{false},\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex}, \optval{style}{bookindex}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{loadglsentries}\marg{myentries} \gls{glsdefpostdesc}\marg{general}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrseelists}\marg{\gls{glscurrententrylabel}}\comment{} } \cbeg{document} This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:autoseeindexfalsepostname}, title={Cross-references (\optfmt{autoseeindex\dequals false} and post-name hook)}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields without the auto-indexing of the cross-referenced terms but using the post-name hook}] {% \usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}^^J% \usepackage[autoseeindex=false,nostyles,^^J% stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]{glossaries-extra}^^J% \makeglossaries^^J% \newglossaryentry{pumpkin}{name={pumpkin},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucumber}{name={cucumber},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{melon}{name={melon},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{gourd}{name={gourd},description={},^^J% see={pumpkin,cucumber,melon}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucurbit}{name={cucurbit},description={},^^J% see={gourd}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{courgette}{name={courgette},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{marrow}{name={marrow},description={},^^J% seealso={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{zucchini}{name={zucchini},description={},^^J% alias={courgette}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{broccoli}{name={broccoli},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cauliflower}{name={cauliflower},description={}, seealso={broccoli}}^^J% \glsdefpostname{general}{\glsxtrseelists{\glscurrententrylabel}}^^J% } { This document is only discussing \glspl{courgette} (baby \glspl{marrow}, also called a \gls{zucchini}), \glspl{pumpkin} and \glspl{melon}.^^J% \printglossaries^^J% } \end{resultbox} However, this still doesn't solve the problem that the zucchini entry isn't included in the glossary. It needs to be indexed, but \idx{indexing} has been suppressed. Firstly, because the automatic \idx{indexing} triggered by the \gloskey{alias} key has been suppressed with \optval{autoseeindex}{false}, and, secondly, because the presence of the \gloskey{alias} key automatically suppresses \idx{indexing} with the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This doesn't cause a problem for the zucchini hyperlink, since the target is courgette (obtained from the \gloskey{alias} key). The second method is to not use those keys in the entry definitions and use \gls{glssee} or \gls{glsxtrindexseealso} within the document. For example, the file \filefmt{myentries.tex} now contains: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pumpkin}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pumpkin},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cucumber}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cucumber},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{melon}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{melon},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gourd}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gourd},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cucurbit}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cucurbit},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{courgette}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{courgette},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{marrow}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{marrow},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zucchini}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zucchini},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{broccoli}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{broccoli},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cauliflower}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{cauliflower},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \end{codebox} The document: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}] \marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{loadglsentries}\marg{myentries} \gls{glssee}\marg{gourd}\marg{pumpkin,melon,courgette} \gls{glssee}\marg{zucchini}\marg{courgette} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{zucchini}\marg{alias}\marg{courgette} \cbeg{document} This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:noxrfields}, title={Cross-references (no \optfmt{see}, \optfmt{seealso} or \optfmt{alias})}, description={Example document illustrating cross-references without using the see, seealso or alias keys} ] {% \usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}^^J% \usepackage[nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]{glossaries-extra}^^J% \makeglossaries^^J% \newglossaryentry{pumpkin}{name={pumpkin},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucumber}{name={cucumber},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{melon}{name={melon},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{gourd}{name={gourd},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cucurbit}{name={cucurbit},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{courgette}{name={courgette},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{marrow}{name={marrow},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{zucchini}{name={zucchini},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{broccoli}{name={broccoli},description={}}^^J% \newglossaryentry{cauliflower}{name={cauliflower},description={}}^^J% \glssee{gourd}{pumpkin,melon,courgette}^^J% \glssee{zucchini}{courgette}^^J% \GlsXtrSetField{zucchini}{alias}{courgette}^^J% } { This document is only discussing \glspl{courgette} (baby \glspl{marrow}, also called a \gls{zucchini}), \glspl{pumpkin} and \glspl{melon}.^^J% \printglossaries } \end{resultbox} Note that aliases require the \gloskey{alias} field to be set. In this case, I've set it with \gls{GlsXtrSetField}. The gourd and zucchini entries have been included in the glossary because they were added with \gls{glssee}. The other entries are in the glossary because they were indexed when referenced with \gls{gls} or \gls{glspl}. Since cucumber isn't required in the document, I haven't included it in the cross-reference list for gourd. This method is flexible as it allows the cross-referencing to vary between documents. For example, another document may instead have: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrindexseealso}\marg{pumpkin}\marg{courgette,melon} \gls{glsxtrindexseealso}\marg{melon}\marg{pumpkin,courgette} \gls{glsxtrindexseealso}\marg{courgette}\marg{pumpkin,melon} \end{codebox} The third method is to switch to \app{bib2gls}. The file \filefmt{myentries.tex} can be converted to \filefmt{myentries.bib} using: \begin{terminal} \app{convertgls2bib} \switch{index-conversion} myentries.tex myentries.bib \end{terminal} I've used the option \switch{index-conversion} (or \switch{i}) which will use \atentry{index} instead of \atentry{entry} for entries that have an empty description (which is the case in this example). This creates the file \filefmt{myentries.bib}, which contains the following (space compacted): \begin{codebox} \comment{Encoding: UTF-8} @index\marg{pumpkin, \gloskeyval{name}{pumpkin}} @index\marg{cucumber, \gloskeyval{name}{cucumber}} @index\marg{melon, \gloskeyval{name}{melon}} @index\marg{gourd, \gloskeyval{see}{pumpkin,cucumber,melon}, \gloskeyval{name}{gourd}} @index\marg{cucurbit, \gloskeyval{see}{gourd}, \gloskeyval{name}{cucurbit}} @index\marg{courgette, \gloskeyval{name}{courgette}} @index\marg{marrow, \gloskeyval{name}{marrow}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{courgette}} @index\marg{zucchini, \gloskeyval{name}{zucchini}, \gloskeyval{alias}{courgette}} @index\marg{broccoli, \gloskeyval{name}{broccoli}} @index\marg{cauliflower, \gloskeyval{name}{cauliflower}, \gloskeyval{seealso}{broccoli}} \end{codebox} The earlier example~\ref{ex:autoseeindextrue} on page~\pageref{ex:autoseeindextrue} can be rewritten as: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}} \marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{myentries}} \cbeg{document} This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} In order to support letter \idxpl{group}, \app{bib2gls} needs to be invoked with the \switch{group} switch. The result is: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:recordedanddeps}, title={Cross-references (\appfmt{bib2gls})}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields with bib2gls and selection=recorded and deps}] {% \cbeg{filecontents*}{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% \% Encoding: UTF-8^^J% @index{pumpkin, name = {pumpkin}}^^J% @index{cucumber, name = {cucumber}}^^J% @index{melon, name = {melon}}^^J% @index{gourd, see = {pumpkin,cucumber,melon}, name = {gourd}}^^J% @index{cucurbit, see = {gourd}, name = {cucurbit}}^^J% @index{courgette, name = {courgette}}^^J% @index{marrow, name = {marrow}, seealso = {courgette}}^^J% @index{zucchini, name = {zucchini}, alias = {courgette}}^^J% @index{broccoli, name = {broccoli}}^^J% @index{cauliflower, name = {cauliflower}, seealso = {broccoli} }^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=\cmd{jobname}} } { This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This uses the default \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps}, which selects entries that have \records, and their dependencies. Records correspond to the usual indexing performed by the \idx{glslike}, \idx{glstextlike} or \idx{glsadd} commands. With \app{bib2gls}, the cross-referencing fields don't trigger an index but identify dependencies. Note that the above doesn't include the gourd entry (which cross-references entries that have been indexed). The selection criteria can be changed to also include unrecorded entries that cross-reference selected entries. There are two options to choose from: \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see}, which will apply to all cross-reference fields (\gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias}, or \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see not also}, which doesn't consider the \gloskey{seealso} field. Changing the \idxpl!{resourceopt} in the above example to: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{myentries}, \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see}} \end{codebox} results in: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:recordedanddepsandsee}, title={Cross-references (\appfmt{bib2gls} and \optfmt{selection\dequals recorded and deps and see})}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields with bib2gls and selection=recorded and deps and see}] {% \cbeg{filecontents*}{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% \% Encoding: UTF-8^^J% @index{pumpkin, name = {pumpkin}}^^J% @index{cucumber, name = {cucumber}}^^J% @index{melon, name = {melon}}^^J% @index{gourd, see = {pumpkin,cucumber,melon}, name = {gourd}}^^J% @index{cucurbit, see = {gourd}, name = {cucurbit}}^^J% @index{courgette, name = {courgette}}^^J% @index{marrow, name = {marrow}, seealso = {courgette}}^^J% @index{zucchini, name = {zucchini}, alias = {courgette}}^^J% @index{broccoli, name = {broccoli}}^^J% @index{cauliflower, name = {cauliflower}, seealso = {broccoli} }^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=\cmd{jobname},selection={recorded and deps and see}} } { This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This now includes the gourd entry because it cross-references pumpkin and melon, which have been \recorded\ in the document. The cucurbit entry is also included because it cross-references the (now selected) gourd entry. Note that the cucumber entry has been selected because the gourd entry depends on it. This means there are no broken links in the glossary, but it looks a bit odd as the cucumber entry has no \idx{locationlist}. As from \app{bib2gls} v3.0, this can be removed with one of the cross-reference pruning options, such as \resourceopt{prune-xr}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{myentries}, \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see},\resourceopt{prune-xr}} \end{codebox} results in: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:recordedanddepsandseeprune}, title={Cross-references (\appfmt{bib2gls} and \optfmt{selection\dequals recorded and deps and see}, \optfmt{prune-xr})}, description={Example document illustrating the cross-referencing fields with bib2gls and selection=recorded and deps and see and pruning}] {% \cbeg{filecontents*}{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% \% Encoding: UTF-8^^J% @index{pumpkin, name = {pumpkin}}^^J% @index{cucumber, name = {cucumber}}^^J% @index{melon, name = {melon}}^^J% @index{gourd, see = {pumpkin,cucumber,melon}, name = {gourd}}^^J% @index{cucurbit, see = {gourd}, name = {cucurbit}}^^J% @index{courgette, name = {courgette}}^^J% @index{marrow, name = {marrow}, seealso = {courgette}}^^J% @index{zucchini, name = {zucchini}, alias = {courgette}}^^J% @index{broccoli, name = {broccoli}}^^J% @index{cauliflower, name = {cauliflower}, seealso = {broccoli} }^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=\cmd{jobname},selection={recorded and deps and see},prune-xr} } { This document is only discussing \gls{glspl}\marg{courgette} (baby \gls{glspl}\marg{marrow}, also called a \gls{gls}\marg{zucchini}), \gls{glspl}\marg{pumpkin} and \gls{glspl}\marg{melon}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This has removed the unnecessary cucumber from the gourd's \gloskey{see} list, and so cucumber doesn't get selected. \begin{information} See the \app{bib2gls} user manual for further details on the cross-reference selection and pruning options. \end{information} \subsection{Accessing the Cross-Referencing Fields} \label{sec:getsee} If you have switched off the indexing of the cross-reference fields (with \optval{autoseeindex}{false}) or want to suppress the \idxpl{locationlist}, then you can adjust the glossary style or hooks to include the cross-references since they won't be shown otherwise. \cmddef{glsxtrseelists} If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} or \gloskey{alias} fields set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseeformat} (for \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{alias}) or \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat} (for \gloskey{seealso}). If any of these fields are set, the list is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsxtrseelistsencap} This simply does a space followed by \meta{content}. If more than one of the fields are set (not recommended), then they will be displayed in the order: \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias}. The entire set will be encapsulated with \gls{glsxtrseelistsencap} and each sub-list will be separated with: \cmddef{glsxtrseelistsdelim} which defaults to a comma followed by a space. \cmddef{glsxtrusesee} If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{see} field set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseeformat}, otherwise this does nothing. An error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) will occur if the entry hasn't been defined. \cmddef{glsxtrusealias} As \gls{glsxtrusesee} but for the \gloskey{alias} field. \cmddef{glsxtruseseealso} If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{seealso} field set, this will display the cross reference according to \gls{glsxtruseseealsoformat}, otherwise this does nothing. An error (or warning with \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}) will occur if the entry hasn't been defined. \cmddef{glsxtralias} This expands to the value of the \gloskey{alias} field (which should be a single entry label) or empty if the field isn't set. If the entry isn't defined, this command will expand to \gls{relax} (without any error or warning). If you want to first test if the field is set, you can use \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}. \cmddef{glsxtrseealsolabels} This expands to the value of the \gloskey{seealso} field (which should be a comma-separated list of entry labels) or empty if the field isn't set. If the entry isn't defined, this command will expand to \gls{relax} (without any error or warning). If you want to first test if the field is set, you can use \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}. \cmddef{glsxtruseseealsoformat} This command is used to format a \qt{see also} cross-reference. This is simply defined to do: \begin{codebox*} \gls{glsseeformat}\oarg{\gls{seealsoname}}\margm{csv-list}\margm{} \end{codebox*} \subsection{Cross-Reference Indexing} \label{sec:glssee} \begin{information} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, see the \app{bib2gls} user manual for information about the \resourceopt{selection}, \resourceopt{see}, \resourceopt{seealso}, \resourceopt{alias}, \resourceopt{alias-loc} options. \end{information} The actual \idx{indexing} of the \gloskey{seealso} key is performed with: \cmddef{glsxtrindexseealso} which is analogous to \gls{glssee}. As with \gls{glssee}, this can also be used explicitly. With \app{makeindex}, \gls{glsxtrindexseealso} simply does: \begin{codebox*} \gls{glssee}\oarg{\gls{seealsoname}}\margm{entry-label}\margm{xr-list} \end{codebox*} With \app{xindy}, \gls{glsxtrindexseealso} behaves in an analogous way, using the appropriate cross-referencing markup. \cmddef{glsxtrsetaliasnoindex} This hook is used within the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands to automatically switch off the \idx{indexing} for aliases. (The hook is performed after the options set by \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts}.) By default, this hook just sets \glsoptval{noindex}{true}. If you would like to add \locations\ to the aliased \idx{locationlist} then you can redefine it to use: \cmddef{glsxtrindexaliased} For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrsetaliasnoindex}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrindexaliased}} \end{codebox} Note that this needs \glsoptval{noindex}{false} to ensure the \idx{indexing} takes place so don't simply append \gls{glsxtrindexaliased} to the definition of \gls{glsxtrsetaliasnoindex}. \begin{information} Don't use the above hooks with \app{bib2gls} as this function is disabled with \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}. Use the \resourceopt{alias-loc} resource option instead. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtraddallcrossrefs} This is used at the end of the document if \optval{indexcrossrefs}{true} to automatically index any cross-references (identified in the \gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias} fields). This command iterates over all entries in all glossaries and, if an entry has been marked as used, does: \cmddef{glsxtraddunusedxrefs} which indexes any labels identified in the cross-reference fields of the entry given by \meta{entry-label} that haven't been marked as used. This can be time consuming if there are a large number of entries defined. If this is the case, you may want to consider switching to \app{bib2gls} and use either \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see} or \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps and see not also}. There should be no need to use \gls{glsxtraddallcrossrefs} explicitly, but you may want to redefine it to only iterate over specific glossaries. The unused entries are indexed using the \encap{glsxtrunusedformat} format. \cmddef{glsxtrunusedformat} This ignores its argument (the \location) and just does \gls{unskip}. \section{First Use Flag} \label{sec:glsunset} Each entry has an associated \idx{firstuseflag} (a conditional or boolean variable), which determines whether or not the entry has been marked as \qt{used}. Unsetting this flag means that the entry is marked as used. Resetting the flag means that the entry is marked as unused. The \idx{glslike} commands (which are the principle method of referencing an entry) all mark the entry as used after the \idx{linktext} is displayed but before the \idx{postlinkhook} is used. The purpose of this is to allow for additional information that needs to be shown when a term first appears in a document. For example, an abbreviation may need to have its full form shown on the instance. However, there are some cases where that additional information may need to be shown again or where the literal first instance of the term may need to be in its terse form. For example, if the term is used in the front matter. If any \idx{glslike} commands (which are robust) are used in section headings or captions, they can end up in the table of contents or corresponding \qt{list of \ldots} (such as the list of figures). This can cause the \idx{firstuseflag} to be unset too soon. For these situations, use the commands described in \sectionref{sec:headtitle} instead. The base \sty{glossaries} package provides commands to explicitly unset or reset the \idx{firstuseflag} either locally (confined to the current scope) or globally. These commands are: \gls{glsunset} (global unset), \gls{glslocalunset} (local unset), \gls{glsreset} (global reset) and \gls{glslocalreset} (local reset). The \sty{glossaries-extra} package adds hooks to the above commands. These do nothing by default, but are modified by \gls{glsenableentrycount} and \gls{glsenableentryunitcount} to perform the count increment or reset (see \sectionref{sec:entrycount}). \cmddef{glsxtrpostunset} This hook is added to \gls{glsunset}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostlocalunset} This hook is added to \gls{glslocalunset}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostreset} This hook is added to \gls{glsreset}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostlocalreset} This hook is added to \gls{glslocalreset}. The base package also provides commands to unset or reset all entries or all entries within particular glossaries: \gls{glsunsetall} and \gls{glsresetall}. For example, if you don't want the \idx{firstuse} in the front matter, you can unset all entries at the start of the front matter and reset them at the start of the main matter. \begin{codebox} \cmd{frontmatter}\gls{glsunsetall} \ldots \cmd{mainmatter}\gls{glsresetall} \end{codebox} With \sty{glossaries-extra} you can unset a specific subset of entries. \cmddef{glslocalunseteach} Locally unsets each entry in the given comma-separated list of entry labels. \cmddef{glslocalreseteach} Locally resets each entry in the given comma-separated list of entry labels. You can test if an entry has been marked as used with \gls{ifglsused} (but take care if you are using \app{bib2gls} or the \optval{undefaction}{warn} option, see below). This command allows the entry display style to vary the \idx{linktext} according to whether or not the entry has been marked as used. However, it can't be used within the \idx{postlinkhook} as by that time, the \idx{firstuseflag} will have already been unset. \begin{information} See the \sty{glossaries} user manual for further details of the above commands. \end{information} For example, in the following document the \qt{html} entry is first used in the abstract, which shows both the long and the short form, but it would be helpful for the full form to be reshown in the main section about web pages. This is achieved by resetting the \idx{firstuseflag}. \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \cbeg{document} \cbeg{abstract} This abstract mentions \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \cend{abstract} Some casual reference to \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \cmd{section}\marg{Web Pages} \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}This section is all about \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Resetting the first use flag (\cmd{glsreset})}, label={ex:glsreset}, description={Example document illustrating the use of \cmd{glsreset}}] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} }{% \cbeg{abstract}^^J This abstract mentions \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J \cend{abstract}^^J Some casual reference to \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J \cmd{section}\marg{Web Pages}^^J \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}% This section is all about \gls{gls}\marg{html}. } \end{resultbox} In the above example, an alternative is to use \gls{glsxtrfull} where you particularly want the full form, but some abbreviation styles have a different expansion with the \idxc{inlinefullform}{inline} \gls{glsxtrfull} form compared with the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides the options \glsopt{preunset} and \glsopt{prereset}, which can be used to unset or reset the \idx{firstuseflag} before the \idx{linktext}. This means that in the above example, the line: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsreset}\marg{html}This section is all about \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \end{codebox} can be replaced with: \begin{codebox} This section is all about \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{prereset}}\marg{html}. \end{codebox} As mentioned above, the \idx{firstuseflag} is unset before the \idx{postlinkhook}, so \gls{ifglsused} isn't helpful in the \idx{postlinkhook}. Instead, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} This command is initialised by the \idx{glslike} commands according to the value of the \idx{firstuseflag} before the \idx{linktext}. It's also initialised by the \idx{glstextlike} commands: not according to the value of the \idx{firstuseflag} but according to whether or not the \idx{glstextlike} command emulates \idx{firstuse}. For example, \gls{gls} will define \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to do its first argument if the \idx{firstuseflag} indicates the entry hasn't yet been used, otherwise it will define \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to do its second argument. Whereas \gls{glsfirst} will always define \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to do its first argument (unless used with \glsopt{preunset}) and \gls{glstext} will always define \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to do its second argument (unless used with \glsopt{prereset}), regardless of the state of the \idx{firstuseflag}. The \glsopt{preunset} and \glsopt{prereset} options will additionally redefine \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse} to match the option. See \sectionref{sec:postlinkhook} for further details about the \idx{postlinkhook}. If you want to check if the calling command was both the \idx{firstuse} and it was a \idx{glslike} command, you can use: \gls{glsxtrifwasglslikeandfirstuse}. The unset function performed by the \idx{glslike} commands before the \idx{postlinkhook} uses the global \gls{glsunset} by default. If you want \gls{glslocalunset} instead, you can use the \glsopt{local} option (provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package) or \glsoptval{postunset}{local}. To prevent the \idx{firstuseflag} from being unset after the \idx{linktext}, use \glsoptval{postunset}{none}. \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \cbeg{document} \marg{\% local scope \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsopt{local}}\marg{html}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. }\% end scope \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{postunset}{none}}\marg{html}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Local unset}, label={ex:glslocalunset}, description={Example document illustrating locally unsetting the first use flag}] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} }{% \marg{\% local scope^^J \gls{gls}\oarg{local}\marg{html}.^^J Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}.^^J }\% end scope^^J \codepar Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. \codepar \gls{gls}\oarg{postunset=none}\marg{html}. Used? \gls{ifglsused}\marg{html}\marg{Yes}\marg{No}. } \end{resultbox} If you are using the \optval{undefaction}{warn} option (which is automatically implemented by the \opt{record} option), the \idx{firstuseflag} is undefined and so is neither true nor false, in which case \gls{ifglsused} will trigger an error or warning and do neither. In this situation, you may need to use the following command instead. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfUnusedOrUndefined} This does \meta{true} if the entry hasn't been defined or hasn't been marked as \glsdisp{firstuseflag}{used}, otherwise does \meta{true}. Note that this command will generate an error or warning (according to \opt{undefaction}) if the entry hasn't been defined, but will still do \meta{true}. This is more useful than \gls{ifglsused} with \app{bib2gls} where the entries are never defined on the first \LaTeX\ run. \subsection{Buffering Unsets} \label{sec:unsetbuffer} Sometimes commands like \gls{gls} are used in a context where changing a boolean variable can cause things to go wrong. The outer, middle and inner formatting (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}) can be used to change the font for the \idx{linktext}, but it may be that the \idx{glslike} command occurs within a block of text that needs to be encapsulated by such a command. One example of this is using \idx{gls} in one of the commands provided with the \sty{soul} package. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{gls}\marg{html}.} \end{codebox} This causes the confusing error: \begin{transcript} Glossary entry `\marg{html}' has not been defined. \end{transcript} The simplest workaround is to put \code{\gls{gls}\marg{html}} inside the argument of \gls{mbox}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}.} \end{codebox} This can work provided it's not the \idx{firstuse} of this entry. It if is, then unsetting the \idx{firstuseflag} causes a problem and results in the error: \begin{transcript} ! Package soul Error: Reconstruction failed. \end{transcript} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a way of temporarily switching off \gls{glsunset} so that it just makes a note of the entry's label but doesn't actually perform the change. \cmddef{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering} This starts the buffering. The unstarred version doesn't check for duplicates, so the internal list may end up with multiple occurrences of the same label. The starred version only adds a label to the internal list if it's not already in it. If you are using entry counting (see \sectionref{sec:entrycount}) the unstarred version is preferable to ensure the entry count is correct. \begin{important} Buffering only applies to the global \gls{glsunset} and does not affect the local \gls{glslocalunset}. \end{important} The buffer can be locally cleared with: \cmddef{GlsXtrClearUnsetBuffer} This doesn't stop buffering. It will simply discard the labels that have been buffered so far. In order to restore the normal behaviour of \gls{glsunset}, the buffering must be stopped or discarded. \cmddef{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering} This stops the buffering, restores \gls{glsunset}, and unsets all the buffered labels. The starred form uses \gls{glslocalunset} to unset the buffered labels. Before you stop the unset buffering, you can iterate over the current buffer. \cmddef{GlsXtrForUnsetBufferedList} This iterates over the currently buffered list of entry labels and performs \code{\csfmt{\meta{handler-cs}}\margm{entry-label}} for each label, where \meta{cs} is a control sequence that takes a single argument. This is best used with the starred version of \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering}[*] to avoid duplicates. \cmddef{GlsXtrDiscardUnsetBuffering} This discards the buffer and restores \gls{glsunset} to its normal behaviour. It's possible to locally unset entries before use (analogous to \glsoptval{preunset}{local}) if the entry has already been encountered in the buffer. This will still be problematic for situations where changing a conditional causes a problem, but may be useful in some situations. This feature is enabled with: \cmddef{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal} This may be placed before or after \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering} but the locally collected list of unused entries will be cleared at the start of each instance of \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering}. It will also be cleared by \gls{GlsXtrClearUnsetBuffer}. All entries that have been marked as unused can be reset with: \cmddef{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer} This will perform a local reset on all the entries in the \qt{not used} list and do \gls{GlsXtrClearUnsetBuffer}. This feature can be switched off with: \cmddef{GlsXtrUnsetBufferDisableRepeatLocal} It's disabled by default. The way this feature works is as follows (while buffering is active): \begin{enumerate} \item Each time an entry is referenced with a \idx{glslike} command, the \gls{glsinitreunsets} hook checks if the current entry (identified by \gls{glslabel}) has been added to the buffer. (Bear in mind that the label is added to the buffer after the \idx{linktext} when \gls{glsunset} is used.) \begin{enumerate} \item If it has been added to the buffer, then this is an indication that the entry has already been used within the buffer zone (that is, an attempt has been made to globally unset the \idx{firstuseflag}). A local unset is then performed, which is essentially equivalent to using the \glsoptval{preunset}{local} option, so the reference will behave like \idx{subsequentuse}. \item If it hasn't been added to the buffer, then this is an indication that the entry hasn't already been used within the buffer zone, but it may or may not have been used before the buffering started. If the \idx{firstuseflag} indicates that the entry hasn't been used, the entry's label will be added to the \qt{not used} list. The reference will behave like \idx{firstuse}, but the unset won't be performed afterwards (because buffering is in progress). \end{enumerate} \item The entries that are in the \qt{not used} list can be locally reset and both the buffer and the \qt{not used} list can be cleared with \gls{GlsXtrClearUnsetBuffer}. \end{enumerate} Note that this approach can't be used for situations where the change in conditional causes a problem, but it can be used in situations where the content of an environment or command is repeatedly processed, which upsets the \idx{firstuseflag}. For example, consider the following \cls{beamer} document: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{beamer} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \cbeg{document} \cbeg{frame} \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 1} \cbeg{itemize} \cmd{item} \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{html} \cend{itemize} \cend{frame} \cbeg{frame} \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 2} \cbeg{itemize} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{svm} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{html} \cend{itemize} \cend{frame} \cmd{frame}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The first page isn't a problem as the frame doesn't have overlays. The first reference of the \qt{html} entry shows the full form and the next shows just the short form. The second page (which is the first of the overlays of the second frame) correctly shows the full form of the \qt{svm} entry for the first reference and the short form for the second reference, but on the third page (the second of the overlays) now has all instances of \qt{svm} showing as \idx{subsequentuse} (just the short form). I could put \gls{glslocalresetall} at the start of the frame, but that would reset the \qt{html} entry as well. Another workaround is to locally reset the first \qt{svm} entry with \glsopt{prereset}{local}, but that defeats the point of the \idx{firstuseflag}, which is intended to keep track of whether or not you have used an entry so that you don't have to. The frame can be placed inside a buffering zone: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering} \cbeg{frame} \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 2} \cbeg{itemize} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{svm} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{html} \cend{itemize} \cend{frame} \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering} \end{codebox} This ensures that the \idx{firstuseflag} isn't reset until after the frame, but it means that all references to the \qt{svm} entry on both the second and third page show the full form. The \qt{repeat local} function can be used so that repeated references for the same entry can be locally unset before use. This can be enabled with \gls{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal} which fixes the second page, but not the third page, which shows all references to \qt{svm} as the short form. What's needed is to locally reset and entries that are in the frame but haven't yet been used (\qt{svm}, in this case) at the start of the frame with \gls{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer}: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering} \gls{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal} \cbeg{frame} \gls{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer} \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 2} \cbeg{itemize} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{svm} \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{html} \cend{itemize} \cend{frame} \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering} \end{codebox} Note that on the first overlay, the buffer and \qt{not used} list are both empty. On the second overlay, the buffer contains the \qt{svm} and \qt{html} labels and the \qt{not used} list just contains the \qt{svm} label. The reset performed by \gls{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer} will reset \qt{svm} and then clear both the buffer and the \qt{not used} list. This means that the first \qt{svm} reference is once again considered \idx{firstuse} and it will once again be added to the \qt{not used} list (so that it would be reset again if there was a third overlay). \begin{resultbox} \createexample* [arara={pdflatex,pdflatex},class={beamer},pages={1,2,3,4}, label={ex:unsetbeamer}, title={Abbreviations with \clsfmt{beamer} (unset buffering)}, description={An example document that uses beamer with buffering} ] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{svm}\marg{SVM}\marg{support vector machine}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} }% {% \cbeg{frame}^^J \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 1}^^J \cbeg{itemize}^^J \cmd{item} \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}^^J \cend{itemize}^^J \cend{frame}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrUnsetBufferEnableRepeatLocal}^^J% \cbeg{frame}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrResetLocalBuffer}^^J \cmd{frametitle}\marg{Frame 2}^^J \cbeg{itemize}^^J \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{svm}^^J \cmd{item}<+-> \gls{gls}\marg{svm} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}^^J \cend{itemize}^^J% \cend{frame}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering}^^J% \cmd{frame}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} } \end{resultbox} This is quite cumbersome, but these commands could potentially be added to hooks at the start and end of problematic environments (but the buffering needs to be started and ended outside of the repeated content). The following example uses \gls{mbox} to protect \gls{gls} within the buffer zone: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering} \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}. Next use: \gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}.} \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering} \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Buffering first use unsets with \cmd{mbox}}, label={ex:bufferingmbox}, description={Example document that uses buffering to defer unsetting the first use flag unset in problematic contexts. The use of box creates an overly long line}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} } {\gls{GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering}^^J% \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}.^^J% Next use: \gls{mbox}\marg{\gls{gls}\marg{html}}.}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering}^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. } \end{resultbox} Note that the use of \gls{mbox} prevents line-breaking and the second instance of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{html}} is treated as \idx{firstuse}. \begin{warning} Note that since the change in the \idx{firstuseflag} now doesn't occur until \gls{GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering}, multiple references of the same term within the buffering zone will always be treated as \idx{firstuse} (if the term wasn't used before the buffering started). \end{warning} Other alternatives include using \gls{protect} and inner formatting (see \sectionref{sec:innertextformat} for limitations) or middle formatting (see \sectionref{sec:middleformat}) with \gls{GlsXtrExpandedFmt} (which can't be used with fragile \idx{linktext}). Both approaches are demonstrated in the following example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \comment{custom command to expand content before using \gls{ul}:} \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{xpul}}[1]\marg{\gls{GlsXtrExpandedFmt}\marg{\gls{ul}}\marg{\#1}} \codepar \cbeg{document} First approach (inner formatting): \marg{\% scope \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}[1]\marg{\gls{ul}\marg{\#1}}\% \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}} } \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Second approach (middle formatting with expanded link text): \gls{glsresetall} \marg{\% scope \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{xpul}\marg{\#1}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{xpul}\marg{\#1}}\% \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.} } \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[label={ex:protectinnertextformat}, title={Alternatives to buffering}, description={Example document illustrating inner and middle formatting alternatives to unset buffering where entries are referenced within sensitive formatting commands}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{soul}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \% custom command to expand content before using \gls{ul}:^^J \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{xpul}}[1]\marg{\gls{GlsXtrExpandedFmt}\marg{\gls{ul}}\marg{\#1}} \codepar } {% First approach (inner formatting):^^J% \marg{\% scope^^J \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrdefaultentrytextfmt}}[1]\marg{\gls{ul}\marg{\#1}}\%^^J \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J Next use: \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}}^^J% }^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \codepar Second approach (middle formatting with expanded link text):^^J% \gls{glsresetall}^^J% \marg{\% scope^^J \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrabbreviationfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{xpul}\marg{\#1}}\%^^J \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrregularfont}}[1]\marg{\cmd{xpul}\marg{\#1}}\%^^J \gls{ul}\marg{Some text about \gls{protect}\gls{gls}\marg{html}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.}^^J% } \codepar Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. } \end{resultbox} The change in the \idx{firstuseflag} isn't the only content within the \idx{glslike} commands that can cause a problem. The \idx{whatsit} caused by \idx{indexing} can also be problematic. Buffering can also be used to help with that situation. Indexing can be switched off at the start of the buffering and \gls{GlsXtrForUnsetBufferedList} can be used to perform the indexing outside of the problematic content. Note that this can cause a problem if the \location\ changes (for example, if a page break occurs within the buffering zone). Buffering can also be used to simply gather the labels that have been referenced with a \idx{glslike} command in order to, for example, display a \idx{mini-glossary} at the end of the block. See for example, \gallerypage{minigloss}{Gallery: Mini-Glossary}. \section{Accessing Fields} \label{sec:getfields} See \sectionref{sec:setfields} for setting fields after an entry has been defined, \sectionref{sec:csvfields} for fields that contain comma-separated lists or whose values may be contained within comma-separated lists, \sectionref{sec:getsee} for cross-referencing fields (\gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias}), and \sectionref{sec:fieldconditionals} for testing field values. See also the base \sty{glossaries} package's commands, such as \gls{glsentryname} and \gls{glsletentryfield}. \cmddef{glsxtrusefield} This expands to the value of the \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. Expands to \gls{relax} if the \idx{field} or entry are undefined. \cmddef{Glsxtrusefield} This is like \gls{glsxtrusefield} but converts the first character to \idx{uppercase} using \gls{makefirstuc} (provided by \sty{mfirstuc}) which is robust. If \sty{hyperref} is loaded, \code{\gls{Glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}} will use the expandable: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in a PDF bookmark. \cmddef{GLSxtrusefield} This is like \gls{glsxtrusefield} but converts the field value to \idx{uppercase}. See \sectionref{sec:uppercase}. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldtitlecase} This is like \gls{glsxtrusefield} but converts the field value to \idx{titlecase}. This internally uses: \cmddef{glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs} This converts \meta{content} to \idx{titlecase} (expanding the first token once). If \gls{glscapitalisewords} has been defined, that will be used, otherwise \gls{capitalisewords} will be used. \cmddef{glsxtrentryparentname} Expands to the entry's parent \gloskey{name} if defined. Expands to nothing if the entry doesn't have a parent or if the entry isn't defined. If you simply require the parent label then use \gls{glsentryparent} or, to first test if the entry has a parent, either use \gls{ifglshasparent} or use \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} with the field label set to \code{parent}. \cmddef{glsxtrhiername} Displays the hierarchical name for the given entry. The cross-reference format \gls{glsseeitemformat} may be redefined to use this command to show the hierarchy, if required. This command has a recursive definition. If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has a parent, then this command will do \code{\gls{glsxtrhiername}\margm{parent-label}} for the entry's parent and will then do the separator \gls{glsxtrhiernamesep}. Then, regardless of whether or not the entry has a parent, it will do \code{\gls{glsfmttext}\margm{entry-label}}, if the entry is an abbreviation (see \sectionref{sec:examplediffsabbrv}), or \code{\gls{glsfmtname}\margm{entry-label}} otherwise. \begin{information} If \sty{hyperref} is loaded, \gls{glsxtrhiername} will behave as \gls{glsentryname} in a PDF bookmark. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtrhiernamesep} Separator symbol (\glsxtrhiernamesep) used between each name in commands like \gls{glsxtrhiername}. \cmddef{Glsxtrhiername} As \gls{glsxtrhiername} but the first name in the list has its first character converted to \idx{uppercase} using \gls{Glsfmttext} or \gls{Glsfmtname} (\idx{sentencecase}). If \sty{hyperref} is loaded, \gls{Glsxtrhiername} will expand to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glsentryname}\margm{entry-label}} \end{compactcodebox} in a PDF bookmark. The \gls{makefirstuc} mapping from \gls{glsxtrhiername} to \gls{Glsxtrhiername} is set with \gls{glsmfuaddmap}, if supported. \cmddef{GlsXtrhiername} As \gls{glsxtrhiername} but each name in the list has its first character converted to \idx{uppercase} using \gls{Glsfmttext} or \gls{Glsfmtname}. \cmddef{GLSxtrhiername} As \gls{glsxtrhiername} but the first name in the list is converted to \idx{uppercase} using \gls{GLSfmttext} or \gls{GLSfmtname}. \cmddef{GLSXTRhiername} As \gls{glsxtrhiername} but each name in the list is converted to \idx{uppercase} using \gls{GLSfmttext} or \gls{GLSfmtname} (\idx{allcaps}). \section{Encapsulation (Formatting) Based on Field Values} These commands assume that a given entry has a special purpose field that's used to store information on how to format text. \subsection{Foreign Language Field} \label{sec:foreignfield} \cmddef{GlsXtrForeignTextField} This command should expand to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used to store a language tag (such as \code{en-GB} or \code{de-CH-1996}). The default value is \code{userii} (which corresponds to the \gloskey{user2} key). \cmddef{GlsXtrForeignText} If the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the field identified by \gls{GlsXtrForeignTextField} set, then this command will encapsulate \meta{text} according to the language tag stored in that field. This uses \sty{tracklang}['s] interface to determine the language label that corresponds to the language tag. If the language label can be determined, the \meta{text} will be encapsulated with \gls{foreignlanguage} otherwise just \meta{text} is done. If \gls{foreignlanguage} isn't defined (that is, there's no language support for the document), this command simply does \meta{text}. If an old version of \sty{tracklang} is used, this command issues a warning and just does \meta{text}. If \sty{tracklang} can't determine the corresponding language label to use with \gls{foreignlanguage}, then a warning is issued with: \cmddef{GlsXtrUnknownDialectWarning} where \meta{locale} is the language tag supplied in the given field value and \meta{root language} is the root language that \sty{tracklang} has inferred from the tag. \begin{information} \gls{GlsXtrForeignText} requires \sty{tracklang} v1.3.6+. \end{information} For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[main=british,brazilian,ngerman]\marg{babel} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-user}} \gls{newabbreviation} \oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{Associa\c{c}\~ao Brasileria de Normas T\'ecnicas}, \gloskeyval{user2}{pt-BR} } \marg{abnt}\marg{ABNT}\marg{Brazilian National Standards Organization} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation} \oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{Deutsches Institut f\"ur Normung e.V.}, \gloskeyval{user2}{de-DE-1996}} \marg{din}\marg{DIN}\marg{German Institute for Standardization} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{tug}\marg{TUG}\marg{\cmd{TeX}\cmd{ }User Group} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserparen}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\#2}\% \gls{glsxtrparen} \marg{\#1\% \gls{ifglshasfield}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserfield}}\marg{\#2}\% \marg{, \cmd{emph}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrForeignText}\marg{\#2}\marg{\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}}}\% \marg{}\% }\% } \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{abnt}, \gls{gls}\marg{din}, \gls{gls}\marg{tug}. \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Foreign language field encapsulation}, label={ex:foreignlangfmt}, description={Example document illustrating fields containing different languages that need encapsulating with the relevant language command}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[main=british,brazilian,ngerman]\marg{babel}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-user}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J% \oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{Associa\c{c}\~ao Brasileria de Normas T\'ecnicas},^^J% \gloskeyval{user2}{pt-BR}^^J% }^^J% \marg{abnt}\marg{ABNT}\marg{Brazilian National Standards Organization}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}^^J% \oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{Deutsches Institut f\"ur Normung e.V.},^^J% \gloskeyval{user2}{de-DE-1996}}^^J% \marg{din}\marg{DIN}\marg{German Institute for Standardization}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{tug}\marg{TUG}\marg{\cmd{TeX}\cmd{ }User Group}^^J% \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserparen}}[2]\marg{\%^^J% \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\#2}\%^^J% \gls{glsxtrparen}^^J% \marg{\#1\%^^J% \gls{ifglshasfield}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserfield}}\marg{\#2}\%^^J% \marg{, \cmd{emph}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrForeignText}\marg{\#2}\marg{\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}}}\%^^J% \marg{}\%^^J% }\%^^J% } } { \gls{gls}\marg{abnt}, \gls{gls}\marg{din}, \gls{gls}\marg{tug}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \subsection{Associated Entry Format} \label{sec:glsxtrfmt} An entry may have a particular formatting style associated with it (rather than a more general category-wide format). This needs to be provided by a text-block command that takes a single argument. The name (without the leading backslash) should be stored in the field identified by: \cmddef{GlsXtrFmtField} This command should expand to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} used to store the formatting command's control sequence name. The default value is \code{useri} (which corresponds to the \gloskey{user1} key). \cmddef{glsxtrfmt} This command behaves like: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslink}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\meta{fmt-link-text}} \end{compactcodebox} where the \idx{linktext} \meta{fmt-link-text} is formatted according to: \cmddef{glsxtrfmtdisplay} The default definition simply does \code{\cmd{\meta{csname}}\margm{text}\meta{insert}} where the control sequence name \meta{csname} is obtained from the field given by \gls{GlsXtrFmtField}. If the field hasn't been set, \gls{@firstofone} is used (which simply does its argument). The unstarred version assumes an empty \meta{insert}. The default \gls{glslink} options are given by \gls{GlsXtrFmtDefaultOptions}. \begin{information} The \idx{postlinkhook} is suppressed with \gls{glsxtrfmt}. \end{information} If you don't want the complexity of \gls{glslink}, a partially expandable command is provided that may be used in section headings: \cmddef{glsxtrentryfmt} If \sty{hyperref} has been loaded, this will expand to: \cmddef{glsxtrpdfentryfmt} within the PDF bookmarks, which just does \meta{text}. Otherwise \gls{glsxtrentryfmt} will format \meta{text} according to the control sequence name identified in the field given by \gls{GlsXtrFmtField} (or \code{@firstofone}, if not set). For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{amsmath} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{postdot},\optval{style}{\glostyle{index}}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{mtx}}[1]\marg{\cmd{boldsymbol}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{mtxinv}}[1]\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{\#1}\cmd{sp}\marg{-1}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{matrix}\marg{\% \gloskeyval{name}{matrix}, \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{M}}}, \gloskeyval{plural}{matrices}, \gloskeyval{user1}{mtx},\comment{corresponds to \cmd{mtx}} \gloskeyval{description}{rectangular array of values} } \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{identitymatrix}\marg{\% \gloskeyval{name}{identity matrix}, \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{I}}}, \gloskeyval{plural}{identity matrices}, \gloskeyval{description}{a diagonal matrix with all diagonal elements equal to 1 and all other elements equal to 0} } \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{matrixinv}\marg{\% \gloskeyval{name}{matrix inverse}, \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtxinv}\marg{M}}}, \gloskeyval{user1}{mtxinv},\comment{corresponds to \cmd{mtxinv}} \gloskeyval{description}{a square \gls{gls}\marg{matrix} such that \$\cmd{mtx}\marg{M}\cmd{mtxinv}\marg{M}=\gls{glssymbol}\marg{identitymatrix}\$} } \cbeg{document} A \gls{gls}\marg{matrix} is denoted \gls{glssymbol}\marg{matrix}. The inverse is denoted \gls{glssymbol}\marg{matrixinv}. \cmd{[} \gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrix}\marg{A} \gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrixinv}\marg{A} = \gls{glssymbol}\marg{identitymatrix} \cmd{]} Compare \$\gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrix}\marg{A}[\_0]\$ with \$\gls{glsxtrfmt*}\marg{matrix}\marg{A}[\_0]\$. \cmd{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Storing a formatting command in a field}, label={ex:glsxtrfmt}, description={Example document that uses a field to store the formatting command associated with the glossary entry}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[T1]\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{amsmath}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[postdot,style=index]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{mtx}}[1]\marg{\cmd{boldsymbol}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{mtxinv}}[1]\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{\#1}\cmd{sp}\marg{-1}}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{matrix}\marg{\%^^J% \gloskeyval{name}{matrix},^^J% \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{M}}},^^J% \gloskeyval{plural}{matrices},^^J% \gloskeyval{user1}{mtx},^^J% \gloskeyval{description}{rectangular array of values}^^J% }^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{identitymatrix}\marg{\%^^J% \gloskeyval{name}{identity matrix},^^J% \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{I}}},^^J% \gloskeyval{plural}{identity matrices},^^J% \gloskeyval{description}{a diagonal matrix with all diagonal elements equal to^^J% 1 and all other elements equal to 0}^^J% } \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{matrixinv}\marg{\%^^J% \gloskeyval{name}{matrix inverse},^^J% \gloskeyval{symbol}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtxinv}\marg{M}}},^^J% \gloskeyval{user1}{mtxinv},^^J% \gloskeyval{description}{a square \gls{gls}\marg{matrix} such that^^J% \string$\cmd{mtx}\marg{M}\cmd{mtxinv}\marg{M}=\gls{glssymbol}\marg{identitymatrix}\string$}^^J% }^^J% } {% A \gls{gls}\marg{matrix} is denoted \gls{glssymbol}\marg{matrix}.^^J% The inverse is denoted \gls{glssymbol}\marg{matrixinv}.^^J% \cmd{[}^^J% \gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrix}\marg{A}^^J% \gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrixinv}\marg{A}^^J% =^^J% \gls{glssymbol}\marg{identitymatrix}^^J% \cmd{]}^^J% Compare \string$\gls{glsxtrfmt}\marg{matrix}\marg{A}[\string_0]\string$^^J% with \string$\gls{glsxtrfmt*}\marg{matrix}\marg{A}[\string_0]\string$. \cmd{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Note the difference between using \gls{glsxtrfmt*} vs \gls{glsxtrfmt}. There are also \idx{sentencecase} versions of the above commands: \cmddef{Glsxtrfmt} This is simply a shortcut for: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrfmt}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}\margm{text}} \end{compactcodebox} Similarly for the starred form: \cmddef{Glsxtrfmt*} which is a shortcut for: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrfmt*}\oargm{options}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}\margm{text}}\oargm{insert} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{Glsxtrentryfmt} This is a shortcut for \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrentryfmt}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glssentencecase}\margm{text}} \end{compactcodebox} but uses: \cmddef{Glsxtrpdfentryfmt} for the PDF bookmarks. This uses \gls{MFUsentencecase} to perform the case-change, which is expandable. If you are writing \gls{glsxtrfmt} or \gls{glsxtrentryfmt} explicitly in the document text, you can, of course, enter the appropriate case in \meta{text} directly. The purpose of providing the \idx{sentencecase} commands is to enable a mapping to be setup with \gls{MFUaddmap} in the event that \gls{glsxtrfmt} or \gls{glsxtrentryfmt} occur at the start of content, such as another entry's description, that will have \idx{sentencecase} automatically applied. This will require \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+ to support the mapping. See the \sty{mfirstuc} manual for further details. \section{Comma-Separated Lists} \label{sec:csvfields} These commands are for field values that are comma-separated lists (for example, the field has been constructed with \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}) or for testing if field values are contained within comma-separated lists. \begin{information} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you can sort field values that contain a comma-separated list of labels (such as the \gloskey{see} or \gloskey{seealso} field) with the \resourceopt{sort-label-list} option (provided \app{bib2gls} can access those fields). See the \app{bib2gls} manual for further details. \end{information} \cmddef{glsseelist} This is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to format the entry labels in \gloskey{see} cross-reference list. (It's used internally by \gls{glsseeformat}, which adds the \emph{see} prefix.) It may also be used for any comma-separated list of entry labels. Note that the argument isn't expanded. If expansion is required, use: \cmddef{glsxtrseelist} This fully expands its argument and passes the result to \gls{glsseelist}. With just the base \sty{glossaries} package, each item is encapsulated with \gls{glsseeitem}. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines \gls{glsseelist} to make it more flexible and provides additional commands to further customize the formatting. \cmddef{glsxtrtaggedlist} This is a similar command that has an initial tag inserted before the start of the list. If the list only contains one element, the \meta{singular tag} is used. If the list contains more than one element, the \meta{plural tag} is used. The separator between the tag and the list is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrtaggedlistsep} The separators between the elements of the list and the formatting of each list element is as for \gls{glsseelist} (see below). If the list is empty, nothing is displayed. The \meta{label prefix} is inserted before the current item in the list to form the entry label. \begin{warning} Spaces in \meta{csv-list} are significant. Avoid unwanted leading or trailing spaces and empty labels. \end{warning} \cmddef{glsseeitemformat} The base \sty{glossaries} package just uses \gls{glsentryname} or \gls{glsentrytext} in this command. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines this so that it does: \begin{codebox} \gls{ifglshasshort}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glsfmttext}\margm{entry-label}} \marg{\gls{glsfmtname}\margm{entry-label}} \end{codebox} Note that the use of \gls{glsfmttext} rather than \gls{glsentrytext} allows the abbreviation style to be used. With \sty{glossaries-extra}, the first item in \gls{glsseelist} will be encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsseefirstitem} The default definition is simply \code{\gls{glsseeitem}\margm{entry-label}} but can be redefined, for example to convert the first character to \idx{uppercase} if \idx{sentencecase} is required. \begin{information} If the label corresponds to a multi-entry, \gls{mglsseefirstitem} will be used instead (see \sectionref{sec:msee}). Similarly, \gls{mglsseeitem} will be used instead of \gls{glsseeitem} for a multi-entry label. \end{information} \cmddef{glsseesep} This is used between each entry in the list, except between the final pair. \cmddef{glsseelastsep} This is used between the penultimate and final item in the list. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{space}\gls{andname}\cmd{space} \end{codebox} (\gls{andname} is provided by \sty{glossaries}, if not already defined, and simply expands to \gls{amp} but it may be defined to expand to something else by another package before \sty{glossaries} is loaded.) With \sty{glossaries-extra}, if there are at least three elements in the list, the separator between the final two elements will be given by: \cmddef{glsseelastoxfordsep} This just defaults to \gls{glsseelastsep} but may be redefined to include a comma, if preferred. \cmddef{glsxtrforcsvfield} This iterates over the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} and performs \code{\meta{handler cs}\margm{element}} for each element of the list. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the complete list can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. Does nothing if the field hasn't been set or the entry hasn't been defined. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't. It's possible to prematurely break the loop at the end of the current iteration with: \cmddef{glsxtrendfor} If nested within another command that also uses \gls{@for}, use the unstarred version to localise the break. This command is simply set to \gls{@endfortrue}, which is provided by the \sty{xfor} package. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist} This formats the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) for the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} using \sty{datatool-base}['s] \gls{DTLformatlist}. This command uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} so the complete list can be obtained with \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. This adds implicit grouping. There is no starred version. The following demonstrates the difference between \gls{glsseelist} (which specifically requires a list of labels) and \gls{glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist} (which formats an arbitrary list): \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{autoseeindex}{false}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{example}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{example},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{see}{another1,another2}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another1}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{another one},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another2}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{another two},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \cbeg{document} \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{duck} \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{albatross} \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{arara} Animal list: \gls{glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist}\marg{example}\marg{animals} \codepar See list: \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{see}\marg{example} \marg{\gls{glsxtrseelist}\marg{\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}}\marg{not set}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} There's no \idx{indexing} in this document so I've used \optval{autoseeindex}{false} to avoid an error. This means there's no cross-reference list in the glossary but, as demonstrated, the \qt{see} list can be reproduced in the document. The result is: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Formatting lists contained in field values}, label={ex:fieldformatcsv}, description={Example document that uses two different methods of sorting fields that contain a comma-separated list}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{autoseeindex=false}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{example}\marg{name=example,description={},^^J% see={another1,another2}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another1}\marg{name={another one},description={}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another2}\marg{name={another two},description={}}^^J% } {% \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{duck}^^J% \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{albatross}^^J% \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{arara}^^J% Animal list: \gls{glsxtrfieldformatcsvlist}\marg{example}\marg{animals}.^^J% \codepar See list: \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{see}\marg{example}\marg{\gls{glsxtrseelist}\marg{\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}}\marg{not set}.^^J% \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This first constructs a comma-separated list in a custom \idx{internalfield} with the label \code{animals}. There's no associated key that can be used in \gls{newglossaryentry}. In this case, the \idx{field} could simply be set in one command. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrdeffield}\marg{example}\marg{animals}\marg{duck,albatross,arara} \end{codebox} The main reason for providing \gls{glsxtrapptocsvfield} is for the benefit of \app{bib2gls}, as it sometimes has to construct a field value list while it's writing the \ext{glstex} file, but there may be other uses in complex documents that construct field values through some custom function. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList} This does \meta{true} if the comma-separated list stored in the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) contains the given \meta{value} (using \gls{DTLifinlist} provided by \sty{datatool-base}) or \meta{false} if the value isn't in the list or if the field hasn't been set or the entry hasn't been defined. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't. This command internally uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}, so take care if it's nested. Within \meta{false}, you can test if \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} is empty or undefined. If it's defined but not empty, then the field has been set but doesn't contain \meta{value}. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldValueInCsvList} This command is essentially the other way around to the above. In this case, the comma-separated list is provided in the argument \meta{csv-list} and the search value is the field's value. This does \meta{true} if the value is found in \meta{csv-list} or \meta{false} if the value isn't in \meta{csv-list} or the field isn't set or the entry hasn't been defined. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. The starred version doesn't. Again, this command internally uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}, so you can test \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} in \meta{false} to determine whether or not the field has been set. \cmddef{xGlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList} As \gls{GlsXtrIfValueInFieldCsvList} but fully expands \meta{value} first. \section{List Fields} \label{sec:listfields} Comma-separated list fields are covered in \sectionref{sec:csvfields}. The commands in this section are for fields that store \sty{etoolbox} internal lists. Elements can be appended to these fields using commands \gls{glsxtrfieldlistadd}, described in \sectionref{sec:setfields}. The commands listed below provide an easy interface to iterate over the field values. See the \sty{etoolbox} documentation for further details about internal lists. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldformatlist} Formats the list using the same separators as used by \sty{datatool}['s] \gls{DTLformatlist}. This internally uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{forlistcsloop} with the same handler macro as used with \gls{DTLformatlist}. \cmddef{glsxtrfielddolistloop} This uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{dolistcsloop}, which uses the command \csfmt{do} as the handler. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldforlistloop} This uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{forlistcsloop}, which uses the \meta{handler-cs} as the handler. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldifinlist} This uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifinlistcs} to test if \meta{item} is in the list. \cmddef{glsxtrfieldxifinlist} This uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{xifinlistcs} to test if \meta{item} is in the list. \section{Field Conditionals} \label{sec:fieldconditionals} \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldUndef} Tests if the given \idx{field} (identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label}) is undefined for the entry given by \meta{entry-label}. Does \meta{true} if the entry doesn't exists or if entry exists but the field hasn't been set. Does \meta{false} if the field has been set, even if it has been set to empty. Unlike \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} there is no grouping or starred version and no assignment of \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}. This is simply a shortcut that internally uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsundef}. The base \sty{glossaries} package provides a similar command \gls{ifglsfieldvoid}, which uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsvoid} instead. \cmddef{glsxtrifhasfield} This tests if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \idx{field} identified by its \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} \meta{field-label} set. This is like \gls{ifglshasfield} but doesn't produce a warning if the entry or field doesn't exist. This command first assigns \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} to the field value. If this is defined and not empty, \meta{true} is done otherwise \meta{false} is done. You can test \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} within \meta{false} to find out whether it's undefined or empty using \sty{etoolbox}'s commands, such as \gls{ifundef} or \gls{ifdefempty}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping to make nesting easier. The starred version doesn't (to make assignments easier). \begin{information} If you are simply displaying the value of the field (for example, in the \idx{postdeschook}) then use the unstarred version. If you are making an assignment based on the value of the field, then use the starred version. \end{information} \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum} This command should only be used with fields that contain integer values. It internally uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} (the starred or unstarred version, to match the starred or unstarred version of \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr}) and tests if \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} is equal to (\meta{op} is \code{=}), less than (\meta{op} is \code{<}) or greater than (\meta{op} is \code{>}) the given number \meta{number}. If the field is empty or undefined, \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} will be set to \code{0}. Remember that the unstarred version adds implicit grouping. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldEqNum} This is a shortcut that uses \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum} with \meta{op} set to \code{=}. The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldNonZero} This is a shortcut that uses \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldCmpNum} with \meta{op} set to \code{=} and the final two arguments swapped. (So it's true if the field value is not zero.) The unstarred version adds implicit grouping. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr} This internally uses \gls{glsxtrifhasfield} (the starred or unstarred version, to match the starred or unstarred version of \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr}) and tests if \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue} is equal to \meta{value}. Remember that the unstarred version adds implicit grouping. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfFieldEqXpStr} This is like \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr} but expands the string before the comparison. This also has an starred version that doesn't add implicit grouping. \cmddef{GlsXtrIfXpFieldEqXpStr} This is like \gls{GlsXtrIfFieldEqStr} but expands both the field value and the string before the comparison. This also has an starred version that doesn't add implicit grouping. \chapter{Counting References} \label{sec:countref} There are three basic ways of counting entry references: \begin{enumerate} \item Counting the total number of times \gls{glsunset} is used (\gls{glsreset} resets the count unless \gls{glsresetcurrcountfalse} and is best avoided). This is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package and is intended for documents where the term should be displayed differently if it's only been used a certain number of times. The information has to be written to the \ext{aux} file so that it's available on the next \LaTeX\ run. This method is extended by \sty{glossaries-extra} and is described in \sectionref{sec:entrycount}. This method relies on the document only using the \idx{glslike} commands and is inappropriate with \app{bib2gls}. \item Counting the total number of records. This method is only available with \app{bib2gls} and is intended for documents where the term should be displayed differently if it's only been \recorded\ (\indexed) a certain number of times. This is a more efficient method than entry counting. See \sectionref{sec:recordcount} for further details. \item Counting the number of times the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands are used. Unlike the other two methods, this just provides a running total rather than the total from the previous \LaTeX\ run. This method is intended to make it more convenient to work with hooks like \gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook}, \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys} or \gls{glslinkpresetkeys}. See \sectionref{sec:linkcount} for further details. \end{enumerate} \section{Entry Counting (First Use Flag)} \label{sec:entrycount} \begin{information} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you need to use record counting instead (see \sectionref{sec:recordcount}). \end{information} Entry counting is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package and is enabled with \gls{glsenableentrycount}. This keeps a count of the number of times an entry is marked as used, which is done by hooking into the unset and reset commands (see \sectionref{sec:glsunset}). The current running total can be obtained with \gls{glsentrycurrcount}. The total from the end of the previous \LaTeX\ run can be obtained with \gls{glsentryprevcount}. Since entry counting relies on the \idx{firstuseflag}, it doesn't take the \idx{glstextlike} commands into account. \begin{warning} Entry counting is incompatible with \opteqvalref{docdef}{true}. \end{warning} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package modifies \gls{glsenableentrycount} to allow for the \catattr{entrycount} attribute. This means that you not only need to enable entry counting with \gls{glsenableentrycount}, but you also need to set the \catattr{entrycount} attribute (see below). Prior to v1.49, the associated counter was reset back to 0 when the \idx{firstuseflag} is reset. This behaviour is now only implemented if the following conditional is true: \cmddef{ifglsresetcurrcount} To (locally) change this conditional to true use: \cmddef{glsresetcurrcounttrue} To (locally) change this conditional to false use: \cmddef{glsresetcurrcountfalse} As from v1.49, the default is now false. Note that this conditional is also available with \sty{glossaries} v4.50+. \begin{important} Remember that entry counting only counts the number of times an entry is used by commands that change the \idx{firstuseflag}. (That is, all those commands that mark the entry as having been used.) There are many commands that don't modify this flag and they won't contribute to the entry use count. \end{important} With just the base \sty{glossaries} package, the associated entry counting commands, such as \gls{cgls}, are only available when entry counting has been activated with \gls{glsenableentrycount}. Whereas with \sty{glossaries-extra}, those commands are always available but behave in the same way as the corresponding \idx{glslike} commands if entry counting hasn't been activated. The commands provided by the \opt{shortcuts} options, such as \gls{ac} are defined to use \gls{cgls} instead of \gls{gls} etc so you can use them either with or without entry counting. In order to activate entry counting with \sty{glossaries-extra}, you not only need to use \gls{glsenableentrycount} but also need to specify the trigger value. \cmddef{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting} This command is provided as a shortcut to activate entry counting and assign the trigger value. This command performs the following: \begin{itemize} \item enables entry counting with \gls{glsenableentrycount}; \item redefines the \idx{glslike} commands to do the equivalent \gls{cgls} commands (so you don't need to keep track of which entries have entry counting enabled); \item sets the \catattr{entrycount} attribute to \meta{trigger-value} for all the supplied categories; \item disables the unit counting command (which is incompatible). \end{itemize} If you want to have different trigger values for different categories, you can set the \catattr{entrycount} attribute afterwards for the other category. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting}\marg{\cat{abbreviation},\cat{acronym}}\marg{1} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{2} \end{codebox} If you use \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting} multiple times, the repeated instances will simply set the \catattr{entrycount} attribute for the listed categories. So the above can also be written as: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting}\marg{\cat{abbreviation},\cat{acronym}}\marg{1} \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{2} \end{codebox} The commands like \gls{cgls} behave like the corresponding \idx{glslike} command if the entry count at the end of the previous run was more than a trigger value. With just the base \sty{glossaries} package, this trigger value is 1. With \sty{glossaries-extra} you can specify a different value. \begin{important} The appropriate trigger value must be set for the required category or categories. \end{important} As with the \idx{glslike} commands, the \gls{cgls} set of commands may also be used with the star (\code{*}) or plus (\code{+}) modifiers or the modifier given by \gls{GlsXtrSetAltModifier}. If the entry count at the end of the previous run doesn't exceed the trigger value, the corresponding formatting command is used instead. For example, \gls{cgls} will use \gls{cglsformat}. The complete set of commands are: \cmddef{cgls} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{gls} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cglsformat} This is redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} to test whether or not the entry has the \catattr{regular} attribute set or is an abbreviation: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{cglsformat}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsifregular}\marg{\#1}\marg{\gls{glsentryfirst}\marg{\#1}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshaslong}\marg{\#1}\marg{\gls{glsentrylong}\marg{\#1}}\marg{\gls{glsentryfirst}\marg{\#1}}}\#2\% } \end{compactcodebox} This show the first use value if the entry is regular otherwise it will show the long form. The insert is appended at the end. \cmddef{cglspl} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{glspl} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cglsplformat} This is like \gls{cglsformat} but uses the plural commands. \cmddef{cGls} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{Gls} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cGlsformat} This is like \gls{cglsformat} but uses the \idx{sentencecase} commands. \cmddef{cGlspl} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{Glspl} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cGlsplformat} This is like \gls{cglsformat} but uses the plural \idx{sentencecase} commands. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides some additional commands: \cmddef{cGLS} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{GLS} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cGLSformat} This simply uses \gls{cglsformat} converted to \idx{uppercase}. \cmddef{cGLSpl} If the trigger value has been supplied for the entry's category and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{GLSpl} otherwise it uses: \cmddef{cGLSplformat} This simply uses \gls{cglsplformat} converted to \idx{uppercase}. The test to determine whether or not an entry trips the trigger value is performed by: \cmddef{glsxtrifcounttrigger} This obtains the trigger value from the entry's \catattr{entrycount} attribute. \begin{important} Since these commands require information from the previous \LaTeX\ run, and extra \LaTeX\ call must be added to the build process (before the relevant \idx{indexingapp}). \end{important} For example, in the following document the trigger value is set to 1. The CSS entry is only used once (which doesn't exceed the trigger). The HTML entry is used twice (which does exceed the trigger). The sample entry is only used once, but entry counting hasn't been enabled on its category (the default \cat{general}). \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting}\marg{\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{1} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{css}\marg{CSS}\marg{cascading style sheet} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{gls}\marg{css}, \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} If the document is saved in a file called \filefmt{myDoc.tex} then the build process is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc pdflatex myDoc makeglossaries myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} Note the second \LaTeX\ call before \app{makeglossaries}. The result is shown below: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:catentrycount}, title={Entry counting according to category}, description={Example document illustrating entry counting}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting}\marg{abbreviation}\marg{1}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{css}\marg{CSS}\marg{cascading style sheet}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{name={sample},description={an example}}^^J% } {% First use: \gls{gls}\marg{css}, \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{sample}.^^J% Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Note that the CSS entry only shows the long form, doesn't appear in the glossary and doesn't have a hyperlink. This is because the total count from the previous \LaTeX\ run doesn't exceed the value (1, in this case) that triggers the normal behaviour of \gls{gls}. The HTML entry has a total count of 2 from the previous \LaTeX\ run, so it's displayed as normal with the full form on \idx{firstuse} and has a hyperlink to its entry in the glossary. The sample entry is only used once, but it has the default \cat{general} category, which doesn't have the \catattr{entrycount} attribute set. Note that if the build process only had one \LaTeX\ call before running \app{makeglossaries}, the HTML entry would also not appear in the glossary. This is because on the first \LaTeX\ run, the total from the previous run is 0 (because there's no information in the \ext{aux} file). The \sty{glossaries-extra} package also provides the ability to count per sectional unit instead: \cmddef{glsenableentryunitcount} \begin{important} It's not possible to enable both document-wide entry counting (\gls{glsenableentrycount}) and unit entry counting (\gls{glsenableentryunitcount}). \end{important} The unit entry counting provides separate totals for each section unit. As above, this uses the \catattr{entrycount} attribute to provide the trigger value but also requires the \catattr{unitcount} attribute, which should be set to the name of the appropriate counter, such as \ctr{section} or \ctr{chapter}. \begin{warning} Due to the asynchronous nature of \TeX's output routine, discrepancies will occur in page spanning paragraphs if you use the \ctr{page} counter. \end{warning} As before, there is a command provided to enable the feature and set the corresponding attributes at the same time: \cmddef{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting} This command performs the following: \begin{itemize} \item enables unit entry counting with \gls{glsenableentryunitcount}; \item redefines the \idx{glslike} commands to do the equivalent \gls{cgls} commands (so you don't need to keep track of which entries have entry counting enabled); \item sets the \catattr{entrycount} attribute to the supplied trigger for all the supplied categories; \item sets the \catattr{unitcount} attribute to the supplied counter for all the supplied categories; \item disables the document-wide counting command (which is incompatible). \end{itemize} If you use \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting} multiple times, the repeated instances will simply set the \catattr{entrycount} and \catattr{unitcount} attributes for the listed categories. The counter value is used as part of a label, which means that \thecountername\ needs to be expandable. Since \sty{hyperref} also has a similar requirement and provides \theHcountername\ as an expandable alternative, \sty{glossaries-extra} will use \theHcountername\ if it exists otherwise it will use \thecountername. The commands for accessing the totals, \gls{glsentrycurrcount} and \gls{glsentryprevcount} have different definitions with unit entry counting and will expand to the total for the current unit. The overall totals can be obtained with additional commands: \cmddef{glsentryprevtotalcount} This expands to the overall total from the previous \LaTeX\ run. \cmddef{glsentryprevmaxcount} This expands to the maximum per-unit total from the previous \LaTeX\ run. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting}\marg{\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{2}\marg{section} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \comment{\gloskeyval{category}{abbreviation}:} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{css}\marg{CSS}\marg{cascading style sheet} \codepar \comment{\gloskeyval{category}{general}:} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{sample}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \cmd{section}\marg{Sample} \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Used three times: \gls{gls}\marg{css} and \gls{gls}\marg{css} and \gls{gls}\marg{css}. \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample} \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{css}. \codepar Used twice: \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} As before, if the document is in a file called \filefmt{myDoc.tex} then the build process is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc pdflatex myDoc makeglossaries myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The result is: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:catunitentrycount}, title={Entry unit counting (per section) according to category}, description={Example document illustrating entry unit counting (per section)}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting}\marg{abbreviation}\marg{2}\marg{section}^^J% \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \% category=abbreviation:^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{HTML}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{css}\marg{CSS}\marg{cascading style sheet}^^J% \% category=general:^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{name={sample},description={an example}}^^J% } {% \cmd{section}\marg{Sample} \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Used three times: \gls{gls}\marg{css} and \gls{gls}\marg{css} and \gls{gls}\marg{css}. \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample} \codepar Used once: \gls{gls}\marg{css}. \codepar Used twice: \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} In this document, the CSS entry is used three times in the first section. This is more than the trigger value of 2, so \code{\gls{gls}\marg{css}} is expanded on \idx{firstuse} with the short form used on subsequent use, and the CSS entries in that section are added to the glossary. In the second section, the CSS entry is only used once, which trips the suppression trigger, so in that section, the long form is used and \code{\gls{gls}\marg{css}} doesn't get a line added to the glossary file. The HTML entry is used a total of three times, but the expansion and indexing suppression trigger is tripped in both sections because the per-unit total (1 for the first section and 2 for the second chapter) is less than or equal to the trigger value. The sample entry has only been used once, but it doesn't trip the indexing suppression because it's in the \cat{general} category, which hasn't been listed in \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting}. The per-unit entry counting can be used for other purposes. In the following example document, the trigger value is set to zero, which means the index suppression won't be triggered, but the unit entry count is used to automatically suppress the hyperlink for commands like \gls{gls} by modifying the \gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook} which is used at the end of the macro the determines whether or not to suppress the hyperlink. \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{makeglossaries} \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{0}\marg{page} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook}}\marg{\% \cmd{ifnum}\gls{glsentrycurrcount}\gls{glslabel}>0 \gls{setupglslink}\marg{hyper=false}\% \cmd{fi} } \codepar \cbeg{document} \codepar A \gls{gls}\marg{sample} entry. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \cmd{newpage} Next page: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Again: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This only produces a hyperlink for the first instance of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{sample}} on each page. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[pages={1,2}, label={ex:unitentrycounthyper}, arara={pdflatex,pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, title={Enabling unit counting to hook into hyperlink setting}, description={Example document that demonstrates how to automatically switch off the hyperlink using unit counting}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \gls{GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting}\marg{general}\marg{0}\marg{page}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{name={sample},description={an example}}^^J% \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook}}\marg{\%^^J \cmd{ifnum}\gls{glsentrycurrcount}\gls{glslabel}>0^^J \gls{setupglslink}\marg{hyper=false}\%^^J \cmd{fi}^^J% } } {A \gls{gls}\marg{sample} entry. Next use: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \cmd{newpage}^^J% Next page: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. Again: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The earlier warning about using the \ctr{page} counter still applies. If the first instance of \gls{gls} occurs at the top of the page within a paragraph that started on the previous page, then the count will continue from the previous page. \section{Link Counting} \label{sec:linkcount} As from version 1.26, an alternative method of entry counting is to count the number of times the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands are used. (The \qt{link} in this method's name refers to the use of the internal command \csfmt{@gls@link} not to \gls{hyperlink} although \csfmt{@gls@link} may use \gls{hyperlink} when displaying the \idx{linktext}.) To enable link counting use the preamble-only command: \cmddef{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting} where \meta{categories} is a list of category labels. The optional argument \meta{parent counter} may be used to identify a parent counter (which must already be defined). If present, the associated link counter will be reset when the parent counter is incremented. This command automatically sets the \catattr{linkcount} attribute for the given categories. If the optional argument is present, it also sets the \catattr{linkcountmaster} attribute. When enabled, the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands will increment the associated counter using \cmddef{glsxtrinclinkcounter} This just does \code{\gls{stepcounter}\margm{counter}} by default but if you need \gls{refstepcounter} instead, just redefine this command: \begin{codebox} \gls{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrinclinkcounter}}[1]\marg{\gls{refstepcounter}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} You can access the internal count register using: \cmddef{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue} where \meta{label} is the entry's label. This will expand to 0 if the register hasn't been defined. It's also possible to access the display value (\gls{thecounter}) using \cmddef{GlsXtrTheLinkCounter} (This will expand to 0 if the counter hasn't been defined.) \begin{important} In order to conserve resources, the counter is only defined when it first needs to be incremented so terms that have been defined but haven't been used in the document won't have the associated count register allocated. \end{important} You can test if the counter has been defined using: \cmddef{GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef} This expands to \meta{true} if the link counter associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} has been defined, otherwise expands to \meta{false}. The counter name can be obtained using \cmddef{GlsXtrLinkCounterName} This simply expands to the counter name associated with the entry given by \meta{entry-label} without any check for existence. For example, to change the display command (\gls{thecounter}) using \sty{etoolbox}: \begin{codebox} \gls{csdef}\marg{the\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterName}\marg{duck}}\% \marg{\gls{Roman}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterName}\marg{duck}}} \end{codebox} This is useful if you just want to change the display for specific entries but isn't convenient if you want to change the display for all entries. Instead, it's simpler to redefine \gls{GlsXtrTheLinkCounter}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GlsXtrTheLinkCounter}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef}\marg{\#1}\% \marg{\gls{Roman}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterName}\marg{\#1}}}\% \marg{0}\% } \end{codebox} In both cases, the redefinition should be implemented after \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting}. Here's an example document that uses link counting to disable the hyperlink after the first reference. This redefines \gls{glslinkpresetkeys} (which is used by both \gls{gls} and \gls{glstext}) instead of \gls{glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook} (which is used by \gls{gls} but not by \gls{glstext}). \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\% \cmd{ifnum}\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}>1 \gls{setupglslink}\marg{\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\% \cmd{fi} } \codepar \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting}\marg{\cat{general}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample1}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample1},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample2}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample2},\gloskeyval{description}{another example}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ex}\marg{ex}\marg{example} \codepar \cbeg{document} \cmd{section}\marg{Sample Section} \codepar \gls{Gls}\marg{sample1}, \gls{gls}\marg{sample2} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex}. \gls{Glstext}\marg{sample1} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex} again. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample Section} \codepar \gls{Gls}\marg{sample1}, \gls{gls}\marg{sample2} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex}. \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The use of \gls{glslinkpresetkeys} means that the options can override this. For example \begin{codebox} \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{hyper}{true}}\marg{sample1} \end{codebox} (or simply \code{\gls{gls}+\marg{sample1}}) will override the \glsoptval{hyper}{false} setting in \gls{glslinkpresetkeys}. If \gls{glslinkpostsetkeys} is used instead, the \glsoptval{hyper}{false} setting will override the setting provided in the optional argument. The resulting document is shown below: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:linkcount}, title={Link counting used to selectively suppress hyperlinks}, description={Example document that uses link counting to selectively suppress hyperlinks}] {% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\%^^J \cmd{ifnum}\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}>1^^J \gls{setupglslink}\marg{hyper=false}\%^^J% \cmd{fi} } \codepar \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting}\marg{general} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample1}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample1},\gloskeyval{description}{an example}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample2}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample2},\gloskeyval{description}{another example}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ex}\marg{ex}\marg{example} \codepar } {\cmd{section}\marg{Sample Section}^^J% \codepar \gls{Gls}\marg{sample1}, \gls{gls}\marg{sample2} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex}.^^J% \gls{Glstext}\marg{sample1} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex} again.^^J% \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample Section}^^J% \codepar \gls{Gls}\marg{sample1}, \gls{gls}\marg{sample2} and \gls{gls}\marg{ex}.^^J% \codepar \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The \cat{abbreviation} category doesn't have the \catattr{linkcount} attribute set (since it's not listed in the argument of \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting}). This means that \gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue} always expands to 0 for the abbreviation (\code{ex}), so the inequality test: \begin{codebox} \cmd{ifnum}\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}>1 \end{codebox} will always be false. This means that the abbreviation won't have \glsoptval{hyper}{false} applied. If the test is changed to \begin{codebox} \cmd{ifnum}\gls{GlsXtrLinkCounterValue}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}=1 \cmd{else} \gls{setupglslink}\marg{\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\% \cmd{fi} \end{codebox} Then the abbreviation will always have \glsoptval{hyper}{false} applied. To reset the counter every section use the optional argument to set the parent counter: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting}\oarg{section}\marg{\cat{general}} \end{codebox} \chapter{Multi (or Compound) Entries} \label{sec:multientries} Nested entries (where the entry definition references other entries) are discussed in \sectionref{sec:nested}. This chapter deals with occasions where a term or phrase may consist of multiple sub-terms that are independently defined. (Examples in \sectionref{sec:exskipfirstsuffix} and \sectionref{sec:exskippostlink} provide workarounds for nested entries.) For example, the names of bacteria, such as \emph{Clostridium botulinum} and \emph{Clostridium perfringens}, are made up of the genus (for example, \emph{Clostridium}) and the species (for example, \emph{botulinum} or \emph{perfringens}). The genus is often abbreviated after \gls{firstuse}. For example, \emph{C. botulinum}. However, if the name is defined as a single term consisting of both the genus and species then it's not possible to apply the abbreviation when a different species with the same genus is used. Consider the following document: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{cbot}\marg{C. botulinum}\marg{Clostridium botulinum} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{cperf}\marg{C. perfringens}\marg{Clostridium perfringens} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{gls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{gls}\marg{cperf}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} The result is: \begin{resultbox} Clostridium botulinum, C. botulinum, Clostridium perfringens. \end{resultbox} However, it should more typically be: \begin{resultbox} Clostridium botulinum, C. botulinum, C. perfringens. \end{resultbox} In this case, the genus should actually be a separate definition: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium} \gls{gls}\marg{botulinum}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium} \gls{gls}\marg{botulinum}, \gls{gls}\marg{clostridium} \gls{gls}\marg{perfringens}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} This is quite awkward to write. This chapter describes how to provide a shortcut for this kind of construct. Each term should be defined as normal (as in the above example), and a \qt{multi-entry} label is then defined with the list of labels of the entries that need to be referenced. \cmddef{multiglossaryentry} This defines a multi-entry set with the label \meta{multi-label}, consisting of the entries whose labels are listed in \meta{entry-label-list}, where the main entry (which must be present in \meta{entry-label-list}) is identified by \meta{main-label}. If \meta{main-label} is omitted, it's assumed to be the final label in \meta{entry-label-list}. The main entry is described in more detail in \sectionref{sec:mglsmain}. \begin{important} The entries in \meta{entry-label-list} must already be defined (using commands like \gls{newglossaryentry} or \gls{newabbreviation}). \end{important} The \meta{options} are a comma-separated list of options to override the current settings and are described in \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions}. The earlier example can now be modified to include the following: \begin{codebox} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens} \end{codebox} These commands must come after the \code{clostridium}, \code{botulinum} and \code{perfringens} definitions. Once defined, a multi-entry set can be referenced in the document using commands like: \cmddef{mgls} This command essentially does \code{\gls{gls}\margm{label}} for each item in the \meta{label list} (with separators, see \sectionref{sec:mglssep}). If the final optional argument \meta{insert} is provided, it will be applied to the final (non-skipped) element in the list. So the document body in the above example, can be rewritten as: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}. \end{codebox} There are some variants of \gls{mgls} listed in \sectionref{sec:mglslike}. The available \meta{options} are listed in \sectionref{sec:mglsopts}. They are applied after the \gls{multiglossaryentry} options and will override settings for the individual entries. \begin{important} You can't use \meta{multi-label} in commands like \gls{gls} as this label represents a set of entry labels not a single entry. \end{important} The \gls{multiglossaryentry} command will generate an error if the label has already been defined as a multi-entry. \cmddef{providemultiglossaryentry} This does nothing if a multi-entry set with the given label has already been defined otherwise it will act like \gls{multiglossaryentry}. Notes and associated commands applying to \gls{multiglossaryentry} also apply to \gls{providemultiglossaryentry} unless otherwise stated. \begin{important} \gls{multiglossaryentry} may be placed anywhere after the entries listed in \meta{label list} have been defined. A multi-entry label can't be referenced (with commands like \gls{mgls}) before it has been defined. \end{important} There is limited support for \optval{docdef}{true}. The multi-entry definition can be picked up from the \ext{aux} file on the next run to allow cross-references in any glossaries that occur at the start of the document. Any changes made with commands like \gls{mglsSetMain} won't be carried over to the next run. By default \gls{multiglossaryentry} will be localised to the current scope. If you want to globally define a multi-entry you need to first switch on global definitions with: \cmddef{multiglossaryentryglobaltrue} To switch back to local definitions use: \cmddef{multiglossaryentryglobalfalse} You can test if this setting is on with: \cmddef{ifmultiglossaryentryglobal} If you want to change the multi-entry options (locally) you can use: \cmddef{mglsSetOptions} This removes the original options and replaces them with \meta{new-options}. If you want to (locally) append to the existing options, use: \cmddef{mglsAddOptions} Note that \gls{multiglossaryentry} doesn't make any adjustments to the component entries. You will need to use the \gloskey{parent} key when you define the entries if you want a hierarchical structure in your \idx{glossary}. (See the example in \sectionref{sec:mglsexhier}.) If you don't want the other elements in the glossary, you can suppress the indexing with \mglsoptval{indexothers}{false} (\sectionref{sec:multiglsoptionsindexing}) or put them in an ignored glossary. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newignoredglossary}\marg{common} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{type}{common}}\marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \end{codebox} The \meta{multi-label} can't be used in commands like \gls{gls} since the label refers to a set of entry labels not to an individual entry. Similarly, an individual entry label can't be used in commands like \gls{mgls}. It is possible (although potentially confusing) to use the same label for a multi-entry as for an individual entry (see the example in \sectionref{sec:exskippostlink}). Context will determine which is meant, except in the case of the cross-referencing fields (\gloskey{see}, \gloskey{seealso} and \gloskey{alias}) where the cross-referenced label will first be tested if it's a known multi-entry label. If you don't want to have to keep track of which labels refer to multi-entries and which refer to individual entries you can use: \cmddef{GlsXtrMglsOrGls} where \meta{mgls cs} is the \gls{mgls}-like command to use if \meta{label} has been defined as a multi-entry and \meta{gls cs} is the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} command to use otherwise. The \meta{modifier} may be omitted, otherwise it's the modifier that may be used with \gls{mgls} or \gls{gls} (asterisk \code{*}, plus \code{+} or the token identified with \gls{GlsXtrSetAltModifier}). The modifier and remaining options are passed to the relevant command (\meta{mgls cs} or \meta{gls cs}). You may prefer to define your own shortcut commands for common combinations. For example, (assuming these commands haven't already been defined by the \opt{shortcuts} option): \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{ac}}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrMglsOrGls}\marg{\gls{mgls}}\marg{\gls{gls}}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{acp}}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrMglsOrGls}\marg{\gls{mglsmainpl}}\marg{\gls{glspl}}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{Ac}}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrMglsOrGls}\marg{\gls{Mgls}}\marg{\gls{Gls}}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{Acp}}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrMglsOrGls}\marg{\gls{Mglsmainpl}}\marg{\gls{Glspl}}} \end{codebox} \section{Examples} \label{sec:mglsexamples} \subsection{Example: Hierarchical} \label{sec:mglsexhier} Bacteria names are represented by the genus (for example, Clostridium) followed by the species (for example, botulinum). This example has the genus as a parent of the species. \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{latinname}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}} \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes} \marg{genus,species}\marg{\catattr{textformat},\catattr{glossnamefont}}\marg{latinname} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc}} \gls{newabbreviation} \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens}, \gloskeyval{category}{species},\gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{tetani}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{tetani},\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}\marg{\mglsoptval{indexothers}{false},\mglsoptval{hyper}{allmain}} \codepar \cbeg{document} First use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}. \codepar Next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This suppresses the indexing of the non-main elements (in this case, the genus). However the genus is included in the glossary (without a \gls{locationlist}) because it's the parent of the species (which are indexed). \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: hierarchical}, label={ex:multientryhier}, description={Example document with hierarchical multi-entries}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{latinname}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}^^J \marg{genus,species}\marg{textformat,glossnamefont}\marg{latinname}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{long-only-short-only-desc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J \marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{tetani}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{tetani},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}\marg{indexothers=false,hyper=allmain} } {% First use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The \mglsoptval{hyper}{allmain} option makes the entire content of each \gls{mgls} a hyperlink to the main entry in the glossary. \subsection{Example: Suffix} \label{sec:mglsexsuffix} This example has a minor modification to the previous one. In this case the multi-entries are defined with a suffix: \begin{codebox} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{\mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{botulism}}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{\mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{gas gangrene}}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{\mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{tetanus}}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani} \end{codebox} The rest of the document is as in \sectionref{sec:mglsexhier}. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: hierarchical with first-use suffix}, label={ex:multientryhierfirstusesuffix}, description={Example document with hierarchical multi-entries that have a first-use suffix}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{latinname}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}^^J \marg{genus,species}\marg{textformat,glossnamefont}\marg{latinname}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{long-only-short-only-desc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J \marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{tetani}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{tetani},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{firstsuffix=botulism}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{firstsuffix=gas gangrene}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{firstsuffix=tetanus}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}\marg{indexothers=false,hyper=allmain} } {% First use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \subsection{Example: Category Suffix} \label{sec:mglsexcatsuffix} This is an alternative to the previous example. Instead of storing the extra information in the \mglsopt{firstsuffix} key, the information is stored in the \gloskey{user1} key of the last element (the species). A category suffix is used to look up the field and append it. \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{user1}{botulism}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens},\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{user1}{gas gangrene}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{tetani}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{tetani},\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{user1}{tetanus}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}} \codepar \gls{mglsdefcategorysuffix}\marg{bacteria}\marg{\% \gls{mglsisfirstuse} \marg{\gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{useri}\marg{\gls{mglslastelementlabel}}\marg{ (\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue})}{}}\% \marg{}\% } \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani} \end{codebox} The result is the same as the previous example. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: hierarchical with category suffix}, label={ex:multientryhiercatsuffix}, description={Example document with hierarchical multi-entries that have a category suffix}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{latinname}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}^^J \marg{genus,species}\marg{textformat,glossnamefont}\marg{latinname}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{long-only-short-only-desc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J \marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{user1}{botulism},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{perfringens}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{perfringens},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{user1}{gas gangrene},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{tetani}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{tetani},\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{user1}{tetanus},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}^^J% \codepar \gls{mglsdefcategorysuffix}\marg{bacteria}\marg{\%^^J% \gls{mglsisfirstuse}^^J \marg{\gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{useri}\marg{\gls{mglslastelementlabel}}\marg{ (\gls{glscurrentfieldvalue})}{}}\%^^J \marg{}\%^^J% } \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{category=bacteria}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}\marg{indexothers=false,hyper=allmain} } {% First use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \subsection{Example: Separators} \label{sec:mglsexsep} The first example (\sectionref{sec:mglsexhier}) can be modified so that the species are also abbreviations. In this case, the separators are modified to suppress the space (\gls{relax}) if both the genus and species are abbreviated, or to use a \idx{nbsp} between the genus short form (shown on subsequent use) and the species long form (shown on \idx{firstuse}). If the genus is showing the long form (\idx{firstuse}) then a normal space is used. Note that the separator attributes apply to the category of the element before the separator (not to the multi-entry category). \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}\marg{\cmd{space}} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}\marg{\cmd{space}} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}\marg{\glssymbol{idx.nbsp}} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}\marg{\gls{relax}} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{species}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only-desc}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{botulinum}\marg{bot.}\marg{botulinum} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{perfringens}\marg{per.}\marg{perfringens} \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species}, \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{tetani}\marg{tet.}\marg{tetani} \end{codebox} This will cause a double dot at the end of the second sentence, which can be suppressed using the \catattr{discardperiod} and \catattr{retainfirstuseperiod} attributes. \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}\marg{species}\marg{\catattr{discardperiod},\catattr{retainfirstuseperiod}}\marg{true} \end{codebox} This works because the final element's \idx{postlinkhook} is transferred to the multi-entry post-link hook, which can detect the sentence terminating period. If the post-link hook settings are changed, for example, to \code{\mglsoptval{postlinks}{all},\mglsoptval{mpostlink}{false}} then the feature won't work as the final element's \idx{postlinkhook} can't detect the period (because \gls{gls} is embedded too deeply inside the internal workings of \gls{mgls}). \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: separators}, label={ex:multientrysep}, description={Example document demonstrating multi-entry separators}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {\cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{latinname}}[1]\marg{\cmd{emph}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}^^J \marg{genus,species}\marg{textformat,glossnamefont}\marg{latinname}^^J% \codepar \% multi-entry category attributes:^^J% \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{combinedfirstsepfirst}\marg{\cmd{space}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{combinedfirstsep}\marg{\cmd{space}}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{combinedsepfirst}\marg{\string~}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{genus}\marg{combinedsep}\marg{\gls{relax}}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{genus}\marg{long-only-short-only-desc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{genus},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J \marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{species}\marg{long-only-short-only-desc}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{botulinum}\marg{bot.}\marg{botulinum}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{perfringens}\marg{per.}\marg{perfringens}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{species},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{parent}{clostridium}}\marg{tetani}\marg{tet.}\marg{tetani}^^J% \gls{glssetcategoriesattributes}\marg{species}\marg{discardperiod,retainfirstuseperiod}\marg{true}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cperf}\marg{clostridium,perfringens}^^J% \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{ctet}\marg{clostridium,tetani}^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}\marg{indexothers=false,hyper=allmain} } {% First use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \codepar Next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{cbot}, \gls{mgls}\marg{cperf}, \gls{mgls}\marg{ctet}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \subsection{Example: Skipping Elements (Fragment Element)} \label{sec:exskipfirstsuffix} This example is an alternative way of dealing with nested links (see \sectionref{sec:nested}). \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{\glostyle{long}}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{ssi}\marg{server-side includes} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-sc-only}} \gls{newabbreviation} \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{combinedabbrv}, \gloskeyval{description}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{ssi} enabled \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html}}} \marg{shtml-frag}\marg{shtml}\marg{enabled} \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{multioptions} \marg{\mglsoptval{usedskipothers},\mglsoptvalm{firstsuffix}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{\gls{mglslastmainlabel}}}} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry} \oarg{\mglsoptval{category}{combinedabbrv}} \marg{shtml}\oarg{shtml-frag}\marg{ssi,shtml-frag,html} \codepar \cbeg{document} Individual elements first use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}{html}. \codepar Individual elements next use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsreset}\marg{shtml}: \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This uses the \catattr{multioptions} attribute to skip \qt{other} elements on subsequent use. The problematic abbreviation (SHTML) is defined as a fragment that simply expands to \qt{enabled} on first use. Note that the description has to be supplied for the glossary. The resulting document is shown below. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: skipping elements}, label={ex:multientryskip}, description={Example document demonstrating multi-entry sets with elements skipped}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods,style=long]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{ssi}\marg{server-side includes}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{combinedabbrv}\marg{long-only-short-sc-only}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{combinedabbrv},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{ssi} enabled \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html}}}^^J \marg{shtml-frag}\marg{shtml}\marg{enabled} \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{multioptions}^^J \marg{usedskipothers,firstsuffix=\marg{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{\gls{mglslastmainlabel}}}} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}^^J \oarg{category=combinedabbrv}^^J \marg{shtml}\oarg{shtml-frag}\marg{ssi,shtml-frag,html} \codepar } {Individual elements first use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}{html}. \codepar Individual elements next use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsreset}\marg{shtml}: \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} The key difference here from the example using \gls{glsps} at the end of \sectionref{sec:nested} is that the individual elements hyperlink to their respective entries in the glossary on first use of \gls{mgls}. The problem is that with the \optfmt{colorlinks} package option, it's not obvious where the hyperlinks start and end. The suffix (\textsc{shtml}) will hyperlink to the \qt{shtml} entry in the glossary, so the \qt{enabled} hyperlink is redundant. The simplest fix for this is to add \mglsoptval{hyper}{notmainfirst} to the option list, which will prevent \qt{enabled} from being a hyperlink. Another problem occurs where \gls{mgls} is used before the individual elements are used, which leads to their full expansion with a confusing amount of parentheses. A simple solution is to use the option \mglsoptval{mglsopts}{unsetothers}, which will unset the other (not-main) elements first. This can be localised with \mglsopt{presetlocal} but \gls{gls} will then unset the \idx{firstuseflag} globally, which means that the other elements won't show the full form when they are first used on their on after \gls{mgls}. This can be switched to a local unset with \mglsoptval{others}{local}. The complete set of options are now: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\catattr{multioptions}} \marg{\% \mglsoptval{hyper}{notmainfirst}, \mglsoptval{mglsopts}{\mglsopt{presetlocal},\mglsopt{unsetothers},\mglsoptval{others}{local}}, \mglsopt{usedskipothers}, \mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{\gls{mglslastmainlabel}}} } \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: skipping elements (unsetting others)}, label={ex:multientryskipunsetothers}, description={Example document demonstrating multi-entry sets with elements skipped and unset}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods,style=long]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{ssi}\marg{server-side includes}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\oarg{combinedabbrv}\marg{long-only-short-sc-only}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}^^J \oarg{\gloskeyval{category}{combinedabbrv},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{ssi} enabled \gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{html}}}^^J \marg{shtml-frag}\marg{shtml}\marg{enabled} \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\catattr{multioptions}}^^J \marg{\%^^J \mglsoptval{hyper}{notmainfirst},^^J \mglsoptval{mglsopts}{\mglsopt{presetlocal},\mglsopt{unsetothers},\mglsoptval{others}{local}},^^J \mglsopt{usedskipothers},^^J \mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{\gls{mglslastmainlabel}}}^^J% }^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}^^J \oarg{category=combinedabbrv}^^J \marg{shtml}\oarg{shtml-frag}\marg{ssi,shtml-frag,html} } {Individual elements first use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}{html}. \codepar Individual elements next use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsreset}\marg{shtml}: \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This method still has two main drawbacks: the description must be added manually and the long form can't be accessed with \gls{glsxtrlong}. The next example provides an alternative approach. \subsection{Example: Skipping Elements (Prefix and Post-Link Hooks)} \label{sec:exskippostlink} This is a modified version of the previous example. In this case, the main element isn't a fragment and also happens to have the same label as the multi-entry set. (\code{\gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}} references the multi-entry label and \code{\gls{gls}\marg{shtml}} references the individual entry.) In this case, the nested parts are marked up with custom commands: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{shtml} \marg{\marg{}\cmd{combinedpre}\marg{ssi} enabled \cmd{combinedpost}\marg{html}} \end{codebox} This means that it's no longer necessary to manually insert the description and the long form can be accessed as usual with \code{\gls{glsxtrshort}\marg{shtml}}. Note that it is necessary to define the custom commands robustly otherwise they will need to be protected against premature expansion: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{shtml} \marg{\marg{}\gls{protect}\cmd{combinedpre}\marg{ssi} enabled \gls{protect}\cmd{combinedpost}\marg{html}} \end{codebox} In both cases, an initial empty group is added to guard against any \idx{sentencecase} commands, such as \gls{Glsxtrlong}. The abbreviations all use the \abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user} style, which places the short form in the post-link hook on \idx{firstuse}. The \gls{gls} \idx{postlinkhook} for the main element can be transferred to the \gls{mgls} post-link using: \begin{codebox} \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main} \end{codebox} All elements have their individual post-link hooks suppressed by default. As in the previous example, the other elements can be skipped on subsequent use: \begin{codebox} \mglsopt{usedskipothers} \end{codebox} Within \gls{mgls}, the nested content needs to be suppressed, which can be done by redefining the custom commands. This can be done in the multi-entry prefix. Since the entire content of \gls{mgls} (except for the final multi-entry post-link hook) occurs inside a group, this redefinition will be localised. The complete document is as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}[\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{\glostyle{long}}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{makeglossaries} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-postshort-sc-user}} \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{ssi}\marg{server-side includes} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language} \codepar \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}} \codepar \cmd{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{shtml} \marg{\marg{}\cmd{combinedpre}\marg{ssi} enabled \cmd{combinedpost}\marg{html}} \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\catattr{multioptions}} \marg{\% \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main}, \mglsopt{usedskipothers} } \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry} \oarg{\mglsoptval{category}{combinedabbrv}} \marg{shtml}\oarg{shtml}\marg{ssi,shtml,html} \codepar \gls{mglsdefcategoryprefix}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\cmd{ignorespaces}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{unskip}}\% } \codepar \cbeg{document} Individual elements first use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Individual elements next use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual entry first use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsresetall}: \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsresetall}: \codepar Individual entry first use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. (Wrong!) \codepar \gls{printglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This now produces: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Multi-entries: skipping elements (prefix and post-link hooks)}, label={ex:multientryskipprefixpostlink}, description={Example document demonstrating multi-entry sets with elements skipped and prefix and post-link hooks}, arara={pdflatex,makeglossaries,pdflatex,pdfcrop}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[colorlinks]\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}[stylemods,style=long]\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \gls{makeglossaries}^^J% \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-postshort-sc-user}^^J% \codepar \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ssi}\marg{ssi}\marg{server-side includes}^^J% \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{html}\marg{html}\marg{hypertext markup language}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \cmd{newrobustcmd}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsps}\marg{\#1}}^^J% \codepar \cmd{newabbreviation}\marg{shtml}\marg{shtml}^^J% \marg{\marg{}\cmd{combinedpre}\marg{ssi} enabled \cmd{combinedpost}\marg{html}}^^J% \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{multioptions}^^J \marg{\%^^J mpostlinkelement=main,^^J usedskipothers^^J }^^J% \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}^^J \oarg{category=combinedabbrv}^^J \marg{shtml}\oarg{shtml}\marg{ssi,shtml,html}^^J% \codepar \gls{mglsdefcategoryprefix}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\%^^J \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\cmd{ignorespaces}}\%^^J \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{unskip}}\%^^J% } } {% Individual elements first use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \codepar Individual elements next use: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Individual entry first use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsresetall}:^^J% \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}.^^J% \codepar Resetting all\gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsresetall}:^^J% \codepar Individual entry first use: \gls{gls}\marg{shtml}.^^J% \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. (Wrong!)^^J% \codepar \gls{printglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Note the last two paragraphs, which highlights what happens if \code{\gls{gls}\marg{shtml}} is used before \code{\gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}} when neither of the other elements (\code{ssi} and \code{html}) have been used. The final instance of \gls{mgls} has produced the wrong result. This is because it's the first use of the multi-entry \code{shtml} but not the first use of the individual entry \code{shtml}. One way around this is to modify the prefix to ensure that the main element's \idx{firstuseflag} matches the multi-entry's first use flag: \begin{codebox} \gls{mglsdefcategoryprefix}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpre}}[1]\marg{\cmd{ignorespaces}}\% \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{combinedpost}}[1]\marg{\gls{unskip}}\% \gls{mglsisfirstuse} \marg{\gls{glslocalreset}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentmainlabel}}}\% \marg{\gls{glslocalunset}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentmainlabel}}}\% } \end{codebox} The \opteqvalref{showtargets}{annoteleft} option can be used to mark up the links with the targets. For example, the first instance of \code{\gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}} will show as: \begin{resultbox} \newcommand{\markup}[2]{% \glsshowtargetfonttext{[#1]}% \glsxtrshowtargetsymbolleft#2\glsxtrshowtargetsymbolright}% Multi-entry first use: \markup{glo:ssi}{\textsc{ssi}} \markup{glo:shtml}{enabled} \markup{glo:html}{\textsc{html}} (\textsc{shtml}). \end{resultbox} Each entry has an individual hyperlink to its own glossary item, which may be confusing. This can be made clearer by suppressing the main element link on first use with: \begin{codebox} \mglsoptval{hyper}{notmainfirst} \end{codebox} (as in the previous example), and adjusting the abbreviation style so that the parenthetical content in the post-link hook has a hyperlink: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtruserparen}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrfullsep}\marg{\#2}\% \gls{glsxtrparen} \marg{\gls{glshyperlink}\oarg{\#1}\marg{\#2}\% \gls{ifglshasfield}\marg{\gls{glsxtruserfield}}\marg{\#2}\marg{, \gls{glscurrentfieldvalue}}\marg{}\% }\% } \end{codebox} The remaining problem is how to deal with the possibility that \code{\gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}} may come before the \idx{firstuse} of the other elements. For example: \begin{codebox} Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \end{codebox} This leads to: \begin{resultbox} Multi-entry first use: server-side includes enabled hypertext markup language (\textsc{shtml}). Individual elements: \textsc{ssi} and \textsc{html}. \end{resultbox} This means that the abbreviations \textsc{ssi} and \textsc{html} aren't explained in the document text. One way around this is to only locally unset the other element \idxpl{firstuseflag}: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{combinedabbrv}\marg{\catattr{multioptions}} \marg{\% \mglsoptval{hyper}{notmainfirst}, \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main}, \mglsoptval{usedskipothers}, \mglsoptval{mglsopts}{\mglsoptval{others}{local}} } \end{codebox} With the above setting, the following: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsresetall}\gls{mglsresetall} \codepar Multi-entry first use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Multi-entry next use: \gls{mgls}\marg{shtml}. \codepar Individual elements: \gls{gls}\marg{ssi} and \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \end{codebox} will now produce: \begin{resultbox} Multi-entry first use: server-side includes enabled hypertext markup language (\textsc{shtml}). Multi-entry next use: \textsc{shtml}. Individual elements: server-side includes (\textsc{ssi}) and hypertext markup language (\textsc{html}). \end{resultbox} \section{Main and Other Elements} \label{sec:mglsmain} The list of labels provided in the final argument of \gls{multiglossaryentry} consists of a main element and all the other elements. If the main element isn't identified in the optional argument, it's assumed to be the final element in the list. The main element allows you to determine which target to use if you want the entire content of \gls{mgls} to be a single hyperlink. You can also use the settings described in \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions} to only index the main element. You can change the main element using: \gls{mglsSetMain} The new main label provided in the second argument must be in the list corresponding to \meta{multi-label}. This change is locally applied to the current scope. Note that if you are using \app{bib2gls}, this change in the document can't be detected. The main element can also be used to identify which element should be displayed in the plural with \gls{mglsmainpl}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{great}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{great},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{little}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{little},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{grebe}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{grebe},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{greatgrebe}\marg{great,grebe} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{littlegrebe}\marg{little,grebe} \end{codebox} In the above, two multi-entries are defined: \code{greatgrebe} and \code{littlegrebe}. In both cases the main element is \code{grebe} (the last element). Using \gls{mglspl} will show the plural for all elements, but using \gls{mglsmainpl} will only use the plural for the main element (grebe). For example: \begin{codebox} Plural all: \gls{mglspl}\marg{greatgrebe}, \gls{mglspl}\marg{littlegrebe}. Plural main: \gls{mglsmainpl}\marg{greatgrebe}, \gls{mglsmainpl}\marg{littlegrebe}. \end{codebox} produces: \begin{resultbox} Plural all: greats grebes, littles grebes. Plural main: great grebes, little grebes. \end{resultbox} \section{Prefixes and Suffixes} \label{sec:mglsfixes} A multi-entry may have associated prefixes and suffixes. These are scoped and are placed outside of the hyperlinks and encapsulating commands. They are not affected by case-changing commands, such as \gls{Mgls}. If you want a prefix to obey case-changing, use the \gls{mpgls}-like commands instead (\sectionref{sec:mpgls}). The prefix is inserted with: \cmddef{mglsprefix} The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{mglsprefix}}\marg{\% \gls{ifdefempty}\gls{mglscurrentcategory} \marg{\gls{mglscurrentprefix}}\% \marg{\% \gls{mglshascategoryprefix}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}\% \marg{\gls{mglsusecategoryprefix}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}}\% \marg{\gls{mglscurrentprefix}}\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} This will insert the current prefix unless there is prefix command associated with the current category. The suffix is inserted with: \cmddef{mglssuffix} This command is defined as follows: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{mglssuffix}}\marg{\% \gls{ifdefempty}\gls{mglscurrentcategory} \marg{\gls{ifdefempty}{\gls{mglscurrentsuffix}}\marg{}\marg{\cmd{space}(\gls{mglscurrentsuffix})}}\% \marg{\% \gls{mglshascategorysuffix}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}\% \marg{\gls{mglsusecategorysuffix}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifdefempty}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentsuffix}}\marg{}\marg{\cmd{space}(\gls{mglscurrentsuffix})}}\% }\% } \end{compactcodebox} If there is a suffix associated with the current category, that will be used, otherwise if the current suffix isn't empty this inserts a space followed by the current suffix in parentheses. You can access the label of the last (non-skipped) element with \gls{mglslastelementlabel}. Note that in both cases the category corresponds to the multi-entry category (see \sectionref{sec:multiglscategory}). To define a category-dependent prefix, use: \cmddef{mglsdefcategoryprefix} You can reference the current prefix with \gls{mglscurrentprefix} within \meta{definition}. To define a category-dependent suffix, use: \cmddef{mglsdefcategorysuffix} You can reference the current suffix with \gls{mglscurrentsuffix} within \meta{definition}. The default definition of \gls{mglsprefix} tests if there is a category prefix using: \cmddef{mglshascategoryprefix} This does \meta{true} if a prefix has been assigned to the given category, otherwise it does \meta{false}. If you need to obtain the prefix for a particular category, you can use: \cmddef{mglsusecategoryprefix} This expands to the prefix, if set, for the given category or to nothing otherwise. The default definition of \gls{mglssuffix} tests if there is a category suffix using: \cmddef{mglshascategorysuffix} This does \meta{true} if a suffix has been assigned to the given category, otherwise it does \meta{false}. If you need to obtain the suffix for a particular category, you can use: \cmddef{mglsusecategorysuffix} This expands to the suffix, if set, for the given category or to nothing otherwise. The current prefix \gls{mglscurrentprefix} and \gls{mglscurrentsuffix} are obtained as follows: \begin{itemize} \item if this is the first use of the multi-entry (\sectionref{sec:mglsfirstuse}) then the \meta{prefix} is set to the value of the \mglsopt{firstprefix} option and the \meta{suffix} is set to the value of the \mglsopt{firstsuffix} option; \item otherwise the \meta{prefix} is set to the value of the \mglsopt{usedprefix} option and the \meta{suffix} is set to the value of the \mglsopt{usedsuffix} option. \end{itemize} \begin{important} The prefix and suffix (if set) are placed outside of the hyperlink and text formatting encapsulator. They are not affected by case-changing commands such as \gls{Mgls} or \gls{MGLS}. \end{important} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-only-short-only}} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{clostridium}\marg{C.}\marg{Clostridium} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botulinum}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botulinum},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \codepar \gls{multiglossaryentry}\oarg{\mglsoptval{firstsuffix}{botulism}} \marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \end{codebox} On first use, this produces (assuming the \qt{clostridum} element hasn't been used previously): \begin{resultbox} Clostridium botulinum (botulism). \end{resultbox} On subsequent use, this produces: \begin{resultbox} C. botulinum. \end{resultbox} \section{Separators} \label{sec:mglssep} The separators between each instance of \gls{gls} are given by the following commands, which all take two arguments. The first argument is the label of the previous element. The second argument is the label of the following element. \cmddef{glscombinedsep} This is inserted between two entries that have both been marked as used. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}}\% \marg{ }% } \end{codebox} This will use the \catattr{combinedsep} attribute for the \meta{prev label}'s category, if set. Otherwise this just does a space. Note that this ignores the second argument. \cmddef{glscombinedfirstsep} This is inserted between two entries where only the next entry has been marked as used. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}}\% \marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% } \end{codebox} This will use the \catattr{combinedfirstsep} attribute for \meta{prev label}'s category, if set. If that attribute isn't set, \gls{glscombinedsep} is used. \cmddef{glscombinedsepfirst} This is inserted between two entries where only the previous entry has been marked as used. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}}\% \marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% } \end{codebox} This will use the \catattr{combinedsepfirst} attribute for \meta{prev label}'s category, if set. If that attribute isn't set, \gls{glscombinedsep} is used. \cmddef{glscombinedfirstsepfirst} This is inserted between two entries where both have been marked as used. The default definition is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}}\% \marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}\% } \end{codebox} This will use the \catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst} attribute for \meta{prev label}'s category, if set. If that attribute isn't set, \gls{glscombinedsep} is used. These commands may be redefined as required. For example, to have no space between two elements that have both been marked as used and are both abbreviations (disregarding category attributes): \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#1}\marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#2}\marg{}\marg{\cmd{space}}}\marg{\cmd{space}}\% } \end{codebox} There are some commands for redefining the above separators to common combinations. \cmddef{glssetcombinedsepabbrvnbsp} This does the following: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#1}\marg{\glssymbol{idx.nbsp}}\marg{ }}\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#1}\marg{\glssymbol{idx.nbsp}}\marg{ }}\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}}\% \marg{ }\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}}\% \marg{ }\% } \end{codebox} This uses a \idx{nbsp} following an abbreviation (that has already been marked as used). Note that if the associated attributes are set the commands will behave according to the attribute. \cmddef{glssetcombinedsepabbrvnone} \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsep}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#2}\marg{}\marg{ }}}\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedsepfirst}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{ }}\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsep}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsep}}}\% \marg{\gls{ifglshasshort}\marg{\#2}\marg{}\marg{ }}\% }\% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}\% \marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\#1}\marg{\catattr{combinedfirstsepfirst}}}\% \marg{ }\% } \end{codebox} This does nothing if either element are abbreviations that have already been used. Note that if the associated attributes are set the commands will behave according to the attribute. \cmddef{glssetcombinedsepnarrow} This is rather more complicated as it measures a field value and uses \meta{narrow-sep} if the width is less than \meta{width}. The field value is determined as follows: \begin{itemize} \item on \idx{firstuse} the \gloskey{long} field is used if it is set otherwise the \gloskey{first} field is used; \item otherwise the \gloskey{short} field is used if it is set otherwise the \gloskey{text} field is used; \end{itemize} Note that this doesn't take into account fonts, hooks, abbreviation styles or plural forms (e.g.\ \gls{mglspl}) or other field references (e.g.\ \gls{mglsname}). If the associated attributes are set the commands will behave according to the attribute. \section{\glsfmtname{mgls} Element Hooks} \label{sec:mglselementhooks} The \gls{mgls}-like commands use the following hooks: \cmddef{mglselementprehook} This is done before each (non-skipped) element. (Default does nothing.) \cmddef{mglselementposthook} This is done after each (non-skipped) element. (Default does nothing.) Note that this is different from the normal entry post-link hook \gls{glspostlinkhook}. If the individual entry post-link hook is enabled (see the \mglsopt{postlinks} key in \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions}), this will go before \gls{mglselementposthook}. The definitions of the following commands are scoped within the \gls{mgls}-like commands so they can't be accessed elsewhere (including in the post-link hook, see \sectionref{sec:mglspostlinkhook}). They may be used in the above hooks or in the separator commands (described in \sectionref{sec:mglssep}) or in the command used to encapsulate the entire content. They can also be used in the post-link hook (see \sectionref{sec:entryfmtmods}) to determine if an entry is being used within a \gls{mgls}-like command. \cmddef{mglscurrentmultilabel} Expands to the multi-entry label. \cmddef{mglscurrentmainlabel} Expands to the label of the main element. \cmddef{mglscurrentlist} Expands to the complete comma-separated list of elements. \cmddef{mglscurrentoptions} Expands to the options used when the multi-entry was defined. This doesn't include options set with \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup} or those passed to \gls{mgls} (or whichever variant is being used). \cmddef{mglscurrentcategory} Expands to the multi-entry category current in effect. \cmddef{glsxtrcurrentmglscsname} Expands to the control sequence name of the calling command (for example, \code{mgls} or \code{mglspl}). To test if the current multi-entry is the first use: \cmddef{mglsisfirstuse} This does \meta{true} if this is the first use otherwise it does \meta{false}. Note that this applies to the multi-entry first use flag not the \idxpl{firstuseflag} of the individual elements. At each iteration of the loop over the element list, the following commands are set, which can be accessed in hooks such as \gls{mglselementprehook} or in hooks used by the underlying \gls{gls} etc commands. For example, if \gls{mglscurrentlabel} is defined then \gls{gls} is being used inside \gls{mgls}. \cmddef{mglscurrentlabel} Expands to the current element label. \cmddef{mglselementindex} This is a count register that is set to the element index. \cmddef{mglscurrentprefix} Expands to the current multi-entry prefix. \cmddef{mglscurrentsuffix} Expands to the current multi-entry suffix. \cmddef{mglsiflast} If this is the last iteration, does \meta{true} otherwise does \meta{false}. This takes the skip options into account, so the last iteration may not necessarily be when the element index is equal to the total number of elements. \section{Post-Link Hook} \label{sec:mglspostlinkhook} There is a hook that occurs at the end the \gls{mgls}-like commands according to the \mglsopt{mpostlink} setting (see \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions}). The hook used depends on the \mglsopt{mpostlinkelement} option. These hooks can't access the commands described in \sectionref{sec:mglselementhooks} as the hook occurs outside of the scope in which they are defined. The \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{custom} option uses: \cmddef{mglscustompostlinkhook} This does nothing by default. The \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{last} option uses: \cmddef{mglslastelementpostlinkhook} which emulates the post-link hook of the last element. The \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main} option uses: \cmddef{mglslastmainpostlinkhook} which emulates the post-link hook of the main element. The default settings \code{\mglsoptval{postlinks}{none}, \mglsoptval{mpostlink}{true}, \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{last}} will suppress the individual element \idxpl{postlinkhook} (\gls{glspostlinkhook}) and do the multi-entry post-link hook for the last element (\gls{mglslastelementpostlinkhook}). If you have the final element's \idx{postlinkhook} enabled and the multi-entry post-link hook enabled (for example, \code{\mglsoptval{postlinks}{all}, \mglsoptval{mpostlink}{true}, \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{last}}), the final element's \idx{postlinkhook} will be done twice. Similarly for the main element with \code{\mglsoptval{postlinks}{all}, \mglsoptval{mpostlink}{true}, \mglsoptval{mpostlinkelement}{main}}. The following commands are available for use in these hooks and may also be used in the definition of \gls{mglssuffix}. \cmddef{mglslastmultilabel} Expands to the multi-entry label. \cmddef{mglslastcategory} Expands to the multi-entry category (see \sectionref{sec:multiglscategory}). This will be empty if no category was assigned. \cmddef{mglswasfirstuse} If that was the first use of the multi-entry (see \sectionref{sec:mglsfirstuse}) this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. \subsection{Last Element} \label{sec:mglspostlinkhooklastelement} The following commands relate to the last element. \cmddef{mglslastelementlabel} Expands to the label of the last non-skipped element. If all elements were skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will be empty. Test if the last element was skipped: \cmddef{mglsiflastelementskipped} If the last element was skipped this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. If all elements were skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{true}. Test if the last element was its first use: \cmddef{mglsiflastelementwasfirstuse} If the last non-skipped element was used for the first time this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. (Corresponds to \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}.) If all elements were skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{true}. Test if the last element was plural: \cmddef{mglsiflastelementwasplural} If the last non-skipped element had the plural form displayed, this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. (Corresponds to \gls{glsifplural}.) If all elements were skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{false}. Test if the last element was had any case-changing applied: \cmddef{mglsiflastelementcapscase} Corresponds to \gls{glscapscase} of the last non-skipped element. If all elements were skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{no-change}. \subsection{Main Element} \label{sec:mglspostlinkhookmainelement} The following commands relate to the main element. \cmddef{mglslastmainlabel} Expands to the label of the main element from the multi-entry that was just referenced. If the main element was skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will be empty. If this is the same as \gls{mglslastelementlabel} then the main element was the last element. Test if the main element was skipped: \cmddef{mglsiflastmainskipped} If the main element from the multi-entry that was just referenced was skipped this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. If the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{true}. Test if the main element was its first use: \cmddef{mglsiflastmainwasfirstuse} If the main element was used for the first time this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. (Corresponds to \gls{glsxtrifwasfirstuse}.) If the main element was skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{true}. Test if the main element was plural: \cmddef{mglsiflastmainwasplural} If the main element from the multi-entry that was just referenced had its plural form displayed this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. (Corresponds to \gls{glsifplural}.) If the main element was skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{false}. Test if the main element was had any case-changing applied: \cmddef{mglsiflastmaincapscase} Corresponds to \gls{glscapscase} of the main element from the multi-entry that was just referenced. If the main element was skipped or if the multi-entry wasn't defined, this will do \meta{no-change}. \section{Multi-Entry First Use} \label{sec:mglsfirstuse} Each multi-entry set has an associated first use flag. This is independent of the \idx{firstuseflag} associated with the individual entries that make up the set. As with the \idx{glslike} commands, \gls{mgls} unsets this flag. Unlike the \idx{glstextlike} commands, all the commands described in \sectionref{sec:mglslike} (including commands like \gls{mglsname}) unset this flag, even if the elements use commands like \gls{glsname} that don't unset the entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. You can determine whether or not a multi-entry set has been marked as used with: \cmddef{ifmglsused} This does \meta{true} if the given multi-entry has been marked as used, otherwise it does \meta{false}. You can (globally) unset the flag (mark the set as having been referenced) with: \cmddef{mglsunset} or reset it with: \cmddef{mglsreset} There are also local versions of these commands: \cmddef{mglslocalunset} which locally unsets the flag and \cmddef{mglslocalreset} which locally resets the flag. It's also possible to unset or reset all multi-entries. \cmddef{mglsunsetall} Unsets all multi-entries. \cmddef{mglsresetall} Resets all multi-entries. \begin{important} Note that unsetting or resetting any of the individual element \idxpl{firstuseflag} doesn't affect the multi-entry flag. Similarly, unsetting or resetting the multi-entry flag doesn't affect the \idxpl{firstuseflag} of the individual elements. \end{important} \section{Multi-Entry Category} \label{sec:multiglscategory} A multi-entry set may have an associated category set using the \mglsopt{category} key described in \sectionref{sec:multiglsoptions}. This isn't set by default, but if it is set the category may have attributes set in the usual way. The multi-entry category is independent of the individual entry categories. The following attribute is recognised by commands like \gls{mgls}: \optiondef{catattr.multioptions} The value are the default options to apply to any multi-entry set with the given category. These can be overridden by the first optional argument of \gls{multiglossaryentry} or by the \mglsopt{setup} key in the first optional argument of commands like \gls{mgls}. \optiondef{catattr.combinedfirstsep} The separator to use for \gls{glscombinedfirstsep}. \optiondef{catattr.combinedfirstsepfirst} The separator to use for \gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}. \optiondef{catattr.combinedsepfirst} The separator to use for \gls{glscombinedsepfirst}. \optiondef{catattr.combinedsep} The separator to use for \gls{glscombinedsep}. Note that you can't access the category or its attributes via the multi-entry label (for example, with \gls{glshasattribute}). If you need to access the current multi-entry's category within any of the \gls{mgls}-like hooks (\sectionref{sec:mglselementhooks}), you can obtain the category with \gls{mglscurrentcategory} and use commands like \gls{glshascategoryattribute}. \section{Multi-Entry Settings} \label{sec:multiglsoptions} The settings that govern all multi-entries can be set using: \cmddef{multiglossaryentrysetup} The \meta{options} are the same as for \gls{multiglossaryentry}. Whenever the \gls{mgls}-like commands are used, options are applied in the following order: \begin{enumerate} \item general options identified by \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}; \item the category key is assigned if it's in the general options, \gls{multiglossaryentry} or \mglsopt{setup} key; \item \catattr{multioptions} category attribute (if set); \item any options provided in the first optional argument of \gls{multiglossaryentry}; \item any options provided in the \mglsopt{setup} key in the first optional argument of the \gls{mgls}-like command. \end{enumerate} These options are described below. \subsection{Indexing} \label{sec:multiglsoptionsindexing} \optiondef{mglsopt.indexmain} This setting may take one of the following values: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{false}] don't index the main entry; \item[\optfmt{true}] index the main entry; \item[\optfmt{first}] only index the main entry if it's the \idx{firstuse} (of the main entry). \end{description} \optiondef{mglsopt.indexothers} This setting may take one of the following values: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{false}] don't index the other entries; \item[\optfmt{true}] index the other entries; \item[\optfmt{first}] only index the other entries if it's the \idx{firstuse} (of the non-main entry). \end{description} \subsection{Location Formats (Encaps)} \label{sec:multiglsoptionsencap} \optiondef{mglsopt.encapmain} This setting value should be the value to pass to \glsopt{format} option (\idx{locationencap}) for the main entry. \optiondef{mglsopt.encapothers} This setting value should be the value to pass to \glsopt{format} option (\idx{locationencap}) for the other (not main) entries. \subsection{Post-Link Hooks} \label{sec:multiglsoptionspostlink} \optiondef{mglsopt.postlinks} This setting determines whether or not to enable the individual element's \idx{postlinkhook}. The value may be one of: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{none}] suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for all elements; \item[\optfmt{all}] don't suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for all elements; \item[\optfmt{notlast}] only suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for the last element; \item[\optfmt{mainnotlast}] suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for all \qt{other} (not main) elements and for the last element (so only the main element will have its \idx{postlinkhook} as long as it's not the last element); \item[\optfmt{mainonly}] suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for all \qt{other} (not main) elements; \item[\optfmt{othernotlast}] suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for the main element and for the last element (so only the other elements will have their \idx{postlinkhook} as long as the element isn't the last one); \item[\optfmt{otheronly}] suppress the \idx{postlinkhook} for the main element. \end{description} \optiondef{mglsopt.mpostlink} This setting determines whether or not to enable the multi-entry post-link hook (see \sectionref{sec:mglspostlinkhook}). The value may be one of: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{false}] suppress the multi-entry post-link hook; \item[\optfmt{true}] enable the multi-entry post-link hook; \item[\optfmt{firstonly}] enable the multi-entry post-link hook only for the \idx{mfirstuse} of the multi-entry; \item[\optfmt{usedonly}] enable the multi-entry post-link hook only for the \idx{msubsequentuse} of the multi-entry. \end{description} \optiondef{mglsopt.mpostlinkelement} This setting indicates which post-link hook should be used if the multi-entry post-link hook has been enabled. Allowed values: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{last}] use \gls{mglslastelementpostlinkhook} (that is, use the \idx{postlinkhook} for the last element); \item[\optfmt{main}] use \gls{mglslastmainpostlinkhook} (that is, use the \idx{postlinkhook} for the main element); \item[\optfmt{custom}] use \gls{mglscustompostlinkhook}. \end{description} \begin{warning} Some combinations may cause a repeated hook. \end{warning} \subsection{Prefixes and Suffixes} \label{sec:multiglsoptionsfixes} See \sectionref{sec:mglsfixes} for more information on prefixes and suffixes. Note that the prefixes and suffixes are not affected by case-changing commands such as \gls{Mgls} or \gls{MGLS}. If you want a prefix to obey case-changing, use the \gls{mpgls}-like commands instead (see \sectionref{sec:mpgls}). \optiondef{mglsopt.firstprefix} The prefix to use on \idx{mfirstuse} of the multi-entry. \optiondef{mglsopt.usedprefix} The prefix to use on \idx{msubsequentuse} of the multi-entry. \optiondef{mglsopt.firstsuffix} The suffix to use on \idx{mfirstuse} of the multi-entry. \optiondef{mglsopt.usedsuffix} The suffix to use on \idx{msubsequentuse} of the multi-entry. \subsection{Skipping Elements} \label{sec:multiglsoptionsskip} \begin{information} The skip options apply to the multi-entry first use flag not the individual element first use. See \sectionref{sec:mglsfirstuse}. \end{information} \optiondef{mglsopt.firstskipmain} If \optfmt{true}, the main element will be omitted on (multi-entry) \idx{mfirstuse}. \optiondef{mglsopt.firstskipothers} If \optfmt{true}, the other (non-main) elements will be omitted on (multi-entry) \idx{mfirstuse}. \optiondef{mglsopt.usedskipmain} If \optfmt{true}, the main element will be omitted on (multi-entry) \idx{msubsequentuse}. \optiondef{mglsopt.usedskipothers} If \optfmt{true}, the other (non-main) elements will be omitted on (multi-entry) \idx{msubsequentuse}. Note that it is technically possible to set the skip options so that both the main and the other elements are skipped. However, by default, this will generate a warning and only the final optional argument (the \meta{insert}) will be displayed. There won't be a loop over all elements so the commands set at each iteration, such as \gls{mglscurrentlabel}, won't be defined. The warning and the insertion of the \meta{insert} is done by: \cmddef{glsxtrmglsWarnAllSkipped} where \meta{message} is the warning message and \meta{cs} is the control sequence that encapsulates the entire content (including hyperlink and the \mglsopt{textformat} setting, if enabled). If, for some particular reason, you want this scenario, you can redefine this command to omit the warning. \subsection{General} \label{sec:multiglsoptionsgeneral} \optiondef{mglsopt.multi.hyper} This setting may take one of the following values: \begin{description} \item[\optfmt{none}] no hyperlinks; \item[\optfmt{allmain}] encapsulate the entire content with a single hyperlink to the main entry's target; \item[\optfmt{mainonly}] only hyperlink the main entry; \item[\optfmt{individual}] hyperlink each entry individually; \item[\optfmt{otheronly}] only hyperlink the other entries; \item[\optfmt{notmainfirst}] don't hyperlink the main entry on \idxn{mfirstuse}; \item[\optfmt{nototherfirst}] don't hyperlink the other entries on \idxn{mfirstuse}; \item[\optfmt{notfirst}] don't hyperlink any entries on \idxn{mfirstuse}. \end{description} \optiondef{mglsopt.textformat} This setting value should be the control sequence name (without the leading backslash) of the command used to encapsulate the entire content. \optiondef{mglsopt.category} The category to apply to the multi-entry. This is independent of the categories of each of the elements. The default is no category. See \sectionref{sec:multiglscategory}. \optiondef{mglsopt.mglsopts} Default options to pass to commands like \gls{mgls}. Note that \mglsopt{setup} can't be used within this value. \section{\glsfmtname{mgls} Options} \label{sec:mglsopts} The \meta{options} for \gls{mgls} (and similar commands) are listed below. Any additional options provided will be appended to the \mglsopt{all} value. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\oarg{\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}}\marg{cbot} \end{codebox} is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\oarg{\mglsoptval{all}{\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}}}\marg{cbot} \end{codebox} Whereas: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\oarg{\glsoptval{counter}{chapter},\mglsoptval{all}{\glsoptval{counter}{section}}}\marg{cbot} \end{codebox} is treated as: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\oarg{\mglsoptval{all}{\glsoptval{counter}{section},\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}}}\marg{cbot} \end{codebox} which has the same effect as: \begin{codebox} \gls{mgls}\oarg{\mglsoptval{all}{\glsoptval{counter}{chapter}}}\marg{cbot} \end{codebox} \begin{information} The descriptions below reference \gls{gls} which is used internally by \gls{mgls}. Replace this with \gls{glspl} etc as applicable for the variants, such as \gls{mglspl}. \end{information} \optiondef{mglsopt.setup} The value should be a list of any options that can be passed to \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}. These options will override any conflicting options that were supplied to \gls{multiglossaryentry} or \gls{multiglossaryentrysetup}. Note that \mglsopt{mglsopts} can't be used within this value. \optiondef{mglsopt.all} The value should be a list of any options that can be passed to \gls{gls}. These options will be passed to each instance of \gls{gls} and will override any conflicting setting in \mglsopt{setup}. \optiondef{mglsopt.main} The value should be a list of any options that can be passed to \gls{gls}. These options will be passed to the instance of \gls{gls} used for the main label and will override any conflicting setting in \mglsopt{all}. \optiondef{mglsopt.others} The value should be a list of any options that can be passed to \gls{gls}. These options will be passed to each instance of \gls{gls} used for the other (not main) labels and will override any conflicting setting in \mglsopt{all}. \optiondef{mglsopt.hyper} A boolean option to determine whether or not to use hyperlinks (if supported). This may cause a conflict with other options, but is essentially provided to allow the starred version of \gls{mgls} to switch off all hyperlinks. \optiondef{mglsopt.multiunset} This only applies to the \idx{mfirstuseflag}, described in \sectionref{sec:mglsfirstuse}, not the \idxpl{firstuseflag} of the elements. The value may be one of: \begin{description} \item \optfmt{global} globally unset the flag; \item \optfmt{local} locally unset the flag; \item \optfmt{none} don't unset the flag. \end{description} \optiondef{mglsopt.presetlocal} A boolean option that governs whether or not the following options should have a local or global effect. \optiondef{mglsopt.resetall} A boolean option to determine whether or not to reset all elements \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. This option refers to the individual entry's \idx{firstuseflag} not the \idx{mfirstuseflag}. (This is similar to passing \glsopt{prereset} to each \gls{gls} but it's also applied to any skipped elements.) \optiondef{mglsopt.resetmain} A boolean option to determine whether or not to reset the main entry's \idx{firstuseflag} \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. \optiondef{mglsopt.resetothers} A boolean option to determine whether or not to reset the \idx{firstuseflag} of all the other (not main) elements \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. \optiondef{mglsopt.unsetall} A boolean option to determine whether or not to unset all elements \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. This option refers to the individual entry's \idx{firstuseflag} not the \idx{mfirstuseflag}. (This is similar to passing \glsopt{preunset} to each \gls{gls} but it's also applied to any skipped elements.) \optiondef{mglsopt.unsetmain} A boolean option to determine whether or not to unset the main entry's \idx{firstuseflag} \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. \optiondef{mglsopt.unsetothers} A boolean option to determine whether or not to unset the \idx{firstuseflag} of all the other (not main) elements \emph{before} using \gls{gls}. The \optfmt{reset\ldots} options all use: \cmddef{mglselementreset} The \optfmt{unset\ldots} options all use: \cmddef{mglselementunset} These take the \mglsopt{presetlocal} into account. An alternative way of resetting the other elements is to use: \cmddef{mglsunsetothers} or for a local reset: \cmddef{mglslocalunsetothers} \section{Variants of \glsfmtname{mgls}} \label{sec:mglslike} The commands listed in this section all behave like \gls{mgls}. These (including \gls{mgls} itself) are collectively referred to as the \gls{mgls}-like commands. All commands unset the \idx{mfirstuseflag} (unless the \mglsoptval{multiunset}{none} option is applied). Only those commands that use the \idx{glslike} commands (such as \gls{gls} or \gls{glspl}) will unset the individual entry's \idx{firstuseflag}. \subsection{\glsfmtname{gls}-like} \label{sec:mglsbasic} \cmddef{mglspl} This uses \gls{glspl} instead of \gls{gls} for each entry. \cmddef{mglsmainpl} This uses \gls{glspl} instead of \gls{gls} for the main entry and \gls{gls} for all the other entries. \cmddef{Mgls} This uses \gls{Gls} for the first entry and \gls{gls} for the other entries. \cmddef{MGls} This uses \gls{Gls} for all entries. \cmddef{Mglspl} This uses \gls{Glspl} for the first entry and \gls{glspl} for the remaining entries. \cmddef{Mglsmainpl} The first entry uses the appropriate \idx{sentencecase} command. The plural form is used for the main entry. So, if the first entry is also the main entry, \gls{Glspl} is used, otherwise \gls{Gls} is used. For the remaining entries, \gls{glspl} will be used if the entry is the main one, otherwise \gls{gls} will be used. \cmddef{MGlspl} This uses \gls{Glspl} for all entries. \cmddef{MGlsmainpl} This uses \gls{Glspl} for the main entry and \gls{Gls} for the other entries. \cmddef{MGLS} This uses \gls{GLS} for all entries. \cmddef{MGLSpl} This uses \gls{GLSpl} instead of \gls{gls} for each entry. \cmddef{MGLSmainpl} This uses \gls{GLSpl} for the main entry and \gls{GLS} for the others. \subsection{Abbreviations} \label{sec:mglsabbrv} \cmddef{mglsshort} This will use \gls{glsxtrshort} for any entries that have the \gloskey{short} field set and will use \gls{glstext} otherwise. \cmddef{mglslong} This will use \gls{glsxtrlong} for any entries that have the \gloskey{long} field set and will use \gls{glstext} otherwise. \cmddef{mglsfull} This will use \gls{glsxtrfull} for any entries that have the \gloskey{short} field set and will use \gls{glsfirst} otherwise. \cmddef{Mglsshort} As \gls{mglsshort} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first entry. \cmddef{Mglslong} As \gls{mglslong} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first entry. \cmddef{Mglsfull} As \gls{mglsfull} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first entry. \subsection{Other Fields} \label{sec:mglsotherfields} \cmddef{mglsname} This uses \gls{glsname} for each entry. \cmddef{Mglsname} This uses \gls{Glsname} for the first entry and \gls{glsname} for the remaining entries. \cmddef{MGlsname} This uses \gls{Glsname} for each entry. \cmddef{mglssymbol} This uses \gls{glssymbol} for each entry if the \gloskey{symbol} field has been set, otherwise it uses \gls{gls}. \cmddef{MGlssymbol} This uses \gls{glssymbol} if the \gloskey{symbol} field has been set otherwise it uses \gls{Gls} for each element. (Note that no \idx{casechange} is applied to the symbol as this usually isn't appropriate.) \cmddef{Mglssymbol} As \gls{MGlssymbol}, but \gls{Gls} is only used for the first element (if it doesn't have the \gloskey{symbol} field set). \cmddef{mglsusefield} If the field given by \gls{mglsfield} exists for an element, \gls{glsdisp} will be used for that element, with the \idx{linktext} obtained from the field value (followed by the \meta{insert}), otherwise \gls{gls} will be used. \cmddef{mglsfield} This command expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} required by \gls{mglsusefield}. The default value is \code{useri}, which corresponds to the \gloskey{user1} key. \cmddef{Mglsusefield} As \gls{mglsusefield} but \idx{sentencecase} for the first element. \cmddef{MGlsusefield} As \gls{mglsusefield} but \idx{sentencecase} for each element. You can use the pre-element hook \gls{mglselementprehook} to locally redefine \gls{mglsfield}. Examples: \begin{enumerate} \item if the multi-category is \qt{sample} then use the \gloskey{user2} field otherwise use the \gloskey{user1} field: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglselementprehook}}\marg{\% \cmd{ifdefstring}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}\marg{sample}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{userii}}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{useri}}\% } \end{codebox} \item if the element's category is \qt{sample} then use the \gloskey{user2} field otherwise use the \gloskey{user1} field: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglselementprehook}}\marg{\% \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentlabel}}\marg{sample}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{userii}}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{useri}}\% } \end{codebox} \item if either the multi-entry's category or the element's category has the custom attribute \qt{mglsfield} set then use it otherwise use the \gloskey{user1} field: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglselementprehook}}\marg{\% \gls{glshascategoryattribute}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}\marg{mglsfield}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{\gls{glsgetcategoryattribute}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentcategory}}\marg{mglsfield}}}\% \marg{\% \gls{glshasattribute}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentlabel}}\marg{mglsfield}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{\gls{glsgetattribute}\marg{\gls{mglscurrentlabel}}\marg{mglsfield}}}\% \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{mglsfield}}\marg{useri}}\% }\% } \end{codebox} \end{enumerate} \subsection{Support for \glsfmtname{pkg.glossaries-prefix} (\glsfmtname{pgls})} \label{sec:mpgls} If you load the \sty{glossaries-prefix} package (either after \sty{glossaries-extra}) or with the \opt{prefix} package option, then the following commands will use one of the \gls{pgls}-like commands provided by that package. (See the \sty{glossaries} user manual for further details.) If the \sty{glossaries-prefix} package hasn't been loaded then \gls{gls} (or analogous case-changing variant) will be used instead and a warning is issued with: \cmddef{mpglsWarning} This may be redefined to do nothing to remove the warning. \cmddef{mpgls} Uses \gls{pgls} for the first element and \gls{gls} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{mpglspl} Uses \gls{pglspl} for the first element and \gls{glspl} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{mpglsmainpl} Only uses the plural form for the main element. The first element uses the prefixing command (\gls{pgls} or \gls{pglspl}, depending on whether the first element is the main element). \cmddef{Mpgls} Uses \gls{Pgls} for the first element and \gls{gls} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{Mpglsmainpl} Only uses the plural form for the main element. The first element uses the \idx{sentencecase} prefixing command (\gls{Pgls} or \gls{Pglspl}, depending on whether the first element is the main element). \cmddef{MPGls} Uses \gls{Pgls} for the first element and \gls{Gls} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{MPGlspl} Uses \gls{Pglspl} for the first element and \gls{Glspl} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{MPGlsmainpl} Only uses the plural form for the main element. The first element uses the prefixing command (\gls{Pgls} or \gls{Pglspl}, depending on whether the first element is the main element). All elements are use \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{MPGLS} Uses \gls{PGLS} for the first element and \gls{GLS} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{MPGLSpl} Uses \gls{PGLSpl} for the first element and \gls{GLSpl} for the remaining elements. \cmddef{MPGLSmainpl} Only uses the plural form for the main element. All elements are converted to \idx{allcaps}. The first element uses the prefixing command (\gls{PGLS} or \gls{PGLSpl}, depending on whether the first element is the main element). \section{Cross-References} \label{sec:msee} Multi-entry labels may be used in the cross-referencing keys \gloskey{see} and \gloskey{seealso}. The formatting command will use: \cmddef{mglsseefirstitem} for the first item in the list (if it's a multi-entry) and \cmddef{mglsseeitem} for any subsequent items that are multi-entries. The default definition of \gls{mglsseeitem} is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{mglsseeitem}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{mglsname}\oarg{\mglsoptval{all}{noindex},\mglsoptvalm{setup}{hyper=allmain}}\marg{\#1}\% } \end{compactcodebox} This switches off indexing, sets the hyperlink to encompass the entire multi-entry content and uses the \gloskey{name} field. The default definition of \gls{mglsseefirstitem} is simply \gls{mglsseeitem}. For example, to use the \gloskey{short} or \gloskey{text} fields: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{mglsseeitem}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{mglsshort}\oarg{\mglsoptval{all}{noindex},\mglsoptvalm{setup}{hyper=allmain}}\marg{\#1}\% } \end{compactcodebox} A multi-entry label may also be used in the \gloskey{alias} key. The hyperlink target will be the target for the main entry. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{multiglossaryentry}\marg{cbot}\marg{clostridium,botulinum} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{botox}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{botox},\gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{alias}{cbot}} \end{codebox} In this case \code{\gls{gls}\marg{botox}} will hyperlink to the \code{botulinum} target. \begin{important} Any multi-entries used in the cross-referencing keys must be defined before the glossary is displayed. There is some support for \optval{docdef}{true} but not for the other \opt{docdef} settings. \end{important} \section{Additional Commands} \label{sec:multiextras} You can test if a label represents a multi-entry using: \cmddef{glsxtrifmulti} This does \meta{true} if a multi-entry has been defined with the label \meta{multi-label} otherwise it does \meta{false}. \cmddef{glsxtrmultimain} Expands to the main entry label for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label} or nothing if not defined. \cmddef{glsxtrmultilist} Expands to the list of element labels for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label} or nothing if not defined. \cmddef{mglsforelements} Iterates over all the list of element labels for the multi-entry identified by \meta{multi-label}. This defines \meta{cs} to the current element label on each iteration of the loop, which can be used to reference the label in \meta{body}. This internally uses \gls{@for} (patched by the \sty{xfor} package, which allows the loop to be broken). \cmddef{mglsforotherelements} As \gls{mglsforelements} but skips the main entry label. \cmddef{glsxtrmultitotalelements} Expands to the total number of elements in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined. \cmddef{glsxtrmultimainindex} Expands to the index of the main element in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined. Indexing starts from 1 for the first element. \cmddef{glsxtrmultilastotherindex} Expands to the index of the final non-main element in the given multi-entry or nothing if \meta{multi-label} hasn't been defined. The \gls{multiglossaryentry} command will write the label information to the \ext{aux} file using: \cmddef{writemultiglossentry} This is will write the following line to the \ext+{aux} file: \cmddef{@glsxtr@multientry} This is provided to support \optval{docdef}{true} and also for the benefit of any tools that require the information (such as \app{bib2gls} or autocompletion tools). If it's not required and causes too much clutter, it can be disabled by redefining \gls{writemultiglossentry} to do nothing. \section{\glsfmtname{app.bib2gls}} \label{sec:mbib2gls} In the \app{bib2gls} v2.9+ user manual, these multi-entry sets are referred to as \qt{compound entries} or \qt{compound sets} to differentiate them from \app{bib2gls}['s] multi-entry types (such as \atentry{dualentry}). Each instance of one of the \gls{mgls}-like commands is written to the \ext{aux} file and so can be picked up by \app{bib2gls} (at least version 2.9). The \idx{resourceopt} can be used to determine whether or not to consider the other (non-main) elements to be dependent on the main element. With \app{bib2gls}, you can either define the compound entries in the document with \gls{multiglossaryentry} (or \gls{providemultiglossaryentry}) or you can use the \atentry{compoundset} entry type in a \ext{bib} file. Whichever method you use, remember that the entries that form the elements of the set must be defined first. See the \app{bib2gls} manual (v2.9+) for further details. You can use the resource option \resourceopt{compound-adjust-name} to replace the \gloskey{name} field of the main entry to: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} where \meta{multi-label} is the label identifying the compound set, \meta{name} was the value of the \gloskey{name} before adjustment, \meta{sublist1} is the sub-list of other element labels before the main element (empty if the main element is the first element in the list), and \meta{sublist2} is the sub-list of other elements after the main element (empty if the main label is the final element). This command is defined in \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls}, which is automatically loaded with \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}. Case-changing versions of this command are also available. \cmddef{Glsxtrmultientryadjustedname} This is a \idx{sentencecase} version of \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname}. \cmddef{GlsXtrmultientryadjustedname} This is a \idx{titlecase} version of \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname}. \cmddef{GLSxtrmultientryadjustedname} This is an \idx{allcaps} version of \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustedname}. Note that the above commands don't take the prefix or suffix into account (see \sectionref{sec:mglsfixes}). The separator between each element in the sub-lists is produced with: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustednamesep} The default definition just uses \gls{glscombinedfirstsepfirst}. The separator between the last element of \meta{sublist1} and the main element is produced with: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustednamepresep} Similarly for the separator between the main element and the first element of \meta{sublist2}: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustednamepostsep} These both default to \gls{glsxtrmultientryadjustednamesep}. The \meta{name} is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt} This just does its argument by default. If \meta{sublist1} is empty for the \idx{sentencecase} version, then \meta{name} is encapsulated with: \cmddef{Glsxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt} This does \gls{makefirstuc}\marg{text} by default. For the \idx{titlecase} version, the name is encapsulated with: \cmddef{GlsXtrmultientryadjustednamefmt} This uses \gls{glscapitalisewords}, if defined, or \gls{capitalisewords} otherwise. The \idx{allcaps} version uses: \cmddef{GLSxtrmultientryadjustednamefmt} This uses \gls{mfirstucMakeUppercase} by default. Each element label in the sub-lists is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsxtrmultientryadjustednameother} This does \code{\gls{glsentryname}\margm{label}} by default. For the \idx{sentencecase} version (where \meta{sublist1} isn't empty), then the element label is encapsulated with: \cmddef{Glsxtrmultientryadjustednameother} This does \code{\gls{Glsentryname}\margm{label}} by default. The \idx{titlecase} version uses: \cmddef{GlsXtrmultientryadjustednameother} This does \code{\gls{glsentrytitlecase}\margm{label}\marg{name}} by default. The \idx{allcaps} version uses: \cmddef{GLSxtrmultientryadjustednameother} This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{GLSxtrmultientryadjustednameother}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{mfirstucMakeUppercase}\marg{\gls{glsentryname}\marg{\#1}}} \end{compactcodebox} \chapter{Defining and Displaying Glossaries} \label{sec:glossaries} As with the base \sty{glossaries} package, you need to establish the indexing method in the preamble and use the appropriate \csmetafmt{print}{\ldots}{glossary} command. For example, to use the \qt{noidx} method you need \gls{makenoidxglossaries} in the preamble and \gls{printnoidxglossary} in the document. Whereas if you want to use \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}, you need \gls{makeglossaries} in the preamble and \gls{printglossary} in the document. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides a hybrid approach: \cmddef{makeglossaries} If the optional argument is present, then \meta{types} should be a comma-separated list of \idx{glossary} labels that should be processed by \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy} as per the normal behaviour of \gls{makeglossaries}. Any non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} that are not listed in \meta{types} should be treated as though \gls{makenoidxglossaries} was used. This means that the \idxpl{glossary} listed in \meta{types} should be displayed using \gls{printglossary} and the other (non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary}) should be displayed with \gls{printnoidxglossary}. See \file{sample-mixedsort.tex} for an example. If the optional argument is omitted, it will be treated as per the original \gls{makeglossaries} provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package. If the optional argument is present, \gls{glsindexingsetting} will be set to \code{makeindex-noidx} or \code{xindy-noidx}, depending on whether \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy} should be used. \begin{information} \Idxpl{glossary} can't be defined after \gls{makeglossaries}. This ensures that all the required \idx{indexing} files are opened. If you're not using \gls{makeglossaries}, \idxpl{glossary} need to be defined before any entries that should belong to them are defined. \end{information} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides \gls{newignoredglossary} to define an \idx{ignoredglossary} that doesn't have any associated \idx{indexing} files. This will automatically switch off hyperlinks for any entries assigned to the \idx{glossary} (since there will be no target). With \sty{glossaries-extra}, it's possible to have targets without using the \idx{indexing} methods provided by the base package. For example, it's possible to have standalone entries (see \sectionref{sec:glossentry}) or targets can be created with \gls{printunsrtglossary}, so \sty{glossaries-extra} provides a starred version. \cmddef{newignoredglossary*} This behaves like the unstarred version but doesn't disable hyperlinks. The \idx{glossary} will still be omitted by iterative commands, such as \gls{printunsrtglossaries}, and can't be used with \gls{printglossary} or \gls{printnoidxglossary}. If you use an \idx{ignoredglossary} with \gls{printunsrtglossary}, you will need to use the \printglossopt{title} option to override the default title, if required. \cmddef{provideignoredglossary} This is like \gls{newignoredglossary} but does nothing if the \idx{glossary} has already been defined. With the \idx{indexing} options provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package, if you want a term to appear in more than one \idx{glossary}, it's necessary to define a duplicate entry with a different label. With the \idx{unsrtfam}, the same entry can appear in multiple \idxpl{glossary}. This can be done by simply copying the entry's label to the required \idx{glossary} using: \cmddef{glsxtrcopytoglossary} This just adds the label to the target \idx{glossary}['s] internal comma-separated list that commands like \gls{printunsrtglossary} iterate over. The unstarred version locally adds the label. The starred version performs a global change. \begin{warning} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary} is not compatible with \opteqvalref{docdef}{true}. \end{warning} Note that the \gloskey{type} field will still be set to the original \idx{glossary}. This is considered the entry's primary glossary. There's no field that keeps track of the additional \idxpl{glossary} the entry has been copied to. If used with \gls{printglossary} or \gls{printnoidxglossary}, the entry will only be \indexed\ for its primary \idx{glossary}. It won't show up in the other \idxpl{glossary}, but will be found when using an iterative command, such as \gls{glsaddall}, over the target \idx{glossary}. You can test if an entry has already been added to a \idx{glossary} with: \cmddef{GlsXtrIfInGlossary} This does \meta{true} if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} is in the internal list of the \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{glossary-type}, otherwise it does \meta{false}. If the \idx{glossary} doesn't exist, this does \meta{false} and will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}). This command considers \idxpl{ignoredglossary} as existing. You can test if a \idx{glossary} is empty with: \cmddef{glsxtrifemptyglossary} This does \meta{true} if the glossary identified by \meta{glossary-type} is empty, otherwise does \meta{false}. If the \idx{glossary} doesn't exist, this does \meta{true} and will either generate an error (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{error}) or a warning (\opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}). This command considers \idxpl{ignoredglossary} as existing. To test for the existence of a \idx{glossary}, you can use \gls{ifglossaryexists} and \gls{doifglossarynoexistsordo}, which are documented in the \qt{Conditionals} section of the \sty{glossaries} user manual. The base \sty{glossaries} package provides \gls{forallglossaries} to iterate over a list of \idxpl{glossary} labels (all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} by default). This can also be used with \sty{glossaries-extra} but \gls{forallacronyms} is only for \idxpl{glossary} that have been declared as lists of acronyms, so it's inappropriate with the \sty{glossaries-extra} package. Instead, you can use the analogous command: \cmddef{forallabbreviationlists} Each instance of \gls{newabbreviation} will add the abbreviation's associated \idx{glossary} (identified by the \gloskey{type} key) to the internal list of labels (if not already added). Note that this won't take into account any \idxpl{glossary} that had abbreviations copied or moved to it. \section{Entry Page Reference} \label{sec:glspageref} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides \gls{glsrefentry}, which uses \gls{ref} to reference the entry's associated counter (enabled with \opt{entrycounter} or \opt{subentrycounter}, not the \idx{locationcounter}). The \sty{glossaries-extra} package additionally provides: \cmddef{glsxtrpageref} This works in the same way but uses \gls{pageref} instead of \gls{ref}. As with \gls{glsrefentry}, if the corresponding counter has not been enabled, this just does \code{\gls{gls}\margm{entry-label}}. \section{Glossary Preamble} \label{sec:glospreamble} The base package provides \gls{glossarypreamble}, which is used at the start of the \idx{glossary}. By default, this will use the preamble associated with the current \idx{glossary}. If you redefine \gls{glossarypreamble}, this will set the preamble for all glossaries. To set the preamble for a particular glossary, you can use \gls{setglossarypreamble}. With \sty{glossaries-extra}, you can additionally append to an existing preamble using: \cmddef{apptoglossarypreamble} This (locally) appends \meta{text} to the preamble for the \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{type}. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed. \cmddef{pretoglossarypreamble} This (locally) prepends \meta{text} to the preamble for the \idx{glossary} identified by \meta{type}. If \meta{type} is omitted, \gls{glsdefaulttype} is assumed. \section{Options} \label{sec:printglossopts} In addition to the \idxc{printglossopt}{options} available with \gls{printglossary}, the following options are also provided. Some of these listed here are specific to \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \env{printunsrtglossarywrap}. Options provided by the base package that aren't available for the \idx{unsrtfam} are identified below. \optiondef{printgloss.sort} This option is only available for \gls{printnoidxglossary}. The \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary} commands simply iterate over the \idx{glossary}['s] internal list in the order in which the entries have been added to that \idx{glossary}. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, use the \resourceopt{sort} resource option instead. \optiondef{printgloss.title} This option is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to override the default title for the \idx{glossary}. This option is also available for \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} but not for \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.toctitle} This option is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to override the default table of contents title for the \idx{glossary}. This option is also available for \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} but not for \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.numberedsection} This option is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to indicate whether or not the section header used at the start of the \idx{glossary} should be numbered rather than unnumbered (and whether or not to automatically label the glossary with \code{\gls+{label}\marg{\gls{glsautoprefix}\meta{glossary-type}}}). The \opt{numberedsection} package option will change the default setting to match. This option is not available for \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.style} This option is provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to set the \idx{glossarystyle}. This option is not available for \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.label} This option is provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} to add \code{\gls+{label}\margm{label}} after the section header. This is essentially like \optval{numberedsection}{nameref} but you supply the label. This option is not available for \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}. Alternatively, you can use: \cmddef*{glsxtrsetglossarylabel} This will need to be scoped or changed between \idxpl{glossary} or use a command in \meta{label} that expands differently for each \idx{glossary} to avoid duplicate labels. \begin{information} If the supplied value is empty, the label is suppressed (without otherwise altering the \opt{numberedsection} setting). \end{information} \optiondef{printgloss.leveloffset} This option sets or increments the \idx{hierarchicallevel} offset. If \meta{offset} starts with \code{++} then the current offset is incremented by the given amount otherwise the current offset is set to \meta{offset}. For example, an entry with a normal \gls{hierarchicallevel} of 1 will be treated as though it has \gls{hierarchicallevel} $1+\meta{offset}$. Note that the \idx{glossarystyle} may not support the resulting \idx{hierarchicallevel}. This option is only available for the \idx{unsrtfam} and the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment. See \sectionref{sec:printunsrtinner} for an example. \optiondef{printgloss.flatten} Treats all entries as though they have the same \idx{hierarchicallevel} (the value of \printglossopt{leveloffset}). This option is only available for the \idx{unsrtfam} and the \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment. Unlike the \resourceopt{flatten} resource option, this option doesn't actually remove the \gloskey{parent} field. \optiondef{printgloss.groups} This option is only applicable to the \idx{unsrtfam} and \env{printunsrtglossarywrap}. If set to false, it will prevent \idxpl{group} from being formed. If true (the default), \idxpl{group} will only be formed if they are supported. See \sectionref{sec:printunsrt} for further details. \optiondef{printgloss.prefix} This option is provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} and simply redefines \gls{glolinkprefix} to expand to \meta{prefix}. If hyperlinks are supported and the \idx{glossarystyle} uses \gls{glstarget} to create the entry's hypertarget, the target name is obtained from \code{\gls{glolinkprefix}\meta{entry-label}}. If you are displaying multiple \idxpl{glossary} with shared entries (for example, using the \resourceopt{secondary} resource option with \app{bib2gls}), then changing the prefix can avoid duplicate targets. Alternatively, you can redefine \gls{glstarget} to use \gls{glsxtrtarget}. Note that this option will also affect the targets used by the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands. This means that if you have, for example, \gls{gls} in the description of an entry, then its hyperlink will go to that entry's item in the current \idx{glossary}. Whereas referencing that entry outside of the \idx{glossary} will hyperlink to the \idx{glossary} that uses the prefix matching the setting at that point in the document. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{showtargets}{annoteleft},\optval{style}{\glostyle{tree}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample}, \gloskeyval{description}{an example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{another}}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{another}, \gloskeyval{description}{some other example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{sample}}} \cbeg{document} Link to glossary 1: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Link to glossary 2: \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{prefix}{other-}}\marg{sample}. \gls{printunsrtglossary} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{prefix}{other-}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This uses the \opt{showtargets} package option to show the target names to the left of the hyperlink or hypertarget. The result is: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Changing the target prefix}, label={ex:targetprefixes}, description={Example document that illustrates two glossaries with different target prefixes}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{showtargets}{annoteleft},\optval{style}{\glostyle{tree}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{an example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{another}}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{another},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{some other example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{sample}}} }{Link to glossary 1: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Link to glossary 2: \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{prefix}{other-}}\marg{sample}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{prefix}{other-}} } \end{resultbox} Within the main part of the document, the first reference to \qt{sample} has a hyperlink to the first \idx{glossary} (with the target \code{glo:sample}, which uses the default prefix), and the second reference has a hyperlink to the second \idx{glossary} (with the target \code{other-sample}). Within the \idxpl{glossary}, the \gls{gls} references use the current \idx{glossary} prefix, so the target is in the same \idx{glossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.targetnameprefix} This is similar to the previous option but only affects the prefix for the entry item's target and doesn't change the prefix for any references contained within the \idx{glossary}. This \emph{prepends} the given prefix to the default prefix. If the above example is modified to: \begin{codebox} Link to glossary 1: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Link to glossary 2: \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{prefix}{other-glo:}}\marg{sample}. \gls{printunsrtglossary} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{targetnameprefix}{other-}} \end{codebox} Then the result will be: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Prepending to the target prefix for just the entry item}, label={ex:targetprefixname}, description={Example document that illustrates two glossaries with different target prefixes using targetprefixname}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{showtargets}{annoteleft},\optval{style}{\glostyle{tree}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{an example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{another}}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{another}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{another},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{some other example description that references \gls{gls}\marg{sample}}} }{Link to glossary 1: \gls{gls}\marg{sample}. \codepar Link to glossary 2: \gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{prefix}{other-glo:}}\marg{sample}.^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{targetnameprefix}{other-}} } \end{resultbox} Note that this has prepended \code{other-} to the existing \code{glo:}\ prefix. This is why the \glsopt{prefix} option in the second \gls{gls} reference had to be changed to match the appropriate hypertarget name. The \gls{gls} references in the second \idx{glossary} now point to the relevant line in the first \idx{glossary}. It's possible to combine \printglossopt{targetnameprefix} with \printglossoptvalm{prefix}{} but that will also affect the \gls{gls} references within the \idx{glossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.target} This is a boolean option that can be used to switch off the automatic creation of the entry hypertargets but still allows hyperlinks within the \idx{glossary}. This can be used to prevent duplicate destinations for secondary \idxpl{glossary}. \optiondef{printgloss.preamble} Redefines \gls{glossarypreamble} to \meta{text}. \optiondef{printgloss.postamble} Redefines \gls{glossarypostamble} to \meta{text}. \section{Displaying a Glossary Without Sorting or Indexing} \label{sec:printunsrt} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides two ways of displaying a \idx{glossary}, depending on the \idx{indexing} option: \gls{printglossary} (used with \gls{makeglossaries}) or \gls{printnoidxglossary} (used with \gls{makenoidxglossaries}). The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides an alternative that doesn't require sorting or \idx{indexing}. \cmddef{printunsrtglossary} This behaves in a similar way to \gls{printnoidxglossary}, but it always lists all the defined entries for the given glossary in the order in which they were added to the glossary. Unlike \gls{printglossary}, you may use \gls{printunsrtglossary} with an \idx{ignoredglossary}. \begin{important} The \idx{unsrtfam} and \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} are not intended for use with \gls{makeglossaries} and \gls{makenoidxglossaries}. Mixing these different methods can result in unexpected behaviour. \end{important} There is also a starred version which has a mandatory argument: \cmddef{printunsrtglossary*} This is equivalent to: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{begingroup} \meta{init-code}\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oargm{options} \cmd{endgroup} \end{compactcodebox} There's no significant difference between doing: \begin{compactcodebox} \marg{\meta{init-code}\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oargm{options}} \end{compactcodebox} and \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oargm{options}\margm{init-code} \end{compactcodebox} Note that unlike \gls{glossarypreamble}, the supplied \meta{init-code} is done before the \idx{glossary} header. \begin{important} If you want to use one of the \env{tabular}-like styles with \gls{printunsrtglossary}, make sure you load \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} which modifies the definition of \gls{glsgroupskip} to avoid the \qt{Incomplete \csfmt{iftrue}} error that may otherwise occur. \end{important} As with \gls{printglossary} and \gls{printnoidxglossary}, there is also a command to print all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} in the order in which they were defined: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaries} This means you now have the option to simply list all entries on the first \LaTeX\ run without the need for a post-processor, however there will be no \idx{locationlist} in this case, as that has to be set by a post-processor such as \app{bib2gls} (see \sectionref{sec:bib2gls}). \begin{warning} No attempt is made to gather hierarchical elements. If child entries aren't defined immediately after their parent entry, they won't be together in the \idx{glossary} when using \gls{printunsrtglossary}. \end{warning} The way that \gls{printunsrtglossary} basically works is to iterate over every label in the \idx{glossary}['s] internal label list and format each entry according to the way the \idx{glossarystyle} would normally format the entry's \idx{hierarchicallevel} (described in more detail in \sectionref{sec:printunsrtadvanced}). If a change in letter group is detected, the letter group heading and group skip will be inserted. A label is appended to the \idx{glossary}['s] internal label list whenever an entry is defined. This means that the list will normally be in order of definition, but it's also possible to copy an entry's label to another \idx{glossary}['s] internal label list using \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}, which can be used to provide a different order. A simple example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{\glostyle{treegroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The document build only requires one \LaTeX\ call in this case. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Displaying unsorted glossaries}, label={ex:printunsrt}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{\glostyle{treegroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% }{\gls{printunsrtglossary}} \end{resultbox} Note the difference if the \opt{stylemods} option is used: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{\glostyle{treegroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Displaying unsorted glossaries with \optfmt{stylemods}}, label={ex:printunsrtstylemods}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing using the stylemods option}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{\glostyle{treegroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% }{\gls{printunsrtglossary}} \end{resultbox} In this case, the \idx{group} headings are now numbers instead of letters. The styles provided with \sty{glossaries-extra} and those modified by \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} are designed to assist integration with \app{bib2gls}. Without these modifications, \gls{printunsrtglossary} behaves like the less sophisticated \gls{printnoidxglossary} which checks if the label is an integer less than 256 and uses \gls{char} to create the title (if no title has been provided). If you really want to use \gls{printunsrtglossary} without \app{bib2gls} and you want letter \idxpl{group} with \opt{stylemods} without having to define all the titles, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrnoidxgroups} which will switch over to using the group titling method used with \gls{printnoidxglossary} (which only supports \idx{ascii}). This command is only available with \opteqvalref{record}{off} and can't be used with \gls{makeglossaries}. If, conversely, you don't want any \idxpl{group} formed, regardless of the \idx{glossarystyle}, you can disable them with \printglossoptval{groups}{false}. The above example can be modified so that the document contains: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptvalm{title}{Glossary 1}} \gls{glsxtrnoidxgroups} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptvalm{title}{Glossary 2}} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{groups}{false},\printglossoptvalm{title}{Glossary 3}} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{tree},\printglossopt{nogroupskip},\printglossoptvalm{title}{Glossary 4}} \end{codebox} This repeats the same \idx{glossary}. The first is the same as the previous example. The second is the same as the example that didn't use \opt{stylemods}. The final two \idxpl{glossary} have the \idxpl{group} suppressed. Using \printglossoptval{groups}{false} (Glossary~3) is more efficient than using \printglossopt{nogroupskip} and switching to a style that doesn't show the header (Glossary~4). I've also switched to two column mode to display the result in a more compact form. The first two glossaries are shown on the left and the last two are on the right: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Displaying unsorted glossaries with different group settings}, label={ex:printunsrtgroup}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing with different group settings}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{\glostyle{treegroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% }{\cmd{twocolumn}\gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{title=\marg{Glossary 1}}^^J% \gls{glsxtrnoidxgroups}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{title=\marg{Glossary 2}}^^J% \cmd{newpage} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{groups}{false},title=\marg{Glossary 3}}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{tree},\printglossopt{nogroupskip},title=\marg{Glossary 4}} } \end{resultbox} The \idx{unsrtfam} were designed for use with \app{bib2gls}, which uses more complex alphanumeric \idx{group} labels to allow for greater customization and to avoid conflict where there are multiple \idxpl{glossary} or \idxpl{hierarchicallevel} with potentially the same letter \idxpl{group}. The way that \app{bib2gls} works is to select entries from a \ext{bib} file, according to the document requirements, sort the entries, and then write the entry definitions (with commands like \gls{longnewglossaryentry*} or \gls{newabbreviation}) in the \ext{glstex} in the desired order, which is then input by \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}. This means that \gls{printunsrtglossary} will display the entries in that order since, from \sty{glossaries-extra}['s] point of view, that's the order of definition. While it is possible to use \gls{printunsrtglossary} without \app{bib2gls}, as in the above example, for long or complex \idxpl{glossary} it's better to use \app{bib2gls} which can automatically assign appropriate titles to the \idxpl{group}. \Idxpl{group} and hierarchy are discussed in more detail in \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}. See \sectionref{sec:printunsrtlocations} for \idxpl{locationlist} and \sectionref{sec:printunsrtinner}. Advanced commands and further detail about the way \gls{printunsrtglossary} works are covered in \sectionref{sec:printunsrtadvanced}. \subsection{Groups and Hierarchy} \label{sec:printunsrtgroups} \begin{information} See \gallerypage{logicaldivisions}{Gallery: Logical Glossary Divisions (type vs group vs parent)} for the difference between the \gloskey{group}, \gloskey{type} and \gloskey{parent} fields. \end{information} Here's a longer example that uses \opt{stylemods} to automatically load \sty{glossary-bookindex}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{adder}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{adder},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck},\gloskeyval{parent}{waterfowl}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zebra}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zebra},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{mallard}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{mallard},\gloskeyval{parent}{duck}, \gloskeyval{description}{}} \codepar \gls{newglossary*}\marg{another}\marg{Another Glossary} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{mallard}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{aardvark}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{zebra}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{ant}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{duck}\marg{another} \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrtglossary} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} Unlike the previous examples that defined the entries in alphabetical order, this example hasn't used any logical order. Note, in particular, that the child entries \qt{duck} and \qt{mallard} (which have the \gloskey{parent} key set) have not been defined immediately after their parent. The first \gls{printunsrtglossary} has the default \printglossoptval{type}{main} and lists all entries defined in the \code{main} \idx{glossary}, in the order in which they were defined. The second \gls{printunsrtglossary} lists all entries in the custom \code{another} \idx{glossary} and is in the order in which the entries were copied to that \idx{glossary}. The document build again simply requires one \LaTeX\ call. The result is shown in \exampleref{ex:unsrtcopygrp}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:unsrtcopygrp}, title={Displaying unsorted glossaries with a copied list}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing that copies entries to another glossary. Entries are listed in order of definition with child entries indented, that results in a confusing list}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{adder}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{adder},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck},\gloskeyval{parent}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zebra}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zebra},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{mallard}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{mallard},\gloskeyval{parent}{duck},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \codepar \gls{newglossary*}\marg{another}\marg{Another Glossary}^^J% \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{mallard}\marg{another}^^J% \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{aardvark}\marg{another}^^J% \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{zebra}\marg{another}^^J% \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{ant}\marg{another}^^J% \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{duck}\marg{another} }{\gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} } \end{resultbox} There are some oddities in both lists. It's the \idx{glossarystyle} that determines the formatting of the entries according to the entry's \gls{hierarchicallevel}, but it looks strange for the duck and mallard entries to be indented when they don't follow after their parent entry. As the internal loop within \gls{printunsrtglossary} iterates over each entry, it tries to determine which \idxc{group}{letter group} the entry belongs to. If it's different from the \idx{group} for the previous entry (in the same hierarchical level), a \idx{group} header is added (which may or may not be displayed, depending on the \idx{glossarystyle}). This means than an unordered list of entries, such as in the above example, may contain repeated headers. The way that the \idx{group} is determined depends on whether or not the \gloskey{group} key has been defined. If it isn't defined (the default), then the \idx{group} label is obtained from the \idx{uppercase} character code of the first token of the \gloskey{sort} key. If the token doesn't have an \idx{uppercase} character code (indicating that it's not a letter) or if the sort value is empty then the label will be set to \code{glssymbols} (which corresponds to the symbol \idx{group}). This is the same way that \gls{printnoidxglossary} inserts \idxpl{group}. Remember that if the \gloskey{sort} key hasn't been set, it will be assigned automatically to the same value as the \gloskey{name} key (or with \optval{sort}{use} or \optval{sort}{def} to a numerical value). The \gloskey{sort} key will be empty if you use \optval{sort}{clear}. The \optval{sort}{none} setting simply skips the pre-processing of the \gloskey{sort} key (such as sanitizing). For example, the ant entry doesn't explicitly use the \gloskey{sort} key, so the sort value is obtained from the \gloskey{name} key, which is set to \code{ant}. The first token is \qt{a}, which is a letter. The \idx{group}['s] label is obtained from the letter's \idx{uppercase} character decimal code (65). There's no associated title (which can be assigned with \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}), so the title is simply \qt{65} (with \opt{stylemods}, see earlier) or \qt{A} (without \opt{stylemods} or with \gls{glsxtrnoidxgroups}). The ant entry is followed by \qt{adder}. The same process determines that the \qt{adder} \idx{group} label is also 65. There's no change in the \idx{group} label from the previous entry (ant) so no header is inserted. By default, this \idx{group} check is omitted for child entries, which is why no group header is inserted before duck or mallard. So the next entry to be checked for a \idx{group} is the zebra entry, which has the group label 90 (the decimal code for \qt{Z}). Again there's no title associated with that label so the title is simply the label. The zebra entry is followed by aardvark which, following the same process, has the \idx{group} label 65. This is different from the previous group label (90) so a group header is inserted. This is why there are two \qt{90} letter \idxpl{group}. \begin{important} The \idx{unsrtfam} don't order the entries. \end{important} If the \gloskey{group} key has been defined (which is the case with \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}) then the \idx{group} \emph{label} is obtained from the \gloskey{group} field. If the \gloskey{group} field is defined but empty then the entry will belong to the empty group. The value of the \gloskey{sort} field is now irrelevant. So, simply adding the \opt{record} option to the above example document will cause the group headers to disappear. This is because the \gloskey{group} key will now be defined but is empty for each entry. Even with a style like \glostyle{bookindex}, there won't be any \idx{group} headers. Provided the \gloskey{group} key has been defined, the field used to store the \idx{group} label is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrgroupfield} This expands to \code{group}, by default. However it's possible to use a different field in which to store the group label, in which case \gls{glsxtrgroupfield} will need to be redefined. For example: \begin{codebox} \marg{\gls{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgroupfield}}\marg{othergroup}\gls{printunsrtglossary}} \end{codebox} or \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\marg{\gls{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgroupfield}}\marg{othergroup}} \end{codebox} (but this still requires the \gloskey{group} key to be defined, even if it's not being used to store the \idx{group} label). With \app{bib2gls}, the \resourceopt{secondary} resource option (combined with \switch{group}) will store the \idx{group} label obtained from the secondary sort in the \glosfield{secondarygroup} field and adds the redefinition of \gls{glsxtrgroupfield} to the associated \idx{glossary} preamble. This prevents it from clashing with the \gloskey{group} field in the event that the secondary sort method has produced a different set of \idxpl{group} (which is likely). The follow example document uses \opt{record} to create the \gloskey{group} key and assigns \idx{group} labels with associated titles. Note that the \glosfield{secondarygroup} field doesn't have an associated key, so it needs to be set with a field assignment command, such as \gls{GlsXtrSetField}. \newcommand*{\examplegroupsdefs}{% \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{group1label}\marg{Group 1}\newline \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{group2label}\marg{Group 2}\newline \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{group3label}\marg{Group 3}\newline \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{group4label}\marg{Group 4}\newline \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group1label}}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group1label}}\newline \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{ant}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{group4label}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{adder}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{adder},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group2label}}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck},\gloskeyval{parent}{waterfowl},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{group}{group4label}}\newline \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{duck}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{group2label}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{zebra}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zebra},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group2label}}\newline \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{zebra}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{group3label}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group2label}}\newline \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{group1label}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle},\gloskeyval{description}{},\newline\space \gloskeyval{group}{group1label}}\newline \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{mallard}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{mallard},\gloskeyval{parent}{duck},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{},\gloskeyval{group}{group2label}} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{mallard}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{group3label}\newline \codepar \gls{newglossary*}\marg{another}\marg{Another Glossary}\newline \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{mallard}\marg{another}\newline \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{aardvark}\marg{another}\newline \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{zebra}\marg{another}\newline \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{ant}\marg{another}\newline \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{duck}\marg{another}\newline \gls{setglossarypreamble}\oarg{another}\marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgroupfield}}\marg{secondarygroup}} } \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \examplegroupsdefs \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrtglossary} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This is essentially mimicking the way that the \resourceopt{secondary} resource option sets the \glosfield{secondarygroup} field and adds the redefinition of \gls{glsxtrgroupfield} to the secondary \idx{glossary}['s] preamble. (Although in this case, there's no logical order.) The result is shown in \exampleref{ex:unsrtcustomgrp}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:unsrtcustomgrp}, title={Displaying unsorted glossaries with custom groups}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing and has the group labels explicitly set}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \examplegroupsdefs }{\gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} } \end{resultbox} Note that even though the duck and mallard entries have the \gloskey{group} and \glosfield{secondarygroup} fields set, there's no group title for them in either \idx{glossary} because they are child entries. \cmddef{glsxtraddgroup} This command will perform \meta{code} if the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} should have \idx{group} support (provided the \gloskey{group} field has been set). The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtraddgroup}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{ifglsxtrprintglossflatten} \#2\% \cmd{else} \gls{ifglshasparent}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\#2}\% \cmd{fi} } \end{compactcodebox} This means that only entries that don't have a parent (with \printglossoptval{flatten}{false}) or any entry (with \printglossoptval{flatten}{true}) will have the \idx{group} check performed. With \app{bib2gls}, the \resourceopt{group-level} will redefine \gls{glsxtraddgroup} to always do \meta{code}, which means that all entries will have the \idx{group} check performed. \begin{important} If no group label has been provided no header will be added. \end{important} The following hook is used just before the header information is appended: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarygrouphook} The argument is the internal command used to build the group header (which will then be appended to main internal command containing the glossary code). This hook may be redefined to insert any additional code before the heading. Use \code{\gls{preto}\#1\margm{content}} if you want to insert \meta{content} before the header and \code{\gls{appto}\#1\margm{content}} if you want to insert \meta{content} after the header. (You can reference the entry label with \gls{glscurrententrylabel} and the current \idx{hierarchicallevel} with \gls{glscurrententrylevel} but make sure they are expanded if they occur in \meta{content}.) For example, \gls{printunsrttable} redefines this hook to finish off the current row before the \idx{group} header is added. The above document can be modified to show the sub-\idx{group} headings: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtraddgroup}}[2]\marg{\#2} \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtraddgroup}}[2]\marg{\% \cmd{ifnum}\gls{glscurrententrylevel}<2 \#2\cmd{fi}} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} \end{codebox} The result is shown in \exampleref{ex:unsrtcustomsubgrp}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:unsrtcustomsubgrp}, title={Displaying unsorted glossaries with custom groups and sub-group headings}, description={Example document that doesn't require any external indexing and has the group labels explicitly set with sub-group headings}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \codepar \examplegroupsdefs }{\cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtraddgroup}}[2]\marg{\#2}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtraddgroup}}[2]\marg{\%^^J \cmd{ifnum}\gls{glscurrententrylevel}<2 \#2\cmd{fi}^^J% }^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} } \end{resultbox} Note that the mallard entry (which has \idx{hierarchicallevel}~2) has its group shown in the first \idx{glossary} (where the group is formed for all levels) but not in the second \idx{glossary} (where the redefinition of \gls{glsxtraddgroup} restricts \idx{group} formation to just level~0 and level~1). There's a small visual distinction between the \idx{group} titles in different \idxpl{hierarchicallevel} in the above. The top-level (level~0) groups have the title centred, whereas the sub-groups have their titles indented by the same amount as the corresponding sub-entries. This is due to the \idx{glossarystyle}. Other styles may use the same formatting for all \idxpl{hierarchicallevel}. The \idxpl{glossarystyle} provided with \sty{glossaries-extra} and the base styles patched by \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} all redefine: \cmddef{glssubgroupheading} to format the sub-group headings in a manner applicable to the style. For example, styles that don't show sub-entry names typically redefine this command to do nothing. A default definition that simply does \code{\gls{glsgroupheading}\margm{group-label}} is automatically initialised by \gls{setglossarystyle} (via \gls{glsxtrpreglossarystyle}) to allow for styles that don't redefine this command. The first two arguments refer to the \idx{hierarchicallevel}, where \meta{previous level} is the level of the previous \idx{group} and \meta{level} is the level of this new sub-\idx{group}. The \meta{parent-label} is the label of the current entry's parent, where the current entry is the first entry of the sub-\idx{group} that immediately follows the heading. The \glostyle{bookindex} style defines \gls{glssubgroupheading} to use the style's associated command \gls{glsxtrbookindexformatsubheader}. This can be redefined as required. For example, the following uses the parent entry's hierarchical information: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexformatsubheader}}[5]\marg{\% \cmd{ifnum}\#2>1\gls{relax} \gls{glstreesubsubitem}\gls{glstreegroupheaderfmt}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrhiername}\marg{\#3} / \#5}\% \cmd{else} \gls{glstreesubitem}\gls{glstreegroupheaderfmt}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrhiername}\marg{\#3} / \#5}\% \cmd{fi} } \end{codebox} The above examples are contrived and demonstrate the need to define entries in a sensible order to achieve a sensible \idx{glossary} with \gls{printunsrtglossary}. If you want to use this approach to display a \idx{glossary}, you would need to make sure that you take care with the order that you define entries. This can be quite tedious for a large number of entries. To switch to \app{bib2gls}, the entry data needs to be provided in a \ext{bib} file. For example, the file \filefmt{animalfamilies.bib} might contain: \newcommand*{\examplegroupsbibdefs}{% \atentry{index}\marg{waterfowl,\gloskeyval{user1}{Anseriformes}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{ant,\gloskeyval{user1}{Formicidae}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{adder,\gloskeyval{user1}{Vipera berus}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{duck,\gloskeyval{parent}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{user1}{Anatidae}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{zebra,\gloskeyval{user1}{Hippotigris}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{aardvark,\gloskeyval{user1}{Orycteropus afer}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{gazelle,\gloskeyval{user1}{Gazella}}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{mallard,\gloskeyval{parent}{duck},\gloskeyval{user1}{Anas platyrhynchos}} } \begin{codebox} \examplegroupsbibdefs \end{codebox} I've included some additional information stored in the \gloskey{user1} field that wasn't in the earlier examples. The document needs to use the \opt{record} option and \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} in order for it to work properly with \app{bib2gls}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}} \marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossary*}\marg{another}\marg{Another Glossary} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{selection}{all},\comment{select all entries} \resourceoptvalm{src}{animalfamilies},\comment{identify bib file(s)} \resourceoptval{sort}{en-GB},\comment{sort method} \resourceoptvalm{secondary}{la:user1:another}\comment{sort again and copy to `another'} } \gls{glsdefpostname}\marg{\cat{index}}\marg{ (\cmd{emph}\marg{\gls{glsentryuseri}\marg{\gls{glscurrententrylabel}}})} \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrtglossary} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} If this code is saved in the file \filefmt{myDoc.tex} then the build process is now: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls \switch{group} myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The \switch{group} (or \switch{g}) switch is important as it instructs \app{bib2gls} to set the \gloskey{group} field for the primary sort and the \glosfield{secondarygroup} for the secondary sort. The primary sort will sort entries according to \code{en-GB} (British English). This can simply be set to \code{en} without a region. The secondary sort will resort the entries, but this time according to \code{la} (Latin) using the \gloskey{user1} key as the sort value. The entry labels will then be copied to the custom \code{another} glossary. The \ext{glstex} file created by \app{bib2gls} (which will then be input by \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} on the subsequent \LaTeX\ run) essentially contains the following code: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{6881280}\marg{W} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{5832704}\marg{G} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{5373952}\marg{A} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{7077888}\marg{Z} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another5373952}\marg{A} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another5767168}\marg{F} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another6356992}\marg{O} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another5898240}\marg{H} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another6815744}\marg{V} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{another5832704}\marg{G} \codepar \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Orycteropus afer},\gloskeyval{group}{5373952}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{adder}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{adder}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Vipera berus},\gloskeyval{group}{5373952}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Formicidae},\gloskeyval{group}{5373952}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{gazelle}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Gazella},\gloskeyval{group}{5832704}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{waterfowl}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Anseriformes},\gloskeyval{group}{6881280}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck}, \gloskeyval{parent}{waterfowl},\gloskeyval{user1}{Anatidae},\gloskeyval{group}{}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{mallard}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{mallard}, \gloskeyval{parent}{duck},\gloskeyval{user1}{Anas platyrhynchos},\gloskeyval{group}{}}\marg{} \gls{longnewglossaryentry*}\marg{zebra}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{zebra}, \gloskeyval{user1}{Hippotigris},\gloskeyval{group}{7077888}}\marg{} \codepar \gls{apptoglossarypreamble}\oarg{another} \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrgroupfield}}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{waterfowl}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another5373952} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{duck}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{mallard}\marg{another} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{ant}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{ant}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another5767168} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{gazelle}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{gazelle}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another5832704} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{zebra}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{zebra}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another5898240} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{aardvark}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another6356992} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{adder}\marg{another} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{adder}\marg{\glosfield{secondarygroup}}\marg{another6815744} \end{codebox} It's more complicated than this as helper commands are provided to make it easier to customize and the entries will all have \gloskeyval{category}{index} since they were defined with \atentry{index}, but this is basically like the preamble in the earlier examples, except that the ordering and \idxpl{group} are more logical. The result is shown in \exampleref{ex:bib2glsgrp}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:bib2glsgrp}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, title={Displaying sorted glossaries with groups using \appfmt{bib2gls}}, description={Example document that uses bib2gls to created a two differently sorted lists with the same entries}] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{animalfamilies.bib}^^J% \examplegroupsbibdefs^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossary*}\marg{another}\marg{Another Glossary}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{selection}{all},\comment{select all entries} \resourceoptvalm{src}{animalfamilies},\comment{identify bib file(s)} \resourceoptval{sort}{en-GB},\comment{sort method} \resourceoptvalm{secondary}{la:user1:another}\comment{sort again and copy to `another'} }^^J% \gls{glsdefpostname}\marg{index}\marg{ ^^J (\cmd{emph}\marg{\gls{glsentryuseri}\marg{\gls{glscurrententrylabel}}})} }{\gls{printunsrtglossary}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{another}} } \end{resultbox} Note that the \gloskey{group} and \glosfield{secondarygroup} fields haven't been set for the child entries (duck and mallard). This is the default behaviour and it means that regardless of the definition you provide for \gls{glsxtraddgroup}, sub-groups won't be displayed. If you want those fields set for child entries, you need to use the \resourceopt{group-level} resource option. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{selection}{all},\comment{select all entries} \strong{\resourceoptvalm{group-level}{<=1},\comment{\idxc{hierarchicallevel}{level}~0 and 1}} \resourceoptvalm{src}{animalfamilies},\comment{identify bib file(s)} \resourceoptval{sort}{en-GB},\comment{sort method} \resourceoptvalm{secondary}{la:user1:another}\comment{sort again and copy} } \end{codebox} This will add support for level~0 (no parent) and level~1 (parent but no grandparent) entries. Deeper levels won't have support. The \switch{group} switch is still required. \subsection{Location Lists} \label{sec:printunsrtlocations} The \idx{unsrtfam} check for the existence of the \gloskey{location} and \glosfield{loclist} keys. These are both defined by the \opt{record} option. (The \glosfield{loclist} field is also used by \gls{makenoidxglossaries} but isn't defined as a key.) The \gloskey{location} field (if set) should contain the formatted \idx{locationlist}. This is checked first and used if not empty. Otherwise the \glosfield{loclist} field (if set) is used, but that will use the same method as \gls{printnoidxglossary} to format, which doesn't compact consecutive locations. It's possible to choose a different field for the formatted \idx{locationlist} by redefining: \cmddef{GlsXtrLocationField} This should expand to the \idx{internalfieldlabel}. If the field is not the default \gloskey{location} then the test for \glosfield{loclist} is omitted. Whichever field is used, the formatted \idx{locationlist} is passed to the appropriate \idx{glossarystyle} command (\gls{glossentry} or \gls{subglossentry}) encapsulated with \gls{glossaryentrynumbers}. If there's no location field or if the tested fields are empty, then an empty argument (with no \gls{glossaryentrynumbers} encapsulator) is passed to the \idx{glossarystyle} command. In this case, the \opt{nonumberlist} option is redundant as there's no \idx{locationlist} to suppress. \subsection{Advanced Commands} \label{sec:printunsrtadvanced} To provide a better understanding of how filtered and inner glossaries work, it’s useful to understand the difference between \gls{printglossary} (used with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}) and \gls{printunsrtglossary} (used with \app{bib2gls}). In the first case, \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy} is used to create a file that contains content in the form: \begin{codebox} \gls{glossarysection}\oarg{\gls{glossarytoctitle}}\marg{\gls{glossarytitle}}\comment{} \gls{glossarypreamble} \cbeg{\env{theglossary}}\gls{glossaryheader} \meta{content} \cend{\env{theglossary}}\gls{glossarypostamble} \end{codebox} where \meta{content} contains lines such as: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsgroupheading}\margm{group label}\gls{relax} \gls{glsresetentrylist} \gls{glossentry}\margm{entry label}\margm{location list}\comment{} \gls{subglossentry}\margm{level}\margm{entry label}\margm{location list}\comment{} \end{codebox} The \idx{group} headings (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}) are typeset using \gls{glsgroupheading}. Top-level entries are typeset with \gls{glossentry} and child entries are typeset with \gls{subglossentry} where \meta{level} indicates the \idx{hierarchicallevel}. Both \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy} order the items so that the child entries are placed immediately after the corresponding parent entry. The \gls{printglossary} command essentially does: \begin{codebox} \meta{Set default title and style.} \cmd{bgroup} \meta{Initial setup.} \meta{Input the file created by \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}.} \cmd{egroup} \end{codebox} The initial setup part sets the \idx{glossarystyle} (which determines the definitions of \env{theglossary}, \gls{glossaryheader}, \gls{glsgroupheading}, \gls{glossentry} and \gls{subglossentry}), assigns the title (\gls{glossarytitle} and \gls{glossarytoctitle}) and defines \gls{currentglossary}. (There is some other stuff done both before and after the file is input, but that's not relevant here.) In the case of \app{bib2gls}, there isn't a glossary file to input. Instead, \app{bib2gls} is used to create a file that contains the entry definitions, which is input in the document preamble (via \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}). The entries are defined in the required order and use internal \idxpl{field} to store the indexing information (such as the \idx{group} label and \idxpl{locationlist}). Now \gls{printunsrtglossary} is used to display the glossary, which essentially does: \begin{codebox} \meta{Set default title and style.} \cmd{bgroup} \meta{Initial setup.} \gls{glossarysection}\oarg{\gls{glossarytoctitle}}\marg{\gls{glossarytitle}}\comment{} \gls{glossarypreamble} \meta{Construct internal control sequence containing glossary content.} \meta{Expand internal control sequence.} \gls{glossarypostamble} \cmd{egroup} \end{codebox} The \meta{initial setup} is the same as for \gls{printglossary}. The key difference here is that there's no file containing the typeset \idx{glossary} that can be simply input. Instead it's necessary to iterate over the \idx{glossary}['s] internal label list. Some of the \idxpl{glossarystyle} use a \env{tabular}-like environment (such as \env{longtable}, which is used by the \glostyle{long} styles). It's always problematic having a loop inside a \env{tabular} context so \gls{printunsrtglossary} by-passes the problem by moving the loop outside of the \env{theglossary} environment. The command iterates over all entry labels (in the order in which they were added to the \idx{glossary}) and constructs an internal control sequence (\inlineglsdef{@glsxtr@doglossary}), which ends up containing: \begin{codebox} \cbeg{\env{theglossary}}\gls{glossaryheader} \meta{begin code} \meta{content} \meta{end code} \cend{\env{theglossary}} \end{codebox} \begin{warning} Note that \gls{glsresetentrylist} has been removed in v1.50 since it's generally unnecessary with \app{bib2gls} and causes interference with tabular styles. \end{warning} The \meta{begin code} can be inserted just after \code{\cbeg{theglossary}} by the command: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarypostbegin} This does nothing by default (so \meta{begin code} will be omitted). If you still need to have \gls{glsresetentrylist} at the start, you can redefine this hook as follows: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossarypostbegin}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{appto}\#1\marg{\gls{glsresetentrylist}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} The \meta{end code} can be inserted just before \code{\cend{theglossary}} by the command: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarypreend} This does nothing by default (so \meta{end code} will be omitted). (These two hooks are only used in \gls{printunsrtglossary} not in by \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary} or \env{printunsrtglossarywrap}.) For example, \gls{printunsrttable} redefines the end hook to finish off the final row. In both hooks, the argument will be \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary} and, in both cases, you need to use \gls{appto} within the definition in order to insert \meta{begin code} and \meta{end code} in the correct place. If you use \gls{preto}, the code will end up at the start, before \code{\cbeg{theglossary}} The \meta{content} in this case is different as it doesn't explicitly contain \gls{glossentry} and \gls{subglossentry} but instead uses an internal handler that just takes the entry label as the argument. The \code{\gls{glsgroupheading}\margm{group label}} command is inserted whenever a top-level entry has the group field set to a label that's different to the previous top-level entry’s group field (and, if supported, sub-groups are similarly inserted with \gls{glssubgroupheading}, see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}). So the content is in the form: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsgroupheading}\margm{group label}\comment{} \cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}\margm{entry label}\comment{} \cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}\margm{entry label}\comment{} \ldots \gls{glsgroupheading}\margm{group label}\comment{} \cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}\margm{entry label}\comment{} \cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}\margm{entry label}\comment{} \ldots \end{codebox} There are hooks and commands available for use within those hooks that may be adjusted to customize the way the \idx{glossary} is displayed. These are described below. At each iteration (while the \idx{glossary} content is being constructed), the following steps are performed: \begin{enumerate} \item Store the current entry label in \gls{glscurrententrylabel}. \item If \gls{glscurrententrylabel} is empty, skip this iteration. \item Define placeholder commands: \cmddef{glscurrententrylevel} This is set to the current entry's \idx{hierarchicallevel} (taking \printglossopt{leveloffset} and \printglossopt{flatten} options into account); \cmddef{glscurrenttoplevelentry} This is set to the current entry label if \gls{glscurrententrylevel} is 0 (that is, it expands to the most recent top-level entry, allowing for \printglossopt{flatten} and \printglossopt{leveloffset}); \cmddef{glscurrentrootentry} This is set to the current entry label if \printglossoptval{flatten}{true} or if the current entry doesn't have a parent (that is, it expands to the most recent top-level entry, allowing for \printglossopt{flatten} but not \printglossopt{leveloffset}). \item Perform the entry process hook: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} This does nothing by default. Within the definition of this hook, you may use: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryskipentry} This will cause the remainder of the current iteration to be skipped, which will prevent the current entry from being shown in the \idx{glossary}. \item If \printglossoptval{groups}{true}, use \gls{glsxtraddgroup} (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}) to append the top-level group heading (\gls{glsgroupheading}) or the sub-group heading (\gls{glssubgroupheading}) to \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary}. \item Perform the pre-entry process hook: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarypreentryprocesshook} The argument will be \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary}. This may be used to insert any additional content before the entry (use \code{\gls{appto}\#1\margm{content}}). (The entry label can be referenced with \gls{glscurrententrylabel} but make sure it's expanded if it occurs in \meta{content}.) For example, \gls{printunsrttable} redefines this hook to insert \sym{amp} and \gls{tabularnewline} between blocks. \item Append \code{\cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}\margm{entry label}} to \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary}. \item Perform the post-entry process hook: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarypostentryprocesshook} The argument will be \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary}. This may be used to append any additional content after the entry (use \code{\gls{appto}\#1\margm{content}}). (The entry label can be referenced with \gls{glscurrententrylabel} but make sure it's expanded if it occurs in \meta{content}.) For example, \gls{printunsrttable} redefines this hook to reset the block index if the end of a row has been reached. \end{enumerate} \begin{warning} The placeholders \gls{glscurrenttoplevelentry} and \gls{glscurrentrootentry} may not be an ancestor of the current entry. For example, if the \idx{glossary} doesn't have child entries immediately following their parent entry. \end{warning} Once the \idx{glossary} construction (\gls{@glsxtr@doglossary}) has been completed, the following hook is performed: \cmddef{printunsrtglossarypredoglossary} This does nothing by default. You can redefine this to show the definition of \gls{@glsxtr@doglossary} for debugging purposes: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossarypredoglossary}}\marg{\comment{} \cmd{csshow}\marg{@glsxtr@doglossary}} \end{codebox} This will interrupt the \LaTeX\ run and display the definition in the transcript. The handler command \code{\cmd{\meta{internal cs handler}}} performs the following: \begin{codebox} \cmd{protected@xdef}\gls{glscurrententrylabel}\margm{entry-label}\comment{} \gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}\gls{glscurrententrylabel} \end{codebox} This stores the entry's label in \gls{glscurrententrylabel} (which allows it to be referenced in style hooks, such as the \idx{postnamehook} or \idx{postdeschook}). Note that it uses a global definition to avoid scoping issues caused with \env{tabular}-like styles. The main handling of the entry is performed by: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryhandler} This is simply defined to use: \cmddef{glsxtrunsrtdo} This displays the entry according to the current \idx{glossarystyle}, taking the \idx{hierarchicallevel} into account (as given by \gls{glscurrententrylevel}). The following are additional commands that may be useful in the above hooks. \cmddef{glsxtriflabelinlist} Does \meta{true} if the given label is in the given comma-separated list of labels, otherwise does \meta{false}. The label and list are fully expanded. \cmddef{ifglsxtrprintglossflatten} This conditional is set by the \printglossopt{flatten} option and can be used to test if the option has been set. For example, the following skips all entries that have the \gloskey{category} set to \cat{symbol}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pi}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{category}{symbol}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}},\gloskeyval{description}{}, \gloskeyval{category}{symbol}} \cbeg{document} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}\oarg{1}\marg{\% \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\#1}\marg{symbol}\% \marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\% \marg{}\% } \gls{printunsrtglossary} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Filtering by category}, label={ex:filterbycat}, description={Example document that displays a glossary with entries filtered by category}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pi}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}},\gloskeyval{description}{},^^J \gloskeyval{category}{symbol}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{aardvark}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{aardvark},\gloskeyval{description}{}} }{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}\oarg{1}\marg{\%^^J \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\#1}\marg{symbol}\%^^J \marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\%^^J \marg{}\%^^J }^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary} } \end{resultbox} \subsubsection{Inner Glossaries} \label{sec:printunsrtinner} \begin{information} See also \gallerypage{bib2gls-inner}{Gallery: Inner or Nested Glossaries}. \end{information} It's possible you may want to combine multiple \idxpl{glossary} sequentially, as sub-blocks of a single list. The inner part of \gls{printunsrtglossary} can be created with: \cmddef{printunsrtinnerglossary} This can't be used on its own, as it only forms a fragment. It doesn't include the section header, style initialisation, preamble, \env{theglossary} environment, header and postamble. As with \gls{printunsrtglossary}, \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary} constructs an internal control sequence containing the content, but it adds scoping to localise the effects of any supplied options. So it essentially does: \begin{codebox} \cmd{begingroup} \meta{Initial setup (process options).} \meta{pre-code} \meta{Construct internal control sequence containing glossary content.} \meta{Expand internal control sequence.} \meta{post-code} \cmd{endgroup} \end{codebox} There are two ways this command may be used. \envdef{printunsrtglossarywrap} The \env{printunsrtglossarywrap} environment takes one optional argument that uses the same keys as \gls{printunsrtglossary} (see \sectionref{sec:printglossopts}). Note that in this case the \printglossopt{type} key simply provides a title (if one has been assigned to that \idx{glossary}). It doesn't indicate the content. There's no point using both \printglossopt{type} and \printglossopt{title}. The start of the environment sets up the glossary style and does the header: \begin{codebox} \meta{Set default title and style.} \meta{Initial setup.} \gls{glossarysection}\oarg{\gls{glossarytoctitle}}\marg{\gls{glossarytitle}}\comment{} \gls{glossarypreamble} \cbeg{\env{theglossary}}\gls{glossaryheader}\gls{glsresetentrylist} \end{codebox} The end of this wrapper environment ends \env{theglossary} and does the postamble: \begin{codebox} \cend{\env{theglossary}}\gls{glossarypostamble} \end{codebox} Note that the \gls{printunsrtglossarypostbegin}, \gls{printunsrtglossarypreend} and \gls{printunsrtglossarypredoglossary} hooks aren't used. For example, the following has two \idxpl{glossary} but displays them as inner \idxpl{glossary}: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{bee}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{bee},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{other} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{duck},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{goose}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{goose},\gloskeyval{description}{}} \cbeg{document} \cbeg{\env{printunsrtglossarywrap}}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{index}} \gls{glstreeitem} First Glossary \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{leveloffset}{1}}\marg{}\marg{} \gls{glstreeitem} Second Glossary \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{other},\printglossoptval{leveloffset}{1}}\marg{}\marg{} \cend{\env{printunsrtglossarywrap}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Inner glossaries using \envfmt{printunsrtglossarywrap}}, label={ex:unsrtwrap}, description={Example document illustrating two inner glossaries offset by 1 level}] {\cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{ant}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{ant},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{bee}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{bee},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{other}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{duck}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{other},\gloskeyval{name}{duck},\gloskeyval{description}{}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{goose}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{other},\gloskeyval{name}{goose},\gloskeyval{description}{}} }{\cbeg{\env{printunsrtglossarywrap}}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{index}}^^J% \gls{glstreeitem} First Glossary^^J% \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{leveloffset}{1}}\marg{}\marg{}^^J% \gls{glstreeitem} Second Glossary^^J% \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{other},\printglossoptval{leveloffset}{1}}\marg{}\marg{}^^J% \cend{\env{printunsrtglossarywrap}} } \end{resultbox} The other way that \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary} can be used is within \gls{printunsrtglossary}. The handler function described in \sectionref{sec:printunsrtadvanced} that's used to process each entry to be displayed in the \idx{glossary}, is defined as: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}}[1]\marg{\gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} It's possible to redefine this so that it also displays an inner glossary. The following example has the terms \qt{pictograph} and \qt{Greek symbol} in the \code{main} glossary. Two \idxpl{ignoredglossary} are created (which don't require a title) where the \idx{glossary} label matches an entry label in the \code{main} \idx{glossary}. \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontawesome} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{\glostyle{tree}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pictograph}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pictograph}, \gloskeyval{description}{picture or symbol representing a word or phrase}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{mathgreek}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{Greek symbol}, \gloskeyval{description}{mathematical constants or functions}} \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{pictograph} \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{mathgreek} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cut}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{pictograph}, \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faCut}}, \gloskeyval{description}{cut}} \gls{newglossaryentry}{paste}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{pictograph}, \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faPaste}}, \gloskeyval{description}{paste}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{mathgreek}, \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}}, \gloskeyval{description}{alpha}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{beta}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{mathgreek}, \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{beta}}}, \gloskeyval{description}{beta}} \cbeg{document} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{nestedhandler}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}\marg{\#1}\% \gls{ifglossaryexists}*\marg{\#1}\% \marg{\% \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptvalm{type}{\#1},\printglossoptvalm{leveloffset}{++1}, \printglossoptval{groups}{false}}\marg{}\marg{}\% }\% {}\% } \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\marg{\cmd{let}\gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}\cmd{nestedhandler}} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This creates a custom command \csfmt{nestedhandler} that can be used as the handler to create nested \idxpl{glossary}. After each item in the glossary, if the entry's label matches the label of a defined glossary, that glossary is displayed with its \idx{hierarchicallevel} incremented by 1, which creates the illusion of child entries. The resulting document is shown in \exampleref{ex:nested}. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[label={ex:nested}, title={Nested glossaries}, description={Example document with a glossary that has inner glossaries}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontawesome}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{style}{\glostyle{tree}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pictograph}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{picture or symbol representing a word or phrase}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{mathgreek}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{Greek symbol},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{mathematical constants or functions}}^^J% \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{pictograph}^^J% \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{mathgreek}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cut}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faCut}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{cut}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}{paste}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faPaste}}, \gloskeyval{description}{paste}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{alpha}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{mathgreek},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{alpha}}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{alpha}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{beta}\marg{\gloskeyval{type}{mathgreek},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{beta}}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{beta}} }{% \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{nestedhandler}}[1]\marg{\%^^J \gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}\marg{\#1}\%^^J \gls{ifglossaryexists}*\marg{\#1}\%^^J \marg{\%^^J \gls{printunsrtinnerglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptvalm{type}{\#1},\printglossoptvalm{leveloffset}{++1},\printglossoptval{groups}{false}}\marg{}\marg{}\%^^J }\%^^J {}\%^^J% }^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\marg{\cmd{let}\gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}\cmd{nestedhandler}} } \end{resultbox} \subsubsection{Per-Unit Glossaries} \label{sec:printunsrtunit} If you are using \app{bib2gls} then it's possible to only list entries that match a particular counter value. For example, you may want a \idx{mini-glossary} at the start of a section that only lists the entries that have been \recorded\ in that section. This can be done by using the handler to skip entries that don't have a matching record. It can also be implemented with record counting, as shown in \exampleref{ex:recordcountminigloss} in \sectionref{sec:recordcount}. It's also possible to make each \idx{indexing} instance automatically make a note of a particular counter using: \cmddef{GlsXtrRecordCounter} (This doesn't correspond to a \app{bib2gls} \record. That's dealt with by the indexing that comes first.) This command may only be used in the preamble (with \opt{record}) and indicates that whenever an entry is indexed, the following line should be added to the \ext+{aux} file: \cmddef{glsxtr@counterrecord} where \meta{value} is given by \gls{thecounter}. On the next \LaTeX\ run, this information is picked up from the \ext{aux} file and the information is added to the \glosfield{record.counter} field (stored as an \sty{etoolbox} internal list). This internal command is only used in the \ext{aux} file and has a user-level hook: \cmddef{glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook} This does nothing by default. If you want to redefined this, the redefinition must be placed in the document preamble before the \ext{aux} file is input. There are two ways of skipping an entry. The first is to redefine \gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} to perform the test and use \gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry} to skip an unwanted entry (as illustrated earlier). The second is to perform the test in \gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}. The first method is the better option for large lists that may contain group headers. The example below uses the second method. The file \filefmt{myentries.bib} contains the following: \newcommand{\printunitexamplebib}{% \atentry{symbol}\marg{pi,\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}},\newline \gloskeyval{description}{ratio of the length of the circumference of a circle to its diameter}}\newline \atentry{symbol}\marg{root2,\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{surd}2}},\newline \gloskeyval{description}{Pythagoras' constant}}\newline \atentry{symbol}\marg{zeta3,\gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{zeta}(3)}},\newline \gloskeyval{description}{Ap\cmd{'}ery's constant}}\newline \atentry{symbol}\marg{zero,\gloskeyval{name}{0},\newline \gloskeyval{description}{nothing or nil}}\newline \atentry{symbol}\marg{one,\gloskeyval{name}{1},\newline \gloskeyval{description}{single entity, unity}} } \begin{codebox} \printunitexamplebib \end{codebox} The document redefines the handler to only show entries in the current section: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter}\marg{\ctr{section}} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{myentries}} \cbeg{document} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrfieldxifinlist}\marg{\#1}\marg{record.section}\marg{\thecounter{section}} \marg{\gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}\marg{\#1}}\% \marg{}\% } \cmd{section}\marg{Sample} \gls{printunsrtglossary} This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{pi}, \gls{gls}\marg{root2} and \gls{gls}\marg{zeta3}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample} \gls{printunsrtglossary} This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{one}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi} and \gls{gls}\marg{zero}. \cend{document} \end{codebox} If the document is saved in the file \filefmt{myDoc.tex} then the build process is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The first \LaTeX\ run adds the \records\ to the \ext{aux} file for \app{bib2gls} to pick up, but also adds the \gls{glsxtr@counterrecord} lines (which \app{bib2gls} ignores) that setup the \glslink{opt.glosfield.record.counter}{\fieldfmt{record.section}} list field for the given entry. This means that \gls{glsxtrfieldxifinlist} can be used to determine whether or not the current section number (\thecounter{section}) is in the list. If it is, then the entry is displayed in the current \idx{glossarystyle} using the default \gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}. Otherwise nothing is displayed. The following command is provided that performs something similar: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryunit} This is equivalent to: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{\gls{glsdefaulttype}},\#1}\marg{\comment{} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunitsetup}\marg{\#2}\comment{} }% \end{compactcodebox} This initialises the hook via: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryunitsetup} This is essentially does: \begin{compactcodebox} \comment{redefine handler to only show entries with a match:} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryhandler}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrfieldxifinlist}\marg{\#1}\marg{record.\meta{counter-name}}\marg{\thecountername} \marg{\gls{glsxtrunsrtdo}\marg{\#1}}\comment{} \marg{}\comment{} }\comment{} \meta{assign target name prefixes (see below)} \comment{suppress section header:} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glossarysection}}[2][]\marg{}\comment{} \comment{append vertical space after the glossary:} \cmd{appto}\gls{glossarypostamble}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryunitpostskip}}\comment{} \end{compactcodebox} This is more complicated than the original example as it also suppresses the glossary section header and modifies the target name prefix. Additionally, the following is appended to the end of the \idx{glossary}: \cmddef{printunsrtglossaryunitpostskip} This simply does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glspar}\cmd{medskip}\gls{glspar} \end{compactcodebox} which creates a small vertical space. The target name prefix (\printglossopt{targetnameprefix}) is assigned as follows. If \theHcountername\ has been defined, the prefix is: \begin{compactcodebox} record.\meta{counter-name}.\theHcountername.\gls{@gobble} \end{compactcodebox} otherwise the prefix is: \begin{compactcodebox} record.\meta{counter-name}.\thecountername.\gls{@gobble} \end{compactcodebox} The use of \gls{@gobble} at the end discards \gls{glolinkprefix}. The above example can be rewritten using \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}. I've added \resourceopt{symbol-sort-fallback} to sort by the description and a full glossary at the end of the document. \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter}\marg{\ctr{section}} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{myentries}, \resourceoptval{symbol-sort-fallback}{\gloskey{description}} } \cbeg{document} \cmd{section}\marg{Sample} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\marg{\ctr{section}} This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{pi}, \gls{gls}\marg{root2} and \gls{gls}\marg{zeta3}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\marg{\ctr{section}} This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{one}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi} and \gls{gls}\marg{zero}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The build process is the same as before: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The resulting document is shown in \exampleref{ex:minigloss}. Note that all glossaries show the \idxpl{locationlist}, which all contain the page number~1, since the example document is only one page long. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:minigloss}, title={Sub-glossary for a given counter value}, description={Example document demonstrating a mini-glossary that only shows entries recorded in the current section}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% \printunitexamplebib^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter}\marg{\ctr{section}}^^J \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{\cmd{jobname}},^^J \resourceoptval{symbol-sort-fallback}{\gloskey{description}}^^J% } }{\cmd{section}\marg{Sample}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\marg{section}^^J% This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{pi}, \gls{gls}\marg{root2} and \gls{gls}\marg{zeta3}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\marg{section}^^J% This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{one}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi} and \gls{gls}\marg{zero}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Other variations include creating a secondary \idx{glossary} that's ordered differently for the \idxpl{mini-glossary}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{glossary2} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{\cmd{jobname}}, \resourceoptval{symbol-sort-fallback}{\gloskey{description}}, \resourceoptval{secondary}{use:glossary2} } \end{codebox} This orders the secondary glossary according to use (the first record for the entire document not for the given unit). The \idxpl{mini-glossary} will then need the \printglossopt{type} option: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{glossary2}}\marg{\ctr{section}} \end{codebox} There is an alternative method that ensures the \idxpl{mini-glossary} are ordered by use within the section. This can be done by redefining \gls{glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook} to create a \idx{glossary} for each unit (instead of using a secondary \idx{glossary}): \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook}}[3]\marg{\comment{} \gls{provideignoredglossary}\marg{\#2.\#3}\comment{} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}*\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2.\#3}\comment{} } \end{codebox} (Remember this needs to be done in the preamble, before the \ext{aux} file is input.) This creates a \idx{glossary} with the label \code{\meta{counter}.\meta{value}}, if it's not already defined, and adds the entry's label to it. This means that this \idx{glossary} will only contain the entries for the matching \meta{counter} and \meta{value}, and the entry labels are in the order they were added to the \ext{aux} file. The \idx{glossary} needs to be set appropriately. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{section.\thecounter{section}}}\marg{\ctr{section}} \end{codebox} There's now no filtering required, but \gls{printunsrtglossaryunit} is still useful as it automatically suppresses the section header, alters the hyperlink prefix and adds extra spacing after the glossary. However, if you prefer, you can simply do something like: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{section.\thecounter{section}}, \printglossoptval{target}{false}} {\cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glossarysection}}[2][]\marg{}} \gls{printunsrtglossaryunitpostskip} \end{codebox} This is done in \exampleref{ex:minigloss2}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:minigloss2}, title={Sub-glossary for a given counter value ordered by use in the section}, description={Example document demonstrating a mini-glossary that only shows entries recorded in the current section in the order they were recorded in that section}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}\marg{\cmd{jobname}.bib}^^J% \printunitexamplebib^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{stylemods},\optval{style}{index}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J \gls{GlsXtrRecordCounter}\marg{\ctr{section}}^^J \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{\cmd{jobname}},^^J \resourceoptval{symbol-sort-fallback}{\gloskey{description}}^^J% } \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrAddCounterRecordHook}}[3]\marg{\%^^J \gls{provideignoredglossary}\marg{\#2.\#3}\%^^J \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}*\marg{\#1}\marg{\#2.\#3}\%^^J% } \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{minigloss}}\marg{\%^^J \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{section.\cmd{thesection}},^^J \printglossoptval{target}{false}}^^J {\cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glossarysection}}[2][]\marg{}}^^J \gls{printunsrtglossaryunitpostskip}^^J% } }{\cmd{section}\marg{Sample}^^J% \cmd{minigloss}^^J% This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{pi}, \gls{gls}\marg{root2} and \gls{gls}\marg{zeta3}. \codepar \cmd{section}\marg{Another Sample}^^J% \cmd{minigloss}^^J% This section discusses \gls{gls}\marg{one}, \gls{gls}\marg{pi} and \gls{gls}\marg{zero}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \section{Standalone Entry Items} \label{sec:glossentry} It may be that you don't want a list but would rather display entry details throughout the document. You can simply do \gls{glsentryname} followed by \gls{glsentrydesc}. (Remember that if you don't want a sorted list, use \optval{sort}{none} or \optval{sort}{clear} to skip the preprocessing of the \gloskey{sort} field.) For example, in the preamble provide a custom command to display the entry's name and description: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{displayterm}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip}\cmd{par}\cmd{noindent} Definition: \gls{glsentryname}\marg{\#1}.\cmd{par} \gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\#1} \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip} } \end{codebox} define your entries, for example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{function}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{function}, \gloskeyval{description}{a relation or expression involving variables} } \end{codebox} and then later in the text: \begin{codebox} \cmd{displayterm}\marg{function} \end{codebox} However, if may be that you want to use \sty{hyperref} and have commands like \gls{gls} link back to the place where the term is described. Instead of using \gls{glsentryname} use: \cmddef{glsxtrglossentry} where \meta{entry-label} is the entry's label. This is designed to behave much like the way the name is displayed in the glossary. It performs the following: \begin{itemize} \item Defines \gls{glscurrententrylabel} to the entry's label. This is usually done at the start of the glossary style commands \gls{glossentry} and \gls{subglossentry} and may be used by hooks, such as the \idx{postnamehook}. Here the definition is localised so that it's only available for use in \gls{glossentryname}. \item Defines \gls{currentglossary} to the entry's glossary type. This is usually done at the start of commands like \gls{printglossary} and may be used by style hooks. Here the definition is localised so that it's only available for use in \gls{glsentryitem} and \gls{glssubentryitem}. The value is obtained by fully expanding: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneGlossaryType} which defaults to the value of the \gloskey{type} field for the current entry. \item Increments and display the entry counters if the \opt{entrycounter} or \opt{subentrycounter} package options are set. If the entry doesn't have a parent, then this does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsentryitem}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} otherwise it does: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneSubEntryItem} which defaults to \code{\gls{glssubentryitem}\margm{entry-label}} if the entry has a parent but not a grandparent. This reflects the behaviour of the predefined hierarchical styles. A bug in pre-version~1.31 used \gls{glsentryitem} for all child levels, which doesn't match the hierarchical glossary styles. If you want to restore this behaviour, just do: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{GlsXtrStandaloneSubEntryItem}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glssubentryitem}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} \item Sets the hyper-target if supported (using \gls{glstarget}) and displays the entry name using: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryName} which uses \code{\gls{glstarget}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glossentryname}\margm{entry-label}}} by default. Remember that \gls{glossentryname} uses \gls{glsnamefont} or picks up the style from category attributes such as \catattr{glossnamefont}. This can result in duplicate targets if you use both standalone commands and display the \idx{glossary}. In which case, you can redefine \gls{glstarget} to use \gls{glsxtrtarget}, which will ensure that the first target will be the one that takes precedence. \end{itemize} If you have used \gls{nopostdesc} or \gls{glsxtrnopostpunc} in any of your description fields, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtractivatenopost} to make these commands behave as they normally do within a glossary. This needs to be placed before: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glossentrydesc}\margm{entry-label}\gls{glspostdescription} \end{compactcodebox} and scoped. Note that \gls{glsnonextpages} and \gls{glsnextpages} have no effect outside of the glossary and are not intended for use in a standalone context. It's also possible to select a different field (rather than using \gloskey{name}): \cmddef{glsxtrglossentryother} The \meta{field-label} must be given using its \idx{internalfieldlabel}. The \meta{header} argument is the code to pass to the third argument of \gls{glsxtrtitleorpdforheading}. It may be left empty in which case the default is determined as follows: \begin{itemize} \item If \csfmt{glsxtrhead\meta{field-label}} is defined (see \sectionref{sec:headingsadvanced}), then \meta{header} is \csfmt{glsxtrhead\meta{field-label}}\marg{entry-label}. \item Otherwise \meta{header} is simply the field value. \end{itemize} The \gls{glsxtrglossentryother} command internally uses \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryOther} instead of \gls{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryName}, which uses \code{\gls{glossentrynameother}\margm{entry-label}\marg{field-label}} instead of \code{\gls{glossentryname}\margm{entry-label}}. If you have loaded the \sty{glossaries-accsupp} package (through the \opt{accsupp} option) then accessibility support will be provided if there's a corresponding command: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{gls\meta{field-label}accessdisplay}\margm{text}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} (for example, \gls{glssymbolaccessdisplay}). This means that my custom command can be changed to: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{displayterm}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip}\cmd{par}\cmd{noindent} Definition: \gls{glsxtrglossentry}\marg{\#1}.\cmd{par} \gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\#1} \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip} } \end{codebox} If I want numbered definitions, then I can use the package options \opt{entrycounter} or \opt{subentrycounter} and remove the colon: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{displayterm}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip}\cmd{par}\cmd{noindent} Definition \gls{glsxtrglossentry}\marg{\#1}.\cmd{par} \gls{glsentrydesc}\marg{\#1} \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip} } \end{codebox} The counter label uses a dot after the number by default but this can be changed to a colon: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsentrycounterlabel}}\marg{\gls{theglossaryentry}:\cmd{space}} \end{codebox} It's now possible to not only use \gls{gls} to link back to the definition but also use \gls{glsrefentry} to reference the counter and \gls{glsxtrpageref} to reference the page number. If I want the description to behave more like it does in a glossary in need to make the following modification: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{displayterm}}[1]\marg{\% \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip}\cmd{par}\cmd{noindent} Definition \gls{glsxtrglossentry}\marg{\#1}.\cmd{par} \cmd{begingroup} \gls{glsxtractivatenopost} \gls{glossentrydesc}\marg{\#1}\gls{glspostdescription} \cmd{endgroup} \cmd{par}\cmd{medskip} } \end{codebox} (Note the grouping to localise \gls{glsxtractivatenopost}.) You can also use \gls{glsxtrglossentry} within section headings. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{section}\marg{\gls{glsxtrglossentry}\marg{function}} \end{codebox} If \gls{glsxtrglossentry} occurs in a section title and \sty{hyperref} has been loaded, then \gls{glsxtrglossentry} will expand in the PDF bookmark as: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryPdfName} This defaults to \code{\gls{glsentryname}\margm{entry-label}} The page headers and table of contents will use \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryHeadName} which defaults to \code{\gls{glsxtrheadname}\margm{entry-label}}. For example, to ensure that the name is displayed in \idx{sentencecase} in the title, PDF bookmarks and heading: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{glossname}}\marg{firstuc} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryPdfName}}[1]\marg{\gls{Glsentryname}\marg{\#1}} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryHeadName}}[1]\marg{\gls{Glsentryname}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} Note that this requires \sty{glossaries} v4.50+ to ensure that \gls{Glsentryname} expands. An alternative is to use \gls{Glsxtrusefield}. If \gls{glsxtrglossentryother} occurs in a section title and \sty{hyperref} has been loaded, then \gls{glsxtrglossentryother} will expand in the PDF bookmark as: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryPdfOther} This defaults to the value of the given field. The page headers and table of contents will use the \meta{header} argument, if not empty, otherwise it will use: \cmddef{GlsXtrStandaloneEntryHeadOther} This does \csfmt{glsxtrhead\meta{field-label}}, if it exists, or otherwise it just does the value of the given field (which can be obtained with \gls{glsxtrusefield}). If you're using a page style or table of contents that doesn't use \gls{markright} or \gls{markboth} or \gls{@starttoc} then you need to insert \gls{glsxtrmarkhook} and \gls{@glsxtrinmark} at the start of the header or table of contents either scoped or afterwards cancelled with \gls{@glsxtrnotinmark} and \gls{glsxtrrestoremarkhook}, see \sectionref{sec:headingsadvanced}. \section{Glossary Style Modifications} \label{sec:glosstylemods} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines \gls{setglossarystyle}, and it now includes a hook that's performed before the style is set: \cmddef{glsxtrpreglossarystyle} This allows for new style commands that aren't provided by the base \sty{glossaries} package to be initialised in the event that a style that doesn't redefine them is used. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpreglossarystyle}}\marg{\comment{} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glssubgroupheading}}[4]\marg{\gls{glsgroupheading}\marg{\#\#4}}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} If you prefer a different default, you can redefine this command as appropriate. The commands \gls{glossentryname} and \gls{glossentrydesc} are modified to take into account the \catattr{glossname}, \catattr{glossnamefont}, \catattr{glossdesc} and \catattr{glossdescfont} attributes (see \sectionref{sec:categories}). This means you can make simple font or case-changing modifications to the name and description without defining a new glossary style. The command \gls{glossentrysymbol} is modified to take into account the \catattr{glosssymbolfont} attribute. Note that, unlike the above, there's no corresponding attribute to change the case as it's usually not appropriate to change the case of a symbol (and for some symbols, such as pictographs, there's no concept of case). If \gls{texorpdfstring} has been defined \gls{glossentrysymbol} will be defined to do: \begin{codebox} \gls{texorpdfstring}\margm{\TeX\ code}\margm{PDF} \end{codebox} The \meta{\TeX\ code} part is robust and deals with the actual typesetting of the symbol. The \meta{PDF} part is simply: \cmddef{glsentrypdfsymbol} which is defined to just do \code{\gls{glsentrysymbol}\margm{entry-label}}. The chances are that the code in the \gloskey{symbol} key won't be valid in the PDF bookmarks, so you can redefine \gls{glsentrypdfsymbol} to use a more appropriate field. (If you do redefine this command, remember that it needs to fully expand.) For example, if you are using \sty{glossaries-accsupp}, you could use the \gloskey{symbolaccess} field: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsentrypdfsymbol}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsentrysymbolaccess}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} Alternatively, if you are using \app{bib2gls} you can use the \TeX\ parser library to interpret a copy of the \gloskey{symbol} field and use that. For example, with the \idxpl{resourceopt}: \begin{codebox} \resourceoptvalm{replicate-fields}{\gloskey{symbol}=\gloskey{user1}}, \resourceoptval{interpret-fields}{\gloskey{user1}} \end{codebox} This copies the value of the \gloskey{symbol} field to the \gloskey{user1} field (\resourceopt{replicate-fields}) and then replaces the value of the \gloskey{user1} field with its interpreted value (\resourceopt{interpret-fields}). This means you can then do: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsentrypdfsymbol}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsentryuseri}\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} (You may need \XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX\ with this method.) This allows \gls{glossentrysymbol} to be used in a section heading with standalone definitions. See the \app{bib2gls} manual for further details about the \TeX\ interpreter. If you want to adapt a style to use another field instead of \gloskey{name}, you can use: \cmddef{glossentrynameother} This behaves just like \gls{glossentryname} (that is, it obeys the \catattr{glossname} attribute, uses either the \catattr{glossnamefont} attribute or \gls{glsnamefont} to format the text, and uses the \idx{postnamehook}) but the text is obtained from the field given \meta{field-label} instead of \gloskey{name}. The \meta{field-label} argument must be the \idx{internalfieldlabel} (for example \code{desc} rather than \code{description}). \subsection{Post-Name Hooks} \label{sec:postnamehooks} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package adds a hook to \gls{glossentryname} and \gls{Glossentryname} (which is used in \idxpl{glossarystyle} to display the entry's name): \cmddef{glsxtrpostnamehook} This is the main \idx{postnamehook}, which implements additional hooks to allow for customisation. By default, \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook} checks the \catattr{indexname} attribute. If the attribute exists for the category to which the entry belongs, then the name is automatically indexed using: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrdoautoindexname}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\catattr{indexname}} \end{compactcodebox} See \sectionref{sec:autoindex} for further details. The post-name hook \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook} will also use: \cmddef{glsxtrpostnamecategory} if it exists. You can use \gls{glscurrententrylabel} to obtain the entry label with the definition of this command. For example, suppose you are using a glossary style the doesn't display the symbol, you can insert the symbol after the name for a particular category, say, the \qt{symbol} category: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\cmd{glsxtrpostnamesymbol}}\marg{\cmd{space} (\gls{glsentrysymbol}\marg{\gls{glscurrententrylabel}})} \end{codebox} For convenience, you can use: \cmddef{glsdefpostname} This is simply a shortcut for: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{csdef}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory}}\margm{definition} \end{compactcodebox} Note that it doesn't check if the command has already been defined. The \idx{postnamehook} also does: \cmddef{glsextrapostnamehook} (before \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory}) to allow for additional non-category related code. This does nothing by default. \subsection{Post-Description Hooks} \label{sec:postdeschooks} The \sty{glossaries} package provides the hook \gls{glspostdescription}, which is placed after the description in some of the predefined styles. The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package modifies the predefined styles to ensure that they all use this hook. This provides a convenient way to make slight adjustments, such as appending content after the description, without having to define a custom glossary style. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package redefines \gls{glspostdescription} so that it includes the following hook: \cmddef{glsxtrpostdescription} This new hook simply performs the \idx{catpostdeschook}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostdescription}}\marg{\comment{} \cmd{csuse}\marg{glsxtrpostdesc\gls{glscategory}\marg{\gls{glscurrententrylabel}}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} \begin{information} The punctuation that is automatically inserted with \opt{postdot} or \opt{postpunc} is placed after \gls{glsxtrpostdescription}, not before. \end{information} If you want to modify the hook for all entries (without affecting the \opt{postpunc} or \opt{postdot} options), then redefine \gls{glsxtrpostdescription}. If you want to adjust this hook according to the entry's category, then you can simply redefine the \idx{catpostdeschook}. \cmddef{glsxtrpostdesccategory} Some common \idxpl{catpostdeschook} are provided: \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescgeneral} The \idx{postdeschook} for the \cat{general} category. \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescterm} The \idx{postdeschook} for the \cat{term} category. \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescacronym} The \idx{postdeschook} for the \cat{acronym} category. \cmddef*{glsxtrpostdescabbreviation} The \idx{postdeschook} for the \cat{abbreviation} category. The above all do nothing by default. You can redefine them with \gls{renewcommand} or use: \cmddef{glsdefpostdesc} This will define (or redefine) \gls{glsxtrpostdesccategory}. The package options \opt{symbols}, \opt{numbers} and \opt{index} provide corresponding \idxpl{catpostdeschook}. You can reference the current entry within these hooks using \gls{glscurrententrylabel}, which is defined within the \idx{glossary} (any of the \csfmt{print\ldots glossary} commands) and also within the standalone commands, such as \gls{glsxtrglossentry}. \cmddef{glsxtrnopostpunc} Suppresses the post-description punctuation that is automatically inserted by package options \opt{postdot} or \opt{postpunc}. The \sty{glossaries} package provides \gls{nopostdesc}, which may be used in the \gloskey{description} to suppress the \idx{postdeschook} for that entry. This suppresses both the post-description punctuation and the additional \gls{glsxtrpostdescription} hook. If you only want to suppress to punctuation, then use \gls{glsxtrnopostpunc} instead. \begin{information} The \idxpl{postdeschook} are implemented by \gls{glspostdescription} within the glossary style. If this command isn't used in the style, then the additional hooks won't be available. \end{information} \cmddef{glsxtrrestorepostpunc} If this command is placed in the definition of \gls{glsxtrpostdescription} or added to the \idx{catpostlinkhook}, then it will counter-act any use of \gls{glsxtrnopostpunc} to restore the post-description punctuation. These commands have no effect outside of the glossary (except with standalone entries that use \gls{glsxtractivatenopost} and \gls{glspostdescription}, see \sectionref{sec:glossentry}). \subsection{Number (Location) List} \label{sec:glosstylenumlist} The \idx{locationlist} is now placed inside the argument of: \cmddef{GlsXtrFormatLocationList} This is internally used by \gls{glossaryentrynumbers}. The \opt{nonumberlist} option redefines \gls{glossaryentrynumbers} so that it doesn't display the \idx{numberlist}, but it still saves the \idx{numberlist} in case it's required. The desired font formatting for the \idx{locationlist} can now more easily be set by redefining \gls{GlsXtrFormatLocationList}, without interfering with \gls{glossaryentrynumbers}. \begin{important} If you want to suppress the \idx{numberlist} always use the \opt{nonumberlist} option instead of redefining \gls{glossaryentrynumbers} to do nothing. \end{important} Note that if you are using the \idx{unsrtfam} the \idx{locationlist} will only be present if the appropriate field has been set (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtlocations}). There's no need to save locations with \app{bib2gls} or with \gls{printnoidxglossary} because this is performed automatically (unlike \gls{printglossary} where the trick with \gls{glossaryentrynumbers} is required to capture the \idx{locationlist}). Sometimes users like to insert \qt{page} or \qt{pages} in front of the \idx{locationlist}. This is quite fiddly to do with the base \sty{glossaries} package, but \sty{glossaries-extra} provides a way of doing this. First you need to enable this option and specify the text to display using: \cmddef{GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag} where \meta{page tag} is the text to display if the \idx{locationlist} only contains a single location and \meta{pages tag} is the text to display otherwise. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag}\marg{Page: }\marg{Pages: } \end{codebox} An extra run is required when using this command. \begin{important} Use \encap{glsignore} not \encap{@gobble} as the format if you want to suppress the page number (and only index the entry once). \end{important} See the accompanying sample file \file{sample-pages.tex} for an example. \begin{information} Note that \app{bib2gls} the \resourceopt{loc-prefix} resource option inserts a prefix at the start of non-empty location lists, which can be used as an alternative to \gls{GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag}. There is also a corresponding \resourceopt{loc-suffix} option to provide a suffix. \end{information} \Idxpl{locationlist} displayed with \gls{printnoidxglossary} internally use: \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc} This command is provided by \sty{glossaries}, but is modified by \sty{glossaries-extra} to check for the start and end range formation identifiers \verb|(| and \verb|)| which are discarded to obtain the actual control sequence name that forms the location formatting command. If the range identifiers aren't present, this just uses \cmddef{glsxtrdisplaysingleloc} otherwise it uses \cmddef{glsxtrdisplaystartloc} for the start of a range (where the identifier has been stripped from \meta{format}) or \cmddef{glsxtrdisplayendloc} for the end of a range (where the identifier has been stripped from \meta{format}). By default the start range command saves the format in: \cmddef{glsxtrlocrangefmt} and does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrdisplaysingleloc}\margm{format}\margm{location} \end{compactcodebox} (If the format is empty, it will be replaced with \code{glsnumberformat}.) The end command checks that the format matches the start of the range, does: \cmddef{glsxtrdisplayendlochook} (which does nothing by default), followed by: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrdisplaysingleloc}\margm{format}\margm{location} \end{compactcodebox} and then sets \gls{glsxtrlocrangefmt} to empty. This means that the list \begin{codebox} \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{(textbf}\marg{1}, \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{textbf}\marg{1}, \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{)textbf}\marg{1}. \end{codebox} doesn't display any differently from \begin{codebox} \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{textbf}\marg{1}, \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{textbf}\marg{1}, \gls{glsnoidxdisplayloc}\marg{}\marg{page}\marg{textbf}\marg{1}. \end{codebox} but it does make it easier to define your own custom list handler that can accommodate the ranges. \subsection{Indexing Groups} \label{sec:glosgroups} The letter or symbol or number \idxpl{group} are a by-product of the \idx{indexingapp}. These are usually determined during the sorting according to the first (significant) character of the sort value. If the first character is an alphabetical character, the group is a letter group, with the group label the same as the letter. If the sort value is numeric, the group is a number group, with the label \code{glsnumbers}, otherwise the group is a symbol group with the label \code{glssymbols}. \begin{information} For the \idx{unsrtfam}, see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups} for more details about how \idx{group} headers are inserted into the \idx{glossary}. Only those commands are able to support sub-\idxpl{group}. \end{information} With \app{xindy}, the number group is automatically provided with the \optval{xindy}{glsnumbers} package option. It can be suppressed with \optval{xindy}{\marg{glsnumbers=false}} (see the base \sty{glossaries} user manual for further details). With \app{bib2gls}, group formation requires \switch{group} (or \switch{g}). This setting is off by default to allow for a faster process where no groups are required. When this setting is on, there are additional groups, depending on the sort method. For example, if you use a date-time sort method, then you will have date-time groups. \begin{warning} Take care not to confusion \idxpl{group} with hierarchy. See \gallerypage{logicaldivisions}{Gallery: Logical Glossary Divisions (type vs group vs parent)} for the difference between the \gloskey{group}, \gloskey{type} and \gloskey{parent} fields. \end{warning} The base \sty{glossaries} package provides a simplistic way of assigning a title to a group to allow for the use of language-sensitive commands \gls{glssymbolsgroupname} and \gls{glsnumbersgroupname}, which correspond to the \code{glssymbols} and \code{glsnumbers} groups. The more flexible groups that can be created with \app{bib2gls} require a better approach that is less likely to cause a conflict. \cmddef{glsxtrsetgrouptitle} Globally assigns the given title \meta{group-title} to the group identified by \meta{group-label}. This command is used implicitly within the \ext{glstex} file to assign titles to groups obtained by \app{bib2gls}. Judicious definitions of the helper commands provided by \app{bib2gls} can provide a more flexible way of assigning groups. \cmddef{glsxtrlocalsetgrouptitle} As above but the assignment is local. \cmddef{glsxtrgetgrouptitle} Obtains the title corresponding to the group identified by \meta{group-label} and stores the result in \meta{cs}. This command first checks if a title has been assigned by \gls{glsxtrgetgrouptitle} and then, for compatibility with the base \sty{glossaries} package, it will test for the existence of \csfmt{\meta{group-label}groupname} if \meta{group-label} is \code{glssymbols} or \code{glsnumbers} or a single character. If no title is obtained from any of these tests, then the title will be assumed to be the same as the label. \begin{information} The \gls{printnoidxglossary} command has a slightly different method, which uses the character code so it's not suitable with \idx{utf8}. In general, \gls{printnoidxglossary} is best avoided, where possible, and is inappropriate for locale-sensitive sorting. \end{information} \subsection{\stytext{glossaries-extra-stylemods}} \label{sec:stylemods} The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package (more conveniently loaded through the \sty{glossaries-extra} \opt{stylemods} option) modifies some of the predefined styles that are provided with the \sty{glossaries} package. \begin{important} Any styles loaded after \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} won't be patched. \end{important} The \opt{stylemods} option may be provided without a value, in which case all currently defined styles will be patched. Alternatively, you can supply a comma-separated list as the value, which indicates that, for each \meta{element} in the list, the package \styfmt{glossary\dhyphen\meta{element}} should be loaded and, if it's a package provided with the base \sty{glossaries} package, patched. For example: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossary-longragged} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossary-mcols} \cmd{usepackage}\marg{glossaries-extra-stylemods} \gls{setglossarystyle}\marg{\glostyle{mcolindex}} \end{compactcodebox} is equivalent to: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optvalm{stylemods}{longragged,mcols},\optval{style}{\glostyle{mcolindex}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{compactcodebox} You may prefer to combine \optval{stylemods} with \opt{nostyles} to reduce the overhead of loading unnecessary packages. The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package adjusts the predefined styles so that they all use \gls{glspostdescription} and replaces any hard-coded space before the \idx{locationlist} with \cmddef{glsxtrprelocation} You can therefore redefine that command in combination with \opt{postpunc} to alter the separator before the \idx{locationlist}. For example, to have a comma followed by \gls{hfil}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}[\opteqvalref{postpunc}{comma},\opt{stylemods}]\marg{glossaries-extra} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrprelocation}}\marg{\gls{hfil}} \end{codebox} \begin{warning} Be careful with doing this as it will look odd if the \gls{locationlist} is missing. \end{warning} With \app{bib2gls} you can instead redefine \gls{glsxtrprelocation} to do nothing and set the location prefixes with \resourceopt{loc-prefix} which will only apply if the entry has a \gls{locationlist}. Alternatively, you could redefine \gls{glsxtrprelocation} to check if the \gloskey{location} field is set. \subsubsection{Inline Style} \label{sec:stylemodsinline} The patched \glostyle{inline} style is dealt with slightly differently. The original definition provided by the \sty{glossary-inline} package uses \gls{glspostdescription} at the end of the glossary (not after each entry description) within the definition of \gls{glspostinline}. The style modification changes this so that \gls{glspostinline} just does a full stop followed by space factor adjustment, and the description \gls{glsinlinedescformat} and sub-entry description formats \gls{glsinlinesubdescformat} are redefined to include \gls{glsxtrpostdescription} (not \gls{glspostdescription}). This means that the modified \glostyle{inline} style isn't affected by the \opt{nopostdot} option, but the \idx{catpostdeschook} can still be used. \subsubsection{Tabular Styles} \label{sec:stylemodstab} The \env{tabular}-like styles, such as \glostyle{long} are adjusted so that the \gls{ifglsnogroupskip} conditional (set with \opt{nogroupskip}) is moved outside of the definition of \gls{glsgroupskip} to avoid problems that cause an \qt{Incomplete \csfmt{iftrue}} error with \gls{printunsrtglossary} and \gls{printnoidxglossary}. This means that if you want to change this conditional using \gls{setupglossaries} or using the \printglossopt{nogroupskip} option in \gls{printglossary}, \gls{printnoidxglossary} or \gls{printunsrtglossary}, you must also reset the \idx{glossarystyle}. \subsubsection{List Styles} \label{sec:stylemodslist} The \glostyle{list} styles use: \cmddef{glslistprelocation} (which defaults to \gls{glsxtrprelocation}) for top-level items and: \cmddef{glslistchildprelocation} (which defaults to \gls{glslistprelocation}) for child items. The description (including the post-description hook) is governed by: \cmddef{glslistdesc} for the \glostyle{list} and \glostyle{altlist} styles (but not the \glostyle{listdotted} variations). The hard-coded \code{\gls{item}\oargm{target and name}} is replaced with: \cmddef{glslistitem} The \glostyle{altlist} styles use: \cmddef{glsaltlistitem} which internally uses \gls{glslistitem}. The header item (for the list styles that should the group title, such as \glostyle{listgroup}) is governed by: \cmddef{glslistgroupheaderitem} This ignores the \meta{group-label} by default and simply places the second argument in the optional argument of \gls{item}. The \meta{header code} is the formatted group title, possibly including a hypertarget. The spacing after the group item is given by: \cmddef{glslistgroupafterheader} For just the \glostyle{list} style and its letter group variations (not the \glostyle{altlist} or \glostyle{listdotted} variations) the \idx{locationlist} for child entries is followed by: \cmddef{glslistchildpostlocation} which defaults to a \idx{fullstop}. The default value of \gls{glslistdottedwidth} is changed so that it's set at the start of the document (if it hasn't been changed in the preamble). This should take into account situations where \gls{hsize} isn't set until the start of the document. The separator between groups (if not \opt{nogroupskip}) is now given by: \cmddef{glslistgroupskip} This defaults to \gls{indexspace} with penalties to deter page breaks. This command isn't used if \opt{nogroupskip} is set. \subsubsection{Tree Styles} \label{sec:stylemodstree} The group headings for styles like \glostyle{treegroup} are formatted with: \cmddef{glstreegroupheaderfmt} The navigation elements for styles like \glostyle{treehypergroup} is formatted with: \cmddef{glstreenavigationfmt} The above two commands are defined in terms of \gls{glstreenamefmt}, since that was the command originally used for the group headings and navigation. This now allows these different elements to be defined independently, but the most common redefinition is for \gls{glstreenamefmt} to remove the bold in the name. If the bold is still required for the group heading and navigation elements, then both other commands also need redefining. To simplify matters, all three commands have been defined to use: \cmddef{glstreedefaultnamefmt} This simply does \code{\gls+{textbf}\margm{text}}. This means that if you want to change all three to use a particular style you only need to redefine \gls{glstreedefaultnamefmt}, but if you only want to redefine \gls{glstreenamefmt} without affecting the other two commands, then you now can. The separator between groups without headers is given by: \cmddef{glstreegroupskip} This defaults to just \gls{indexspace} without penalties. This command isn't used if \opt{nogroupskip} is set. (The penalties introduced in v1.41 were moved to \gls{glstreegroupheaderskip} in v1.42 as they are inappropriate when there's no header.) The separator between groups with headers is now given by: \cmddef{glstreegroupheaderskip} This defaults to \gls{glstreegroupskip} with penalties to deter page breaks after the group heading. The styles that display the \idx{group} titles now use: \cmddef{glstreePreHeader} This does nothing by default and is inserted before the group title. You can redefine it to add the group title to the PDF bookmarks. For example, if the \idx{glossary} title uses \gls{chapter} then: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstreePreHeader}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{pdfbookmark}\oarg{1}\marg{\#2}\marg{\gls{currentglossary}.\#1}\comment{} } \end{codebox} will insert section-level bookmarks. The use of \gls{currentglossary} helps to provide unique bookmark labels in the event of multiple glossaries. The \sty{glossary-tree} package provides the commands \cmddef{glstreepredesc} and \cmddef{glstreechildpredesc} (which both default to a space) and uses them in the \glostyle{tree}-like styles, but not for the \glostyle{alttree} style. The \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} package modifies the \glostyle{alttree} style so that it has equivalent hooks: \cmddef{glsalttreepredesc} and \cmddef{glsalttreechildpredesc} These do nothing by default. The \glostyle{index}-like and \glostyle{tree}-like styles insert the pre-\idx{locationlist} space with: \cmddef{glstreeprelocation} (which defaults to \gls{glsxtrprelocation}) for top-level items and \cmddef{glstreechildprelocation} (which defaults to \gls{glstreeprelocation}) for child items. The styles like \glostyle{treenoname} use: \cmddef{glstreenonamedesc} to display the pre-description separator, the description and the post-description hook. Similarly for the symbol: \cmddef{glstreenonamesymbol} The above are just used for top-level entries. Child entries don't have the name or symbol displayed for the \glostyle{treenoname} styles, so there's only a command for the child description: \cmddef{glstreenonamechilddesc} For the \glostyle{tree} styles (but not the \glostyle{treenoname} or \glostyle{alttree} styles), the description is displayed using: \cmddef{glstreedesc} and the symbol with: \cmddef{glstreesymbol} Again the above two commands are just for top-level entries. The child entries use: \cmddef{glstreechilddesc} for the description and \cmddef{glstreechildsymbol} for the symbol. There are now wrapper commands for \gls{glstreedesc} and \gls{glstreechilddesc} that check for the description and symbol to determine what separator to use before the page list: \cmddef{glstreeDescLoc} for top-level entries and \cmddef{glstreeChildDescLoc} for sub-entries. If either the symbol or description is present these will use \gls{glstreeprelocation} or \gls{glstreechildprelocation}, respectively. Otherwise, both will use: \cmddef{glstreeNoDescSymbolPreLocation} The default is a space. This means that you could have, say, a comma followed by a space for terms that are simply an alias, but just have a space for terms that have a description that ends with a full stop (or that just have a symbol without a description) where the comma would be inappropriate. \begin{information} Version 1.42 has corrected an error that was introduced to v1.41 that caused the name to run into the location list if there was no symbol and no description. \end{information} There are some additional commands for use with the \glostyle{alttree} style to make it easier to modify. These commands are only defined if the \sty{glossary-tree} package has already been loaded, which is typically the case unless the \opt{notree} or \opt{nostyles} option has been used when loading \sty{glossaries}. \cmddef{gglssetwidest} This is like \gls{glssetwidest} but performs a global assignment. \cmddef{eglssetwidest} This is like \gls{glssetwidest} but expands \meta{name}. \cmddef{xglssetwidest} This is like \gls{eglssetwidest} but performs a global assignment. The following only set the value if \meta{name} is wider than the current value. Local update: \cmddef{glsupdatewidest} Global update: \cmddef{gglsupdatewidest} Locale update (expands \meta{name}): \cmddef{eglsupdatewidest} Global update (expands \meta{name}): \cmddef{xglsupdatewidest} The widest entry value can later be retrieved using: \cmddef{glsgetwidestname} which expands to the widest top-level name and: \cmddef{glsgetwidestsubname} expands to either the widest name for the given \idx{hierarchicallevel} or to the widest top-level name, if no widest name set for \meta{level}. Note that if you are using \app{bib2gls}, you can use the resource option \resourceopt{set-widest} which will try to determine the widest name of all the selected entries. This isn't guaranteed to work as it may depend on fonts or commands that \app{bib2gls} can't replicate, but it should be suitable for names that just consist of text, and can be more efficient than iterating over all the defined entries using \TeX. The command \gls{glsfindwidesttoplevelname} provided by \sty{glossary-tree} has a CamelCase synonym: \cmddef{glsFindWidestTopLevelName} Similar commands are also provided. If the optional \meta{glossary labels} is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed. \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName} This has an additional check that the entry has been \idxc{firstuseflag}{used}. Naturally this is only useful if the glossaries that use the \glostyle{alttree} style occur at the end of the document. This command should be placed just before the start of the glossary. (Alternatively, place it at the end of the document and save the value in the auxiliary file for the next run.) \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedAnyName} This is like the previous command but if doesn't check the \gloskey{parent} key. This is useful if all \idxpl{hierarchicallevel} should have the same width for the name. \cmddef{glsFindWidestAnyName} This is like the previous command but doesn't check if the entry has been used. \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedLevelTwo} This is like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName} but also sets the first two sub-levels as well. Any entry that has a great-grandparent is ignored. \cmddef{glsFindWidestLevelTwo} This is like the previous command but doesn't check if the entry has been used. \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol} This is like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyName} but also measures the symbol. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register}. \cmddef{glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbol} This is like the previous command but it doesn't check if the entry has been used. \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation} This is like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol} but also measures the \idx{locationlist}. This requires \gls{glsentrynumberlist}. The length of the widest symbol is stored in \meta{register1} and the length of the widest \idx{locationlist} is stored in \meta{register2}. \cmddef{glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbolLocation} This is like the previous command but it doesn't check if the entry has been used. \cmddef{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameLocation} This is like \gls{glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation} but doesn't measure the symbol. The length of the widest \idx{locationlist} is stored in \meta{register}. \cmddef{glsFindWidestAnyNameLocation} This is like the previous command but doesn't check if the entry has been used. The layout of the symbol, description and \idx{locationlist} is governed by: \cmddef{glsxtralttreeSymbolDescLocation} for top-level entries and \cmddef{glsxtralttreeSubSymbolDescLocation} for sub-entries. There is now a user level command that performs the initialisation for the \glostyle{alttree} style: \cmddef{glsxtralttreeInit} The paragraph indent for subsequent paragraphs in multi-paragraph descriptions is provided by the length: \cmddef{glsxtrAltTreeIndent} For additional commands that are available with the \glostyle{alttree} style, see the documented code (\filefmt{glossaries-extra-code.pdf}). See also the accompanying sample files \file{sample-alttree.tex}, \file{sample-alttree-sym.tex} and \file{sample-alttree-marginpar.tex}. \section{New Glossary Styles} \label{sec:newglossarystyles} The \sty{glossaries-extra} package comes with some new styles. The associated style package needs to be loaded. This can be done with \csfmt{usepackage} but it's simpler to use the \opt{stylemods} option. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{bookindex}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} If you don't require any of the base styles, use \opt{nostyles} (but note that some style packages automatically load another style package if it the style builds on an existing one). \subsection{\stytext{glossary-bookindex} package} \label{sec:bookindex} \glsstartrange{opt.glostyle.bookindex,pkg.glossary-bookindex}% The \inlineglsdef{pkg.glossary-bookindex} package provides the glossary style \inlineglsdef{opt.glostyle.bookindex}. This is very similar to the \glostyle{mcolindexgroup} style but is designed for indexes, so by default only the name and location list are displayed. This style is demonstrated in \exampleref{ex:bookindex} (using \app{bib2gls}). Note that some entries don't have \idxpl{locationlist} because they weren't \recorded\ in the document, but were included as dependencies. See \sectionref{sec:seenoindex} for dealing with cross-references that may not be required. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:bookindex}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, title={The \optfmt{bookindex} style}, description={Example document demonstrating the bookindex style}] {\cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,nostyles,stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=example-glossaries-xr,^^J selection=\marg{recorded and deps and see not also}^^J% } } {\gls{glsaddeach}\marg{lorem,amet,adipiscing,placerat,arcu,vulputate}^^J% \gls{glsaddeach}\oarg{thevalue=2}\marg{arcu,consectetuer,donec,augue}^^J% \gls{glsaddeach}\oarg{thevalue=3}\marg{arcu,lorem,nulla}^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossary} } \end{resultbox} The \glostyle{bookindex} style only supports a maximum \idx{hierarchicallevel} of 2 (top-level, level~1 and level~2). It's primarily designed for use with \app{bib2gls}. It may be used with other indexing options, but some features may not be present and \idx{utf8} characters may cause a problem with non-Unicode engines in letter group headings or PDF bookmarks. (\app{bib2gls} uses numeric identifies by default to avoid these problems, see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}.) The number of columns is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexcols} which defaults to 2. This style uses the \env{multicols} environment. If the command: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexcolspread} isn't empty then it's supplied as the optional argument following \code{\cbeg{multicols}\margm{n}}. You can switch from \env{multicols} to \env{multicols*} by redefining: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv} For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv}}\marg{multicols*} \end{codebox} Each top-level entry is displayed using: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexname} This just does \code{\gls{glossentryname}\margm{entry-label}} by default. For example, if you want the symbol to be included: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexname}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glossentryname}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \gls{ifglshassymbol}\marg{\#1}\marg{\cmd{space} (\gls{glossentrysymbol}\marg{\#1})}\marg{}\comment{} } \end{codebox} or if you want the description (if set): \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexname}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glossentryname}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \gls{ifglshasdesc}\marg{\#1}\marg{\cmd{space} \gls{glossentrydesc}\marg{\#1}\gls{glspostdescription}}{}\comment{} } \end{codebox} (which picks up the \idx{postdeschook}). Alternatively you can use the \gls{glsxtrpostnamecategory} hook to append information after the name according to the entry's category. Sub-entries are displayed using: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubname} which just defaults to \code{\gls{glsxtrbookindexname}\margm{entry-label}}. The separator used before the \idx{locationlist} for top-level entries is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexprelocation} where \meta{entry-label} is the entry's label. This checks if the \gloskey{location} field has been set. If it has, it does: \begin{codebox} ,\gls{glsxtrprelocation} \end{codebox} otherwise it just does \gls{glsxtrprelocation} (which defaults to \csfmt{space}) with no comma. If you're using \app{bib2gls} with \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false}, the \gloskey{location} field won't be set. The separator used before the \idx{locationlist} for sub-entries is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubprelocation} which defaults to \code{\gls{glsxtrbookindexprelocation}\marg{entry-label}}. The actual location list is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexlocation} for top-level entries and: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsublocation} for sub-entries. These both just do \meta{location list} by default. The separator used between a top-level parent and child entry is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep} This defaults to \csfmt{nopagebreak}. The separator used between a sub-level parent and child entry is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexparentsubchildsep} This defaults to \gls{glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep}. The separator between top-level entries is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexbetween} This comes after the entry given by \meta{entry1-label}, if the entry has no children, or after the last descendent otherwise, so it always comes immediately before the entry given by \meta{entry2-label} unless the entry occurs at the start of a group. This does nothing by default. The separator between two level~1 entries is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubbetween} The separator between two level~2 entries is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubsubbetween} At the end of each letter \idx{group}, the following hooks are done in order: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup} where \meta{entry-label} is the label of the last level~2 entry \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup} where \meta{entry-label} is the label of the last level~1 entry \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexatendgroup} where \meta{entry-label} is the label of the last level~0 entry. For example, the resource option \resourceoptval{seealso}{omit} instructs \app{bib2gls} to omit the \gloskey{seealso} cross-reference from the \idx{locationlist}. (The \gloskey{see} cross-reference will still be added unless you also have \resourceoptval{see}{omit}.) The \gloskey{seealso} cross-reference can instead be appended after the child entries using: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexatendgroup}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{\gloskey{seealso}}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \marg{\gls{glstreesubitem}\gls{glsxtruseseealso}\marg{\#1}}\marg{}\comment{} } \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexbetween}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrbookindexatendgroup}\marg{\#1}\comment{} }% \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{\gloskey{seealso}}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \marg{\gls{glstreesubsubitem}\gls{glsxtruseseealso}\marg{\#1}}\marg{}\comment{} } \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexsubbetween}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup}\marg{\#1}\comment{} } \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}\marg{\gloskey{seealso}}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \marg{\gls{glstreeitem}\cmd{hspace}*\marg{40pt}\gls{glsxtruseseealso}\marg{\#1}}\marg{}\comment{} } \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexsubsubbetween}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup}\marg{\#1}\comment{} } \end{codebox} This uses \gls{glstreesubitem} and \gls{glstreesubsubitem} to indent the cross-reference according to the next level down, so the cross-reference for a top-level entry is aligned with the sub-entries, and a level~1 entry has its cross-reference aligned with sub-sub-entries. In the event that a level~2 entry has a cross-reference, this is indented a bit further (but it won't be aligned with any deeper level as the \glostyle{bookindex} style only supports a maximum of two sub-levels). The \glostyle{bookindex} style uses group headings. (If you use \app{bib2gls} remember to invoke it with the \switch{group} or \switch{g} switch, see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}.) The heading will use: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexbookmark} If \gls{pdfbookmark} has been defined, this will use that command to bookmark the group title. If \optval{section}{chapter} is set (default if chapters are defined) then this uses level~1 otherwise it uses level~2. You can redefine this command if this isn't appropriate. If \gls{pdfbookmark} hasn't been defined, this command does nothing. The group heading is formatted according to: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexformatheader} which is defined as: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexformatheader}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \cmd{par}\marg{\cmd{centering}\gls{glstreegroupheaderfmt}\marg{\#1}\cmd{par}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} where \gls{glstreegroupheaderfmt} is provided by the \sty{glossary-tree} package, which is automatically loaded. Note that the entry names aren't encapsulated with \gls{glstreenamefmt}. The skip after a \idx{group} header is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexpregroupskip} The argument is the skip that would normally be inserted if there wasn't a group header. The \sty{glossary-bookindex} package provides some supplementary commands that aren't used by default, but may be used when adjusting the style. These commands should only be used within one of the \csfmt{print\ldots glossary} commands. (That is, they should only be used in \idxpl{glossarystyle} or in hooks.) \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexmarkentry} This writes information to the \ext{aux} file that can be read on the next run to obtain the first and last entry on each page of the glossary. You can display the first entry associated with the current page using: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexfirstmark} and the last entry associated with the current page using: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexlastmark} These do nothing if there are no entries marked on the current page (or if the document build isn't up to date). The entry is formatted using: \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexfirstmarkfmt} for the first instance and \cmddef{glsxtrbookindexlastmarkfmt} for the last. These commands are designed for use in page headers or footers where the page number is stable. For example, \gls{glsxtrbookindexname} can be redefined to mark the current entry: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexname}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrbookindexmarkentry}\marg{\#1}\comment{} \gls{glossentryname}\marg{\#1}\comment{} } \end{codebox} If you only want to mark the top-level entries, remember to redefine \gls{glsxtrbookindexsubname} as it defaults to \gls{glsxtrbookindexname}: \begin{codebox} \gls{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexsubname}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glossentryname}\marg{\#1}\comment{} } \end{codebox} Then if you're using \sty{fancyhdr} you can set the page style to show the first and last entry for the current page with: \begin{codebox} \cmd{pagestyle}\marg{fancy}\comment{} \cmd{lhead}\marg{\gls{thepage}}\comment{} \cmd{lfoot}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexfirstmark}}\comment{} \cmd{cfoot}\marg{}\comment{} \cmd{rfoot}\marg{\gls{glsxtrbookindexlastmark}}\comment{} \end{codebox} \glsendrange{opt.glostyle.bookindex,pkg.glossary-bookindex}% \subsection{\stytext{glossary-longextra} package} \label{sec:longextra} \glsstartrange{pkg.glossary-longextra}% The \inlineglsdef{pkg.glossary-longextra} package provides additional \env{tabular}-like styles similar to those provided by \sty{glossary-longbooktabs} (which is automatically loaded). These don't support \idxpl{hierarchicallevel} except for homographs (level~1 entries with the same name as their parent). By default, these styles use the \env{longtable} environment, but if you know that your \idx{glossary} won't span more than a page and you need to use it in a context that's incompatible with \env{longtable}, you can instead setup these styles to use \env{tabular} instead. In order to do this you must use: \cmddef{GlsLongExtraUseTabulartrue} \emph{before the style is set}. If you later want to switch back to using \env{longtable} for another \idx{glossary}, use: \cmddef{GlsLongExtraUseTabularfalse} (or scope \gls{GlsLongExtraUseTabulartrue}). Again, the style must be set after this change to the conditional is implemented. You can test this setting with: \cmddef{ifGlsLongExtraUseTabular} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsLongExtraUseTabulartrue} \gls{setglossarystyle}\marg{\glostyle{long-name-desc}} \end{codebox} or \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsLongExtraUseTabulartrue} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{\glostyle{long-name-desc}}} \end{codebox} If you switch to \env{tabular}, the default vertical alignment is obtained from: \cmddef{glslongextraTabularVAlign} This should expand to one of: \code{c} (centred), \code{t} (top) or \code{b} (bottom). The default is \code{c}. For either \env{tabular} or \env{longtable}, the column titles are formatted according to: \cmddef{glslongextraHeaderFmt} which simply does \code{\cmd{textbf}\margm{text}} by default. As with the \glostyle{long}-like styles, the header text for the columns are given by the language-sensitive commands: \gls{entryname}, \gls{descriptionname}, \gls{symbolname} and \gls{pagelistname}. Most styles show the \gloskey{name} which, as with other predefined styles, also includes the entry item number (if \opt{entrycounter} is on) and hypertarget anchor. These are all performed for top-level entries with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameFmt} This uses \gls{glossentryname}, so it supports the \idx{postnamehook} and associated attributes. Child entries are displayed with: \cmddef{glslongextraSubNameFmt} This includes the sub-entry item number (if \opt{subentrycounter} is on) and the hypertarget anchor. The actual name isn't shown by default. The horizontal alignment for the name column is obtained with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameAlign} This expands to \code{l} by default. For styles that show the \gloskey{description}, that's formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraDescFmt} for top-level entries, which uses \gls{glossentrydesc} and the \idx{postdeschook}, and \cmddef{glslongextraSubDescFmt} for child entries (which just uses \gls{glslongextraDescFmt}). The horizontal alignment for the description column is obtained with: \cmddef{glslongextraDescAlign} This expands to \code{>\marg{\cmd{raggedright}}p\marg{\gls{glsdescwidth}}} by default. This means ragged-right paragraph style with width given by \gls{glsdescwidth}. (See the documentation for the \sty{array} package for information about this alignment syntax.) If a widest name has been set, \gls{glsdescwidth} will be calculated according to the best fit for the given style. If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you may be able to use the \resourceopt{set-widest} option, otherwise to set the widest name, use: \cmddef{glslongextraSetWidest} If you have already used \gls{glssetwidest} provided with the \glostyle{alttree} style, the default widest name will be obtained from that, but note that only level~0 is supported for the \sty{glossary-longextra} styles. You can update the widest name with: \cmddef{glslongextraUpdateWidest} This is like \gls{glslongextraSetWidest} but will only set the new value if it's wider than the current widest name. Although these styles don't support hierarchy, the following is provided for child entries: \cmddef{glslongextraUpdateWidestChild} This does nothing by default. If \gls{glslongextraSubNameFmt} is redefined to show the child name, then the above command will need to be redefined to use \gls{glslongextraUpdateWidest}. For styles that show the \idx{locationlist}, that's formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationFmt} for top-level entries. Child \idxpl{locationlist} are formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraSubLocationFmt} Both of these simply do the \meta{location list} argument. The horizontal alignment for the \idx{locationlist} column is obtained with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationAlign} This expands to \code{>\marg{\cmd{raggedright}}p\marg{\gls{glspagelistwidth}}} by default. This means ragged-right paragraph style with width given by \gls{glspagelistwidth}. For styles that show the \gloskey{symbol} (in addition to the \gloskey{name}), that's formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymbolFmt} for top-level entries. This simply uses \gls{glossentrysymbol}. Child entries use: \cmddef{glslongextraSubSymbolFmt} which uses \gls{glslongextraSymbolFmt}. The horizontal alignment for the symbol column (except for the \glostyle{long-sym-desc} and \glostyle{long-desc-sym} styles) is obtained with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymbolAlign} This expands to \code{c} by default. Top-level \idx{group} headings are formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraGroupHeading} The first argument is the total number of columns in the table. For example, 2 for the \glostyle{long-name-desc} style or 3 for the \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc} style. The second argument is the \idx{group}['s] label (not the title). This command does nothing by default. (If you are using \app{bib2gls}, remember that you need to use the \switch{group} or \switch{g} switch to support \idxpl{group}.) Sub-level \idxpl{group} are only supported with the \idx{unsrtfam} (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}). When they are supported, the heading will be formatted with: \cmddef{glslongextraSubGroupHeading} The styles are sub-divided below into the set of elements that are shown in each column, which may consist of: \gloskey{name}, \gloskey{symbol}, \gloskey{description} or \idx{locationlist}. There will be blank cells if any of the corresponding fields have not been set or if the \idx{locationlist} has been suppressed. \subsubsection{Name and Description Only} \label{sec:longextranamedesc} These styles don't display the symbol or \idx{locationlist}, regardless of whether or not they have been set. In each case, the style starts with: \cmddef{glslongextraSetDescWidth} which updates \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name, identified with \gls{glslongextraSetWidest}. The column header text is also taken into account. If a widest name hasn't been set and the column header is shorter than one or more names, the description column may be too wide. The value of \gls{glsdescwidth} is calculated as $\gls{linewidth}-4\gls{tabcolsep}-W$, where $W$ is the width of the widest name. If you want to set \gls{glsdescwidth} to a specific value, then redefine \gls{glslongextraSetDescWidth} with the desired length assignment. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-desc} This has two columns: the name on the left and the description on the right. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-name} This has two columns: the name on the right and the description on the left. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraDescNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Name, Symbol and Description Only} \label{sec:longextranamesymdesc} These styles don't show the \idx{locationlist}. In each case, the style starts with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymSetDescWidth} which updates \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name, identified with \gls{glslongextraSetWidest}. This starts by calculating \gls{glsdescwidth} with \gls{glslongextraSetDescWidth} and then subtracts the width of the symbol column header text (which is assumed to be the widest text in that column). If you want to set \gls{glsdescwidth} to a specific value, then redefine \gls{glslongextraSymSetDescWidth} with the desired length assignment. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-desc-sym} This has three columns: the name on the left, the description in the middle and the symbol on the right. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-sym-desc} This has three columns: the name on the left, the symbol in the middle and the description on the right. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-sym-desc-name} This has three columns: the name on the right, the description in the middle and the symbol on the left. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-sym-name} This has three columns: the name on the right, the symbol in the middle and the description on the left. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Name, Description and Location Only} \label{sec:longextranamedescloc} These styles don't display the symbol, regardless of whether or not the \gloskey{symbol} field has been set. In each case, the style starts with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocSetDescWidth} which updates \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name, identified with \gls{glslongextraSetWidest}. This starts by calculating \gls{glsdescwidth} with \gls{glslongextraSetDescWidth} and then subtracts $2\gls{tabcolsep}-\gls{glspagelistwidth}$. If you want to set \gls{glsdescwidth} to a specific value, then redefine \gls{glslongextraLocSetDescWidth} with the desired length assignment. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-desc-loc} This has three columns: the name on the left, the description in the middle and the \idx{locationlist} on the right. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescLocationTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescLocationTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescLocationHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-loc-desc-name} This has three columns: the name on the right, the description in the middle and the \idx{locationlist} on the left. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Name, Description, Symbol and Location} \label{sec:longextranamedescsymloc} These styles show the name, description, symbol and \idx{locationlist}. In each case, the style starts with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymLocSetDescWidth} which updates \gls{glsdescwidth} according to the widest name, identified with \gls{glslongextraSetWidest}. This starts by calculating \gls{glsdescwidth} with \gls{glslongextraSymSetDescWidth} and then subtracts $2\gls{tabcolsep}-\gls{glspagelistwidth}$. If you want to set \gls{glsdescwidth} to a specific value, then redefine \gls{glslongextraSymLocSetDescWidth} with the desired length assignment. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-desc-sym-loc} This has four columns, from left to right: the name, description, symbol and the \idx{locationlist}. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymLocationTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymLocationTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameDescSymLocationHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-sym-desc-loc} This has four columns, from left to right: the name, symbol, description and the \idx{locationlist}. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescLocationTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescLocationTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraNameSymDescLocationHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-loc-sym-desc-name} This has four columns, from left to right: the \idx{locationlist}, symbol, description and the name. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationSymDescNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationSymDescNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationSymDescNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-loc-desc-sym-name} This has four columns, from left to right: the \idx{locationlist}, description, symbol and the name. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescSymNameTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescSymNameTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraLocationDescSymNameHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Symbol and Description Only} \label{sec:longextrasymdesc} These are two-column styles designed to show only the symbol and description. However, if the \gloskey{symbol} isn't set then the name will be used instead. If this occurs, you may need to change the width of the description column. The horizontal alignment for the symbol column is obtained with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymbolNameAlign} which expands to \code{l} by default. Note that this is different from the alignment used for styles like \glostyle{long-name-sym-desc}. These styles have the entry item number (if \opt{entrycounter} is on) and the hypertarget anchor (if enabled) in the symbol column since there's no name shown (unless the symbol is missing). These are all performed by for top-level entries by: \cmddef{glslongextraSymbolTargetFmt} The symbol is formatted according to \gls{glslongextraSymbolFmt}. Child entries use: \cmddef{glslongextraSubSymbolTargetFmt} Unlike \gls{glslongextraSubNameFmt} this shows the field value (formatted with \gls{glslongextraSymbolFmt}). The following commands use the above if the \gloskey{symbol} field is set, otherwise they show the name. \cmddef{glslongextraSymbolOrName} Shows the symbol, if set, or the name otherwise, with the target. Child entries use: \cmddef{glslongextraSubSymbolOrName} Shows the symbol with \gls{glslongextraSubSymbolTargetFmt}, if set, or the name otherwise, with the target. In each case, the style starts with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymNoNameSetDescWidth} which calculates \gls{glsdescwidth} as $\gls{linewidth}-4\gls{tabcolsep}-W$, where $W$ is the width of the symbol column header. Note that this assumes the content of the symbol column isn't wider than the column header. If you want to set \gls{glsdescwidth} to a specific value, then redefine \gls{glslongextraSymNoNameSetDescWidth} with the desired length assignment. For example, if you have a mixture of entries with symbols and some without, which means that there will be a name shown that's wider than the symbol column header, then set the widest name (for example, with the \resourceopt{set-widest} resource option) and add the following redefinition: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraSymNoNameSetDescWidth}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glslongextraSetDescWidth} } \end{codebox} Note that, in this case, if you don't set the widest name then the description column will end up even wider (and therefore cause the table to be even wider) if the name header is narrower than the symbol header. \optiondef{glostyle.long-sym-desc} The symbol is in the left column (or the name, if the symbol isn't set). The description is in the right. The \idx{locationlist} isn't shown. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraSymDescHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-sym} The symbol is in the right column (or the name, if the symbol isn't set). The description is in the left. The \idx{locationlist} isn't shown. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraDescSymHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Abbreviations Only} \label{sec:longextraabbr} These styles are designed for abbreviations. They display the short and long forms, rather than the name and description, although these may happen to match. They are primarily intended for \idxpl{mini-glossary} or similar summary lists. Although these styles don't show the name or description, they still use some of the name and description settings provided by \sty{glossary-longextra}. The column for the short form uses the same alignment as for the name columns (\gls{glslongextraNameAlign}). The column for the long form uses the same alignment as for the description columns (\gls{glslongextraDescAlign}) and has the width set to \gls{glsdescwidth}. However, the name and description formatting commands or attributes (such as \gls{glsnamefont}, \catattr{glossnamefont} or \catattr{glossname}) aren't used as the formatting is left to the abbreviation style. If the \gloskey{short} field hasn't been set, the short column will show the name instead, and if the \gloskey{long} field hasn't been set, the long column will show the description instead (using the same commands as for styles like \glostyle{long-name-desc}, which do use the associated formatting commands and attributes). These styles use the following commands: \cmddef{glslongextraShortHeader} The header for the column showing the short form. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraShortHeader}}\marg{\gls{entryname}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraLongHeader} The header for the column showing the long form. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraLongHeader}}\marg{\gls{descriptionname}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraShortTargetFmt} This governs the way that the short form should be displayed, including the target. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraShortTargetFmt}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsentryitem}\marg{\#1}\gls{glstarget}\marg{\#1}\marg{\marg{\gls{glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}}}\comment{} \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook}\marg{\#1}% } \end{compactcodebox} Note that the \idx{postnamehook} is included. \cmddef{glslongextraLongFmt} This governs the way that the long form should be displayed. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraLongFmt}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \marg{\gls{glsxtrlong}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsopt{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#1}}\gls{glspostdescription} } \end{compactcodebox} Note that the \idx{postdeschook} is included. \cmddef{glslongextraSubShortTargetFmt} This governs the way that the short form for child entries should be displayed, including the target. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraSubShortTargetFmt}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glssubentryitem}\marg{\#2}\gls{glstarget}\marg{\#2}\marg{\marg{\gls{glsxtrshort}\oarg{\glsopt{noindex},\glsoptval{hyper}{false}}\marg{\#2}}}\comment{} \gls{glsxtrpostnamehook}\marg{\#2}% } \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraSubLongFmt} This governs the way that the long form for child entries should be displayed. This is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraSubLongFmt}}[2]\marg{\gls{glslongextraLongFmt}\marg{\#2}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraShortNoNameSetDescWidth} This is used to compute the value of \gls{glsdescwidth} and assumes that none of the short forms are wider than \gls{glslongextraShortHeader}. \optiondef{glostyle.abbr-short-long} A two column style. The short form is in the left column. The long form is in the right. The \idx{locationlist} isn't shown. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraShortLongTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraShortLongTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraShortLongHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \optiondef{glostyle.abbr-long-short} A two column style. The short form is in the right column. The long form is in the left. The \idx{locationlist} isn't shown. The table header is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLongShortTabularHeader} which shows the column headers with horizontal rules. The table footer is given by: \cmddef{glslongextraLongShortTabularFooter} which just does a horizontal rule. With \env{longtable}, the table header and footer are set with: \cmddef{glslongextraLongShortHeader} which uses the above header and footer commands. \subsubsection{Custom Fields} \label{sec:longextracustom} These styles allow one, two or three custom columns in addition to the name column. The \qt{custom1} styles indicate one custom column, the \qt{custom2} styles indicate two custom columns, and the \qt{custom3} styles indicate three custom columns. Some styles also include the description column. These styles don't display the location. However, if you are using \app{bib2gls} you can set one of the custom fields to \gloskey{location}, but if you have long \idxpl{locationlist} you may need to change the corresponding alignment command to switch to a paragraph column. \begin{information} The \qt{first custom column} means the first of the custom columns, which may not be the first column in the table. Similarly the \qt{second custom column} means the second of the custom columns (if supported by the style), and the \qt{third custom column} means the third of the custom columns (if supported by the style). \end{information} \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIField} Expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} for the first custom column. This will be used in the \qt{custom1}, \qt{custom2} and \qt{custom3} styles. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIField} Expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} for the second custom column. This will be used in the \qt{custom2} and \qt{custom3} styles. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIIField} Expands to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} for the third custom column. This will be used in the \qt{custom3} style. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIHeader} Expands to the header text for the first custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glslongextraCustomIField}} \end{compactcodebox} which means that it will be \qt{Useri} by default, which is unlikely to be appropriate, but it may be suitable if you change the first custom field. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIHeader} Expands to the header text for the second custom column. The default likewise simply applies \idx{sentencecase} to the \idx{internalfieldlabel}. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIIHeader} Expands to the header text for the third custom column. The default likewise simply applies \idx{sentencecase} to the \idx{internalfieldlabel}. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIFmt} This is used to format each top-level entry in the first custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glslongextraCustomIField}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraSubCustomIFmt} This is used to format each sub-entry in the first custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslongextraCustomIFmt}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIFmt} This is used to format each top-level entry in the second custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glslongextraCustomIIField}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraSubCustomIIFmt} This is used to format each sub-entry in the second custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslongextraCustomIIFmt}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIIFmt} This is used to format each top-level entry in the third custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glslongextraCustomIIIField}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraSubCustomIIIFmt} This is used to format each sub-entry in the third custom column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glslongextraCustomIIIFmt}\margm{entry-label} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIAlign} Expands to the alignment specifier for the first custom column. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIAlign} Expands to the alignment specifier for the second custom column. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIIAlign} Expands to the alignment specifier for the third custom column. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomTabularFooter} The footer used for all the custom styles. The default definition simply does \gls{bottomrule}. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomITabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1} style (which has two columns). This command and the previous command are used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1} style. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-custom1-name} style (which has two columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-custom1-name} style. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIITabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2} style (which has three columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2} style. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-custom2-name} style (which has three columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-custom2-name} style. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIITabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3} style (which has four columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIIHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3} style. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-custom3-name} style (which has four columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-custom3-name} style. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom1} A two column style with the name in the first column and the first custom field in the second. For top-level entries, the name is formatted with \gls{glslongextraNameFmt} and the custom field is formatted with \gls{glslongextraCustomIFmt}. Sub-entries use \gls{glslongextraSubNameFmt} and \gls{glslongextraSubCustomIFmt}. \optiondef{glostyle.long-custom1-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom1} but with the name in the last column. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom2} A three column style with the name in the first column, the first custom field in the second and the second custom field in the third. As \glostyle{long-name-custom1}, but additionally the second custom field is formatted with \gls{glslongextraCustomIIFmt} for top-level entries and with \gls{glslongextraSubCustomIIFmt} for child-entries. \optiondef{glostyle.long-custom2-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom2} but with the name in the last column. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom3} A four column style with the name in the first column, the first custom field in the second, the second custom field in the third, and the third custom field in the fourth. As \glostyle{long-name-custom2}, but additionally the third custom field is formatted with \gls{glslongextraCustomIIIFmt} for top-level entries and with \gls{glslongextraSubCustomIIIFmt} for child-entries. \optiondef{glostyle.long-custom3-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom3} but with the name in the last column. The following styles also have a description column, which uses \gls{glslongextraDescAlign} for the column alignment. These styles attempt to calculate an appropriate width for \gls{glsdescwidth}. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomISetDescWidth} Sets \gls{glsdescwidth} for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style. This first uses \gls{glslongextraSetDescWidth} to calculate the width $W$ if there were only a name and description column. It then measures the width of the first custom column header $w$ and sets \gls{glsdescwidth} to $w - 2\gls{tabcolsep} - w$. This assumes that the first custom column header is wider than the value of each entry's first custom field. If this isn't the case, then you will need to redefined this command as appropriate. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIISetDescWidth} Sets \gls{glsdescwidth} for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style. This first uses \gls{glslongextraCustomISetDescWidth} to calculate the width $W$ if there were only a name column, first custom column, and description column. It then measures the width of the second custom column header $w$ and sets \gls{glsdescwidth} to $w - 2\gls{tabcolsep} - w$. This assumes that the second custom column header is wider than the value of each entry's second custom field. If this isn't the case, then you will need to redefined this command as appropriate. \cmddef{glslongextraCustomIIISetDescWidth} Sets \gls{glsdescwidth} for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style. This first uses \gls{glslongextraCustomIISetDescWidth} to calculate the width $W$ if there were only a name column, first custom column, second custom column, and description column. It then measures the width of the third custom column header $w$ and sets \gls{glsdescwidth} to $w - 2\gls{tabcolsep} - w$. This assumes that the third custom column header is wider than the value of each entry's third custom field. If this isn't the case, then you will need to redefined this command as appropriate. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIDescTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style (which has three columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIDescHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} style. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom1-name} style (which has three columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom1-name} style. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIDescTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style (which has four columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIDescHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} style. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomIINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom2-name} style (which has four columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomIINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom2-name} style. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIIDescTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style (which has five columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraNameCustomIIIDescHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} style. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomIIINameTabularHeader} The table header for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom3-name} style (which has five columns). Used in the following. \cmddef{glslongextraDescCustomIIINameHeader} The \env{longtable} header and footer markup for the \glostyle{long-desc-custom3-name} style. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom1-desc} A three column style with the name in the first column, the first custom field in the second, and the description in the third. This is like \glostyle{long-name-custom1} but additionally has the description column formatted as per \glostyle{long-name-desc}. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-custom1-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom1-desc} but the name and description columns are swapped. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom2-desc} A four column style with the name in the first column, the first custom field in the second, the second custom field in the third, and the description in the fourth. This is like \glostyle{long-name-custom2} but additionally has the description column formatted as per \glostyle{long-name-desc}. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-custom2-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom2-desc} but the name and description columns are swapped. \optiondef{glostyle.long-name-custom3-desc} A five column style with the name in the first column, the first custom field in the second, the second custom field in the third, the third custom field in the fourth, and the description in the fifth. This is like \glostyle{long-name-custom3} but additionally has the description column formatted as per \glostyle{long-name-desc}. \optiondef{glostyle.long-desc-custom3-name} As \glostyle{long-name-custom3-desc} but the name and description columns are swapped. \glsendrange{pkg.glossary-longextra}% \subsection{\stytext{glossary-topic} package} \label{sec:topic} \glsstartrange{pkg.glossary-topic}% The \inlineglsdef{pkg.glossary-topic} package provides glossary styles designed for hierarchical \idxpl{glossary} where the top-level entries are topic titles. This package automatically loads the \sty{multicol} package. If the \sty{glossary-tree} package is also loaded then commands like \gls{glssetwidest} can be used on these styles in much the same way as for the \glostyle{alttree} style. If a widest value isn't set then these styles behave more like the \glostyle{tree} style. This package provides styles designed for \idxpl{glossary} that are lists of topics. That is, the top-level entries are considered topic titles (which may or may not have an associated symbol or description) and the sub-entries are items within that topic. By default the \idx{locationlist} isn't shown for the top-level entries but is shown after the description for sub-entries (unless suppressed with \opt{nonumberlist} or \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false}). The following styles are provided: \optiondef*{glostyle.topic} This style is similar to the \glostyle{tree} style but the indentation doesn't start until the second sub-item level. The top-level entries have the name displayed in a larger font with the description following in a new paragraph (see \exampleref{ex:topicstyle}). This style doesn't support the \opt{nogroupskip} setting. \newcommand{\topicexampledefs}{% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pictograph}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{picture or symbol representing a word or phrase}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{copy}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faCopy}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{copy}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cut}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faCut}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{cut}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}{edit}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faEdit}}, \gloskeyval{description}{edit}} \gls{newglossaryentry}{paste}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{pictograph},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{faPaste}}, \gloskeyval{description}{paste}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{symbols}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{Symbols},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{mathematical constants or functions}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{constant}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{symbols},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{constant},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{a fixed quantity or numerical value}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{pi}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{constant},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{pi}}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{ratio of the length of the circumference of a circle to its diameter}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{root2}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{constant},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{surd}2}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{Pythagoras' constant}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{function}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{symbols},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{function},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{a rule that assigns a value to every element of the domain}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{cosx}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{function},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{cos}(x)}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{cosine}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{lnx}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{function},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{ln}(x)}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{natural logarithm}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{parameter}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{symbols},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{parameter},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{a constant or variable that distinguishes a specific form}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{x}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{parameter},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{x}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{the abscissa value}}^^J% \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{y}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{parameter},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{y}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{the ordinate value}} \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{z}\marg{\gloskeyval{parent}{parameter},^^J \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{z}},^^J \gloskeyval{description}{the applicate value}} } \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:topicstyle}, title={The \optfmt{topic} style}, description={Example document demonstrating the topic style}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontawesome}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{postdot},\optval{stylemods}{topic},\optval{style}{\glostyle{topic}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \topicexampledefs } {\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} \end{resultbox} \optiondef*{glostyle.topicmcols} This style is like the \glostyle{topic} style but the sub-entries are placed inside a \env{multicols} environment (unlike styles such as \glostyle{mcoltree} where the entire glossary content is within a single \env{multicols} environment). The environment name is supplied in the value of the command: \cmddef{glstopicColsEnv} This defaults to \code{multicols}. You can change this to the starred form. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstopicColsEnv}}\marg{multicols*} \end{codebox} The number of columns is given by the command: \cmddef{glstopicCols} This expands to 2, by default. This style is demonstrated in \exampleref*{ex:topicmcolsstyle}. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:topicmcolsstyle}, title={The \optfmt{topicmcols} style}, description={Example document demonstrating the topicmcols style}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontawesome}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{postdot},\optval{stylemods}{topic},\optval{style}{\glostyle{topicmcols}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \topicexampledefs } {\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} \end{resultbox} Both styles can have a widest name set like the \glostyle{alttree} style, using the commands provided by \sty{glossary-tree} and \sty{glossaries-extra-stylemods} or with the \resourceopt{set-widest} resource option. If a widest name is set, then the sub-entry names will be placed in a box of the given width otherwise they won't be placed in a box. In \exampleref{ex:topicmcolsstylewidest}, the widest names have been set for level~1 and level~2 using: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetwidest}\oarg{1}\marg{parameter} \gls{glssetwidest}\oarg{2}\marg{\gls{glsentryname}\marg{cosine}} \end{codebox} Note that this doesn't change the indentation at the start of the level~2 items to match the width of the level~1 widest name. \begin{resultbox}[float] \createexample*[label={ex:topicmcolsstylewidest}, title={The \optfmt{topicmcols} style with the widest name set}, description={Example document demonstrating the topicmcols style}] {% \cmd{usepackage}\marg{fontawesome}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{postdot},\optval{stylemods}{topic},\optval{style}{\glostyle{topicmcols}}}\marg{glossaries-extra}^^J% \topicexampledefs^^J% \gls{glssetwidest}\oarg{1}\marg{parameter}^^J% \gls{glssetwidest}\oarg{2}\marg{\gls{glsentryname}\marg{cosine}} } {\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} \end{resultbox} Both of the above styles use the following commands. \cmddef{glstopicParIndent} This command is a length that's used for the paragraph indentation in any multi-paragraph description for top-level entries, but not for the first paragraph (at the start of the description) which isn't indented. \cmddef{glstopicSubIndent} This command is a length that's used to calculate the hanging indentation for sub-entries. The level~1 sub-entries don't indent the name. Level~$n$ sub-entries have the name indented by $(n-1)\times\gls{glstopicSubIndent}$. The hanging indent depends on whether or not a widest name has been set for the level. There is also a length for additional indentation used in the second paragraph onwards for child entries with multi-paragraph descriptions: \cmddef{glstopicSubItemParIndent} This is initialised to \gls{parindent} when \sty{glossary-topic} is loaded. \cmddef{glstopicInit} This hook is used at the start of the glossary. It does nothing by default. Although the styles don't support letter \idxpl{group} by default, if you have many topics (top-level entries) and you feel that it would help the reader to divide them up into headed letter groups, you can redefine: \cmddef{glstopicGroupHeading} This does nothing by default. If you want to redefine it, you can fetch the title corresponding to the group label with \gls{glsxtrgetgrouptitle}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glstopicGroupHeading}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrgetgrouptitle}\marg{\#1}\marg{\cmd{thisgrptitle}}\comment{} \cmd{section}*\marg{\cmd{thisgrptitle}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} Remember that if you are using \app{bib2gls}, you will need the \switch{group} or \switch{g} switch to support \idxpl{group} (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrtgroups}). Sub-\idxpl{group} are only available with \app{bib2gls} and the \resourceopt{group-level} option. If they are supported, sub-group headings are formatted according to: \cmddef{glstopicSubGroupHeading} This formats the sub-group heading. Note that unlike \gls{glstopicGroupHeading} this command does actually format the sub-group heading by default. This means that it you use \resourceoptval{group-level}{all}, the top-level groups won't be displayed, but the sub-groups will be. Top-level entries are formatted according to: \cmddef{glstopicItem} This formats the name and (if provided) the symbol. The description (if set) will follow in a new paragraph. At the start of \gls{glstopicItem}, a vertical space is added with: \cmddef{glstopicPreSkip} which defaults to \csfmt{medskip}. There is then a hook: \cmddef{glstopicMarker} which does nothing by default, but may be redefined. For example, to add a line to the table of contents. The name and symbol are set in the form of a title using: \cmddef{glstopicTitle} This uses \gls{Glossentryname} which uses \idx{sentencecase}. If there's a symbol, this is added in parentheses. Both name and symbol (if present) are encapsulated by: \cmddef{glstopicTitleFont} This uses a bold, large font by default. If the entry has the description key set (tested with \gls{ifglshasdesc}) then a paragraph break is inserted followed by: \cmddef{glstopicMidSkip} which defaults to \csfmt{smallskip}. This is followed by the description which is formatted according to: \cmddef{glstopicDesc} This just does \code{\gls{Glossentrydesc}\marg{entry-label}} followed by the \idx{postdeschook}. There is then a paragraph break followed by: \cmddef{glstopicPostSkip} regardless of whether or not the description was displayed. This defaults to \csfmt{smallskip}. This is then followed by: \cmddef{glstopicLoc} which may be used to display the \idx{locationlist}, but does nothing by default. The sub-entries first set up the paragraph and hanging indentations using: \cmddef{glstopicAssignSubIndent} This uses: \cmddef{glstopicAssignWidest} to determine if a widest name has been set for the given level. The sub-entry has its information displayed using: \cmddef{glstopicSubItem} This encapsulates the name with: \cmddef{glstopicSubNameFont} By default this just uses \csfmt{textbf}. This is followed by: \cmddef{glstopicSubItemSep} which defaults to \csfmt{quad}. The name and separator are passed in the \meta{text} argument of: \cmddef{glstopicSubItemBox} If a widest name was set for the given level, this will put \meta{text} inside a box of that width otherwise it just does \meta{text}. This is followed by the symbol in parentheses if set. Then, if the description is set, the description and \idx{postdeschook} are displayed followed by: \cmddef{glstopicSubPreLocSep} (This command isn't used if the description isn't set.) Finally the location list is displayed using: \cmddef{glstopicSubLoc} which just does \meta{location} by default. \glsendrange{pkg.glossary-topic}% \subsection{\stytext{glossary-table} package} \label{sec:table} \glsstartrange{pkg.glossary-table}% The \inlineglsdef{pkg.glossary-table} package is new to version 1.49. It automatically loads the \sty{longtable}, \sty{array} and \sty{booktabs} packages. If you want to use \gls{glspenaltygroupskip} for the group skip, you will need to also load \sty{glossary-longbooktabs}. \begin{important} This package is designed specifically for use with \app{bib2gls}. It can be used to create a supplemental \idx{glossary} with other \idx{indexing} options, but the entries will be listed in order of definition and no child entries will be shown. \end{important} The \sty{glossary-table} package doesn't provide any general purpose styles, but instead provides one highly customized style (\inlineglsdef{opt.glostyle.table}), which is designed to work with a supplied command: \cmddef{printunsrttable} The \glostyle{table} style should not be set with the \opt{style} package option, \gls{setglossarystyle} or the \printglossopt{style} option, as it's only intended for use within \gls{printunsrttable}, which sets up the appropriate hooks to allow the style to work with \gls{printunsrtglossary} (which is used implicitly). Tabular styles such as \gloskey{long} create a \env{longtable} with one entry per row and no caption. The \glostyle{longheader} style is similar but adds a header row, and the \glostyle{long-booktabs} style includes rules above and below the header row and at the end of the table. In all these \env{longtable} styles, the glossary title is outside of the style, and is typically put in a sectioning command. Similarly, the glossary preamble \gls{glossarypreamble} and postamble \gls{glossarypostamble} are outside of \env{longtable}. The \glostyle{table} style, on the other hand, allows multiple entries per row. The glossary title (\printglossopt{title}) is the table caption with what's normally the table of contents title (\printglossopt{toctitle}) as the caption title for the list of tables. Similarly, the preamble and postamble are included in the table header and footer, instead of being outside of the table. This means that \gls{glossarysection}, \gls{glossarypreamble} and \gls{glossarypostamble} are redefined by \gls{printunsrttable} to do nothing so that they aren't shown outside of the \env{longtable} by \gls{printunsrtglossary}, otherwise there would be a duplication of the information in the header and footer of the table. The \gls{printunsrtglossary} hooks are used to insert the inter-block \idx{tab} character and new row command in the construction performed outside of \env{longtable}, which would otherwise cause issues if used directly in the \glostyle{table} style. The block styles (see \sectionref{sec:blockstyles}) alter the way the \glostyle{table} style sets up the \env{longtable} environment and the way that the entries are formatted. The top level \idx{glossarystyle} command \gls{glossentry} is defined to do the block according to the designated block style, which includes the child entries, if the \glosfield{childcount} field has been set and is non-zero. \begin{information} The \gls{subglossentry} command is redefined to do nothing, but it won't be used as the child entries are all filtered out. If you don't use the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option, no child entries will be shown. There's no recursive descent down the \idxpl{hierarchicallevel}. \end{information} This means that the child entries will be listed in one of the columns in the block, according to the style. This can make the column quite wide. The child names aren't displayed by default but the block styles support the \opt{subentrycounter} option. The child entries are listed in a \env{tabular} environment, which means they are contained in the same row as their parent and can't be broken across a page. A \qt{block} indicates a block of columns used to format one entry (and, optionally, its children). One row of the table may contain multiple blocks. For example, a block may consist of two columns with the name in the first column and the description in the second, or may consist of three columns with the name in the first column, the symbol in the second, and the description in the third. So if a block style has 3 columns, and the desired number of blocks is set to 2, then the table will have a total of $3\times2=6$ columns. The style supports up to 1 \idx{hierarchicallevel}, but you will need the \resourceopt{save-child-count} resource option if you want the level~1 sub-entries to show. Deeper level entries are omitted. Sub-entries are automatically filtered by a custom hook that \gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook} is assigned to within \gls{printunsrttable}. This custom hook allows additional filtering to be employed with the command: \cmddef{glstableiffilter} This command should do \meta{true} if the entry identified by \meta{entry-label} should be skipped, otherwise it should do \meta{false}. The default definition simply does \meta{false}. For example, the following will filter entries that have the category set to \cat{general}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstableiffilter}}[1]{\comment{} \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\#1}\marg{general}} \end{codebox} Note that if this command is redefined to do neither \meta{true} nor \meta{false} or does both, it will interfere with the width calculations if \glstableopt{par} isn't set to the default \glstableoptval{par}{false}. You can use the \glstableopt{init} option to locally redefine commands within \gls{printunsrttable}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrttable}\oarg{\glstableoptvalm{init}{\comment{} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glstableiffilter}}[1]{\comment{} \gls{glsifcategory}\marg{\#\#1}\marg{general}}\comment{} }} \end{codebox} An extra field (the \qt{other} field) may be added with the \glstableopt{other} key. If this value is empty, then no extra field will be added. Some block styles, such as \glstableblockstyle{other-name} and \glstableblockstyle{symbol-other} put the other field in its own column. If the other field isn't set, this will lead to an empty column. If there isn't a designated column for the other field, then block styles that show the description will put the other field in before the description, but in the same column as the description. Otherwise, block styles that don't show the description, will put the other field after the name, but in the same column as the name. The following example uses the \glstableblockstyle{name} block style, which only has one column per block. The name is followed by the description in parentheses (if set), which is then followed by the child list. I redefined \gls{glstableNameFmt} to make the name appear in bold, to highlight it. I've used the \glstableoptval{par}{ragged} option, otherwise the table will be too wide to fit the page. \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage} [\opt{record},\optval{stylemods}{table},\opt{subentrycounter}] \marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{ \comment{entries in \file{example-glossaries-childnoname.bib}:} \resourceoptval{src}{example-glossaries-childnoname}, \resourceoptval{selection}{all}, \resourceoptval{save-child-count}} \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrttable} \oarg{ \glstableoptval{block-style}{name},\glstableoptval{par}{ragged}, \printglossoptvalm{preamble}{Some preamble text}, \printglossoptvalm{postamble}{Some postamble text}, \glstableoptvalm{init}{\comment{} \cmd{let}\gls{glstableNameFmt}\cmd{textbf} \cmd{def}\gls{glstablenameheader}\marg{Summary}\comment{} } } \cend{document} \end{codebox} This creates a table with two entries per row. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[label={ex:table}, title={Two entries per row with \cmd{printunsrttable}}, description={Example document with a tabular glossary with two entries per row. The child list is in the same cell as the parent.}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {% \cmd{usepackage}[record,stylemods=table,subentrycounter]\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{^^J \comment{entries in example-glossaries-childnoname.bib:} \resourceoptval{src}{example-glossaries-childnoname},^^J \resourceoptval{selection}{all},^^J \resourceoptval{save-child-count}}^^J% } {% \gls{printunsrttable}^^J% \oarg{^^J block-style=name,par=ragged,^^J preamble=\marg{Some preamble text},^^J postamble=\marg{Some postamble text},^^J init=\marg{\comment{} \cmd{let}\gls{glstableNameFmt}\cmd{textbf} \cmd{def}\gls{glstablenameheader}\marg{Summary}\comment{} }^^J% } } \end{resultbox} Note that each row is as deep as the entry with the most children. So where a row has one column with two children and another with seven, the row is deep enough to accommodate the seven child entries, which leaves a gap below the smaller list of two children. \subsubsection{Child Entries} \label{sec:tablechildren} Entries with a \idx{hierarchicallevel} greater than 0 are filtered out (see above). This takes the \printglossopt{leveloffset} option into account. Child entries can be included, but only by checking if the \glosfield{childcount} field has been set and is non-zero. This is done by: \cmddef{glstableChildEntries} Note that \gls{glstableiffilter} filters top-level entries, and their child entries will also be filtered. Child entries for non-filtered top-level entries can be filtered by redefining: \cmddef{glstableiffilterchild} where \meta{entry-label} is the child entry label. This command should do \meta{true} if the child entry should be filtered and \meta{false} otherwise. If the child count is non-zero, taking both \glosfield{childcount} and child filtering into account, then \gls{glstableChildEntries} command will display the non-filtered children in the form: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstablePreChildren} \cbeg{glstablesubentries} \gls{glstableblocksubentry}\margm{child-1-label} \gls{glstableblocksubentrysep} \gls{glstableblocksubentry}\margm{child-2-label} \ldots \gls{glstableblocksubentrysep} \gls{glstableblocksubentry}\margm{child-n-label} \cend{glstablesubentries} \end{compactcodebox} This consists of the following. \cmddef{glstablePreChildren} Occurs at the start. If \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}, this will do \cmd{par} otherwise it does nothing. \begin{warning} In general, it's best not to list children with \glstableoptval{par}{false}, except with a style like \glstableblockstyle{name} or \glstableblockstyle{name-desc} with no description, as the table can end up too wide for the page. \end{warning} \envdef{glstablesubentries} This environment encapsulates the child list. By default, this does: \begin{compactcodebox} \cbeg{tabular}[t]\margm{align} \meta{content} \cend{tabular} \end{compactcodebox} The \meta{align} argument is obtained by expanding: \cmddef{glstablesubentryalign} which takes the \glstableopt{par} setting into account. Each child item is display using \gls{glstableblocksubentry} which is redefined by the block style. The separator between each child item is given by: \cmddef{glstableblocksubentrysep} This just expands to \gls{glstablenewline}. \subsubsection{Options} \label{sec:tableoptions} The optional argument of \gls{printunsrttable} may have the options that can typically be passed to \gls{printunsrtglossary}, except that the \printglossopt{nonumberlist} and \printglossopt{style} options won't have an effect. If you want the \idx{locationlist}, it can simply be obtained from the \gloskey{location} field in the appropriate style hook. Some default settings are changed: \printglossoptval{groups}{false} and \printglossopt{nogroupskip}{true}. If you want letter \idx{group} headings, you will need to both add \printglossoptval{groups}{true} to the options list and invoke \app{bib2gls} with the \switch{group} switch. The group headings will span the entire width of the table. This may result in empty blocks at the end of the previous row. If you want a vertical gap before the group heading (but not before the first group), you will need to add \printglossopt{nogroupskip}{false}, but you will also need to load \sty{glossary-longbooktabs}. Note that this option is designed to be used with group headings and will have no effect with \printglossoptval{groups}{false}. Additionally, the following options may also be used. \optiondef{printunsrttab.blocks} The value is the number of blocks in the table. The total number of columns in the table will be this value multiplied by the number of columns per block, which is determined by the block style. For example, the \glstableblockstyle{name-desc} block style has two columns, so if there are three blocks then there will be a total of six columns. \optiondef{printunsrttab.caption} A boolean option that determines whether or not to include a caption. The caption on the first page of the table is produced with: \cmddef*{glstablecaption} where \meta{label code} is the code to create the label, if one has been supplied (either by an option such as \optval{numberedsection}{autolabel} or by the \printglossopt{label} option). The \meta{title} argument will be \gls{glossarytitle}, which can be changed with the \printglossopt{title} option. The \meta{lot title} argument is the title for the list of tables and is actually what would normally be the title for the table of contents, which can be set with the \printglossopt{toctitle} option. The default definition simply does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{caption}\oargm{lot title}\marg{\meta{label code}\meta{title}} \end{compactcodebox} An empty \meta{lot title} (\printglossoptvalm{toctitle}{}) will prevent the caption from being added to the list of tables. \begin{important} The \opt{numberedsection} option will only influence the label, not the table numbering. If you don't want the table numbered, redefine \gls{glstablecaption} to use \starredcs{caption}. \end{important} If the table spans across multiple pages, the caption for subsequent pages will be produced with: \cmddef*{glstablenextcaption} This ignores the \meta{lot title} argument by default and does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{caption}\oarg{}\marg{\meta{title}\gls{glstablepostnextcaption}} \end{compactcodebox} This has an empty optional argument to prevent the caption from being repeatedly added to the list of tables. The title is followed by: \cmddef*{glstablepostnextcaption} You can either redefine this command to adjust the content after the title or redefine \gls{glstablenextcaption}, as appropriate. \optiondef{printunsrttab.header} A boolean option to determine whether or not to show the header row. Note that a header with three column block styles, such as \glstableblockstyle{name-symbol-desc}, can result in overfull lines. You may need to shorten the header text to fit. The header text is produced with one of the following commands: \cmddef*{glstablenameheader} Expands to the header for the name column. Just uses \gls{entryname} by default. \cmddef*{glstabledescheader} Expands to the header for the description column for block styles like \glstableblockstyle{name-desc} and \glstableblockstyle{name-symbol-desc}. Just uses \gls{descriptionname} by default. \cmddef*{glstablesymbolheader} Expands to the header for the symbol column for block styles like \glstableblockstyle{name-symbol} and \glstableblockstyle{name-symbol-desc}. Just uses \gls{symbolname} by default. \cmddef*{glstableotherheader} Expands to the header for the other column. The default definition applies \gls{MFUsentencecase} to the other field label. \optiondef{printunsrttab.rules} A boolean option to determine whether or not to show the horizontal rules (provided by \sty{booktabs}). If used with \glstableoptval{header}{true}, there will be a rule above and below the header row. If used with \glstableoptval{header}{false}, there will only be one rule at the top of the table. In both cases, there will be a rule at the bottom of the table. \optiondef{printunsrttab.blocksep} The value is inserted into the alignment specifier list between blocks. For example, the default value of the pipe character will insert a vertical line. Set this value to empty to remove it. \optiondef{printunsrttab.par} Indicates whether or not the columns should be paragraphs. The value may be one of: \optfmt{false}, \optfmt{justified} or \optfmt{ragged}. The default \glstableoptval{par}{false} will just use one of the column specifiers \code{l}, \code{r} or \code{c}. The other values will use the \code{p} specifier, in which case the column widths will be calculated. \optiondef{printunsrttab.other} This should be set to the \idx{internalfieldlabel} of the other field or to empty if no other field should be included. \optiondef{printunsrttab.init} The \meta{code} will be added shortly before \gls{printunsrtglossary} is called and any local changes will be scoped. \optiondef{printunsrttab.block-style} The block style. Available styles are listed in \sectionref{sec:blockstyles}. \subsubsection{Block Styles} \label{sec:blockstyles} The block style may be set with the \glstableopt{block-style} option or with: \cmddef{glstablesetstyle} \begin{warning} The block styles are still under development, so the underlying commands are not yet documented and liable to change. \end{warning} The following block styles are predefined. \glstableblockstyledef{name} Blocks have one column with the name, which is followed by the symbol and the description, if they have been set, in parentheses. The child list follows at the end of the column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{name-desc} This is the default style. Blocks have two columns with the name in the first column of the block and the description in the second. If the other field is set, it will follow the description. The child entries will be at the end of the second column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{desc-name} As \glstableblockstyle{name-desc} but with the columns swapped. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the first column. \glstableblockstyledef{name-symbol} Blocks have two columns with the name in the first column of the block and the symbol in the second. If the other field is set, it will be placed after the name in the first column. The child entries are at the end of the first column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{symbol-name} As \glstableblockstyle{name-symbol} but with the columns swapped. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the second column. \glstableblockstyledef{name-other} This is like \glstableblockstyle{name-desc} but puts the other field in the second column. The description and symbol aren't shown. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the second column. \glstableblockstyledef{other-name} This is like \glstableblockstyle{desc-name} but puts the other field in the second column. The description and symbol aren't shown. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the first column. \glstableblockstyledef{symbol-other} This is like \glstableblockstyle{name-other} but shows the symbol instead of the name. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the second column. \glstableblockstyledef{other-symbol} This is like \glstableblockstyle{other-name} but shows the symbol instead of the name. The child entries (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero) will be at the end of the first column. \glstableblockstyledef{name-symbol-desc} Blocks have three columns with the name in the first column of the block, the symbol in the second, and the description in the third, preceded by the other field, if set. The child entries are at the end of the third column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{name-desc-symbol} Blocks have three columns with the name in the first column of the block, the description in the second, preceded by the other field, if set, and the symbol in the third. The child entries are at the end of the second column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{name-other-desc} Blocks have three columns with the name in the first column of the block, the other in the second, and the description in the third. The child entries are at the end of the third column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{desc-other-name} Blocks have three columns with the description in the first column of the block, the other in the second, and the name in the third. The child entries are at the end of the first column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{name-symbol-other-desc} Blocks have four columns with the name in the first column of the block, the symbol in the second, the other in the third, and the description in the fourth. The child entries are at the end of the fourth column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{name-other-symbol-desc} Blocks have four columns with the name in the first column of the block, the other in the second, the symbol in the third, and the description in the fourth. The child entries are at the end of the fourth column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{desc-symbol-other-name} Blocks have four columns with the description in the first column of the block, the symbol in the second, the other in the third, and the name in the fourth. The child entries are at the end of the first column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \glstableblockstyledef{desc-other-symbol-name} Blocks have four columns with the description in the first column of the block, the other in the second, the symbol in the third, and the name in the fourth. The child entries are at the end of the first column (if \glosfield{childcount} is set and non-zero). \subsubsection{Associated Commands} \label{sec:tablecommands} The rows are separated with: \cmddef{glstablenewline} This simply does \gls{tabularnewline} (not \gls{bksl} which has a different action in paragraph columns). The following commands are used in the column specifier where a left, right or centred column is required, taking the \glstableopt{par} option into account. Note that with \glstableoptval{par}{justified}, the result will always be \code{p\margm{width}}, whereas with \glstableoptval{par}{ragged} the paragraph will be ragged right or ragged left or have centring applied. \cmddef{glstableleftalign} Expands to \code{l} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{raggedright}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting. This command is used in the column specifier where a left-justified column is required. \cmddef{glstablerightalign} Expands to \code{r} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{raggedleft}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting. This command is used in the column specifier where a right-justified column is required. \cmddef{glstablecenteralign} Expands to \code{c} or \code{p\margm{width}} or \code{>{\cmd{protect}\cmd{centering}p\margm{width}}}, depending on the \glstableopt{par} setting. This command is used in the column specifier where a centred column is required. \cmddef{glstablenamecolalign} Expands to the alignment for the name column. The default definition uses left alignment: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstableleftalign}\marg{\gls{glstablenamewidth}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glstabledesccolalign} Expands to the alignment for the description column. The default definition uses left alignment: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstableleftalign}\marg{\gls{glstabledescwidth}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glstablesymbolcolalign} Expands to the alignment for the symbol column, in block styles where the symbol has its own column. The default definition uses centred alignment: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstablecenteralign}\marg{\gls{glstablesymbolwidth}} \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{glstableothercolalign} Expands to the alignment for the other column, in block styles where the other field has its own column. The default definition uses left alignment: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstableleftalign}\marg{\gls{glstableotherwidth}} \end{compactcodebox} If \glstableoptval{par}{justified} or \glstableoptval{par}{ragged}, the column widths will be calculated. The following length registers will be set, where applicable to the block style. \cmddef{glstablenamewidth} The width of the name column. \cmddef{glstabledescwidth} The width of the description column. \cmddef{glstablesymbolwidth} The width of the symbol column. \cmddef{glstableotherwidth} The width of the other column. Unless \glstableoptval{par}{false}, the table will be the width of a line and each block will have equal width. \cmddef{glstableblockwidth} Note that in all the above, the width doesn't include the inter-column space given by \gls{tabcolsep}. The length registers below are initialise to 5pt, and can be redefined as appropriate. \cmddef{glstablepostpreambleskip} The vertical skip after the preamble. \cmddef{glstableprepostambleskip} The vertical skip before the postamble. Formatting for the name, symbol, description and other field values are applied by the following commands. \cmddef{glstableNameFmt} Formatting applied to the name. Simply does \meta{text} by default. Note that the argument \meta{text} will \code{\gls{glossentryname}\margm{label}}, so any formatting applied by that command will also be in effect. \cmddef{glstableSubNameFmt} Formatting applied to the child name. Does nothing by default, which means that the child name won't show. \cmddef{glstableSymbolFmt} Formatting applied to the symbol. Simply does \meta{text} by default. Note that the argument \meta{text} will \code{\gls{glossentrysymbol}\margm{label}}, so any formatting applied by that command will also be in effect. \cmddef{glstableSubSymbolFmt} Formatting applied to the child symbol. Just does \gls{glstableSymbolFmt} by default. \cmddef{glstableDescFmt} Formatting applied to the description. Simply does \meta{text} by default. Note that the argument \meta{text} will be: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glossentrydesc}\margm{label}\gls{glspostdescription} \end{compactcodebox} so any formatting applied by \gls{glossentrydesc} will also be in effect. Note that the \gls{postdeschook} is included in the formatted. \cmddef{glstableSubDescFmt} Formatting applied to the child description. Just does \gls{glstableDescFmt} by default. The other field's \idxc{internalfieldlabel}{internal label} is provided by expanding: \cmddef{glstableotherfield} This is redefined by the \glstableopt{other} option, but it may be redefined before \gls{printunsrttable} if a default field is required. \cmddef{glstableOtherFmt} The formatting applied to the other field. This just does \meta{text} by default. The field value itself is displayed with: \cmddef{glstableOther} The default definition does: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glstableOtherFmt}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrusefield}\margm{entry-label}\marg{\gls{glstableotherfield}}} \end{compactcodebox} The value for the child entries is displayed with: \cmddef{glstableSubOther} The default definition simply does \gls{glstableOther}\margm{entry-label} You can test whether or not the other field is set for a given entry with: \cmddef{glstableifhasotherfield} This does \meta{true} of the other field is non-void (according to \gls{ifglsfieldvoid}) otherwise it does \meta{false}. This will always do \meta{false} if \gls{glstableotherfield} is void. The column headers are supplied by the following commands, where applicable. \cmddef{glstablenameheader} The header for the name column. The default definition is \gls{entryname}. \cmddef{glstabledescheader} The header for the description column. The default definition is \gls{descriptionname}. \cmddef{glstablesymbolheader} The header for the symbol column. The default definition is \gls{symbolname}. \cmddef{glstableotherheader} The header for the other column. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{MFUsentencecase}\marg{\gls{glstableotherfield}} \end{compactcodebox} The column headers are formatted according to: \cmddef{glstableHeaderFmt} The default definition is \code{\gls{textbf}\margm{text}}. \begin{warning} The remaining commands are undocumented as they are liable to change. \end{warning} \glsendrange{pkg.glossary-table}% \chapter{Accessibility Support} \label{sec:accsupp} The \sty{glossaries} package comes with a supplementary package \sty{glossaries-accsupp} that helps provide accessibility support. The \sty{glossaries-extra} package provides additional support, but only if the \sty{glossaries-accsupp} package has already been loaded when the relevant commands are defined. The best and simplest way to do this is through the \opt{accsupp} package option. See the \ctanmirrornofn{macros/latex/contrib/glossaries/glossaries-user.html\#sec:accsupp}{\qt{Accessibility Support}} chapter in the \sty{glossaries} user guide for further information about \sty{glossaries-accsupp}. \section{Abbreviations} \label{sec:accessabbr} The accessibility fields relating to abbreviations are \gloskey{shortaccess}, \gloskey{shortpluralaccess}, \gloskey{longaccess} and \gloskey{longpluralaccess}. These provide the replacement text for the corresponding \gloskey{short}, \gloskey{shortplural}, \gloskey{long} and \gloskey{longplural} fields. The \gloskey{access} field provides the replacement text for the \gloskey{name} field. Some of these accessibility fields are automatically assigned by \gls{newabbreviation} if they haven't been set. \cmddef{glsxtrassignactualsetup} This command is used to locally redefine common formatting commands so that they can be stripped to obtain only the text. You can add additional commands with \gls{appto}. For example, the following eccentric example has some strange styling in the abbreviation: \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{foo}\marg{f\gls+{textsuperscript}\marg{o}\gls+{textsubscript}\marg{o}}\marg{furry old otters} \end{codebox} If an accessibility field is being automatically assigned with text obtained from the short value, then the subscript and superscript commands will need to be stripped. These need to be locally redefined to just do their arguments: \begin{codebox} \gls{appto}\gls{glsxtrassignactualsetup}\marg{\% \gls+{letcs}\marg{\gls{textsuperscript}}\marg{@firstofone}\% \gls{letcs}\marg{\gls{textsubscript}}\marg{@firstofone}\% } \end{codebox} The attributes that specifically relate to accessibility in abbreviations are listed below. The \qt{actual short value} means the value obtained from the \gloskey{short} value after any markup commands have have locally redefined using \gls{glsxtrassignactualsetup}. The actual short value may then be modified by these attributes. Similarly, for the \qt{actual long value}. Finally, if \gloskey{shortaccess} hasn't already been set, it will be set to: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsdefaultshortaccess}\margm{actual long}\margm{actual short} \end{codebox} (with \gls{glsdefaultshortaccess} expanded). This command is provided by \sty{glossaries-accsupp} and is defined to do just \margm{actual long}. It was redefined by \sty{glossaries-extra} v1.42 to do \code{\margm{actual long} (\margm{actual short})}, but has been reverted back to its original definition in v1.49. \optiondef{catattr.accessinsertdots} If the \gloskey{shortaccess} key hasn't been set then this attribute will be checked. If true, the actual short value will have dots inserted (as per \catattr{insertdots}). Note that if this attribute hasn't been set but \catattr{insertdots} is true (and the \gloskey{shortaccess} key hasn't been set), then the actual short value will also have dots inserted. \optiondef{catattr.accessaposplural} If the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} key hasn't been set then this attribute will be checked. If true, the actual short plural value will have the apostrophe suffix (similar to \catattr{aposplural} but using \gls{glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix} instead of \gls{abbrvpluralsuffix}). Note that if this attribute hasn't been set but \catattr{aposplural} is true (and the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} key hasn't been set), then the actual short plural value will also have the apostrophe suffix. \optiondef{catattr.accessnoshortplural} If the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} key hasn't been set and the \catattr{accessaposplural} attribute hasn't been set, then this attribute will be checked. If true, the actual short plural value will be the same as the singular (as \catattr{noshortplural}). Note that if this attribute hasn't been set but \catattr{noshortplural} is true (and the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} key hasn't been set), then the actual short plural value will also be the singular form. \optiondef{catattr.nameshortaccess} If the \gloskey{access} key hasn't been set and this attribute is true, then the \gloskey{access} field will be set to the same as the \gloskey{shortaccess}. \optiondef{catattr.textshortaccess} If the \gloskey{textaccess} key hasn't been set and this attribute is true, then the \gloskey{textaccess} field will be set to the same as the \gloskey{shortaccess}. Additionally, if the \gloskey{pluralaccess} key hasn't been set, then it will be set to the same as the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} value. \optiondef{catattr.firstshortaccess} If the \gloskey{firstaccess} key hasn't been set and this attribute is true, then the \gloskey{firstaccess} field will be set to the same as the \gloskey{shortaccess}. Additionally, if the \gloskey{firstpluralaccess} key hasn't been set, then it will be set to the same as the \gloskey{shortpluralaccess} value. \section{Accessibility Wrappers} \label{sec:glsaccessfield} The glossary style commands such as \gls{glossentryname} incorporate accessibility support by using the \csfmt{glsaccess\meta{field}} commands instead of the corresponding \csfmt{glsentry\meta{field}} commands. If the \sty{glossaries-accsupp} package hasn't been loaded or if the relevant accessibility field hasn't been set, these commands simply do the corresponding \csfmt{glsentry\meta{field}} command. \cmddef{glsaccessname} This shows the \gloskey{name} field encapsulated with \gls{glsnameaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryname}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessname} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessname} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccesstext} This shows the \gloskey{text} field encapsulated with \gls{glstextaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrytext}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccesstext} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccesstext} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessplural} This shows the \gloskey{plural} field encapsulated with \gls{glspluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryplural}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfirst} This shows the \gloskey{first} field encapsulated with \gls{glsfirstaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryfirst}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfirst} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfirst} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfirstplural} This shows the \gloskey{firstplural} field encapsulated with \gls{glsfirstpluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryfirstplural}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfirstplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfirstplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccesssymbol} This shows the \gloskey{symbol} field encapsulated with \gls{glssymbolaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrysymbol}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccesssymbol} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccesssymbol} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccesssymbolplural} This shows the \gloskey{symbolplural} field encapsulated with \gls{glssymbolpluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrysymbolplural}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccesssymbolplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccesssymbolplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessdesc} This shows the \gloskey{description} field encapsulated with \gls{glsdescriptionaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrydesc}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessdesc} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessdesc} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessdescplural} This shows the \gloskey{descriptionplural} field encapsulated with \gls{glsdescriptionpluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrydescplural}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessdescplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessdescplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessshort} This shows the \gloskey{short} field encapsulated with \gls{glsshortaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryshort}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessshort} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessshort} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessshortpl} This shows the \gloskey{shortplural} field encapsulated with \gls{glsshortpluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryshortpl}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessshortpl} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessshortpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccesslong} This shows the \gloskey{long} field encapsulated with \gls{glslongaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrylong}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccesslong} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccesslong} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccesslongpl} This shows the \gloskey{longplural} field encapsulated with \gls{glslongpluralaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentrylongpl}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccesslongpl} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccesslongpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuseri} This shows the \gloskey{user1} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuseri}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuseri} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuseri} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuserii} This shows the \gloskey{user2} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriiaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuserii}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuserii} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuserii} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuseriii} This shows the \gloskey{user3} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriiiaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuseriii}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuseriii} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuseriii} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuseriv} This shows the \gloskey{user4} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuserivaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuseriv}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuseriv} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuseriv} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuserv} This shows the \gloskey{user5} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuservaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuserv}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuserv} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuserv} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessuservi} This shows the \gloskey{user6} field encapsulated with \gls{glsuserviaccessdisplay} or just \gls{glsentryuservi}\margm{entry-label}. \cmddef{Glsaccessuservi} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessuservi} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \section{Inner Formatting Wrappers} \label{sec:glsaccessfmtfield} These \csfmt{glsaccessfmt\meta{field}} commands are similar to the corresponding \csfmt{glsaccess\meta{field}} commands described above, but they format the field value using \gls{glsfmtfield}, \gls{Glsfmtfield} or \gls{GLSfmtfield} with the supplied \meta{cs} encapsulating command. The default entry display style \gls{glsgenentryfmt}, and the predefined abbreviation styles all incorporate accessibility support by using these commands in order to support the \idx{innerformatting}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtname} This shows the \gloskey{name} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsnameaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtname} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtname} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmttext} This shows the \gloskey{text} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glstextaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmttext} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmttext} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtplural} This shows the \gloskey{plural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glspluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtfirst} This shows the \gloskey{first} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsfirstaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtfirst} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtfirst} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtfirstplural} This shows the \gloskey{firstplural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsfirstpluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtfirstplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtfirstplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtsymbol} This shows the \gloskey{symbol} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glssymbolaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtsymbol} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtsymbol} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtsymbolplural} This shows the \gloskey{symbolplural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glssymbolpluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtsymbolplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtsymbolplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtdesc} This shows the \gloskey{description} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsdescriptionaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtdesc} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtdesc} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtdescplural} This shows the \gloskey{descriptionplural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsdescriptionpluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtdescplural} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtdescplural} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtshort} This shows the \gloskey{short} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsshortaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtshort} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtshort} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtshortpl} This shows the \gloskey{shortplural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsshortpluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtshortpl} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtshortpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtlong} This shows the \gloskey{long} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glslongaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtlong} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtlong} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtlongpl} This shows the \gloskey{longplural} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glslongpluralaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtlongpl} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtlongpl} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuseri} This shows the \gloskey{user1} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuseri} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuseri} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuserii} This shows the \gloskey{user2} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriiaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuserii} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuserii} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuseriii} This shows the \gloskey{user3} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuseriiiaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuseriii} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuseriii} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuseriv} This shows the \gloskey{user4} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuserivaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuseriv} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuseriv} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuserv} This shows the \gloskey{user5} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuservaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuserv} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuserv} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \cmddef{glsaccessfmtuservi} This shows the \gloskey{user6} field formatted with \meta{cs} and, if accessibility support provided, encapsulated with \gls{glsuserviaccessdisplay}. \cmddef{Glsaccessfmtuservi} As above but \idx{sentencecase}. \cmddef{GLSaccessfmtuservi} As above but \idx{allcaps}. \chapter{Categories} \label{sec:categories} \begin{information} For multi-entry categories, see \sectionref{sec:multiglscategory}. \end{information} Each entry defined by \gls{newglossaryentry} (or commands that internally use it such as \gls{newabbreviation}) is assigned a category through the \gloskey{category} key. You may add any category that you like, but since the category is a label used in the creation of some control sequences, avoid problematic characters within the category label. (So take care if you have \sty{babel} shorthands on that make some characters active.) The use of categories can give you more control over the way entries are displayed in the text or glossary. Note that an entry's category is independent of the glossary type. Be careful not to confuse \gloskey{category} with \gloskey{type}. \cmddef{glscategory} Expands to the category of the given entry or does nothing if the entry doesn't exist (analogous to \gls{glsentryname}). \cmddef{glsifcategory} Tests if the entry given by \meta{entry-label} has the \gloskey{category} set to \meta{category}. An entry may have its \gloskey{category} field changed using commands such as \gls{GlsXtrSetField} (see \sectionref{sec:setfields}). In addition, the following commands are provided to batch set the \gloskey{category} for a collection of entries. \cmddef{glsxtrsetcategory} Globally sets the \gloskey{category} field to the fully expanded \meta{category-label} for each entry listed in \meta{entry-labels}. \cmddef{glsxtrsetcategoryforall} Globally sets the \gloskey{category} field to the fully expanded \meta{category-label} for each entry belonging to the \idxpl{glossary} listed in \meta{glossary-labels}. There are also some iterative commands available: \cmddef{glsforeachincategory} This iterates through all entries in the \idxpl{glossary} identified by the comma-separated list \meta{glossary-labels} that have the category given by \meta{category-label} and performs \meta{body} for each match. Within \meta{body}, you can use \meta{glossary-cs} and \meta{label-cs} (which much be control sequences) to access the current glossary and entry label. If \meta{glossary-labels} is omitted, all glossaries are assumed. \cmddef{glsforeachwithattribute} This iterates over all entries in the given list of \idxpl{glossary} that have a category with the given \meta{attribute-label} set to \meta{attribute-value} and performs \meta{body} at each iteration. If \meta{glossary-types} is omitted, the list of all non-\idxpl{ignoredglossary} is assumed. The remaining arguments are as for \gls{glsforeachincategory}. \section{Known Categories} \label{sec:knowncategories} These are the category labels that are set or referenced by \sty{glossaries-extra}. \optiondef{cat.general} The default category assumed by \gls{newglossaryentry}. \optiondef{cat.abbreviation} The default category assumed by \gls{newabbreviation}. \optiondef{cat.acronym} The default category assumed by \gls{newacronym}. \optiondef{cat.index} The default category assumed by \gls{newterm}. \optiondef{cat.symbol} The default category assumed by \gls{glsxtrnewsymbol}. \optiondef{cat.number} The default category assumed by \gls{glsxtrnewnumber}. \section{Attributes} \label{sec:attributes} Each category may have a set of attributes, where each attribute has an associated value for its given category. An entry's attribute set corresponds to the attributes associated with the entry's category. As with the category, the attribute name is also a label. You can provide your own custom attributes, which you can set and access with the commands described in \sectionref{sec:attributecmds}. \subsection{Known Attributes} \label{sec:knownattributes} This section lists attributes that \sty{glossaries-extra} sets or accesses. If an attribute hasn't been set, a default is assumed. For boolean attributes, the test may simply be to determine if the attribute has been set to \code{true}, in which case any other value or a missing value will be interpreted as false. Conversely, the test may be to determine if the attribute has been set to \code{false}, in which case any other value or a missing value will be interpreted as true. \begin{information} See \sectionref{sec:multiglscategory} for attributes relating to multi-entry categories. \end{information} \subsubsection{Abbreviation Attributes} \label{sec:abbrattr} See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr} for abbreviation accessibility attributes. \optiondef{catattr.regular} This attribute indicates whether or not an entry should be considered a regular entry. This enables \gls{glsentryfmt} to determine whether to use \gls{glsgenentryfmt} or \gls{glsxtrgenabbrvfmt}. The \cat{general} and \cat{acronym} categories have the \catattr{regular} attribute automatically set to \code{true}. Some abbreviation styles change this value. \optiondef{catattr.discardperiod} If set to \qt{true}, the \idx{postlinkhook} will discard a \idx{fullstop} that follows \emph{non-plural} commands like \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext}(see \sectionref{sec:postlinkhook}). \begin{information} This attribute doesn't apply to the accessibility fields. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr} for attributes related to accessibility support for abbreviations. \end{information} Note that this can cause a problem if you access a field that doesn't end with a full stop. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation} \oarg{\gloskeyval{user1}{German Speaking \cmd{TeX}\cmd{ }User Group}} \marg{dante}\marg{DANTE e.V.}\marg{Deutschsprachige Anwendervereinigung \cmd{TeX}\cmd{ }e.V.} \end{codebox} Here the \gloskey{short} and \gloskey{long} fields end with a full stop, but the \gloskey{user1} field doesn't. The simplest solution in this situation is to put the sentence terminator in the final optional argument. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsuseri}\marg{dante}\oarg{.} \end{codebox} This will bring the punctuation character inside the \idx{linktext} and it won't be discarded. \optiondef{catattr.pluraldiscardperiod} If this attribute is set to \qt{true} \emph{and} the \catattr{discardperiod} attribute is set to \qt{true}, this will behave as above for the plural commands like \gls{glspl} or \gls{glsplural}. \optiondef{catattr.retainfirstuseperiod} If this attribute is set to \qt{true} then the discard is determined by \gls{glsxtrdiscardperiodretainfirstuse}, regardless of the \catattr{discardperiod} or \catattr{pluraldiscardperiod} attributes. This is useful for \meta{short} (\meta{long}) abbreviation styles where only the short form has a trailing \idx{fullstop}. \begin{information} This attribute doesn't apply to the accessibility fields. See \sectionref{sec:accessabbr} for attributes related to accessibility support for abbreviations. \end{information} \optiondef{catattr.markwords} If this attribute is set to \qt{true} any entry defined using \gls{newabbreviation} will automatically have spaces in the long form replaced with: \cmddef{glsxtrwordsep} and each word is encapsulated with: \cmddef{glsxtrword} For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{\catattr{markwords}}\marg{true} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ip}\marg{IP}\marg{Internet Protocol} \end{codebox} is essentially the same as \begin{codebox} \gls{newabbreviation}\marg{ip}\marg{IP} \marg{\gls{glsxtrword}\marg{Internet}\gls{glsxtrwordsep}\gls{glsxtrword}\marg{Protocol}} \end{codebox} The \qt{hyphen} styles, such as \abbrstyle{long-hyphen-short-hyphen}, take advantage of this markup. If the inserted material (provided in the final argument of \idx{glslike} commands) starts with a hyphen then \gls{glsxtrwordsep} is locally redefined to a hyphen. (The default value is a space). Note that this only applies to commands like \gls{gls} and not like \gls{glsxtrlong}. You can provide your own localised switch, if required. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{hyplong}}[2][]\marg{\% \marg{\cmd{def}\gls{glsxtrwordsep}\marg{-}\gls{glsxtrlong}\oarg{\#1}\marg{\#2}}} \end{codebox} This setting will also adjust the long plural. This attribute is only applicable to entries defined using \gls{newabbreviation} (or \gls{newacronym} if it's using \gls{newabbreviation}.) \begin{important} This setting may result in the \gls{glsxtrword} and \gls{glsxtrwordsep} markup ending up in the \gloskey{sort} field, depending on the style in use. \end{important} \optiondef{catattr.markshortwords} This is similar to \catattr{markwords} but applies to the short form. (Only useful for abbreviations that contain spaces.) This attribute is only applicable to entries defined using \gls{newabbreviation} (or \gls{newacronym} if it's using \gls{newabbreviation}.) This setting will only adjust the short plural if the \gloskey{shortplural} key isn't used. This setting will take precedence over \catattr{insertdots}. \begin{important} This setting may result in the \gls{glsxtrword} and \gls{glsxtrwordsep} markup ending up in the \gloskey{sort} field, depending on the style in use. \end{important} \optiondef{catattr.insertdots} If this attribute is set to \qt{true} any entry defined using \gls{newabbreviation} will automatically have \idxpl{fullstop} inserted after each letter. The entry will be defined with those dots present as though they had been present in the \meta{short} argument of \gls{newabbreviation} (rather than inserting them every time the entry is used). The short plural form defaults to the new dotted version of the original \meta{short} form with the plural suffix appended. \emph{This setting is incompatible with \catattr{markshortwords}.} This attribute is only applicable to entries defined using \gls{newabbreviation} (or \gls{newacronym} if it's using \gls{newabbreviation}.) \begin{important} If you explicitly override the short plural using the \gloskey{shortplural} key, you must explicitly insert the dots yourself (since there's no way for the code to determine if the plural has a suffix that shouldn't be followed by a dot). \end{important} This attribute is best used with the \catattr{discardperiod} attribute set to \qt{true}. \optiondef{catattr.aposplural} If this attribute is set to \qt{true}, \gls{newabbreviation} will insert an apostrophe (') before the plural suffix for the \emph{short} plural form (unless explicitly overridden with the \gloskey{shortplural} key). The long plural form is unaffected by this setting. This setting overrides \catattr{noshortplural}. This attribute is only applicable to entries defined using \gls{newabbreviation} (or \gls{newacronym} if it's using \gls{newabbreviation}.) Check with your supervisor, publisher or editor if you want to use this attribute as this usage is controversial. \optiondef{catattr.noshortplural} If this attribute is set to \qt{true}, \gls{newabbreviation} won't append the plural suffix for the short plural form. This means the \gloskey{short} and \gloskey{shortplural} values will be the same unless explicitly overridden. \emph{This setting is incompatible with \catattr{aposplural}.} This attribute is only applicable to entries defined using \gls{newabbreviation} (or \gls{newacronym} if it's using \gls{newabbreviation}.) \optiondef{catattr.tagging} If this attribute is set to \qt{true}, the tagging command defined by \gls{GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging} will be activated to use \gls{glsxtrtagfont} in the glossary (see \sectionref{sec:tagging}) \subsubsection{Attributes that Alter \glsfmttext{glslink} Options} \label{sec:glsoptsattr} \optiondef{catattr.nohyperfirst} When used with the \idx{glslike} commands, if this attribute is set to \code{true}, this will automatically suppress the hyperlink on \idx{firstuse}. \begin{information} This settings can be overridden by explicitly setting the \glsopt{hyper} key on or off in the optional argument of the \idx{glslike} command. \end{information} As from version 1.07, \gls{glsfirst}, \gls{Glsfirst}, \gls{GLSfirst} and their plural versions (which should ideally behave in a similar way to the \idx{firstuse} of \gls{gls} or \gls{glspl}) now honour this attribute (but not the package-wide \optval{hyperfirst}{false} option, which matches the behaviour of \sty{glossaries}). If you want commands like \gls{glsfirst} to ignore the \catattr{nohyperfirst} attribute then just redefine \gls{glsxtrchecknohyperfirst} to do nothing. \optiondef{catattr.nohypernext} If set to \code{true}, this will automatically set \glsoptval{hyper}{false} on \idx{subsequentuse} when using the \idx{glslike} commands. \optiondef{catattr.nohyper} If set to \code{true}, this will automatically set \glsoptval{hyper}{false} when using the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands. \optiondef{catattr.indexonlyfirst} This is similar to the \opt{indexonlyfirst} package option but only for entries that have a category with this attribute set to \qt{true}. \optiondef{catattr.wrgloss} When using the \idx{glslike} or \idx{glstextlike} commands, this will automatically set \glsoptval{wrgloss}{after} it this attribute is set to \qt{after}. \optiondef{catattr.textformat} The \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands have the \idx{linktext} encapsulated in the argument of \gls{glstextformat} by default (the outer formatting, see \sectionref{sec:glstextformat}). If the \catattr{textformat} attribute is set, the control sequence given by the attribute value will be used instead. The attribute value should be the name (without the leading backslash) of a command that takes a single argument (the \idx{linktext}). Remember that the abbreviation styles may apply an additional font change. \optiondef{catattr.hyperoutside} This boolean attribute may be \code{false}, \code{true} or unset. If unset, \code{true} is assumed. This indicates the default setting of the \glsopt{hyperoutside} option, described in \sectionref{sec:glsopts}. \subsubsection{Glossary Attributes} \label{sec:glossattr} \optiondef{catattr.glossdesc} This attribute is checked by the \gls{glossentrydesc} to determine whether or not to apply any \idx{casechange}. The value may be one of: \begin{deflist} \itemtitle{\optfmt{firstuc}} \begin{itemdesc} Applies \idx+{sentencecase}. That is, the first letter of the description will be converted to \idx{uppercase} (using \gls{Glsentrydesc}). \end{itemdesc} \itemtitle{\optfmt{title}} \begin{itemdesc} Applies \idx+{titlecase}. If you have at least \sty{glossaries} v4.48, the title casing is indirectly performed by \gls{glscapitalisewords}, which defaults to \gls{capitalisewords} (provided by \sty{mfirstuc}). You can either redefine \gls{glscapitalisewords} if you want the change to also affect \gls{glsentrytitlecase} or if you only want the change to apply to the attribute case-changing then redefine \gls{glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs}. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs}}[1]\marg{\gls{xcapitalisefmtwords}*\marg{\#1}} \end{codebox} (Note that the argument to \gls{glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs} will be a control sequence whose replacement text is the entry's description, which is why \gls{xcapitalisefmtwords} is needed instead of \gls{capitalisefmtwords}.) \begin{warning} If an error occurs with this setting, try redefining \gls{glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs} as shown above. \end{warning} \end{itemdesc} \end{deflist} Any other values of this attribute are ignored. Remember that there are design limitations for both the \idx{sentencecase} and the \idx{titlecase} commands. See the \sty{mfirstuc} user manual for further details. \begin{information} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you can use the \resourceopt{description-case-change} setting instead. \end{information} \optiondef{catattr.glossdescfont} If set, the value should be the name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash) that takes one argument. This control sequence will be applied by \gls{glossentrydesc} to the description text. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{glossdescfont}}\marg{emph} \end{codebox} \optiondef{catattr.glossname} As \catattr{glossdesc} but applies to \gls{glossentryname}. Additionally, if this attribute is set to \qt{uc} the name is converted to \idx{allcaps}. \begin{information} If you are using \app{bib2gls}, you can use the \resourceopt{name-case-change} setting instead. \end{information} \optiondef{catattr.indexname} If set, the \idx{postnamehook} will index the entry using \gls{index}. See \sectionref{sec:autoindex} for further details. \optiondef{catattr.glossnamefont} As \catattr{glossdescfont} but applies to \gls{glossentryname}. Note that this overrides \gls{glsnamefont} which will only be used if this attribute hasn't been set. Remember that \idxpl{glossarystyle} may additionally apply a font change, such as the list styles which put the name in the optional argument of \gls{item}. \optiondef{catattr.glosssymbolfont} This is similar to \catattr{glossnamefont} and \catattr{glossdescfont} but is used by \gls{glossentrysymbol}. \subsubsection{Other Attributes} \label{sec:otherattr} \optiondef{catattr.headuc} If this attribute is set to \qt{true}, commands like \gls{glsfmtshort} will use the upper case version in the page headers. \optiondef{catattr.entrycount} The value of this attribute (if set) must be an integer and is used in combination with \gls{glsenableentrycount} (see \sectionref{sec:entrycount}). Leave blank or undefined for categories that shouldn't have this facility enabled. The value of this attribute is used by \gls{glsxtrifcounttrigger} to determine how commands such as \gls{cgls} should behave. \optiondef{catattr.linkcount} This attribute is set to \code{true} by \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting} (see \sectionref{sec:linkcount}). \optiondef{catattr.linkcountmaster} This attribute is set by \gls{GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting} to the name of the counter that requires the link counter to be added to its reset list (see \sectionref{sec:linkcount}). \optiondef{catattr.dualindex} If this attribute is set, whenever a glossary entry has information written to the external glossary file through commands like \gls{gls} and \gls{glsadd}, a~corresponding line will be written to the indexing file using \gls{index}. The value may be \code{true} to simply enable this feature or the value may be the encap to use with \gls{index}. See \sectionref{sec:autoindex} for further details. \optiondef{catattr.targeturl} If set, the hyperlink generated by commands like \gls{gls} will be set to the URL provided by this attribute's value. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targeturl}}\marg{master-doc.pdf} \end{codebox} (See also the accompanying sample file \file{sample-external.tex}.) If the URL contains awkward characters (such as \verb|%| or \verb|~|) remember that the base \sty{glossaries} package provides commands like \gls{glspercentchar} and \gls{glstildechar} that expand to literal characters. \optiondef{catattr.targetname} If you want to a named anchor within the target URL (notionally adding \code{\#\meta{name}} to the URL), then you also need to set \catattr{targetname} to the anchor \meta{name}. You may use \gls{glslabel} within \meta{name} which is set by commands like \gls{gls} to the entry's label. All the predefined \idxpl{glossarystyle} start each entry listing with \gls{glstarget} which sets the anchor to \code{\gls{glolinkprefix}\gls{glslabel}}, so if you want entries to link to glossaries in the URL given by \catattr{targeturl}, you can just do: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targetname}}\marg{\gls{glolinkprefix}\gls{glslabel}} \end{codebox} (If the target document changed \gls{glolinkprefix} then you will need to adjust the above as appropriate.) \optiondef{catattr.targetcategory} If the anchor is in the form \code{\meta{name1}.\meta{name2}} then use \catattr{targetname} for the \meta{name2} part and \catattr{targetcategory} for the \meta{name1} part. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targeturl}}\marg{master-doc.pdf} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targetcategory}}\marg{page} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targetname}}\marg{7} \end{codebox} will cause all link text for \cat{general} entries to link to \filefmt{master-doc.pdf\#page.7} (page 7 of that PDF). If you want a mixture in your document of entries that link to an internal glossary and entries that link to an external URL then you can use \gls{newignoredglossary*} for the external list. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{newignoredglossary*}\marg{external} \codepar \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{external}\marg{\catattr{targeturl}}\marg{master-doc.pdf} \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{targetname}}\marg{\gls{glolinkprefix}\gls{glslabel}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample},\gloskeyval{description}{local example}} \codepar \gls{newglossaryentry}\marg{sample2}\marg{\gloskeyval{name}{sample2}, \gloskeyval{type}{external}, \gloskeyval{category}{external}, \gloskeyval{description}{external example}} \end{codebox} \optiondef{catattr.externallocation} The value should be the file name of the target document when manually indexing an external location with \glsopt{thevalue}. In general, it's better to use \app{bib2gls} v1.7+ which can handle multiple external sources and doesn't require this attribute. \subsection{Accessing and Setting Attributes} \label{sec:attributecmds} Attributes can be set using the following commands: \cmddef{glssetcategoryattribute} Locally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for the given category. \cmddef{glssetcategoriesattribute} Globally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for all the categories in the comma-separated list \meta{category list}. \cmddef{glssetcategoryattributes} Globally sets each attribute in the comma separated \meta{attribute list} to \meta{value} for the given \meta{category}. \cmddef{glssetcategoriesattributes} Globally sets each attribute in the comma separated \meta{attribute list} to \meta{value} for each category in the comma-separated list \meta{category list}. \cmddef{glssetattribute} Locally sets the given attribute to \meta{value} for the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. This command can't be used to assign an attribute for a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glssetregularcategory} A shortcut that sets the \catattr{regular} attribute to \code{true} for the given category using \gls{glssetcategoryattribute}. An attribute can be locally unset using: \cmddef{glsunsetcategoryattribute} Attribute values can be obtained with the following commands: \cmddef{glsgetcategoryattribute} Expands to the value of the given attribute for the given category. Expands to nothing if the attribute hasn't been set. \cmddef{glsgetattribute} Expands to the value of the given attribute for the category associated with the entry identified by \meta{entry-label}. Expands to nothing if the attribute hasn't been set. This command can't be used to assign an attribute for a multi-entry category. Attributes can be tested with the following commands. \cmddef{glshascategoryattribute} This uses \sty{etoolbox}['s] \gls{ifcsvoid} and does \meta{true} if the attribute has been set and isn't blank and isn't \gls{relax} otherwise it does \meta{false}. \cmddef{glshasattribute} As \gls{glshascategoryattribute} but the category is obtained from the given entry. This command can't be used to test an attribute associated with a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glsifcategoryattribute} This tests if the given attribute for the given category is set and equal to \meta{value}. If true, \meta{true} is done. If the attribute isn't set or is set but isn't equal to \meta{value}, \meta{false} is done. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{glsifcategoryattribute}\marg{\cat{general}}\marg{\catattr{nohyper}}\marg{true}\marg{NO HYPER}\marg{HYPER} \end{codebox} This does \qt{NO HYPER} if the \cat{general} category has the \catattr{nohyper} attribute set to \code{true} otherwise if does \qt{HYPER}. \cmddef{glsifattribute} As \gls{glsifcategoryattribute} but the category is obtained from the given entry. This command can't be used to test an attribute associated with a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glsifregularcategory} A shortcut that tests if the given category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{true}. \cmddef{glsifnotregularcategory} A shortcut that tests if the given category has the \catattr{regular} attribute set to \code{false}. \begin{warning} If the \catattr{regular} attribute hasn't been set, both \gls{glsifregularcategory} and \gls{glsifnotregularcategory} will do \meta{false}. The choice of command needs to be determined by what outcome should occur if the attribute hasn't been set. \end{warning} \cmddef{glsifregular} As \gls{glsifregularcategory} but the category is obtained from the given entry. This command can't be used to test an attribute associated with a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glsifnotregular} As \gls{glsifnotregularcategory} but the category is obtained from the given entry. This command can't be used to test an attribute associated with a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glsifcategoryattributetrue} Expands to \meta{true} if the attribute is \code{true} and \meta{false} otherwise. Expands to \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category. \cmddef{glsifattributetrue} As \gls{glsifcategoryattributetrue} but the category is obtained from the given entry. Expands to \meta{false} if the entry isn't defined. This command can't be used to test an attribute associated with a multi-entry category. \cmddef{glsifcategoryattributehasitem} Does \meta{true} if the category has the attribute (whose value is a comma-separated list) contains the given item and \meta{false} otherwise. Does \meta{false} if there's no such attribute for the given category. The item and list are expanded and passed to \sty{datatool}['s] \gls{DTLifinlist} to perform the test. \chapter{\apptext{bib2gls}: Managing Reference Databases} \label{sec:bib2gls}\glsstartrange{app.bib2gls} The command line application \app{bib2gls} performs two functions in one: \begin{itemize} \item selects entries according to \records\ found in the \ext+{aux} file (similar to \BibTeX), \item hierarchically sorts entries and collates \idxpl{locationlist} (similar to \app{makeindex} or \app{xindy}). \end{itemize} Instead of storing all your entry definitions in a \ext+{tex} and loading them using \gls{input} or \gls{loadglsentries}, the entries can instead be stored in a \ext+{bib} file and \app{bib2gls} can selectively write the appropriate commands to a \ext+{glstex} file which is loaded using \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}. This means that you can use a reference managing system to maintain the database and it reduces the \TeX\ overhead by only defining the entries that are actually required in the document. If you currently have a \ext{tex} file that contains hundreds of definitions, but you only use a dozen or so in your document, then the build time is needlessly slowed by the unrequired definitions that occur when the file is input. (You can convert an existing \ext{tex} file containing glossary definitions to a \ext{bib} file using \app{convertgls2bib}, supplied with \app{bib2gls}.) There are some new commands and options added to \sty{glossaries-extra} to help assist the integration of \app{bib2gls} into the document build process. This chapter just provides a general overview of \app{bib2gls}. The full details and some sample documents are provided in the \app{bib2gls} \ctansupportmirror{bib2gls/bib2gls.pdf}{manual} \texdocref{bib2gls} \hypertarget{examplebib}{}An example of the contents of \ext{bib} file that stores glossary entries that can be extracted with \app{bib2gls} called, say, \filefmt{terms.bib}: \newcommand{\termsbibcontent}{% \atentry{entry}\marg{bird,\newline\space \gloskeyval{name}{bird},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{feathered animal},\newline\space \gloskeyval{see}{[see also]duck,goose}\newline } \codepar \atentry{entry}\marg{duck,\newline\space \gloskeyval{name}{duck},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a waterbird with short legs}\newline } \codepar \atentry{entry}\marg{goose,\newline\space \gloskey{name}=\glsquote{goose},\newline\space \gloskey{plural}=\glsquote{geese},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a waterbird with a long neck}\newline }% }% \begin{codebox} \termsbibcontent \end{codebox}% The following provides some abbreviations in a file called, say, \filefmt{abbrvs.bib}: \newcommand{\abbrvsbibcontent}{% \atentry{string}\marg{ssi=\marg{server-side includes}}\newline \atentry{string}\marg{html=\marg{hypertext markup language}} \codepar \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{shtml,\newline\space \gloskey{short}=\glsquote{shtml},\newline\space \gloskey{long}= ssi \# \glsquote{ enabled } \# html,\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a combination of \gls{gls}\marg{html} and \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}}\newline } \codepar \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{html,\newline\space \gloskey{short} =\glsquote{html},\newline\space \gloskey{long} = html,\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a markup language for creating web pages}\newline } \codepar \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{ssi,\newline\space \gloskey{short}=\glsquote{ssi},\newline\space \gloskey{long} = ssi,\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a simple interpreted server-side scripting language}\newline }% \codepar \atentry{abbreviation}\marg{xml,\newline\space \gloskey{short}=\marg{xml}, \gloskey{long}=\marg{extensible markup language}, \gloskey{description}=\marg{a simple text-base format for representing structured information} }% }% \begin{codebox} \abbrvsbibcontent \end{codebox}% The above defines \ext{bib} strings (with \atentry{string}) and uses string concatenation (with \code{\#}), which is a \BibTeX\ feature. Another supported \ext{bib} feature is \atentry{preamble}, which may be used to provide command definitions. Here are some symbols in a file called, say, \filefmt{symbols.bib}: \newcommand{\symbolsbibcontent}{% \atentry{preamble}\marg{\glsquote{\cmd{providecommand}\marg{\cmd{mtx}}[1]\marg{\cmd{boldsymbol}\marg{\#1}}}} \codepar \atentry{symbol}\marg{M,\newline\space \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mtx}\marg{M}}},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a matrix}\newline } \codepar \atentry{symbol}\marg{v,\newline\space \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{vec}\marg{v}}},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a vector}\newline } \codepar \atentry{symbol}\marg{S,\newline\space \gloskeyval{name}{\cmd{ensuremath}\marg{\cmd{mathcal}\marg{S}}},\newline\space \gloskeyval{description}{a set}\newline }% } \begin{codebox} \symbolsbibcontent \end{codebox}% To ensure that \app{bib2gls} can find out which entries have been used in the document, you need the \opt{record} package option: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} If you are using \sty{hyperref}, you may prefer to use \opteqvalref{record}{nameref}. The \ext{glstex} file created by \app{bib2gls} is loaded using: \cmddef{glsxtrresourcefile} where \meta{basename} is the basename (without the extension) of the \ext{glstex} file. This command will redefine \gls{glsindexingsetting} to \code{bib2gls} (or \code{bib2gls-xindy} or \code{bib2gls-makeindex} if \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid}). There's a shortcut version: \cmddef{GlsXtrLoadResources} This internally uses \gls{glsxtrresourcefile} and sets the \meta{basename} to \gls{jobname} in the first instance and to \code{\gls{jobname}-\meta{n}} on subsequent instances (where \meta{n} is incremented at the end of every \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}). For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{terms,moreterms}} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{symbols,constants}} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{abbreviations}} \end{codebox} is equivalent to: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra} \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{terms,moreterms}}\marg{\gls{jobname}} \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{symbols,constants}}\marg{\gls{jobname}-1} \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{abbreviations}}\marg{\gls{jobname}-2} \end{codebox} If required, the value of \meta{n} is stored in the count register: \cmddef{glsxtrresourcecount} although there should be little need to use this. \begin{information} Since \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} is more convenient to use than \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}, all examples use \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}. \end{information} The \gls{glsxtrresourcefile} command writes the following to the \ext{aux} file: \cmddef{glsxtr@resource} and will input \metafilefmt{}{filename}{.glstex} if it exists. (Version 1.08 assumed \metafilefmt{}{filename}{.tex} but that's potentially dangerous if, for example, \meta{filename} happens to be the same as \gls{jobname}. The \ext+{glstex} extension was enforced by version 1.11.) If you are using or developing a build system that needs to know which applications to run as part of the document build, you can search the \ext{aux} for for instances of \gls{glsxtr@resource}. For example, using \app{arara}: \begin{codebox} \% arara: bib2gls if found("aux", "glsxtr@resource") \end{codebox} Since the \ext{glstex} file won't exist on the first \LaTeX\ run, the \opt{record} package option additionally switches on \opteqvalref{undefaction}{warn}. Any use of commands like \gls{gls} or \gls{glstext} will produce \idx{unknowntag} in the document, since the entries are undefined at this point. Once \app{bib2gls} has created the \ext{glstex} file the references should be resolved. This may cause a shift in the locations if the actual text produced once the entry is defined is significantly larger than the placeholder \idx{unknowntag} (as this can alter the page breaking). Note that as from v1.12, \gls{glsxtrresourcefile} temporarily switches the category code of \code{@} to 11 (letter) while it reads the file to allow for any internal commands. \begin{information} The package options \opteqvalref{record}{only} and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref} automatically load \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls}, which provides additional commands that are useful with \app{bib2gls}. Since they cover sorting and \idxpl{locationlist}, they're not relevant with the \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid} option. \end{information} These commands are provided by \sty{glossaries-extra} for use with \app{bib2gls}. The information provided with \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} is written to the \ext{aux} file using: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{protected@write}\cmd{@auxout}\marg{\gls{glsxtrresourceinit}}\margm{information} \end{compactcodebox} where \meta{information} is the information to pass to \app{bib2gls}. The command in the second argument: \cmddef{glsxtrresourceinit} may be used to temporarily redefine commands before the information is written to the file. This does nothing by default, but may be redefined to allow the use of short commands for convenience. For example, with: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrresourceinit}}\marg{\cmd{let}\gls{u}\gls{glshex}} \end{codebox} you can just use, for example, \code{\gls{u} E6} instead of \code{\gls{string}\gls{u}E6} in the custom rule. This redefinition of \gls{u} is scoped so its original definition is restored after the write operation. If you have complex regular expressions or use \resourceopt{assign-fields} (\app{bib2gls} v3.3+), you may find it more convenient to redefine \gls{glsxtrresourceinit} to use \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences}. \cmddef{glsxtrMFUsave} If you have \sty{mfirstuc} v2.08+, this command will be used on the first instance of \gls{glsxtrresourcefile}, and will add \gls{MFUsave} to the begin document hook and then disable itself. This is provided to help \app{bib2gls} v3.0+ pick up any of \sty{mfirstuc}['s] exclusions, blockers and mappings to assist with its \idx{sentencecase} function. The assumption is that all exclusions, blockers and mappings will be set up in the preamble. If there are any within the \env{document} environment that you want \app{bib2gls} to be aware of, redefine this command to do nothing before the first instance of \gls{glsxtrresourcefile} (or \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}) and use \gls{MFUsaveatend} instead. If you have multiple resource commands and you want a default set of options you can supply them in the definition of: \cmddef{GlsXtrDefaultResourceOptions} For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{GlsXtrDefaultResourceOptions}}\marg{\resourceoptval{selection}{all}} \end{codebox} This should be done before the resource commands to which the options should apply. \section{Indexing (Recording)} \label{sec:bib2glsindexing} As with \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, the \idx{glslike} and \idx{glstextlike} commands automatically index, but the underlying \idx{indexing} mechanism is more like that used with \gls{makenoidxglossaries}. Each indexing instance creates a \record\ in the \ext+{aux} file, which \app{bib2gls} can then pick up when it parses the \ext{aux} file. Each record has an associated format (the \idx{locationencap}) which can be set with the \glsopt{format} key and an associated \idx{locationcounter} (as with the other indexing methods). The formatted \idx{locationlist} is stored in the \gloskey{location} field (unless \resourceoptval{save-locations}{false}). Additionally, the individual locations are stored in the \glosfield{loclist} field as an \sty{etoolbox} internal list (as with \gls{makenoidxglossaries}). This may be used to pick out individual locations to avoid the complexity of parsing the formatted list. See the \app{bib2gls} manual for information on how to separate the \idx{locationlist} into groups associated with different counters. \section{Selection} \label{sec:bib2glsselection} The default behaviour is for \app{bib2gls} to select all entries that have a \record\ in the \ext{aux} file, and any dependent entries (including parent and cross-references). The \code{glsignore} format (for example, \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore}}\marg{duck}}) is recognised by \app{bib2gls} as a special \idxc{ignoredlocation}{ignored record}. This means that it will match the selection criteria but the record won't be added to the location list. This means that you won't get spurious commas in the \idx{locationlist} (as can happen with the other \idx{indexing} methods), so you can do, for example, \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat}\marg{glsignore} \end{codebox} at the start of the front matter and \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat}\marg{glsnumberformat} \end{codebox} at the start of the main matter to prevent any records in the front matter from occurring in the \idxpl{locationlist}. \begin{warning} Commands like \gls{glsaddall} and \gls{glsaddallunused} don't work with \app{bib2gls} as the command has to iterate over each \idx{glossary}['s] internal lists of defined entry labels, which will be empty on the first run and on subsequent runs will only contain those entries that have been selected by \app{bib2gls}. Use \resourceoptval{selection}{all} to select all entries instead. \end{warning} The \resourceopt{selection} option indicates which entries should be selected from the \ext{bib} files (listed in \resourceopt{src}). For example, \resourceoptval{selection}{all} indicates to select all entries, regardless of whether or not the entries have been referenced in the document. This will lead to empty \idxpl{locationlist} for some (or all) entries. The default setting is \resourceoptval{selection}{recorded and deps}, which indicates to select all entries that have \records\ and any dependent entries. See the \app{bib2gls} user manual for more details of this option. \section{Sorting and Displaying the Glossary} \label{sec:bib2glssortprint} With \app{makeindex} and \app{xindy}, the terms (read from the associated input file) are sorted and the code to typeset the \idx{glossary} is written to an output file, which is then input by \gls{printglossary}. With \app{bib2gls}, the entries supplied in the \ext{bib} files are sorted and the entry definition code (\gls{longnewglossaryentry} or \gls{newabbreviation}) is written to the \ext{glstex} file in the order obtained by sorting. This means that the \idx{glossary}['s] internal list is in the required order, so the \idx{glossary} can be displayed with \gls{printunsrtglossary} (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrt}). The \idx{indexing} information, such as the \idx{locationlist} or letter groups, is stored in fields such as \gloskey{location} or \gloskey{group} (where applicable), so the information can be included by \gls{printunsrtglossary}, but it means that the information is also available for use elsewhere in the document (so the \opt{savenumberlist} package option provided by \sty{glossaries} is redundant). There are many sorting options provided by \app{bib2gls}. The default is to sort according to the system locale. If the document has a language setting, you can use \resourceoptval{sort}{doc} to instruct \app{bib2gls} to sort according to that. (The language tag obtained from \sty{tracklang}['s] interface is written to the \ext{aux} file.) For a multilingual document you need to explicitly set the locale using a well-formed language tag. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{ \resourceoptval{src}{terms}, \comment{ data in terms.bib} \resourceoptval{sort}{de-DE-1996} \comment{ sort according to this locale} } \end{codebox} The locale-sensitive sort methods usually ignore most punctuation so for lists of symbols you may find it more appropriate to use one of the letter-base sort methods that sort according to the Unicode value of each character. Alternatively you can provide a custom rule. See the \app{bib2gls} manual for full details of all the available sort methods. Suppose the \ext{bib} examples shown \hyperlink{examplebib}{earlier} have been stored in the files \filefmt{terms.bib}, \filefmt{abbrvs.bib} and \filefmt{symbols.bib} which may either be in the current directory or on \TeX's path. Then the document might look like: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{terms,abbrvs,symbols}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} The document build process (assuming the document is called \filefmt{mydoc}) is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex mydoc bib2gls mydoc pdflatex mydoc \end{terminal} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[ label={ex:bib2gls}, title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: one resource set}, description={Example document using bib2gls with one resource set}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{terms.bib}^^J% \termsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{symbols.bib}^^J% \symbolsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=\marg{terms,abbrvs,symbols}} \codepar } {\gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} This creates a single glossary containing the entries: \code{bird}, \code{duck}, \code{goose}, \code{html}, \code{M}, \code{shtml} and \code{ssi} (in that order). The \code{bird}, \code{shtml} and \code{M} entries were added because \app{bib2gls} detected (from the \ext{aux} file) that they had been used in the document. The other entries were added because \app{bib2gls} detected (from the \ext{bib} files) that they are referenced by the used entries. In the case of \code{duck} and \code{goose}, they are in the \gloskey{see} field for \code{bird}. In the case of \code{ssi} and \code{html}, they are referenced in the \gloskey{description} field of \code{shtml}. These cross-referenced entries won't have a \idx{locationlist} when the \idx{glossary} is first displayed, but depending on how they are referenced, they may pick up a \idx{locationlist} on the next document build. The \code{xml} entry isn't required at all, and so hasn't been defined (from LaTeX's point of view). The entries can be separated into different glossaries with different sort methods: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{abbreviations},\opt{symbols}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{terms},\resourceoptval{sort}{en-GB},\resourceoptval{type}{main}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{abbrvs},\resourceoptval{sort}{letter-nocase},\resourceoptval{type}{abbreviations}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{symbols},\resourceoptval{sort}{use},\resourceoptval{type}{symbols}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} \begin{resultbox} \createexample* [title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: multiple resource sets}, label={ex:bib2glsmultiresources}, description={Example document using bib2gls with multiple resource sets}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls,pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{terms.bib}^^J% \termsbibcontent \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{symbols.bib}^^J% \symbolsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,abbreviations,symbols}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src=terms,sort=en-GB,type=main} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{src=abbrvs,sort=letter-nocase,type=abbreviations} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{src=symbols,sort=use,type=symbols} } {\gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} Or you can have multiple instance of \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} with the same \resourceopt{type}, which will produce a \idx{glossary} with ordered sub-blocks. For example: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{style}{\glostyle{indexgroup}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{abbrvs},\resourceoptval{sort}{letter-nocase},\resourceoptval{type}{main}, \resourceoptval{group}{abbreviations}} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{abbreviations}\marg{Abbreviations} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} \oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{symbols},\resourceoptval{sort}{use},\resourceoptval{type}{main}, \resourceoptval{group}{symbols}} \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{symbols}\marg{Abbreviations} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{terms},\resourceoptval{sort}{en-GB},\resourceoptval{type}{main}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} This sets the \gloskey{group} field for each resource set to the label given by the \resourceopt{group} resource option. This will result in a glossary where the first group has the label \code{abbreviations} and title \qt{Abbreviations}, the second group has the label \code{symbols} and title \qt{Symbols} and then follow the usual letter groups. Note that for this example to work, you must run \app{bib2gls} with the \switch{group} (or \switch{g}) switch. For example, if the document is called \filefmt{myDoc.tex}: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls \switch{g} myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: sub-blocks}, label={ex:bib2glssubblocks}, description={Example document using bib2gls with multiple resource sets for a single glossary to create a glossary with sub-blocks}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{terms.bib}^^J% \termsbibcontent \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{symbols.bib}^^J% \symbolsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,style=indexgroup}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}^^J \oarg{src={abbrvs},sort=letter-nocase,type=main,^^J group={abbreviations}}^^J% \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{abbreviations}\marg{Abbreviations} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}^^J \oarg{src={symbols},sort=use,type=main,group=symbols}^^J% \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{symbols}\marg{Abbreviations} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{src={terms},sort=en-GB,type=main} } {\gls{gls}\marg{bird} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{shtml} \codepar \gls{gls}\marg{M} \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \begin{important} The value of the \gloskey{group} field must always be a label (so avoid special characters). You can set the corresponding title with \code{glsxtrsetgrouptitle} (see \sectionref{sec:glosstylemods}). If no title is set then the label is used as the group title. \end{important} You can provide your own custom sort rule. For example, if you are using \XeLaTeX\ or \LuaLaTeX: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{ \resourceoptvalm{src}{terms}, \comment{entries in terms.bib} \resourceoptval{sort}{custom}, \comment{custom sort rule} \resourceoptvalm{sort-rule}{\comment{required with sort=custom} < \ae;\AE\ < a;\'a;\aa;\"a,\"A;\'A;\AA;\"A < b,B < c;\'c,C;\'C < d,D < e;\'e,E;\'E < f,F < g,G < h,H < i;\'i,I;\'I < j,J < l;\l,L;\L < m,M < n,N < o;\"o;\o,O;\"O;\O\ < p,P < q,Q < r,R < s;\'s,S;\'S < t,T < u;\'u,U;\'U < v,V < w,W < x,X < y,Y < z;\.z,Z;\.Z } } \end{codebox} \begin{warning} With old versions of the \LaTeX\ kernel, \idx{utf8} characters, such as \'e or \o, will expand when written to the \ext{aux} file. \end{warning} Some of the options, including \resourceopt{sort-rule}, allow Unicode characters to be indicated in the format \gls{u}\meta{hex} (or \gls{u}~\meta{hex}). \app{bib2gls} will recognise this as the character given by the hexadecimal value \meta{hex}. \begin{important} The \meta{options} provided to \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources} will expand as they are written to the \ext{aux} file (unless protected). This includes \gls{u}, so with a non-Unicode aware engine or where the document source is required to be \idx{ascii}, the character \ae\ needs to be written as \code{\gls{string}\gls{u} E6} and so on. Alternatively, use the shortcut \code{\gls{string}\gls{u} E6}. \end{important} For example, the above can be rewritten as: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{ \resourceoptvalm{src}{terms}, \comment{entries in terms.bib} \resourceoptval{sort}{custom}, \comment{custom sort rule} \resourceoptvalm{sort-rule}{\comment{required with sort=custom} < \gls{glshex} E6;\gls{glshex} C6 < a;\gls{glshex} E1;\gls{glshex} E5,\gls{glshex} E4,A;\gls{glshex} C1;\gls{glshex} C5;\gls{glshex} C4 < b,B < c;\gls{glshex} 0107,C;\gls{glshex} 0106 < d,D < e;\gls{glshex} E9,E;\gls{glshex} C9 < f,F < g,G < h,H < i;\gls{glshex} ED,I;\gls{glshex} CD < j,J < l;\gls{glshex} 0142,L;\gls{glshex} 0141 < m,M < n,N < o;\gls{glshex} F6;\gls{glshex} F8,O;\gls{glshex} D6;\gls{glshex} D8 < p,P < q,Q < r,R < s;\gls{glshex} 013F,S;\gls{glshex} 015A < t,T < u;\gls{glshex} FA,U;\gls{glshex} DA < v,V < w,W < x,X < y,Y < z;\gls{glshex} 017C,Z;\gls{glshex} 017B } } \end{codebox} \section{Record Counting} \label{sec:recordcount} As from version 1.1 of \app{bib2gls}, you can save the total record count for each entry by invoking \app{bib2gls} with the \switch{record-count} or \switch{record-count-unit} switches. These options will ensure that when each entry is written to the \ext{glstex} file \app{bib2gls} will additionally set the following internal fields for that entry: \begin{itemize} \item \glosfield{recordcount}: set to the total number of \records\ found for the entry; \item \glosfield{recordcount.counter}: set to the total number of \records\ found for the entry for the given counter. \end{itemize} If \switch{record-count-unit} is used then additionally: \begin{itemize} \item \glosfield{recordcount.counter.location}: set to the total number of \records\ found for the entry for the given counter with the given location. \end{itemize} Only use the unit counting option if the locations don't contain any special characters. With \sty{hyperref} use \theHcountername\ rather than \thecountername. Otherwise, if you really need unit counting with locations that may contain formatting commands, then you can try redefining: \cmddef{glsxtrdetoklocation} so that it detokenizes \meta{location} but take care when using \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount} with commands like \gls{thepage} as they can end up becoming detokenized too early. Note that the record count includes \locations\ that \app{bib2gls} discards, such as \idxc{ignoredlocation}{ignored records}, duplicates and partial duplicates (unless you filter them out with \switch{record-count-rule}). It doesn't include cross-reference records. For example, suppose a document has an entry with the label \code{bird} that is \recorded\ (\indexed) as follows: \begin{description} \item[Page 1] two (2) instances of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{bird}}; \item[Page 2] one (1) instance of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{bird}}; \item[Page 3] four (4) instances of \code{\gls{gls}\marg{bird}}; \item[Section 3] one (1) instance of \code{\gls{gls}\oarg{\glsoptval{counter}{section}}\marg{bird}}. \end{description} Then the total record count (stored in the \glosfield{recordcount} field) is $2+1+4+1=8$, the total for the \ctr{page} counter (stored in the \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter}{recordcount.page} field) is $2+1+4=7$, and the total for the \ctr{section} counter (stored in the \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter}{recordcount.section} field) is~1. With the unit counting on as well, the following fields are assigned: \begin{itemize} \item \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter.location}{recordcount.page.1} is set to 2; \item \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter.location}{recordcount.page.2} is set to 1; \item \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter.location}{recordcount.page.3} is set to 4; \item \glosfielddisp{recordcount.counter.location}{recordcount.section.3} is set to~1. \end{itemize} You can access these fields using the following commands which will expand to the field value if set or to 0 if unset: \cmddef{GlsXtrTotalRecordCount} This expands to the total record count for the entry given by \meta{label}. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrTotalRecordCount}\marg{bird} \end{codebox} expands to 8. \cmddef{GlsXtrRecordCount} This expands to the \idxc{locationcounter}{counter} total for the entry given by \meta{entry-label} where \meta{counter} is the counter name. For example: \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrRecordCount}\marg{bird}\marg{\ctr{page}} \end{codebox} expands to 7 and \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrRecordCount}\marg{bird}\marg{\ctr{section}} \end{codebox} expands to 1. \cmddef{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount} This expands to the total for the given \location. For example \begin{codebox} \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount}\marg{bird}\marg{\ctr{page}}\marg{3} \end{codebox} expands to 4. Be careful about using \gls{thepage} in the \meta{location} part. Remember that due to \TeX's asynchronous output routine, \gls{thepage} may not be correct. There are commands analogous to the entry counting commands like \gls{cgls} and \gls{cglsformat} that are triggered by the record count. These are listed below. The test to determine if the entry's record count exceeds the trigger value (which should be stored in the \catattr{recordcount} attribute) is obtained with: \cmddef{glsxtrifrecordtrigger} If the \catattr{recordcount} attribute is set and \meta{total} exceeds the value given by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute, then this does \meta{true} otherwise it does \meta{false}. The \meta{total} is given by: \cmddef{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue} This should expand to the record count value that needs testing. The default definition is: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue}}[1]\marg{\% \gls{GlsXtrTotalRecordCount}\marg{\#1}\% } \end{compactcodebox} This command may be redefined as appropriate. For example, it may be redefined to use \gls{GlsXtrRecordCount} for a particular \idx{locationcounter} or to use \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount} for a particular location. The \catattr{recordcount} attribute may be set with \gls{glssetcategoryattribute} or can be set for each listed category with: \cmddef{GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute} The value must be an integer. Commands like \gls{rgls} behave slightly differently to \gls{cgls}. It's necessary for the command to add a \record\ to the \ext{aux} file in order for the entry to be selected and for the record count to be correct on the next \app{bib2gls}+\LaTeX\ run (for the default \resourceoptvalm{selection}{recorded and deps}). The trigger record is created with \glsoptval{format}{glstriggerrecordformat}, which \app{bib2gls} v1.1+ recognises as a special type of \idx{ignoredlocation} format. This corresponds to the command: \cmddef{glstriggerrecordformat} As with \gls{glsignore}, this command does nothing and is considered an ignored record (so it won't appear in the \idx{locationlist}), but it indicates to \app{bib2gls} that the entry must be selected and, if the \resourceopt{trigger-type} option has been set, the entry will be assigned to the \resourceopt{trigger-type} glossary. For example, to assign the entry to an \idx{ignoredglossary}: \begin{codebox} \gls{newignoredglossary}\marg{ignored} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{trigger-type}{ignored}} \end{codebox} This ensures that the entry is defined but it won't show up the normal glossary. \begin{information} The \idx{postlinkhook} won't be implemented if the record trigger is tripped. (That is, if the \gls{rglsformat}-like command is used instead of the \idx{glslike} command.) \end{information} \cmddef{rgls} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{gls} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rglsformat} This has the same definition as \gls{cglsformat}. \cmddef{rglspl} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{glspl} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rglsplformat} which uses the appropriate plural fields. \cmddef{rGls} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{Gls} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rGlsformat} which performs the appropriate case-change. \cmddef{rGlspl} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{Glspl} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rGlsplformat} which uses the appropriate plural fields and case-change. \cmddef{rGLS} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{GLS} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rGLSformat} which performs the appropriate case-change. \cmddef{rGLSpl} If the value has been supplied by the \catattr{recordcount} attribute and is exceeded, this behaves like \gls{GLSpl} otherwise it creates a trigger record and uses: \cmddef{rGLSplformat} which uses the appropriate plural fields and case-change. To make it easier to switch on record counting for an existing document, you can use: \cmddef{glsxtrenablerecordcount} This redefines \gls{gls}, \gls{glspl}, \gls{Gls}, \gls{Glspl}, \gls{GLS}, \gls{GLSpl} to \gls{rgls}, \gls{rglspl}, \gls{rGls}, \gls{rGlspl}, \gls{rGLS}, \gls{rGLSpl}, respectively, for convenience. This command will also switch the shortcut commands such as \gls{ac} or \gls{ab}, if they have been enabled, from using the \gls{cgls}-like commands to the corresponding \gls{rgls} command. For example, using the earlier \hypertarget{examplebib}{\filefmt{terms.bib}, \filefmt{abbrvs.bib} and \filefmt{symbols.bib}} example files: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{article} \codepar \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{newignoredglossary}\marg{ignored} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}} \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{ \resourceoptvalm{src}{terms,abbrvs,symbols}, \resourceoptval{trigger-type}{ignored}, \resourceoptvalm{category}{same as entry} } \codepar \gls{glsxtrenablerecordcount} \gls{GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute}\marg{\cat{general},\cat{abbreviation}}\marg{1} \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{entry}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{\cat{symbol}}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{gls}\marg{bird}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}, \gls{gls}\marg{bird}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}, \gls{gls}\marg{M}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} If the document is called \filefmt{myDoc.tex}, then the build process is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls \switch{record-count} myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The \resourceoptvalm{category}{same as entry} resource option assigns the \gloskey{category} field to the \ext{bib} entry type (without the initial \code{@}). This means that the entries defined in \filefmt{terms.bib} (with \atentry{entry}) have their \gloskey{category} set to \code{entry}, the entries defined in \filefmt{abbrvs.bib} (with \atentry{abbreviation}) have their \gloskey{category} set to \code{abbreviation}, and the entries defined in \filefmt{symbols.bib} (with \atentry{symbol}) have their \gloskey{category} set to \code{symbol}. I've added \idxpl{postlinkhook} to the \catfmt{entry} and \catfmt{symbol} categories to show the description on \idx{firstuse} (but not for the \catfmt{abbreviation} category). \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[ label={ex:bib2glsrecordcounting}, title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: record counting}, description={Example document using bib2gls with multiple resource sets}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { recordcount: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{terms.bib}^^J% \termsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cbeg{filecontents*}{symbols.bib}^^J% \symbolsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{newignoredglossary}\marg{ignored}^^J% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{^^J \resourceoptvalm{src}{terms,abbrvs,symbols},^^J \resourceoptval{trigger-type}{ignored},^^J \resourceoptvalm{category}{same as entry}^^J% } \codepar \gls{glsxtrenablerecordcount}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute}\marg{symbol,abbreviation}\marg{1} \codepar \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{entry}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}}^^J% \gls{glsdefpostlink}\marg{symbol}\marg{\gls{glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse}} } {\gls{gls}\marg{M}, \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}, \gls{gls}\marg{bird}, \gls{gls}\marg{html},^^J% \gls{gls}\marg{M}, \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} In the above, \code{ssi} and \code{bird} only have one record. However, they have been treated differently. The \code{ssi} entry is using \gls{rglsformat} whereas the \code{bird} entry is using the normal \gls{gls} behaviour. This is because the record counting hasn't been applied to the custom \catfmt{entry} category, whereas it has been applied to the \catfmt{abbreviation} and \catfmt{symbol} categories. \subsection{Unit Record Counting} \label{sec:unitrecordcount} If you want unit record counting you need to remember to invoke \app{bib2gls} with \switch{record-count-unit} and you will also need to redefine \gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue} appropriately. For example, suppose you want to reset all abbreviations at the start of each chapter, so that the full form is shown again, but only if the abbreviation isn't used elsewhere in the chapter. This would require records with the \glsopt{counter} set to \ctr{chapter}. This can be done with the \opt{counter} package option: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\optval{counter}{\ctr{chapter}}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \end{codebox} However, this will have chapter numbers instead of page numbers in the \idxpl{locationlist}. If you don't want \idxpl{locationlist} then this isn't a problem. The list can simply be suppressed with \opt{nonumberlist}. If you want page numbers in the \idxpl{locationlist} then you will need to \record\ each entry with both the \ctr{page} and \ctr{chapter} counters. This can be done with the hook that occurs before the \gls{gls} options are set: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore},\glsoptval{counter}{\ctr{chapter}}}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}} \end{codebox} Note that I've used the ignored location format to prevent the chapter number from being added to the \idx{locationlist}. An alternative is to use the \resourceoptval{loc-counters}{\ctr{page}} resource option to only show the locations that use the \ctr{page} counter. The definition of \gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue} needs to be changed so that it uses the total for the given location. If \sty{hyperref} is used, you will need \theHcounter{chapter}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount}\marg{\#1}\marg{\ctr{chapter}}\marg{\theHcounter{chapter}}\comment{} } \end{codebox} otherwise use \thecounter{chapter}. Consider the following (using the abbreviations defined in the earlier \filefmt{abbrvs.bib}): \begin{codebox} \cbeg{document} \cmd{chapter}\marg{First} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \cmd{chapter}\marg{Second} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{xml}. \codepar \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} Note that the \code{xml} entry is only used once in the entire document, but it will still be added to the glossary. The previous example used the \resourceopt{trigger-type} resource option to move entries with the \encap{glstriggerrecordformat} encap (that is, they didn't exceed the trigger value) to another glossary. Unfortunately, using that option in this case will move all three abbreviations to the \resourceopt{trigger-type} glossary. The \code{ssi} entry is only used once in the first chapter (but is used twice in the second chapter), and the \code{html} is only used once in the second chapter (but is used three times in the first chapter). So all three will have \records\ in the \ext{aux} file with the special \encap{glstriggerrecordformat} format. A simple solution is to omit any entries that don't have the \gloskey{location} field set when displaying the glossary: \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}*\marg{\gloskey{location}}\marg{\#1} \marg{}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\comment{} } \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \end{codebox} An alternative is to test the total record count, but remember that each entry is being \recorded\ twice: once with the \ctr{page} counter and once with the \ctr{chapter} counter, so the total count for the \code{ssi} entry will be 2 not 1. \begin{warning} Take care not to strip entries from a \glslink{hierarchicallevel}{hierarchical glossary} as it will break the hierarchy and will cause formatting problems in the glossary. \end{warning} The complete document is: \begin{codebox} \cmd{documentclass}\marg{scrreport} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{postdot}}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{\abbrstyle{long-short-sc-desc}} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{abbrvs}} \codepar \cmd{preto}\marg{\cmd{chapter}}\marg{\gls{glsresetall}} \gls{glsxtrenablerecordcount} \gls{GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute}\marg{abbreviation}\marg{1} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{\glsoptval{format}{glsignore},\glsoptval{counter}{\ctr{chapter}}}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount}\marg{\#1}\marg{\ctr{chapter}}\marg{\thecounter{chapter}}\comment{} } \cbeg{document} \cmd{chapter}\marg{First} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \cmd{chapter}\marg{Second} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{xml}. \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}*\marg{\gloskey{location}}\marg{\#1} \marg{}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\comment{} } \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} If the document is in a file called \filefmt{myDoc.tex} then the document build is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls --record-count-unit myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[ label={ex:bib2glsunitrecordcounting}, title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: unit record counting},class=scrreport,pages={1,2,3}, description={Example document using bib2gls with unit records}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { recordcountunit: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,postdot}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{chapterpagestyle}}\marg{empty}\comment{to assist cropping}% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{abbrvs}} \codepar \cmd{preto}\marg{\cmd{chapter}}\marg{\gls{glsresetall}}^^J% \gls{glsxtrenablerecordcount}^^J% \gls{GlsXtrSetRecordCountAttribute}\marg{abbreviation}\marg{1} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{format=glsignore,counter=chapter}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{glsxtrrecordtriggervalue}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrLocationRecordCount}\marg{\#1}\marg{chapter}\marg{\cmd{theHchapter}}\comment{}% } } {\cmd{chapter}\marg{First} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \cmd{chapter}\marg{Second} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{xml}. \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}*\marg{location}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\comment{}% }^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \subsection{Mini-Glossaries} \label{sec:unitrecordcountminigloss} Record counting doesn't have to be used with the \gls{rgls} set of commands. When \app{bib2gls} writes the code to the \ext{glstex} file to save the record counting information, it does it with helper commands that it provides in the \ext{glstex} file: \cmddef{bibglssettotalrecordcount} This sets the total record count and is defined in the \ext{glstex} file as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{providecommand}*\marg{\gls{bibglssettotalrecordcount}}[2]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{\#1}\marg{\glosfield{recordcount}}\marg{\#2}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} \cmddef{bibglssetrecordcount} This sets the total for the given counter and is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{providecommand}*\marg{\gls{bibglssetrecordcount}}[3]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{\#1}\marg{\recordcounterfield{\#2}}\marg{\#3}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} The following is only available with \switch{record-count-unit}: \cmddef{bibglssetlocationrecordcount} This sets the total for the given location and is defined as: \begin{compactcodebox} \cmd{providecommand}*\marg{\gls{bibglssetlocationrecordcount}}[4]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{\#1}\marg{\recordcounterlocationfield{\#2}{\gls{glsxtrdetoklocation}\marg{\#3}}}\marg{\#4}\comment{} } \end{compactcodebox} By defining one of more of these commands before the \ext{glstex} file is input, it's possible to pick up the information, without the need to iterate over all entries later. For example, the following will create a \idx{mini-glossary} for each particular location and populate it with entries that have a record for that location. \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{bibglssetlocationrecordcount}}[4]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{\#1}\marg{\recordcounterlocationfield{\#2}{\#3}}\marg{\#4}\comment{} \gls{provideignoredglossary}\marg{minigloss.\#2.\#3}\comment{} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{\#1}{minigloss.\#2.\#3}\comment{} } \end{codebox} I've omitted \gls{glsxtrdetoklocation} for clarity and because I'm confident the locations won't be problematic. The \idx{mini-glossary} can then be displayed at the start of the chapter with: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{\printglossoptval{type}{minigloss.chapter.\theHcounter{chapter}}} \end{codebox} The previous example can be altered to strip the \gls{rgls} commands and instead add a \idx{mini-glossary} at the start of each chapter (the redefinition of \gls{glslinkpresetkeys} remains to ensure there are locations with the \ctr{chapter} counter). I've also provided a command to make it easier to display the \idxpl{mini-glossary}: \begin{codebox} \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{minigloss}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oarg{\printglossoptval{style}{\glostyle{abbr-short-long}},\printglossoptval{type}{minigloss.chapter.\theHcounter{chapter}},\printglossoptval{groups}{false},\printglossoptval{target}{false}}\comment{} \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glossarysection}}[2][]\marg{}\comment{} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraShortLongTabularHeader}}\marg{\cmd{toprule}}\comment{} }% } \end{codebox} The document build is the same. \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[label=ex:recordcountminigloss,class=scrreport,pages={1,2,3}, title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: unit record counting mini-glossary}, description={Example document using bib2gls to create a mini-glossary with unit records}, arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { recordcountunit: on },pdflatex,pdfcrop} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{abbrvs.bib}^^J% \abbrvsbibcontent^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{T1}\marg{fontenc}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{colorlinks}\marg{hyperref}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{record,postdot,stylemods=longextra}\marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\cmd{chapterpagestyle}}\marg{empty}\comment{to assist cropping}% \gls{setabbreviationstyle}\marg{long-short-sc-desc} \codepar \cmd{newcommand}*\marg{\gls{bibglssetlocationrecordcount}}[4]\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrSetField}\marg{\#1}\marg{recordcount.\#2.\#3}\marg{\#4}\comment{} \gls{provideignoredglossary}\marg{minigloss.\#2.\#3}\comment{} \gls{glsxtrcopytoglossary}\marg{\#1}{minigloss.\#2.\#3}\comment{}% } \codepar \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptvalm{src}{abbrvs}} \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslinkpresetkeys}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsadd}\oarg{format=glsignore,counter=chapter}\marg{\gls{glslabel}}}^^J% \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{minigloss}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{printunsrtglossary*}\oarg{style=abbr-short-long,type=minigloss.chapter.\cmd{theHchapter},groups=false,target=false}\comment{} \marg{\cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glossarysection}}[2][]\marg{}\comment{} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glslongextraShortLongTabularHeader}}\marg{\cmd{toprule}}\comment{}% }} } {\cmd{chapter}\marg{First} \cmd{minigloss} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \codepar \cmd{chapter}\marg{Second} \cmd{minigloss} \gls{gls}\marg{html}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{ssi}. \gls{gls}\marg{xml}. \codepar \cmd{renewcommand}*\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryentryprocesshook}}[1]\marg{\comment{} \gls{glsxtrifhasfield}*\marg{location}\marg{\#1}\marg{}\marg{\gls{printunsrtglossaryskipentry}}\comment{}% }^^J% \gls{printunsrtglossaries} } \end{resultbox} \section{The \stytext{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} package} \label{sec:bib2glssty} \pkgdef{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} \glsstartrange{pkg.glossaries-extra-bib2gls}% The package options \opteqvalref{record}{only} (or simply \opt{record}) and \opteqvalref{record}{nameref} automatically loads the supplementary package \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls}, which provides some commands that are specific to \app{bib2gls}, in particular to sorting and \idxpl{locationlist} which aren't relevant with \opteqvalref{record}{hybrid}. If \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is loaded via the \opt{record} package option then the check for associated language files (see \sectionref{sec:lang}) will also search for the existence of \metafilefmt{glossariesxtr-}{script}{.ldf} for each document dialect (where \meta{script} is the four letter script identifier, such as \code{Latn}). \subsection{Displaying Glossaries} \label{sec:printunsrtshortcuts} \Idxpl{glossary} are displayed with the \idx{unsrtfam} (see \sectionref{sec:printunsrt}). Some styles, such as \glostyle{bookindex}, are customized for use with \app{bib2gls}. The following commands are shortcuts that use \gls{printunsrtglossary}. However, they are only defined if a corresponding package option has been set \emph{before} \sty{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} is loaded. This means that the options must be passed as a package option, not using \gls{glossariesextrasetup}, if the shortcut commands are required. \cmddef{printunsrtabbreviations} This shortcut is provided if the \opt{abbreviations} package option has been used. This is a shortcut for: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{type=abbreviations,\meta{options}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{printunsrtacronyms} This shortcut is provided if the \opt{acronyms} (or \opt{acronym}) package option has been used. This is a shortcut for: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{type=\gls{acronymtype},\meta{options}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{printunsrtsymbols} This shortcut is provided if the \opt{symbols} package option has been used. This is a shortcut for: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{type=symbols,\meta{options}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{printunsrtnumbers} This shortcut is provided if the \opt{numbers} package option has been used. This is a shortcut for: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{type=numbers,\meta{options}} \end{codebox} \cmddef{printunsrtindex} This shortcut is provided if the \opt{index} package option has been used. This is a shortcut for: \begin{codebox} \gls{printunsrtglossary}\oarg{type=index,\meta{options}} \end{codebox} \subsection{Helper Commands for Resource Options} \label{sec:resourcecommands} \cmddef{glshex} This simply expands to \code{\gls{string}\gls{u}\meta{hex}}, which is used to identify the Unicode character \meta{hex} in the value of some \idxpl{resourceopt}. \cmddef{glshashchar} This expands to a literal \idx{sym.hash} character (similar to \gls{glsbackslash}). \cmddef{glscapturedgroup} This simply expands to \code{\gls{string}\gls{dollar}\meta{n}} which is used to indicate the \meta{n}th captured group in a regular expression replacement in the value of some \idxpl{resourceopt} (requires \app{bib2gls} v1.5+), such as \resourceopt{sort-replace}. For example: \begin{codebox} \resourceoptvalm{sort-replace}{\marg{([a-zA-Z])\gls{string}\gls{cs.dot}}\marg{\gls{glscapturedgroup}1}} \end{codebox} This removes a full stop that follows any of the characters a,\ldots,z or A,\ldots,Z. \begin{important} Note that \gls{glscapturedgroup} isn't the same as the match group identifier \gls{MGP}. \end{important} If you have complex regular expressions or use \resourceopt{assign-fields}, you may find it more convenient to redefine \gls{glsxtrresourceinit} to use the following command: \cmddef{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} \begin{important} \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} should not be used outside of the definition of \gls{glsxtrresourceinit} as the definitions will likely cause interference and are only intended as resource option instructions for \app{bib2gls}. \end{important} This command locally redefines escape sequences used in regular expressions so that they detokenize when they expand. This means that you won't need to use \gls{string} or \gls{protect} in front of them. The following commands are defined: \begin{itemize} \item \cmddefsyntax{}{u} (Unicode character); \item General use: \cmddefsyntax{}{cs} (expands to detokenized \csfmt{csname} when writing to the \ext{aux} file); \item For literal characters in regular expressions: \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.dot} \cmddefsyntax{}{bksl} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.slash} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.pipe} \cmddefsyntax{}{amp} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.plus} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.lt} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.gt} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.star} \cmddefsyntax{}{dollar} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.circum} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.tilde} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.openparen} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.closeparen} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.opensq} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.closesq} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.quote} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.hyphen} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.question} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.colon} \cmddefsyntax{}{cs.hash} \item Special markup for use as instructions or keywords in \resourceopt{assign-fields}: \cmddefsyntax{}{MGP} \cmddefsyntax{}{LEN} \cmddefsyntax{}{CAT} \cmddefsyntax{}{TRIM} \cmddefsyntax{}{CS} \cmddefsyntax{}{INTERPRET} \cmddefsyntax{}{LABELIFY} \cmddefsyntax{}{LABELIFYLIST} \cmddefsyntax{}{NULL} \cmddefsyntax{}{IN} \cmddefsyntax{}{NIN} \cmddefsyntax{}{PREFIXOF} \cmddefsyntax{}{NOTPREFIXOF} \cmddefsyntax{}{SUFFIXOF} \cmddefsyntax{}{NOTSUFFIXOF} \cmddefsyntax{}{LC} \cmddefsyntax{}{UC} \cmddefsyntax{}{FIRSTLC} \cmddefsyntax{}{FIRSTUC} \cmddefsyntax{}{TITLE}. \end{itemize} For example, with \begin{codebox} \cmd{renewcommand}\marg{\gls{glsxtrresourceinit}}\marg{\comment{} \gls{GlsXtrResourceInitEscSequences} } \end{codebox} then the earlier example can be written more compactly as: \begin{codebox} \resourceoptvalm{sort-replace}{\marg{([a-zA-Z])\gls{cs.dot}}\marg{\gls{dollar}1}} \end{codebox} A convenient shortcut for use in the \resourceopt{entry-type-aliases} setting: \cmddef{GlsXtrBibTeXEntryAliases} This provides aliases for \BibTeX's standard entry types (such as \atentry{article} and \atentry{book}) to \app{bib2gls}['s] \atentry{bibtexentry} entry type (requires \app{bib2gls} v1.4+). You may also want to provide storage keys for \BibTeX's standard fields rather than having to alias them all. This can be done with: \cmddef{GlsXtrProvideBibTeXFields} This defines each \BibTeX\ field, such as \fieldfmt{author}, as a glossary entry key: \begin{compactcodebox} \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{address}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibaddress}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{author}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibauthor}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{booktitle}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibbooktitle}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{chapter}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibchapter}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{edition}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibedition}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{howpublished}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibhowpublished}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{institution}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibinstitution}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{journal}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibjournal}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{month}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibmonth}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{note}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibnote}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{number}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibnumber}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{organization}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbiborganization}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{pages}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibpages}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{publisher}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibpublisher}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{school}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibschool}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{series}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibseries}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{title}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibtitle}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{bibtextype}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibtype}}\% \gls{glsaddstoragekey}\marg{volume}\marg{}\marg{\inlineglsdef{glsxtrbibvolume}}\% \end{compactcodebox} This command should be placed before the first \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}. \begin{warning} \BibTeX's \fieldfmt{type} field clashes with the \sty{glossaries} package's \gloskey{type} key, so this command provides the key \fieldfmt{bibtextype} instead. You can alias it with \resourceoptvalm{field-aliases}{\gloskey{type}=\fieldfmt{bibtextype}} in the \idxpl{resourceopt}. \end{warning} \subsubsection{Custom Sort} \label{sec:customsort} There are many locale alphabetical rules provided with \app{bib2gls}, such as \resourceoptval{sort}{de-1996} for German new orthography. However, it may be that your particular locale isn't supported, or you want a rule that covers multiple scripts or non-alphabetic symbols. The \resourceoptval{sort}{custom} setting combined with \resourceopt{sort-rule} provides a way to define your own sort rule. For example, suppose I have a file called \filefmt{animals.bib} that contains: \newcommand{\animalsbib}{% \atentry{index}\marg{bee}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{lion}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{ant}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{cow}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{goose}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{zebu}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{egret}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{elk}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{llama}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{lynx}\newline \atentry{index}\marg{bat}% } \begin{codebox} \animalsbib \end{codebox} Here's a very limited rule that only recognises five letters: \begin{codebox} \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}} \marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{bibglssetlastgrouptitle}}[2]\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{\#1\#2}\marg{Other}\% } \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{animals},\resourceoptval{selection}{all}, \resourceoptval{sort}{custom},\resourceoptvalm{sort-rule}{ < a,A < b,B < e,E < l,L < ll,Ll,LL < z,Z}} \codepar \cbeg{document} \gls{printunsrtglossaries} \cend{document} \end{codebox} Any characters that aren't included in the rule (such as \qt{c} and \qt{g}) are placed at the end. I've defined \gls{bibglssetlastgrouptitle} to label that final group of characters \qt{Other}. If the document is in a file called \filefmt{myDoc.tex}, the build process is: \begin{terminal} pdflatex myDoc bib2gls \switch{g} myDoc pdflatex myDoc \end{terminal} The result is: \begin{resultbox} \createexample*[arara={pdflatex,bib2gls: { group : on },pdflatex,pdfcrop}, label={ex:bib2glscustomsort}, title={Using \appfmt{bib2gls}: simple custom sort rule}, description={Example document that provides a simplistic custom sort rule} ] {\cbeg{filecontents*}{animals.bib}^^J% \animalsbib^^J% \cend{filecontents*}^^J% \cmd{usepackage}\oarg{\opt{record},\opt{nostyles},\optval{stylemods}{bookindex},\optval{style}{\glostyle{bookindex}}}^^J \marg{glossaries-extra} \codepar \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\gls{bibglssetlastgrouptitle}}[2]\marg{\%^^J \gls{glsxtrsetgrouptitle}\marg{\#1\#2}\marg{Other}\%^^J% } \gls{GlsXtrLoadResources}\oarg{\resourceoptval{src}{animals},\resourceoptval{selection}{all},^^J \resourceoptval{sort}{custom},\resourceoptvalm{sort-rule}{ < a,A < b,B < e,E < l,L < ll,Ll,LL < z,Z}} } {\gls{printunsrtglossaries}} \end{resultbox} Note that \qt{egret} has been placed after \qt{elk}. This is because \qt{l} is included in the rule but \qt{g} isn't. Whereas \qt{lynx} comes before \qt{llama} because there's a separate \qt{ll} group after the \qt{l} group. The commands listed below provide common rule blocks for use in the \resourceopt{sort-rule} resource option. If you want a rule for a specific locale, you can provide similar commands in a file called \metafilefmt{glossariesxtr-}{tag}{.ldf}, where \meta{tag} identifies the dialect, locale, region or root language. See the description of \gls{IfTrackedLanguageFileExists} in the \sty{tracklang} documentation for further details. If this file is on \TeX's path and the \sty{tracklang} package (automatically loaded by \sty{glossaries}) detects that the document has requested that language or locale, then the file will automatically be loaded. For example, if you want to provide a rule block for Welsh, then create a file called \filefmt{glossariesxtr-welsh.ldf} that contains: \begin{codebox} \gls{ProvidesGlossariesExtraLang}\marg{welsh}[2018/02/23 v1.0] \codepar \cmd{@ifpackageloaded}\marg{glossaries-extra-bib2gls} \marg{ \cmd{newcommand}\marg{\cmd{glsxtrWelshRules}}\marg{\% \gls{glsxtrLatinA} \gls{string}